Improve gcore manpage and clarify "-o" option
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright (C) 1988-2018 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
3 @c
4 @c %**start of header
5 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
6 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
7 @setfilename gdb.info
8 @c
9 @c man begin INCLUDE
10 @include gdb-cfg.texi
11 @c man end
12 @c
13 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
14 @setchapternewpage odd
15 @c %**end of header
16
17 @iftex
18 @c @smallbook
19 @c @cropmarks
20 @end iftex
21
22 @finalout
23 @c To avoid file-name clashes between index.html and Index.html, when
24 @c the manual is produced on a Posix host and then moved to a
25 @c case-insensitive filesystem (e.g., MS-Windows), we separate the
26 @c indices into two: Concept Index and all the rest.
27 @syncodeindex ky fn
28 @syncodeindex tp fn
29
30 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
31 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
32 @syncodeindex vr fn
33
34 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
35 @c This is updated by GNU Press.
36 @set EDITION Tenth
37
38 @c !!set GDB edit command default editor
39 @set EDITOR /bin/ex
40
41 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
42
43 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
44 @c manuals to an info tree.
45 @dircategory Software development
46 @direntry
47 * Gdb: (gdb). The GNU debugger.
48 * gdbserver: (gdb) Server. The GNU debugging server.
49 @end direntry
50
51 @copying
52 @c man begin COPYRIGHT
53 Copyright @copyright{} 1988-2018 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
54
55 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
56 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3 or
57 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
58 Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
59 Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
60 and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
61
62 (a) The FSF's Back-Cover Text is: ``You are free to copy and modify
63 this GNU Manual. Buying copies from GNU Press supports the FSF in
64 developing GNU and promoting software freedom.''
65 @c man end
66 @end copying
67
68 @ifnottex
69 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
70
71 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, of @cite{Debugging with
72 @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger} for @value{GDBN}
73 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
74 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
75 @end ifset
76 Version @value{GDBVN}.
77
78 @insertcopying
79 @end ifnottex
80
81 @titlepage
82 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
83 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
84 @sp 1
85 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
86 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
87 @sp 1
88 @subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
89 @end ifset
90 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
91 @page
92 @tex
93 {\parskip=0pt
94 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.)\par
95 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
96 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
97 }
98 @end tex
99
100 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
101 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
102 51 Franklin Street, Fifth Floor,
103 Boston, MA 02110-1301, USA@*
104 ISBN 978-0-9831592-3-0 @*
105
106 @insertcopying
107 @end titlepage
108 @page
109
110 @ifnottex
111 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
112
113 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
114
115 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
116
117 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN}
118 @ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
119 @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
120 @end ifset
121 Version @value{GDBVN}.
122
123 Copyright (C) 1988-2018 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
124
125 This edition of the GDB manual is dedicated to the memory of Fred
126 Fish. Fred was a long-standing contributor to GDB and to Free
127 software in general. We will miss him.
128
129 @menu
130 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
131 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
132
133 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
134 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
135 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
136 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
137 * Reverse Execution:: Running programs backward
138 * Process Record and Replay:: Recording inferior's execution and replaying it
139 * Stack:: Examining the stack
140 * Source:: Examining source files
141 * Data:: Examining data
142 * Optimized Code:: Debugging optimized code
143 * Macros:: Preprocessor Macros
144 * Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
145 * Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
146
147 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
148
149 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
150 * Altering:: Altering execution
151 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
152 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
153 * Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
154 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
155 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
156 * Extending GDB:: Extending @value{GDBN}
157 * Interpreters:: Command Interpreters
158 * TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
159 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
160 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
161 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
162 * JIT Interface:: Using the JIT debugging interface.
163 * In-Process Agent:: In-Process Agent
164
165 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
166
167 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
168 * Command Line Editing: (rluserman). Command Line Editing
169 * Using History Interactively: (history). Using History Interactively
170 @end ifset
171 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
172 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
173 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
174 @end ifclear
175 * In Memoriam:: In Memoriam
176 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
177 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
178 * Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
179 * Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
180 * Agent Expressions:: The GDB Agent Expression Mechanism
181 * Target Descriptions:: How targets can describe themselves to
182 @value{GDBN}
183 * Operating System Information:: Getting additional information from
184 the operating system
185 * Trace File Format:: GDB trace file format
186 * Index Section Format:: .gdb_index section format
187 * Man Pages:: Manual pages
188 * Copying:: GNU General Public License says
189 how you can copy and share GDB
190 * GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
191 * Concept Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} concepts
192 * Command and Variable Index:: Index of @value{GDBN} commands, variables,
193 functions, and Python data types
194 @end menu
195
196 @end ifnottex
197
198 @contents
199
200 @node Summary
201 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
202
203 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
204 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
205 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
206
207 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
208 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
209
210 @itemize @bullet
211 @item
212 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
213
214 @item
215 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
216
217 @item
218 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
219
220 @item
221 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
222 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
223 @end itemize
224
225 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C@t{++}.
226 For more information, see @ref{Supported Languages,,Supported Languages}.
227 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
228
229 Support for D is partial. For information on D, see
230 @ref{D,,D}.
231
232 @cindex Modula-2
233 Support for Modula-2 is partial. For information on Modula-2, see
234 @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}.
235
236 Support for OpenCL C is partial. For information on OpenCL C, see
237 @ref{OpenCL C,,OpenCL C}.
238
239 @cindex Pascal
240 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
241 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
242 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
243 syntax.
244
245 @cindex Fortran
246 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
247 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
248 underscore.
249
250 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Objective-C,
251 using either the Apple/NeXT or the GNU Objective-C runtime.
252
253 @menu
254 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
255 * Free Documentation:: Free Software Needs Free Documentation
256 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
257 @end menu
258
259 @node Free Software
260 @unnumberedsec Free Software
261
262 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
263 General Public License
264 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
265 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
266 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
267 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
268 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
269 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
270
271 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
272 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
273 from anyone else.
274
275 @node Free Documentation
276 @unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
277
278 The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
279 the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
280 include with the free software. Many of our most important
281 programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
282 texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
283 when an important free software package does not come with a free
284 manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
285 gaps today.
286
287 Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
288 normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
289 authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
290 copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
291 them from the free software world.
292
293 That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
294 from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
295 manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
296 only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
297 contract to make it non-free.
298
299 Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
300 price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
301 charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
302 Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
303 problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
304 are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
305 modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
306
307 The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
308 free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
309 commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
310 accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
311
312 Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
313 When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
314 are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
315 provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
316 manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
317 a changed version of the program is not really available to our
318 community.
319
320 Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
321 acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
322 author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
323 authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
324 to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
325 may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
326 with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
327 are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
328 of the manual.
329
330 However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
331 content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
332 media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
333 obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
334 manual to replace it.
335
336 Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
337 lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
338 free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
339 the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
340 realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
341 the free software community.
342
343 If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
344 the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
345 license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
346 don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
347 will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
348 option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
349 what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
350 try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
351 is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
352
353 You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
354 manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
355 copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
356 improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
357 at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
358 and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
359 Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
360 have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
361
362 The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
363 published by other publishers, at
364 @url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
365
366 @node Contributors
367 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
368
369 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
370 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
371 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
372 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
373 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
374 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
375 blow-by-blow account.
376
377 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
378
379 @quotation
380 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
381 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
382 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
383 @end quotation
384
385 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
386 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
387 releases:
388 Andrew Cagney (releases 6.3, 6.2, 6.1, 6.0, 5.3, 5.2, 5.1 and 5.0);
389 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
390 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
391 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
392 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
393 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
394 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
395 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
396 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
397
398 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
399 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
400
401 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
402 in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
403 Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
404 demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
405 much general update work leading to release 3.0).
406
407 @value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
408 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
409 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
410
411 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
412 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
413
414 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF 2 support.
415
416 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
417 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
418 support.
419 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
420 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
421 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
422 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
423 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
424 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
425 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
426 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
427 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
428 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
429 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
430 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
431 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
432 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
433 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
434 Marko Mlinar contributed OpenRISC 1000 support.
435
436 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K @sc{gnu}/Linux support.
437
438 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
439 libraries.
440
441 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
442 about several machine instruction sets.
443
444 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
445 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
446 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
447 and RDI targets, respectively.
448
449 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
450 command-line editing and command history.
451
452 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
453 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
454
455 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
456 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
457 symbols.
458
459 Hitachi America (now Renesas America), Ltd. sponsored the support for
460 H8/300, H8/500, and Super-H processors.
461
462 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
463
464 Mitsubishi (now Renesas) sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D
465 processors.
466
467 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
468
469 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
470
471 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
472
473 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
474 watchpoints.
475
476 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
477
478 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
479
480 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
481 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
482
483 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
484 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
485 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
486 compiler, and the Text User Interface (nee Terminal User Interface):
487 Ben Krepp, Richard Title, John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann,
488 Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase
489 provided HP-specific information in this manual.
490
491 DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
492 Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
493
494 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
495 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
496 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
497 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
498 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
499 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
500 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
501 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
502 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
503 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
504 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
505 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
506 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
507 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
508 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
509
510 Andrew Cagney, Fernando Nasser, and Elena Zannoni, while working for
511 Cygnus Solutions, implemented the original @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
512
513 Jim Blandy added support for preprocessor macros, while working for Red
514 Hat.
515
516 Andrew Cagney designed @value{GDBN}'s architecture vector. Many
517 people including Andrew Cagney, Stephane Carrez, Randolph Chung, Nick
518 Duffek, Richard Henderson, Mark Kettenis, Grace Sainsbury, Kei
519 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Andreas Schwab, Jason
520 Thorpe, Corinna Vinschen, Ulrich Weigand, and Elena Zannoni, helped
521 with the migration of old architectures to this new framework.
522
523 Andrew Cagney completely re-designed and re-implemented @value{GDBN}'s
524 unwinder framework, this consisting of a fresh new design featuring
525 frame IDs, independent frame sniffers, and the sentinel frame. Mark
526 Kettenis implemented the @sc{dwarf 2} unwinder, Jeff Johnston the
527 libunwind unwinder, and Andrew Cagney the dummy, sentinel, tramp, and
528 trad unwinders. The architecture-specific changes, each involving a
529 complete rewrite of the architecture's frame code, were carried out by
530 Jim Blandy, Joel Brobecker, Kevin Buettner, Andrew Cagney, Stephane
531 Carrez, Randolph Chung, Orjan Friberg, Richard Henderson, Daniel
532 Jacobowitz, Jeff Johnston, Mark Kettenis, Theodore A. Roth, Kei
533 Sakamoto, Yoshinori Sato, Michael Snyder, Corinna Vinschen, and Ulrich
534 Weigand.
535
536 Christian Zankel, Ross Morley, Bob Wilson, and Maxim Grigoriev from
537 Tensilica, Inc.@: contributed support for Xtensa processors. Others
538 who have worked on the Xtensa port of @value{GDBN} in the past include
539 Steve Tjiang, John Newlin, and Scott Foehner.
540
541 Michael Eager and staff of Xilinx, Inc., contributed support for the
542 Xilinx MicroBlaze architecture.
543
544 Initial support for the FreeBSD/mips target and native configuration
545 was developed by SRI International and the University of Cambridge
546 Computer Laboratory under DARPA/AFRL contract FA8750-10-C-0237
547 ("CTSRD"), as part of the DARPA CRASH research programme.
548
549 The original port to the OpenRISC 1000 is believed to be due to
550 Alessandro Forin and Per Bothner. More recent ports have been the work
551 of Jeremy Bennett, Franck Jullien, Stefan Wallentowitz and
552 Stafford Horne.
553
554 @node Sample Session
555 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
556
557 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
558 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
559 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
560
561 @iftex
562 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
563 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
564 @end iftex
565
566 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
567 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
568
569 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
570 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
571 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
572 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
573 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
574 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
575 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
576 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
577 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
578
579 @smallexample
580 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
581 $ @b{./m4}
582 @b{define(foo,0000)}
583
584 @b{foo}
585 0000
586 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
587
588 @b{bar}
589 0000
590 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
591
592 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
593 @b{baz}
594 @b{Ctrl-d}
595 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
596 @end smallexample
597
598 @noindent
599 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
600
601 @smallexample
602 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
603 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
604 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
605 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
606 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
607 the conditions.
608 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
609 for details.
610
611 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
612 (@value{GDBP})
613 @end smallexample
614
615 @noindent
616 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
617 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
618 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
619 that examples fit in this manual.
620
621 @smallexample
622 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
623 @end smallexample
624
625 @noindent
626 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
627 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
628 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
629 @code{break} command.
630
631 @smallexample
632 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
633 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
634 @end smallexample
635
636 @noindent
637 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
638 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
639 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
640
641 @smallexample
642 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
643 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
644 @b{define(foo,0000)}
645
646 @b{foo}
647 0000
648 @end smallexample
649
650 @noindent
651 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
652 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
653 context where it stops.
654
655 @smallexample
656 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
657
658 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
659 at builtin.c:879
660 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
661 @end smallexample
662
663 @noindent
664 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
665 the next line of the current function.
666
667 @smallexample
668 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
669 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
670 : nil,
671 @end smallexample
672
673 @noindent
674 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
675 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
676 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
677 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
678
679 @smallexample
680 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
681 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
682 at input.c:530
683 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
684 @end smallexample
685
686 @noindent
687 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
688 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
689 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
690 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
691 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
692 stack frame for each active subroutine.
693
694 @smallexample
695 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
696 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
697 at input.c:530
698 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
699 at builtin.c:882
700 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
701 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
702 at macro.c:71
703 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
704 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
705 @end smallexample
706
707 @noindent
708 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
709 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
710 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
711
712 @smallexample
713 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
714 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
715 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
716 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
717 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
718 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
719 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
720 : xstrdup(rq);
721 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
722 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
723 @end smallexample
724
725 @noindent
726 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
727 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
728 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
729 (@code{print}) to see their values.
730
731 @smallexample
732 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
733 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
734 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
735 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
736 @end smallexample
737
738 @noindent
739 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
740 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
741 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
742
743 @smallexample
744 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
745 533 xfree(rquote);
746 534
747 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
748 : xstrdup (lq);
749 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
750 : xstrdup (rq);
751 537
752 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
753 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
754 540 @}
755 541
756 542 void
757 @end smallexample
758
759 @noindent
760 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
761 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
762
763 @smallexample
764 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
765 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
766 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
767 540 @}
768 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
769 $3 = 9
770 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
771 $4 = 7
772 @end smallexample
773
774 @noindent
775 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
776 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
777 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
778 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
779 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
780 assignments.
781
782 @smallexample
783 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
784 $5 = 7
785 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
786 $6 = 9
787 @end smallexample
788
789 @noindent
790 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
791 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
792 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
793 example that caused trouble initially:
794
795 @smallexample
796 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
797 Continuing.
798
799 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
800
801 baz
802 0000
803 @end smallexample
804
805 @noindent
806 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
807 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
808 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
809
810 @smallexample
811 @b{Ctrl-d}
812 Program exited normally.
813 @end smallexample
814
815 @noindent
816 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
817 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
818 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
819
820 @smallexample
821 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
822 @end smallexample
823
824 @node Invocation
825 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
826
827 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
828 The essentials are:
829 @itemize @bullet
830 @item
831 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
832 @item
833 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{Ctrl-d} to exit.
834 @end itemize
835
836 @menu
837 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
838 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
839 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
840 * Logging Output:: How to log @value{GDBN}'s output to a file
841 @end menu
842
843 @node Invoking GDB
844 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
845
846 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
847 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
848
849 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
850 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
851
852 The command-line options described here are designed
853 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
854 options may effectively be unavailable.
855
856 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
857 specifying an executable program:
858
859 @smallexample
860 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
861 @end smallexample
862
863 @noindent
864 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
865 specified:
866
867 @smallexample
868 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
869 @end smallexample
870
871 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
872 to debug a running process:
873
874 @smallexample
875 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
876 @end smallexample
877
878 @noindent
879 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
880 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
881
882 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
883 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
884 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
885 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
886 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
887
888 You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
889 executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
890 option processing.
891 @smallexample
892 @value{GDBP} --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
893 @end smallexample
894 This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
895 @code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
896
897 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
898 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{--silent}
899 (or @code{-q}/@code{--quiet}):
900
901 @smallexample
902 @value{GDBP} --silent
903 @end smallexample
904
905 @noindent
906 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
907 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
908
909 @noindent
910 Type
911
912 @smallexample
913 @value{GDBP} -help
914 @end smallexample
915
916 @noindent
917 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
918 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
919
920 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
921 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
922 @samp{-x} option is used.
923
924
925 @menu
926 * File Options:: Choosing files
927 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
928 * Startup:: What @value{GDBN} does during startup
929 @end menu
930
931 @node File Options
932 @subsection Choosing Files
933
934 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
935 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
936 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
937 @samp{-c} (or @samp{-p}) options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
938 first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
939 equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
940 second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
941 equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
942 If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
943 first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
944 to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
945 a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
946 prefixing it with @file{./}, e.g.@: @file{./12345}.
947
948 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
949 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
950 argument and ignore it.
951
952 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
953 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
954 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
955 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
956 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
957
958 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
959 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
960 @c it.
961
962 @table @code
963 @item -symbols @var{file}
964 @itemx -s @var{file}
965 @cindex @code{--symbols}
966 @cindex @code{-s}
967 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
968
969 @item -exec @var{file}
970 @itemx -e @var{file}
971 @cindex @code{--exec}
972 @cindex @code{-e}
973 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
974 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
975
976 @item -se @var{file}
977 @cindex @code{--se}
978 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
979 file.
980
981 @item -core @var{file}
982 @itemx -c @var{file}
983 @cindex @code{--core}
984 @cindex @code{-c}
985 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
986
987 @item -pid @var{number}
988 @itemx -p @var{number}
989 @cindex @code{--pid}
990 @cindex @code{-p}
991 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
992
993 @item -command @var{file}
994 @itemx -x @var{file}
995 @cindex @code{--command}
996 @cindex @code{-x}
997 Execute commands from file @var{file}. The contents of this file is
998 evaluated exactly as the @code{source} command would.
999 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
1000
1001 @item -eval-command @var{command}
1002 @itemx -ex @var{command}
1003 @cindex @code{--eval-command}
1004 @cindex @code{-ex}
1005 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command.
1006
1007 This option may be used multiple times to call multiple commands. It may
1008 also be interleaved with @samp{-command} as required.
1009
1010 @smallexample
1011 @value{GDBP} -ex 'target sim' -ex 'load' \
1012 -x setbreakpoints -ex 'run' a.out
1013 @end smallexample
1014
1015 @item -init-command @var{file}
1016 @itemx -ix @var{file}
1017 @cindex @code{--init-command}
1018 @cindex @code{-ix}
1019 Execute commands from file @var{file} before loading the inferior (but
1020 after loading gdbinit files).
1021 @xref{Startup}.
1022
1023 @item -init-eval-command @var{command}
1024 @itemx -iex @var{command}
1025 @cindex @code{--init-eval-command}
1026 @cindex @code{-iex}
1027 Execute a single @value{GDBN} command before loading the inferior (but
1028 after loading gdbinit files).
1029 @xref{Startup}.
1030
1031 @item -directory @var{directory}
1032 @itemx -d @var{directory}
1033 @cindex @code{--directory}
1034 @cindex @code{-d}
1035 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source and script files.
1036
1037 @item -r
1038 @itemx -readnow
1039 @cindex @code{--readnow}
1040 @cindex @code{-r}
1041 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
1042 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
1043 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
1044
1045 @item --readnever
1046 @anchor{--readnever}
1047 @cindex @code{--readnever}, command-line option
1048 Do not read each symbol file's symbolic debug information. This makes
1049 startup faster but at the expense of not being able to perform
1050 symbolic debugging. DWARF unwind information is also not read,
1051 meaning backtraces may become incomplete or inaccurate. One use of
1052 this is when a user simply wants to do the following sequence: attach,
1053 dump core, detach. Loading the debugging information in this case is
1054 an unnecessary cause of delay.
1055 @end table
1056
1057 @node Mode Options
1058 @subsection Choosing Modes
1059
1060 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
1061 batch mode or quiet mode.
1062
1063 @table @code
1064 @anchor{-nx}
1065 @item -nx
1066 @itemx -n
1067 @cindex @code{--nx}
1068 @cindex @code{-n}
1069 Do not execute commands found in any initialization file.
1070 There are three init files, loaded in the following order:
1071
1072 @table @code
1073 @item @file{system.gdbinit}
1074 This is the system-wide init file.
1075 Its location is specified with the @code{--with-system-gdbinit}
1076 configure option (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
1077 It is loaded first when @value{GDBN} starts, before command line options
1078 have been processed.
1079 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}
1080 This is the init file in your home directory.
1081 It is loaded next, after @file{system.gdbinit}, and before
1082 command options have been processed.
1083 @item @file{./.gdbinit}
1084 This is the init file in the current directory.
1085 It is loaded last, after command line options other than @code{-x} and
1086 @code{-ex} have been processed. Command line options @code{-x} and
1087 @code{-ex} are processed last, after @file{./.gdbinit} has been loaded.
1088 @end table
1089
1090 For further documentation on startup processing, @xref{Startup}.
1091 For documentation on how to write command files,
1092 @xref{Command Files,,Command Files}.
1093
1094 @anchor{-nh}
1095 @item -nh
1096 @cindex @code{--nh}
1097 Do not execute commands found in @file{~/.gdbinit}, the init file
1098 in your home directory.
1099 @xref{Startup}.
1100
1101 @item -quiet
1102 @itemx -silent
1103 @itemx -q
1104 @cindex @code{--quiet}
1105 @cindex @code{--silent}
1106 @cindex @code{-q}
1107 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
1108 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
1109
1110 @item -batch
1111 @cindex @code{--batch}
1112 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
1113 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
1114 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
1115 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
1116 in the command files. Batch mode also disables pagination, sets unlimited
1117 terminal width and height @pxref{Screen Size}, and acts as if @kbd{set confirm
1118 off} were in effect (@pxref{Messages/Warnings}).
1119
1120 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
1121 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
1122 make this more useful, the message
1123
1124 @smallexample
1125 Program exited normally.
1126 @end smallexample
1127
1128 @noindent
1129 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
1130 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
1131 mode.
1132
1133 @item -batch-silent
1134 @cindex @code{--batch-silent}
1135 Run in batch mode exactly like @samp{-batch}, but totally silently. All
1136 @value{GDBN} output to @code{stdout} is prevented (@code{stderr} is
1137 unaffected). This is much quieter than @samp{-silent} and would be useless
1138 for an interactive session.
1139
1140 This is particularly useful when using targets that give @samp{Loading section}
1141 messages, for example.
1142
1143 Note that targets that give their output via @value{GDBN}, as opposed to
1144 writing directly to @code{stdout}, will also be made silent.
1145
1146 @item -return-child-result
1147 @cindex @code{--return-child-result}
1148 The return code from @value{GDBN} will be the return code from the child
1149 process (the process being debugged), with the following exceptions:
1150
1151 @itemize @bullet
1152 @item
1153 @value{GDBN} exits abnormally. E.g., due to an incorrect argument or an
1154 internal error. In this case the exit code is the same as it would have been
1155 without @samp{-return-child-result}.
1156 @item
1157 The user quits with an explicit value. E.g., @samp{quit 1}.
1158 @item
1159 The child process never runs, or is not allowed to terminate, in which case
1160 the exit code will be -1.
1161 @end itemize
1162
1163 This option is useful in conjunction with @samp{-batch} or @samp{-batch-silent},
1164 when @value{GDBN} is being used as a remote program loader or simulator
1165 interface.
1166
1167 @item -nowindows
1168 @itemx -nw
1169 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
1170 @cindex @code{-nw}
1171 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
1172 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
1173 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1174
1175 @item -windows
1176 @itemx -w
1177 @cindex @code{--windows}
1178 @cindex @code{-w}
1179 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1180 used if possible.
1181
1182 @item -cd @var{directory}
1183 @cindex @code{--cd}
1184 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1185 instead of the current directory.
1186
1187 @item -data-directory @var{directory}
1188 @itemx -D @var{directory}
1189 @cindex @code{--data-directory}
1190 @cindex @code{-D}
1191 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its data directory.
1192 The data directory is where @value{GDBN} searches for its
1193 auxiliary files. @xref{Data Files}.
1194
1195 @item -fullname
1196 @itemx -f
1197 @cindex @code{--fullname}
1198 @cindex @code{-f}
1199 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1200 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1201 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1202 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1203 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1204 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1205 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1206 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1207 frame.
1208
1209 @item -annotate @var{level}
1210 @cindex @code{--annotate}
1211 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1212 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1213 (@pxref{Annotations}). The annotation @var{level} controls how much
1214 information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt, values of
1215 expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0 is the
1216 normal, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of
1217 @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable for programs
1218 that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 has been deprecated.
1219
1220 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
1221 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
1222
1223 @item --args
1224 @cindex @code{--args}
1225 Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1226 executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1227 This option stops option processing.
1228
1229 @item -baud @var{bps}
1230 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1231 @cindex @code{--baud}
1232 @cindex @code{-b}
1233 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1234 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1235
1236 @item -l @var{timeout}
1237 @cindex @code{-l}
1238 Set the timeout (in seconds) of any communication used by @value{GDBN}
1239 for remote debugging.
1240
1241 @item -tty @var{device}
1242 @itemx -t @var{device}
1243 @cindex @code{--tty}
1244 @cindex @code{-t}
1245 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1246 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1247
1248 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1249 @item -tui
1250 @cindex @code{--tui}
1251 Activate the @dfn{Text User Interface} when starting. The Text User
1252 Interface manages several text windows on the terminal, showing
1253 source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1254 (@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}). Do not use this
1255 option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs (@pxref{Emacs, ,
1256 Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1257
1258 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1259 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1260 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1261 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1262 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1263 @xref{Interpreters, , Command Interpreters}.
1264
1265 @samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi2}) causes
1266 @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{@sc{gdb/mi} interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,
1267 The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}) included since @value{GDBN} version 6.0. The
1268 previous @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in @value{GDBN} version 5.3 and
1269 selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi1}, is deprecated. Earlier
1270 @sc{gdb/mi} interfaces are no longer supported.
1271
1272 @item -write
1273 @cindex @code{--write}
1274 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1275 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1276 (@pxref{Patching}).
1277
1278 @item -statistics
1279 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1280 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1281 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1282
1283 @item -version
1284 @cindex @code{--version}
1285 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1286 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1287
1288 @item -configuration
1289 @cindex @code{--configuration}
1290 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print details about its build-time
1291 configuration parameters, and then exit. These details can be
1292 important when reporting @value{GDBN} bugs (@pxref{GDB Bugs}).
1293
1294 @end table
1295
1296 @node Startup
1297 @subsection What @value{GDBN} Does During Startup
1298 @cindex @value{GDBN} startup
1299
1300 Here's the description of what @value{GDBN} does during session startup:
1301
1302 @enumerate
1303 @item
1304 Sets up the command interpreter as specified by the command line
1305 (@pxref{Mode Options, interpreter}).
1306
1307 @item
1308 @cindex init file
1309 Reads the system-wide @dfn{init file} (if @option{--with-system-gdbinit} was
1310 used when building @value{GDBN}; @pxref{System-wide configuration,
1311 ,System-wide configuration and settings}) and executes all the commands in
1312 that file.
1313
1314 @anchor{Home Directory Init File}
1315 @item
1316 Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
1317 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
1318 @code{HOME} environment variable.} and executes all the commands in
1319 that file.
1320
1321 @anchor{Option -init-eval-command}
1322 @item
1323 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-iex} and
1324 @samp{-ix} options in their specified order. Usually you should use the
1325 @samp{-ex} and @samp{-x} options instead, but this way you can apply
1326 settings before @value{GDBN} init files get executed and before inferior
1327 gets loaded.
1328
1329 @item
1330 Processes command line options and operands.
1331
1332 @anchor{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}
1333 @item
1334 Reads and executes the commands from init file (if any) in the current
1335 working directory as long as @samp{set auto-load local-gdbinit} is set to
1336 @samp{on} (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory}).
1337 This is only done if the current directory is
1338 different from your home directory. Thus, you can have more than one
1339 init file, one generic in your home directory, and another, specific
1340 to the program you are debugging, in the directory where you invoke
1341 @value{GDBN}.
1342
1343 @item
1344 If the command line specified a program to debug, or a process to
1345 attach to, or a core file, @value{GDBN} loads any auto-loaded
1346 scripts provided for the program or for its loaded shared libraries.
1347 @xref{Auto-loading}.
1348
1349 If you wish to disable the auto-loading during startup,
1350 you must do something like the following:
1351
1352 @smallexample
1353 $ gdb -iex "set auto-load python-scripts off" myprogram
1354 @end smallexample
1355
1356 Option @samp{-ex} does not work because the auto-loading is then turned
1357 off too late.
1358
1359 @item
1360 Executes commands and command files specified by the @samp{-ex} and
1361 @samp{-x} options in their specified order. @xref{Command Files}, for
1362 more details about @value{GDBN} command files.
1363
1364 @item
1365 Reads the command history recorded in the @dfn{history file}.
1366 @xref{Command History}, for more details about the command history and the
1367 files where @value{GDBN} records it.
1368 @end enumerate
1369
1370 Init files use the same syntax as @dfn{command files} (@pxref{Command
1371 Files}) and are processed by @value{GDBN} in the same way. The init
1372 file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
1373 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
1374 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
1375 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing Modes}).
1376
1377 To display the list of init files loaded by gdb at startup, you
1378 can use @kbd{gdb --help}.
1379
1380 @cindex init file name
1381 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
1382 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
1383 The @value{GDBN} init files are normally called @file{.gdbinit}.
1384 The DJGPP port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini}, due to
1385 the limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems. The Windows
1386 port of @value{GDBN} uses the standard name, but if it finds a
1387 @file{gdb.ini} file in your home directory, it warns you about that
1388 and suggests to rename the file to the standard name.
1389
1390
1391 @node Quitting GDB
1392 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1393 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1394 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1395
1396 @table @code
1397 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1398 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1399 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1400 @itemx q
1401 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1402 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{Ctrl-d}). If you
1403 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1404 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1405 error code.
1406 @end table
1407
1408 @cindex interrupt
1409 An interrupt (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1410 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1411 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1412 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1413 until a time when it is safe.
1414
1415 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1416 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1417 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
1418
1419 @node Shell Commands
1420 @section Shell Commands
1421
1422 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1423 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1424 just use the @code{shell} command.
1425
1426 @table @code
1427 @kindex shell
1428 @kindex !
1429 @cindex shell escape
1430 @item shell @var{command-string}
1431 @itemx !@var{command-string}
1432 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command-string}.
1433 Note that no space is needed between @code{!} and @var{command-string}.
1434 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1435 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1436 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1437 @end table
1438
1439 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1440 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1441 @value{GDBN}:
1442
1443 @table @code
1444 @kindex make
1445 @cindex calling make
1446 @item make @var{make-args}
1447 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1448 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1449 @end table
1450
1451 @node Logging Output
1452 @section Logging Output
1453 @cindex logging @value{GDBN} output
1454 @cindex save @value{GDBN} output to a file
1455
1456 You may want to save the output of @value{GDBN} commands to a file.
1457 There are several commands to control @value{GDBN}'s logging.
1458
1459 @table @code
1460 @kindex set logging
1461 @item set logging on
1462 Enable logging.
1463 @item set logging off
1464 Disable logging.
1465 @cindex logging file name
1466 @item set logging file @var{file}
1467 Change the name of the current logfile. The default logfile is @file{gdb.txt}.
1468 @item set logging overwrite [on|off]
1469 By default, @value{GDBN} will append to the logfile. Set @code{overwrite} if
1470 you want @code{set logging on} to overwrite the logfile instead.
1471 @item set logging redirect [on|off]
1472 By default, @value{GDBN} output will go to both the terminal and the logfile.
1473 Set @code{redirect} if you want output to go only to the log file.
1474 @kindex show logging
1475 @item show logging
1476 Show the current values of the logging settings.
1477 @end table
1478
1479 @node Commands
1480 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1481
1482 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1483 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1484 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1485 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1486 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1487
1488 @menu
1489 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1490 * Completion:: Command completion
1491 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1492 @end menu
1493
1494 @node Command Syntax
1495 @section Command Syntax
1496
1497 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1498 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1499 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1500 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1501 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1502 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1503
1504 @cindex abbreviation
1505 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1506 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1507 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1508 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1509 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1510 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1511 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1512
1513 @cindex repeating commands
1514 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1515 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1516 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1517 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1518 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1519 repeat. User-defined commands can disable this feature; see
1520 @ref{Define, dont-repeat}.
1521
1522 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1523 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1524 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1525
1526 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1527 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1528 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen Size}). Since it is easy to press one
1529 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1530 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1531
1532 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1533 @cindex comment
1534 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1535 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1536 Files,,Command Files}).
1537
1538 @cindex repeating command sequences
1539 @kindex Ctrl-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1540 The @kbd{Ctrl-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1541 commands. This command accepts the current line, like @key{RET}, and
1542 then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1543 for editing.
1544
1545 @node Completion
1546 @section Command Completion
1547
1548 @cindex completion
1549 @cindex word completion
1550 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1551 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1552 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1553 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1554
1555 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1556 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1557 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1558 enter it). For example, if you type
1559
1560 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1561 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1562 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1563 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1564 @smallexample
1565 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1566 @end smallexample
1567
1568 @noindent
1569 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1570 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1571
1572 @smallexample
1573 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1574 @end smallexample
1575
1576 @noindent
1577 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1578 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1579 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1580 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1581 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1582 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1583
1584 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1585 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1586 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1587 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1588 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1589 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1590 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1591 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1592 example:
1593
1594 @smallexample
1595 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1596 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1597 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1598 make_abs_section make_function_type
1599 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1600 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1601 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1602 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1603 @end smallexample
1604
1605 @noindent
1606 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1607 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1608 command.
1609
1610 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1611 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1612 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1613 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1614 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1615
1616 If the number of possible completions is large, @value{GDBN} will
1617 print as much of the list as it has collected, as well as a message
1618 indicating that the list may be truncated.
1619
1620 @smallexample
1621 (@value{GDBP}) b m@key{TAB}@key{TAB}
1622 main
1623 <... the rest of the possible completions ...>
1624 *** List may be truncated, max-completions reached. ***
1625 (@value{GDBP}) b m
1626 @end smallexample
1627
1628 @noindent
1629 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands:
1630
1631 @table @code
1632 @kindex set max-completions
1633 @item set max-completions @var{limit}
1634 @itemx set max-completions unlimited
1635 Set the maximum number of completion candidates. @value{GDBN} will
1636 stop looking for more completions once it collects this many candidates.
1637 This is useful when completing on things like function names as collecting
1638 all the possible candidates can be time consuming.
1639 The default value is 200. A value of zero disables tab-completion.
1640 Note that setting either no limit or a very large limit can make
1641 completion slow.
1642 @kindex show max-completions
1643 @item show max-completions
1644 Show the maximum number of candidates that @value{GDBN} will collect and show
1645 during completion.
1646 @end table
1647
1648 @cindex quotes in commands
1649 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1650 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1651 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1652 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1653 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1654 @value{GDBN} commands.
1655
1656 A likely situation where you might need this is in typing an
1657 expression that involves a C@t{++} symbol name with template
1658 parameters. This is because when completing expressions, GDB treats
1659 the @samp{<} character as word delimiter, assuming that it's the
1660 less-than comparison operator (@pxref{C Operators, , C and C@t{++}
1661 Operators}).
1662
1663 For example, when you want to call a C@t{++} template function
1664 interactively using the @code{print} or @code{call} commands, you may
1665 need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name} that
1666 was specialized for @code{int}, @code{name<int>()}, or the version
1667 that was specialized for @code{float}, @code{name<float>()}. To use
1668 the word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1669 @code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1670 @value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1671 when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1672
1673 @smallexample
1674 (@value{GDBP}) p 'func< @kbd{M-?}
1675 func<int>() func<float>()
1676 (@value{GDBP}) p 'func<
1677 @end smallexample
1678
1679 When setting breakpoints however (@pxref{Specify Location}), you don't
1680 usually need to type a quote before the function name, because
1681 @value{GDBN} understands that you want to set a breakpoint on a
1682 function:
1683
1684 @smallexample
1685 (@value{GDBP}) b func< @kbd{M-?}
1686 func<int>() func<float>()
1687 (@value{GDBP}) b func<
1688 @end smallexample
1689
1690 This is true even in the case of typing the name of C@t{++} overloaded
1691 functions (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished by
1692 argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1693 don't need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1694 that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1695 that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}.
1696
1697 @smallexample
1698 (@value{GDBP}) b bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1699 bubble(int) bubble(double)
1700 (@value{GDBP}) b bubble(dou @kbd{M-?}
1701 bubble(double)
1702 @end smallexample
1703
1704 See @ref{quoting names} for a description of other scenarios that
1705 require quoting.
1706
1707 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C Plus Plus
1708 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1709 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1710 see @ref{Debugging C Plus Plus, ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
1711
1712 @cindex completion of structure field names
1713 @cindex structure field name completion
1714 @cindex completion of union field names
1715 @cindex union field name completion
1716 When completing in an expression which looks up a field in a
1717 structure, @value{GDBN} also tries@footnote{The completer can be
1718 confused by certain kinds of invalid expressions. Also, it only
1719 examines the static type of the expression, not the dynamic type.} to
1720 limit completions to the field names available in the type of the
1721 left-hand-side:
1722
1723 @smallexample
1724 (@value{GDBP}) p gdb_stdout.@kbd{M-?}
1725 magic to_fputs to_rewind
1726 to_data to_isatty to_write
1727 to_delete to_put to_write_async_safe
1728 to_flush to_read
1729 @end smallexample
1730
1731 @noindent
1732 This is because the @code{gdb_stdout} is a variable of the type
1733 @code{struct ui_file} that is defined in @value{GDBN} sources as
1734 follows:
1735
1736 @smallexample
1737 struct ui_file
1738 @{
1739 int *magic;
1740 ui_file_flush_ftype *to_flush;
1741 ui_file_write_ftype *to_write;
1742 ui_file_write_async_safe_ftype *to_write_async_safe;
1743 ui_file_fputs_ftype *to_fputs;
1744 ui_file_read_ftype *to_read;
1745 ui_file_delete_ftype *to_delete;
1746 ui_file_isatty_ftype *to_isatty;
1747 ui_file_rewind_ftype *to_rewind;
1748 ui_file_put_ftype *to_put;
1749 void *to_data;
1750 @}
1751 @end smallexample
1752
1753
1754 @node Help
1755 @section Getting Help
1756 @cindex online documentation
1757 @kindex help
1758
1759 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1760 using the command @code{help}.
1761
1762 @table @code
1763 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1764 @item help
1765 @itemx h
1766 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1767 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1768
1769 @smallexample
1770 (@value{GDBP}) help
1771 List of classes of commands:
1772
1773 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1774 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1775 data -- Examining data
1776 files -- Specifying and examining files
1777 internals -- Maintenance commands
1778 obscure -- Obscure features
1779 running -- Running the program
1780 stack -- Examining the stack
1781 status -- Status inquiries
1782 support -- Support facilities
1783 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without
1784 stopping the program
1785 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1786
1787 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1788 commands in that class.
1789 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1790 documentation.
1791 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1792 (@value{GDBP})
1793 @end smallexample
1794 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1795
1796 @item help @var{class}
1797 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1798 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1799 help display for the class @code{status}:
1800
1801 @smallexample
1802 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1803 Status inquiries.
1804
1805 List of commands:
1806
1807 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1808 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1809 info -- Generic command for showing things
1810 about the program being debugged
1811 show -- Generic command for showing things
1812 about the debugger
1813
1814 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1815 documentation.
1816 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1817 (@value{GDBP})
1818 @end smallexample
1819
1820 @item help @var{command}
1821 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1822 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1823
1824 @kindex apropos
1825 @item apropos @var{args}
1826 The @code{apropos} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1827 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1828 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1829
1830 @smallexample
1831 apropos alias
1832 @end smallexample
1833
1834 @noindent
1835 results in:
1836
1837 @smallexample
1838 @c @group
1839 alias -- Define a new command that is an alias of an existing command
1840 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1841 d -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1842 del -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1843 delete -- Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions
1844 @c @end group
1845 @end smallexample
1846
1847 @kindex complete
1848 @item complete @var{args}
1849 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1850 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1851 command you want completed. For example:
1852
1853 @smallexample
1854 complete i
1855 @end smallexample
1856
1857 @noindent results in:
1858
1859 @smallexample
1860 @group
1861 if
1862 ignore
1863 info
1864 inspect
1865 @end group
1866 @end smallexample
1867
1868 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1869 @end table
1870
1871 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1872 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1873 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1874 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1875 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Command, Variable, and
1876 Function Index point to all the sub-commands. @xref{Command and Variable
1877 Index}.
1878
1879 @c @group
1880 @table @code
1881 @kindex info
1882 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1883 @item info
1884 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1885 program. For example, you can show the arguments passed to a function
1886 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1887 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1888 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1889 @w{@code{help info}}.
1890
1891 @kindex set
1892 @item set
1893 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1894 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1895 @code{set prompt $}.
1896
1897 @kindex show
1898 @item show
1899 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1900 @value{GDBN} itself.
1901 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1902 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1903 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1904 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1905
1906 @kindex info set
1907 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1908 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1909 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1910 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1911 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1912 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1913 @end table
1914 @c @end group
1915
1916 Here are several miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1917 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1918
1919 @table @code
1920 @kindex show version
1921 @cindex @value{GDBN} version number
1922 @item show version
1923 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1924 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1925 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1926 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1927 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1928 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1929 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1930 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1931 @value{GDBN}.
1932
1933 @kindex show copying
1934 @kindex info copying
1935 @cindex display @value{GDBN} copyright
1936 @item show copying
1937 @itemx info copying
1938 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1939
1940 @kindex show warranty
1941 @kindex info warranty
1942 @item show warranty
1943 @itemx info warranty
1944 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1945 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1946
1947 @kindex show configuration
1948 @item show configuration
1949 Display detailed information about the way @value{GDBN} was configured
1950 when it was built. This displays the optional arguments passed to the
1951 @file{configure} script and also configuration parameters detected
1952 automatically by @command{configure}. When reporting a @value{GDBN}
1953 bug (@pxref{GDB Bugs}), it is important to include this information in
1954 your report.
1955
1956 @end table
1957
1958 @node Running
1959 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1960
1961 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1962 debugging information when you compile it.
1963
1964 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1965 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1966 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1967 kill a child process.
1968
1969 @menu
1970 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1971 * Starting:: Starting your program
1972 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1973 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1974
1975 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1976 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1977 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1978 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1979
1980 * Inferiors and Programs:: Debugging multiple inferiors and programs
1981 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1982 * Forks:: Debugging forks
1983 * Checkpoint/Restart:: Setting a @emph{bookmark} to return to later
1984 @end menu
1985
1986 @node Compilation
1987 @section Compiling for Debugging
1988
1989 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1990 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1991 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1992 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1993 and addresses in the executable code.
1994
1995 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1996 the compiler.
1997
1998 Programs that are to be shipped to your customers are compiled with
1999 optimizations, using the @samp{-O} compiler option. However, some
2000 compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O} options
2001 together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
2002 executables containing debugging information.
2003
2004 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
2005 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
2006 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
2007 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
2008 in pushing your luck. For more information, see @ref{Optimized Code}.
2009
2010 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
2011 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
2012 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
2013
2014 @value{GDBN} knows about preprocessor macros and can show you their
2015 expansion (@pxref{Macros}). Most compilers do not include information
2016 about preprocessor macros in the debugging information if you specify
2017 the @option{-g} flag alone. Version 3.1 and later of @value{NGCC},
2018 the @sc{gnu} C compiler, provides macro information if you are using
2019 the DWARF debugging format, and specify the option @option{-g3}.
2020
2021 @xref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or GCC,
2022 gcc.info, Using the @sc{gnu} Compiler Collection (GCC)}, for more
2023 information on @value{NGCC} options affecting debug information.
2024
2025 You will have the best debugging experience if you use the latest
2026 version of the DWARF debugging format that your compiler supports.
2027 DWARF is currently the most expressive and best supported debugging
2028 format in @value{GDBN}.
2029
2030 @need 2000
2031 @node Starting
2032 @section Starting your Program
2033 @cindex starting
2034 @cindex running
2035
2036 @table @code
2037 @kindex run
2038 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
2039 @item run
2040 @itemx r
2041 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
2042 You must first specify the program name with an argument to
2043 @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
2044 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file}
2045 command (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
2046
2047 @end table
2048
2049 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
2050 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
2051 that process run your program. In some environments without processes,
2052 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program. Other targets,
2053 like @samp{remote}, are always running. If you get an error
2054 message like this one:
2055
2056 @smallexample
2057 The "remote" target does not support "run".
2058 Try "help target" or "continue".
2059 @end smallexample
2060
2061 @noindent
2062 then use @code{continue} to run your program. You may need @code{load}
2063 first (@pxref{load}).
2064
2065 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
2066 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
2067 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
2068 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
2069 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
2070 divided into four categories:
2071
2072 @table @asis
2073 @item The @emph{arguments.}
2074 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
2075 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
2076 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
2077 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
2078 the arguments.
2079 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
2080 @code{SHELL} environment variable. If you do not define @code{SHELL},
2081 @value{GDBN} uses the default shell (@file{/bin/sh}). You can disable
2082 use of any shell with the @code{set startup-with-shell} command (see
2083 below for details).
2084
2085 @item The @emph{environment.}
2086 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
2087 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
2088 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
2089 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your Program's Environment}.
2090
2091 @item The @emph{working directory.}
2092 You can set your program's working directory with the command
2093 @kbd{set cwd}. If you do not set any working directory with this
2094 command, your program will inherit @value{GDBN}'s working directory if
2095 native debugging, or the remote server's working directory if remote
2096 debugging. @xref{Working Directory, ,Your Program's Working
2097 Directory}.
2098
2099 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
2100 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
2101 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
2102 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
2103 set a different device for your program.
2104 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your Program's Input and Output}.
2105
2106 @cindex pipes
2107 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
2108 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
2109 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
2110 wrong program.
2111 @end table
2112
2113 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
2114 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and Continuing}, for discussion
2115 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
2116 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
2117 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
2118
2119 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
2120 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
2121 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
2122 your current breakpoints.
2123
2124 @table @code
2125 @kindex start
2126 @item start
2127 @cindex run to main procedure
2128 The name of the main procedure can vary from language to language.
2129 With C or C@t{++}, the main procedure name is always @code{main}, but
2130 other languages such as Ada do not require a specific name for their
2131 main procedure. The debugger provides a convenient way to start the
2132 execution of the program and to stop at the beginning of the main
2133 procedure, depending on the language used.
2134
2135 The @samp{start} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2136 breakpoint at the beginning of the main procedure and then invoking
2137 the @samp{run} command.
2138
2139 @cindex elaboration phase
2140 Some programs contain an @dfn{elaboration} phase where some startup code is
2141 executed before the main procedure is called. This depends on the
2142 languages used to write your program. In C@t{++}, for instance,
2143 constructors for static and global objects are executed before
2144 @code{main} is called. It is therefore possible that the debugger stops
2145 before reaching the main procedure. However, the temporary breakpoint
2146 will remain to halt execution.
2147
2148 Specify the arguments to give to your program as arguments to the
2149 @samp{start} command. These arguments will be given verbatim to the
2150 underlying @samp{run} command. Note that the same arguments will be
2151 reused if no argument is provided during subsequent calls to
2152 @samp{start} or @samp{run}.
2153
2154 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration. In
2155 these cases, using the @code{start} command would stop the execution
2156 of your program too late, as the program would have already completed
2157 the elaboration phase. Under these circumstances, either insert
2158 breakpoints in your elaboration code before running your program or
2159 use the @code{starti} command.
2160
2161 @kindex starti
2162 @item starti
2163 @cindex run to first instruction
2164 The @samp{starti} command does the equivalent of setting a temporary
2165 breakpoint at the first instruction of a program's execution and then
2166 invoking the @samp{run} command. For programs containing an
2167 elaboration phase, the @code{starti} command will stop execution at
2168 the start of the elaboration phase.
2169
2170 @anchor{set exec-wrapper}
2171 @kindex set exec-wrapper
2172 @item set exec-wrapper @var{wrapper}
2173 @itemx show exec-wrapper
2174 @itemx unset exec-wrapper
2175 When @samp{exec-wrapper} is set, the specified wrapper is used to
2176 launch programs for debugging. @value{GDBN} starts your program
2177 with a shell command of the form @kbd{exec @var{wrapper}
2178 @var{program}}. Quoting is added to @var{program} and its
2179 arguments, but not to @var{wrapper}, so you should add quotes if
2180 appropriate for your shell. The wrapper runs until it executes
2181 your program, and then @value{GDBN} takes control.
2182
2183 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
2184 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
2185 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
2186 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
2187
2188 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
2189 the debugged program, without setting the variable in your shell's
2190 environment:
2191
2192 @smallexample
2193 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper env 'LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so'
2194 (@value{GDBP}) run
2195 @end smallexample
2196
2197 This command is available when debugging locally on most targets, excluding
2198 @sc{djgpp}, Cygwin, MS Windows, and QNX Neutrino.
2199
2200 @kindex set startup-with-shell
2201 @anchor{set startup-with-shell}
2202 @item set startup-with-shell
2203 @itemx set startup-with-shell on
2204 @itemx set startup-with-shell off
2205 @itemx show startup-with-shell
2206 On Unix systems, by default, if a shell is available on your target,
2207 @value{GDBN}) uses it to start your program. Arguments of the
2208 @code{run} command are passed to the shell, which does variable
2209 substitution, expands wildcard characters and performs redirection of
2210 I/O. In some circumstances, it may be useful to disable such use of a
2211 shell, for example, when debugging the shell itself or diagnosing
2212 startup failures such as:
2213
2214 @smallexample
2215 (@value{GDBP}) run
2216 Starting program: ./a.out
2217 During startup program terminated with signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
2218 @end smallexample
2219
2220 @noindent
2221 which indicates the shell or the wrapper specified with
2222 @samp{exec-wrapper} crashed, not your program. Most often, this is
2223 caused by something odd in your shell's non-interactive mode
2224 initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell,
2225 $@file{.zshenv} for the Z shell, or the file specified in the
2226 @samp{BASH_ENV} environment variable for BASH.
2227
2228 @anchor{set auto-connect-native-target}
2229 @kindex set auto-connect-native-target
2230 @item set auto-connect-native-target
2231 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target on
2232 @itemx set auto-connect-native-target off
2233 @itemx show auto-connect-native-target
2234
2235 By default, if not connected to any target yet (e.g., with
2236 @code{target remote}), the @code{run} command starts your program as a
2237 native process under @value{GDBN}, on your local machine. If you're
2238 sure you don't want to debug programs on your local machine, you can
2239 tell @value{GDBN} to not connect to the native target automatically
2240 with the @code{set auto-connect-native-target off} command.
2241
2242 If @code{on}, which is the default, and if @value{GDBN} is not
2243 connected to a target already, the @code{run} command automaticaly
2244 connects to the native target, if one is available.
2245
2246 If @code{off}, and if @value{GDBN} is not connected to a target
2247 already, the @code{run} command fails with an error:
2248
2249 @smallexample
2250 (@value{GDBP}) run
2251 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2252 @end smallexample
2253
2254 If @value{GDBN} is already connected to a target, @value{GDBN} always
2255 uses it with the @code{run} command.
2256
2257 In any case, you can explicitly connect to the native target with the
2258 @code{target native} command. For example,
2259
2260 @smallexample
2261 (@value{GDBP}) set auto-connect-native-target off
2262 (@value{GDBP}) run
2263 Don't know how to run. Try "help target".
2264 (@value{GDBP}) target native
2265 (@value{GDBP}) run
2266 Starting program: ./a.out
2267 [Inferior 1 (process 10421) exited normally]
2268 @end smallexample
2269
2270 In case you connected explicitly to the @code{native} target,
2271 @value{GDBN} remains connected even if all inferiors exit, ready for
2272 the next @code{run} command. Use the @code{disconnect} command to
2273 disconnect.
2274
2275 Examples of other commands that likewise respect the
2276 @code{auto-connect-native-target} setting: @code{attach}, @code{info
2277 proc}, @code{info os}.
2278
2279 @kindex set disable-randomization
2280 @item set disable-randomization
2281 @itemx set disable-randomization on
2282 This option (enabled by default in @value{GDBN}) will turn off the native
2283 randomization of the virtual address space of the started program. This option
2284 is useful for multiple debugging sessions to make the execution better
2285 reproducible and memory addresses reusable across debugging sessions.
2286
2287 This feature is implemented only on certain targets, including @sc{gnu}/Linux.
2288 On @sc{gnu}/Linux you can get the same behavior using
2289
2290 @smallexample
2291 (@value{GDBP}) set exec-wrapper setarch `uname -m` -R
2292 @end smallexample
2293
2294 @item set disable-randomization off
2295 Leave the behavior of the started executable unchanged. Some bugs rear their
2296 ugly heads only when the program is loaded at certain addresses. If your bug
2297 disappears when you run the program under @value{GDBN}, that might be because
2298 @value{GDBN} by default disables the address randomization on platforms, such
2299 as @sc{gnu}/Linux, which do that for stand-alone programs. Use @kbd{set
2300 disable-randomization off} to try to reproduce such elusive bugs.
2301
2302 On targets where it is available, virtual address space randomization
2303 protects the programs against certain kinds of security attacks. In these
2304 cases the attacker needs to know the exact location of a concrete executable
2305 code. Randomizing its location makes it impossible to inject jumps misusing
2306 a code at its expected addresses.
2307
2308 Prelinking shared libraries provides a startup performance advantage but it
2309 makes addresses in these libraries predictable for privileged processes by
2310 having just unprivileged access at the target system. Reading the shared
2311 library binary gives enough information for assembling the malicious code
2312 misusing it. Still even a prelinked shared library can get loaded at a new
2313 random address just requiring the regular relocation process during the
2314 startup. Shared libraries not already prelinked are always loaded at
2315 a randomly chosen address.
2316
2317 Position independent executables (PIE) contain position independent code
2318 similar to the shared libraries and therefore such executables get loaded at
2319 a randomly chosen address upon startup. PIE executables always load even
2320 already prelinked shared libraries at a random address. You can build such
2321 executable using @command{gcc -fPIE -pie}.
2322
2323 Heap (malloc storage), stack and custom mmap areas are always placed randomly
2324 (as long as the randomization is enabled).
2325
2326 @item show disable-randomization
2327 Show the current setting of the explicit disable of the native randomization of
2328 the virtual address space of the started program.
2329
2330 @end table
2331
2332 @node Arguments
2333 @section Your Program's Arguments
2334
2335 @cindex arguments (to your program)
2336 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
2337 @code{run} command.
2338 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
2339 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
2340 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
2341 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
2342 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
2343
2344 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
2345 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
2346 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
2347 the program, not by the shell.
2348
2349 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
2350 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
2351
2352 @table @code
2353 @kindex set args
2354 @item set args
2355 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
2356 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
2357 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
2358 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
2359 it again without arguments.
2360
2361 @kindex show args
2362 @item show args
2363 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
2364 @end table
2365
2366 @node Environment
2367 @section Your Program's Environment
2368
2369 @cindex environment (of your program)
2370 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
2371 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
2372 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
2373 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
2374 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
2375 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
2376 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
2377
2378 @table @code
2379 @kindex path
2380 @item path @var{directory}
2381 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
2382 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
2383 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
2384 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
2385 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
2386 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
2387 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
2388
2389 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
2390 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
2391 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
2392 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
2393 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
2394 @var{directory} to the search path.
2395 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
2396 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
2397
2398 @kindex show paths
2399 @item show paths
2400 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
2401 environment variable).
2402
2403 @kindex show environment
2404 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
2405 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
2406 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
2407 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
2408 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
2409
2410 @kindex set environment
2411 @anchor{set environment}
2412 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
2413 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
2414 changes for your program (and the shell @value{GDBN} uses to launch
2415 it), not for @value{GDBN} itself. The @var{value} may be any string; the
2416 values of environment variables are just strings, and any
2417 interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
2418 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
2419 null value.
2420 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
2421 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
2422
2423 For example, this command:
2424
2425 @smallexample
2426 set env USER = foo
2427 @end smallexample
2428
2429 @noindent
2430 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
2431 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
2432 are not actually required.)
2433
2434 Note that on Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program via a shell,
2435 which also inherits the environment set with @code{set environment}.
2436 If necessary, you can avoid that by using the @samp{env} program as a
2437 wrapper instead of using @code{set environment}. @xref{set
2438 exec-wrapper}, for an example doing just that.
2439
2440 Environment variables that are set by the user are also transmitted to
2441 @command{gdbserver} to be used when starting the remote inferior.
2442 @pxref{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}.
2443
2444 @kindex unset environment
2445 @anchor{unset environment}
2446 @item unset environment @var{varname}
2447 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
2448 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
2449 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
2450 rather than assigning it an empty value.
2451
2452 Environment variables that are unset by the user are also unset on
2453 @command{gdbserver} when starting the remote inferior.
2454 @pxref{QEnvironmentUnset}.
2455 @end table
2456
2457 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
2458 the shell indicated by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it
2459 exists (or @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable
2460 names a shell that runs an initialization file when started
2461 non-interactively---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, $@file{.zshenv}
2462 for the Z shell, or the file specified in the @samp{BASH_ENV}
2463 environment variable for BASH---any variables you set in that file
2464 affect your program. You may wish to move setting of environment
2465 variables to files that are only run when you sign on, such as
2466 @file{.login} or @file{.profile}.
2467
2468 @node Working Directory
2469 @section Your Program's Working Directory
2470
2471 @cindex working directory (of your program)
2472 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, the inferior will be
2473 initialized with the current working directory specified by the
2474 @kbd{set cwd} command. If no directory has been specified by this
2475 command, then the inferior will inherit @value{GDBN}'s current working
2476 directory as its working directory if native debugging, or it will
2477 inherit the remote server's current working directory if remote
2478 debugging.
2479
2480 @table @code
2481 @kindex set cwd
2482 @cindex change inferior's working directory
2483 @anchor{set cwd command}
2484 @item set cwd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2485 Set the inferior's working directory to @var{directory}, which will be
2486 @code{glob}-expanded in order to resolve tildes (@file{~}). If no
2487 argument has been specified, the command clears the setting and resets
2488 it to an empty state. This setting has no effect on @value{GDBN}'s
2489 working directory, and it only takes effect the next time you start
2490 the inferior. The @file{~} in @var{directory} is a short for the
2491 @dfn{home directory}, usually pointed to by the @env{HOME} environment
2492 variable. On MS-Windows, if @env{HOME} is not defined, @value{GDBN}
2493 uses the concatenation of @env{HOMEDRIVE} and @env{HOMEPATH} as
2494 fallback.
2495
2496 You can also change @value{GDBN}'s current working directory by using
2497 the @code{cd} command.
2498 @xref{cd command}.
2499
2500 @kindex show cwd
2501 @cindex show inferior's working directory
2502 @item show cwd
2503 Show the inferior's working directory. If no directory has been
2504 specified by @kbd{set cwd}, then the default inferior's working
2505 directory is the same as @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
2506
2507 @kindex cd
2508 @cindex change @value{GDBN}'s working directory
2509 @anchor{cd command}
2510 @item cd @r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
2511 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}. If not
2512 given, @var{directory} uses @file{'~'}.
2513
2514 The @value{GDBN} working directory serves as a default for the
2515 commands that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on.
2516 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
2517 @xref{set cwd command}.
2518
2519 @kindex pwd
2520 @item pwd
2521 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
2522 @end table
2523
2524 It is generally impossible to find the current working directory of
2525 the process being debugged (since a program can change its directory
2526 during its run). If you work on a system where @value{GDBN} supports
2527 the @code{info proc} command (@pxref{Process Information}), you can
2528 use the @code{info proc} command to find out the
2529 current working directory of the debuggee.
2530
2531 @node Input/Output
2532 @section Your Program's Input and Output
2533
2534 @cindex redirection
2535 @cindex i/o
2536 @cindex terminal
2537 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
2538 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
2539 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
2540 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
2541 running your program.
2542
2543 @table @code
2544 @kindex info terminal
2545 @item info terminal
2546 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
2547 program is using.
2548 @end table
2549
2550 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
2551 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
2552
2553 @smallexample
2554 run > outfile
2555 @end smallexample
2556
2557 @noindent
2558 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
2559
2560 @kindex tty
2561 @cindex controlling terminal
2562 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
2563 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
2564 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
2565 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
2566 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
2567
2568 @smallexample
2569 tty /dev/ttyb
2570 @end smallexample
2571
2572 @noindent
2573 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
2574 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
2575 that as their controlling terminal.
2576
2577 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
2578 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
2579 terminal.
2580
2581 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
2582 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
2583 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal. @code{tty} is an alias
2584 for @code{set inferior-tty}.
2585
2586 @cindex inferior tty
2587 @cindex set inferior controlling terminal
2588 You can use the @code{show inferior-tty} command to tell @value{GDBN} to
2589 display the name of the terminal that will be used for future runs of your
2590 program.
2591
2592 @table @code
2593 @item set inferior-tty [ @var{tty} ]
2594 @kindex set inferior-tty
2595 Set the tty for the program being debugged to @var{tty}. Omitting @var{tty}
2596 restores the default behavior, which is to use the same terminal as
2597 @value{GDBN}.
2598
2599 @item show inferior-tty
2600 @kindex show inferior-tty
2601 Show the current tty for the program being debugged.
2602 @end table
2603
2604 @node Attach
2605 @section Debugging an Already-running Process
2606 @kindex attach
2607 @cindex attach
2608
2609 @table @code
2610 @item attach @var{process-id}
2611 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
2612 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
2613 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
2614 find out the @var{process-id} of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
2615 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
2616
2617 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
2618 executing the command.
2619 @end table
2620
2621 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
2622 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
2623 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
2624 also have permission to send the process a signal.
2625
2626 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
2627 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
2628 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
2629 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}). You can also use
2630 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
2631 Specify Files}.
2632
2633 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
2634 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
2635 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
2636 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
2637 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
2638 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
2639 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
2640
2641 @table @code
2642 @kindex detach
2643 @item detach
2644 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
2645 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
2646 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
2647 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
2648 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
2649 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
2650 executing the command.
2651 @end table
2652
2653 If you exit @value{GDBN} while you have an attached process, you detach
2654 that process. If you use the @code{run} command, you kill that process.
2655 By default, @value{GDBN} asks for confirmation if you try to do either of these
2656 things; you can control whether or not you need to confirm by using the
2657 @code{set confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
2658 Messages}).
2659
2660 @node Kill Process
2661 @section Killing the Child Process
2662
2663 @table @code
2664 @kindex kill
2665 @item kill
2666 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
2667 @end table
2668
2669 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
2670 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
2671 is running.
2672
2673 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
2674 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
2675 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
2676 outside the debugger.
2677
2678 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
2679 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
2680 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
2681 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
2682 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
2683 breakpoint settings).
2684
2685 @node Inferiors and Programs
2686 @section Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs
2687
2688 @value{GDBN} lets you run and debug multiple programs in a single
2689 session. In addition, @value{GDBN} on some systems may let you run
2690 several programs simultaneously (otherwise you have to exit from one
2691 before starting another). In the most general case, you can have
2692 multiple threads of execution in each of multiple processes, launched
2693 from multiple executables.
2694
2695 @cindex inferior
2696 @value{GDBN} represents the state of each program execution with an
2697 object called an @dfn{inferior}. An inferior typically corresponds to
2698 a process, but is more general and applies also to targets that do not
2699 have processes. Inferiors may be created before a process runs, and
2700 may be retained after a process exits. Inferiors have unique
2701 identifiers that are different from process ids. Usually each
2702 inferior will also have its own distinct address space, although some
2703 embedded targets may have several inferiors running in different parts
2704 of a single address space. Each inferior may in turn have multiple
2705 threads running in it.
2706
2707 To find out what inferiors exist at any moment, use @w{@code{info
2708 inferiors}}:
2709
2710 @table @code
2711 @kindex info inferiors [ @var{id}@dots{} ]
2712 @item info inferiors
2713 Print a list of all inferiors currently being managed by @value{GDBN}.
2714 By default all inferiors are printed, but the argument @var{id}@dots{}
2715 -- a space separated list of inferior numbers -- can be used to limit
2716 the display to just the requested inferiors.
2717
2718 @value{GDBN} displays for each inferior (in this order):
2719
2720 @enumerate
2721 @item
2722 the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2723
2724 @item
2725 the target system's inferior identifier
2726
2727 @item
2728 the name of the executable the inferior is running.
2729
2730 @end enumerate
2731
2732 @noindent
2733 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} inferior number
2734 indicates the current inferior.
2735
2736 For example,
2737 @end table
2738 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2739
2740 @smallexample
2741 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2742 Num Description Executable
2743 2 process 2307 hello
2744 * 1 process 3401 goodbye
2745 @end smallexample
2746
2747 To switch focus between inferiors, use the @code{inferior} command:
2748
2749 @table @code
2750 @kindex inferior @var{infno}
2751 @item inferior @var{infno}
2752 Make inferior number @var{infno} the current inferior. The argument
2753 @var{infno} is the inferior number assigned by @value{GDBN}, as shown
2754 in the first field of the @samp{info inferiors} display.
2755 @end table
2756
2757 @vindex $_inferior@r{, convenience variable}
2758 The debugger convenience variable @samp{$_inferior} contains the
2759 number of the current inferior. You may find this useful in writing
2760 breakpoint conditional expressions, command scripts, and so forth.
2761 @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for general
2762 information on convenience variables.
2763
2764 You can get multiple executables into a debugging session via the
2765 @code{add-inferior} and @w{@code{clone-inferior}} commands. On some
2766 systems @value{GDBN} can add inferiors to the debug session
2767 automatically by following calls to @code{fork} and @code{exec}. To
2768 remove inferiors from the debugging session use the
2769 @w{@code{remove-inferiors}} command.
2770
2771 @table @code
2772 @kindex add-inferior
2773 @item add-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ -exec @var{executable} ]
2774 Adds @var{n} inferiors to be run using @var{executable} as the
2775 executable; @var{n} defaults to 1. If no executable is specified,
2776 the inferiors begins empty, with no program. You can still assign or
2777 change the program assigned to the inferior at any time by using the
2778 @code{file} command with the executable name as its argument.
2779
2780 @kindex clone-inferior
2781 @item clone-inferior [ -copies @var{n} ] [ @var{infno} ]
2782 Adds @var{n} inferiors ready to execute the same program as inferior
2783 @var{infno}; @var{n} defaults to 1, and @var{infno} defaults to the
2784 number of the current inferior. This is a convenient command when you
2785 want to run another instance of the inferior you are debugging.
2786
2787 @smallexample
2788 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2789 Num Description Executable
2790 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2791 (@value{GDBP}) clone-inferior
2792 Added inferior 2.
2793 1 inferiors added.
2794 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
2795 Num Description Executable
2796 2 <null> helloworld
2797 * 1 process 29964 helloworld
2798 @end smallexample
2799
2800 You can now simply switch focus to inferior 2 and run it.
2801
2802 @kindex remove-inferiors
2803 @item remove-inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2804 Removes the inferior or inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}. It is not
2805 possible to remove an inferior that is running with this command. For
2806 those, use the @code{kill} or @code{detach} command first.
2807
2808 @end table
2809
2810 To quit debugging one of the running inferiors that is not the current
2811 inferior, you can either detach from it by using the @w{@code{detach
2812 inferior}} command (allowing it to run independently), or kill it
2813 using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}} command:
2814
2815 @table @code
2816 @kindex detach inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2817 @item detach inferior @var{infno}@dots{}
2818 Detach from the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN}
2819 inferior number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry
2820 still stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors},
2821 but its Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2822
2823 @kindex kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2824 @item kill inferiors @var{infno}@dots{}
2825 Kill the inferior or inferiors identified by @value{GDBN} inferior
2826 number(s) @var{infno}@dots{}. Note that the inferior's entry still
2827 stays on the list of inferiors shown by @code{info inferiors}, but its
2828 Description will show @samp{<null>}.
2829 @end table
2830
2831 After the successful completion of a command such as @code{detach},
2832 @code{detach inferiors}, @code{kill} or @code{kill inferiors}, or after
2833 a normal process exit, the inferior is still valid and listed with
2834 @code{info inferiors}, ready to be restarted.
2835
2836
2837 To be notified when inferiors are started or exit under @value{GDBN}'s
2838 control use @w{@code{set print inferior-events}}:
2839
2840 @table @code
2841 @kindex set print inferior-events
2842 @cindex print messages on inferior start and exit
2843 @item set print inferior-events
2844 @itemx set print inferior-events on
2845 @itemx set print inferior-events off
2846 The @code{set print inferior-events} command allows you to enable or
2847 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new
2848 inferiors have started or that inferiors have exited or have been
2849 detached. By default, these messages will not be printed.
2850
2851 @kindex show print inferior-events
2852 @item show print inferior-events
2853 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that
2854 inferiors have started, exited or have been detached.
2855 @end table
2856
2857 Many commands will work the same with multiple programs as with a
2858 single program: e.g., @code{print myglobal} will simply display the
2859 value of @code{myglobal} in the current inferior.
2860
2861
2862 Occasionaly, when debugging @value{GDBN} itself, it may be useful to
2863 get more info about the relationship of inferiors, programs, address
2864 spaces in a debug session. You can do that with the @w{@code{maint
2865 info program-spaces}} command.
2866
2867 @table @code
2868 @kindex maint info program-spaces
2869 @item maint info program-spaces
2870 Print a list of all program spaces currently being managed by
2871 @value{GDBN}.
2872
2873 @value{GDBN} displays for each program space (in this order):
2874
2875 @enumerate
2876 @item
2877 the program space number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2878
2879 @item
2880 the name of the executable loaded into the program space, with e.g.,
2881 the @code{file} command.
2882
2883 @end enumerate
2884
2885 @noindent
2886 An asterisk @samp{*} preceding the @value{GDBN} program space number
2887 indicates the current program space.
2888
2889 In addition, below each program space line, @value{GDBN} prints extra
2890 information that isn't suitable to display in tabular form. For
2891 example, the list of inferiors bound to the program space.
2892
2893 @smallexample
2894 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2895 Id Executable
2896 * 1 hello
2897 2 goodbye
2898 Bound inferiors: ID 1 (process 21561)
2899 @end smallexample
2900
2901 Here we can see that no inferior is running the program @code{hello},
2902 while @code{process 21561} is running the program @code{goodbye}. On
2903 some targets, it is possible that multiple inferiors are bound to the
2904 same program space. The most common example is that of debugging both
2905 the parent and child processes of a @code{vfork} call. For example,
2906
2907 @smallexample
2908 (@value{GDBP}) maint info program-spaces
2909 Id Executable
2910 * 1 vfork-test
2911 Bound inferiors: ID 2 (process 18050), ID 1 (process 18045)
2912 @end smallexample
2913
2914 Here, both inferior 2 and inferior 1 are running in the same program
2915 space as a result of inferior 1 having executed a @code{vfork} call.
2916 @end table
2917
2918 @node Threads
2919 @section Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads
2920
2921 @cindex threads of execution
2922 @cindex multiple threads
2923 @cindex switching threads
2924 In some operating systems, such as GNU/Linux and Solaris, a single program
2925 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2926 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2927 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2928 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2929 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2930 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2931
2932 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2933 programs:
2934
2935 @itemize @bullet
2936 @item automatic notification of new threads
2937 @item @samp{thread @var{thread-id}}, a command to switch among threads
2938 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
2939 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{thread-id-list} | all] @var{args}},
2940 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2941 @item thread-specific breakpoints
2942 @item @samp{set print thread-events}, which controls printing of
2943 messages on thread start and exit.
2944 @item @samp{set libthread-db-search-path @var{path}}, which lets
2945 the user specify which @code{libthread_db} to use if the default choice
2946 isn't compatible with the program.
2947 @end itemize
2948
2949 @cindex focus of debugging
2950 @cindex current thread
2951 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2952 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2953 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2954 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2955 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2956
2957 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
2958 @cindex thread identifier (system)
2959 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2960 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2961 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2962 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2963 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2964 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}, where @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2965 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2966 @sc{gnu}/Linux, you might see
2967
2968 @smallexample
2969 [New Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 25582)]
2970 @end smallexample
2971
2972 @noindent
2973 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on other systems,
2974 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2975 further qualifier.
2976
2977 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2978 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2979 @c second---i.e.@: when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2980 @c program?
2981 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2982 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
2983 @c threads ab initio?
2984
2985 @anchor{thread numbers}
2986 @cindex thread number, per inferior
2987 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2988 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread number
2989 ---always a single integer---with each thread of an inferior. This
2990 number is unique between all threads of an inferior, but not unique
2991 between threads of different inferiors.
2992
2993 @cindex qualified thread ID
2994 You can refer to a given thread in an inferior using the qualified
2995 @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} syntax, also known as
2996 @dfn{qualified thread ID}, with @var{inferior-num} being the inferior
2997 number and @var{thread-num} being the thread number of the given
2998 inferior. For example, thread @code{2.3} refers to thread number 3 of
2999 inferior 2. If you omit @var{inferior-num} (e.g., @code{thread 3}),
3000 then @value{GDBN} infers you're referring to a thread of the current
3001 inferior.
3002
3003 Until you create a second inferior, @value{GDBN} does not show the
3004 @var{inferior-num} part of thread IDs, even though you can always use
3005 the full @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} form to refer to threads
3006 of inferior 1, the initial inferior.
3007
3008 @anchor{thread ID lists}
3009 @cindex thread ID lists
3010 Some commands accept a space-separated @dfn{thread ID list} as
3011 argument. A list element can be:
3012
3013 @enumerate
3014 @item
3015 A thread ID as shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads}
3016 display, with or without an inferior qualifier. E.g., @samp{2.1} or
3017 @samp{1}.
3018
3019 @item
3020 A range of thread numbers, again with or without an inferior
3021 qualifier, as in @var{inf}.@var{thr1}-@var{thr2} or
3022 @var{thr1}-@var{thr2}. E.g., @samp{1.2-4} or @samp{2-4}.
3023
3024 @item
3025 All threads of an inferior, specified with a star wildcard, with or
3026 without an inferior qualifier, as in @var{inf}.@code{*} (e.g.,
3027 @samp{1.*}) or @code{*}. The former refers to all threads of the
3028 given inferior, and the latter form without an inferior qualifier
3029 refers to all threads of the current inferior.
3030
3031 @end enumerate
3032
3033 For example, if the current inferior is 1, and inferior 7 has one
3034 thread with ID 7.1, the thread list @samp{1 2-3 4.5 6.7-9 7.*}
3035 includes threads 1 to 3 of inferior 1, thread 5 of inferior 4, threads
3036 7 to 9 of inferior 6 and all threads of inferior 7. That is, in
3037 expanded qualified form, the same as @samp{1.1 1.2 1.3 4.5 6.7 6.8 6.9
3038 7.1}.
3039
3040
3041 @anchor{global thread numbers}
3042 @cindex global thread number
3043 @cindex global thread identifier (GDB)
3044 In addition to a @emph{per-inferior} number, each thread is also
3045 assigned a unique @emph{global} number, also known as @dfn{global
3046 thread ID}, a single integer. Unlike the thread number component of
3047 the thread ID, no two threads have the same global ID, even when
3048 you're debugging multiple inferiors.
3049
3050 From @value{GDBN}'s perspective, a process always has at least one
3051 thread. In other words, @value{GDBN} assigns a thread number to the
3052 program's ``main thread'' even if the program is not multi-threaded.
3053
3054 @vindex $_thread@r{, convenience variable}
3055 @vindex $_gthread@r{, convenience variable}
3056 The debugger convenience variables @samp{$_thread} and
3057 @samp{$_gthread} contain, respectively, the per-inferior thread number
3058 and the global thread number of the current thread. You may find this
3059 useful in writing breakpoint conditional expressions, command scripts,
3060 and so forth. @xref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for
3061 general information on convenience variables.
3062
3063 If @value{GDBN} detects the program is multi-threaded, it augments the
3064 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint with the ID and name of
3065 the thread that hit the breakpoint.
3066
3067 @smallexample
3068 Thread 2 "client" hit Breakpoint 1, send_message () at client.c:68
3069 @end smallexample
3070
3071 Likewise when the program receives a signal:
3072
3073 @smallexample
3074 Thread 1 "main" received signal SIGINT, Interrupt.
3075 @end smallexample
3076
3077 @table @code
3078 @kindex info threads
3079 @item info threads @r{[}@var{thread-id-list}@r{]}
3080
3081 Display information about one or more threads. With no arguments
3082 displays information about all threads. You can specify the list of
3083 threads that you want to display using the thread ID list syntax
3084 (@pxref{thread ID lists}).
3085
3086 @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
3087
3088 @enumerate
3089 @item
3090 the per-inferior thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
3091
3092 @item
3093 the global thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}, if the @samp{-gid}
3094 option was specified
3095
3096 @item
3097 the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
3098
3099 @item
3100 the thread's name, if one is known. A thread can either be named by
3101 the user (see @code{thread name}, below), or, in some cases, by the
3102 program itself.
3103
3104 @item
3105 the current stack frame summary for that thread
3106 @end enumerate
3107
3108 @noindent
3109 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
3110 indicates the current thread.
3111
3112 For example,
3113 @end table
3114 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
3115
3116 @smallexample
3117 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
3118 Id Target Id Frame
3119 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3120 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3121 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3122 at threadtest.c:68
3123 @end smallexample
3124
3125 If you're debugging multiple inferiors, @value{GDBN} displays thread
3126 IDs using the qualified @var{inferior-num}.@var{thread-num} format.
3127 Otherwise, only @var{thread-num} is shown.
3128
3129 If you specify the @samp{-gid} option, @value{GDBN} displays a column
3130 indicating each thread's global thread ID:
3131
3132 @smallexample
3133 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
3134 Id GId Target Id Frame
3135 1.1 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3136 1.2 3 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3137 1.3 4 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
3138 * 2.1 2 process 65 thread 1 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
3139 @end smallexample
3140
3141 On Solaris, you can display more information about user threads with a
3142 Solaris-specific command:
3143
3144 @table @code
3145 @item maint info sol-threads
3146 @kindex maint info sol-threads
3147 @cindex thread info (Solaris)
3148 Display info on Solaris user threads.
3149 @end table
3150
3151 @table @code
3152 @kindex thread @var{thread-id}
3153 @item thread @var{thread-id}
3154 Make thread ID @var{thread-id} the current thread. The command
3155 argument @var{thread-id} is the @value{GDBN} thread ID, as shown in
3156 the first field of the @samp{info threads} display, with or without an
3157 inferior qualifier (e.g., @samp{2.1} or @samp{1}).
3158
3159 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the
3160 thread you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
3161
3162 @smallexample
3163 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
3164 [Switching to thread 2 (Thread 0xb7fdab70 (LWP 12747))]
3165 #0 some_function (ignore=0x0) at example.c:8
3166 8 printf ("hello\n");
3167 @end smallexample
3168
3169 @noindent
3170 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
3171 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
3172 threads.
3173
3174 @kindex thread apply
3175 @cindex apply command to several threads
3176 @item thread apply [@var{thread-id-list} | all [-ascending]] [@var{flag}]@dots{} @var{command}
3177 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply the named
3178 @var{command} to one or more threads. Specify the threads that you
3179 want affected using the thread ID list syntax (@pxref{thread ID
3180 lists}), or specify @code{all} to apply to all threads. To apply a
3181 command to all threads in descending order, type @kbd{thread apply all
3182 @var{command}}. To apply a command to all threads in ascending order,
3183 type @kbd{thread apply all -ascending @var{command}}.
3184
3185 The @var{flag} arguments control what output to produce and how to handle
3186 errors raised when applying @var{command} to a thread. @var{flag}
3187 must start with a @code{-} directly followed by one letter in
3188 @code{qcs}. If several flags are provided, they must be given
3189 individually, such as @code{-c -q}.
3190
3191 By default, @value{GDBN} displays some thread information before the
3192 output produced by @var{command}, and an error raised during the
3193 execution of a @var{command} will abort @code{thread apply}. The
3194 following flags can be used to fine-tune this behavior:
3195
3196 @table @code
3197 @item -c
3198 The flag @code{-c}, which stands for @samp{continue}, causes any
3199 errors in @var{command} to be displayed, and the execution of
3200 @code{thread apply} then continues.
3201 @item -s
3202 The flag @code{-s}, which stands for @samp{silent}, causes any errors
3203 or empty output produced by a @var{command} to be silently ignored.
3204 That is, the execution continues, but the thread information and errors
3205 are not printed.
3206 @item -q
3207 The flag @code{-q} (@samp{quiet}) disables printing the thread
3208 information.
3209 @end table
3210
3211 Flags @code{-c} and @code{-s} cannot be used together.
3212
3213 @kindex taas
3214 @cindex apply command to all threads (ignoring errors and empty output)
3215 @item taas @var{command}
3216 Shortcut for @code{thread apply all -s @var{command}}.
3217 Applies @var{command} on all threads, ignoring errors and empty output.
3218
3219 @kindex tfaas
3220 @cindex apply a command to all frames of all threads (ignoring errors and empty output)
3221 @item tfaas @var{command}
3222 Shortcut for @code{thread apply all -s frame apply all -s @var{command}}.
3223 Applies @var{command} on all frames of all threads, ignoring errors
3224 and empty output. Note that the flag @code{-s} is specified twice:
3225 The first @code{-s} ensures that @code{thread apply} only shows the thread
3226 information of the threads for which @code{frame apply} produces
3227 some output. The second @code{-s} is needed to ensure that @code{frame
3228 apply} shows the frame information of a frame only if the
3229 @var{command} successfully produced some output.
3230
3231 It can for example be used to print a local variable or a function
3232 argument without knowing the thread or frame where this variable or argument
3233 is, using:
3234 @smallexample
3235 (@value{GDBP}) tfaas p some_local_var_i_do_not_remember_where_it_is
3236 @end smallexample
3237
3238
3239 @kindex thread name
3240 @cindex name a thread
3241 @item thread name [@var{name}]
3242 This command assigns a name to the current thread. If no argument is
3243 given, any existing user-specified name is removed. The thread name
3244 appears in the @samp{info threads} display.
3245
3246 On some systems, such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, @value{GDBN} is able to
3247 determine the name of the thread as given by the OS. On these
3248 systems, a name specified with @samp{thread name} will override the
3249 system-give name, and removing the user-specified name will cause
3250 @value{GDBN} to once again display the system-specified name.
3251
3252 @kindex thread find
3253 @cindex search for a thread
3254 @item thread find [@var{regexp}]
3255 Search for and display thread ids whose name or @var{systag}
3256 matches the supplied regular expression.
3257
3258 As well as being the complement to the @samp{thread name} command,
3259 this command also allows you to identify a thread by its target
3260 @var{systag}. For instance, on @sc{gnu}/Linux, the target @var{systag}
3261 is the LWP id.
3262
3263 @smallexample
3264 (@value{GDBN}) thread find 26688
3265 Thread 4 has target id 'Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688)'
3266 (@value{GDBN}) info thread 4
3267 Id Target Id Frame
3268 4 Thread 0x41e02940 (LWP 26688) 0x00000031ca6cd372 in select ()
3269 @end smallexample
3270
3271 @kindex set print thread-events
3272 @cindex print messages on thread start and exit
3273 @item set print thread-events
3274 @itemx set print thread-events on
3275 @itemx set print thread-events off
3276 The @code{set print thread-events} command allows you to enable or
3277 disable printing of messages when @value{GDBN} notices that new threads have
3278 started or that threads have exited. By default, these messages will
3279 be printed if detection of these events is supported by the target.
3280 Note that these messages cannot be disabled on all targets.
3281
3282 @kindex show print thread-events
3283 @item show print thread-events
3284 Show whether messages will be printed when @value{GDBN} detects that threads
3285 have started and exited.
3286 @end table
3287
3288 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs}, for
3289 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
3290 programs with multiple threads.
3291
3292 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting Watchpoints}, for information about
3293 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
3294
3295 @anchor{set libthread-db-search-path}
3296 @table @code
3297 @kindex set libthread-db-search-path
3298 @cindex search path for @code{libthread_db}
3299 @item set libthread-db-search-path @r{[}@var{path}@r{]}
3300 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
3301 directories @value{GDBN} will use to search for @code{libthread_db}.
3302 If you omit @var{path}, @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to
3303 its default value (@code{$sdir:$pdir} on @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems).
3304 Internally, the default value comes from the @code{LIBTHREAD_DB_SEARCH_PATH}
3305 macro.
3306
3307 On @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris systems, @value{GDBN} uses a ``helper''
3308 @code{libthread_db} library to obtain information about threads in the
3309 inferior process. @value{GDBN} will use @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3310 to find @code{libthread_db}. @value{GDBN} also consults first if inferior
3311 specific thread debugging library loading is enabled
3312 by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3313
3314 A special entry @samp{$sdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3315 refers to the default system directories that are
3316 normally searched for loading shared libraries. The @samp{$sdir} entry
3317 is the only kind not needing to be enabled by @samp{set auto-load libthread-db}
3318 (@pxref{libthread_db.so.1 file}).
3319
3320 A special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path}
3321 refers to the directory from which @code{libpthread}
3322 was loaded in the inferior process.
3323
3324 For any @code{libthread_db} library @value{GDBN} finds in above directories,
3325 @value{GDBN} attempts to initialize it with the current inferior process.
3326 If this initialization fails (which could happen because of a version
3327 mismatch between @code{libthread_db} and @code{libpthread}), @value{GDBN}
3328 will unload @code{libthread_db}, and continue with the next directory.
3329 If none of @code{libthread_db} libraries initialize successfully,
3330 @value{GDBN} will issue a warning and thread debugging will be disabled.
3331
3332 Setting @code{libthread-db-search-path} is currently implemented
3333 only on some platforms.
3334
3335 @kindex show libthread-db-search-path
3336 @item show libthread-db-search-path
3337 Display current libthread_db search path.
3338
3339 @kindex set debug libthread-db
3340 @kindex show debug libthread-db
3341 @cindex debugging @code{libthread_db}
3342 @item set debug libthread-db
3343 @itemx show debug libthread-db
3344 Turns on or off display of @code{libthread_db}-related events.
3345 Use @code{1} to enable, @code{0} to disable.
3346 @end table
3347
3348 @node Forks
3349 @section Debugging Forks
3350
3351 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
3352 @cindex multiple processes
3353 @cindex processes, multiple
3354 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
3355 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
3356 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
3357 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
3358 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
3359 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
3360 will cause it to terminate.
3361
3362 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
3363 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
3364 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
3365 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
3366 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
3367 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
3368 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
3369 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
3370 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
3371 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
3372
3373 On some systems, @value{GDBN} provides support for debugging programs
3374 that create additional processes using the @code{fork} or @code{vfork}
3375 functions. On @sc{gnu}/Linux platforms, this feature is supported
3376 with kernel version 2.5.46 and later.
3377
3378 The fork debugging commands are supported in native mode and when
3379 connected to @code{gdbserver} in either @code{target remote} mode or
3380 @code{target extended-remote} mode.
3381
3382 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
3383 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
3384
3385 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
3386 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
3387
3388 @table @code
3389 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
3390 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
3391 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
3392 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
3393 process. The @var{mode} argument can be:
3394
3395 @table @code
3396 @item parent
3397 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
3398 unimpeded. This is the default.
3399
3400 @item child
3401 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
3402 unimpeded.
3403
3404 @end table
3405
3406 @kindex show follow-fork-mode
3407 @item show follow-fork-mode
3408 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
3409 @end table
3410
3411 @cindex debugging multiple processes
3412 On Linux, if you want to debug both the parent and child processes, use the
3413 command @w{@code{set detach-on-fork}}.
3414
3415 @table @code
3416 @kindex set detach-on-fork
3417 @item set detach-on-fork @var{mode}
3418 Tells gdb whether to detach one of the processes after a fork, or
3419 retain debugger control over them both.
3420
3421 @table @code
3422 @item on
3423 The child process (or parent process, depending on the value of
3424 @code{follow-fork-mode}) will be detached and allowed to run
3425 independently. This is the default.
3426
3427 @item off
3428 Both processes will be held under the control of @value{GDBN}.
3429 One process (child or parent, depending on the value of
3430 @code{follow-fork-mode}) is debugged as usual, while the other
3431 is held suspended.
3432
3433 @end table
3434
3435 @kindex show detach-on-fork
3436 @item show detach-on-fork
3437 Show whether detach-on-fork mode is on/off.
3438 @end table
3439
3440 If you choose to set @samp{detach-on-fork} mode off, then @value{GDBN}
3441 will retain control of all forked processes (including nested forks).
3442 You can list the forked processes under the control of @value{GDBN} by
3443 using the @w{@code{info inferiors}} command, and switch from one fork
3444 to another by using the @code{inferior} command (@pxref{Inferiors and
3445 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}).
3446
3447 To quit debugging one of the forked processes, you can either detach
3448 from it by using the @w{@code{detach inferiors}} command (allowing it
3449 to run independently), or kill it using the @w{@code{kill inferiors}}
3450 command. @xref{Inferiors and Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors
3451 and Programs}.
3452
3453 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
3454 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
3455 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
3456 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
3457 the child process's @code{main}.
3458
3459 On some systems, when a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you
3460 cannot debug the child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
3461
3462 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
3463 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent
3464 process, use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name
3465 as its argument. By default, after an @code{exec} call executes,
3466 @value{GDBN} discards the symbols of the previous executable image.
3467 You can change this behaviour with the @w{@code{set follow-exec-mode}}
3468 command.
3469
3470 @table @code
3471 @kindex set follow-exec-mode
3472 @item set follow-exec-mode @var{mode}
3473
3474 Set debugger response to a program call of @code{exec}. An
3475 @code{exec} call replaces the program image of a process.
3476
3477 @code{follow-exec-mode} can be:
3478
3479 @table @code
3480 @item new
3481 @value{GDBN} creates a new inferior and rebinds the process to this
3482 new inferior. The program the process was running before the
3483 @code{exec} call can be restarted afterwards by restarting the
3484 original inferior.
3485
3486 For example:
3487
3488 @smallexample
3489 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3490 (gdb) info inferior
3491 Id Description Executable
3492 * 1 <null> prog1
3493 (@value{GDBP}) run
3494 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3495 Program exited normally.
3496 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3497 Id Description Executable
3498 1 <null> prog1
3499 * 2 <null> prog2
3500 @end smallexample
3501
3502 @item same
3503 @value{GDBN} keeps the process bound to the same inferior. The new
3504 executable image replaces the previous executable loaded in the
3505 inferior. Restarting the inferior after the @code{exec} call, with
3506 e.g., the @code{run} command, restarts the executable the process was
3507 running after the @code{exec} call. This is the default mode.
3508
3509 For example:
3510
3511 @smallexample
3512 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3513 Id Description Executable
3514 * 1 <null> prog1
3515 (@value{GDBP}) run
3516 process 12020 is executing new program: prog2
3517 Program exited normally.
3518 (@value{GDBP}) info inferiors
3519 Id Description Executable
3520 * 1 <null> prog2
3521 @end smallexample
3522
3523 @end table
3524 @end table
3525
3526 @code{follow-exec-mode} is supported in native mode and
3527 @code{target extended-remote} mode.
3528
3529 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
3530 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
3531 Catchpoints, ,Setting Catchpoints}.
3532
3533 @node Checkpoint/Restart
3534 @section Setting a @emph{Bookmark} to Return to Later
3535
3536 @cindex checkpoint
3537 @cindex restart
3538 @cindex bookmark
3539 @cindex snapshot of a process
3540 @cindex rewind program state
3541
3542 On certain operating systems@footnote{Currently, only
3543 @sc{gnu}/Linux.}, @value{GDBN} is able to save a @dfn{snapshot} of a
3544 program's state, called a @dfn{checkpoint}, and come back to it
3545 later.
3546
3547 Returning to a checkpoint effectively undoes everything that has
3548 happened in the program since the @code{checkpoint} was saved. This
3549 includes changes in memory, registers, and even (within some limits)
3550 system state. Effectively, it is like going back in time to the
3551 moment when the checkpoint was saved.
3552
3553 Thus, if you're stepping thru a program and you think you're
3554 getting close to the point where things go wrong, you can save
3555 a checkpoint. Then, if you accidentally go too far and miss
3556 the critical statement, instead of having to restart your program
3557 from the beginning, you can just go back to the checkpoint and
3558 start again from there.
3559
3560 This can be especially useful if it takes a lot of time or
3561 steps to reach the point where you think the bug occurs.
3562
3563 To use the @code{checkpoint}/@code{restart} method of debugging:
3564
3565 @table @code
3566 @kindex checkpoint
3567 @item checkpoint
3568 Save a snapshot of the debugged program's current execution state.
3569 The @code{checkpoint} command takes no arguments, but each checkpoint
3570 is assigned a small integer id, similar to a breakpoint id.
3571
3572 @kindex info checkpoints
3573 @item info checkpoints
3574 List the checkpoints that have been saved in the current debugging
3575 session. For each checkpoint, the following information will be
3576 listed:
3577
3578 @table @code
3579 @item Checkpoint ID
3580 @item Process ID
3581 @item Code Address
3582 @item Source line, or label
3583 @end table
3584
3585 @kindex restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3586 @item restart @var{checkpoint-id}
3587 Restore the program state that was saved as checkpoint number
3588 @var{checkpoint-id}. All program variables, registers, stack frames
3589 etc.@: will be returned to the values that they had when the checkpoint
3590 was saved. In essence, gdb will ``wind back the clock'' to the point
3591 in time when the checkpoint was saved.
3592
3593 Note that breakpoints, @value{GDBN} variables, command history etc.
3594 are not affected by restoring a checkpoint. In general, a checkpoint
3595 only restores things that reside in the program being debugged, not in
3596 the debugger.
3597
3598 @kindex delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3599 @item delete checkpoint @var{checkpoint-id}
3600 Delete the previously-saved checkpoint identified by @var{checkpoint-id}.
3601
3602 @end table
3603
3604 Returning to a previously saved checkpoint will restore the user state
3605 of the program being debugged, plus a significant subset of the system
3606 (OS) state, including file pointers. It won't ``un-write'' data from
3607 a file, but it will rewind the file pointer to the previous location,
3608 so that the previously written data can be overwritten. For files
3609 opened in read mode, the pointer will also be restored so that the
3610 previously read data can be read again.
3611
3612 Of course, characters that have been sent to a printer (or other
3613 external device) cannot be ``snatched back'', and characters received
3614 from eg.@: a serial device can be removed from internal program buffers,
3615 but they cannot be ``pushed back'' into the serial pipeline, ready to
3616 be received again. Similarly, the actual contents of files that have
3617 been changed cannot be restored (at this time).
3618
3619 However, within those constraints, you actually can ``rewind'' your
3620 program to a previously saved point in time, and begin debugging it
3621 again --- and you can change the course of events so as to debug a
3622 different execution path this time.
3623
3624 @cindex checkpoints and process id
3625 Finally, there is one bit of internal program state that will be
3626 different when you return to a checkpoint --- the program's process
3627 id. Each checkpoint will have a unique process id (or @var{pid}),
3628 and each will be different from the program's original @var{pid}.
3629 If your program has saved a local copy of its process id, this could
3630 potentially pose a problem.
3631
3632 @subsection A Non-obvious Benefit of Using Checkpoints
3633
3634 On some systems such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, address space randomization
3635 is performed on new processes for security reasons. This makes it
3636 difficult or impossible to set a breakpoint, or watchpoint, on an
3637 absolute address if you have to restart the program, since the
3638 absolute location of a symbol will change from one execution to the
3639 next.
3640
3641 A checkpoint, however, is an @emph{identical} copy of a process.
3642 Therefore if you create a checkpoint at (eg.@:) the start of main,
3643 and simply return to that checkpoint instead of restarting the
3644 process, you can avoid the effects of address randomization and
3645 your symbols will all stay in the same place.
3646
3647 @node Stopping
3648 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
3649
3650 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
3651 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
3652 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
3653
3654 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
3655 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
3656 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
3657 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
3658 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
3659 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
3660 explicitly request this information at any time.
3661
3662 @table @code
3663 @kindex info program
3664 @item info program
3665 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
3666 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
3667 @end table
3668
3669 @menu
3670 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
3671 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
3672 * Skipping Over Functions and Files::
3673 Skipping over functions and files
3674 * Signals:: Signals
3675 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3676 @end menu
3677
3678 @node Breakpoints
3679 @section Breakpoints, Watchpoints, and Catchpoints
3680
3681 @cindex breakpoints
3682 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
3683 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
3684 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
3685 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
3686 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
3687 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
3688 program.
3689
3690 On some systems, you can set breakpoints in shared libraries before
3691 the executable is run.
3692
3693 @cindex watchpoints
3694 @cindex data breakpoints
3695 @cindex memory tracing
3696 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
3697 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
3698 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
3699 when the value of an expression changes. The expression may be a value
3700 of a variable, or it could involve values of one or more variables
3701 combined by operators, such as @samp{a + b}. This is sometimes called
3702 @dfn{data breakpoints}. You must use a different command to set
3703 watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting Watchpoints}), but aside
3704 from that, you can manage a watchpoint like any other breakpoint: you
3705 enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints and watchpoints using the
3706 same commands.
3707
3708 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
3709 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
3710 Automatic Display}.
3711
3712 @cindex catchpoints
3713 @cindex breakpoint on events
3714 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
3715 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
3716 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
3717 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
3718 Catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
3719 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
3720 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3721
3722 @cindex breakpoint numbers
3723 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
3724 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
3725 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
3726 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
3727 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
3728 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
3729 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
3730 enable it again.
3731
3732 @cindex breakpoint ranges
3733 @cindex breakpoint lists
3734 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
3735 @cindex lists of breakpoints
3736 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a space-separated list of breakpoints
3737 on which to operate. A list element can be either a single breakpoint number,
3738 like @samp{5}, or a range of such numbers, like @samp{5-7}.
3739 When a breakpoint list is given to a command, all breakpoints in that list
3740 are operated on.
3741
3742 @menu
3743 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
3744 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
3745 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
3746 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
3747 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
3748 * Conditions:: Break conditions
3749 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
3750 * Dynamic Printf:: Dynamic printf
3751 * Save Breakpoints:: How to save breakpoints in a file
3752 * Static Probe Points:: Listing static probe points
3753 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3754 * Breakpoint-related Warnings:: ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
3755 @end menu
3756
3757 @node Set Breaks
3758 @subsection Setting Breakpoints
3759
3760 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
3761 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
3762 @c
3763 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
3764
3765 @kindex break
3766 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
3767 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
3768 @cindex latest breakpoint
3769 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
3770 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
3771 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
3772 Vars,, Convenience Variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
3773 convenience variables.
3774
3775 @table @code
3776 @item break @var{location}
3777 Set a breakpoint at the given @var{location}, which can specify a
3778 function name, a line number, or an address of an instruction.
3779 (@xref{Specify Location}, for a list of all the possible ways to
3780 specify a @var{location}.) The breakpoint will stop your program just
3781 before it executes any of the code in the specified @var{location}.
3782
3783 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
3784 C@t{++}, a function name may refer to more than one possible place to break.
3785 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}, for a discussion of
3786 that situation.
3787
3788 It is also possible to insert a breakpoint that will stop the program
3789 only if a specific thread (@pxref{Thread-Specific Breakpoints})
3790 or a specific task (@pxref{Ada Tasks}) hits that breakpoint.
3791
3792 @item break
3793 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
3794 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
3795 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
3796 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
3797 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
3798 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
3799 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
3800 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
3801 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
3802 inside loops.
3803
3804 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
3805 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
3806 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
3807 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
3808 existed when your program stopped.
3809
3810 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
3811 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
3812 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
3813 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
3814 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
3815 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
3816 ,Break Conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
3817
3818 @kindex tbreak
3819 @item tbreak @var{args}
3820 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args} are the
3821 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
3822 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
3823 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3824
3825 @kindex hbreak
3826 @cindex hardware breakpoints
3827 @item hbreak @var{args}
3828 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. The @var{args} are the same as for the
3829 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
3830 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
3831 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
3832 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
3833 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
3834 provided by SPARClite DSU and most x86-based targets. These targets
3835 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
3836 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
3837 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
3838 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
3839 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
3840 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
3841 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}).
3842 @xref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3843 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
3844 breakpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
3845 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
3846
3847 @kindex thbreak
3848 @item thbreak @var{args}
3849 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. The @var{args}
3850 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
3851 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
3852 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
3853 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
3854 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
3855 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling Breakpoints}.
3856 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}.
3857
3858 @kindex rbreak
3859 @cindex regular expression
3860 @cindex breakpoints at functions matching a regexp
3861 @cindex set breakpoints in many functions
3862 @item rbreak @var{regex}
3863 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
3864 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
3865 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
3866 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
3867 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
3868 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
3869
3870 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
3871 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
3872 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
3873 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
3874 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
3875 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
3876
3877 @cindex non-member C@t{++} functions, set breakpoint in
3878 When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
3879 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
3880 classes.
3881
3882 @cindex set breakpoints on all functions
3883 The @code{rbreak} command can be used to set breakpoints in
3884 @strong{all} the functions in a program, like this:
3885
3886 @smallexample
3887 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak .
3888 @end smallexample
3889
3890 @item rbreak @var{file}:@var{regex}
3891 If @code{rbreak} is called with a filename qualification, it limits
3892 the search for functions matching the given regular expression to the
3893 specified @var{file}. This can be used, for example, to set breakpoints on
3894 every function in a given file:
3895
3896 @smallexample
3897 (@value{GDBP}) rbreak file.c:.
3898 @end smallexample
3899
3900 The colon separating the filename qualifier from the regex may
3901 optionally be surrounded by spaces.
3902
3903 @kindex info breakpoints
3904 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
3905 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
3906 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
3907 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
3908 not deleted. Optional argument @var{n} means print information only
3909 about the specified breakpoint(s) (or watchpoint(s) or catchpoint(s)).
3910 For each breakpoint, following columns are printed:
3911
3912 @table @emph
3913 @item Breakpoint Numbers
3914 @item Type
3915 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
3916 @item Disposition
3917 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
3918 @item Enabled or Disabled
3919 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
3920 that are not enabled.
3921 @item Address
3922 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address. For a
3923 pending breakpoint whose address is not yet known, this field will
3924 contain @samp{<PENDING>}. Such breakpoint won't fire until a shared
3925 library that has the symbol or line referred by breakpoint is loaded.
3926 See below for details. A breakpoint with several locations will
3927 have @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in this field---see below for details.
3928 @item What
3929 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
3930 line number. For a pending breakpoint, the original string passed to
3931 the breakpoint command will be listed as it cannot be resolved until
3932 the appropriate shared library is loaded in the future.
3933 @end table
3934
3935 @noindent
3936 If a breakpoint is conditional, there are two evaluation modes: ``host'' and
3937 ``target''. If mode is ``host'', breakpoint condition evaluation is done by
3938 @value{GDBN} on the host's side. If it is ``target'', then the condition
3939 is evaluated by the target. The @code{info break} command shows
3940 the condition on the line following the affected breakpoint, together with
3941 its condition evaluation mode in between parentheses.
3942
3943 Breakpoint commands, if any, are listed after that. A pending breakpoint is
3944 allowed to have a condition specified for it. The condition is not parsed for
3945 validity until a shared library is loaded that allows the pending
3946 breakpoint to resolve to a valid location.
3947
3948 @noindent
3949 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
3950 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
3951 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
3952 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
3953 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}).
3954
3955 @noindent
3956 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
3957 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
3958 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
3959 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
3960 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
3961 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
3962
3963 @noindent
3964 For a breakpoints with an enable count (xref) greater than 1,
3965 @code{info break} also displays that count.
3966
3967 @end table
3968
3969 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
3970 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
3971 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
3972 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
3973
3974 @cindex multiple locations, breakpoints
3975 @cindex breakpoints, multiple locations
3976 It is possible that a breakpoint corresponds to several locations
3977 in your program. Examples of this situation are:
3978
3979 @itemize @bullet
3980 @item
3981 Multiple functions in the program may have the same name.
3982
3983 @item
3984 For a C@t{++} constructor, the @value{NGCC} compiler generates several
3985 instances of the function body, used in different cases.
3986
3987 @item
3988 For a C@t{++} template function, a given line in the function can
3989 correspond to any number of instantiations.
3990
3991 @item
3992 For an inlined function, a given source line can correspond to
3993 several places where that function is inlined.
3994 @end itemize
3995
3996 In all those cases, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at all
3997 the relevant locations.
3998
3999 A breakpoint with multiple locations is displayed in the breakpoint
4000 table using several rows---one header row, followed by one row for
4001 each breakpoint location. The header row has @samp{<MULTIPLE>} in the
4002 address column. The rows for individual locations contain the actual
4003 addresses for locations, and show the functions to which those
4004 locations belong. The number column for a location is of the form
4005 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number}.
4006
4007 For example:
4008
4009 @smallexample
4010 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
4011 1 breakpoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
4012 stop only if i==1
4013 breakpoint already hit 1 time
4014 1.1 y 0x080486a2 in void foo<int>() at t.cc:8
4015 1.2 y 0x080486ca in void foo<double>() at t.cc:8
4016 @end smallexample
4017
4018 You cannot delete the individual locations from a breakpoint. However,
4019 each location can be individually enabled or disabled by passing
4020 @var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number} as argument to the
4021 @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands. It's also possible to
4022 @code{enable} and @code{disable} a range of @var{location-number}
4023 locations using a @var{breakpoint-number} and two @var{location-number}s,
4024 in increasing order, separated by a hyphen, like
4025 @kbd{@var{breakpoint-number}.@var{location-number1}-@var{location-number2}},
4026 in which case @value{GDBN} acts on all the locations in the range (inclusive).
4027 Disabling or enabling the parent breakpoint (@pxref{Disabling}) affects
4028 all of the locations that belong to that breakpoint.
4029
4030 @cindex pending breakpoints
4031 It's quite common to have a breakpoint inside a shared library.
4032 Shared libraries can be loaded and unloaded explicitly,
4033 and possibly repeatedly, as the program is executed. To support
4034 this use case, @value{GDBN} updates breakpoint locations whenever
4035 any shared library is loaded or unloaded. Typically, you would
4036 set a breakpoint in a shared library at the beginning of your
4037 debugging session, when the library is not loaded, and when the
4038 symbols from the library are not available. When you try to set
4039 breakpoint, @value{GDBN} will ask you if you want to set
4040 a so called @dfn{pending breakpoint}---breakpoint whose address
4041 is not yet resolved.
4042
4043 After the program is run, whenever a new shared library is loaded,
4044 @value{GDBN} reevaluates all the breakpoints. When a newly loaded
4045 shared library contains the symbol or line referred to by some
4046 pending breakpoint, that breakpoint is resolved and becomes an
4047 ordinary breakpoint. When a library is unloaded, all breakpoints
4048 that refer to its symbols or source lines become pending again.
4049
4050 This logic works for breakpoints with multiple locations, too. For
4051 example, if you have a breakpoint in a C@t{++} template function, and
4052 a newly loaded shared library has an instantiation of that template,
4053 a new location is added to the list of locations for the breakpoint.
4054
4055 Except for having unresolved address, pending breakpoints do not
4056 differ from regular breakpoints. You can set conditions or commands,
4057 enable and disable them and perform other breakpoint operations.
4058
4059 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling what
4060 happens when the @samp{break} command cannot resolve breakpoint
4061 address specification to an address:
4062
4063 @kindex set breakpoint pending
4064 @kindex show breakpoint pending
4065 @table @code
4066 @item set breakpoint pending auto
4067 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} cannot find the breakpoint
4068 location, it queries you whether a pending breakpoint should be created.
4069
4070 @item set breakpoint pending on
4071 This indicates that an unrecognized breakpoint location should automatically
4072 result in a pending breakpoint being created.
4073
4074 @item set breakpoint pending off
4075 This indicates that pending breakpoints are not to be created. Any
4076 unrecognized breakpoint location results in an error. This setting does
4077 not affect any pending breakpoints previously created.
4078
4079 @item show breakpoint pending
4080 Show the current behavior setting for creating pending breakpoints.
4081 @end table
4082
4083 The settings above only affect the @code{break} command and its
4084 variants. Once breakpoint is set, it will be automatically updated
4085 as shared libraries are loaded and unloaded.
4086
4087 @cindex automatic hardware breakpoints
4088 For some targets, @value{GDBN} can automatically decide if hardware or
4089 software breakpoints should be used, depending on whether the
4090 breakpoint address is read-only or read-write. This applies to
4091 breakpoints set with the @code{break} command as well as to internal
4092 breakpoints set by commands like @code{next} and @code{finish}. For
4093 breakpoints set with @code{hbreak}, @value{GDBN} will always use hardware
4094 breakpoints.
4095
4096 You can control this automatic behaviour with the following commands:
4097
4098 @kindex set breakpoint auto-hw
4099 @kindex show breakpoint auto-hw
4100 @table @code
4101 @item set breakpoint auto-hw on
4102 This is the default behavior. When @value{GDBN} sets a breakpoint, it
4103 will try to use the target memory map to decide if software or hardware
4104 breakpoint must be used.
4105
4106 @item set breakpoint auto-hw off
4107 This indicates @value{GDBN} should not automatically select breakpoint
4108 type. If the target provides a memory map, @value{GDBN} will warn when
4109 trying to set software breakpoint at a read-only address.
4110 @end table
4111
4112 @value{GDBN} normally implements breakpoints by replacing the program code
4113 at the breakpoint address with a special instruction, which, when
4114 executed, given control to the debugger. By default, the program
4115 code is so modified only when the program is resumed. As soon as
4116 the program stops, @value{GDBN} restores the original instructions. This
4117 behaviour guards against leaving breakpoints inserted in the
4118 target should gdb abrubptly disconnect. However, with slow remote
4119 targets, inserting and removing breakpoint can reduce the performance.
4120 This behavior can be controlled with the following commands::
4121
4122 @kindex set breakpoint always-inserted
4123 @kindex show breakpoint always-inserted
4124 @table @code
4125 @item set breakpoint always-inserted off
4126 All breakpoints, including newly added by the user, are inserted in
4127 the target only when the target is resumed. All breakpoints are
4128 removed from the target when it stops. This is the default mode.
4129
4130 @item set breakpoint always-inserted on
4131 Causes all breakpoints to be inserted in the target at all times. If
4132 the user adds a new breakpoint, or changes an existing breakpoint, the
4133 breakpoints in the target are updated immediately. A breakpoint is
4134 removed from the target only when breakpoint itself is deleted.
4135 @end table
4136
4137 @value{GDBN} handles conditional breakpoints by evaluating these conditions
4138 when a breakpoint breaks. If the condition is true, then the process being
4139 debugged stops, otherwise the process is resumed.
4140
4141 If the target supports evaluating conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} may
4142 download the breakpoint, together with its conditions, to it.
4143
4144 This feature can be controlled via the following commands:
4145
4146 @kindex set breakpoint condition-evaluation
4147 @kindex show breakpoint condition-evaluation
4148 @table @code
4149 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation host
4150 This option commands @value{GDBN} to evaluate the breakpoint
4151 conditions on the host's side. Unconditional breakpoints are sent to
4152 the target which in turn receives the triggers and reports them back to GDB
4153 for condition evaluation. This is the standard evaluation mode.
4154
4155 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation target
4156 This option commands @value{GDBN} to download breakpoint conditions
4157 to the target at the moment of their insertion. The target
4158 is responsible for evaluating the conditional expression and reporting
4159 breakpoint stop events back to @value{GDBN} whenever the condition
4160 is true. Due to limitations of target-side evaluation, some conditions
4161 cannot be evaluated there, e.g., conditions that depend on local data
4162 that is only known to the host. Examples include
4163 conditional expressions involving convenience variables, complex types
4164 that cannot be handled by the agent expression parser and expressions
4165 that are too long to be sent over to the target, specially when the
4166 target is a remote system. In these cases, the conditions will be
4167 evaluated by @value{GDBN}.
4168
4169 @item set breakpoint condition-evaluation auto
4170 This is the default mode. If the target supports evaluating breakpoint
4171 conditions on its end, @value{GDBN} will download breakpoint conditions to
4172 the target (limitations mentioned previously apply). If the target does
4173 not support breakpoint condition evaluation, then @value{GDBN} will fallback
4174 to evaluating all these conditions on the host's side.
4175 @end table
4176
4177
4178 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
4179 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
4180 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
4181 special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
4182 programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
4183 starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
4184 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
4185 @samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
4186
4187
4188 @node Set Watchpoints
4189 @subsection Setting Watchpoints
4190
4191 @cindex setting watchpoints
4192 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
4193 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
4194 this may happen. (This is sometimes called a @dfn{data breakpoint}.)
4195 The expression may be as simple as the value of a single variable, or
4196 as complex as many variables combined by operators. Examples include:
4197
4198 @itemize @bullet
4199 @item
4200 A reference to the value of a single variable.
4201
4202 @item
4203 An address cast to an appropriate data type. For example,
4204 @samp{*(int *)0x12345678} will watch a 4-byte region at the specified
4205 address (assuming an @code{int} occupies 4 bytes).
4206
4207 @item
4208 An arbitrarily complex expression, such as @samp{a*b + c/d}. The
4209 expression can use any operators valid in the program's native
4210 language (@pxref{Languages}).
4211 @end itemize
4212
4213 You can set a watchpoint on an expression even if the expression can
4214 not be evaluated yet. For instance, you can set a watchpoint on
4215 @samp{*global_ptr} before @samp{global_ptr} is initialized.
4216 @value{GDBN} will stop when your program sets @samp{global_ptr} and
4217 the expression produces a valid value. If the expression becomes
4218 valid in some other way than changing a variable (e.g.@: if the memory
4219 pointed to by @samp{*global_ptr} becomes readable as the result of a
4220 @code{malloc} call), @value{GDBN} may not stop until the next time
4221 the expression changes.
4222
4223 @cindex software watchpoints
4224 @cindex hardware watchpoints
4225 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
4226 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
4227 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
4228 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
4229 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
4230 culprit.)
4231
4232 On some systems, such as most PowerPC or x86-based targets,
4233 @value{GDBN} includes support for hardware watchpoints, which do not
4234 slow down the running of your program.
4235
4236 @table @code
4237 @kindex watch
4238 @item watch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4239 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when the
4240 expression @var{expr} is written into by the program and its value
4241 changes. The simplest (and the most popular) use of this command is
4242 to watch the value of a single variable:
4243
4244 @smallexample
4245 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo
4246 @end smallexample
4247
4248 If the command includes a @code{@r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]}}
4249 argument, @value{GDBN} breaks only when the thread identified by
4250 @var{thread-id} changes the value of @var{expr}. If any other threads
4251 change the value of @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} will not break. Note
4252 that watchpoints restricted to a single thread in this way only work
4253 with Hardware Watchpoints.
4254
4255 Ordinarily a watchpoint respects the scope of variables in @var{expr}
4256 (see below). The @code{-location} argument tells @value{GDBN} to
4257 instead watch the memory referred to by @var{expr}. In this case,
4258 @value{GDBN} will evaluate @var{expr}, take the address of the result,
4259 and watch the memory at that address. The type of the result is used
4260 to determine the size of the watched memory. If the expression's
4261 result does not have an address, then @value{GDBN} will print an
4262 error.
4263
4264 The @code{@r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}} argument allows creation
4265 of masked watchpoints, if the current architecture supports this
4266 feature (e.g., PowerPC Embedded architecture, see @ref{PowerPC
4267 Embedded}.) A @dfn{masked watchpoint} specifies a mask in addition
4268 to an address to watch. The mask specifies that some bits of an address
4269 (the bits which are reset in the mask) should be ignored when matching
4270 the address accessed by the inferior against the watchpoint address.
4271 Thus, a masked watchpoint watches many addresses simultaneously---those
4272 addresses whose unmasked bits are identical to the unmasked bits in the
4273 watchpoint address. The @code{mask} argument implies @code{-location}.
4274 Examples:
4275
4276 @smallexample
4277 (@value{GDBP}) watch foo mask 0xffff00ff
4278 (@value{GDBP}) watch *0xdeadbeef mask 0xffffff00
4279 @end smallexample
4280
4281 @kindex rwatch
4282 @item rwatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4283 Set a watchpoint that will break when the value of @var{expr} is read
4284 by the program.
4285
4286 @kindex awatch
4287 @item awatch @r{[}-l@r{|}-location@r{]} @var{expr} @r{[}thread @var{thread-id}@r{]} @r{[}mask @var{maskvalue}@r{]}
4288 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read from
4289 or written into by the program.
4290
4291 @kindex info watchpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4292 @item info watchpoints @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4293 This command prints a list of watchpoints, using the same format as
4294 @code{info break} (@pxref{Set Breaks}).
4295 @end table
4296
4297 If you watch for a change in a numerically entered address you need to
4298 dereference it, as the address itself is just a constant number which will
4299 never change. @value{GDBN} refuses to create a watchpoint that watches
4300 a never-changing value:
4301
4302 @smallexample
4303 (@value{GDBP}) watch 0x600850
4304 Cannot watch constant value 0x600850.
4305 (@value{GDBP}) watch *(int *) 0x600850
4306 Watchpoint 1: *(int *) 6293584
4307 @end smallexample
4308
4309 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
4310 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
4311 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
4312 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
4313 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
4314 @emph{statement}, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
4315
4316 @cindex use only software watchpoints
4317 You can force @value{GDBN} to use only software watchpoints with the
4318 @kbd{set can-use-hw-watchpoints 0} command. With this variable set to
4319 zero, @value{GDBN} will never try to use hardware watchpoints, even if
4320 the underlying system supports them. (Note that hardware-assisted
4321 watchpoints that were set @emph{before} setting
4322 @code{can-use-hw-watchpoints} to zero will still use the hardware
4323 mechanism of watching expression values.)
4324
4325 @table @code
4326 @item set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4327 @kindex set can-use-hw-watchpoints
4328 Set whether or not to use hardware watchpoints.
4329
4330 @item show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4331 @kindex show can-use-hw-watchpoints
4332 Show the current mode of using hardware watchpoints.
4333 @end table
4334
4335 For remote targets, you can restrict the number of hardware
4336 watchpoints @value{GDBN} will use, see @ref{set remote
4337 hardware-breakpoint-limit}.
4338
4339 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
4340
4341 @smallexample
4342 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
4343 @end smallexample
4344
4345 @noindent
4346 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
4347
4348 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
4349 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
4350 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
4351 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
4352 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
4353 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
4354 will print a message like this:
4355
4356 @smallexample
4357 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
4358 @end smallexample
4359
4360 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
4361 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
4362 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
4363 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
4364 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
4365 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
4366 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
4367 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
4368
4369 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
4370 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
4371 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
4372 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
4373 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
4374 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
4375
4376 @smallexample
4377 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
4378 @end smallexample
4379
4380 @noindent
4381 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
4382
4383 Watching complex expressions that reference many variables can also
4384 exhaust the resources available for hardware-assisted watchpoints.
4385 That's because @value{GDBN} needs to watch every variable in the
4386 expression with separately allocated resources.
4387
4388 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
4389 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
4390 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
4391
4392 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
4393 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
4394 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
4395 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
4396 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
4397 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
4398 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
4399 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
4400 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
4401
4402 @cindex watchpoints and threads
4403 @cindex threads and watchpoints
4404 In multi-threaded programs, watchpoints will detect changes to the
4405 watched expression from every thread.
4406
4407 @quotation
4408 @emph{Warning:} In multi-threaded programs, software watchpoints
4409 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
4410 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
4411 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
4412 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
4413 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
4414 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
4415 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
4416 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
4417 @end quotation
4418
4419 @xref{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}.
4420
4421 @node Set Catchpoints
4422 @subsection Setting Catchpoints
4423 @cindex catchpoints, setting
4424 @cindex exception handlers
4425 @cindex event handling
4426
4427 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
4428 kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
4429 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
4430
4431 @table @code
4432 @kindex catch
4433 @item catch @var{event}
4434 Stop when @var{event} occurs. The @var{event} can be any of the following:
4435
4436 @table @code
4437 @item throw @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4438 @itemx rethrow @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4439 @itemx catch @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
4440 @kindex catch throw
4441 @kindex catch rethrow
4442 @kindex catch catch
4443 @cindex stop on C@t{++} exceptions
4444 The throwing, re-throwing, or catching of a C@t{++} exception.
4445
4446 If @var{regexp} is given, then only exceptions whose type matches the
4447 regular expression will be caught.
4448
4449 @vindex $_exception@r{, convenience variable}
4450 The convenience variable @code{$_exception} is available at an
4451 exception-related catchpoint, on some systems. This holds the
4452 exception being thrown.
4453
4454 There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling in
4455 @value{GDBN}:
4456
4457 @itemize @bullet
4458 @item
4459 The support for these commands is system-dependent. Currently, only
4460 systems using the @samp{gnu-v3} C@t{++} ABI (@pxref{ABI}) are
4461 supported.
4462
4463 @item
4464 The regular expression feature and the @code{$_exception} convenience
4465 variable rely on the presence of some SDT probes in @code{libstdc++}.
4466 If these probes are not present, then these features cannot be used.
4467 These probes were first available in the GCC 4.8 release, but whether
4468 or not they are available in your GCC also depends on how it was
4469 built.
4470
4471 @item
4472 The @code{$_exception} convenience variable is only valid at the
4473 instruction at which an exception-related catchpoint is set.
4474
4475 @item
4476 When an exception-related catchpoint is hit, @value{GDBN} stops at a
4477 location in the system library which implements runtime exception
4478 support for C@t{++}, usually @code{libstdc++}. You can use @code{up}
4479 (@pxref{Selection}) to get to your code.
4480
4481 @item
4482 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
4483 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
4484 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
4485 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
4486 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
4487 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
4488 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
4489 disabled within interactive calls. @xref{Calling}, for information on
4490 controlling this with @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception}.
4491
4492 @item
4493 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
4494
4495 @item
4496 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
4497 @end itemize
4498
4499 @item exception
4500 @kindex catch exception
4501 @cindex Ada exception catching
4502 @cindex catch Ada exceptions
4503 An Ada exception being raised. If an exception name is specified
4504 at the end of the command (eg @code{catch exception Program_Error}),
4505 the debugger will stop only when this specific exception is raised.
4506 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is raised.
4507
4508 When inserting an exception catchpoint on a user-defined exception whose
4509 name is identical to one of the exceptions defined by the language, the
4510 fully qualified name must be used as the exception name. Otherwise,
4511 @value{GDBN} will assume that it should stop on the pre-defined exception
4512 rather than the user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception
4513 called @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then
4514 the command to use to catch such exceptions is @kbd{catch exception
4515 Pck.Constraint_Error}.
4516
4517 @item handlers
4518 @kindex catch handlers
4519 @cindex Ada exception handlers catching
4520 @cindex catch Ada exceptions when handled
4521 An Ada exception being handled. If an exception name is
4522 specified at the end of the command
4523 (eg @kbd{catch handlers Program_Error}), the debugger will stop
4524 only when this specific exception is handled.
4525 Otherwise, the debugger stops execution when any Ada exception is handled.
4526
4527 When inserting a handlers catchpoint on a user-defined
4528 exception whose name is identical to one of the exceptions
4529 defined by the language, the fully qualified name must be used
4530 as the exception name. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will assume that it
4531 should stop on the pre-defined exception rather than the
4532 user-defined one. For instance, assuming an exception called
4533 @code{Constraint_Error} is defined in package @code{Pck}, then the
4534 command to use to catch such exceptions handling is
4535 @kbd{catch handlers Pck.Constraint_Error}.
4536
4537 @item exception unhandled
4538 @kindex catch exception unhandled
4539 An exception that was raised but is not handled by the program.
4540
4541 @item assert
4542 @kindex catch assert
4543 A failed Ada assertion.
4544
4545 @item exec
4546 @kindex catch exec
4547 @cindex break on fork/exec
4548 A call to @code{exec}.
4549
4550 @item syscall
4551 @itemx syscall @r{[}@var{name} @r{|} @var{number} @r{|} @r{group:}@var{groupname} @r{|} @r{g:}@var{groupname}@r{]} @dots{}
4552 @kindex catch syscall
4553 @cindex break on a system call.
4554 A call to or return from a system call, a.k.a.@: @dfn{syscall}. A
4555 syscall is a mechanism for application programs to request a service
4556 from the operating system (OS) or one of the OS system services.
4557 @value{GDBN} can catch some or all of the syscalls issued by the
4558 debuggee, and show the related information for each syscall. If no
4559 argument is specified, calls to and returns from all system calls
4560 will be caught.
4561
4562 @var{name} can be any system call name that is valid for the
4563 underlying OS. Just what syscalls are valid depends on the OS. On
4564 GNU and Unix systems, you can find the full list of valid syscall
4565 names on @file{/usr/include/asm/unistd.h}.
4566
4567 @c For MS-Windows, the syscall names and the corresponding numbers
4568 @c can be found, e.g., on this URL:
4569 @c http://www.metasploit.com/users/opcode/syscalls.html
4570 @c but we don't support Windows syscalls yet.
4571
4572 Normally, @value{GDBN} knows in advance which syscalls are valid for
4573 each OS, so you can use the @value{GDBN} command-line completion
4574 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4575 available choices.
4576
4577 You may also specify the system call numerically. A syscall's
4578 number is the value passed to the OS's syscall dispatcher to
4579 identify the requested service. When you specify the syscall by its
4580 name, @value{GDBN} uses its database of syscalls to convert the name
4581 into the corresponding numeric code, but using the number directly
4582 may be useful if @value{GDBN}'s database does not have the complete
4583 list of syscalls on your system (e.g., because @value{GDBN} lags
4584 behind the OS upgrades).
4585
4586 You may specify a group of related syscalls to be caught at once using
4587 the @code{group:} syntax (@code{g:} is a shorter equivalent). For
4588 instance, on some platforms @value{GDBN} allows you to catch all
4589 network related syscalls, by passing the argument @code{group:network}
4590 to @code{catch syscall}. Note that not all syscall groups are
4591 available in every system. You can use the command completion
4592 facilities (@pxref{Completion,, command completion}) to list the
4593 syscall groups available on your environment.
4594
4595 The example below illustrates how this command works if you don't provide
4596 arguments to it:
4597
4598 @smallexample
4599 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4600 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4601 (@value{GDBP}) r
4602 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4603
4604 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'close'), \
4605 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4606 (@value{GDBP}) c
4607 Continuing.
4608
4609 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'close'), \
4610 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4611 (@value{GDBP})
4612 @end smallexample
4613
4614 Here is an example of catching a system call by name:
4615
4616 @smallexample
4617 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall chroot
4618 Catchpoint 1 (syscall 'chroot' [61])
4619 (@value{GDBP}) r
4620 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4621
4622 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'chroot'), \
4623 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4624 (@value{GDBP}) c
4625 Continuing.
4626
4627 Catchpoint 1 (returned from syscall 'chroot'), \
4628 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4629 (@value{GDBP})
4630 @end smallexample
4631
4632 An example of specifying a system call numerically. In the case
4633 below, the syscall number has a corresponding entry in the XML
4634 file, so @value{GDBN} finds its name and prints it:
4635
4636 @smallexample
4637 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4638 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 'exit_group')
4639 (@value{GDBP}) r
4640 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4641
4642 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall 'exit_group'), \
4643 0xffffe424 in __kernel_vsyscall ()
4644 (@value{GDBP}) c
4645 Continuing.
4646
4647 Program exited normally.
4648 (@value{GDBP})
4649 @end smallexample
4650
4651 Here is an example of catching a syscall group:
4652
4653 @smallexample
4654 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall group:process
4655 Catchpoint 1 (syscalls 'exit' [1] 'fork' [2] 'waitpid' [7]
4656 'execve' [11] 'wait4' [114] 'clone' [120] 'vfork' [190]
4657 'exit_group' [252] 'waitid' [284] 'unshare' [310])
4658 (@value{GDBP}) r
4659 Starting program: /tmp/catch-syscall
4660
4661 Catchpoint 1 (call to syscall fork), 0x00007ffff7df4e27 in open64 ()
4662 from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
4663
4664 (@value{GDBP}) c
4665 Continuing.
4666 @end smallexample
4667
4668 However, there can be situations when there is no corresponding name
4669 in XML file for that syscall number. In this case, @value{GDBN} prints
4670 a warning message saying that it was not able to find the syscall name,
4671 but the catchpoint will be set anyway. See the example below:
4672
4673 @smallexample
4674 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 764
4675 warning: The number '764' does not represent a known syscall.
4676 Catchpoint 2 (syscall 764)
4677 (@value{GDBP})
4678 @end smallexample
4679
4680 If you configure @value{GDBN} using the @samp{--without-expat} option,
4681 it will not be able to display syscall names. Also, if your
4682 architecture does not have an XML file describing its system calls,
4683 you will not be able to see the syscall names. It is important to
4684 notice that these two features are used for accessing the syscall
4685 name database. In either case, you will see a warning like this:
4686
4687 @smallexample
4688 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall
4689 warning: Could not open "syscalls/i386-linux.xml"
4690 warning: Could not load the syscall XML file 'syscalls/i386-linux.xml'.
4691 GDB will not be able to display syscall names.
4692 Catchpoint 1 (syscall)
4693 (@value{GDBP})
4694 @end smallexample
4695
4696 Of course, the file name will change depending on your architecture and system.
4697
4698 Still using the example above, you can also try to catch a syscall by its
4699 number. In this case, you would see something like:
4700
4701 @smallexample
4702 (@value{GDBP}) catch syscall 252
4703 Catchpoint 1 (syscall(s) 252)
4704 @end smallexample
4705
4706 Again, in this case @value{GDBN} would not be able to display syscall's names.
4707
4708 @item fork
4709 @kindex catch fork
4710 A call to @code{fork}.
4711
4712 @item vfork
4713 @kindex catch vfork
4714 A call to @code{vfork}.
4715
4716 @item load @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4717 @itemx unload @r{[}regexp@r{]}
4718 @kindex catch load
4719 @kindex catch unload
4720 The loading or unloading of a shared library. If @var{regexp} is
4721 given, then the catchpoint will stop only if the regular expression
4722 matches one of the affected libraries.
4723
4724 @item signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
4725 @kindex catch signal
4726 The delivery of a signal.
4727
4728 With no arguments, this catchpoint will catch any signal that is not
4729 used internally by @value{GDBN}, specifically, all signals except
4730 @samp{SIGTRAP} and @samp{SIGINT}.
4731
4732 With the argument @samp{all}, all signals, including those used by
4733 @value{GDBN}, will be caught. This argument cannot be used with other
4734 signal names.
4735
4736 Otherwise, the arguments are a list of signal names as given to
4737 @code{handle} (@pxref{Signals}). Only signals specified in this list
4738 will be caught.
4739
4740 One reason that @code{catch signal} can be more useful than
4741 @code{handle} is that you can attach commands and conditions to the
4742 catchpoint.
4743
4744 When a signal is caught by a catchpoint, the signal's @code{stop} and
4745 @code{print} settings, as specified by @code{handle}, are ignored.
4746 However, whether the signal is still delivered to the inferior depends
4747 on the @code{pass} setting; this can be changed in the catchpoint's
4748 commands.
4749
4750 @end table
4751
4752 @item tcatch @var{event}
4753 @kindex tcatch
4754 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
4755 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
4756
4757 @end table
4758
4759 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
4760
4761
4762 @node Delete Breaks
4763 @subsection Deleting Breakpoints
4764
4765 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4766 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
4767 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
4768 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
4769 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
4770 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
4771
4772 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
4773 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
4774 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
4775 their breakpoint numbers.
4776
4777 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
4778 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
4779 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
4780
4781 @table @code
4782 @kindex clear
4783 @item clear
4784 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
4785 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). When
4786 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
4787 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
4788
4789 @item clear @var{location}
4790 Delete any breakpoints set at the specified @var{location}.
4791 @xref{Specify Location}, for the various forms of @var{location}; the
4792 most useful ones are listed below:
4793
4794 @table @code
4795 @item clear @var{function}
4796 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
4797 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the named @var{function}.
4798
4799 @item clear @var{linenum}
4800 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
4801 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified
4802 @var{linenum} of the specified @var{filename}.
4803 @end table
4804
4805 @cindex delete breakpoints
4806 @kindex delete
4807 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
4808 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4809 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
4810 list specified as argument. If no argument is specified, delete all
4811 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
4812 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
4813 @end table
4814
4815 @node Disabling
4816 @subsection Disabling Breakpoints
4817
4818 @cindex enable/disable a breakpoint
4819 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
4820 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
4821 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
4822 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
4823
4824 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
4825 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying
4826 one or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} to
4827 print a list of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints if you
4828 do not know which numbers to use.
4829
4830 Disabling and enabling a breakpoint that has multiple locations
4831 affects all of its locations.
4832
4833 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of several
4834 different states of enablement:
4835
4836 @itemize @bullet
4837 @item
4838 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
4839 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
4840 @item
4841 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
4842 @item
4843 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
4844 disabled.
4845 @item
4846 Enabled for a count. The breakpoint stops your program for the next
4847 N times, then becomes disabled.
4848 @item
4849 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
4850 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
4851 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
4852 @end itemize
4853
4854 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
4855 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
4856
4857 @table @code
4858 @kindex disable
4859 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
4860 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4861 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
4862 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
4863 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
4864 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
4865 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
4866
4867 @kindex enable
4868 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
4869 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
4870 become effective once again in stopping your program.
4871
4872 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{list}@dots{}
4873 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
4874 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
4875
4876 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} count @var{count} @var{list}@dots{}
4877 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} records
4878 @var{count} with each of the specified breakpoints, and decrements a
4879 breakpoint's count when it is hit. When any count reaches 0,
4880 @value{GDBN} disables that breakpoint. If a breakpoint has an ignore
4881 count (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}), that will be
4882 decremented to 0 before @var{count} is affected.
4883
4884 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{list}@dots{}
4885 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
4886 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
4887 Breakpoints set by the @code{tbreak} command start out in this state.
4888 @end table
4889
4890 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
4891 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
4892 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
4893 ,Setting Breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
4894 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
4895 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
4896 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
4897 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
4898 Stepping}.)
4899
4900 @node Conditions
4901 @subsection Break Conditions
4902 @cindex conditional breakpoints
4903 @cindex breakpoint conditions
4904
4905 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
4906 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
4907 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
4908 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
4909 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
4910 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
4911 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
4912 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
4913
4914 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
4915 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
4916 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
4917 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
4918 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
4919
4920 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
4921 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
4922 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
4923 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
4924 one.
4925
4926 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
4927 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
4928 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
4929 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
4930 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
4931 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
4932 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
4933 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
4934 conditions for the
4935 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
4936 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}).
4937
4938 Breakpoint conditions can also be evaluated on the target's side if
4939 the target supports it. Instead of evaluating the conditions locally,
4940 @value{GDBN} encodes the expression into an agent expression
4941 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) suitable for execution on the target,
4942 independently of @value{GDBN}. Global variables become raw memory
4943 locations, locals become stack accesses, and so forth.
4944
4945 In this case, @value{GDBN} will only be notified of a breakpoint trigger
4946 when its condition evaluates to true. This mechanism may provide faster
4947 response times depending on the performance characteristics of the target
4948 since it does not need to keep @value{GDBN} informed about
4949 every breakpoint trigger, even those with false conditions.
4950
4951 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
4952 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
4953 Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
4954 with the @code{condition} command.
4955
4956 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
4957 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
4958 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
4959 catchpoint.
4960
4961 @table @code
4962 @kindex condition
4963 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
4964 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
4965 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
4966 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
4967 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
4968 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
4969 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
4970 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
4971 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
4972 prints an error message:
4973
4974 @smallexample
4975 No symbol "foo" in current context.
4976 @end smallexample
4977
4978 @noindent
4979 @value{GDBN} does
4980 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
4981 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
4982 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4983
4984 @item condition @var{bnum}
4985 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
4986 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
4987 @end table
4988
4989 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
4990 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
4991 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
4992 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
4993 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
4994 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
4995 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
4996 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
4997 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
4998 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
4999 your program reaches it.
5000
5001 @table @code
5002 @kindex ignore
5003 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
5004 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
5005 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
5006 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
5007 takes no action.
5008
5009 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
5010 a count of zero.
5011
5012 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
5013 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
5014 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
5015 Stepping,,Continuing and Stepping}.
5016
5017 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
5018 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
5019 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
5020
5021 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
5022 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
5023 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
5024 Variables}.
5025 @end table
5026
5027 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
5028
5029
5030 @node Break Commands
5031 @subsection Breakpoint Command Lists
5032
5033 @cindex breakpoint commands
5034 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
5035 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
5036 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
5037 enable other breakpoints.
5038
5039 @table @code
5040 @kindex commands
5041 @kindex end@r{ (breakpoint commands)}
5042 @item commands @r{[}@var{list}@dots{}@r{]}
5043 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
5044 @itemx end
5045 Specify a list of commands for the given breakpoints. The commands
5046 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
5047 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
5048
5049 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
5050 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
5051
5052 With no argument, @code{commands} refers to the last breakpoint,
5053 watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most recently
5054 encountered). If the most recent breakpoints were set with a single
5055 command, then the @code{commands} will apply to all the breakpoints
5056 set by that command. This applies to breakpoints set by
5057 @code{rbreak}, and also applies when a single @code{break} command
5058 creates multiple breakpoints (@pxref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous
5059 Expressions}).
5060 @end table
5061
5062 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
5063 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
5064
5065 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
5066 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
5067 that resumes execution.
5068
5069 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
5070 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
5071 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
5072 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
5073 ambiguities about which list to execute.
5074
5075 @kindex silent
5076 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
5077 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
5078 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
5079 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
5080 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
5081 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
5082
5083 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
5084 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
5085 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for Controlled Output}.
5086
5087 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
5088 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
5089
5090 @smallexample
5091 break foo if x>0
5092 commands
5093 silent
5094 printf "x is %d\n",x
5095 cont
5096 end
5097 @end smallexample
5098
5099 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
5100 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
5101 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
5102 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
5103 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
5104 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
5105 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
5106
5107 @smallexample
5108 break 403
5109 commands
5110 silent
5111 set x = y + 4
5112 cont
5113 end
5114 @end smallexample
5115
5116 @node Dynamic Printf
5117 @subsection Dynamic Printf
5118
5119 @cindex dynamic printf
5120 @cindex dprintf
5121 The dynamic printf command @code{dprintf} combines a breakpoint with
5122 formatted printing of your program's data to give you the effect of
5123 inserting @code{printf} calls into your program on-the-fly, without
5124 having to recompile it.
5125
5126 In its most basic form, the output goes to the GDB console. However,
5127 you can set the variable @code{dprintf-style} for alternate handling.
5128 For instance, you can ask to format the output by calling your
5129 program's @code{printf} function. This has the advantage that the
5130 characters go to the program's output device, so they can recorded in
5131 redirects to files and so forth.
5132
5133 If you are doing remote debugging with a stub or agent, you can also
5134 ask to have the printf handled by the remote agent. In addition to
5135 ensuring that the output goes to the remote program's device along
5136 with any other output the program might produce, you can also ask that
5137 the dprintf remain active even after disconnecting from the remote
5138 target. Using the stub/agent is also more efficient, as it can do
5139 everything without needing to communicate with @value{GDBN}.
5140
5141 @table @code
5142 @kindex dprintf
5143 @item dprintf @var{location},@var{template},@var{expression}[,@var{expression}@dots{}]
5144 Whenever execution reaches @var{location}, print the values of one or
5145 more @var{expressions} under the control of the string @var{template}.
5146 To print several values, separate them with commas.
5147
5148 @item set dprintf-style @var{style}
5149 Set the dprintf output to be handled in one of several different
5150 styles enumerated below. A change of style affects all existing
5151 dynamic printfs immediately. (If you need individual control over the
5152 print commands, simply define normal breakpoints with
5153 explicitly-supplied command lists.)
5154
5155 @table @code
5156 @item gdb
5157 @kindex dprintf-style gdb
5158 Handle the output using the @value{GDBN} @code{printf} command.
5159
5160 @item call
5161 @kindex dprintf-style call
5162 Handle the output by calling a function in your program (normally
5163 @code{printf}).
5164
5165 @item agent
5166 @kindex dprintf-style agent
5167 Have the remote debugging agent (such as @code{gdbserver}) handle
5168 the output itself. This style is only available for agents that
5169 support running commands on the target.
5170 @end table
5171
5172 @item set dprintf-function @var{function}
5173 Set the function to call if the dprintf style is @code{call}. By
5174 default its value is @code{printf}. You may set it to any expression.
5175 that @value{GDBN} can evaluate to a function, as per the @code{call}
5176 command.
5177
5178 @item set dprintf-channel @var{channel}
5179 Set a ``channel'' for dprintf. If set to a non-empty value,
5180 @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as an expression and pass the result as
5181 a first argument to the @code{dprintf-function}, in the manner of
5182 @code{fprintf} and similar functions. Otherwise, the dprintf format
5183 string will be the first argument, in the manner of @code{printf}.
5184
5185 As an example, if you wanted @code{dprintf} output to go to a logfile
5186 that is a standard I/O stream assigned to the variable @code{mylog},
5187 you could do the following:
5188
5189 @example
5190 (gdb) set dprintf-style call
5191 (gdb) set dprintf-function fprintf
5192 (gdb) set dprintf-channel mylog
5193 (gdb) dprintf 25,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob
5194 Dprintf 1 at 0x123456: file main.c, line 25.
5195 (gdb) info break
5196 1 dprintf keep y 0x00123456 in main at main.c:25
5197 call (void) fprintf (mylog,"at line 25, glob=%d\n",glob)
5198 continue
5199 (gdb)
5200 @end example
5201
5202 Note that the @code{info break} displays the dynamic printf commands
5203 as normal breakpoint commands; you can thus easily see the effect of
5204 the variable settings.
5205
5206 @item set disconnected-dprintf on
5207 @itemx set disconnected-dprintf off
5208 @kindex set disconnected-dprintf
5209 Choose whether @code{dprintf} commands should continue to run if
5210 @value{GDBN} has disconnected from the target. This only applies
5211 if the @code{dprintf-style} is @code{agent}.
5212
5213 @item show disconnected-dprintf off
5214 @kindex show disconnected-dprintf
5215 Show the current choice for disconnected @code{dprintf}.
5216
5217 @end table
5218
5219 @value{GDBN} does not check the validity of function and channel,
5220 relying on you to supply values that are meaningful for the contexts
5221 in which they are being used. For instance, the function and channel
5222 may be the values of local variables, but if that is the case, then
5223 all enabled dynamic prints must be at locations within the scope of
5224 those locals. If evaluation fails, @value{GDBN} will report an error.
5225
5226 @node Save Breakpoints
5227 @subsection How to save breakpoints to a file
5228
5229 To save breakpoint definitions to a file use the @w{@code{save
5230 breakpoints}} command.
5231
5232 @table @code
5233 @kindex save breakpoints
5234 @cindex save breakpoints to a file for future sessions
5235 @item save breakpoints [@var{filename}]
5236 This command saves all current breakpoint definitions together with
5237 their commands and ignore counts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
5238 suitable for use in a later debugging session. This includes all
5239 types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints,
5240 tracepoints). To read the saved breakpoint definitions, use the
5241 @code{source} command (@pxref{Command Files}). Note that watchpoints
5242 with expressions involving local variables may fail to be recreated
5243 because it may not be possible to access the context where the
5244 watchpoint is valid anymore. Because the saved breakpoint definitions
5245 are simply a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands that recreate the
5246 breakpoints, you can edit the file in your favorite editing program,
5247 and remove the breakpoint definitions you're not interested in, or
5248 that can no longer be recreated.
5249 @end table
5250
5251 @node Static Probe Points
5252 @subsection Static Probe Points
5253
5254 @cindex static probe point, SystemTap
5255 @cindex static probe point, DTrace
5256 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{SDT} probes in the code. @acronym{SDT} stands
5257 for Statically Defined Tracing, and the probes are designed to have a tiny
5258 runtime code and data footprint, and no dynamic relocations.
5259
5260 Currently, the following types of probes are supported on
5261 ELF-compatible systems:
5262
5263 @itemize @bullet
5264
5265 @item @code{SystemTap} (@uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/})
5266 @acronym{SDT} probes@footnote{See
5267 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/AddingUserSpaceProbingToApps}
5268 for more information on how to add @code{SystemTap} @acronym{SDT}
5269 probes in your applications.}. @code{SystemTap} probes are usable
5270 from assembly, C and C@t{++} languages@footnote{See
5271 @uref{http://sourceware.org/systemtap/wiki/UserSpaceProbeImplementation}
5272 for a good reference on how the @acronym{SDT} probes are implemented.}.
5273
5274 @item @code{DTrace} (@uref{http://oss.oracle.com/projects/DTrace})
5275 @acronym{USDT} probes. @code{DTrace} probes are usable from C and
5276 C@t{++} languages.
5277 @end itemize
5278
5279 @cindex semaphores on static probe points
5280 Some @code{SystemTap} probes have an associated semaphore variable;
5281 for instance, this happens automatically if you defined your probe
5282 using a DTrace-style @file{.d} file. If your probe has a semaphore,
5283 @value{GDBN} will automatically enable it when you specify a
5284 breakpoint using the @samp{-probe-stap} notation. But, if you put a
5285 breakpoint at a probe's location by some other method (e.g.,
5286 @code{break file:line}), then @value{GDBN} will not automatically set
5287 the semaphore. @code{DTrace} probes do not support semaphores.
5288
5289 You can examine the available static static probes using @code{info
5290 probes}, with optional arguments:
5291
5292 @table @code
5293 @kindex info probes
5294 @item info probes @r{[}@var{type}@r{]} @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5295 If given, @var{type} is either @code{stap} for listing
5296 @code{SystemTap} probes or @code{dtrace} for listing @code{DTrace}
5297 probes. If omitted all probes are listed regardless of their types.
5298
5299 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against provider
5300 names when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probes by all
5301 probes from all providers are listed.
5302
5303 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe names
5304 when selecting which probes to list. If omitted, probe names are not
5305 considered when deciding whether to display them.
5306
5307 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5308 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5309 given, all object files are considered.
5310
5311 @item info probes all
5312 List the available static probes, from all types.
5313 @end table
5314
5315 @cindex enabling and disabling probes
5316 Some probe points can be enabled and/or disabled. The effect of
5317 enabling or disabling a probe depends on the type of probe being
5318 handled. Some @code{DTrace} probes can be enabled or
5319 disabled, but @code{SystemTap} probes cannot be disabled.
5320
5321 You can enable (or disable) one or more probes using the following
5322 commands, with optional arguments:
5323
5324 @table @code
5325 @kindex enable probes
5326 @item enable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5327 If given, @var{provider} is a regular expression used to match against
5328 provider names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted,
5329 all probes from all providers are enabled.
5330
5331 If given, @var{name} is a regular expression to match against probe
5332 names when selecting which probes to enable. If omitted, probe names
5333 are not considered when deciding whether to enable them.
5334
5335 If given, @var{objfile} is a regular expression used to select which
5336 object files (executable or shared libraries) to examine. If not
5337 given, all object files are considered.
5338
5339 @kindex disable probes
5340 @item disable probes @r{[}@var{provider} @r{[}@var{name} @r{[}@var{objfile}@r{]}@r{]}@r{]}
5341 See the @code{enable probes} command above for a description of the
5342 optional arguments accepted by this command.
5343 @end table
5344
5345 @vindex $_probe_arg@r{, convenience variable}
5346 A probe may specify up to twelve arguments. These are available at the
5347 point at which the probe is defined---that is, when the current PC is
5348 at the probe's location. The arguments are available using the
5349 convenience variables (@pxref{Convenience Vars})
5350 @code{$_probe_arg0}@dots{}@code{$_probe_arg11}. In @code{SystemTap}
5351 probes each probe argument is an integer of the appropriate size;
5352 types are not preserved. In @code{DTrace} probes types are preserved
5353 provided that they are recognized as such by @value{GDBN}; otherwise
5354 the value of the probe argument will be a long integer. The
5355 convenience variable @code{$_probe_argc} holds the number of arguments
5356 at the current probe point.
5357
5358 These variables are always available, but attempts to access them at
5359 any location other than a probe point will cause @value{GDBN} to give
5360 an error message.
5361
5362
5363 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
5364 @node Error in Breakpoints
5365 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
5366
5367 If you request too many active hardware-assisted breakpoints and
5368 watchpoints, you will see this error message:
5369
5370 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
5371 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
5372 @smallexample
5373 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
5374 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
5375 @end smallexample
5376
5377 @noindent
5378 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
5379 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
5380 watchpoints it needs to insert.
5381
5382 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
5383 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
5384
5385 @node Breakpoint-related Warnings
5386 @subsection ``Breakpoint address adjusted...''
5387 @cindex breakpoint address adjusted
5388
5389 Some processor architectures place constraints on the addresses at
5390 which breakpoints may be placed. For architectures thus constrained,
5391 @value{GDBN} will attempt to adjust the breakpoint's address to comply
5392 with the constraints dictated by the architecture.
5393
5394 One example of such an architecture is the Fujitsu FR-V. The FR-V is
5395 a VLIW architecture in which a number of RISC-like instructions may be
5396 bundled together for parallel execution. The FR-V architecture
5397 constrains the location of a breakpoint instruction within such a
5398 bundle to the instruction with the lowest address. @value{GDBN}
5399 honors this constraint by adjusting a breakpoint's address to the
5400 first in the bundle.
5401
5402 It is not uncommon for optimized code to have bundles which contain
5403 instructions from different source statements, thus it may happen that
5404 a breakpoint's address will be adjusted from one source statement to
5405 another. Since this adjustment may significantly alter @value{GDBN}'s
5406 breakpoint related behavior from what the user expects, a warning is
5407 printed when the breakpoint is first set and also when the breakpoint
5408 is hit.
5409
5410 A warning like the one below is printed when setting a breakpoint
5411 that's been subject to address adjustment:
5412
5413 @smallexample
5414 warning: Breakpoint address adjusted from 0x00010414 to 0x00010410.
5415 @end smallexample
5416
5417 Such warnings are printed both for user settable and @value{GDBN}'s
5418 internal breakpoints. If you see one of these warnings, you should
5419 verify that a breakpoint set at the adjusted address will have the
5420 desired affect. If not, the breakpoint in question may be removed and
5421 other breakpoints may be set which will have the desired behavior.
5422 E.g., it may be sufficient to place the breakpoint at a later
5423 instruction. A conditional breakpoint may also be useful in some
5424 cases to prevent the breakpoint from triggering too often.
5425
5426 @value{GDBN} will also issue a warning when stopping at one of these
5427 adjusted breakpoints:
5428
5429 @smallexample
5430 warning: Breakpoint 1 address previously adjusted from 0x00010414
5431 to 0x00010410.
5432 @end smallexample
5433
5434 When this warning is encountered, it may be too late to take remedial
5435 action except in cases where the breakpoint is hit earlier or more
5436 frequently than expected.
5437
5438 @node Continuing and Stepping
5439 @section Continuing and Stepping
5440
5441 @cindex stepping
5442 @cindex continuing
5443 @cindex resuming execution
5444 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
5445 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
5446 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
5447 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
5448 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
5449 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
5450 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
5451 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution (@pxref{Signals, ,Signals}),
5452 or you may step into the signal's handler (@pxref{stepping and signal
5453 handlers}).)
5454
5455 @table @code
5456 @kindex continue
5457 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
5458 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
5459 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5460 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5461 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
5462 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
5463 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
5464 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
5465 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
5466 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
5467
5468 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
5469 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
5470 @code{continue} is ignored.
5471
5472 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
5473 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
5474 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
5475 @code{continue}.
5476 @end table
5477
5478 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
5479 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}) to go back to the
5480 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
5481 Different Address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
5482
5483 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
5484 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; Watchpoints; and Catchpoints}) at the
5485 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
5486 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
5487 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
5488 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
5489
5490 @table @code
5491 @kindex step
5492 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
5493 @item step
5494 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
5495 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
5496 abbreviated @code{s}.
5497
5498 @quotation
5499 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
5500 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
5501 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
5502 @c distinction here.
5503 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
5504 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
5505 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
5506 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
5507 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
5508 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
5509 below.
5510 @end quotation
5511
5512 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
5513 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5514 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
5515 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
5516 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
5517 called within the line.
5518
5519 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
5520 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
5521 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
5522 on @acronym{MIPS} machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
5523 was any debugging information about the routine.
5524
5525 @item step @var{count}
5526 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
5527 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
5528 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
5529
5530 @kindex next
5531 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
5532 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
5533 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
5534 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
5535 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
5536 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
5537 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
5538 is abbreviated @code{n}.
5539
5540 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
5541
5542
5543 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
5544 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
5545 @c
5546 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
5547 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
5548 @c function are executed without stopping.
5549
5550 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
5551 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
5552 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
5553
5554 @kindex set step-mode
5555 @item set step-mode
5556 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
5557 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
5558 @itemx set step-mode on
5559 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
5560 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
5561 information rather than stepping over it.
5562
5563 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
5564 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
5565 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
5566
5567 @item set step-mode off
5568 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
5569 debug information. This is the default.
5570
5571 @item show step-mode
5572 Show whether @value{GDBN} will stop in or step over functions without
5573 source line debug information.
5574
5575 @kindex finish
5576 @kindex fin @r{(@code{finish})}
5577 @item finish
5578 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
5579 returns. Print the returned value (if any). This command can be
5580 abbreviated as @code{fin}.
5581
5582 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
5583 ,Returning from a Function}).
5584
5585 @kindex until
5586 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
5587 @cindex run until specified location
5588 @item until
5589 @itemx u
5590 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
5591 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
5592 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
5593 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
5594 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
5595 than the address of the jump.
5596
5597 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
5598 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
5599 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
5600 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
5601 through the next iteration.
5602
5603 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
5604 stack frame.
5605
5606 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
5607 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
5608 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
5609 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
5610 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
5611
5612 @smallexample
5613 (@value{GDBP}) f
5614 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
5615 206 expand_input();
5616 (@value{GDBP}) until
5617 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
5618 @end smallexample
5619
5620 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
5621 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
5622 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
5623 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
5624 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
5625 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
5626 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
5627
5628 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
5629 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
5630 argument.
5631
5632 @item until @var{location}
5633 @itemx u @var{location}
5634 Continue running your program until either the specified @var{location} is
5635 reached, or the current stack frame returns. The location is any of
5636 the forms described in @ref{Specify Location}.
5637 This form of the command uses temporary breakpoints, and
5638 hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument. The specified
5639 location is actually reached only if it is in the current frame. This
5640 implies that @code{until} can be used to skip over recursive function
5641 invocations. For instance in the code below, if the current location is
5642 line @code{96}, issuing @code{until 99} will execute the program up to
5643 line @code{99} in the same invocation of factorial, i.e., after the inner
5644 invocations have returned.
5645
5646 @smallexample
5647 94 int factorial (int value)
5648 95 @{
5649 96 if (value > 1) @{
5650 97 value *= factorial (value - 1);
5651 98 @}
5652 99 return (value);
5653 100 @}
5654 @end smallexample
5655
5656
5657 @kindex advance @var{location}
5658 @item advance @var{location}
5659 Continue running the program up to the given @var{location}. An argument is
5660 required, which should be of one of the forms described in
5661 @ref{Specify Location}.
5662 Execution will also stop upon exit from the current stack
5663 frame. This command is similar to @code{until}, but @code{advance} will
5664 not skip over recursive function calls, and the target location doesn't
5665 have to be in the same frame as the current one.
5666
5667
5668 @kindex stepi
5669 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
5670 @item stepi
5671 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
5672 @itemx si
5673 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
5674
5675 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
5676 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
5677 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
5678 Display,, Automatic Display}.
5679
5680 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
5681
5682 @need 750
5683 @kindex nexti
5684 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
5685 @item nexti
5686 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
5687 @itemx ni
5688 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
5689 proceed until the function returns.
5690
5691 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
5692
5693 @end table
5694
5695 @anchor{range stepping}
5696 @cindex range stepping
5697 @cindex target-assisted range stepping
5698 By default, and if available, @value{GDBN} makes use of
5699 target-assisted @dfn{range stepping}. In other words, whenever you
5700 use a stepping command (e.g., @code{step}, @code{next}), @value{GDBN}
5701 tells the target to step the corresponding range of instruction
5702 addresses instead of issuing multiple single-steps. This speeds up
5703 line stepping, particularly for remote targets. Ideally, there should
5704 be no reason you would want to turn range stepping off. However, it's
5705 possible that a bug in the debug info, a bug in the remote stub (for
5706 remote targets), or even a bug in @value{GDBN} could make line
5707 stepping behave incorrectly when target-assisted range stepping is
5708 enabled. You can use the following command to turn off range stepping
5709 if necessary:
5710
5711 @table @code
5712 @kindex set range-stepping
5713 @kindex show range-stepping
5714 @item set range-stepping
5715 @itemx show range-stepping
5716 Control whether range stepping is enabled.
5717
5718 If @code{on}, and the target supports it, @value{GDBN} tells the
5719 target to step a range of addresses itself, instead of issuing
5720 multiple single-steps. If @code{off}, @value{GDBN} always issues
5721 single-steps, even if range stepping is supported by the target. The
5722 default is @code{on}.
5723
5724 @end table
5725
5726 @node Skipping Over Functions and Files
5727 @section Skipping Over Functions and Files
5728 @cindex skipping over functions and files
5729
5730 The program you are debugging may contain some functions which are
5731 uninteresting to debug. The @code{skip} command lets you tell @value{GDBN} to
5732 skip a function, all functions in a file or a particular function in
5733 a particular file when stepping.
5734
5735 For example, consider the following C function:
5736
5737 @smallexample
5738 101 int func()
5739 102 @{
5740 103 foo(boring());
5741 104 bar(boring());
5742 105 @}
5743 @end smallexample
5744
5745 @noindent
5746 Suppose you wish to step into the functions @code{foo} and @code{bar}, but you
5747 are not interested in stepping through @code{boring}. If you run @code{step}
5748 at line 103, you'll enter @code{boring()}, but if you run @code{next}, you'll
5749 step over both @code{foo} and @code{boring}!
5750
5751 One solution is to @code{step} into @code{boring} and use the @code{finish}
5752 command to immediately exit it. But this can become tedious if @code{boring}
5753 is called from many places.
5754
5755 A more flexible solution is to execute @kbd{skip boring}. This instructs
5756 @value{GDBN} never to step into @code{boring}. Now when you execute
5757 @code{step} at line 103, you'll step over @code{boring} and directly into
5758 @code{foo}.
5759
5760 Functions may be skipped by providing either a function name, linespec
5761 (@pxref{Specify Location}), regular expression that matches the function's
5762 name, file name or a @code{glob}-style pattern that matches the file name.
5763
5764 On Posix systems the form of the regular expression is
5765 ``Extended Regular Expressions''. See for example @samp{man 7 regex}
5766 on @sc{gnu}/Linux systems. On non-Posix systems the form of the regular
5767 expression is whatever is provided by the @code{regcomp} function of
5768 the underlying system.
5769 See for example @samp{man 7 glob} on @sc{gnu}/Linux systems for a
5770 description of @code{glob}-style patterns.
5771
5772 @table @code
5773 @kindex skip
5774 @item skip @r{[}@var{options}@r{]}
5775 The basic form of the @code{skip} command takes zero or more options
5776 that specify what to skip.
5777 The @var{options} argument is any useful combination of the following:
5778
5779 @table @code
5780 @item -file @var{file}
5781 @itemx -fi @var{file}
5782 Functions in @var{file} will be skipped over when stepping.
5783
5784 @item -gfile @var{file-glob-pattern}
5785 @itemx -gfi @var{file-glob-pattern}
5786 @cindex skipping over files via glob-style patterns
5787 Functions in files matching @var{file-glob-pattern} will be skipped
5788 over when stepping.
5789
5790 @smallexample
5791 (gdb) skip -gfi utils/*.c
5792 @end smallexample
5793
5794 @item -function @var{linespec}
5795 @itemx -fu @var{linespec}
5796 Functions named by @var{linespec} or the function containing the line
5797 named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when stepping.
5798 @xref{Specify Location}.
5799
5800 @item -rfunction @var{regexp}
5801 @itemx -rfu @var{regexp}
5802 @cindex skipping over functions via regular expressions
5803 Functions whose name matches @var{regexp} will be skipped over when stepping.
5804
5805 This form is useful for complex function names.
5806 For example, there is generally no need to step into C@t{++} @code{std::string}
5807 constructors or destructors. Plus with C@t{++} templates it can be hard to
5808 write out the full name of the function, and often it doesn't matter what
5809 the template arguments are. Specifying the function to be skipped as a
5810 regular expression makes this easier.
5811
5812 @smallexample
5813 (gdb) skip -rfu ^std::(allocator|basic_string)<.*>::~?\1 *\(
5814 @end smallexample
5815
5816 If you want to skip every templated C@t{++} constructor and destructor
5817 in the @code{std} namespace you can do:
5818
5819 @smallexample
5820 (gdb) skip -rfu ^std::([a-zA-z0-9_]+)<.*>::~?\1 *\(
5821 @end smallexample
5822 @end table
5823
5824 If no options are specified, the function you're currently debugging
5825 will be skipped.
5826
5827 @kindex skip function
5828 @item skip function @r{[}@var{linespec}@r{]}
5829 After running this command, the function named by @var{linespec} or the
5830 function containing the line named by @var{linespec} will be skipped over when
5831 stepping. @xref{Specify Location}.
5832
5833 If you do not specify @var{linespec}, the function you're currently debugging
5834 will be skipped.
5835
5836 (If you have a function called @code{file} that you want to skip, use
5837 @kbd{skip function file}.)
5838
5839 @kindex skip file
5840 @item skip file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
5841 After running this command, any function whose source lives in @var{filename}
5842 will be skipped over when stepping.
5843
5844 @smallexample
5845 (gdb) skip file boring.c
5846 File boring.c will be skipped when stepping.
5847 @end smallexample
5848
5849 If you do not specify @var{filename}, functions whose source lives in the file
5850 you're currently debugging will be skipped.
5851 @end table
5852
5853 Skips can be listed, deleted, disabled, and enabled, much like breakpoints.
5854 These are the commands for managing your list of skips:
5855
5856 @table @code
5857 @kindex info skip
5858 @item info skip @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5859 Print details about the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified,
5860 print a table with details about all functions and files marked for skipping.
5861 @code{info skip} prints the following information about each skip:
5862
5863 @table @emph
5864 @item Identifier
5865 A number identifying this skip.
5866 @item Enabled or Disabled
5867 Enabled skips are marked with @samp{y}.
5868 Disabled skips are marked with @samp{n}.
5869 @item Glob
5870 If the file name is a @samp{glob} pattern this is @samp{y}.
5871 Otherwise it is @samp{n}.
5872 @item File
5873 The name or @samp{glob} pattern of the file to be skipped.
5874 If no file is specified this is @samp{<none>}.
5875 @item RE
5876 If the function name is a @samp{regular expression} this is @samp{y}.
5877 Otherwise it is @samp{n}.
5878 @item Function
5879 The name or regular expression of the function to skip.
5880 If no function is specified this is @samp{<none>}.
5881 @end table
5882
5883 @kindex skip delete
5884 @item skip delete @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5885 Delete the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, delete all
5886 skips.
5887
5888 @kindex skip enable
5889 @item skip enable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5890 Enable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, enable all
5891 skips.
5892
5893 @kindex skip disable
5894 @item skip disable @r{[}@var{range}@r{]}
5895 Disable the specified skip(s). If @var{range} is not specified, disable all
5896 skips.
5897
5898 @end table
5899
5900 @node Signals
5901 @section Signals
5902 @cindex signals
5903
5904 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
5905 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
5906 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
5907 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c});
5908 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
5909 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
5910 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
5911 requested an alarm).
5912
5913 @cindex fatal signals
5914 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
5915 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
5916 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
5917 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
5918 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
5919 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
5920
5921 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
5922 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
5923 signal.
5924
5925 @cindex handling signals
5926 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
5927 @code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
5928 (so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
5929 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
5930 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
5931
5932 @table @code
5933 @kindex info signals
5934 @kindex info handle
5935 @item info signals
5936 @itemx info handle
5937 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
5938 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
5939 the defined types of signals.
5940
5941 @item info signals @var{sig}
5942 Similar, but print information only about the specified signal number.
5943
5944 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
5945
5946 @item catch signal @r{[}@var{signal}@dots{} @r{|} @samp{all}@r{]}
5947 Set a catchpoint for the indicated signals. @xref{Set Catchpoints},
5948 for details about this command.
5949
5950 @kindex handle
5951 @item handle @var{signal} @r{[}@var{keywords}@dots{}@r{]}
5952 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal}
5953 can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
5954 @samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
5955 @samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
5956 known signals. Optional arguments @var{keywords}, described below,
5957 say what change to make.
5958 @end table
5959
5960 @c @group
5961 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
5962 Their full names are:
5963
5964 @table @code
5965 @item nostop
5966 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
5967 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
5968
5969 @item stop
5970 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
5971 the @code{print} keyword as well.
5972
5973 @item print
5974 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
5975
5976 @item noprint
5977 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
5978 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
5979
5980 @item pass
5981 @itemx noignore
5982 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
5983 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
5984 and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
5985
5986 @item nopass
5987 @itemx ignore
5988 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
5989 @code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
5990 @end table
5991 @c @end group
5992
5993 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
5994 program until you
5995 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
5996 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
5997 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
5998 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
5999 program sees that signal when you continue.
6000
6001 The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
6002 non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
6003 @code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
6004 erroneous signals.
6005
6006 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
6007 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
6008 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
6009 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
6010 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
6011 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
6012 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
6013 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
6014 Program a Signal}.
6015
6016 @cindex stepping and signal handlers
6017 @anchor{stepping and signal handlers}
6018
6019 @value{GDBN} optimizes for stepping the mainline code. If a signal
6020 that has @code{handle nostop} and @code{handle pass} set arrives while
6021 a stepping command (e.g., @code{stepi}, @code{step}, @code{next}) is
6022 in progress, @value{GDBN} lets the signal handler run and then resumes
6023 stepping the mainline code once the signal handler returns. In other
6024 words, @value{GDBN} steps over the signal handler. This prevents
6025 signals that you've specified as not interesting (with @code{handle
6026 nostop}) from changing the focus of debugging unexpectedly. Note that
6027 the signal handler itself may still hit a breakpoint, stop for another
6028 signal that has @code{handle stop} in effect, or for any other event
6029 that normally results in stopping the stepping command sooner. Also
6030 note that @value{GDBN} still informs you that the program received a
6031 signal if @code{handle print} is set.
6032
6033 @anchor{stepping into signal handlers}
6034
6035 If you set @code{handle pass} for a signal, and your program sets up a
6036 handler for it, then issuing a stepping command, such as @code{step}
6037 or @code{stepi}, when your program is stopped due to the signal will
6038 step @emph{into} the signal handler (if the target supports that).
6039
6040 Likewise, if you use the @code{queue-signal} command to queue a signal
6041 to be delivered to the current thread when execution of the thread
6042 resumes (@pxref{Signaling, ,Giving your Program a Signal}), then a
6043 stepping command will step into the signal handler.
6044
6045 Here's an example, using @code{stepi} to step to the first instruction
6046 of @code{SIGUSR1}'s handler:
6047
6048 @smallexample
6049 (@value{GDBP}) handle SIGUSR1
6050 Signal Stop Print Pass to program Description
6051 SIGUSR1 Yes Yes Yes User defined signal 1
6052 (@value{GDBP}) c
6053 Continuing.
6054
6055 Program received signal SIGUSR1, User defined signal 1.
6056 main () sigusr1.c:28
6057 28 p = 0;
6058 (@value{GDBP}) si
6059 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
6060 9 @{
6061 @end smallexample
6062
6063 The same, but using @code{queue-signal} instead of waiting for the
6064 program to receive the signal first:
6065
6066 @smallexample
6067 (@value{GDBP}) n
6068 28 p = 0;
6069 (@value{GDBP}) queue-signal SIGUSR1
6070 (@value{GDBP}) si
6071 sigusr1_handler () at sigusr1.c:9
6072 9 @{
6073 (@value{GDBP})
6074 @end smallexample
6075
6076 @cindex extra signal information
6077 @anchor{extra signal information}
6078
6079 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can inspect extra signal information
6080 associated with the intercepted signal, before it is actually
6081 delivered to the program being debugged. This information is exported
6082 by the convenience variable @code{$_siginfo}, and consists of data
6083 that is passed by the kernel to the signal handler at the time of the
6084 receipt of a signal. The data type of the information itself is
6085 target dependent. You can see the data type using the @code{ptype
6086 $_siginfo} command. On Unix systems, it typically corresponds to the
6087 standard @code{siginfo_t} type, as defined in the @file{signal.h}
6088 system header.
6089
6090 Here's an example, on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, printing the stray
6091 referenced address that raised a segmentation fault.
6092
6093 @smallexample
6094 @group
6095 (@value{GDBP}) continue
6096 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault.
6097 0x0000000000400766 in main ()
6098 69 *(int *)p = 0;
6099 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo
6100 type = struct @{
6101 int si_signo;
6102 int si_errno;
6103 int si_code;
6104 union @{
6105 int _pad[28];
6106 struct @{...@} _kill;
6107 struct @{...@} _timer;
6108 struct @{...@} _rt;
6109 struct @{...@} _sigchld;
6110 struct @{...@} _sigfault;
6111 struct @{...@} _sigpoll;
6112 @} _sifields;
6113 @}
6114 (@value{GDBP}) ptype $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault
6115 type = struct @{
6116 void *si_addr;
6117 @}
6118 (@value{GDBP}) p $_siginfo._sifields._sigfault.si_addr
6119 $1 = (void *) 0x7ffff7ff7000
6120 @end group
6121 @end smallexample
6122
6123 Depending on target support, @code{$_siginfo} may also be writable.
6124
6125 @cindex Intel MPX boundary violations
6126 @cindex boundary violations, Intel MPX
6127 On some targets, a @code{SIGSEGV} can be caused by a boundary
6128 violation, i.e., accessing an address outside of the allowed range.
6129 In those cases @value{GDBN} may displays additional information,
6130 depending on how @value{GDBN} has been told to handle the signal.
6131 With @code{handle stop SIGSEGV}, @value{GDBN} displays the violation
6132 kind: "Upper" or "Lower", the memory address accessed and the
6133 bounds, while with @code{handle nostop SIGSEGV} no additional
6134 information is displayed.
6135
6136 The usual output of a segfault is:
6137 @smallexample
6138 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault
6139 0x0000000000400d7c in upper () at i386-mpx-sigsegv.c:68
6140 68 value = *(p + len);
6141 @end smallexample
6142
6143 While a bound violation is presented as:
6144 @smallexample
6145 Program received signal SIGSEGV, Segmentation fault
6146 Upper bound violation while accessing address 0x7fffffffc3b3
6147 Bounds: [lower = 0x7fffffffc390, upper = 0x7fffffffc3a3]
6148 0x0000000000400d7c in upper () at i386-mpx-sigsegv.c:68
6149 68 value = *(p + len);
6150 @end smallexample
6151
6152 @node Thread Stops
6153 @section Stopping and Starting Multi-thread Programs
6154
6155 @cindex stopped threads
6156 @cindex threads, stopped
6157
6158 @cindex continuing threads
6159 @cindex threads, continuing
6160
6161 @value{GDBN} supports debugging programs with multiple threads
6162 (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads}). There
6163 are two modes of controlling execution of your program within the
6164 debugger. In the default mode, referred to as @dfn{all-stop mode},
6165 when any thread in your program stops (for example, at a breakpoint
6166 or while being stepped), all other threads in the program are also stopped by
6167 @value{GDBN}. On some targets, @value{GDBN} also supports
6168 @dfn{non-stop mode}, in which other threads can continue to run freely while
6169 you examine the stopped thread in the debugger.
6170
6171 @menu
6172 * All-Stop Mode:: All threads stop when GDB takes control
6173 * Non-Stop Mode:: Other threads continue to execute
6174 * Background Execution:: Running your program asynchronously
6175 * Thread-Specific Breakpoints:: Controlling breakpoints
6176 * Interrupted System Calls:: GDB may interfere with system calls
6177 * Observer Mode:: GDB does not alter program behavior
6178 @end menu
6179
6180 @node All-Stop Mode
6181 @subsection All-Stop Mode
6182
6183 @cindex all-stop mode
6184
6185 In all-stop mode, whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
6186 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
6187 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
6188 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
6189 underfoot.
6190
6191 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
6192 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
6193 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
6194
6195 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
6196 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
6197 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
6198 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
6199 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
6200 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
6201 stops.
6202
6203 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
6204 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
6205 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
6206 first thread completes whatever you requested.
6207
6208 @cindex automatic thread selection
6209 @cindex switching threads automatically
6210 @cindex threads, automatic switching
6211 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
6212 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
6213 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
6214 message such as @samp{[Switching to Thread @var{n}]} to identify the
6215 thread.
6216
6217 On some OSes, you can modify @value{GDBN}'s default behavior by
6218 locking the OS scheduler to allow only a single thread to run.
6219
6220 @table @code
6221 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
6222 @cindex scheduler locking mode
6223 @cindex lock scheduler
6224 Set the scheduler locking mode. It applies to normal execution,
6225 record mode, and replay mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
6226 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only
6227 the current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The
6228 @code{step} mode optimizes for single-stepping; it prevents other
6229 threads from preempting the current thread while you are stepping, so
6230 that the focus of debugging does not change unexpectedly. Other
6231 threads never get a chance to run when you step, and they are
6232 completely free to run when you use commands like @samp{continue},
6233 @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another thread hits a
6234 breakpoint during its timeslice, @value{GDBN} does not change the
6235 current thread away from the thread that you are debugging. The
6236 @code{replay} mode behaves like @code{off} in record mode and like
6237 @code{on} in replay mode.
6238
6239 @item show scheduler-locking
6240 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
6241 @end table
6242
6243 @cindex resume threads of multiple processes simultaneously
6244 By default, when you issue one of the execution commands such as
6245 @code{continue}, @code{next} or @code{step}, @value{GDBN} allows only
6246 threads of the current inferior to run. For example, if @value{GDBN}
6247 is attached to two inferiors, each with two threads, the
6248 @code{continue} command resumes only the two threads of the current
6249 inferior. This is useful, for example, when you debug a program that
6250 forks and you want to hold the parent stopped (so that, for instance,
6251 it doesn't run to exit), while you debug the child. In other
6252 situations, you may not be interested in inspecting the current state
6253 of any of the processes @value{GDBN} is attached to, and you may want
6254 to resume them all until some breakpoint is hit. In the latter case,
6255 you can instruct @value{GDBN} to allow all threads of all the
6256 inferiors to run with the @w{@code{set schedule-multiple}} command.
6257
6258 @table @code
6259 @kindex set schedule-multiple
6260 @item set schedule-multiple
6261 Set the mode for allowing threads of multiple processes to be resumed
6262 when an execution command is issued. When @code{on}, all threads of
6263 all processes are allowed to run. When @code{off}, only the threads
6264 of the current process are resumed. The default is @code{off}. The
6265 @code{scheduler-locking} mode takes precedence when set to @code{on},
6266 or while you are stepping and set to @code{step}.
6267
6268 @item show schedule-multiple
6269 Display the current mode for resuming the execution of threads of
6270 multiple processes.
6271 @end table
6272
6273 @node Non-Stop Mode
6274 @subsection Non-Stop Mode
6275
6276 @cindex non-stop mode
6277
6278 @c This section is really only a place-holder, and needs to be expanded
6279 @c with more details.
6280
6281 For some multi-threaded targets, @value{GDBN} supports an optional
6282 mode of operation in which you can examine stopped program threads in
6283 the debugger while other threads continue to execute freely. This
6284 minimizes intrusion when debugging live systems, such as programs
6285 where some threads have real-time constraints or must continue to
6286 respond to external events. This is referred to as @dfn{non-stop} mode.
6287
6288 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops to report a debugging event,
6289 @emph{only} that thread is stopped; @value{GDBN} does not stop other
6290 threads as well, in contrast to the all-stop mode behavior. Additionally,
6291 execution commands such as @code{continue} and @code{step} apply by default
6292 only to the current thread in non-stop mode, rather than all threads as
6293 in all-stop mode. This allows you to control threads explicitly in
6294 ways that are not possible in all-stop mode --- for example, stepping
6295 one thread while allowing others to run freely, stepping
6296 one thread while holding all others stopped, or stepping several threads
6297 independently and simultaneously.
6298
6299 To enter non-stop mode, use this sequence of commands before you run
6300 or attach to your program:
6301
6302 @smallexample
6303 # If using the CLI, pagination breaks non-stop.
6304 set pagination off
6305
6306 # Finally, turn it on!
6307 set non-stop on
6308 @end smallexample
6309
6310 You can use these commands to manipulate the non-stop mode setting:
6311
6312 @table @code
6313 @kindex set non-stop
6314 @item set non-stop on
6315 Enable selection of non-stop mode.
6316 @item set non-stop off
6317 Disable selection of non-stop mode.
6318 @kindex show non-stop
6319 @item show non-stop
6320 Show the current non-stop enablement setting.
6321 @end table
6322
6323 Note these commands only reflect whether non-stop mode is enabled,
6324 not whether the currently-executing program is being run in non-stop mode.
6325 In particular, the @code{set non-stop} preference is only consulted when
6326 @value{GDBN} starts or connects to the target program, and it is generally
6327 not possible to switch modes once debugging has started. Furthermore,
6328 since not all targets support non-stop mode, even when you have enabled
6329 non-stop mode, @value{GDBN} may still fall back to all-stop operation by
6330 default.
6331
6332 In non-stop mode, all execution commands apply only to the current thread
6333 by default. That is, @code{continue} only continues one thread.
6334 To continue all threads, issue @code{continue -a} or @code{c -a}.
6335
6336 You can use @value{GDBN}'s background execution commands
6337 (@pxref{Background Execution}) to run some threads in the background
6338 while you continue to examine or step others from @value{GDBN}.
6339 The MI execution commands (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}) are
6340 always executed asynchronously in non-stop mode.
6341
6342 Suspending execution is done with the @code{interrupt} command when
6343 running in the background, or @kbd{Ctrl-c} during foreground execution.
6344 In all-stop mode, this stops the whole process;
6345 but in non-stop mode the interrupt applies only to the current thread.
6346 To stop the whole program, use @code{interrupt -a}.
6347
6348 Other execution commands do not currently support the @code{-a} option.
6349
6350 In non-stop mode, when a thread stops, @value{GDBN} doesn't automatically make
6351 that thread current, as it does in all-stop mode. This is because the
6352 thread stop notifications are asynchronous with respect to @value{GDBN}'s
6353 command interpreter, and it would be confusing if @value{GDBN} unexpectedly
6354 changed to a different thread just as you entered a command to operate on the
6355 previously current thread.
6356
6357 @node Background Execution
6358 @subsection Background Execution
6359
6360 @cindex foreground execution
6361 @cindex background execution
6362 @cindex asynchronous execution
6363 @cindex execution, foreground, background and asynchronous
6364
6365 @value{GDBN}'s execution commands have two variants: the normal
6366 foreground (synchronous) behavior, and a background
6367 (asynchronous) behavior. In foreground execution, @value{GDBN} waits for
6368 the program to report that some thread has stopped before prompting for
6369 another command. In background execution, @value{GDBN} immediately gives
6370 a command prompt so that you can issue other commands while your program runs.
6371
6372 If the target doesn't support async mode, @value{GDBN} issues an error
6373 message if you attempt to use the background execution commands.
6374
6375 @cindex @code{&}, background execution of commands
6376 To specify background execution, add a @code{&} to the command. For example,
6377 the background form of the @code{continue} command is @code{continue&}, or
6378 just @code{c&}. The execution commands that accept background execution
6379 are:
6380
6381 @table @code
6382 @kindex run&
6383 @item run
6384 @xref{Starting, , Starting your Program}.
6385
6386 @item attach
6387 @kindex attach&
6388 @xref{Attach, , Debugging an Already-running Process}.
6389
6390 @item step
6391 @kindex step&
6392 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, step}.
6393
6394 @item stepi
6395 @kindex stepi&
6396 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, stepi}.
6397
6398 @item next
6399 @kindex next&
6400 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, next}.
6401
6402 @item nexti
6403 @kindex nexti&
6404 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, nexti}.
6405
6406 @item continue
6407 @kindex continue&
6408 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, continue}.
6409
6410 @item finish
6411 @kindex finish&
6412 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, finish}.
6413
6414 @item until
6415 @kindex until&
6416 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, until}.
6417
6418 @end table
6419
6420 Background execution is especially useful in conjunction with non-stop
6421 mode for debugging programs with multiple threads; see @ref{Non-Stop Mode}.
6422 However, you can also use these commands in the normal all-stop mode with
6423 the restriction that you cannot issue another execution command until the
6424 previous one finishes. Examples of commands that are valid in all-stop
6425 mode while the program is running include @code{help} and @code{info break}.
6426
6427 You can interrupt your program while it is running in the background by
6428 using the @code{interrupt} command.
6429
6430 @table @code
6431 @kindex interrupt
6432 @item interrupt
6433 @itemx interrupt -a
6434
6435 Suspend execution of the running program. In all-stop mode,
6436 @code{interrupt} stops the whole process, but in non-stop mode, it stops
6437 only the current thread. To stop the whole program in non-stop mode,
6438 use @code{interrupt -a}.
6439 @end table
6440
6441 @node Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6442 @subsection Thread-Specific Breakpoints
6443
6444 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
6445 Programs with Multiple Threads}), you can choose whether to set
6446 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
6447
6448 @table @code
6449 @cindex breakpoints and threads
6450 @cindex thread breakpoints
6451 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{thread-id}
6452 @item break @var{location} thread @var{thread-id}
6453 @itemx break @var{location} thread @var{thread-id} if @dots{}
6454 @var{location} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
6455 writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always to
6456 specify some source line.
6457
6458 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} with a breakpoint command
6459 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
6460 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. The @var{thread-id} specifier
6461 is one of the thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown
6462 in the first column of the @samp{info threads} display.
6463
6464 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} when you set a
6465 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
6466 program.
6467
6468 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
6469 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{thread-id}} before or
6470 after the breakpoint condition, like this:
6471
6472 @smallexample
6473 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
6474 @end smallexample
6475
6476 @end table
6477
6478 Thread-specific breakpoints are automatically deleted when
6479 @value{GDBN} detects the corresponding thread is no longer in the
6480 thread list. For example:
6481
6482 @smallexample
6483 (@value{GDBP}) c
6484 Thread-specific breakpoint 3 deleted - thread 28 no longer in the thread list.
6485 @end smallexample
6486
6487 There are several ways for a thread to disappear, such as a regular
6488 thread exit, but also when you detach from the process with the
6489 @code{detach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running
6490 Process}), or if @value{GDBN} loses the remote connection
6491 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), etc. Note that with some targets,
6492 @value{GDBN} is only able to detect a thread has exited when the user
6493 explictly asks for the thread list with the @code{info threads}
6494 command.
6495
6496 @node Interrupted System Calls
6497 @subsection Interrupted System Calls
6498
6499 @cindex thread breakpoints and system calls
6500 @cindex system calls and thread breakpoints
6501 @cindex premature return from system calls
6502 There is an unfortunate side effect when using @value{GDBN} to debug
6503 multi-threaded programs. If one thread stops for a
6504 breakpoint, or for some other reason, and another thread is blocked in a
6505 system call, then the system call may return prematurely. This is a
6506 consequence of the interaction between multiple threads and the signals
6507 that @value{GDBN} uses to implement breakpoints and other events that
6508 stop execution.
6509
6510 To handle this problem, your program should check the return value of
6511 each system call and react appropriately. This is good programming
6512 style anyways.
6513
6514 For example, do not write code like this:
6515
6516 @smallexample
6517 sleep (10);
6518 @end smallexample
6519
6520 The call to @code{sleep} will return early if a different thread stops
6521 at a breakpoint or for some other reason.
6522
6523 Instead, write this:
6524
6525 @smallexample
6526 int unslept = 10;
6527 while (unslept > 0)
6528 unslept = sleep (unslept);
6529 @end smallexample
6530
6531 A system call is allowed to return early, so the system is still
6532 conforming to its specification. But @value{GDBN} does cause your
6533 multi-threaded program to behave differently than it would without
6534 @value{GDBN}.
6535
6536 Also, @value{GDBN} uses internal breakpoints in the thread library to
6537 monitor certain events such as thread creation and thread destruction.
6538 When such an event happens, a system call in another thread may return
6539 prematurely, even though your program does not appear to stop.
6540
6541 @node Observer Mode
6542 @subsection Observer Mode
6543
6544 If you want to build on non-stop mode and observe program behavior
6545 without any chance of disruption by @value{GDBN}, you can set
6546 variables to disable all of the debugger's attempts to modify state,
6547 whether by writing memory, inserting breakpoints, etc. These operate
6548 at a low level, intercepting operations from all commands.
6549
6550 When all of these are set to @code{off}, then @value{GDBN} is said to
6551 be @dfn{observer mode}. As a convenience, the variable
6552 @code{observer} can be set to disable these, plus enable non-stop
6553 mode.
6554
6555 Note that @value{GDBN} will not prevent you from making nonsensical
6556 combinations of these settings. For instance, if you have enabled
6557 @code{may-insert-breakpoints} but disabled @code{may-write-memory},
6558 then breakpoints that work by writing trap instructions into the code
6559 stream will still not be able to be placed.
6560
6561 @table @code
6562
6563 @kindex observer
6564 @item set observer on
6565 @itemx set observer off
6566 When set to @code{on}, this disables all the permission variables
6567 below (except for @code{insert-fast-tracepoints}), plus enables
6568 non-stop debugging. Setting this to @code{off} switches back to
6569 normal debugging, though remaining in non-stop mode.
6570
6571 @item show observer
6572 Show whether observer mode is on or off.
6573
6574 @kindex may-write-registers
6575 @item set may-write-registers on
6576 @itemx set may-write-registers off
6577 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the values of
6578 registers, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}, or the
6579 @code{jump} command. It defaults to @code{on}.
6580
6581 @item show may-write-registers
6582 Show the current permission to write registers.
6583
6584 @kindex may-write-memory
6585 @item set may-write-memory on
6586 @itemx set may-write-memory off
6587 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to alter the contents
6588 of memory, such as with assignment expressions in @code{print}. It
6589 defaults to @code{on}.
6590
6591 @item show may-write-memory
6592 Show the current permission to write memory.
6593
6594 @kindex may-insert-breakpoints
6595 @item set may-insert-breakpoints on
6596 @itemx set may-insert-breakpoints off
6597 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert breakpoints.
6598 This affects all breakpoints, including internal breakpoints defined
6599 by @value{GDBN}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6600
6601 @item show may-insert-breakpoints
6602 Show the current permission to insert breakpoints.
6603
6604 @kindex may-insert-tracepoints
6605 @item set may-insert-tracepoints on
6606 @itemx set may-insert-tracepoints off
6607 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert (regular)
6608 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6609 non-fast tracepoints, fast tracepoints being under the control of
6610 @code{may-insert-fast-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6611
6612 @item show may-insert-tracepoints
6613 Show the current permission to insert tracepoints.
6614
6615 @kindex may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6616 @item set may-insert-fast-tracepoints on
6617 @itemx set may-insert-fast-tracepoints off
6618 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to insert fast
6619 tracepoints at the beginning of a tracing experiment. It affects only
6620 fast tracepoints, regular (non-fast) tracepoints being under the
6621 control of @code{may-insert-tracepoints}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6622
6623 @item show may-insert-fast-tracepoints
6624 Show the current permission to insert fast tracepoints.
6625
6626 @kindex may-interrupt
6627 @item set may-interrupt on
6628 @itemx set may-interrupt off
6629 This controls whether @value{GDBN} will attempt to interrupt or stop
6630 program execution. When this variable is @code{off}, the
6631 @code{interrupt} command will have no effect, nor will
6632 @kbd{Ctrl-c}. It defaults to @code{on}.
6633
6634 @item show may-interrupt
6635 Show the current permission to interrupt or stop the program.
6636
6637 @end table
6638
6639 @node Reverse Execution
6640 @chapter Running programs backward
6641 @cindex reverse execution
6642 @cindex running programs backward
6643
6644 When you are debugging a program, it is not unusual to realize that
6645 you have gone too far, and some event of interest has already happened.
6646 If the target environment supports it, @value{GDBN} can allow you to
6647 ``rewind'' the program by running it backward.
6648
6649 A target environment that supports reverse execution should be able
6650 to ``undo'' the changes in machine state that have taken place as the
6651 program was executing normally. Variables, registers etc.@: should
6652 revert to their previous values. Obviously this requires a great
6653 deal of sophistication on the part of the target environment; not
6654 all target environments can support reverse execution.
6655
6656 When a program is executed in reverse, the instructions that
6657 have most recently been executed are ``un-executed'', in reverse
6658 order. The program counter runs backward, following the previous
6659 thread of execution in reverse. As each instruction is ``un-executed'',
6660 the values of memory and/or registers that were changed by that
6661 instruction are reverted to their previous states. After executing
6662 a piece of source code in reverse, all side effects of that code
6663 should be ``undone'', and all variables should be returned to their
6664 prior values@footnote{
6665 Note that some side effects are easier to undo than others. For instance,
6666 memory and registers are relatively easy, but device I/O is hard. Some
6667 targets may be able undo things like device I/O, and some may not.
6668
6669 The contract between @value{GDBN} and the reverse executing target
6670 requires only that the target do something reasonable when
6671 @value{GDBN} tells it to execute backwards, and then report the
6672 results back to @value{GDBN}. Whatever the target reports back to
6673 @value{GDBN}, @value{GDBN} will report back to the user. @value{GDBN}
6674 assumes that the memory and registers that the target reports are in a
6675 consistant state, but @value{GDBN} accepts whatever it is given.
6676 }.
6677
6678 If you are debugging in a target environment that supports
6679 reverse execution, @value{GDBN} provides the following commands.
6680
6681 @table @code
6682 @kindex reverse-continue
6683 @kindex rc @r{(@code{reverse-continue})}
6684 @item reverse-continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6685 @itemx rc @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
6686 Beginning at the point where your program last stopped, start executing
6687 in reverse. Reverse execution will stop for breakpoints and synchronous
6688 exceptions (signals), just like normal execution. Behavior of
6689 asynchronous signals depends on the target environment.
6690
6691 @kindex reverse-step
6692 @kindex rs @r{(@code{step})}
6693 @item reverse-step @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6694 Run the program backward until control reaches the start of a
6695 different source line; then stop it, and return control to @value{GDBN}.
6696
6697 Like the @code{step} command, @code{reverse-step} will only stop
6698 at the beginning of a source line. It ``un-executes'' the previously
6699 executed source line. If the previous source line included calls to
6700 debuggable functions, @code{reverse-step} will step (backward) into
6701 the called function, stopping at the beginning of the @emph{last}
6702 statement in the called function (typically a return statement).
6703
6704 Also, as with the @code{step} command, if non-debuggable functions are
6705 called, @code{reverse-step} will run thru them backward without stopping.
6706
6707 @kindex reverse-stepi
6708 @kindex rsi @r{(@code{reverse-stepi})}
6709 @item reverse-stepi @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6710 Reverse-execute one machine instruction. Note that the instruction
6711 to be reverse-executed is @emph{not} the one pointed to by the program
6712 counter, but the instruction executed prior to that one. For instance,
6713 if the last instruction was a jump, @code{reverse-stepi} will take you
6714 back from the destination of the jump to the jump instruction itself.
6715
6716 @kindex reverse-next
6717 @kindex rn @r{(@code{reverse-next})}
6718 @item reverse-next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6719 Run backward to the beginning of the previous line executed in
6720 the current (innermost) stack frame. If the line contains function
6721 calls, they will be ``un-executed'' without stopping. Starting from
6722 the first line of a function, @code{reverse-next} will take you back
6723 to the caller of that function, @emph{before} the function was called,
6724 just as the normal @code{next} command would take you from the last
6725 line of a function back to its return to its caller
6726 @footnote{Unless the code is too heavily optimized.}.
6727
6728 @kindex reverse-nexti
6729 @kindex rni @r{(@code{reverse-nexti})}
6730 @item reverse-nexti @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
6731 Like @code{nexti}, @code{reverse-nexti} executes a single instruction
6732 in reverse, except that called functions are ``un-executed'' atomically.
6733 That is, if the previously executed instruction was a return from
6734 another function, @code{reverse-nexti} will continue to execute
6735 in reverse until the call to that function (from the current stack
6736 frame) is reached.
6737
6738 @kindex reverse-finish
6739 @item reverse-finish
6740 Just as the @code{finish} command takes you to the point where the
6741 current function returns, @code{reverse-finish} takes you to the point
6742 where it was called. Instead of ending up at the end of the current
6743 function invocation, you end up at the beginning.
6744
6745 @kindex set exec-direction
6746 @item set exec-direction
6747 Set the direction of target execution.
6748 @item set exec-direction reverse
6749 @cindex execute forward or backward in time
6750 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in reverse, until the
6751 exec-direction mode is changed to ``forward''. Affected commands include
6752 @code{step, stepi, next, nexti, continue, and finish}. The @code{return}
6753 command cannot be used in reverse mode.
6754 @item set exec-direction forward
6755 @value{GDBN} will perform all execution commands in the normal fashion.
6756 This is the default.
6757 @end table
6758
6759
6760 @node Process Record and Replay
6761 @chapter Recording Inferior's Execution and Replaying It
6762 @cindex process record and replay
6763 @cindex recording inferior's execution and replaying it
6764
6765 On some platforms, @value{GDBN} provides a special @dfn{process record
6766 and replay} target that can record a log of the process execution, and
6767 replay it later with both forward and reverse execution commands.
6768
6769 @cindex replay mode
6770 When this target is in use, if the execution log includes the record
6771 for the next instruction, @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{replay
6772 mode}. In the replay mode, the inferior does not really execute code
6773 instructions. Instead, all the events that normally happen during
6774 code execution are taken from the execution log. While code is not
6775 really executed in replay mode, the values of registers (including the
6776 program counter register) and the memory of the inferior are still
6777 changed as they normally would. Their contents are taken from the
6778 execution log.
6779
6780 @cindex record mode
6781 If the record for the next instruction is not in the execution log,
6782 @value{GDBN} will debug in @dfn{record mode}. In this mode, the
6783 inferior executes normally, and @value{GDBN} records the execution log
6784 for future replay.
6785
6786 The process record and replay target supports reverse execution
6787 (@pxref{Reverse Execution}), even if the platform on which the
6788 inferior runs does not. However, the reverse execution is limited in
6789 this case by the range of the instructions recorded in the execution
6790 log. In other words, reverse execution on platforms that don't
6791 support it directly can only be done in the replay mode.
6792
6793 When debugging in the reverse direction, @value{GDBN} will work in
6794 replay mode as long as the execution log includes the record for the
6795 previous instruction; otherwise, it will work in record mode, if the
6796 platform supports reverse execution, or stop if not.
6797
6798 For architecture environments that support process record and replay,
6799 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands:
6800
6801 @table @code
6802 @kindex target record
6803 @kindex target record-full
6804 @kindex target record-btrace
6805 @kindex record
6806 @kindex record full
6807 @kindex record btrace
6808 @kindex record btrace bts
6809 @kindex record btrace pt
6810 @kindex record bts
6811 @kindex record pt
6812 @kindex rec
6813 @kindex rec full
6814 @kindex rec btrace
6815 @kindex rec btrace bts
6816 @kindex rec btrace pt
6817 @kindex rec bts
6818 @kindex rec pt
6819 @item record @var{method}
6820 This command starts the process record and replay target. The
6821 recording method can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6822 the command uses the @code{full} recording method. The following
6823 recording methods are available:
6824
6825 @table @code
6826 @item full
6827 Full record/replay recording using @value{GDBN}'s software record and
6828 replay implementation. This method allows replaying and reverse
6829 execution.
6830
6831 @item btrace @var{format}
6832 Hardware-supported instruction recording. This method does not record
6833 data. Further, the data is collected in a ring buffer so old data will
6834 be overwritten when the buffer is full. It allows limited reverse
6835 execution. Variables and registers are not available during reverse
6836 execution. In remote debugging, recording continues on disconnect.
6837 Recorded data can be inspected after reconnecting. The recording may
6838 be stopped using @code{record stop}.
6839
6840 The recording format can be specified as parameter. Without a parameter
6841 the command chooses the recording format. The following recording
6842 formats are available:
6843
6844 @table @code
6845 @item bts
6846 @cindex branch trace store
6847 Use the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) recording format. In
6848 this format, the processor stores a from/to record for each executed
6849 branch in the btrace ring buffer.
6850
6851 @item pt
6852 @cindex Intel Processor Trace
6853 Use the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} recording format. In this
6854 format, the processor stores the execution trace in a compressed form
6855 that is afterwards decoded by @value{GDBN}.
6856
6857 The trace can be recorded with very low overhead. The compressed
6858 trace format also allows small trace buffers to already contain a big
6859 number of instructions compared to @acronym{BTS}.
6860
6861 Decoding the recorded execution trace, on the other hand, is more
6862 expensive than decoding @acronym{BTS} trace. This is mostly due to the
6863 increased number of instructions to process. You should increase the
6864 buffer-size with care.
6865 @end table
6866
6867 Not all recording formats may be available on all processors.
6868 @end table
6869
6870 The process record and replay target can only debug a process that is
6871 already running. Therefore, you need first to start the process with
6872 the @kbd{run} or @kbd{start} commands, and then start the recording
6873 with the @kbd{record @var{method}} command.
6874
6875 @cindex displaced stepping, and process record and replay
6876 Displaced stepping (@pxref{Maintenance Commands,, displaced stepping})
6877 will be automatically disabled when process record and replay target
6878 is started. That's because the process record and replay target
6879 doesn't support displaced stepping.
6880
6881 @cindex non-stop mode, and process record and replay
6882 @cindex asynchronous execution, and process record and replay
6883 If the inferior is in the non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) or in
6884 the asynchronous execution mode (@pxref{Background Execution}), not
6885 all recording methods are available. The @code{full} recording method
6886 does not support these two modes.
6887
6888 @kindex record stop
6889 @kindex rec s
6890 @item record stop
6891 Stop the process record and replay target. When process record and
6892 replay target stops, the entire execution log will be deleted and the
6893 inferior will either be terminated, or will remain in its final state.
6894
6895 When you stop the process record and replay target in record mode (at
6896 the end of the execution log), the inferior will be stopped at the
6897 next instruction that would have been recorded. In other words, if
6898 you record for a while and then stop recording, the inferior process
6899 will be left in the same state as if the recording never happened.
6900
6901 On the other hand, if the process record and replay target is stopped
6902 while in replay mode (that is, not at the end of the execution log,
6903 but at some earlier point), the inferior process will become ``live''
6904 at that earlier state, and it will then be possible to continue the
6905 usual ``live'' debugging of the process from that state.
6906
6907 When the inferior process exits, or @value{GDBN} detaches from it,
6908 process record and replay target will automatically stop itself.
6909
6910 @kindex record goto
6911 @item record goto
6912 Go to a specific location in the execution log. There are several
6913 ways to specify the location to go to:
6914
6915 @table @code
6916 @item record goto begin
6917 @itemx record goto start
6918 Go to the beginning of the execution log.
6919
6920 @item record goto end
6921 Go to the end of the execution log.
6922
6923 @item record goto @var{n}
6924 Go to instruction number @var{n} in the execution log.
6925 @end table
6926
6927 @kindex record save
6928 @item record save @var{filename}
6929 Save the execution log to a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6930 Default filename is @file{gdb_record.@var{process_id}}, where
6931 @var{process_id} is the process ID of the inferior.
6932
6933 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
6934
6935 @kindex record restore
6936 @item record restore @var{filename}
6937 Restore the execution log from a file @file{@var{filename}}.
6938 File must have been created with @code{record save}.
6939
6940 @kindex set record full
6941 @item set record full insn-number-max @var{limit}
6942 @itemx set record full insn-number-max unlimited
6943 Set the limit of instructions to be recorded for the @code{full}
6944 recording method. Default value is 200000.
6945
6946 If @var{limit} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will start
6947 deleting instructions from the log once the number of the record
6948 instructions becomes greater than @var{limit}. For every new recorded
6949 instruction, @value{GDBN} will delete the earliest recorded
6950 instruction to keep the number of recorded instructions at the limit.
6951 (Since deleting recorded instructions loses information, @value{GDBN}
6952 lets you control what happens when the limit is reached, by means of
6953 the @code{stop-at-limit} option, described below.)
6954
6955 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will never
6956 delete recorded instructions from the execution log. The number of
6957 recorded instructions is limited only by the available memory.
6958
6959 @kindex show record full
6960 @item show record full insn-number-max
6961 Show the limit of instructions to be recorded with the @code{full}
6962 recording method.
6963
6964 @item set record full stop-at-limit
6965 Control the behavior of the @code{full} recording method when the
6966 number of recorded instructions reaches the limit. If ON (the
6967 default), @value{GDBN} will stop when the limit is reached for the
6968 first time and ask you whether you want to stop the inferior or
6969 continue running it and recording the execution log. If you decide
6970 to continue recording, each new recorded instruction will cause the
6971 oldest one to be deleted.
6972
6973 If this option is OFF, @value{GDBN} will automatically delete the
6974 oldest record to make room for each new one, without asking.
6975
6976 @item show record full stop-at-limit
6977 Show the current setting of @code{stop-at-limit}.
6978
6979 @item set record full memory-query
6980 Control the behavior when @value{GDBN} is unable to record memory
6981 changes caused by an instruction for the @code{full} recording method.
6982 If ON, @value{GDBN} will query whether to stop the inferior in that
6983 case.
6984
6985 If this option is OFF (the default), @value{GDBN} will automatically
6986 ignore the effect of such instructions on memory. Later, when
6987 @value{GDBN} replays this execution log, it will mark the log of this
6988 instruction as not accessible, and it will not affect the replay
6989 results.
6990
6991 @item show record full memory-query
6992 Show the current setting of @code{memory-query}.
6993
6994 @kindex set record btrace
6995 The @code{btrace} record target does not trace data. As a
6996 convenience, when replaying, @value{GDBN} reads read-only memory off
6997 the live program directly, assuming that the addresses of the
6998 read-only areas don't change. This for example makes it possible to
6999 disassemble code while replaying, but not to print variables.
7000 In some cases, being able to inspect variables might be useful.
7001 You can use the following command for that:
7002
7003 @item set record btrace replay-memory-access
7004 Control the behavior of the @code{btrace} recording method when
7005 accessing memory during replay. If @code{read-only} (the default),
7006 @value{GDBN} will only allow accesses to read-only memory.
7007 If @code{read-write}, @value{GDBN} will allow accesses to read-only
7008 and to read-write memory. Beware that the accessed memory corresponds
7009 to the live target and not necessarily to the current replay
7010 position.
7011
7012 @item set record btrace cpu @var{identifier}
7013 Set the processor to be used for enabling workarounds for processor
7014 errata when decoding the trace.
7015
7016 Processor errata are defects in processor operation, caused by its
7017 design or manufacture. They can cause a trace not to match the
7018 specification. This, in turn, may cause trace decode to fail.
7019 @value{GDBN} can detect erroneous trace packets and correct them, thus
7020 avoiding the decoding failures. These corrections are known as
7021 @dfn{errata workarounds}, and are enabled based on the processor on
7022 which the trace was recorded.
7023
7024 By default, @value{GDBN} attempts to detect the processor
7025 automatically, and apply the necessary workarounds for it. However,
7026 you may need to specify the processor if @value{GDBN} does not yet
7027 support it. This command allows you to do that, and also allows to
7028 disable the workarounds.
7029
7030 The argument @var{identifier} identifies the @sc{cpu} and is of the
7031 form: @code{@var{vendor}:@var{procesor identifier}}. In addition,
7032 there are two special identifiers, @code{none} and @code{auto}
7033 (default).
7034
7035 The following vendor identifiers and corresponding processor
7036 identifiers are currently supported:
7037
7038 @multitable @columnfractions .1 .9
7039
7040 @item @code{intel}
7041 @tab @var{family}/@var{model}[/@var{stepping}]
7042
7043 @end multitable
7044
7045 On GNU/Linux systems, the processor @var{family}, @var{model}, and
7046 @var{stepping} can be obtained from @code{/proc/cpuinfo}.
7047
7048 If @var{identifier} is @code{auto}, enable errata workarounds for the
7049 processor on which the trace was recorded. If @var{identifier} is
7050 @code{none}, errata workarounds are disabled.
7051
7052 For example, when using an old @value{GDBN} on a new system, decode
7053 may fail because @value{GDBN} does not support the new processor. It
7054 often suffices to specify an older processor that @value{GDBN}
7055 supports.
7056
7057 @smallexample
7058 (gdb) info record
7059 Active record target: record-btrace
7060 Recording format: Intel Processor Trace.
7061 Buffer size: 16kB.
7062 Failed to configure the Intel Processor Trace decoder: unknown cpu.
7063 (gdb) set record btrace cpu intel:6/158
7064 (gdb) info record
7065 Active record target: record-btrace
7066 Recording format: Intel Processor Trace.
7067 Buffer size: 16kB.
7068 Recorded 84872 instructions in 3189 functions (0 gaps) for thread 1 (...).
7069 @end smallexample
7070
7071 @kindex show record btrace
7072 @item show record btrace replay-memory-access
7073 Show the current setting of @code{replay-memory-access}.
7074
7075 @item show record btrace cpu
7076 Show the processor to be used for enabling trace decode errata
7077 workarounds.
7078
7079 @kindex set record btrace bts
7080 @item set record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
7081 @itemx set record btrace bts buffer-size unlimited
7082 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in @acronym{BTS}
7083 format. Default is 64KB.
7084
7085 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
7086 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
7087 that uses the btrace recording method and the @acronym{BTS} format.
7088 The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the requested
7089 @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the actual
7090 buffer size for each thread that uses the btrace recording method and
7091 the @acronym{BTS} format.
7092
7093 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
7094 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
7095
7096 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
7097 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
7098
7099 @item show record btrace bts buffer-size @var{size}
7100 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
7101 tracing in @acronym{BTS} format.
7102
7103 @kindex set record btrace pt
7104 @item set record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
7105 @itemx set record btrace pt buffer-size unlimited
7106 Set the requested ring buffer size for branch tracing in Intel
7107 Processor Trace format. Default is 16KB.
7108
7109 If @var{size} is a positive number, then @value{GDBN} will try to
7110 allocate a buffer of at least @var{size} bytes for each new thread
7111 that uses the btrace recording method and the Intel Processor Trace
7112 format. The actually obtained buffer size may differ from the
7113 requested @var{size}. Use the @code{info record} command to see the
7114 actual buffer size for each thread.
7115
7116 If @var{limit} is @code{unlimited} or zero, @value{GDBN} will try to
7117 allocate a buffer of 4MB.
7118
7119 Bigger buffers mean longer traces. On the other hand, @value{GDBN} will
7120 also need longer to process the branch trace data before it can be used.
7121
7122 @item show record btrace pt buffer-size @var{size}
7123 Show the current setting of the requested ring buffer size for branch
7124 tracing in Intel Processor Trace format.
7125
7126 @kindex info record
7127 @item info record
7128 Show various statistics about the recording depending on the recording
7129 method:
7130
7131 @table @code
7132 @item full
7133 For the @code{full} recording method, it shows the state of process
7134 record and its in-memory execution log buffer, including:
7135
7136 @itemize @bullet
7137 @item
7138 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
7139 @item
7140 Lowest recorded instruction number (counting from when the current execution log started recording instructions).
7141 @item
7142 Highest recorded instruction number.
7143 @item
7144 Current instruction about to be replayed (if in replay mode).
7145 @item
7146 Number of instructions contained in the execution log.
7147 @item
7148 Maximum number of instructions that may be contained in the execution log.
7149 @end itemize
7150
7151 @item btrace
7152 For the @code{btrace} recording method, it shows:
7153
7154 @itemize @bullet
7155 @item
7156 Recording format.
7157 @item
7158 Number of instructions that have been recorded.
7159 @item
7160 Number of blocks of sequential control-flow formed by the recorded
7161 instructions.
7162 @item
7163 Whether in record mode or replay mode.
7164 @end itemize
7165
7166 For the @code{bts} recording format, it also shows:
7167 @itemize @bullet
7168 @item
7169 Size of the perf ring buffer.
7170 @end itemize
7171
7172 For the @code{pt} recording format, it also shows:
7173 @itemize @bullet
7174 @item
7175 Size of the perf ring buffer.
7176 @end itemize
7177 @end table
7178
7179 @kindex record delete
7180 @kindex rec del
7181 @item record delete
7182 When record target runs in replay mode (``in the past''), delete the
7183 subsequent execution log and begin to record a new execution log starting
7184 from the current address. This means you will abandon the previously
7185 recorded ``future'' and begin recording a new ``future''.
7186
7187 @kindex record instruction-history
7188 @kindex rec instruction-history
7189 @item record instruction-history
7190 Disassembles instructions from the recorded execution log. By
7191 default, ten instructions are disassembled. This can be changed using
7192 the @code{set record instruction-history-size} command. Instructions
7193 are printed in execution order.
7194
7195 It can also print mixed source+disassembly if you specify the the
7196 @code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier, and print the raw instructions in hex
7197 as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier.
7198
7199 The current position marker is printed for the instruction at the
7200 current program counter value. This instruction can appear multiple
7201 times in the trace and the current position marker will be printed
7202 every time. To omit the current position marker, specify the
7203 @code{/p} modifier.
7204
7205 To better align the printed instructions when the trace contains
7206 instructions from more than one function, the function name may be
7207 omitted by specifying the @code{/f} modifier.
7208
7209 Speculatively executed instructions are prefixed with @samp{?}. This
7210 feature is not available for all recording formats.
7211
7212 There are several ways to specify what part of the execution log to
7213 disassemble:
7214
7215 @table @code
7216 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}
7217 Disassembles ten instructions starting from instruction number
7218 @var{insn}.
7219
7220 @item record instruction-history @var{insn}, +/-@var{n}
7221 Disassembles @var{n} instructions around instruction number
7222 @var{insn}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, disassembles
7223 @var{n} instructions after instruction number @var{insn}. If
7224 @var{n} is preceded with @code{-}, disassembles @var{n}
7225 instructions before instruction number @var{insn}.
7226
7227 @item record instruction-history
7228 Disassembles ten more instructions after the last disassembly.
7229
7230 @item record instruction-history -
7231 Disassembles ten more instructions before the last disassembly.
7232
7233 @item record instruction-history @var{begin}, @var{end}
7234 Disassembles instructions beginning with instruction number
7235 @var{begin} until instruction number @var{end}. The instruction
7236 number @var{end} is included.
7237 @end table
7238
7239 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
7240
7241 @kindex set record
7242 @item set record instruction-history-size @var{size}
7243 @itemx set record instruction-history-size unlimited
7244 Define how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
7245 instruction-history} command. The default value is 10.
7246 A @var{size} of @code{unlimited} means unlimited instructions.
7247
7248 @kindex show record
7249 @item show record instruction-history-size
7250 Show how many instructions to disassemble in the @code{record
7251 instruction-history} command.
7252
7253 @kindex record function-call-history
7254 @kindex rec function-call-history
7255 @item record function-call-history
7256 Prints the execution history at function granularity. It prints one
7257 line for each sequence of instructions that belong to the same
7258 function giving the name of that function, the source lines
7259 for this instruction sequence (if the @code{/l} modifier is
7260 specified), and the instructions numbers that form the sequence (if
7261 the @code{/i} modifier is specified). The function names are indented
7262 to reflect the call stack depth if the @code{/c} modifier is
7263 specified. The @code{/l}, @code{/i}, and @code{/c} modifiers can be
7264 given together.
7265
7266 @smallexample
7267 (@value{GDBP}) @b{list 1, 10}
7268 1 void foo (void)
7269 2 @{
7270 3 @}
7271 4
7272 5 void bar (void)
7273 6 @{
7274 7 ...
7275 8 foo ();
7276 9 ...
7277 10 @}
7278 (@value{GDBP}) @b{record function-call-history /ilc}
7279 1 bar inst 1,4 at foo.c:6,8
7280 2 foo inst 5,10 at foo.c:2,3
7281 3 bar inst 11,13 at foo.c:9,10
7282 @end smallexample
7283
7284 By default, ten lines are printed. This can be changed using the
7285 @code{set record function-call-history-size} command. Functions are
7286 printed in execution order. There are several ways to specify what
7287 to print:
7288
7289 @table @code
7290 @item record function-call-history @var{func}
7291 Prints ten functions starting from function number @var{func}.
7292
7293 @item record function-call-history @var{func}, +/-@var{n}
7294 Prints @var{n} functions around function number @var{func}. If
7295 @var{n} is preceded with @code{+}, prints @var{n} functions after
7296 function number @var{func}. If @var{n} is preceded with @code{-},
7297 prints @var{n} functions before function number @var{func}.
7298
7299 @item record function-call-history
7300 Prints ten more functions after the last ten-line print.
7301
7302 @item record function-call-history -
7303 Prints ten more functions before the last ten-line print.
7304
7305 @item record function-call-history @var{begin}, @var{end}
7306 Prints functions beginning with function number @var{begin} until
7307 function number @var{end}. The function number @var{end} is included.
7308 @end table
7309
7310 This command may not be available for all recording methods.
7311
7312 @item set record function-call-history-size @var{size}
7313 @itemx set record function-call-history-size unlimited
7314 Define how many lines to print in the
7315 @code{record function-call-history} command. The default value is 10.
7316 A size of @code{unlimited} means unlimited lines.
7317
7318 @item show record function-call-history-size
7319 Show how many lines to print in the
7320 @code{record function-call-history} command.
7321 @end table
7322
7323
7324 @node Stack
7325 @chapter Examining the Stack
7326
7327 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
7328 stopped and how it got there.
7329
7330 @cindex call stack
7331 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
7332 is generated.
7333 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
7334 the arguments of the call,
7335 and the local variables of the function being called.
7336 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
7337 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
7338 stack}.
7339
7340 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
7341 stack allow you to see all of this information.
7342
7343 @cindex selected frame
7344 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
7345 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
7346 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
7347 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
7348 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
7349 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7350
7351 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
7352 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
7353 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}).
7354
7355 @menu
7356 * Frames:: Stack frames
7357 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
7358 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
7359 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
7360 * Frame Apply:: Applying a command to several frames
7361 * Frame Filter Management:: Managing frame filters
7362
7363 @end menu
7364
7365 @node Frames
7366 @section Stack Frames
7367
7368 @cindex frame, definition
7369 @cindex stack frame
7370 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
7371 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
7372 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
7373 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
7374 which the function is executing.
7375
7376 @cindex initial frame
7377 @cindex outermost frame
7378 @cindex innermost frame
7379 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
7380 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
7381 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
7382 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
7383 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
7384 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
7385 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
7386 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
7387
7388 @cindex frame pointer
7389 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
7390 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
7391 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
7392 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
7393 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register}
7394 (@pxref{Registers, $fp}) while execution is going on in that frame.
7395
7396 @cindex frame number
7397 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
7398 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
7399 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
7400 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
7401 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
7402
7403 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
7404 @c underflow problems.
7405 @cindex frameless execution
7406 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
7407 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{NGCC} option
7408 @smallexample
7409 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
7410 @end smallexample
7411 generates functions without a frame.)
7412 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
7413 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
7414 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
7415 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
7416 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
7417 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
7418 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
7419
7420 @node Backtrace
7421 @section Backtraces
7422
7423 @cindex traceback
7424 @cindex call stack traces
7425 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
7426 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
7427 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
7428 stack.
7429
7430 @anchor{backtrace-command}
7431 @kindex backtrace
7432 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
7433 To print a backtrace of the entire stack, use the @code{backtrace}
7434 command, or its alias @code{bt}. This command will print one line per
7435 frame for frames in the stack. By default, all stack frames are
7436 printed. You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system
7437 interrupt character, normally @kbd{Ctrl-c}.
7438
7439 @table @code
7440 @item backtrace [@var{args}@dots{}]
7441 @itemx bt [@var{args}@dots{}]
7442 Print the backtrace of the entire stack. The optional @var{args} can
7443 be one of the following:
7444
7445 @table @code
7446 @item @var{n}
7447 @itemx @var{n}
7448 Print only the innermost @var{n} frames, where @var{n} is a positive
7449 number.
7450
7451 @item -@var{n}
7452 @itemx -@var{n}
7453 Print only the outermost @var{n} frames, where @var{n} is a positive
7454 number.
7455
7456 @item full
7457 Print the values of the local variables also. This can be combined
7458 with a number to limit the number of frames shown.
7459
7460 @item no-filters
7461 Do not run Python frame filters on this backtrace. @xref{Frame
7462 Filter API}, for more information. Additionally use @ref{disable
7463 frame-filter all} to turn off all frame filters. This is only
7464 relevant when @value{GDBN} has been configured with @code{Python}
7465 support.
7466
7467 @item hide
7468 A Python frame filter might decide to ``elide'' some frames. Normally
7469 such elided frames are still printed, but they are indented relative
7470 to the filtered frames that cause them to be elided. The @code{hide}
7471 option causes elided frames to not be printed at all.
7472 @end table
7473 @end table
7474
7475 @kindex where
7476 @kindex info stack
7477 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
7478 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
7479
7480 @cindex multiple threads, backtrace
7481 In a multi-threaded program, @value{GDBN} by default shows the
7482 backtrace only for the current thread. To display the backtrace for
7483 several or all of the threads, use the command @code{thread apply}
7484 (@pxref{Threads, thread apply}). For example, if you type @kbd{thread
7485 apply all backtrace}, @value{GDBN} will display the backtrace for all
7486 the threads; this is handy when you debug a core dump of a
7487 multi-threaded program.
7488
7489 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
7490 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
7491 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
7492 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
7493 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
7494 line number.
7495
7496 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
7497 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
7498
7499 @smallexample
7500 @group
7501 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7502 at builtin.c:993
7503 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600, data=...) at macro.c:242
7504 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
7505 at macro.c:71
7506 (More stack frames follow...)
7507 @end group
7508 @end smallexample
7509
7510 @noindent
7511 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
7512 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
7513 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
7514
7515 @noindent
7516 The value of parameter @code{data} in frame 1 has been replaced by
7517 @code{@dots{}}. By default, @value{GDBN} prints the value of a parameter
7518 only if it is a scalar (integer, pointer, enumeration, etc). See command
7519 @kbd{set print frame-arguments} in @ref{Print Settings} for more details
7520 on how to configure the way function parameter values are printed.
7521
7522 @cindex optimized out, in backtrace
7523 @cindex function call arguments, optimized out
7524 If your program was compiled with optimizations, some compilers will
7525 optimize away arguments passed to functions if those arguments are
7526 never used after the call. Such optimizations generate code that
7527 passes arguments through registers, but doesn't store those arguments
7528 in the stack frame. @value{GDBN} has no way of displaying such
7529 arguments in stack frames other than the innermost one. Here's what
7530 such a backtrace might look like:
7531
7532 @smallexample
7533 @group
7534 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
7535 at builtin.c:993
7536 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=<optimized out>) at macro.c:242
7537 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=<optimized out>, td=0xf7fffb08)
7538 at macro.c:71
7539 (More stack frames follow...)
7540 @end group
7541 @end smallexample
7542
7543 @noindent
7544 The values of arguments that were not saved in their stack frames are
7545 shown as @samp{<optimized out>}.
7546
7547 If you need to display the values of such optimized-out arguments,
7548 either deduce that from other variables whose values depend on the one
7549 you are interested in, or recompile without optimizations.
7550
7551 @cindex backtrace beyond @code{main} function
7552 @cindex program entry point
7553 @cindex startup code, and backtrace
7554 Most programs have a standard user entry point---a place where system
7555 libraries and startup code transition into user code. For C this is
7556 @code{main}@footnote{
7557 Note that embedded programs (the so-called ``free-standing''
7558 environment) are not required to have a @code{main} function as the
7559 entry point. They could even have multiple entry points.}.
7560 When @value{GDBN} finds the entry function in a backtrace
7561 it will terminate the backtrace, to avoid tracing into highly
7562 system-specific (and generally uninteresting) code.
7563
7564 If you need to examine the startup code, or limit the number of levels
7565 in a backtrace, you can change this behavior:
7566
7567 @table @code
7568 @item set backtrace past-main
7569 @itemx set backtrace past-main on
7570 @kindex set backtrace
7571 Backtraces will continue past the user entry point.
7572
7573 @item set backtrace past-main off
7574 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the user entry point. This is the
7575 default.
7576
7577 @item show backtrace past-main
7578 @kindex show backtrace
7579 Display the current user entry point backtrace policy.
7580
7581 @item set backtrace past-entry
7582 @itemx set backtrace past-entry on
7583 Backtraces will continue past the internal entry point of an application.
7584 This entry point is encoded by the linker when the application is built,
7585 and is likely before the user entry point @code{main} (or equivalent) is called.
7586
7587 @item set backtrace past-entry off
7588 Backtraces will stop when they encounter the internal entry point of an
7589 application. This is the default.
7590
7591 @item show backtrace past-entry
7592 Display the current internal entry point backtrace policy.
7593
7594 @item set backtrace limit @var{n}
7595 @itemx set backtrace limit 0
7596 @itemx set backtrace limit unlimited
7597 @cindex backtrace limit
7598 Limit the backtrace to @var{n} levels. A value of @code{unlimited}
7599 or zero means unlimited levels.
7600
7601 @item show backtrace limit
7602 Display the current limit on backtrace levels.
7603 @end table
7604
7605 You can control how file names are displayed.
7606
7607 @table @code
7608 @item set filename-display
7609 @itemx set filename-display relative
7610 @cindex filename-display
7611 Display file names relative to the compilation directory. This is the default.
7612
7613 @item set filename-display basename
7614 Display only basename of a filename.
7615
7616 @item set filename-display absolute
7617 Display an absolute filename.
7618
7619 @item show filename-display
7620 Show the current way to display filenames.
7621 @end table
7622
7623 @node Selection
7624 @section Selecting a Frame
7625
7626 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
7627 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
7628 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
7629 of the stack frame just selected.
7630
7631 @table @code
7632 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
7633 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
7634 @item frame @var{n}
7635 @itemx f @var{n}
7636 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
7637 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
7638 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
7639 @code{main}.
7640
7641 @item frame @var{stack-addr} [ @var{pc-addr} ]
7642 @itemx f @var{stack-addr} [ @var{pc-addr} ]
7643 Select the frame at address @var{stack-addr}. This is useful mainly if the
7644 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
7645 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
7646 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
7647 switches between them. The optional @var{pc-addr} can also be given to
7648 specify the value of PC for the stack frame.
7649
7650 @kindex up
7651 @item up @var{n}
7652 Move @var{n} frames up the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For positive
7653 numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the outermost frame, to higher
7654 frame numbers, to frames that have existed longer.
7655
7656 @kindex down
7657 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
7658 @item down @var{n}
7659 Move @var{n} frames down the stack; @var{n} defaults to 1. For
7660 positive numbers @var{n}, this advances toward the innermost frame, to
7661 lower frame numbers, to frames that were created more recently.
7662 You may abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
7663 @end table
7664
7665 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
7666 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
7667 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
7668 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
7669
7670 @need 1000
7671 For example:
7672
7673 @smallexample
7674 @group
7675 (@value{GDBP}) up
7676 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
7677 at env.c:10
7678 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
7679 @end group
7680 @end smallexample
7681
7682 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
7683 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
7684 You can also edit the program at the point of execution with your favorite
7685 editing program by typing @code{edit}.
7686 @xref{List, ,Printing Source Lines},
7687 for details.
7688
7689 @table @code
7690 @kindex select-frame
7691 @item select-frame
7692 The @code{select-frame} command is a variant of @code{frame} that does
7693 not display the new frame after selecting it. This command is
7694 intended primarily for use in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the
7695 output might be unnecessary and distracting.
7696
7697 @kindex down-silently
7698 @kindex up-silently
7699 @item up-silently @var{n}
7700 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
7701 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
7702 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
7703 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
7704 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
7705 distracting.
7706 @end table
7707
7708 @node Frame Info
7709 @section Information About a Frame
7710
7711 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
7712 stack frame.
7713
7714 @table @code
7715 @item frame
7716 @itemx f
7717 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
7718 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
7719 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
7720 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
7721 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7722
7723 @kindex info frame
7724 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
7725 @item info frame
7726 @itemx info f
7727 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
7728 including:
7729
7730 @itemize @bullet
7731 @item
7732 the address of the frame
7733 @item
7734 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
7735 @item
7736 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
7737 @item
7738 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
7739 @item
7740 the address of the frame's arguments
7741 @item
7742 the address of the frame's local variables
7743 @item
7744 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
7745 @item
7746 which registers were saved in the frame
7747 @end itemize
7748
7749 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
7750 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
7751 the usual conventions.
7752
7753 @item info frame @var{addr}
7754 @itemx info f @var{addr}
7755 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
7756 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
7757 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
7758 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
7759 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}.
7760
7761 @kindex info args
7762 @item info args
7763 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
7764
7765 @item info locals
7766 @kindex info locals
7767 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
7768 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
7769 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
7770
7771 @end table
7772
7773 @node Frame Apply
7774 @section Applying a Command to Several Frames.
7775 @kindex frame apply
7776 @cindex apply command to several frames
7777 @table @code
7778 @item frame apply [all | @var{count} | @var{-count} | level @var{level}@dots{}] [@var{flag}]@dots{} @var{command}
7779 The @code{frame apply} command allows you to apply the named
7780 @var{command} to one or more frames.
7781
7782 @table @code
7783 @item @code{all}
7784 Specify @code{all} to apply @var{command} to all frames.
7785
7786 @item @var{count}
7787 Use @var{count} to apply @var{command} to the innermost @var{count}
7788 frames, where @var{count} is a positive number.
7789
7790 @item @var{-count}
7791 Use @var{-count} to apply @var{command} to the outermost @var{count}
7792 frames, where @var{count} is a positive number.
7793
7794 @item @code{level}
7795 Use @code{level} to apply @var{command} to the set of frames identified
7796 by the @var{level} list. @var{level} is a frame level or a range of frame
7797 levels as @var{level1}-@var{level2}. The frame level is the number shown
7798 in the first field of the @samp{backtrace} command output.
7799 E.g., @samp{2-4 6-8 3} indicates to apply @var{command} for the frames
7800 at levels 2, 3, 4, 6, 7, 8, and then again on frame at level 3.
7801
7802 @end table
7803
7804 @end table
7805
7806 Note that the frames on which @code{frame apply} applies a command are
7807 also influenced by the @code{set backtrace} settings such as @code{set
7808 backtrace past-main} and @code{set backtrace limit N}. See
7809 @xref{Backtrace,,Backtraces}.
7810
7811 The @var{flag} arguments control what output to produce and how to handle
7812 errors raised when applying @var{command} to a frame. @var{flag}
7813 must start with a @code{-} directly followed by one letter in
7814 @code{qcs}. If several flags are provided, they must be given
7815 individually, such as @code{-c -q}.
7816
7817 By default, @value{GDBN} displays some frame information before the
7818 output produced by @var{command}, and an error raised during the
7819 execution of a @var{command} will abort @code{frame apply}. The
7820 following flags can be used to fine-tune this behavior:
7821
7822 @table @code
7823 @item -c
7824 The flag @code{-c}, which stands for @samp{continue}, causes any
7825 errors in @var{command} to be displayed, and the execution of
7826 @code{frame apply} then continues.
7827 @item -s
7828 The flag @code{-s}, which stands for @samp{silent}, causes any errors
7829 or empty output produced by a @var{command} to be silently ignored.
7830 That is, the execution continues, but the frame information and errors
7831 are not printed.
7832 @item -q
7833 The flag @code{-q} (@samp{quiet}) disables printing the frame
7834 information.
7835 @end table
7836
7837 The following example shows how the flags @code{-c} and @code{-s} are
7838 working when applying the command @code{p j} to all frames, where
7839 variable @code{j} can only be successfully printed in the outermost
7840 @code{#1 main} frame.
7841
7842 @smallexample
7843 @group
7844 (gdb) frame apply all p j
7845 #0 some_function (i=5) at fun.c:4
7846 No symbol "j" in current context.
7847 (gdb) frame apply all -c p j
7848 #0 some_function (i=5) at fun.c:4
7849 No symbol "j" in current context.
7850 #1 0x565555fb in main (argc=1, argv=0xffffd2c4) at fun.c:11
7851 $1 = 5
7852 (gdb) frame apply all -s p j
7853 #1 0x565555fb in main (argc=1, argv=0xffffd2c4) at fun.c:11
7854 $2 = 5
7855 (gdb)
7856 @end group
7857 @end smallexample
7858
7859 By default, @samp{frame apply}, prints the frame location
7860 information before the command output:
7861
7862 @smallexample
7863 @group
7864 (gdb) frame apply all p $sp
7865 #0 some_function (i=5) at fun.c:4
7866 $4 = (void *) 0xffffd1e0
7867 #1 0x565555fb in main (argc=1, argv=0xffffd2c4) at fun.c:11
7868 $5 = (void *) 0xffffd1f0
7869 (gdb)
7870 @end group
7871 @end smallexample
7872
7873 If flag @code{-q} is given, no frame information is printed:
7874 @smallexample
7875 @group
7876 (gdb) frame apply all -q p $sp
7877 $12 = (void *) 0xffffd1e0
7878 $13 = (void *) 0xffffd1f0
7879 (gdb)
7880 @end group
7881 @end smallexample
7882
7883 @table @code
7884
7885 @kindex faas
7886 @cindex apply a command to all frames (ignoring errors and empty output)
7887 @item faas @var{command}
7888 Shortcut for @code{frame apply all -s @var{command}}.
7889 Applies @var{command} on all frames, ignoring errors and empty output.
7890
7891 It can for example be used to print a local variable or a function
7892 argument without knowing the frame where this variable or argument
7893 is, using:
7894 @smallexample
7895 (@value{GDBP}) faas p some_local_var_i_do_not_remember_where_it_is
7896 @end smallexample
7897
7898 Note that the command @code{tfaas @var{command}} applies @var{command}
7899 on all frames of all threads. See @xref{Threads,,Threads}.
7900 @end table
7901
7902
7903 @node Frame Filter Management
7904 @section Management of Frame Filters.
7905 @cindex managing frame filters
7906
7907 Frame filters are Python based utilities to manage and decorate the
7908 output of frames. @xref{Frame Filter API}, for further information.
7909
7910 Managing frame filters is performed by several commands available
7911 within @value{GDBN}, detailed here.
7912
7913 @table @code
7914 @kindex info frame-filter
7915 @item info frame-filter
7916 Print a list of installed frame filters from all dictionaries, showing
7917 their name, priority and enabled status.
7918
7919 @kindex disable frame-filter
7920 @anchor{disable frame-filter all}
7921 @item disable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7922 Disable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7923 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
7924 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
7925 @code{progspace}, or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7926 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters
7927 across all dictionaries are disabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name
7928 of the frame filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
7929 @var{filter-dictionary}. A disabled frame-filter is not deleted, it
7930 may be enabled again later.
7931
7932 @kindex enable frame-filter
7933 @item enable frame-filter @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
7934 Enable a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7935 @var{filter-dictionary} and @var{filter-name}. The
7936 @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{all}, @code{global},
7937 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
7938 dictionary resides. When @code{all} is specified, all frame filters across
7939 all dictionaries are enabled. The @var{filter-name} is the name of the frame
7940 filter and is used when @code{all} is not the option for
7941 @var{filter-dictionary}.
7942
7943 Example:
7944
7945 @smallexample
7946 (gdb) info frame-filter
7947
7948 global frame-filters:
7949 Priority Enabled Name
7950 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
7951 100 Yes Reverse
7952
7953 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7954 Priority Enabled Name
7955 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7956
7957 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7958 Priority Enabled Name
7959 999 Yes BuildProgra Filter
7960
7961 (gdb) disable frame-filter /build/test BuildProgramFilter
7962 (gdb) info frame-filter
7963
7964 global frame-filters:
7965 Priority Enabled Name
7966 1000 No PrimaryFunctionFilter
7967 100 Yes Reverse
7968
7969 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7970 Priority Enabled Name
7971 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7972
7973 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7974 Priority Enabled Name
7975 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7976
7977 (gdb) enable frame-filter global PrimaryFunctionFilter
7978 (gdb) info frame-filter
7979
7980 global frame-filters:
7981 Priority Enabled Name
7982 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
7983 100 Yes Reverse
7984
7985 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
7986 Priority Enabled Name
7987 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
7988
7989 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
7990 Priority Enabled Name
7991 999 No BuildProgramFilter
7992 @end smallexample
7993
7994 @kindex set frame-filter priority
7995 @item set frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name} @var{priority}
7996 Set the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
7997 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
7998 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
7999 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
8000 dictionary resides. The @var{priority} is an integer.
8001
8002 @kindex show frame-filter priority
8003 @item show frame-filter priority @var{filter-dictionary} @var{filter-name}
8004 Show the @var{priority} of a frame filter in the dictionary matching
8005 @var{filter-dictionary}, and the frame filter name matching
8006 @var{filter-name}. The @var{filter-dictionary} may be @code{global},
8007 @code{progspace} or the name of the object file where the frame filter
8008 dictionary resides.
8009
8010 Example:
8011
8012 @smallexample
8013 (gdb) info frame-filter
8014
8015 global frame-filters:
8016 Priority Enabled Name
8017 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
8018 100 Yes Reverse
8019
8020 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
8021 Priority Enabled Name
8022 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
8023
8024 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
8025 Priority Enabled Name
8026 999 No BuildProgramFilter
8027
8028 (gdb) set frame-filter priority global Reverse 50
8029 (gdb) info frame-filter
8030
8031 global frame-filters:
8032 Priority Enabled Name
8033 1000 Yes PrimaryFunctionFilter
8034 50 Yes Reverse
8035
8036 progspace /build/test frame-filters:
8037 Priority Enabled Name
8038 100 Yes ProgspaceFilter
8039
8040 objfile /build/test frame-filters:
8041 Priority Enabled Name
8042 999 No BuildProgramFilter
8043 @end smallexample
8044 @end table
8045
8046 @node Source
8047 @chapter Examining Source Files
8048
8049 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
8050 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
8051 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
8052 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
8053 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
8054 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
8055 source files by explicit command.
8056
8057 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
8058 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
8059 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
8060
8061 @menu
8062 * List:: Printing source lines
8063 * Specify Location:: How to specify code locations
8064 * Edit:: Editing source files
8065 * Search:: Searching source files
8066 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
8067 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
8068 @end menu
8069
8070 @node List
8071 @section Printing Source Lines
8072
8073 @kindex list
8074 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
8075 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
8076 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
8077 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to
8078 print; see @ref{Specify Location}, for the full list.
8079
8080 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
8081
8082 @table @code
8083 @item list @var{linenum}
8084 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
8085 current source file.
8086
8087 @item list @var{function}
8088 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
8089 @var{function}.
8090
8091 @item list
8092 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
8093 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
8094 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
8095 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
8096 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
8097
8098 @item list -
8099 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
8100 @end table
8101
8102 @cindex @code{list}, how many lines to display
8103 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
8104 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
8105
8106 @table @code
8107 @kindex set listsize
8108 @item set listsize @var{count}
8109 @itemx set listsize unlimited
8110 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
8111 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
8112 Setting @var{count} to @code{unlimited} or 0 means there's no limit.
8113
8114 @kindex show listsize
8115 @item show listsize
8116 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
8117 @end table
8118
8119 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
8120 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
8121 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
8122 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
8123 each repetition moves up in the source file.
8124
8125 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
8126 @dfn{locations}. Locations specify source lines; there are several ways
8127 of writing them (@pxref{Specify Location}), but the effect is always
8128 to specify some source line.
8129
8130 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
8131
8132 @table @code
8133 @item list @var{location}
8134 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{location}.
8135
8136 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
8137 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
8138 locations. When a @code{list} command has two locations, and the
8139 source file of the second location is omitted, this refers to
8140 the same source file as the first location.
8141
8142 @item list ,@var{last}
8143 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
8144
8145 @item list @var{first},
8146 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
8147
8148 @item list +
8149 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
8150
8151 @item list -
8152 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
8153
8154 @item list
8155 As described in the preceding table.
8156 @end table
8157
8158 @node Specify Location
8159 @section Specifying a Location
8160 @cindex specifying location
8161 @cindex location
8162 @cindex source location
8163
8164 @menu
8165 * Linespec Locations:: Linespec locations
8166 * Explicit Locations:: Explicit locations
8167 * Address Locations:: Address locations
8168 @end menu
8169
8170 Several @value{GDBN} commands accept arguments that specify a location
8171 of your program's code. Since @value{GDBN} is a source-level
8172 debugger, a location usually specifies some line in the source code.
8173 Locations may be specified using three different formats:
8174 linespec locations, explicit locations, or address locations.
8175
8176 @node Linespec Locations
8177 @subsection Linespec Locations
8178 @cindex linespec locations
8179
8180 A @dfn{linespec} is a colon-separated list of source location parameters such
8181 as file name, function name, etc. Here are all the different ways of
8182 specifying a linespec:
8183
8184 @table @code
8185 @item @var{linenum}
8186 Specifies the line number @var{linenum} of the current source file.
8187
8188 @item -@var{offset}
8189 @itemx +@var{offset}
8190 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before or after the @dfn{current
8191 line}. For the @code{list} command, the current line is the last one
8192 printed; for the breakpoint commands, this is the line at which
8193 execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}
8194 (@pxref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.) When
8195 used as the second of the two linespecs in a @code{list} command,
8196 this specifies the line @var{offset} lines up or down from the first
8197 linespec.
8198
8199 @item @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
8200 Specifies the line @var{linenum} in the source file @var{filename}.
8201 If @var{filename} is a relative file name, then it will match any
8202 source file name with the same trailing components. For example, if
8203 @var{filename} is @samp{gcc/expr.c}, then it will match source file
8204 name of @file{/build/trunk/gcc/expr.c}, but not
8205 @file{/build/trunk/libcpp/expr.c} or @file{/build/trunk/gcc/x-expr.c}.
8206
8207 @item @var{function}
8208 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
8209 For example, in C, this is the line with the open brace.
8210
8211 By default, in C@t{++} and Ada, @var{function} is interpreted as
8212 specifying all functions named @var{function} in all scopes. For
8213 C@t{++}, this means in all namespaces and classes. For Ada, this
8214 means in all packages.
8215
8216 For example, assuming a program with C@t{++} symbols named
8217 @code{A::B::func} and @code{B::func}, both commands @w{@kbd{break
8218 func}} and @w{@kbd{break B::func}} set a breakpoint on both symbols.
8219
8220 Commands that accept a linespec let you override this with the
8221 @code{-qualified} option. For example, @w{@kbd{break -qualified
8222 func}} sets a breakpoint on a free-function named @code{func} ignoring
8223 any C@t{++} class methods and namespace functions called @code{func}.
8224
8225 @xref{Explicit Locations}.
8226
8227 @item @var{function}:@var{label}
8228 Specifies the line where @var{label} appears in @var{function}.
8229
8230 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
8231 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}
8232 in the file @var{filename}. You only need the file name with a
8233 function name to avoid ambiguity when there are identically named
8234 functions in different source files.
8235
8236 @item @var{label}
8237 Specifies the line at which the label named @var{label} appears
8238 in the function corresponding to the currently selected stack frame.
8239 If there is no current selected stack frame (for instance, if the inferior
8240 is not running), then @value{GDBN} will not search for a label.
8241
8242 @cindex breakpoint at static probe point
8243 @item -pstap|-probe-stap @r{[}@var{objfile}:@r{[}@var{provider}:@r{]}@r{]}@var{name}
8244 The @sc{gnu}/Linux tool @code{SystemTap} provides a way for
8245 applications to embed static probes. @xref{Static Probe Points}, for more
8246 information on finding and using static probes. This form of linespec
8247 specifies the location of such a static probe.
8248
8249 If @var{objfile} is given, only probes coming from that shared library
8250 or executable matching @var{objfile} as a regular expression are considered.
8251 If @var{provider} is given, then only probes from that provider are considered.
8252 If several probes match the spec, @value{GDBN} will insert a breakpoint at
8253 each one of those probes.
8254 @end table
8255
8256 @node Explicit Locations
8257 @subsection Explicit Locations
8258 @cindex explicit locations
8259
8260 @dfn{Explicit locations} allow the user to directly specify the source
8261 location's parameters using option-value pairs.
8262
8263 Explicit locations are useful when several functions, labels, or
8264 file names have the same name (base name for files) in the program's
8265 sources. In these cases, explicit locations point to the source
8266 line you meant more accurately and unambiguously. Also, using
8267 explicit locations might be faster in large programs.
8268
8269 For example, the linespec @samp{foo:bar} may refer to a function @code{bar}
8270 defined in the file named @file{foo} or the label @code{bar} in a function
8271 named @code{foo}. @value{GDBN} must search either the file system or
8272 the symbol table to know.
8273
8274 The list of valid explicit location options is summarized in the
8275 following table:
8276
8277 @table @code
8278 @item -source @var{filename}
8279 The value specifies the source file name. To differentiate between
8280 files with the same base name, prepend as many directories as is necessary
8281 to uniquely identify the desired file, e.g., @file{foo/bar/baz.c}. Otherwise
8282 @value{GDBN} will use the first file it finds with the given base
8283 name. This option requires the use of either @code{-function} or @code{-line}.
8284
8285 @item -function @var{function}
8286 The value specifies the name of a function. Operations
8287 on function locations unmodified by other options (such as @code{-label}
8288 or @code{-line}) refer to the line that begins the body of the function.
8289 In C, for example, this is the line with the open brace.
8290
8291 By default, in C@t{++} and Ada, @var{function} is interpreted as
8292 specifying all functions named @var{function} in all scopes. For
8293 C@t{++}, this means in all namespaces and classes. For Ada, this
8294 means in all packages.
8295
8296 For example, assuming a program with C@t{++} symbols named
8297 @code{A::B::func} and @code{B::func}, both commands @w{@kbd{break
8298 -function func}} and @w{@kbd{break -function B::func}} set a
8299 breakpoint on both symbols.
8300
8301 You can use the @kbd{-qualified} flag to override this (see below).
8302
8303 @item -qualified
8304
8305 This flag makes @value{GDBN} interpret a function name specified with
8306 @kbd{-function} as a complete fully-qualified name.
8307
8308 For example, assuming a C@t{++} program with symbols named
8309 @code{A::B::func} and @code{B::func}, the @w{@kbd{break -qualified
8310 -function B::func}} command sets a breakpoint on @code{B::func}, only.
8311
8312 (Note: the @kbd{-qualified} option can precede a linespec as well
8313 (@pxref{Linespec Locations}), so the particular example above could be
8314 simplified as @w{@kbd{break -qualified B::func}}.)
8315
8316 @item -label @var{label}
8317 The value specifies the name of a label. When the function
8318 name is not specified, the label is searched in the function of the currently
8319 selected stack frame.
8320
8321 @item -line @var{number}
8322 The value specifies a line offset for the location. The offset may either
8323 be absolute (@code{-line 3}) or relative (@code{-line +3}), depending on
8324 the command. When specified without any other options, the line offset is
8325 relative to the current line.
8326 @end table
8327
8328 Explicit location options may be abbreviated by omitting any non-unique
8329 trailing characters from the option name, e.g., @w{@kbd{break -s main.c -li 3}}.
8330
8331 @node Address Locations
8332 @subsection Address Locations
8333 @cindex address locations
8334
8335 @dfn{Address locations} indicate a specific program address. They have
8336 the generalized form *@var{address}.
8337
8338 For line-oriented commands, such as @code{list} and @code{edit}, this
8339 specifies a source line that contains @var{address}. For @code{break} and
8340 other breakpoint-oriented commands, this can be used to set breakpoints in
8341 parts of your program which do not have debugging information or
8342 source files.
8343
8344 Here @var{address} may be any expression valid in the current working
8345 language (@pxref{Languages, working language}) that specifies a code
8346 address. In addition, as a convenience, @value{GDBN} extends the
8347 semantics of expressions used in locations to cover several situations
8348 that frequently occur during debugging. Here are the various forms
8349 of @var{address}:
8350
8351 @table @code
8352 @item @var{expression}
8353 Any expression valid in the current working language.
8354
8355 @item @var{funcaddr}
8356 An address of a function or procedure derived from its name. In C,
8357 C@t{++}, Objective-C, Fortran, minimal, and assembly, this is
8358 simply the function's name @var{function} (and actually a special case
8359 of a valid expression). In Pascal and Modula-2, this is
8360 @code{&@var{function}}. In Ada, this is @code{@var{function}'Address}
8361 (although the Pascal form also works).
8362
8363 This form specifies the address of the function's first instruction,
8364 before the stack frame and arguments have been set up.
8365
8366 @item '@var{filename}':@var{funcaddr}
8367 Like @var{funcaddr} above, but also specifies the name of the source
8368 file explicitly. This is useful if the name of the function does not
8369 specify the function unambiguously, e.g., if there are several
8370 functions with identical names in different source files.
8371 @end table
8372
8373 @node Edit
8374 @section Editing Source Files
8375 @cindex editing source files
8376
8377 @kindex edit
8378 @kindex e @r{(@code{edit})}
8379 To edit the lines in a source file, use the @code{edit} command.
8380 The editing program of your choice
8381 is invoked with the current line set to
8382 the active line in the program.
8383 Alternatively, there are several ways to specify what part of the file you
8384 want to print if you want to see other parts of the program:
8385
8386 @table @code
8387 @item edit @var{location}
8388 Edit the source file specified by @code{location}. Editing starts at
8389 that @var{location}, e.g., at the specified source line of the
8390 specified file. @xref{Specify Location}, for all the possible forms
8391 of the @var{location} argument; here are the forms of the @code{edit}
8392 command most commonly used:
8393
8394 @table @code
8395 @item edit @var{number}
8396 Edit the current source file with @var{number} as the active line number.
8397
8398 @item edit @var{function}
8399 Edit the file containing @var{function} at the beginning of its definition.
8400 @end table
8401
8402 @end table
8403
8404 @subsection Choosing your Editor
8405 You can customize @value{GDBN} to use any editor you want
8406 @footnote{
8407 The only restriction is that your editor (say @code{ex}), recognizes the
8408 following command-line syntax:
8409 @smallexample
8410 ex +@var{number} file
8411 @end smallexample
8412 The optional numeric value +@var{number} specifies the number of the line in
8413 the file where to start editing.}.
8414 By default, it is @file{@value{EDITOR}}, but you can change this
8415 by setting the environment variable @code{EDITOR} before using
8416 @value{GDBN}. For example, to configure @value{GDBN} to use the
8417 @code{vi} editor, you could use these commands with the @code{sh} shell:
8418 @smallexample
8419 EDITOR=/usr/bin/vi
8420 export EDITOR
8421 gdb @dots{}
8422 @end smallexample
8423 or in the @code{csh} shell,
8424 @smallexample
8425 setenv EDITOR /usr/bin/vi
8426 gdb @dots{}
8427 @end smallexample
8428
8429 @node Search
8430 @section Searching Source Files
8431 @cindex searching source files
8432
8433 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
8434 regular expression.
8435
8436 @table @code
8437 @kindex search
8438 @kindex forward-search
8439 @kindex fo @r{(@code{forward-search})}
8440 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
8441 @itemx search @var{regexp}
8442 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
8443 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
8444 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
8445 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
8446 @code{fo}.
8447
8448 @kindex reverse-search
8449 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
8450 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
8451 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
8452 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
8453 this command as @code{rev}.
8454 @end table
8455
8456 @node Source Path
8457 @section Specifying Source Directories
8458
8459 @cindex source path
8460 @cindex directories for source files
8461 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
8462 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
8463 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
8464 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
8465 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
8466 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
8467 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name.
8468
8469 For example, suppose an executable references the file
8470 @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}, and our source path is
8471 @file{/mnt/cross}. The file is first looked up literally; if this
8472 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} is tried; if this
8473 fails, @file{/mnt/cross/foo.c} is opened; if this fails, an error
8474 message is printed. @value{GDBN} does not look up the parts of the
8475 source file name, such as @file{/mnt/cross/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}.
8476 Likewise, the subdirectories of the source path are not searched: if
8477 the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the binary refers to
8478 @file{foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would not find it under
8479 @file{/mnt/cross/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib}.
8480
8481 Plain file names, relative file names with leading directories, file
8482 names containing dots, etc.@: are all treated as described above; for
8483 instance, if the source path is @file{/mnt/cross}, and the source file
8484 is recorded as @file{../lib/foo.c}, @value{GDBN} would first try
8485 @file{../lib/foo.c}, then @file{/mnt/cross/../lib/foo.c}, and after
8486 that---@file{/mnt/cross/foo.c}.
8487
8488 Note that the executable search path is @emph{not} used to locate the
8489 source files.
8490
8491 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
8492 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
8493 each line is in the file.
8494
8495 @kindex directory
8496 @kindex dir
8497 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
8498 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
8499 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
8500
8501 The search path is used to find both program source files and @value{GDBN}
8502 script files (read using the @samp{-command} option and @samp{source} command).
8503
8504 In addition to the source path, @value{GDBN} provides a set of commands
8505 that manage a list of source path substitution rules. A @dfn{substitution
8506 rule} specifies how to rewrite source directories stored in the program's
8507 debug information in case the sources were moved to a different
8508 directory between compilation and debugging. A rule is made of
8509 two strings, the first specifying what needs to be rewritten in
8510 the path, and the second specifying how it should be rewritten.
8511 In @ref{set substitute-path}, we name these two parts @var{from} and
8512 @var{to} respectively. @value{GDBN} does a simple string replacement
8513 of @var{from} with @var{to} at the start of the directory part of the
8514 source file name, and uses that result instead of the original file
8515 name to look up the sources.
8516
8517 Using the previous example, suppose the @file{foo-1.0} tree has been
8518 moved from @file{/usr/src} to @file{/mnt/cross}, then you can tell
8519 @value{GDBN} to replace @file{/usr/src} in all source path names with
8520 @file{/mnt/cross}. The first lookup will then be
8521 @file{/mnt/cross/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c} in place of the original location
8522 of @file{/usr/src/foo-1.0/lib/foo.c}. To define a source path
8523 substitution rule, use the @code{set substitute-path} command
8524 (@pxref{set substitute-path}).
8525
8526 To avoid unexpected substitution results, a rule is applied only if the
8527 @var{from} part of the directory name ends at a directory separator.
8528 For instance, a rule substituting @file{/usr/source} into
8529 @file{/mnt/cross} will be applied to @file{/usr/source/foo-1.0} but
8530 not to @file{/usr/sourceware/foo-2.0}. And because the substitution
8531 is applied only at the beginning of the directory name, this rule will
8532 not be applied to @file{/root/usr/source/baz.c} either.
8533
8534 In many cases, you can achieve the same result using the @code{directory}
8535 command. However, @code{set substitute-path} can be more efficient in
8536 the case where the sources are organized in a complex tree with multiple
8537 subdirectories. With the @code{directory} command, you need to add each
8538 subdirectory of your project. If you moved the entire tree while
8539 preserving its internal organization, then @code{set substitute-path}
8540 allows you to direct the debugger to all the sources with one single
8541 command.
8542
8543 @code{set substitute-path} is also more than just a shortcut command.
8544 The source path is only used if the file at the original location no
8545 longer exists. On the other hand, @code{set substitute-path} modifies
8546 the debugger behavior to look at the rewritten location instead. So, if
8547 for any reason a source file that is not relevant to your executable is
8548 located at the original location, a substitution rule is the only
8549 method available to point @value{GDBN} at the new location.
8550
8551 @cindex @samp{--with-relocated-sources}
8552 @cindex default source path substitution
8553 You can configure a default source path substitution rule by
8554 configuring @value{GDBN} with the
8555 @samp{--with-relocated-sources=@var{dir}} option. The @var{dir}
8556 should be the name of a directory under @value{GDBN}'s configured
8557 prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or @samp{--exec-prefix}), and
8558 directory names in debug information under @var{dir} will be adjusted
8559 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
8560 location. This is useful if @value{GDBN}, libraries or executables
8561 with debug information and corresponding source code are being moved
8562 together.
8563
8564 @table @code
8565 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
8566 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
8567 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
8568 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
8569 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
8570 part of absolute file names) or
8571 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
8572 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
8573
8574 @kindex cdir
8575 @kindex cwd
8576 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
8577 @vindex $cwd@r{, convenience variable}
8578 @cindex compilation directory
8579 @cindex current directory
8580 @cindex working directory
8581 @cindex directory, current
8582 @cindex directory, compilation
8583 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
8584 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
8585 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
8586 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
8587 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
8588 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
8589
8590 @item directory
8591 Reset the source path to its default value (@samp{$cdir:$cwd} on Unix systems). This requires confirmation.
8592
8593 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
8594 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
8595
8596 @item set directories @var{path-list}
8597 @kindex set directories
8598 Set the source path to @var{path-list}.
8599 @samp{$cdir:$cwd} are added if missing.
8600
8601 @item show directories
8602 @kindex show directories
8603 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
8604
8605 @anchor{set substitute-path}
8606 @item set substitute-path @var{from} @var{to}
8607 @kindex set substitute-path
8608 Define a source path substitution rule, and add it at the end of the
8609 current list of existing substitution rules. If a rule with the same
8610 @var{from} was already defined, then the old rule is also deleted.
8611
8612 For example, if the file @file{/foo/bar/baz.c} was moved to
8613 @file{/mnt/cross/baz.c}, then the command
8614
8615 @smallexample
8616 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /foo/bar /mnt/cross
8617 @end smallexample
8618
8619 @noindent
8620 will tell @value{GDBN} to replace @samp{/foo/bar} with
8621 @samp{/mnt/cross}, which will allow @value{GDBN} to find the file
8622 @file{baz.c} even though it was moved.
8623
8624 In the case when more than one substitution rule have been defined,
8625 the rules are evaluated one by one in the order where they have been
8626 defined. The first one matching, if any, is selected to perform
8627 the substitution.
8628
8629 For instance, if we had entered the following commands:
8630
8631 @smallexample
8632 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src/include /mnt/include
8633 (@value{GDBP}) set substitute-path /usr/src /mnt/src
8634 @end smallexample
8635
8636 @noindent
8637 @value{GDBN} would then rewrite @file{/usr/src/include/defs.h} into
8638 @file{/mnt/include/defs.h} by using the first rule. However, it would
8639 use the second rule to rewrite @file{/usr/src/lib/foo.c} into
8640 @file{/mnt/src/lib/foo.c}.
8641
8642
8643 @item unset substitute-path [path]
8644 @kindex unset substitute-path
8645 If a path is specified, search the current list of substitution rules
8646 for a rule that would rewrite that path. Delete that rule if found.
8647 A warning is emitted by the debugger if no rule could be found.
8648
8649 If no path is specified, then all substitution rules are deleted.
8650
8651 @item show substitute-path [path]
8652 @kindex show substitute-path
8653 If a path is specified, then print the source path substitution rule
8654 which would rewrite that path, if any.
8655
8656 If no path is specified, then print all existing source path substitution
8657 rules.
8658
8659 @end table
8660
8661 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
8662 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
8663 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
8664
8665 @enumerate
8666 @item
8667 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to its default value.
8668
8669 @item
8670 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
8671 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
8672 directories in one command.
8673 @end enumerate
8674
8675 @node Machine Code
8676 @section Source and Machine Code
8677 @cindex source line and its code address
8678
8679 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
8680 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
8681 a range of addresses as machine instructions. You can use the command
8682 @code{set disassemble-next-line} to set whether to disassemble next
8683 source line when execution stops. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
8684 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
8685 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
8686 well as hex.
8687
8688 @table @code
8689 @kindex info line
8690 @item info line
8691 @itemx info line @var{location}
8692 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
8693 source line @var{location}. You can specify source lines in any of
8694 the ways documented in @ref{Specify Location}. With no @var{location}
8695 information about the current source line is printed.
8696 @end table
8697
8698 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
8699 the object code for the first line of function
8700 @code{m4_changequote}:
8701
8702 @smallexample
8703 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
8704 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c <m4_changequote> and \
8705 ends at 0x6350 <m4_changequote+4>.
8706 @end smallexample
8707
8708 @noindent
8709 @cindex code address and its source line
8710 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
8711 @var{location}) what source line covers a particular address:
8712 @smallexample
8713 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
8714 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 <m4_changequote+152> and \
8715 ends at 0x6404 <m4_changequote+184>.
8716 @end smallexample
8717
8718 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
8719 @cindex @code{x} command, default address
8720 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
8721 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
8722 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
8723 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
8724 ,Examining Memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
8725 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
8726 Variables}).
8727
8728 @cindex info line, repeated calls
8729 After @code{info line}, using @code{info line} again without
8730 specifying a location will display information about the next source
8731 line.
8732
8733 @table @code
8734 @kindex disassemble
8735 @cindex assembly instructions
8736 @cindex instructions, assembly
8737 @cindex machine instructions
8738 @cindex listing machine instructions
8739 @item disassemble
8740 @itemx disassemble /m
8741 @itemx disassemble /s
8742 @itemx disassemble /r
8743 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
8744 instructions. It can also print mixed source+disassembly by specifying
8745 the @code{/m} or @code{/s} modifier and print the raw instructions in hex
8746 as well as in symbolic form by specifying the @code{/r} modifier.
8747 The default memory range is the function surrounding the
8748 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
8749 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
8750 surrounding this value. When two arguments are given, they should
8751 be separated by a comma, possibly surrounded by whitespace. The
8752 arguments specify a range of addresses to dump, in one of two forms:
8753
8754 @table @code
8755 @item @var{start},@var{end}
8756 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to @var{end} (exclusive)
8757 @item @var{start},+@var{length}
8758 the addresses from @var{start} (inclusive) to
8759 @code{@var{start}+@var{length}} (exclusive).
8760 @end table
8761
8762 @noindent
8763 When 2 arguments are specified, the name of the function is also
8764 printed (since there could be several functions in the given range).
8765
8766 The argument(s) can be any expression yielding a numeric value, such as
8767 @samp{0x32c4}, @samp{&main+10} or @samp{$pc - 8}.
8768
8769 If the range of memory being disassembled contains current program counter,
8770 the instruction at that location is shown with a @code{=>} marker.
8771 @end table
8772
8773 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
8774 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
8775
8776 @smallexample
8777 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4, 0x32e4
8778 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
8779 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
8780 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
8781 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
8782 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
8783 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
8784 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
8785 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
8786 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
8787 End of assembler dump.
8788 @end smallexample
8789
8790 Here is an example showing mixed source+assembly for Intel x86
8791 with @code{/m} or @code{/s}, when the program is stopped just after
8792 function prologue in a non-optimized function with no inline code.
8793
8794 @smallexample
8795 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
8796 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8797 5 @{
8798 0x08048330 <+0>: push %ebp
8799 0x08048331 <+1>: mov %esp,%ebp
8800 0x08048333 <+3>: sub $0x8,%esp
8801 0x08048336 <+6>: and $0xfffffff0,%esp
8802 0x08048339 <+9>: sub $0x10,%esp
8803
8804 6 printf ("Hello.\n");
8805 => 0x0804833c <+12>: movl $0x8048440,(%esp)
8806 0x08048343 <+19>: call 0x8048284 <puts@@plt>
8807
8808 7 return 0;
8809 8 @}
8810 0x08048348 <+24>: mov $0x0,%eax
8811 0x0804834d <+29>: leave
8812 0x0804834e <+30>: ret
8813
8814 End of assembler dump.
8815 @end smallexample
8816
8817 The @code{/m} option is deprecated as its output is not useful when
8818 there is either inlined code or re-ordered code.
8819 The @code{/s} option is the preferred choice.
8820 Here is an example for AMD x86-64 showing the difference between
8821 @code{/m} output and @code{/s} output.
8822 This example has one inline function defined in a header file,
8823 and the code is compiled with @samp{-O2} optimization.
8824 Note how the @code{/m} output is missing the disassembly of
8825 several instructions that are present in the @code{/s} output.
8826
8827 @file{foo.h}:
8828
8829 @smallexample
8830 int
8831 foo (int a)
8832 @{
8833 if (a < 0)
8834 return a * 2;
8835 if (a == 0)
8836 return 1;
8837 return a + 10;
8838 @}
8839 @end smallexample
8840
8841 @file{foo.c}:
8842
8843 @smallexample
8844 #include "foo.h"
8845 volatile int x, y;
8846 int
8847 main ()
8848 @{
8849 x = foo (y);
8850 return 0;
8851 @}
8852 @end smallexample
8853
8854 @smallexample
8855 (@value{GDBP}) disas /m main
8856 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8857 5 @{
8858
8859 6 x = foo (y);
8860 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
8861 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
8862
8863 7 return 0;
8864 8 @}
8865 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax
8866 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq
8867 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax
8868 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23>
8869
8870 End of assembler dump.
8871 (@value{GDBP}) disas /s main
8872 Dump of assembler code for function main:
8873 foo.c:
8874 5 @{
8875 6 x = foo (y);
8876 0x0000000000400400 <+0>: mov 0x200c2e(%rip),%eax # 0x601034 <y>
8877
8878 foo.h:
8879 4 if (a < 0)
8880 0x0000000000400406 <+6>: test %eax,%eax
8881 0x0000000000400408 <+8>: js 0x400420 <main+32>
8882
8883 6 if (a == 0)
8884 7 return 1;
8885 8 return a + 10;
8886 0x000000000040040a <+10>: lea 0xa(%rax),%edx
8887 0x000000000040040d <+13>: test %eax,%eax
8888 0x000000000040040f <+15>: mov $0x1,%eax
8889 0x0000000000400414 <+20>: cmovne %edx,%eax
8890
8891 foo.c:
8892 6 x = foo (y);
8893 0x0000000000400417 <+23>: mov %eax,0x200c13(%rip) # 0x601030 <x>
8894
8895 7 return 0;
8896 8 @}
8897 0x000000000040041d <+29>: xor %eax,%eax
8898 0x000000000040041f <+31>: retq
8899
8900 foo.h:
8901 5 return a * 2;
8902 0x0000000000400420 <+32>: add %eax,%eax
8903 0x0000000000400422 <+34>: jmp 0x400417 <main+23>
8904 End of assembler dump.
8905 @end smallexample
8906
8907 Here is another example showing raw instructions in hex for AMD x86-64,
8908
8909 @smallexample
8910 (gdb) disas /r 0x400281,+10
8911 Dump of assembler code from 0x400281 to 0x40028b:
8912 0x0000000000400281: 38 36 cmp %dh,(%rsi)
8913 0x0000000000400283: 2d 36 34 2e 73 sub $0x732e3436,%eax
8914 0x0000000000400288: 6f outsl %ds:(%rsi),(%dx)
8915 0x0000000000400289: 2e 32 00 xor %cs:(%rax),%al
8916 End of assembler dump.
8917 @end smallexample
8918
8919 Addresses cannot be specified as a location (@pxref{Specify Location}).
8920 So, for example, if you want to disassemble function @code{bar}
8921 in file @file{foo.c}, you must type @samp{disassemble 'foo.c'::bar}
8922 and not @samp{disassemble foo.c:bar}.
8923
8924 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
8925 mnemonics or other syntax.
8926
8927 For programs that were dynamically linked and use shared libraries,
8928 instructions that call functions or branch to locations in the shared
8929 libraries might show a seemingly bogus location---it's actually a
8930 location of the relocation table. On some architectures, @value{GDBN}
8931 might be able to resolve these to actual function names.
8932
8933 @table @code
8934 @kindex set disassembler-options
8935 @cindex disassembler options
8936 @item set disassembler-options @var{option1}[,@var{option2}@dots{}]
8937 This command controls the passing of target specific information to
8938 the disassembler. For a list of valid options, please refer to the
8939 @code{-M}/@code{--disassembler-options} section of the @samp{objdump}
8940 manual and/or the output of @kbd{objdump --help}
8941 (@pxref{objdump,,objdump,binutils.info,The GNU Binary Utilities}).
8942 The default value is the empty string.
8943
8944 If it is necessary to specify more than one disassembler option, then
8945 multiple options can be placed together into a comma separated list.
8946 Currently this command is only supported on targets ARM, MIPS, PowerPC
8947 and S/390.
8948
8949 @kindex show disassembler-options
8950 @item show disassembler-options
8951 Show the current setting of the disassembler options.
8952 @end table
8953
8954 @table @code
8955 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
8956 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
8957 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
8958 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
8959 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
8960 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
8961
8962 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
8963 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
8964 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
8965 assemblers for x86-based targets.
8966
8967 @kindex show disassembly-flavor
8968 @item show disassembly-flavor
8969 Show the current setting of the disassembly flavor.
8970 @end table
8971
8972 @table @code
8973 @kindex set disassemble-next-line
8974 @kindex show disassemble-next-line
8975 @item set disassemble-next-line
8976 @itemx show disassemble-next-line
8977 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will disassemble the next source
8978 line or instruction when execution stops. If ON, @value{GDBN} will
8979 display disassembly of the next source line when execution of the
8980 program being debugged stops. This is @emph{in addition} to
8981 displaying the source line itself, which @value{GDBN} always does if
8982 possible. If the next source line cannot be displayed for some reason
8983 (e.g., if @value{GDBN} cannot find the source file, or there's no line
8984 info in the debug info), @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of the
8985 next @emph{instruction} instead of showing the next source line. If
8986 AUTO, @value{GDBN} will display disassembly of next instruction only
8987 if the source line cannot be displayed. This setting causes
8988 @value{GDBN} to display some feedback when you step through a function
8989 with no line info or whose source file is unavailable. The default is
8990 OFF, which means never display the disassembly of the next line or
8991 instruction.
8992 @end table
8993
8994
8995 @node Data
8996 @chapter Examining Data
8997
8998 @cindex printing data
8999 @cindex examining data
9000 @kindex print
9001 @kindex inspect
9002 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
9003 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
9004 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
9005 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
9006 Different Languages}). It may also print the expression using a
9007 Python-based pretty-printer (@pxref{Pretty Printing}).
9008
9009 @table @code
9010 @item print @var{expr}
9011 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
9012 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
9013 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
9014 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
9015 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
9016 Formats}.
9017
9018 @item print
9019 @itemx print /@var{f}
9020 @cindex reprint the last value
9021 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
9022 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value History}). This allows you to
9023 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
9024 @end table
9025
9026 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
9027 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
9028 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
9029
9030 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
9031 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
9032 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
9033 Table}.
9034
9035 @cindex exploring hierarchical data structures
9036 @kindex explore
9037 Another way of examining values of expressions and type information is
9038 through the Python extension command @code{explore} (available only if
9039 the @value{GDBN} build is configured with @code{--with-python}). It
9040 offers an interactive way to start at the highest level (or, the most
9041 abstract level) of the data type of an expression (or, the data type
9042 itself) and explore all the way down to leaf scalar values/fields
9043 embedded in the higher level data types.
9044
9045 @table @code
9046 @item explore @var{arg}
9047 @var{arg} is either an expression (in the source language), or a type
9048 visible in the current context of the program being debugged.
9049 @end table
9050
9051 The working of the @code{explore} command can be illustrated with an
9052 example. If a data type @code{struct ComplexStruct} is defined in your
9053 C program as
9054
9055 @smallexample
9056 struct SimpleStruct
9057 @{
9058 int i;
9059 double d;
9060 @};
9061
9062 struct ComplexStruct
9063 @{
9064 struct SimpleStruct *ss_p;
9065 int arr[10];
9066 @};
9067 @end smallexample
9068
9069 @noindent
9070 followed by variable declarations as
9071
9072 @smallexample
9073 struct SimpleStruct ss = @{ 10, 1.11 @};
9074 struct ComplexStruct cs = @{ &ss, @{ 0, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9 @} @};
9075 @end smallexample
9076
9077 @noindent
9078 then, the value of the variable @code{cs} can be explored using the
9079 @code{explore} command as follows.
9080
9081 @smallexample
9082 (gdb) explore cs
9083 The value of `cs' is a struct/class of type `struct ComplexStruct' with
9084 the following fields:
9085
9086 ss_p = <Enter 0 to explore this field of type `struct SimpleStruct *'>
9087 arr = <Enter 1 to explore this field of type `int [10]'>
9088
9089 Enter the field number of choice:
9090 @end smallexample
9091
9092 @noindent
9093 Since the fields of @code{cs} are not scalar values, you are being
9094 prompted to chose the field you want to explore. Let's say you choose
9095 the field @code{ss_p} by entering @code{0}. Then, since this field is a
9096 pointer, you will be asked if it is pointing to a single value. From
9097 the declaration of @code{cs} above, it is indeed pointing to a single
9098 value, hence you enter @code{y}. If you enter @code{n}, then you will
9099 be asked if it were pointing to an array of values, in which case this
9100 field will be explored as if it were an array.
9101
9102 @smallexample
9103 `cs.ss_p' is a pointer to a value of type `struct SimpleStruct'
9104 Continue exploring it as a pointer to a single value [y/n]: y
9105 The value of `*(cs.ss_p)' is a struct/class of type `struct
9106 SimpleStruct' with the following fields:
9107
9108 i = 10 .. (Value of type `int')
9109 d = 1.1100000000000001 .. (Value of type `double')
9110
9111 Press enter to return to parent value:
9112 @end smallexample
9113
9114 @noindent
9115 If the field @code{arr} of @code{cs} was chosen for exploration by
9116 entering @code{1} earlier, then since it is as array, you will be
9117 prompted to enter the index of the element in the array that you want
9118 to explore.
9119
9120 @smallexample
9121 `cs.arr' is an array of `int'.
9122 Enter the index of the element you want to explore in `cs.arr': 5
9123
9124 `(cs.arr)[5]' is a scalar value of type `int'.
9125
9126 (cs.arr)[5] = 4
9127
9128 Press enter to return to parent value:
9129 @end smallexample
9130
9131 In general, at any stage of exploration, you can go deeper towards the
9132 leaf values by responding to the prompts appropriately, or hit the
9133 return key to return to the enclosing data structure (the @i{higher}
9134 level data structure).
9135
9136 Similar to exploring values, you can use the @code{explore} command to
9137 explore types. Instead of specifying a value (which is typically a
9138 variable name or an expression valid in the current context of the
9139 program being debugged), you specify a type name. If you consider the
9140 same example as above, your can explore the type
9141 @code{struct ComplexStruct} by passing the argument
9142 @code{struct ComplexStruct} to the @code{explore} command.
9143
9144 @smallexample
9145 (gdb) explore struct ComplexStruct
9146 @end smallexample
9147
9148 @noindent
9149 By responding to the prompts appropriately in the subsequent interactive
9150 session, you can explore the type @code{struct ComplexStruct} in a
9151 manner similar to how the value @code{cs} was explored in the above
9152 example.
9153
9154 The @code{explore} command also has two sub-commands,
9155 @code{explore value} and @code{explore type}. The former sub-command is
9156 a way to explicitly specify that value exploration of the argument is
9157 being invoked, while the latter is a way to explicitly specify that type
9158 exploration of the argument is being invoked.
9159
9160 @table @code
9161 @item explore value @var{expr}
9162 @cindex explore value
9163 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the value of the
9164 expression @var{expr} (if @var{expr} is an expression valid in the
9165 current context of the program being debugged). The behavior of this
9166 command is identical to that of the behavior of the @code{explore}
9167 command being passed the argument @var{expr}.
9168
9169 @item explore type @var{arg}
9170 @cindex explore type
9171 This sub-command of @code{explore} explores the type of @var{arg} (if
9172 @var{arg} is a type visible in the current context of program being
9173 debugged), or the type of the value/expression @var{arg} (if @var{arg}
9174 is an expression valid in the current context of the program being
9175 debugged). If @var{arg} is a type, then the behavior of this command is
9176 identical to that of the @code{explore} command being passed the
9177 argument @var{arg}. If @var{arg} is an expression, then the behavior of
9178 this command will be identical to that of the @code{explore} command
9179 being passed the type of @var{arg} as the argument.
9180 @end table
9181
9182 @menu
9183 * Expressions:: Expressions
9184 * Ambiguous Expressions:: Ambiguous Expressions
9185 * Variables:: Program variables
9186 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
9187 * Output Formats:: Output formats
9188 * Memory:: Examining memory
9189 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
9190 * Print Settings:: Print settings
9191 * Pretty Printing:: Python pretty printing
9192 * Value History:: Value history
9193 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
9194 * Convenience Funs:: Convenience functions
9195 * Registers:: Registers
9196 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
9197 * Vector Unit:: Vector Unit
9198 * OS Information:: Auxiliary data provided by operating system
9199 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
9200 * Dump/Restore Files:: Copy between memory and a file
9201 * Core File Generation:: Cause a program dump its core
9202 * Character Sets:: Debugging programs that use a different
9203 character set than GDB does
9204 * Caching Target Data:: Data caching for targets
9205 * Searching Memory:: Searching memory for a sequence of bytes
9206 * Value Sizes:: Managing memory allocated for values
9207 @end menu
9208
9209 @node Expressions
9210 @section Expressions
9211
9212 @cindex expressions
9213 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
9214 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
9215 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
9216 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls,
9217 casts, and string constants. It also includes preprocessor macros, if
9218 you compiled your program to include this information; see
9219 @ref{Compilation}.
9220
9221 @cindex arrays in expressions
9222 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
9223 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
9224 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to create an array
9225 of three integers. If you pass an array to a function or assign it
9226 to a program variable, @value{GDBN} copies the array to memory that
9227 is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
9228
9229 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
9230 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
9231 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
9232 languages.
9233
9234 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
9235 expressions regardless of your programming language.
9236
9237 @cindex casts, in expressions
9238 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
9239 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
9240 at that address in memory.
9241 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
9242
9243 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
9244 to programming languages:
9245
9246 @table @code
9247 @item @@
9248 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
9249 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial Arrays}, for more information.
9250
9251 @item ::
9252 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
9253 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program Variables}.
9254
9255 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
9256 @cindex type casting memory
9257 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
9258 @cindex casts, to view memory
9259 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
9260 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
9261 memory. The address @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is
9262 an integer or pointer (but parentheses are required around binary
9263 operators, just as in a cast). This construct is allowed regardless
9264 of what kind of data is normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
9265 @end table
9266
9267 @node Ambiguous Expressions
9268 @section Ambiguous Expressions
9269 @cindex ambiguous expressions
9270
9271 Expressions can sometimes contain some ambiguous elements. For instance,
9272 some programming languages (notably Ada, C@t{++} and Objective-C) permit
9273 a single function name to be defined several times, for application in
9274 different contexts. This is called @dfn{overloading}. Another example
9275 involving Ada is generics. A @dfn{generic package} is similar to C@t{++}
9276 templates and is typically instantiated several times, resulting in
9277 the same function name being defined in different contexts.
9278
9279 In some cases and depending on the language, it is possible to adjust
9280 the expression to remove the ambiguity. For instance in C@t{++}, you
9281 can specify the signature of the function you want to break on, as in
9282 @kbd{break @var{function}(@var{types})}. In Ada, using the fully
9283 qualified name of your function often makes the expression unambiguous
9284 as well.
9285
9286 When an ambiguity that needs to be resolved is detected, the debugger
9287 has the capability to display a menu of numbered choices for each
9288 possibility, and then waits for the selection with the prompt @samp{>}.
9289 The first option is always @samp{[0] cancel}, and typing @kbd{0 @key{RET}}
9290 aborts the current command. If the command in which the expression was
9291 used allows more than one choice to be selected, the next option in the
9292 menu is @samp{[1] all}, and typing @kbd{1 @key{RET}} selects all possible
9293 choices.
9294
9295 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
9296 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
9297 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
9298
9299 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
9300 @smallexample
9301 @group
9302 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
9303 [0] cancel
9304 [1] all
9305 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
9306 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
9307 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
9308 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
9309 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
9310 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
9311 > 2 4 6
9312 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
9313 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
9314 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
9315 Multiple breakpoints were set.
9316 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
9317 breakpoints.
9318 (@value{GDBP})
9319 @end group
9320 @end smallexample
9321
9322 @table @code
9323 @kindex set multiple-symbols
9324 @item set multiple-symbols @var{mode}
9325 @cindex multiple-symbols menu
9326
9327 This option allows you to adjust the debugger behavior when an expression
9328 is ambiguous.
9329
9330 By default, @var{mode} is set to @code{all}. If the command with which
9331 the expression is used allows more than one choice, then @value{GDBN}
9332 automatically selects all possible choices. For instance, inserting
9333 a breakpoint on a function using an ambiguous name results in a breakpoint
9334 inserted on each possible match. However, if a unique choice must be made,
9335 then @value{GDBN} uses the menu to help you disambiguate the expression.
9336 For instance, printing the address of an overloaded function will result
9337 in the use of the menu.
9338
9339 When @var{mode} is set to @code{ask}, the debugger always uses the menu
9340 when an ambiguity is detected.
9341
9342 Finally, when @var{mode} is set to @code{cancel}, the debugger reports
9343 an error due to the ambiguity and the command is aborted.
9344
9345 @kindex show multiple-symbols
9346 @item show multiple-symbols
9347 Show the current value of the @code{multiple-symbols} setting.
9348 @end table
9349
9350 @node Variables
9351 @section Program Variables
9352
9353 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
9354 in your program.
9355
9356 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
9357 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}); they must be either:
9358
9359 @itemize @bullet
9360 @item
9361 global (or file-static)
9362 @end itemize
9363
9364 @noindent or
9365
9366 @itemize @bullet
9367 @item
9368 visible according to the scope rules of the
9369 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
9370 @end itemize
9371
9372 @noindent This means that in the function
9373
9374 @smallexample
9375 foo (a)
9376 int a;
9377 @{
9378 bar (a);
9379 @{
9380 int b = test ();
9381 bar (b);
9382 @}
9383 @}
9384 @end smallexample
9385
9386 @noindent
9387 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
9388 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
9389 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
9390 the block where @code{b} is declared.
9391
9392 @cindex variable name conflict
9393 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
9394 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
9395 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
9396 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
9397 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
9398 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file by
9399 using the colon-colon (@code{::}) notation:
9400
9401 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
9402 @ifnotinfo
9403 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
9404 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
9405 @end ifnotinfo
9406 @smallexample
9407 @var{file}::@var{variable}
9408 @var{function}::@var{variable}
9409 @end smallexample
9410
9411 @noindent
9412 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
9413 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
9414 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
9415 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
9416
9417 @smallexample
9418 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
9419 @end smallexample
9420
9421 The @code{::} notation is normally used for referring to
9422 static variables, since you typically disambiguate uses of local variables
9423 in functions by selecting the appropriate frame and using the
9424 simple name of the variable. However, you may also use this notation
9425 to refer to local variables in frames enclosing the selected frame:
9426
9427 @smallexample
9428 void
9429 foo (int a)
9430 @{
9431 if (a < 10)
9432 bar (a);
9433 else
9434 process (a); /* Stop here */
9435 @}
9436
9437 int
9438 bar (int a)
9439 @{
9440 foo (a + 5);
9441 @}
9442 @end smallexample
9443
9444 @noindent
9445 For example, if there is a breakpoint at the commented line,
9446 here is what you might see
9447 when the program stops after executing the call @code{bar(0)}:
9448
9449 @smallexample
9450 (@value{GDBP}) p a
9451 $1 = 10
9452 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
9453 $2 = 5
9454 (@value{GDBP}) up 2
9455 #2 0x080483d0 in foo (a=5) at foobar.c:12
9456 (@value{GDBP}) p a
9457 $3 = 5
9458 (@value{GDBP}) p bar::a
9459 $4 = 0
9460 @end smallexample
9461
9462 @cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
9463 These uses of @samp{::} are very rarely in conflict with the very
9464 similar use of the same notation in C@t{++}. When they are in
9465 conflict, the C@t{++} meaning takes precedence; however, this can be
9466 overridden by quoting the file or function name with single quotes.
9467
9468 For example, suppose the program is stopped in a method of a class
9469 that has a field named @code{includefile}, and there is also an
9470 include file named @file{includefile} that defines a variable,
9471 @code{some_global}.
9472
9473 @smallexample
9474 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile
9475 $1 = 23
9476 (@value{GDBP}) p includefile::some_global
9477 A syntax error in expression, near `'.
9478 (@value{GDBP}) p 'includefile'::some_global
9479 $2 = 27
9480 @end smallexample
9481
9482 @cindex wrong values
9483 @cindex variable values, wrong
9484 @cindex function entry/exit, wrong values of variables
9485 @cindex optimized code, wrong values of variables
9486 @quotation
9487 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
9488 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
9489 scope, and just before exit.
9490 @end quotation
9491 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
9492 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
9493 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
9494 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
9495 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
9496 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
9497 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
9498 variable definitions may be gone.
9499
9500 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
9501 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
9502 when compiling.
9503
9504 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
9505 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
9506 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
9507 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
9508 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
9509 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
9510 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
9511
9512 @smallexample
9513 No symbol "foo" in current context.
9514 @end smallexample
9515
9516 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
9517 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
9518 formats. @xref{Compilation}, for more information on choosing compiler
9519 options. @xref{C, ,C and C@t{++}}, for more information about debug
9520 info formats that are best suited to C@t{++} programs.
9521
9522 If you ask to print an object whose contents are unknown to
9523 @value{GDBN}, e.g., because its data type is not completely specified
9524 by the debug information, @value{GDBN} will say @samp{<incomplete
9525 type>}. @xref{Symbols, incomplete type}, for more about this.
9526
9527 @cindex no debug info variables
9528 If you try to examine or use the value of a (global) variable for
9529 which @value{GDBN} has no type information, e.g., because the program
9530 includes no debug information, @value{GDBN} displays an error message.
9531 @xref{Symbols, unknown type}, for more about unknown types. If you
9532 cast the variable to its declared type, @value{GDBN} gets the
9533 variable's value using the cast-to type as the variable's type. For
9534 example, in a C program:
9535
9536 @smallexample
9537 (@value{GDBP}) p var
9538 'var' has unknown type; cast it to its declared type
9539 (@value{GDBP}) p (float) var
9540 $1 = 3.14
9541 @end smallexample
9542
9543 If you append @kbd{@@entry} string to a function parameter name you get its
9544 value at the time the function got called. If the value is not available an
9545 error message is printed. Entry values are available only with some compilers.
9546 Entry values are normally also printed at the function parameter list according
9547 to @ref{set print entry-values}.
9548
9549 @smallexample
9550 Breakpoint 1, d (i=30) at gdb.base/entry-value.c:29
9551 29 i++;
9552 (gdb) next
9553 30 e (i);
9554 (gdb) print i
9555 $1 = 31
9556 (gdb) print i@@entry
9557 $2 = 30
9558 @end smallexample
9559
9560 Strings are identified as arrays of @code{char} values without specified
9561 signedness. Arrays of either @code{signed char} or @code{unsigned char} get
9562 printed as arrays of 1 byte sized integers. @code{-fsigned-char} or
9563 @code{-funsigned-char} @value{NGCC} options have no effect as @value{GDBN}
9564 defines literal string type @code{"char"} as @code{char} without a sign.
9565 For program code
9566
9567 @smallexample
9568 char var0[] = "A";
9569 signed char var1[] = "A";
9570 @end smallexample
9571
9572 You get during debugging
9573 @smallexample
9574 (gdb) print var0
9575 $1 = "A"
9576 (gdb) print var1
9577 $2 = @{65 'A', 0 '\0'@}
9578 @end smallexample
9579
9580 @node Arrays
9581 @section Artificial Arrays
9582
9583 @cindex artificial array
9584 @cindex arrays
9585 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
9586 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
9587 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
9588 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
9589 program.
9590
9591 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
9592 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
9593 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
9594 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
9595 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
9596 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
9597 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
9598 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
9599 example. If a program says
9600
9601 @smallexample
9602 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
9603 @end smallexample
9604
9605 @noindent
9606 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
9607
9608 @smallexample
9609 p *array@@len
9610 @end smallexample
9611
9612 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
9613 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
9614 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
9615 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
9616 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value History}), after printing one out.
9617
9618 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
9619 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
9620 The value need not be in memory:
9621 @smallexample
9622 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
9623 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
9624 @end smallexample
9625
9626 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
9627 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
9628 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
9629 @smallexample
9630 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
9631 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
9632 @end smallexample
9633
9634 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
9635 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
9636 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
9637 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
9638 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
9639 Variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
9640 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
9641 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
9642 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
9643 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
9644
9645 @smallexample
9646 set $i = 0
9647 p dtab[$i++]->fv
9648 @key{RET}
9649 @key{RET}
9650 @dots{}
9651 @end smallexample
9652
9653 @node Output Formats
9654 @section Output Formats
9655
9656 @cindex formatted output
9657 @cindex output formats
9658 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
9659 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
9660 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
9661 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
9662 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
9663
9664 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
9665 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
9666 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
9667 letters supported are:
9668
9669 @table @code
9670 @item x
9671 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
9672 hexadecimal.
9673
9674 @item d
9675 Print as integer in signed decimal.
9676
9677 @item u
9678 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
9679
9680 @item o
9681 Print as integer in octal.
9682
9683 @item t
9684 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
9685 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
9686 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
9687 see @ref{Memory,,Examining Memory}.}
9688
9689 @item a
9690 @cindex unknown address, locating
9691 @cindex locate address
9692 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
9693 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
9694 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
9695
9696 @smallexample
9697 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
9698 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
9699 @end smallexample
9700
9701 @noindent
9702 The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
9703 @xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
9704
9705 @item c
9706 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant. This
9707 prints both the numerical value and its character representation. The
9708 character representation is replaced with the octal escape @samp{\nnn}
9709 for characters outside the 7-bit @sc{ascii} range.
9710
9711 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays @code{char},
9712 @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} data as character
9713 constants. Single-byte members of vectors are displayed as integer
9714 data.
9715
9716 @item f
9717 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
9718 using typical floating point syntax.
9719
9720 @item s
9721 @cindex printing strings
9722 @cindex printing byte arrays
9723 Regard as a string, if possible. With this format, pointers to single-byte
9724 data are displayed as null-terminated strings and arrays of single-byte data
9725 are displayed as fixed-length strings. Other values are displayed in their
9726 natural types.
9727
9728 Without this format, @value{GDBN} displays pointers to and arrays of
9729 @code{char}, @w{@code{unsigned char}}, and @w{@code{signed char}} as
9730 strings. Single-byte members of a vector are displayed as an integer
9731 array.
9732
9733 @item z
9734 Like @samp{x} formatting, the value is treated as an integer and
9735 printed as hexadecimal, but leading zeros are printed to pad the value
9736 to the size of the integer type.
9737
9738 @item r
9739 @cindex raw printing
9740 Print using the @samp{raw} formatting. By default, @value{GDBN} will
9741 use a Python-based pretty-printer, if one is available (@pxref{Pretty
9742 Printing}). This typically results in a higher-level display of the
9743 value's contents. The @samp{r} format bypasses any Python
9744 pretty-printer which might exist.
9745 @end table
9746
9747 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
9748
9749 @smallexample
9750 p/x $pc
9751 @end smallexample
9752
9753 @noindent
9754 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
9755 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
9756
9757 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
9758 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
9759 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
9760
9761 @node Memory
9762 @section Examining Memory
9763
9764 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
9765 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
9766
9767 @cindex examining memory
9768 @table @code
9769 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
9770 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
9771 @itemx x @var{addr}
9772 @itemx x
9773 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
9774 @end table
9775
9776 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
9777 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
9778 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
9779 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
9780 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
9781
9782 @table @r
9783 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
9784 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
9785 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display. If a negative
9786 number is specified, memory is examined backward from @var{addr}.
9787 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
9788 @c 4.1.2.
9789
9790 @item @var{f}, the display format
9791 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print}
9792 (@samp{x}, @samp{d}, @samp{u}, @samp{o}, @samp{t}, @samp{a}, @samp{c},
9793 @samp{f}, @samp{s}), and in addition @samp{i} (for machine instructions).
9794 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially. The default changes
9795 each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
9796
9797 @item @var{u}, the unit size
9798 The unit size is any of
9799
9800 @table @code
9801 @item b
9802 Bytes.
9803 @item h
9804 Halfwords (two bytes).
9805 @item w
9806 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
9807 @item g
9808 Giant words (eight bytes).
9809 @end table
9810
9811 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
9812 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. For the @samp{i} format,
9813 the unit size is ignored and is normally not written. For the @samp{s} format,
9814 the unit size defaults to @samp{b}, unless it is explicitly given.
9815 Use @kbd{x /hs} to display 16-bit char strings and @kbd{x /ws} to display
9816 32-bit strings. The next use of @kbd{x /s} will again display 8-bit strings.
9817 Note that the results depend on the programming language of the
9818 current compilation unit. If the language is C, the @samp{s}
9819 modifier will use the UTF-16 encoding while @samp{w} will use
9820 UTF-32. The encoding is set by the programming language and cannot
9821 be altered.
9822
9823 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
9824 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
9825 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
9826 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
9827 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
9828 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
9829 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
9830 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
9831 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
9832 a value from memory).
9833 @end table
9834
9835 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
9836 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
9837 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
9838 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
9839 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
9840
9841 You can also specify a negative repeat count to examine memory backward
9842 from the given address. For example, @samp{x/-3uh 0x54320} prints three
9843 halfwords (@code{h}) at @code{0x54314}, @code{0x54328}, and @code{0x5431c}.
9844
9845 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
9846 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
9847 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
9848 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
9849 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
9850
9851 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
9852 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
9853 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
9854 including any operands. For convenience, especially when used with
9855 the @code{display} command, the @samp{i} format also prints branch delay
9856 slot instructions, if any, beyond the count specified, which immediately
9857 follow the last instruction that is within the count. The command
9858 @code{disassemble} gives an alternative way of inspecting machine
9859 instructions; see @ref{Machine Code,,Source and Machine Code}.
9860
9861 If a negative repeat count is specified for the formats @samp{s} or @samp{i},
9862 the command displays null-terminated strings or instructions before the given
9863 address as many as the absolute value of the given number. For the @samp{i}
9864 format, we use line number information in the debug info to accurately locate
9865 instruction boundaries while disassembling backward. If line info is not
9866 available, the command stops examining memory with an error message.
9867
9868 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
9869 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
9870 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
9871 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
9872 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
9873 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
9874 for successive uses of @code{x}.
9875
9876 When examining machine instructions, the instruction at current program
9877 counter is shown with a @code{=>} marker. For example:
9878
9879 @smallexample
9880 (@value{GDBP}) x/5i $pc-6
9881 0x804837f <main+11>: mov %esp,%ebp
9882 0x8048381 <main+13>: push %ecx
9883 0x8048382 <main+14>: sub $0x4,%esp
9884 => 0x8048385 <main+17>: movl $0x8048460,(%esp)
9885 0x804838c <main+24>: call 0x80482d4 <puts@@plt>
9886 @end smallexample
9887
9888 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
9889 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
9890 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
9891 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
9892 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
9893 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
9894 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
9895 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
9896 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
9897
9898 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
9899 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
9900 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
9901
9902 @anchor{addressable memory unit}
9903 @cindex addressable memory unit
9904 Most targets have an addressable memory unit size of 8 bits. This means
9905 that to each memory address are associated 8 bits of data. Some
9906 targets, however, have other addressable memory unit sizes.
9907 Within @value{GDBN} and this document, the term
9908 @dfn{addressable memory unit} (or @dfn{memory unit} for short) is used
9909 when explicitly referring to a chunk of data of that size. The word
9910 @dfn{byte} is used to refer to a chunk of data of 8 bits, regardless of
9911 the addressable memory unit size of the target. For most systems,
9912 addressable memory unit is a synonym of byte.
9913
9914 @cindex remote memory comparison
9915 @cindex target memory comparison
9916 @cindex verify remote memory image
9917 @cindex verify target memory image
9918 When you are debugging a program running on a remote target machine
9919 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), you may wish to verify the program's image
9920 in the remote machine's memory against the executable file you
9921 downloaded to the target. Or, on any target, you may want to check
9922 whether the program has corrupted its own read-only sections. The
9923 @code{compare-sections} command is provided for such situations.
9924
9925 @table @code
9926 @kindex compare-sections
9927 @item compare-sections @r{[}@var{section-name}@r{|}@code{-r}@r{]}
9928 Compare the data of a loadable section @var{section-name} in the
9929 executable file of the program being debugged with the same section in
9930 the target machine's memory, and report any mismatches. With no
9931 arguments, compares all loadable sections. With an argument of
9932 @code{-r}, compares all loadable read-only sections.
9933
9934 Note: for remote targets, this command can be accelerated if the
9935 target supports computing the CRC checksum of a block of memory
9936 (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
9937 @end table
9938
9939 @node Auto Display
9940 @section Automatic Display
9941 @cindex automatic display
9942 @cindex display of expressions
9943
9944 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
9945 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
9946 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
9947 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
9948 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
9949 The automatic display looks like this:
9950
9951 @smallexample
9952 2: foo = 38
9953 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
9954 @end smallexample
9955
9956 @noindent
9957 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
9958 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
9959 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
9960 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending your format
9961 specification---it uses @code{x} if you specify either the @samp{i}
9962 or @samp{s} format, or a unit size; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
9963
9964 @table @code
9965 @kindex display
9966 @item display @var{expr}
9967 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
9968 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
9969
9970 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
9971
9972 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
9973 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
9974 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
9975 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
9976 @xref{Output Formats,,Output Formats}.
9977
9978 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
9979 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
9980 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
9981 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
9982 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}.
9983 @end table
9984
9985 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
9986 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
9987 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
9988
9989 @table @code
9990 @kindex delete display
9991 @kindex undisplay
9992 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
9993 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
9994 Remove items from the list of expressions to display. Specify the
9995 numbers of the displays that you want affected with the command
9996 argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one of the
9997 numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display} display;
9998 or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
9999
10000 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
10001 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
10002
10003 @kindex disable display
10004 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
10005 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
10006 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
10007 enabled again later. Specify the numbers of the displays that you
10008 want affected with the command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a
10009 single display number, one of the numbers shown in the first field of
10010 the @samp{info display} display; or it could be a range of display
10011 numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
10012
10013 @kindex enable display
10014 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
10015 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
10016 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
10017 Specify the numbers of the displays that you want affected with the
10018 command argument @var{dnums}. It can be a single display number, one
10019 of the numbers shown in the first field of the @samp{info display}
10020 display; or it could be a range of display numbers, as in @code{2-4}.
10021
10022 @item display
10023 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
10024 done when your program stops.
10025
10026 @kindex info display
10027 @item info display
10028 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
10029 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
10030 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
10031 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
10032 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
10033 @end table
10034
10035 @cindex display disabled out of scope
10036 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
10037 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
10038 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
10039 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
10040 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
10041 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
10042 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
10043 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
10044 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
10045 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
10046
10047 @node Print Settings
10048 @section Print Settings
10049
10050 @cindex format options
10051 @cindex print settings
10052 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
10053 and symbols are printed.
10054
10055 @noindent
10056 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
10057
10058 @table @code
10059 @kindex set print
10060 @item set print address
10061 @itemx set print address on
10062 @cindex print/don't print memory addresses
10063 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
10064 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
10065 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
10066 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
10067 @code{set print address on}:
10068
10069 @smallexample
10070 @group
10071 (@value{GDBP}) f
10072 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
10073 at input.c:530
10074 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
10075 @end group
10076 @end smallexample
10077
10078 @item set print address off
10079 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
10080 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
10081
10082 @smallexample
10083 @group
10084 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
10085 (@value{GDBP}) f
10086 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
10087 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
10088 @end group
10089 @end smallexample
10090
10091 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
10092 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
10093 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
10094 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
10095
10096 @kindex show print
10097 @item show print address
10098 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
10099 @end table
10100
10101 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
10102 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
10103 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
10104 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
10105 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
10106 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
10107 it prints a symbolic address:
10108
10109 @table @code
10110 @item set print symbol-filename on
10111 @cindex source file and line of a symbol
10112 @cindex symbol, source file and line
10113 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
10114 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
10115
10116 @item set print symbol-filename off
10117 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
10118 default.
10119
10120 @item show print symbol-filename
10121 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
10122 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
10123 @end table
10124
10125 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
10126 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
10127 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
10128
10129 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
10130 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
10131
10132 @table @code
10133 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
10134 @itemx set print max-symbolic-offset unlimited
10135 @cindex maximum value for offset of closest symbol
10136 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
10137 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
10138 @var{max-offset}. The default is @code{unlimited}, which tells @value{GDBN}
10139 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes
10140 it. Zero is equivalent to @code{unlimited}.
10141
10142 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
10143 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
10144 symbolic address.
10145 @end table
10146
10147 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
10148 @cindex pointer, finding referent
10149 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
10150 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
10151 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
10152 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
10153 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
10154 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
10155
10156 @smallexample
10157 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
10158 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
10159 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
10160 @end smallexample
10161
10162 @quotation
10163 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
10164 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
10165 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
10166 @end quotation
10167
10168 You can also enable @samp{/a}-like formatting all the time using
10169 @samp{set print symbol on}:
10170
10171 @table @code
10172 @item set print symbol on
10173 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the symbol corresponding to an address, if
10174 one exists.
10175
10176 @item set print symbol off
10177 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print the symbol corresponding to an
10178 address. In this mode, @value{GDBN} will still print the symbol
10179 corresponding to pointers to functions. This is the default.
10180
10181 @item show print symbol
10182 Show whether @value{GDBN} will display the symbol corresponding to an
10183 address.
10184 @end table
10185
10186 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
10187
10188 @table @code
10189 @item set print array
10190 @itemx set print array on
10191 @cindex pretty print arrays
10192 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
10193 but uses more space. The default is off.
10194
10195 @item set print array off
10196 Return to compressed format for arrays.
10197
10198 @item show print array
10199 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
10200 arrays.
10201
10202 @cindex print array indexes
10203 @item set print array-indexes
10204 @itemx set print array-indexes on
10205 Print the index of each element when displaying arrays. May be more
10206 convenient to locate a given element in the array or quickly find the
10207 index of a given element in that printed array. The default is off.
10208
10209 @item set print array-indexes off
10210 Stop printing element indexes when displaying arrays.
10211
10212 @item show print array-indexes
10213 Show whether the index of each element is printed when displaying
10214 arrays.
10215
10216 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
10217 @itemx set print elements unlimited
10218 @cindex number of array elements to print
10219 @cindex limit on number of printed array elements
10220 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
10221 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
10222 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
10223 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
10224 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
10225 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to @code{unlimited} or zero means
10226 that the number of elements to print is unlimited.
10227
10228 @item show print elements
10229 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
10230 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
10231
10232 @item set print frame-arguments @var{value}
10233 @kindex set print frame-arguments
10234 @cindex printing frame argument values
10235 @cindex print all frame argument values
10236 @cindex print frame argument values for scalars only
10237 @cindex do not print frame argument values
10238 This command allows to control how the values of arguments are printed
10239 when the debugger prints a frame (@pxref{Frames}). The possible
10240 values are:
10241
10242 @table @code
10243 @item all
10244 The values of all arguments are printed.
10245
10246 @item scalars
10247 Print the value of an argument only if it is a scalar. The value of more
10248 complex arguments such as arrays, structures, unions, etc, is replaced
10249 by @code{@dots{}}. This is the default. Here is an example where
10250 only scalar arguments are shown:
10251
10252 @smallexample
10253 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=3, s=@dots{}, ss=0xbf8d508c, u=@dots{}, e=green)
10254 at frame-args.c:23
10255 @end smallexample
10256
10257 @item none
10258 None of the argument values are printed. Instead, the value of each argument
10259 is replaced by @code{@dots{}}. In this case, the example above now becomes:
10260
10261 @smallexample
10262 #1 0x08048361 in call_me (i=@dots{}, s=@dots{}, ss=@dots{}, u=@dots{}, e=@dots{})
10263 at frame-args.c:23
10264 @end smallexample
10265 @end table
10266
10267 By default, only scalar arguments are printed. This command can be used
10268 to configure the debugger to print the value of all arguments, regardless
10269 of their type. However, it is often advantageous to not print the value
10270 of more complex parameters. For instance, it reduces the amount of
10271 information printed in each frame, making the backtrace more readable.
10272 Also, it improves performance when displaying Ada frames, because
10273 the computation of large arguments can sometimes be CPU-intensive,
10274 especially in large applications. Setting @code{print frame-arguments}
10275 to @code{scalars} (the default) or @code{none} avoids this computation,
10276 thus speeding up the display of each Ada frame.
10277
10278 @item show print frame-arguments
10279 Show how the value of arguments should be displayed when printing a frame.
10280
10281 @item set print raw frame-arguments on
10282 Print frame arguments in raw, non pretty-printed, form.
10283
10284 @item set print raw frame-arguments off
10285 Print frame arguments in pretty-printed form, if there is a pretty-printer
10286 for the value (@pxref{Pretty Printing}),
10287 otherwise print the value in raw form.
10288 This is the default.
10289
10290 @item show print raw frame-arguments
10291 Show whether to print frame arguments in raw form.
10292
10293 @anchor{set print entry-values}
10294 @item set print entry-values @var{value}
10295 @kindex set print entry-values
10296 Set printing of frame argument values at function entry. In some cases
10297 @value{GDBN} can determine the value of function argument which was passed by
10298 the function caller, even if the value was modified inside the called function
10299 and therefore is different. With optimized code, the current value could be
10300 unavailable, but the entry value may still be known.
10301
10302 The default value is @code{default} (see below for its description). Older
10303 @value{GDBN} behaved as with the setting @code{no}. Compilers not supporting
10304 this feature will behave in the @code{default} setting the same way as with the
10305 @code{no} setting.
10306
10307 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
10308 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_call_site} tags. With
10309 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
10310 this information.
10311
10312 The @var{value} parameter can be one of the following:
10313
10314 @table @code
10315 @item no
10316 Print only actual parameter values, never print values from function entry
10317 point.
10318 @smallexample
10319 #0 equal (val=5)
10320 #0 different (val=6)
10321 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>)
10322 #0 born (val=10)
10323 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
10324 @end smallexample
10325
10326 @item only
10327 Print only parameter values from function entry point. The actual parameter
10328 values are never printed.
10329 @smallexample
10330 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
10331 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
10332 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
10333 #0 born (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10334 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10335 @end smallexample
10336
10337 @item preferred
10338 Print only parameter values from function entry point. If value from function
10339 entry point is not known while the actual value is known, print the actual
10340 value for such parameter.
10341 @smallexample
10342 #0 equal (val@@entry=5)
10343 #0 different (val@@entry=5)
10344 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
10345 #0 born (val=10)
10346 #0 invalid (val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10347 @end smallexample
10348
10349 @item if-needed
10350 Print actual parameter values. If actual parameter value is not known while
10351 value from function entry point is known, print the entry point value for such
10352 parameter.
10353 @smallexample
10354 #0 equal (val=5)
10355 #0 different (val=6)
10356 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
10357 #0 born (val=10)
10358 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
10359 @end smallexample
10360
10361 @item both
10362 Always print both the actual parameter value and its value from function entry
10363 point, even if values of one or both are not available due to compiler
10364 optimizations.
10365 @smallexample
10366 #0 equal (val=5, val@@entry=5)
10367 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
10368 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
10369 #0 born (val=10, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10370 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=<optimized out>)
10371 @end smallexample
10372
10373 @item compact
10374 Print the actual parameter value if it is known and also its value from
10375 function entry point if it is known. If neither is known, print for the actual
10376 value @code{<optimized out>}. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and if both
10377 values are known and identical, print the shortened
10378 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
10379 @smallexample
10380 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
10381 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
10382 #0 lost (val@@entry=5)
10383 #0 born (val=10)
10384 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
10385 @end smallexample
10386
10387 @item default
10388 Always print the actual parameter value. Print also its value from function
10389 entry point, but only if it is known. If not in MI mode (@pxref{GDB/MI}) and
10390 if both values are known and identical, print the shortened
10391 @code{param=param@@entry=VALUE} notation.
10392 @smallexample
10393 #0 equal (val=val@@entry=5)
10394 #0 different (val=6, val@@entry=5)
10395 #0 lost (val=<optimized out>, val@@entry=5)
10396 #0 born (val=10)
10397 #0 invalid (val=<optimized out>)
10398 @end smallexample
10399 @end table
10400
10401 For analysis messages on possible failures of frame argument values at function
10402 entry resolution see @ref{set debug entry-values}.
10403
10404 @item show print entry-values
10405 Show the method being used for printing of frame argument values at function
10406 entry.
10407
10408 @item set print repeats @var{number-of-repeats}
10409 @itemx set print repeats unlimited
10410 @cindex repeated array elements
10411 Set the threshold for suppressing display of repeated array
10412 elements. When the number of consecutive identical elements of an
10413 array exceeds the threshold, @value{GDBN} prints the string
10414 @code{"<repeats @var{n} times>"}, where @var{n} is the number of
10415 identical repetitions, instead of displaying the identical elements
10416 themselves. Setting the threshold to @code{unlimited} or zero will
10417 cause all elements to be individually printed. The default threshold
10418 is 10.
10419
10420 @item show print repeats
10421 Display the current threshold for printing repeated identical
10422 elements.
10423
10424 @item set print null-stop
10425 @cindex @sc{null} elements in arrays
10426 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
10427 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
10428 contain only short strings.
10429 The default is off.
10430
10431 @item show print null-stop
10432 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops printing an array on the first
10433 @sc{null} character.
10434
10435 @item set print pretty on
10436 @cindex print structures in indented form
10437 @cindex indentation in structure display
10438 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
10439 per line, like this:
10440
10441 @smallexample
10442 @group
10443 $1 = @{
10444 next = 0x0,
10445 flags = @{
10446 sweet = 1,
10447 sour = 1
10448 @},
10449 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
10450 @}
10451 @end group
10452 @end smallexample
10453
10454 @item set print pretty off
10455 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
10456
10457 @smallexample
10458 @group
10459 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
10460 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
10461 @end group
10462 @end smallexample
10463
10464 @noindent
10465 This is the default format.
10466
10467 @item show print pretty
10468 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
10469
10470 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
10471 @cindex eight-bit characters in strings
10472 @cindex octal escapes in strings
10473 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
10474 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
10475 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
10476 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
10477 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
10478
10479 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
10480 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
10481 international character sets, and is the default.
10482
10483 @item show print sevenbit-strings
10484 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
10485
10486 @item set print union on
10487 @cindex unions in structures, printing
10488 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures
10489 and other unions. This is the default setting.
10490
10491 @item set print union off
10492 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in
10493 structures and other unions. @value{GDBN} will print @code{"@{...@}"}
10494 instead.
10495
10496 @item show print union
10497 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
10498 structures and other unions.
10499
10500 For example, given the declarations
10501
10502 @smallexample
10503 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
10504 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
10505 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
10506 Bug_forms;
10507
10508 struct thing @{
10509 Species it;
10510 union @{
10511 Tree_forms tree;
10512 Bug_forms bug;
10513 @} form;
10514 @};
10515
10516 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
10517 @end smallexample
10518
10519 @noindent
10520 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
10521
10522 @smallexample
10523 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
10524 @end smallexample
10525
10526 @noindent
10527 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
10528
10529 @smallexample
10530 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
10531 @end smallexample
10532
10533 @noindent
10534 @code{set print union} affects programs written in C-like languages
10535 and in Pascal.
10536 @end table
10537
10538 @need 1000
10539 @noindent
10540 These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
10541
10542 @table @code
10543 @cindex demangling C@t{++} names
10544 @item set print demangle
10545 @itemx set print demangle on
10546 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
10547 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
10548 linkage. The default is on.
10549
10550 @item show print demangle
10551 Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
10552
10553 @item set print asm-demangle
10554 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
10555 Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
10556 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
10557 The default is off.
10558
10559 @item show print asm-demangle
10560 Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
10561 or demangled form.
10562
10563 @cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
10564 @cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
10565 @kindex set demangle-style
10566 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
10567 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
10568 represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
10569
10570 @table @code
10571 @item auto
10572 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
10573 This is the default.
10574
10575 @item gnu
10576 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
10577
10578 @item hp
10579 Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
10580
10581 @item lucid
10582 Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
10583
10584 @item arm
10585 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
10586 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
10587 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
10588 require further enhancement to permit that.
10589
10590 @end table
10591 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
10592
10593 @item show demangle-style
10594 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
10595
10596 @item set print object
10597 @itemx set print object on
10598 @cindex derived type of an object, printing
10599 @cindex display derived types
10600 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
10601 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
10602 the virtual function table. Note that the virtual function table is
10603 required---this feature can only work for objects that have run-time
10604 type identification; a single virtual method in the object's declared
10605 type is sufficient. Note that this setting is also taken into account when
10606 working with variable objects via MI (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
10607
10608 @item set print object off
10609 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
10610 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
10611
10612 @item show print object
10613 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
10614
10615 @item set print static-members
10616 @itemx set print static-members on
10617 @cindex static members of C@t{++} objects
10618 Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
10619
10620 @item set print static-members off
10621 Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
10622
10623 @item show print static-members
10624 Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed or not.
10625
10626 @item set print pascal_static-members
10627 @itemx set print pascal_static-members on
10628 @cindex static members of Pascal objects
10629 @cindex Pascal objects, static members display
10630 Print static members when displaying a Pascal object. The default is on.
10631
10632 @item set print pascal_static-members off
10633 Do not print static members when displaying a Pascal object.
10634
10635 @item show print pascal_static-members
10636 Show whether Pascal static members are printed or not.
10637
10638 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
10639 @item set print vtbl
10640 @itemx set print vtbl on
10641 @cindex pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables
10642 @cindex virtual functions (C@t{++}) display
10643 @cindex VTBL display
10644 Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
10645 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
10646 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
10647
10648 @item set print vtbl off
10649 Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
10650
10651 @item show print vtbl
10652 Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
10653 @end table
10654
10655 @node Pretty Printing
10656 @section Pretty Printing
10657
10658 @value{GDBN} provides a mechanism to allow pretty-printing of values using
10659 Python code. It greatly simplifies the display of complex objects. This
10660 mechanism works for both MI and the CLI.
10661
10662 @menu
10663 * Pretty-Printer Introduction:: Introduction to pretty-printers
10664 * Pretty-Printer Example:: An example pretty-printer
10665 * Pretty-Printer Commands:: Pretty-printer commands
10666 @end menu
10667
10668 @node Pretty-Printer Introduction
10669 @subsection Pretty-Printer Introduction
10670
10671 When @value{GDBN} prints a value, it first sees if there is a pretty-printer
10672 registered for the value. If there is then @value{GDBN} invokes the
10673 pretty-printer to print the value. Otherwise the value is printed normally.
10674
10675 Pretty-printers are normally named. This makes them easy to manage.
10676 The @samp{info pretty-printer} command will list all the installed
10677 pretty-printers with their names.
10678 If a pretty-printer can handle multiple data types, then its
10679 @dfn{subprinters} are the printers for the individual data types.
10680 Each such subprinter has its own name.
10681 The format of the name is @var{printer-name};@var{subprinter-name}.
10682
10683 Pretty-printers are installed by @dfn{registering} them with @value{GDBN}.
10684 Typically they are automatically loaded and registered when the corresponding
10685 debug information is loaded, thus making them available without having to
10686 do anything special.
10687
10688 There are three places where a pretty-printer can be registered.
10689
10690 @itemize @bullet
10691 @item
10692 Pretty-printers registered globally are available when debugging
10693 all inferiors.
10694
10695 @item
10696 Pretty-printers registered with a program space are available only
10697 when debugging that program.
10698 @xref{Progspaces In Python}, for more details on program spaces in Python.
10699
10700 @item
10701 Pretty-printers registered with an objfile are loaded and unloaded
10702 with the corresponding objfile (e.g., shared library).
10703 @xref{Objfiles In Python}, for more details on objfiles in Python.
10704 @end itemize
10705
10706 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for further information on how
10707 pretty-printers are selected,
10708
10709 @xref{Writing a Pretty-Printer}, for implementing pretty printers
10710 for new types.
10711
10712 @node Pretty-Printer Example
10713 @subsection Pretty-Printer Example
10714
10715 Here is how a C@t{++} @code{std::string} looks without a pretty-printer:
10716
10717 @smallexample
10718 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10719 $1 = @{
10720 static npos = 4294967295,
10721 _M_dataplus = @{
10722 <std::allocator<char>> = @{
10723 <__gnu_cxx::new_allocator<char>> = @{
10724 <No data fields>@}, <No data fields>
10725 @},
10726 members of std::basic_string<char, std::char_traits<char>,
10727 std::allocator<char> >::_Alloc_hider:
10728 _M_p = 0x804a014 "abcd"
10729 @}
10730 @}
10731 @end smallexample
10732
10733 With a pretty-printer for @code{std::string} only the contents are printed:
10734
10735 @smallexample
10736 (@value{GDBP}) print s
10737 $2 = "abcd"
10738 @end smallexample
10739
10740 @node Pretty-Printer Commands
10741 @subsection Pretty-Printer Commands
10742 @cindex pretty-printer commands
10743
10744 @table @code
10745 @kindex info pretty-printer
10746 @item info pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10747 Print the list of installed pretty-printers.
10748 This includes disabled pretty-printers, which are marked as such.
10749
10750 @var{object-regexp} is a regular expression matching the objects
10751 whose pretty-printers to list.
10752 Objects can be @code{global}, the program space's file
10753 (@pxref{Progspaces In Python}),
10754 and the object files within that program space (@pxref{Objfiles In Python}).
10755 @xref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}, for details on how @value{GDBN}
10756 looks up a printer from these three objects.
10757
10758 @var{name-regexp} is a regular expression matching the name of the printers
10759 to list.
10760
10761 @kindex disable pretty-printer
10762 @item disable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10763 Disable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
10764 A disabled pretty-printer is not forgotten, it may be enabled again later.
10765
10766 @kindex enable pretty-printer
10767 @item enable pretty-printer [@var{object-regexp} [@var{name-regexp}]]
10768 Enable pretty-printers matching @var{object-regexp} and @var{name-regexp}.
10769 @end table
10770
10771 Example:
10772
10773 Suppose we have three pretty-printers installed: one from library1.so
10774 named @code{foo} that prints objects of type @code{foo}, and
10775 another from library2.so named @code{bar} that prints two types of objects,
10776 @code{bar1} and @code{bar2}.
10777
10778 @smallexample
10779 (gdb) info pretty-printer
10780 library1.so:
10781 foo
10782 library2.so:
10783 bar
10784 bar1
10785 bar2
10786 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10787 library2.so:
10788 bar
10789 bar1
10790 bar2
10791 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library1
10792 1 printer disabled
10793 2 of 3 printers enabled
10794 (gdb) info pretty-printer
10795 library1.so:
10796 foo [disabled]
10797 library2.so:
10798 bar
10799 bar1
10800 bar2
10801 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar:bar1
10802 1 printer disabled
10803 1 of 3 printers enabled
10804 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10805 library1.so:
10806 foo [disabled]
10807 library2.so:
10808 bar
10809 bar1 [disabled]
10810 bar2
10811 (gdb) disable pretty-printer library2 bar
10812 1 printer disabled
10813 0 of 3 printers enabled
10814 (gdb) info pretty-printer library2
10815 library1.so:
10816 foo [disabled]
10817 library2.so:
10818 bar [disabled]
10819 bar1 [disabled]
10820 bar2
10821 @end smallexample
10822
10823 Note that for @code{bar} the entire printer can be disabled,
10824 as can each individual subprinter.
10825
10826 @node Value History
10827 @section Value History
10828
10829 @cindex value history
10830 @cindex history of values printed by @value{GDBN}
10831 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
10832 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
10833 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
10834 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
10835 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
10836 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
10837 symbol table.
10838
10839 @cindex @code{$}
10840 @cindex @code{$$}
10841 @cindex history number
10842 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
10843 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
10844 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
10845 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
10846 history number.
10847
10848 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
10849 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
10850 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
10851 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
10852 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
10853 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
10854 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
10855
10856 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
10857 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
10858
10859 @smallexample
10860 p *$
10861 @end smallexample
10862
10863 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
10864 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
10865
10866 @smallexample
10867 p *$.next
10868 @end smallexample
10869
10870 @noindent
10871 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
10872 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
10873
10874 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
10875 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
10876
10877 @smallexample
10878 print x
10879 set x=5
10880 @end smallexample
10881
10882 @noindent
10883 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
10884 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
10885
10886 @table @code
10887 @kindex show values
10888 @item show values
10889 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
10890 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
10891 values} does not change the history.
10892
10893 @item show values @var{n}
10894 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
10895
10896 @item show values +
10897 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
10898 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
10899 @end table
10900
10901 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
10902 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
10903
10904 @node Convenience Vars
10905 @section Convenience Variables
10906
10907 @cindex convenience variables
10908 @cindex user-defined variables
10909 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
10910 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
10911 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
10912 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
10913 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
10914
10915 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
10916 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
10917 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
10918 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
10919 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value History}.)
10920
10921 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
10922 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
10923 For example:
10924
10925 @smallexample
10926 set $foo = *object_ptr
10927 @end smallexample
10928
10929 @noindent
10930 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
10931 @code{object_ptr}.
10932
10933 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
10934 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
10935 value with another assignment at any time.
10936
10937 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
10938 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
10939 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
10940 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
10941
10942 @table @code
10943 @kindex show convenience
10944 @cindex show all user variables and functions
10945 @item show convenience
10946 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values,
10947 as well as a list of the convenience functions.
10948 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
10949
10950 @kindex init-if-undefined
10951 @cindex convenience variables, initializing
10952 @item init-if-undefined $@var{variable} = @var{expression}
10953 Set a convenience variable if it has not already been set. This is useful
10954 for user-defined commands that keep some state. It is similar, in concept,
10955 to using local static variables with initializers in C (except that
10956 convenience variables are global). It can also be used to allow users to
10957 override default values used in a command script.
10958
10959 If the variable is already defined then the expression is not evaluated so
10960 any side-effects do not occur.
10961 @end table
10962
10963 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
10964 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
10965 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
10966
10967 @smallexample
10968 set $i = 0
10969 print bar[$i++]->contents
10970 @end smallexample
10971
10972 @noindent
10973 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
10974
10975 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
10976 values likely to be useful.
10977
10978 @table @code
10979 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
10980 @item $_
10981 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
10982 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining Memory}). Other
10983 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
10984 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
10985 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
10986 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
10987 to the type of @code{$__}.
10988
10989 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
10990 @item $__
10991 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
10992 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
10993 to match the format in which the data was printed.
10994
10995 @item $_exitcode
10996 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
10997 When the program being debugged terminates normally, @value{GDBN}
10998 automatically sets this variable to the exit code of the program, and
10999 resets @code{$_exitsignal} to @code{void}.
11000
11001 @item $_exitsignal
11002 @vindex $_exitsignal@r{, convenience variable}
11003 When the program being debugged dies due to an uncaught signal,
11004 @value{GDBN} automatically sets this variable to that signal's number,
11005 and resets @code{$_exitcode} to @code{void}.
11006
11007 To distinguish between whether the program being debugged has exited
11008 (i.e., @code{$_exitcode} is not @code{void}) or signalled (i.e.,
11009 @code{$_exitsignal} is not @code{void}), the convenience function
11010 @code{$_isvoid} can be used (@pxref{Convenience Funs,, Convenience
11011 Functions}). For example, considering the following source code:
11012
11013 @smallexample
11014 #include <signal.h>
11015
11016 int
11017 main (int argc, char *argv[])
11018 @{
11019 raise (SIGALRM);
11020 return 0;
11021 @}
11022 @end smallexample
11023
11024 A valid way of telling whether the program being debugged has exited
11025 or signalled would be:
11026
11027 @smallexample
11028 (@value{GDBP}) define has_exited_or_signalled
11029 Type commands for definition of ``has_exited_or_signalled''.
11030 End with a line saying just ``end''.
11031 >if $_isvoid ($_exitsignal)
11032 >echo The program has exited\n
11033 >else
11034 >echo The program has signalled\n
11035 >end
11036 >end
11037 (@value{GDBP}) run
11038 Starting program:
11039
11040 Program terminated with signal SIGALRM, Alarm clock.
11041 The program no longer exists.
11042 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
11043 The program has signalled
11044 @end smallexample
11045
11046 As can be seen, @value{GDBN} correctly informs that the program being
11047 debugged has signalled, since it calls @code{raise} and raises a
11048 @code{SIGALRM} signal. If the program being debugged had not called
11049 @code{raise}, then @value{GDBN} would report a normal exit:
11050
11051 @smallexample
11052 (@value{GDBP}) has_exited_or_signalled
11053 The program has exited
11054 @end smallexample
11055
11056 @item $_exception
11057 The variable @code{$_exception} is set to the exception object being
11058 thrown at an exception-related catchpoint. @xref{Set Catchpoints}.
11059
11060 @item $_probe_argc
11061 @itemx $_probe_arg0@dots{}$_probe_arg11
11062 Arguments to a static probe. @xref{Static Probe Points}.
11063
11064 @item $_sdata
11065 @vindex $_sdata@r{, inspect, convenience variable}
11066 The variable @code{$_sdata} contains extra collected static tracepoint
11067 data. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}. Note that
11068 @code{$_sdata} could be empty, if not inspecting a trace buffer, or
11069 if extra static tracepoint data has not been collected.
11070
11071 @item $_siginfo
11072 @vindex $_siginfo@r{, convenience variable}
11073 The variable @code{$_siginfo} contains extra signal information
11074 (@pxref{extra signal information}). Note that @code{$_siginfo}
11075 could be empty, if the application has not yet received any signals.
11076 For example, it will be empty before you execute the @code{run} command.
11077
11078 @item $_tlb
11079 @vindex $_tlb@r{, convenience variable}
11080 The variable @code{$_tlb} is automatically set when debugging
11081 applications running on MS-Windows in native mode or connected to
11082 gdbserver that supports the @code{qGetTIBAddr} request.
11083 @xref{General Query Packets}.
11084 This variable contains the address of the thread information block.
11085
11086 @item $_inferior
11087 The number of the current inferior. @xref{Inferiors and
11088 Programs, ,Debugging Multiple Inferiors and Programs}.
11089
11090 @item $_thread
11091 The thread number of the current thread. @xref{thread numbers}.
11092
11093 @item $_gthread
11094 The global number of the current thread. @xref{global thread numbers}.
11095
11096 @end table
11097
11098 @node Convenience Funs
11099 @section Convenience Functions
11100
11101 @cindex convenience functions
11102 @value{GDBN} also supplies some @dfn{convenience functions}. These
11103 have a syntax similar to convenience variables. A convenience
11104 function can be used in an expression just like an ordinary function;
11105 however, a convenience function is implemented internally to
11106 @value{GDBN}.
11107
11108 These functions do not require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
11109 @code{Python} support, which means that they are always available.
11110
11111 @table @code
11112
11113 @item $_isvoid (@var{expr})
11114 @findex $_isvoid@r{, convenience function}
11115 Return one if the expression @var{expr} is @code{void}. Otherwise it
11116 returns zero.
11117
11118 A @code{void} expression is an expression where the type of the result
11119 is @code{void}. For example, you can examine a convenience variable
11120 (see @ref{Convenience Vars,, Convenience Variables}) to check whether
11121 it is @code{void}:
11122
11123 @smallexample
11124 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
11125 $1 = void
11126 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
11127 $2 = 1
11128 (@value{GDBP}) run
11129 Starting program: ./a.out
11130 [Inferior 1 (process 29572) exited normally]
11131 (@value{GDBP}) print $_exitcode
11132 $3 = 0
11133 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($_exitcode)
11134 $4 = 0
11135 @end smallexample
11136
11137 In the example above, we used @code{$_isvoid} to check whether
11138 @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void} before and after the execution of the
11139 program being debugged. Before the execution there is no exit code to
11140 be examined, therefore @code{$_exitcode} is @code{void}. After the
11141 execution the program being debugged returned zero, therefore
11142 @code{$_exitcode} is zero, which means that it is not @code{void}
11143 anymore.
11144
11145 The @code{void} expression can also be a call of a function from the
11146 program being debugged. For example, given the following function:
11147
11148 @smallexample
11149 void
11150 foo (void)
11151 @{
11152 @}
11153 @end smallexample
11154
11155 The result of calling it inside @value{GDBN} is @code{void}:
11156
11157 @smallexample
11158 (@value{GDBP}) print foo ()
11159 $1 = void
11160 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid (foo ())
11161 $2 = 1
11162 (@value{GDBP}) set $v = foo ()
11163 (@value{GDBP}) print $v
11164 $3 = void
11165 (@value{GDBP}) print $_isvoid ($v)
11166 $4 = 1
11167 @end smallexample
11168
11169 @end table
11170
11171 These functions require @value{GDBN} to be configured with
11172 @code{Python} support.
11173
11174 @table @code
11175
11176 @item $_memeq(@var{buf1}, @var{buf2}, @var{length})
11177 @findex $_memeq@r{, convenience function}
11178 Returns one if the @var{length} bytes at the addresses given by
11179 @var{buf1} and @var{buf2} are equal.
11180 Otherwise it returns zero.
11181
11182 @item $_regex(@var{str}, @var{regex})
11183 @findex $_regex@r{, convenience function}
11184 Returns one if the string @var{str} matches the regular expression
11185 @var{regex}. Otherwise it returns zero.
11186 The syntax of the regular expression is that specified by @code{Python}'s
11187 regular expression support.
11188
11189 @item $_streq(@var{str1}, @var{str2})
11190 @findex $_streq@r{, convenience function}
11191 Returns one if the strings @var{str1} and @var{str2} are equal.
11192 Otherwise it returns zero.
11193
11194 @item $_strlen(@var{str})
11195 @findex $_strlen@r{, convenience function}
11196 Returns the length of string @var{str}.
11197
11198 @item $_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
11199 @findex $_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
11200 Returns one if the calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
11201 Otherwise it returns zero.
11202
11203 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
11204 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
11205 The default is 1.
11206
11207 Example:
11208
11209 @smallexample
11210 (gdb) backtrace
11211 #0 bottom_func ()
11212 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:21
11213 #1 0x00000000004005a0 in middle_func ()
11214 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:27
11215 #2 0x00000000004005ab in top_func ()
11216 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:33
11217 #3 0x00000000004005b6 in main ()
11218 at testsuite/gdb.python/py-caller-is.c:39
11219 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("middle_func")
11220 $1 = 1
11221 (gdb) print $_caller_is ("top_func", 2)
11222 $1 = 1
11223 @end smallexample
11224
11225 @item $_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
11226 @findex $_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
11227 Returns one if the calling function's name matches the regular expression
11228 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
11229
11230 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
11231 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
11232 The default is 1.
11233
11234 @item $_any_caller_is(@var{name}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
11235 @findex $_any_caller_is@r{, convenience function}
11236 Returns one if any calling function's name is equal to @var{name}.
11237 Otherwise it returns zero.
11238
11239 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
11240 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
11241 The default is 1.
11242
11243 This function differs from @code{$_caller_is} in that this function
11244 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
11245 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_is} only checks the
11246 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
11247
11248 @item $_any_caller_matches(@var{regexp}@r{[}, @var{number_of_frames}@r{]})
11249 @findex $_any_caller_matches@r{, convenience function}
11250 Returns one if any calling function's name matches the regular expression
11251 @var{regexp}. Otherwise it returns zero.
11252
11253 If the optional argument @var{number_of_frames} is provided,
11254 it is the number of frames up in the stack to look.
11255 The default is 1.
11256
11257 This function differs from @code{$_caller_matches} in that this function
11258 checks all stack frames from the immediate caller to the frame specified
11259 by @var{number_of_frames}, whereas @code{$_caller_matches} only checks the
11260 frame specified by @var{number_of_frames}.
11261
11262 @item $_as_string(@var{value})
11263 @findex $_as_string@r{, convenience function}
11264 Return the string representation of @var{value}.
11265
11266 This function is useful to obtain the textual label (enumerator) of an
11267 enumeration value. For example, assuming the variable @var{node} is of
11268 an enumerated type:
11269
11270 @smallexample
11271 (gdb) printf "Visiting node of type %s\n", $_as_string(node)
11272 Visiting node of type NODE_INTEGER
11273 @end smallexample
11274
11275 @end table
11276
11277 @value{GDBN} provides the ability to list and get help on
11278 convenience functions.
11279
11280 @table @code
11281 @item help function
11282 @kindex help function
11283 @cindex show all convenience functions
11284 Print a list of all convenience functions.
11285 @end table
11286
11287 @node Registers
11288 @section Registers
11289
11290 @cindex registers
11291 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
11292 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
11293 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
11294 your machine.
11295
11296 @table @code
11297 @kindex info registers
11298 @item info registers
11299 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
11300 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
11301
11302 @kindex info all-registers
11303 @cindex floating point registers
11304 @item info all-registers
11305 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
11306 and vector registers (in the selected stack frame).
11307
11308 @item info registers @var{reggroup} @dots{}
11309 Print the name and value of the registers in each of the specified
11310 @var{reggroup}s. The @var{reggoup} can be any of those returned by
11311 @code{maint print reggroups} (@pxref{Maintenance Commands}).
11312
11313 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
11314 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
11315 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
11316 the selected stack frame. The @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
11317 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
11318 @end table
11319
11320 @anchor{standard registers}
11321 @cindex stack pointer register
11322 @cindex program counter register
11323 @cindex process status register
11324 @cindex frame pointer register
11325 @cindex standard registers
11326 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
11327 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
11328 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
11329 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
11330 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
11331 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
11332 register that contains the processor status. For example,
11333 you could print the program counter in hex with
11334
11335 @smallexample
11336 p/x $pc
11337 @end smallexample
11338
11339 @noindent
11340 or print the instruction to be executed next with
11341
11342 @smallexample
11343 x/i $pc
11344 @end smallexample
11345
11346 @noindent
11347 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
11348 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
11349 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
11350 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
11351 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
11352 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
11353 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a Function}.} with
11354
11355 @smallexample
11356 set $sp += 4
11357 @end smallexample
11358
11359 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
11360 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
11361 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
11362 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
11363 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
11364 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
11365 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
11366
11367 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
11368 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
11369 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
11370 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
11371 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
11372 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
11373 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
11374
11375 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
11376 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
11377 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
11378 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
11379 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
11380 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
11381 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
11382 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
11383 prints the data in both formats.
11384
11385 @cindex SSE registers (x86)
11386 @cindex MMX registers (x86)
11387 Some machines have special registers whose contents can be interpreted
11388 in several different ways. For example, modern x86-based machines
11389 have SSE and MMX registers that can hold several values packed
11390 together in several different formats. @value{GDBN} refers to such
11391 registers in @code{struct} notation:
11392
11393 @smallexample
11394 (@value{GDBP}) print $xmm1
11395 $1 = @{
11396 v4_float = @{0, 3.43859137e-038, 1.54142831e-044, 1.821688e-044@},
11397 v2_double = @{9.92129282474342e-303, 2.7585945287983262e-313@},
11398 v16_int8 = "\000\000\000\000\3706;\001\v\000\000\000\r\000\000",
11399 v8_int16 = @{0, 0, 14072, 315, 11, 0, 13, 0@},
11400 v4_int32 = @{0, 20657912, 11, 13@},
11401 v2_int64 = @{88725056443645952, 55834574859@},
11402 uint128 = 0x0000000d0000000b013b36f800000000
11403 @}
11404 @end smallexample
11405
11406 @noindent
11407 To set values of such registers, you need to tell @value{GDBN} which
11408 view of the register you wish to change, as if you were assigning
11409 value to a @code{struct} member:
11410
11411 @smallexample
11412 (@value{GDBP}) set $xmm1.uint128 = 0x000000000000000000000000FFFFFFFF
11413 @end smallexample
11414
11415 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
11416 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a Frame}). This means that you get the
11417 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
11418 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
11419 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
11420 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
11421
11422 @cindex caller-saved registers
11423 @cindex call-clobbered registers
11424 @cindex volatile registers
11425 @cindex <not saved> values
11426 Usually ABIs reserve some registers as not needed to be saved by the
11427 callee (a.k.a.: ``caller-saved'', ``call-clobbered'' or ``volatile''
11428 registers). It may therefore not be possible for @value{GDBN} to know
11429 the value a register had before the call (in other words, in the outer
11430 frame), if the register value has since been changed by the callee.
11431 @value{GDBN} tries to deduce where the inner frame saved
11432 (``callee-saved'') registers, from the debug info, unwind info, or the
11433 machine code generated by your compiler. If some register is not
11434 saved, and @value{GDBN} knows the register is ``caller-saved'' (via
11435 its own knowledge of the ABI, or because the debug/unwind info
11436 explicitly says the register's value is undefined), @value{GDBN}
11437 displays @w{@samp{<not saved>}} as the register's value. With targets
11438 that @value{GDBN} has no knowledge of the register saving convention,
11439 if a register was not saved by the callee, then its value and location
11440 in the outer frame are assumed to be the same of the inner frame.
11441 This is usually harmless, because if the register is call-clobbered,
11442 the caller either does not care what is in the register after the
11443 call, or has code to restore the value that it does care about. Note,
11444 however, that if you change such a register in the outer frame, you
11445 may also be affecting the inner frame. Also, the more ``outer'' the
11446 frame is you're looking at, the more likely a call-clobbered
11447 register's value is to be wrong, in the sense that it doesn't actually
11448 represent the value the register had just before the call.
11449
11450 @node Floating Point Hardware
11451 @section Floating Point Hardware
11452 @cindex floating point
11453
11454 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
11455 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
11456
11457 @table @code
11458 @kindex info float
11459 @item info float
11460 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
11461 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
11462 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
11463 the ARM and x86 machines.
11464 @end table
11465
11466 @node Vector Unit
11467 @section Vector Unit
11468 @cindex vector unit
11469
11470 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give you
11471 more information about the status of the vector unit.
11472
11473 @table @code
11474 @kindex info vector
11475 @item info vector
11476 Display information about the vector unit. The exact contents and
11477 layout vary depending on the hardware.
11478 @end table
11479
11480 @node OS Information
11481 @section Operating System Auxiliary Information
11482 @cindex OS information
11483
11484 @value{GDBN} provides interfaces to useful OS facilities that can help
11485 you debug your program.
11486
11487 @cindex auxiliary vector
11488 @cindex vector, auxiliary
11489 Some operating systems supply an @dfn{auxiliary vector} to programs at
11490 startup. This is akin to the arguments and environment that you
11491 specify for a program, but contains a system-dependent variety of
11492 binary values that tell system libraries important details about the
11493 hardware, operating system, and process. Each value's purpose is
11494 identified by an integer tag; the meanings are well-known but system-specific.
11495 Depending on the configuration and operating system facilities,
11496 @value{GDBN} may be able to show you this information. For remote
11497 targets, this functionality may further depend on the remote stub's
11498 support of the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet, see
11499 @ref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}.
11500
11501 @table @code
11502 @kindex info auxv
11503 @item info auxv
11504 Display the auxiliary vector of the inferior, which can be either a
11505 live process or a core dump file. @value{GDBN} prints each tag value
11506 numerically, and also shows names and text descriptions for recognized
11507 tags. Some values in the vector are numbers, some bit masks, and some
11508 pointers to strings or other data. @value{GDBN} displays each value in the
11509 most appropriate form for a recognized tag, and in hexadecimal for
11510 an unrecognized tag.
11511 @end table
11512
11513 On some targets, @value{GDBN} can access operating system-specific
11514 information and show it to you. The types of information available
11515 will differ depending on the type of operating system running on the
11516 target. The mechanism used to fetch the data is described in
11517 @ref{Operating System Information}. For remote targets, this
11518 functionality depends on the remote stub's support of the
11519 @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet, see @ref{qXfer osdata read}.
11520
11521 @table @code
11522 @kindex info os
11523 @item info os @var{infotype}
11524
11525 Display OS information of the requested type.
11526
11527 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, the following values of @var{infotype} are valid:
11528
11529 @anchor{linux info os infotypes}
11530 @table @code
11531 @kindex info os cpus
11532 @item cpus
11533 Display the list of all CPUs/cores. For each CPU/core, @value{GDBN} prints
11534 the available fields from /proc/cpuinfo. For each supported architecture
11535 different fields are available. Two common entries are processor which gives
11536 CPU number and bogomips; a system constant that is calculated during
11537 kernel initialization.
11538
11539 @kindex info os files
11540 @item files
11541 Display the list of open file descriptors on the target. For each
11542 file descriptor, @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process
11543 owning the descriptor, the command of the owning process, the value
11544 of the descriptor, and the target of the descriptor.
11545
11546 @kindex info os modules
11547 @item modules
11548 Display the list of all loaded kernel modules on the target. For each
11549 module, @value{GDBN} prints the module name, the size of the module in
11550 bytes, the number of times the module is used, the dependencies of the
11551 module, the status of the module, and the address of the loaded module
11552 in memory.
11553
11554 @kindex info os msg
11555 @item msg
11556 Display the list of all System V message queues on the target. For each
11557 message queue, @value{GDBN} prints the message queue key, the message
11558 queue identifier, the access permissions, the current number of bytes
11559 on the queue, the current number of messages on the queue, the processes
11560 that last sent and received a message on the queue, the user and group
11561 of the owner and creator of the message queue, the times at which a
11562 message was last sent and received on the queue, and the time at which
11563 the message queue was last changed.
11564
11565 @kindex info os processes
11566 @item processes
11567 Display the list of processes on the target. For each process,
11568 @value{GDBN} prints the process identifier, the name of the user, the
11569 command corresponding to the process, and the list of processor cores
11570 that the process is currently running on. (To understand what these
11571 properties mean, for this and the following info types, please consult
11572 the general @sc{gnu}/Linux documentation.)
11573
11574 @kindex info os procgroups
11575 @item procgroups
11576 Display the list of process groups on the target. For each process,
11577 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process group that it belongs
11578 to, the command corresponding to the process group leader, the process
11579 identifier, and the command line of the process. The list is sorted
11580 first by the process group identifier, then by the process identifier,
11581 so that processes belonging to the same process group are grouped together
11582 and the process group leader is listed first.
11583
11584 @kindex info os semaphores
11585 @item semaphores
11586 Display the list of all System V semaphore sets on the target. For each
11587 semaphore set, @value{GDBN} prints the semaphore set key, the semaphore
11588 set identifier, the access permissions, the number of semaphores in the
11589 set, the user and group of the owner and creator of the semaphore set,
11590 and the times at which the semaphore set was operated upon and changed.
11591
11592 @kindex info os shm
11593 @item shm
11594 Display the list of all System V shared-memory regions on the target.
11595 For each shared-memory region, @value{GDBN} prints the region key,
11596 the shared-memory identifier, the access permissions, the size of the
11597 region, the process that created the region, the process that last
11598 attached to or detached from the region, the current number of live
11599 attaches to the region, and the times at which the region was last
11600 attached to, detach from, and changed.
11601
11602 @kindex info os sockets
11603 @item sockets
11604 Display the list of Internet-domain sockets on the target. For each
11605 socket, @value{GDBN} prints the address and port of the local and
11606 remote endpoints, the current state of the connection, the creator of
11607 the socket, the IP address family of the socket, and the type of the
11608 connection.
11609
11610 @kindex info os threads
11611 @item threads
11612 Display the list of threads running on the target. For each thread,
11613 @value{GDBN} prints the identifier of the process that the thread
11614 belongs to, the command of the process, the thread identifier, and the
11615 processor core that it is currently running on. The main thread of a
11616 process is not listed.
11617 @end table
11618
11619 @item info os
11620 If @var{infotype} is omitted, then list the possible values for
11621 @var{infotype} and the kind of OS information available for each
11622 @var{infotype}. If the target does not return a list of possible
11623 types, this command will report an error.
11624 @end table
11625
11626 @node Memory Region Attributes
11627 @section Memory Region Attributes
11628 @cindex memory region attributes
11629
11630 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
11631 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses
11632 attributes to determine whether to allow certain types of memory
11633 accesses; whether to use specific width accesses; and whether to cache
11634 target memory. By default the description of memory regions is
11635 fetched from the target (if the current target supports this), but the
11636 user can override the fetched regions.
11637
11638 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
11639 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
11640 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
11641 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
11642 all memory.
11643
11644 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
11645 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
11646
11647 @table @code
11648 @kindex mem
11649 @item mem @var{lower} @var{upper} @var{attributes}@dots{}
11650 Define a memory region bounded by @var{lower} and @var{upper} with
11651 attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}, and add it to the list of regions
11652 monitored by @value{GDBN}. Note that @var{upper} == 0 is a special
11653 case: it is treated as the target's maximum memory address.
11654 (0xffff on 16 bit targets, 0xffffffff on 32 bit targets, etc.)
11655
11656 @item mem auto
11657 Discard any user changes to the memory regions and use target-supplied
11658 regions, if available, or no regions if the target does not support.
11659
11660 @kindex delete mem
11661 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11662 Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{} from the list of regions
11663 monitored by @value{GDBN}.
11664
11665 @kindex disable mem
11666 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11667 Disable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
11668 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
11669 It may be enabled again later.
11670
11671 @kindex enable mem
11672 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
11673 Enable monitoring of memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
11674
11675 @kindex info mem
11676 @item info mem
11677 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
11678 for each region:
11679
11680 @table @emph
11681 @item Memory Region Number
11682 @item Enabled or Disabled.
11683 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
11684 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
11685
11686 @item Lo Address
11687 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
11688
11689 @item Hi Address
11690 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
11691
11692 @item Attributes
11693 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
11694 @end table
11695 @end table
11696
11697
11698 @subsection Attributes
11699
11700 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
11701 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
11702 write accesses to a memory region.
11703
11704 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
11705 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
11706 etc.@: from accessing memory.
11707
11708 @table @code
11709 @item ro
11710 Memory is read only.
11711 @item wo
11712 Memory is write only.
11713 @item rw
11714 Memory is read/write. This is the default.
11715 @end table
11716
11717 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
11718 The access size attribute tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
11719 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
11720 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
11721 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
11722
11723 @table @code
11724 @item 8
11725 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
11726 @item 16
11727 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
11728 @item 32
11729 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
11730 @item 64
11731 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
11732 @end table
11733
11734 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
11735 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
11736 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
11737 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
11738 @c
11739 @c @table @code
11740 @c @item hwbreak
11741 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
11742 @c @item swbreak (default)
11743 @c @end table
11744
11745 @subsubsection Data Cache
11746 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
11747 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
11748 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
11749 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
11750 registers.
11751
11752 @table @code
11753 @item cache
11754 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
11755 @item nocache
11756 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory. This is the default.
11757 @end table
11758
11759 @subsection Memory Access Checking
11760 @value{GDBN} can be instructed to refuse accesses to memory that is
11761 not explicitly described. This can be useful if accessing such
11762 regions has undesired effects for a specific target, or to provide
11763 better error checking. The following commands control this behaviour.
11764
11765 @table @code
11766 @kindex set mem inaccessible-by-default
11767 @item set mem inaccessible-by-default [on|off]
11768 If @code{on} is specified, make @value{GDBN} treat memory not
11769 explicitly described by the memory ranges as non-existent and refuse accesses
11770 to such memory. The checks are only performed if there's at least one
11771 memory range defined. If @code{off} is specified, make @value{GDBN}
11772 treat the memory not explicitly described by the memory ranges as RAM.
11773 The default value is @code{on}.
11774 @kindex show mem inaccessible-by-default
11775 @item show mem inaccessible-by-default
11776 Show the current handling of accesses to unknown memory.
11777 @end table
11778
11779
11780 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
11781 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
11782 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
11783 @c
11784 @c @table @code
11785 @c @item verify
11786 @c @item noverify (default)
11787 @c @end table
11788
11789 @node Dump/Restore Files
11790 @section Copy Between Memory and a File
11791 @cindex dump/restore files
11792 @cindex append data to a file
11793 @cindex dump data to a file
11794 @cindex restore data from a file
11795
11796 You can use the commands @code{dump}, @code{append}, and
11797 @code{restore} to copy data between target memory and a file. The
11798 @code{dump} and @code{append} commands write data to a file, and the
11799 @code{restore} command reads data from a file back into the inferior's
11800 memory. Files may be in binary, Motorola S-record, Intel hex,
11801 Tektronix Hex, or Verilog Hex format; however, @value{GDBN} can only
11802 append to binary files, and cannot read from Verilog Hex files.
11803
11804 @table @code
11805
11806 @kindex dump
11807 @item dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
11808 @itemx dump @r{[}@var{format}@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
11809 Dump the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
11810 or the value of @var{expr}, to @var{filename} in the given format.
11811
11812 The @var{format} parameter may be any one of:
11813 @table @code
11814 @item binary
11815 Raw binary form.
11816 @item ihex
11817 Intel hex format.
11818 @item srec
11819 Motorola S-record format.
11820 @item tekhex
11821 Tektronix Hex format.
11822 @item verilog
11823 Verilog Hex format.
11824 @end table
11825
11826 @value{GDBN} uses the same definitions of these formats as the
11827 @sc{gnu} binary utilities, like @samp{objdump} and @samp{objcopy}. If
11828 @var{format} is omitted, @value{GDBN} dumps the data in raw binary
11829 form.
11830
11831 @kindex append
11832 @item append @r{[}binary@r{]} memory @var{filename} @var{start_addr} @var{end_addr}
11833 @itemx append @r{[}binary@r{]} value @var{filename} @var{expr}
11834 Append the contents of memory from @var{start_addr} to @var{end_addr},
11835 or the value of @var{expr}, to the file @var{filename}, in raw binary form.
11836 (@value{GDBN} can only append data to files in raw binary form.)
11837
11838 @kindex restore
11839 @item restore @var{filename} @r{[}binary@r{]} @var{bias} @var{start} @var{end}
11840 Restore the contents of file @var{filename} into memory. The
11841 @code{restore} command can automatically recognize any known @sc{bfd}
11842 file format, except for raw binary. To restore a raw binary file you
11843 must specify the optional keyword @code{binary} after the filename.
11844
11845 If @var{bias} is non-zero, its value will be added to the addresses
11846 contained in the file. Binary files always start at address zero, so
11847 they will be restored at address @var{bias}. Other bfd files have
11848 a built-in location; they will be restored at offset @var{bias}
11849 from that location.
11850
11851 If @var{start} and/or @var{end} are non-zero, then only data between
11852 file offset @var{start} and file offset @var{end} will be restored.
11853 These offsets are relative to the addresses in the file, before
11854 the @var{bias} argument is applied.
11855
11856 @end table
11857
11858 @node Core File Generation
11859 @section How to Produce a Core File from Your Program
11860 @cindex dump core from inferior
11861
11862 A @dfn{core file} or @dfn{core dump} is a file that records the memory
11863 image of a running process and its process status (register values
11864 etc.). Its primary use is post-mortem debugging of a program that
11865 crashed while it ran outside a debugger. A program that crashes
11866 automatically produces a core file, unless this feature is disabled by
11867 the user. @xref{Files}, for information on invoking @value{GDBN} in
11868 the post-mortem debugging mode.
11869
11870 Occasionally, you may wish to produce a core file of the program you
11871 are debugging in order to preserve a snapshot of its state.
11872 @value{GDBN} has a special command for that.
11873
11874 @table @code
11875 @kindex gcore
11876 @kindex generate-core-file
11877 @item generate-core-file [@var{file}]
11878 @itemx gcore [@var{file}]
11879 Produce a core dump of the inferior process. The optional argument
11880 @var{file} specifies the file name where to put the core dump. If not
11881 specified, the file name defaults to @file{core.@var{pid}}, where
11882 @var{pid} is the inferior process ID.
11883
11884 Note that this command is implemented only for some systems (as of
11885 this writing, @sc{gnu}/Linux, FreeBSD, Solaris, and S390).
11886
11887 On @sc{gnu}/Linux, this command can take into account the value of the
11888 file @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating the core
11889 dump (@pxref{set use-coredump-filter}), and by default honors the
11890 @code{VM_DONTDUMP} flag for mappings where it is present in the file
11891 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/smaps} (@pxref{set dump-excluded-mappings}).
11892
11893 @kindex set use-coredump-filter
11894 @anchor{set use-coredump-filter}
11895 @item set use-coredump-filter on
11896 @itemx set use-coredump-filter off
11897 Enable or disable the use of the file
11898 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} when generating core dump
11899 files. This file is used by the Linux kernel to decide what types of
11900 memory mappings will be dumped or ignored when generating a core dump
11901 file. @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process.
11902
11903 To make use of this feature, you have to write in the
11904 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file a value, in hexadecimal,
11905 which is a bit mask representing the memory mapping types. If a bit
11906 is set in the bit mask, then the memory mappings of the corresponding
11907 types will be dumped; otherwise, they will be ignored. This
11908 configuration is inherited by child processes. For more information
11909 about the bits that can be set in the
11910 @file{/proc/@var{pid}/coredump_filter} file, please refer to the
11911 manpage of @code{core(5)}.
11912
11913 By default, this option is @code{on}. If this option is turned
11914 @code{off}, @value{GDBN} does not read the @file{coredump_filter} file
11915 and instead uses the same default value as the Linux kernel in order
11916 to decide which pages will be dumped in the core dump file. This
11917 value is currently @code{0x33}, which means that bits @code{0}
11918 (anonymous private mappings), @code{1} (anonymous shared mappings),
11919 @code{4} (ELF headers) and @code{5} (private huge pages) are active.
11920 This will cause these memory mappings to be dumped automatically.
11921
11922 @kindex set dump-excluded-mappings
11923 @anchor{set dump-excluded-mappings}
11924 @item set dump-excluded-mappings on
11925 @itemx set dump-excluded-mappings off
11926 If @code{on} is specified, @value{GDBN} will dump memory mappings
11927 marked with the @code{VM_DONTDUMP} flag. This flag is represented in
11928 the file @file{/proc/@var{pid}/smaps} with the acronym @code{dd}.
11929
11930 The default value is @code{off}.
11931 @end table
11932
11933 @node Character Sets
11934 @section Character Sets
11935 @cindex character sets
11936 @cindex charset
11937 @cindex translating between character sets
11938 @cindex host character set
11939 @cindex target character set
11940
11941 If the program you are debugging uses a different character set to
11942 represent characters and strings than the one @value{GDBN} uses itself,
11943 @value{GDBN} can automatically translate between the character sets for
11944 you. The character set @value{GDBN} uses we call the @dfn{host
11945 character set}; the one the inferior program uses we call the
11946 @dfn{target character set}.
11947
11948 For example, if you are running @value{GDBN} on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, which
11949 uses the ISO Latin 1 character set, but you are using @value{GDBN}'s
11950 remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Debugging}) to debug a program
11951 running on an IBM mainframe, which uses the @sc{ebcdic} character set,
11952 then the host character set is Latin-1, and the target character set is
11953 @sc{ebcdic}. If you give @value{GDBN} the command @code{set
11954 target-charset EBCDIC-US}, then @value{GDBN} translates between
11955 @sc{ebcdic} and Latin 1 as you print character or string values, or use
11956 character and string literals in expressions.
11957
11958 @value{GDBN} has no way to automatically recognize which character set
11959 the inferior program uses; you must tell it, using the @code{set
11960 target-charset} command, described below.
11961
11962 Here are the commands for controlling @value{GDBN}'s character set
11963 support:
11964
11965 @table @code
11966 @item set target-charset @var{charset}
11967 @kindex set target-charset
11968 Set the current target character set to @var{charset}. To display the
11969 list of supported target character sets, type
11970 @kbd{@w{set target-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
11971
11972 @item set host-charset @var{charset}
11973 @kindex set host-charset
11974 Set the current host character set to @var{charset}.
11975
11976 By default, @value{GDBN} uses a host character set appropriate to the
11977 system it is running on; you can override that default using the
11978 @code{set host-charset} command. On some systems, @value{GDBN} cannot
11979 automatically determine the appropriate host character set. In this
11980 case, @value{GDBN} uses @samp{UTF-8}.
11981
11982 @value{GDBN} can only use certain character sets as its host character
11983 set. If you type @kbd{@w{set host-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
11984 @value{GDBN} will list the host character sets it supports.
11985
11986 @item set charset @var{charset}
11987 @kindex set charset
11988 Set the current host and target character sets to @var{charset}. As
11989 above, if you type @kbd{@w{set charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}},
11990 @value{GDBN} will list the names of the character sets that can be used
11991 for both host and target.
11992
11993 @item show charset
11994 @kindex show charset
11995 Show the names of the current host and target character sets.
11996
11997 @item show host-charset
11998 @kindex show host-charset
11999 Show the name of the current host character set.
12000
12001 @item show target-charset
12002 @kindex show target-charset
12003 Show the name of the current target character set.
12004
12005 @item set target-wide-charset @var{charset}
12006 @kindex set target-wide-charset
12007 Set the current target's wide character set to @var{charset}. This is
12008 the character set used by the target's @code{wchar_t} type. To
12009 display the list of supported wide character sets, type
12010 @kbd{@w{set target-wide-charset @key{TAB}@key{TAB}}}.
12011
12012 @item show target-wide-charset
12013 @kindex show target-wide-charset
12014 Show the name of the current target's wide character set.
12015 @end table
12016
12017 Here is an example of @value{GDBN}'s character set support in action.
12018 Assume that the following source code has been placed in the file
12019 @file{charset-test.c}:
12020
12021 @smallexample
12022 #include <stdio.h>
12023
12024 char ascii_hello[]
12025 = @{72, 101, 108, 108, 111, 44, 32, 119,
12026 111, 114, 108, 100, 33, 10, 0@};
12027 char ibm1047_hello[]
12028 = @{200, 133, 147, 147, 150, 107, 64, 166,
12029 150, 153, 147, 132, 90, 37, 0@};
12030
12031 main ()
12032 @{
12033 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12034 @}
12035 @end smallexample
12036
12037 In this program, @code{ascii_hello} and @code{ibm1047_hello} are arrays
12038 containing the string @samp{Hello, world!} followed by a newline,
12039 encoded in the @sc{ascii} and @sc{ibm1047} character sets.
12040
12041 We compile the program, and invoke the debugger on it:
12042
12043 @smallexample
12044 $ gcc -g charset-test.c -o charset-test
12045 $ gdb -nw charset-test
12046 GNU gdb 2001-12-19-cvs
12047 Copyright 2001 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
12048 @dots{}
12049 (@value{GDBP})
12050 @end smallexample
12051
12052 We can use the @code{show charset} command to see what character sets
12053 @value{GDBN} is currently using to interpret and display characters and
12054 strings:
12055
12056 @smallexample
12057 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
12058 The current host and target character set is `ISO-8859-1'.
12059 (@value{GDBP})
12060 @end smallexample
12061
12062 For the sake of printing this manual, let's use @sc{ascii} as our
12063 initial character set:
12064 @smallexample
12065 (@value{GDBP}) set charset ASCII
12066 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
12067 The current host and target character set is `ASCII'.
12068 (@value{GDBP})
12069 @end smallexample
12070
12071 Let's assume that @sc{ascii} is indeed the correct character set for our
12072 host system --- in other words, let's assume that if @value{GDBN} prints
12073 characters using the @sc{ascii} character set, our terminal will display
12074 them properly. Since our current target character set is also
12075 @sc{ascii}, the contents of @code{ascii_hello} print legibly:
12076
12077 @smallexample
12078 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
12079 $1 = 0x401698 "Hello, world!\n"
12080 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
12081 $2 = 72 'H'
12082 (@value{GDBP})
12083 @end smallexample
12084
12085 @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and string
12086 literals you use in expressions:
12087
12088 @smallexample
12089 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
12090 $3 = 43 '+'
12091 (@value{GDBP})
12092 @end smallexample
12093
12094 The @sc{ascii} character set uses the number 43 to encode the @samp{+}
12095 character.
12096
12097 @value{GDBN} relies on the user to tell it which character set the
12098 target program uses. If we print @code{ibm1047_hello} while our target
12099 character set is still @sc{ascii}, we get jibberish:
12100
12101 @smallexample
12102 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
12103 $4 = 0x4016a8 "\310\205\223\223\226k@@\246\226\231\223\204Z%"
12104 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
12105 $5 = 200 '\310'
12106 (@value{GDBP})
12107 @end smallexample
12108
12109 If we invoke the @code{set target-charset} followed by @key{TAB}@key{TAB},
12110 @value{GDBN} tells us the character sets it supports:
12111
12112 @smallexample
12113 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
12114 ASCII EBCDIC-US IBM1047 ISO-8859-1
12115 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset
12116 @end smallexample
12117
12118 We can select @sc{ibm1047} as our target character set, and examine the
12119 program's strings again. Now the @sc{ascii} string is wrong, but
12120 @value{GDBN} translates the contents of @code{ibm1047_hello} from the
12121 target character set, @sc{ibm1047}, to the host character set,
12122 @sc{ascii}, and they display correctly:
12123
12124 @smallexample
12125 (@value{GDBP}) set target-charset IBM1047
12126 (@value{GDBP}) show charset
12127 The current host character set is `ASCII'.
12128 The current target character set is `IBM1047'.
12129 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello
12130 $6 = 0x401698 "\110\145%%?\054\040\167?\162%\144\041\012"
12131 (@value{GDBP}) print ascii_hello[0]
12132 $7 = 72 '\110'
12133 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello
12134 $8 = 0x4016a8 "Hello, world!\n"
12135 (@value{GDBP}) print ibm1047_hello[0]
12136 $9 = 200 'H'
12137 (@value{GDBP})
12138 @end smallexample
12139
12140 As above, @value{GDBN} uses the target character set for character and
12141 string literals you use in expressions:
12142
12143 @smallexample
12144 (@value{GDBP}) print '+'
12145 $10 = 78 '+'
12146 (@value{GDBP})
12147 @end smallexample
12148
12149 The @sc{ibm1047} character set uses the number 78 to encode the @samp{+}
12150 character.
12151
12152 @node Caching Target Data
12153 @section Caching Data of Targets
12154 @cindex caching data of targets
12155
12156 @value{GDBN} caches data exchanged between the debugger and a target.
12157 Each cache is associated with the address space of the inferior.
12158 @xref{Inferiors and Programs}, about inferior and address space.
12159 Such caching generally improves performance in remote debugging
12160 (@pxref{Remote Debugging}), because it reduces the overhead of the
12161 remote protocol by bundling memory reads and writes into large chunks.
12162 Unfortunately, simply caching everything would lead to incorrect results,
12163 since @value{GDBN} does not necessarily know anything about volatile
12164 values, memory-mapped I/O addresses, etc. Furthermore, in non-stop mode
12165 (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) memory can be changed @emph{while} a gdb command
12166 is executing.
12167 Therefore, by default, @value{GDBN} only caches data
12168 known to be on the stack@footnote{In non-stop mode, it is moderately
12169 rare for a running thread to modify the stack of a stopped thread
12170 in a way that would interfere with a backtrace, and caching of
12171 stack reads provides a significant speed up of remote backtraces.} or
12172 in the code segment.
12173 Other regions of memory can be explicitly marked as
12174 cacheable; @pxref{Memory Region Attributes}.
12175
12176 @table @code
12177 @kindex set remotecache
12178 @item set remotecache on
12179 @itemx set remotecache off
12180 This option no longer does anything; it exists for compatibility
12181 with old scripts.
12182
12183 @kindex show remotecache
12184 @item show remotecache
12185 Show the current state of the obsolete remotecache flag.
12186
12187 @kindex set stack-cache
12188 @item set stack-cache on
12189 @itemx set stack-cache off
12190 Enable or disable caching of stack accesses. When @code{on}, use
12191 caching. By default, this option is @code{on}.
12192
12193 @kindex show stack-cache
12194 @item show stack-cache
12195 Show the current state of data caching for memory accesses.
12196
12197 @kindex set code-cache
12198 @item set code-cache on
12199 @itemx set code-cache off
12200 Enable or disable caching of code segment accesses. When @code{on},
12201 use caching. By default, this option is @code{on}. This improves
12202 performance of disassembly in remote debugging.
12203
12204 @kindex show code-cache
12205 @item show code-cache
12206 Show the current state of target memory cache for code segment
12207 accesses.
12208
12209 @kindex info dcache
12210 @item info dcache @r{[}line@r{]}
12211 Print the information about the performance of data cache of the
12212 current inferior's address space. The information displayed
12213 includes the dcache width and depth, and for each cache line, its
12214 number, address, and how many times it was referenced. This
12215 command is useful for debugging the data cache operation.
12216
12217 If a line number is specified, the contents of that line will be
12218 printed in hex.
12219
12220 @item set dcache size @var{size}
12221 @cindex dcache size
12222 @kindex set dcache size
12223 Set maximum number of entries in dcache (dcache depth above).
12224
12225 @item set dcache line-size @var{line-size}
12226 @cindex dcache line-size
12227 @kindex set dcache line-size
12228 Set number of bytes each dcache entry caches (dcache width above).
12229 Must be a power of 2.
12230
12231 @item show dcache size
12232 @kindex show dcache size
12233 Show maximum number of dcache entries. @xref{Caching Target Data, info dcache}.
12234
12235 @item show dcache line-size
12236 @kindex show dcache line-size
12237 Show default size of dcache lines.
12238
12239 @end table
12240
12241 @node Searching Memory
12242 @section Search Memory
12243 @cindex searching memory
12244
12245 Memory can be searched for a particular sequence of bytes with the
12246 @code{find} command.
12247
12248 @table @code
12249 @kindex find
12250 @item find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, +@var{len}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
12251 @itemx find @r{[}/@var{sn}@r{]} @var{start_addr}, @var{end_addr}, @var{val1} @r{[}, @var{val2}, @dots{}@r{]}
12252 Search memory for the sequence of bytes specified by @var{val1}, @var{val2},
12253 etc. The search begins at address @var{start_addr} and continues for either
12254 @var{len} bytes or through to @var{end_addr} inclusive.
12255 @end table
12256
12257 @var{s} and @var{n} are optional parameters.
12258 They may be specified in either order, apart or together.
12259
12260 @table @r
12261 @item @var{s}, search query size
12262 The size of each search query value.
12263
12264 @table @code
12265 @item b
12266 bytes
12267 @item h
12268 halfwords (two bytes)
12269 @item w
12270 words (four bytes)
12271 @item g
12272 giant words (eight bytes)
12273 @end table
12274
12275 All values are interpreted in the current language.
12276 This means, for example, that if the current source language is C/C@t{++}
12277 then searching for the string ``hello'' includes the trailing '\0'.
12278 The null terminator can be removed from searching by using casts,
12279 e.g.: @samp{@{char[5]@}"hello"}.
12280
12281 If the value size is not specified, it is taken from the
12282 value's type in the current language.
12283 This is useful when one wants to specify the search
12284 pattern as a mixture of types.
12285 Note that this means, for example, that in the case of C-like languages
12286 a search for an untyped 0x42 will search for @samp{(int) 0x42}
12287 which is typically four bytes.
12288
12289 @item @var{n}, maximum number of finds
12290 The maximum number of matches to print. The default is to print all finds.
12291 @end table
12292
12293 You can use strings as search values. Quote them with double-quotes
12294 (@code{"}).
12295 The string value is copied into the search pattern byte by byte,
12296 regardless of the endianness of the target and the size specification.
12297
12298 The address of each match found is printed as well as a count of the
12299 number of matches found.
12300
12301 The address of the last value found is stored in convenience variable
12302 @samp{$_}.
12303 A count of the number of matches is stored in @samp{$numfound}.
12304
12305 For example, if stopped at the @code{printf} in this function:
12306
12307 @smallexample
12308 void
12309 hello ()
12310 @{
12311 static char hello[] = "hello-hello";
12312 static struct @{ char c; short s; int i; @}
12313 __attribute__ ((packed)) mixed
12314 = @{ 'c', 0x1234, 0x87654321 @};
12315 printf ("%s\n", hello);
12316 @}
12317 @end smallexample
12318
12319 @noindent
12320 you get during debugging:
12321
12322 @smallexample
12323 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), "hello"
12324 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
12325 1 pattern found
12326 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', 'o'
12327 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
12328 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
12329 2 patterns found.
12330 (gdb) find &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), @{char[5]@}"hello"
12331 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
12332 0x804956d <hello.1620+6>
12333 2 patterns found.
12334 (gdb) find /b1 &hello[0], +sizeof(hello), 'h', 0x65, 'l'
12335 0x8049567 <hello.1620>
12336 1 pattern found
12337 (gdb) find &mixed, +sizeof(mixed), (char) 'c', (short) 0x1234, (int) 0x87654321
12338 0x8049560 <mixed.1625>
12339 1 pattern found
12340 (gdb) print $numfound
12341 $1 = 1
12342 (gdb) print $_
12343 $2 = (void *) 0x8049560
12344 @end smallexample
12345
12346 @node Value Sizes
12347 @section Value Sizes
12348
12349 Whenever @value{GDBN} prints a value memory will be allocated within
12350 @value{GDBN} to hold the contents of the value. It is possible in
12351 some languages with dynamic typing systems, that an invalid program
12352 may indicate a value that is incorrectly large, this in turn may cause
12353 @value{GDBN} to try and allocate an overly large ammount of memory.
12354
12355 @table @code
12356 @kindex set max-value-size
12357 @item set max-value-size @var{bytes}
12358 @itemx set max-value-size unlimited
12359 Set the maximum size of memory that @value{GDBN} will allocate for the
12360 contents of a value to @var{bytes}, trying to display a value that
12361 requires more memory than that will result in an error.
12362
12363 Setting this variable does not effect values that have already been
12364 allocated within @value{GDBN}, only future allocations.
12365
12366 There's a minimum size that @code{max-value-size} can be set to in
12367 order that @value{GDBN} can still operate correctly, this minimum is
12368 currently 16 bytes.
12369
12370 The limit applies to the results of some subexpressions as well as to
12371 complete expressions. For example, an expression denoting a simple
12372 integer component, such as @code{x.y.z}, may fail if the size of
12373 @var{x.y} is dynamic and exceeds @var{bytes}. On the other hand,
12374 @value{GDBN} is sometimes clever; the expression @code{A[i]}, where
12375 @var{A} is an array variable with non-constant size, will generally
12376 succeed regardless of the bounds on @var{A}, as long as the component
12377 size is less than @var{bytes}.
12378
12379 The default value of @code{max-value-size} is currently 64k.
12380
12381 @kindex show max-value-size
12382 @item show max-value-size
12383 Show the maximum size of memory, in bytes, that @value{GDBN} will
12384 allocate for the contents of a value.
12385 @end table
12386
12387 @node Optimized Code
12388 @chapter Debugging Optimized Code
12389 @cindex optimized code, debugging
12390 @cindex debugging optimized code
12391
12392 Almost all compilers support optimization. With optimization
12393 disabled, the compiler generates assembly code that corresponds
12394 directly to your source code, in a simplistic way. As the compiler
12395 applies more powerful optimizations, the generated assembly code
12396 diverges from your original source code. With help from debugging
12397 information generated by the compiler, @value{GDBN} can map from
12398 the running program back to constructs from your original source.
12399
12400 @value{GDBN} is more accurate with optimization disabled. If you
12401 can recompile without optimization, it is easier to follow the
12402 progress of your program during debugging. But, there are many cases
12403 where you may need to debug an optimized version.
12404
12405 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
12406 optimizer has rearranged your code; the debugger shows you what is
12407 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
12408 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
12409 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
12410 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
12411
12412 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
12413 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
12414 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
12415 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
12416 @xref{Variables}, for more information about debugging optimized code.
12417
12418 @menu
12419 * Inline Functions:: How @value{GDBN} presents inlining
12420 * Tail Call Frames:: @value{GDBN} analysis of jumps to functions
12421 @end menu
12422
12423 @node Inline Functions
12424 @section Inline Functions
12425 @cindex inline functions, debugging
12426
12427 @dfn{Inlining} is an optimization that inserts a copy of the function
12428 body directly at each call site, instead of jumping to a shared
12429 routine. @value{GDBN} displays inlined functions just like
12430 non-inlined functions. They appear in backtraces. You can view their
12431 arguments and local variables, step into them with @code{step}, skip
12432 them with @code{next}, and escape from them with @code{finish}.
12433 You can check whether a function was inlined by using the
12434 @code{info frame} command.
12435
12436 For @value{GDBN} to support inlined functions, the compiler must
12437 record information about inlining in the debug information ---
12438 @value{NGCC} using the @sc{dwarf 2} format does this, and several
12439 other compilers do also. @value{GDBN} only supports inlined functions
12440 when using @sc{dwarf 2}. Versions of @value{NGCC} before 4.1
12441 do not emit two required attributes (@samp{DW_AT_call_file} and
12442 @samp{DW_AT_call_line}); @value{GDBN} does not display inlined
12443 function calls with earlier versions of @value{NGCC}. It instead
12444 displays the arguments and local variables of inlined functions as
12445 local variables in the caller.
12446
12447 The body of an inlined function is directly included at its call site;
12448 unlike a non-inlined function, there are no instructions devoted to
12449 the call. @value{GDBN} still pretends that the call site and the
12450 start of the inlined function are different instructions. Stepping to
12451 the call site shows the call site, and then stepping again shows
12452 the first line of the inlined function, even though no additional
12453 instructions are executed.
12454
12455 This makes source-level debugging much clearer; you can see both the
12456 context of the call and then the effect of the call. Only stepping by
12457 a single instruction using @code{stepi} or @code{nexti} does not do
12458 this; single instruction steps always show the inlined body.
12459
12460 There are some ways that @value{GDBN} does not pretend that inlined
12461 function calls are the same as normal calls:
12462
12463 @itemize @bullet
12464 @item
12465 Setting breakpoints at the call site of an inlined function may not
12466 work, because the call site does not contain any code. @value{GDBN}
12467 may incorrectly move the breakpoint to the next line of the enclosing
12468 function, after the call. This limitation will be removed in a future
12469 version of @value{GDBN}; until then, set a breakpoint on an earlier line
12470 or inside the inlined function instead.
12471
12472 @item
12473 @value{GDBN} cannot locate the return value of inlined calls after
12474 using the @code{finish} command. This is a limitation of compiler-generated
12475 debugging information; after @code{finish}, you can step to the next line
12476 and print a variable where your program stored the return value.
12477
12478 @end itemize
12479
12480 @node Tail Call Frames
12481 @section Tail Call Frames
12482 @cindex tail call frames, debugging
12483
12484 Function @code{B} can call function @code{C} in its very last statement. In
12485 unoptimized compilation the call of @code{C} is immediately followed by return
12486 instruction at the end of @code{B} code. Optimizing compiler may replace the
12487 call and return in function @code{B} into one jump to function @code{C}
12488 instead. Such use of a jump instruction is called @dfn{tail call}.
12489
12490 During execution of function @code{C}, there will be no indication in the
12491 function call stack frames that it was tail-called from @code{B}. If function
12492 @code{A} regularly calls function @code{B} which tail-calls function @code{C},
12493 then @value{GDBN} will see @code{A} as the caller of @code{C}. However, in
12494 some cases @value{GDBN} can determine that @code{C} was tail-called from
12495 @code{B}, and it will then create fictitious call frame for that, with the
12496 return address set up as if @code{B} called @code{C} normally.
12497
12498 This functionality is currently supported only by DWARF 2 debugging format and
12499 the compiler has to produce @samp{DW_TAG_call_site} tags. With
12500 @value{NGCC}, you need to specify @option{-O -g} during compilation, to get
12501 this information.
12502
12503 @kbd{info frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info}) will indicate the tail call frame
12504 kind by text @code{tail call frame} such as in this sample @value{GDBN} output:
12505
12506 @smallexample
12507 (gdb) x/i $pc - 2
12508 0x40066b <b(int, double)+11>: jmp 0x400640 <c(int, double)>
12509 (gdb) info frame
12510 Stack level 1, frame at 0x7fffffffda30:
12511 rip = 0x40066d in b (amd64-entry-value.cc:59); saved rip 0x4004c5
12512 tail call frame, caller of frame at 0x7fffffffda30
12513 source language c++.
12514 Arglist at unknown address.
12515 Locals at unknown address, Previous frame's sp is 0x7fffffffda30
12516 @end smallexample
12517
12518 The detection of all the possible code path executions can find them ambiguous.
12519 There is no execution history stored (possible @ref{Reverse Execution} is never
12520 used for this purpose) and the last known caller could have reached the known
12521 callee by multiple different jump sequences. In such case @value{GDBN} still
12522 tries to show at least all the unambiguous top tail callers and all the
12523 unambiguous bottom tail calees, if any.
12524
12525 @table @code
12526 @anchor{set debug entry-values}
12527 @item set debug entry-values
12528 @kindex set debug entry-values
12529 When set to on, enables printing of analysis messages for both frame argument
12530 values at function entry and tail calls. It will show all the possible valid
12531 tail calls code paths it has considered. It will also print the intersection
12532 of them with the final unambiguous (possibly partial or even empty) code path
12533 result.
12534
12535 @item show debug entry-values
12536 @kindex show debug entry-values
12537 Show the current state of analysis messages printing for both frame argument
12538 values at function entry and tail calls.
12539 @end table
12540
12541 The analysis messages for tail calls can for example show why the virtual tail
12542 call frame for function @code{c} has not been recognized (due to the indirect
12543 reference by variable @code{x}):
12544
12545 @smallexample
12546 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void);
12547 void (*x) (void) = c;
12548 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
12549 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ a (); @}
12550 int main (void) @{ x (); return 0; @}
12551
12552 Breakpoint 1, DW_OP_entry_value resolving cannot find
12553 DW_TAG_call_site 0x40039a in main
12554 a () at t.c:3
12555 3 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ x++; @}
12556 (gdb) bt
12557 #0 a () at t.c:3
12558 #1 0x000000000040039a in main () at t.c:5
12559 @end smallexample
12560
12561 Another possibility is an ambiguous virtual tail call frames resolution:
12562
12563 @smallexample
12564 int i;
12565 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) f (void) @{ i++; @}
12566 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) e (void) @{ f (); @}
12567 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) d (void) @{ f (); @}
12568 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (void) @{ d (); @}
12569 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (void)
12570 @{ if (i) c (); else e (); @}
12571 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (void) @{ b (); @}
12572 int main (void) @{ a (); return 0; @}
12573
12574 tailcall: initial: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004ce(b) 0x4004b2(c) 0x4004a2(d)
12575 tailcall: compare: 0x4004d2(a) 0x4004cc(b) 0x400492(e)
12576 tailcall: reduced: 0x4004d2(a) |
12577 (gdb) bt
12578 #0 f () at t.c:2
12579 #1 0x00000000004004d2 in a () at t.c:8
12580 #2 0x0000000000400395 in main () at t.c:9
12581 @end smallexample
12582
12583 @set CALLSEQ1A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}c@value{ARROW}d@value{ARROW}f}
12584 @set CALLSEQ2A @code{main@value{ARROW}a@value{ARROW}b@value{ARROW}e@value{ARROW}f}
12585
12586 @c Convert CALLSEQ#A to CALLSEQ#B depending on HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK.
12587 @ifset HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
12588 @set ARROW @click{}
12589 @set CALLSEQ1B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ1A}}
12590 @set CALLSEQ2B @clicksequence{@value{CALLSEQ2A}}
12591 @end ifset
12592 @ifclear HAVE_MAKEINFO_CLICK
12593 @set ARROW ->
12594 @set CALLSEQ1B @value{CALLSEQ1A}
12595 @set CALLSEQ2B @value{CALLSEQ2A}
12596 @end ifclear
12597
12598 Frames #0 and #2 are real, #1 is a virtual tail call frame.
12599 The code can have possible execution paths @value{CALLSEQ1B} or
12600 @value{CALLSEQ2B}, @value{GDBN} cannot find which one from the inferior state.
12601
12602 @code{initial:} state shows some random possible calling sequence @value{GDBN}
12603 has found. It then finds another possible calling sequcen - that one is
12604 prefixed by @code{compare:}. The non-ambiguous intersection of these two is
12605 printed as the @code{reduced:} calling sequence. That one could have many
12606 futher @code{compare:} and @code{reduced:} statements as long as there remain
12607 any non-ambiguous sequence entries.
12608
12609 For the frame of function @code{b} in both cases there are different possible
12610 @code{$pc} values (@code{0x4004cc} or @code{0x4004ce}), therefore this frame is
12611 also ambigous. The only non-ambiguous frame is the one for function @code{a},
12612 therefore this one is displayed to the user while the ambiguous frames are
12613 omitted.
12614
12615 There can be also reasons why printing of frame argument values at function
12616 entry may fail:
12617
12618 @smallexample
12619 int v;
12620 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) c (int i) @{ v++; @}
12621 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i);
12622 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) b (int i) @{ a (i); @}
12623 static void __attribute__((noinline, noclone)) a (int i)
12624 @{ if (i) b (i - 1); else c (0); @}
12625 int main (void) @{ a (5); return 0; @}
12626
12627 (gdb) bt
12628 #0 c (i=i@@entry=0) at t.c:2
12629 #1 0x0000000000400428 in a (DW_OP_entry_value resolving has found
12630 function "a" at 0x400420 can call itself via tail calls
12631 i=<optimized out>) at t.c:6
12632 #2 0x000000000040036e in main () at t.c:7
12633 @end smallexample
12634
12635 @value{GDBN} cannot find out from the inferior state if and how many times did
12636 function @code{a} call itself (via function @code{b}) as these calls would be
12637 tail calls. Such tail calls would modify thue @code{i} variable, therefore
12638 @value{GDBN} cannot be sure the value it knows would be right - @value{GDBN}
12639 prints @code{<optimized out>} instead.
12640
12641 @node Macros
12642 @chapter C Preprocessor Macros
12643
12644 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, provide a way to define and invoke
12645 ``preprocessor macros'' which expand into strings of tokens.
12646 @value{GDBN} can evaluate expressions containing macro invocations, show
12647 the result of macro expansion, and show a macro's definition, including
12648 where it was defined.
12649
12650 You may need to compile your program specially to provide @value{GDBN}
12651 with information about preprocessor macros. Most compilers do not
12652 include macros in their debugging information, even when you compile
12653 with the @option{-g} flag. @xref{Compilation}.
12654
12655 A program may define a macro at one point, remove that definition later,
12656 and then provide a different definition after that. Thus, at different
12657 points in the program, a macro may have different definitions, or have
12658 no definition at all. If there is a current stack frame, @value{GDBN}
12659 uses the macros in scope at that frame's source code line. Otherwise,
12660 @value{GDBN} uses the macros in scope at the current listing location;
12661 see @ref{List}.
12662
12663 Whenever @value{GDBN} evaluates an expression, it always expands any
12664 macro invocations present in the expression. @value{GDBN} also provides
12665 the following commands for working with macros explicitly.
12666
12667 @table @code
12668
12669 @kindex macro expand
12670 @cindex macro expansion, showing the results of preprocessor
12671 @cindex preprocessor macro expansion, showing the results of
12672 @cindex expanding preprocessor macros
12673 @item macro expand @var{expression}
12674 @itemx macro exp @var{expression}
12675 Show the results of expanding all preprocessor macro invocations in
12676 @var{expression}. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does
12677 not parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression;
12678 it can be any string of tokens.
12679
12680 @kindex macro exp1
12681 @item macro expand-once @var{expression}
12682 @itemx macro exp1 @var{expression}
12683 @cindex expand macro once
12684 @i{(This command is not yet implemented.)} Show the results of
12685 expanding those preprocessor macro invocations that appear explicitly in
12686 @var{expression}. Macro invocations appearing in that expansion are
12687 left unchanged. This command allows you to see the effect of a
12688 particular macro more clearly, without being confused by further
12689 expansions. Since @value{GDBN} simply expands macros, but does not
12690 parse the result, @var{expression} need not be a valid expression; it
12691 can be any string of tokens.
12692
12693 @kindex info macro
12694 @cindex macro definition, showing
12695 @cindex definition of a macro, showing
12696 @cindex macros, from debug info
12697 @item info macro [-a|-all] [--] @var{macro}
12698 Show the current definition or all definitions of the named @var{macro},
12699 and describe the source location or compiler command-line where that
12700 definition was established. The optional double dash is to signify the end of
12701 argument processing and the beginning of @var{macro} for non C-like macros where
12702 the macro may begin with a hyphen.
12703
12704 @kindex info macros
12705 @item info macros @var{location}
12706 Show all macro definitions that are in effect at the location specified
12707 by @var{location}, and describe the source location or compiler
12708 command-line where those definitions were established.
12709
12710 @kindex macro define
12711 @cindex user-defined macros
12712 @cindex defining macros interactively
12713 @cindex macros, user-defined
12714 @item macro define @var{macro} @var{replacement-list}
12715 @itemx macro define @var{macro}(@var{arglist}) @var{replacement-list}
12716 Introduce a definition for a preprocessor macro named @var{macro},
12717 invocations of which are replaced by the tokens given in
12718 @var{replacement-list}. The first form of this command defines an
12719 ``object-like'' macro, which takes no arguments; the second form
12720 defines a ``function-like'' macro, which takes the arguments given in
12721 @var{arglist}.
12722
12723 A definition introduced by this command is in scope in every
12724 expression evaluated in @value{GDBN}, until it is removed with the
12725 @code{macro undef} command, described below. The definition overrides
12726 all definitions for @var{macro} present in the program being debugged,
12727 as well as any previous user-supplied definition.
12728
12729 @kindex macro undef
12730 @item macro undef @var{macro}
12731 Remove any user-supplied definition for the macro named @var{macro}.
12732 This command only affects definitions provided with the @code{macro
12733 define} command, described above; it cannot remove definitions present
12734 in the program being debugged.
12735
12736 @kindex macro list
12737 @item macro list
12738 List all the macros defined using the @code{macro define} command.
12739 @end table
12740
12741 @cindex macros, example of debugging with
12742 Here is a transcript showing the above commands in action. First, we
12743 show our source files:
12744
12745 @smallexample
12746 $ cat sample.c
12747 #include <stdio.h>
12748 #include "sample.h"
12749
12750 #define M 42
12751 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12752
12753 main ()
12754 @{
12755 #define N 28
12756 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12757 #undef N
12758 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12759 #define N 1729
12760 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
12761 @}
12762 $ cat sample.h
12763 #define Q <
12764 $
12765 @end smallexample
12766
12767 Now, we compile the program using the @sc{gnu} C compiler,
12768 @value{NGCC}. We pass the @option{-gdwarf-2}@footnote{This is the
12769 minimum. Recent versions of @value{NGCC} support @option{-gdwarf-3}
12770 and @option{-gdwarf-4}; we recommend always choosing the most recent
12771 version of DWARF.} @emph{and} @option{-g3} flags to ensure the compiler
12772 includes information about preprocessor macros in the debugging
12773 information.
12774
12775 @smallexample
12776 $ gcc -gdwarf-2 -g3 sample.c -o sample
12777 $
12778 @end smallexample
12779
12780 Now, we start @value{GDBN} on our sample program:
12781
12782 @smallexample
12783 $ gdb -nw sample
12784 GNU gdb 2002-05-06-cvs
12785 Copyright 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
12786 GDB is free software, @dots{}
12787 (@value{GDBP})
12788 @end smallexample
12789
12790 We can expand macros and examine their definitions, even when the
12791 program is not running. @value{GDBN} uses the current listing position
12792 to decide which macro definitions are in scope:
12793
12794 @smallexample
12795 (@value{GDBP}) list main
12796 3
12797 4 #define M 42
12798 5 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12799 6
12800 7 main ()
12801 8 @{
12802 9 #define N 28
12803 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12804 11 #undef N
12805 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12806 (@value{GDBP}) info macro ADD
12807 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:5
12808 #define ADD(x) (M + x)
12809 (@value{GDBP}) info macro Q
12810 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.h:1
12811 included at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:2
12812 #define Q <
12813 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand ADD(1)
12814 expands to: (42 + 1)
12815 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand-once ADD(1)
12816 expands to: once (M + 1)
12817 (@value{GDBP})
12818 @end smallexample
12819
12820 In the example above, note that @code{macro expand-once} expands only
12821 the macro invocation explicit in the original text --- the invocation of
12822 @code{ADD} --- but does not expand the invocation of the macro @code{M},
12823 which was introduced by @code{ADD}.
12824
12825 Once the program is running, @value{GDBN} uses the macro definitions in
12826 force at the source line of the current stack frame:
12827
12828 @smallexample
12829 (@value{GDBP}) break main
12830 Breakpoint 1 at 0x8048370: file sample.c, line 10.
12831 (@value{GDBP}) run
12832 Starting program: /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample
12833
12834 Breakpoint 1, main () at sample.c:10
12835 10 printf ("Hello, world!\n");
12836 (@value{GDBP})
12837 @end smallexample
12838
12839 At line 10, the definition of the macro @code{N} at line 9 is in force:
12840
12841 @smallexample
12842 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12843 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:9
12844 #define N 28
12845 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
12846 expands to: 28 < 42
12847 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
12848 $1 = 1
12849 (@value{GDBP})
12850 @end smallexample
12851
12852 As we step over directives that remove @code{N}'s definition, and then
12853 give it a new definition, @value{GDBN} finds the definition (or lack
12854 thereof) in force at each point:
12855
12856 @smallexample
12857 (@value{GDBP}) next
12858 Hello, world!
12859 12 printf ("We're so creative.\n");
12860 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12861 The symbol `N' has no definition as a C/C++ preprocessor macro
12862 at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:12
12863 (@value{GDBP}) next
12864 We're so creative.
12865 14 printf ("Goodbye, world!\n");
12866 (@value{GDBP}) info macro N
12867 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:13
12868 #define N 1729
12869 (@value{GDBP}) macro expand N Q M
12870 expands to: 1729 < 42
12871 (@value{GDBP}) print N Q M
12872 $2 = 0
12873 (@value{GDBP})
12874 @end smallexample
12875
12876 In addition to source files, macros can be defined on the compilation command
12877 line using the @option{-D@var{name}=@var{value}} syntax. For macros defined in
12878 such a way, @value{GDBN} displays the location of their definition as line zero
12879 of the source file submitted to the compiler.
12880
12881 @smallexample
12882 (@value{GDBP}) info macro __STDC__
12883 Defined at /home/jimb/gdb/macros/play/sample.c:0
12884 -D__STDC__=1
12885 (@value{GDBP})
12886 @end smallexample
12887
12888
12889 @node Tracepoints
12890 @chapter Tracepoints
12891 @c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
12892 @c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
12893
12894 @cindex tracepoints
12895 In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
12896 the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
12897 anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
12898 depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
12899 might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
12900 fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
12901 to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
12902
12903 Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
12904 specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
12905 arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
12906 Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
12907 those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
12908 expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
12909 for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
12910 a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
12911 in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
12912 values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
12913 unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
12914
12915 The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
12916 targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know
12917 how to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the
12918 remote stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN}
12919 support tracepoints as of this writing. The format of the remote
12920 packets used to implement tracepoints are described in @ref{Tracepoint
12921 Packets}.
12922
12923 It is also possible to get trace data from a file, in a manner reminiscent
12924 of corefiles; you specify the filename, and use @code{tfind} to search
12925 through the file. @xref{Trace Files}, for more details.
12926
12927 This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
12928
12929 @menu
12930 * Set Tracepoints::
12931 * Analyze Collected Data::
12932 * Tracepoint Variables::
12933 * Trace Files::
12934 @end menu
12935
12936 @node Set Tracepoints
12937 @section Commands to Set Tracepoints
12938
12939 Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
12940 tracepoints can be set. A tracepoint is actually a special type of
12941 breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), so you can manipulate it using
12942 standard breakpoint commands. For instance, as with breakpoints,
12943 tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from one, and many
12944 of the commands associated with tracepoints take the tracepoint number
12945 as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to work on.
12946
12947 For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
12948 of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
12949 it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
12950 local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
12951 commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
12952 tracepoint was hit.
12953
12954 Tracepoints do not support every breakpoint feature. Ignore counts on
12955 tracepoints have no effect, and tracepoints cannot run @value{GDBN}
12956 commands when they are hit. Tracepoints may not be thread-specific
12957 either.
12958
12959 @cindex fast tracepoints
12960 Some targets may support @dfn{fast tracepoints}, which are inserted in
12961 a different way (such as with a jump instead of a trap), that is
12962 faster but possibly restricted in where they may be installed.
12963
12964 @cindex static tracepoints
12965 @cindex markers, static tracepoints
12966 @cindex probing markers, static tracepoints
12967 Regular and fast tracepoints are dynamic tracing facilities, meaning
12968 that they can be used to insert tracepoints at (almost) any location
12969 in the target. Some targets may also support controlling @dfn{static
12970 tracepoints} from @value{GDBN}. With static tracing, a set of
12971 instrumentation points, also known as @dfn{markers}, are embedded in
12972 the target program, and can be activated or deactivated by name or
12973 address. These are usually placed at locations which facilitate
12974 investigating what the target is actually doing. @value{GDBN}'s
12975 support for static tracing includes being able to list instrumentation
12976 points, and attach them with @value{GDBN} defined high level
12977 tracepoints that expose the whole range of convenience of
12978 @value{GDBN}'s tracepoints support. Namely, support for collecting
12979 registers values and values of global or local (to the instrumentation
12980 point) variables; tracepoint conditions and trace state variables.
12981 The act of installing a @value{GDBN} static tracepoint on an
12982 instrumentation point, or marker, is referred to as @dfn{probing} a
12983 static tracepoint marker.
12984
12985 @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints on some target systems.
12986 @xref{Server,,Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}}.
12987
12988 This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
12989 conditions and actions.
12990
12991 @menu
12992 * Create and Delete Tracepoints::
12993 * Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
12994 * Tracepoint Passcounts::
12995 * Tracepoint Conditions::
12996 * Trace State Variables::
12997 * Tracepoint Actions::
12998 * Listing Tracepoints::
12999 * Listing Static Tracepoint Markers::
13000 * Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments::
13001 * Tracepoint Restrictions::
13002 @end menu
13003
13004 @node Create and Delete Tracepoints
13005 @subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
13006
13007 @table @code
13008 @cindex set tracepoint
13009 @kindex trace
13010 @item trace @var{location}
13011 The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
13012 Its argument @var{location} can be any valid location.
13013 @xref{Specify Location}. The @code{trace} command defines a tracepoint,
13014 which is a point in the target program where the debugger will briefly stop,
13015 collect some data, and then allow the program to continue. Setting a tracepoint
13016 or changing its actions takes effect immediately if the remote stub
13017 supports the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature (@pxref{install tracepoint
13018 in tracing}).
13019 If remote stub doesn't support the @samp{InstallInTrace} feature, all
13020 these changes don't take effect until the next @code{tstart}
13021 command, and once a trace experiment is running, further changes will
13022 not have any effect until the next trace experiment starts. In addition,
13023 @value{GDBN} supports @dfn{pending tracepoints}---tracepoints whose
13024 address is not yet resolved. (This is similar to pending breakpoints.)
13025 Pending tracepoints are not downloaded to the target and not installed
13026 until they are resolved. The resolution of pending tracepoints requires
13027 @value{GDBN} support---when debugging with the remote target, and
13028 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the remote stub (@pxref{disconnected
13029 tracing}), pending tracepoints can not be resolved (and downloaded to
13030 the remote stub) while @value{GDBN} is disconnected.
13031
13032 Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
13033
13034 @smallexample
13035 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
13036
13037 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
13038
13039 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
13040
13041 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
13042
13043 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
13044 @end smallexample
13045
13046 @noindent
13047 You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
13048
13049 @item trace @var{location} if @var{cond}
13050 Set a tracepoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
13051 @var{cond} each time the tracepoint is reached, and collect data only
13052 if the value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
13053 @xref{Tracepoint Conditions, ,Tracepoint Conditions}, for more
13054 information on tracepoint conditions.
13055
13056 @item ftrace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
13057 @cindex set fast tracepoint
13058 @cindex fast tracepoints, setting
13059 @kindex ftrace
13060 The @code{ftrace} command sets a fast tracepoint. For targets that
13061 support them, fast tracepoints will use a more efficient but possibly
13062 less general technique to trigger data collection, such as a jump
13063 instruction instead of a trap, or some sort of hardware support. It
13064 may not be possible to create a fast tracepoint at the desired
13065 location, in which case the command will exit with an explanatory
13066 message.
13067
13068 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{ftrace} exactly as for
13069 @code{trace}.
13070
13071 On 32-bit x86-architecture systems, fast tracepoints normally need to
13072 be placed at an instruction that is 5 bytes or longer, but can be
13073 placed at 4-byte instructions if the low 64K of memory of the target
13074 program is available to install trampolines. Some Unix-type systems,
13075 such as @sc{gnu}/Linux, exclude low addresses from the program's
13076 address space; but for instance with the Linux kernel it is possible
13077 to let @value{GDBN} use this area by doing a @command{sysctl} command
13078 to set the @code{mmap_min_addr} kernel parameter, as in
13079
13080 @example
13081 sudo sysctl -w vm.mmap_min_addr=32768
13082 @end example
13083
13084 @noindent
13085 which sets the low address to 32K, which leaves plenty of room for
13086 trampolines. The minimum address should be set to a page boundary.
13087
13088 @item strace @var{location} [ if @var{cond} ]
13089 @cindex set static tracepoint
13090 @cindex static tracepoints, setting
13091 @cindex probe static tracepoint marker
13092 @kindex strace
13093 The @code{strace} command sets a static tracepoint. For targets that
13094 support it, setting a static tracepoint probes a static
13095 instrumentation point, or marker, found at @var{location}. It may not
13096 be possible to set a static tracepoint at the desired location, in
13097 which case the command will exit with an explanatory message.
13098
13099 @value{GDBN} handles arguments to @code{strace} exactly as for
13100 @code{trace}, with the addition that the user can also specify
13101 @code{-m @var{marker}} as @var{location}. This probes the marker
13102 identified by the @var{marker} string identifier. This identifier
13103 depends on the static tracepoint backend library your program is
13104 using. You can find all the marker identifiers in the @samp{ID} field
13105 of the @code{info static-tracepoint-markers} command output.
13106 @xref{Listing Static Tracepoint Markers,,Listing Static Tracepoint
13107 Markers}. For example, in the following small program using the UST
13108 tracing engine:
13109
13110 @smallexample
13111 main ()
13112 @{
13113 trace_mark(ust, bar33, "str %s", "FOOBAZ");
13114 @}
13115 @end smallexample
13116
13117 @noindent
13118 the marker id is composed of joining the first two arguments to the
13119 @code{trace_mark} call with a slash, which translates to:
13120
13121 @smallexample
13122 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
13123 Cnt Enb ID Address What
13124 1 n ust/bar33 0x0000000000400ddc in main at stexample.c:22
13125 Data: "str %s"
13126 [etc...]
13127 @end smallexample
13128
13129 @noindent
13130 so you may probe the marker above with:
13131
13132 @smallexample
13133 (@value{GDBP}) strace -m ust/bar33
13134 @end smallexample
13135
13136 Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action --- @code{collect
13137 $_sdata}. This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point
13138 call to the tracing library. In the UST example above, you'll see
13139 that the third argument to @code{trace_mark} is a printf-like format
13140 string. The user data is then the result of running that formating
13141 string against the following arguments. Note that @code{info
13142 static-tracepoint-markers} command output lists that format string in
13143 the @samp{Data:} field.
13144
13145 You can inspect this data when analyzing the trace buffer, by printing
13146 the $_sdata variable like any other variable available to
13147 @value{GDBN}. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}.
13148
13149 @vindex $tpnum
13150 @cindex last tracepoint number
13151 @cindex recent tracepoint number
13152 @cindex tracepoint number
13153 The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
13154 of the most recently set tracepoint.
13155
13156 @kindex delete tracepoint
13157 @cindex tracepoint deletion
13158 @item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
13159 Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
13160 default is to delete all tracepoints. Note that the regular
13161 @code{delete} command can remove tracepoints also.
13162
13163 Examples:
13164
13165 @smallexample
13166 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
13167
13168 (@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
13169 @end smallexample
13170
13171 @noindent
13172 You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
13173 @end table
13174
13175 @node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
13176 @subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
13177
13178 These commands are deprecated; they are equivalent to plain @code{disable} and @code{enable}.
13179
13180 @table @code
13181 @kindex disable tracepoint
13182 @item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
13183 Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
13184 @var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
13185 a trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
13186 a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
13187 If the command is issued during a trace experiment and the debug target
13188 has support for disabling tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the
13189 change will be effective immediately. Otherwise, it will be applied to the
13190 next trace experiment.
13191
13192 @kindex enable tracepoint
13193 @item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
13194 Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. If this command is
13195 issued during a trace experiment and the debug target supports enabling
13196 tracepoints during a trace experiment, then the enabled tracepoints will
13197 become effective immediately. Otherwise, they will become effective the
13198 next time a trace experiment is run.
13199 @end table
13200
13201 @node Tracepoint Passcounts
13202 @subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
13203
13204 @table @code
13205 @kindex passcount
13206 @cindex tracepoint pass count
13207 @item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
13208 Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
13209 automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
13210 @var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
13211 the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
13212 @var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
13213 passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
13214 given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
13215 user.
13216
13217 Examples:
13218
13219 @smallexample
13220 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
13221 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
13222
13223 (@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
13224 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
13225 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
13226 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
13227 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
13228 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
13229 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
13230 (@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
13231 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
13232 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
13233 @exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
13234 @end smallexample
13235 @end table
13236
13237 @node Tracepoint Conditions
13238 @subsection Tracepoint Conditions
13239 @cindex conditional tracepoints
13240 @cindex tracepoint conditions
13241
13242 The simplest sort of tracepoint collects data every time your program
13243 reaches a specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for
13244 a tracepoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
13245 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A
13246 tracepoint with a condition evaluates the expression each time your
13247 program reaches it, and data collection happens only if the condition
13248 is true.
13249
13250 Tracepoint conditions can be specified when a tracepoint is set, by
13251 using @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{trace} command.
13252 @xref{Create and Delete Tracepoints, ,Setting Tracepoints}. They can
13253 also be set or changed at any time with the @code{condition} command,
13254 just as with breakpoints.
13255
13256 Unlike breakpoint conditions, @value{GDBN} does not actually evaluate
13257 the conditional expression itself. Instead, @value{GDBN} encodes the
13258 expression into an agent expression (@pxref{Agent Expressions})
13259 suitable for execution on the target, independently of @value{GDBN}.
13260 Global variables become raw memory locations, locals become stack
13261 accesses, and so forth.
13262
13263 For instance, suppose you have a function that is usually called
13264 frequently, but should not be called after an error has occurred. You
13265 could use the following tracepoint command to collect data about calls
13266 of that function that happen while the error code is propagating
13267 through the program; an unconditional tracepoint could end up
13268 collecting thousands of useless trace frames that you would have to
13269 search through.
13270
13271 @smallexample
13272 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{trace normal_operation if errcode > 0}
13273 @end smallexample
13274
13275 @node Trace State Variables
13276 @subsection Trace State Variables
13277 @cindex trace state variables
13278
13279 A @dfn{trace state variable} is a special type of variable that is
13280 created and managed by target-side code. The syntax is the same as
13281 that for GDB's convenience variables (a string prefixed with ``$''),
13282 but they are stored on the target. They must be created explicitly,
13283 using a @code{tvariable} command. They are always 64-bit signed
13284 integers.
13285
13286 Trace state variables are remembered by @value{GDBN}, and downloaded
13287 to the target along with tracepoint information when the trace
13288 experiment starts. There are no intrinsic limits on the number of
13289 trace state variables, beyond memory limitations of the target.
13290
13291 @cindex convenience variables, and trace state variables
13292 Although trace state variables are managed by the target, you can use
13293 them in print commands and expressions as if they were convenience
13294 variables; @value{GDBN} will get the current value from the target
13295 while the trace experiment is running. Trace state variables share
13296 the same namespace as other ``$'' variables, which means that you
13297 cannot have trace state variables with names like @code{$23} or
13298 @code{$pc}, nor can you have a trace state variable and a convenience
13299 variable with the same name.
13300
13301 @table @code
13302
13303 @item tvariable $@var{name} [ = @var{expression} ]
13304 @kindex tvariable
13305 The @code{tvariable} command creates a new trace state variable named
13306 @code{$@var{name}}, and optionally gives it an initial value of
13307 @var{expression}. The @var{expression} is evaluated when this command is
13308 entered; the result will be converted to an integer if possible,
13309 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error. A subsequent
13310 @code{tvariable} command specifying the same name does not create a
13311 variable, but instead assigns the supplied initial value to the
13312 existing variable of that name, overwriting any previous initial
13313 value. The default initial value is 0.
13314
13315 @item info tvariables
13316 @kindex info tvariables
13317 List all the trace state variables along with their initial values.
13318 Their current values may also be displayed, if the trace experiment is
13319 currently running.
13320
13321 @item delete tvariable @r{[} $@var{name} @dots{} @r{]}
13322 @kindex delete tvariable
13323 Delete the given trace state variables, or all of them if no arguments
13324 are specified.
13325
13326 @end table
13327
13328 @node Tracepoint Actions
13329 @subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
13330
13331 @table @code
13332 @kindex actions
13333 @cindex tracepoint actions
13334 @item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
13335 This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
13336 tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
13337 specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
13338 recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
13339 @code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
13340 actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
13341 terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
13342 far, the only defined actions are @code{collect}, @code{teval}, and
13343 @code{while-stepping}.
13344
13345 @code{actions} is actually equivalent to @code{commands} (@pxref{Break
13346 Commands, ,Breakpoint Command Lists}), except that only the defined
13347 actions are allowed; any other @value{GDBN} command is rejected.
13348
13349 @cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
13350 To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
13351 and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
13352
13353 @smallexample
13354 (@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
13355
13356 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
13357
13358 (@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
13359 @end smallexample
13360
13361 In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
13362 commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
13363 hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
13364 following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
13365 followed by the list of things to be collected after each step in a
13366 sequence of single steps. The @code{while-stepping} command is
13367 terminated by its own separate @code{end} command. Lastly, the action
13368 list is terminated by an @code{end} command.
13369
13370 @smallexample
13371 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
13372 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
13373 Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
13374 > collect bar,baz
13375 > collect $regs
13376 > while-stepping 12
13377 > collect $pc, arr[i]
13378 > end
13379 end
13380 @end smallexample
13381
13382 @kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
13383 @item collect@r{[}/@var{mods}@r{]} @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
13384 Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
13385 This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
13386 In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
13387 special arguments are supported:
13388
13389 @table @code
13390 @item $regs
13391 Collect all registers.
13392
13393 @item $args
13394 Collect all function arguments.
13395
13396 @item $locals
13397 Collect all local variables.
13398
13399 @item $_ret
13400 Collect the return address. This is helpful if you want to see more
13401 of a backtrace.
13402
13403 @emph{Note:} The return address location can not always be reliably
13404 determined up front, and the wrong address / registers may end up
13405 collected instead. On some architectures the reliability is higher
13406 for tracepoints at function entry, while on others it's the opposite.
13407 When this happens, backtracing will stop because the return address is
13408 found unavailable (unless another collect rule happened to match it).
13409
13410 @item $_probe_argc
13411 Collects the number of arguments from the static probe at which the
13412 tracepoint is located.
13413 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
13414
13415 @item $_probe_arg@var{n}
13416 @var{n} is an integer between 0 and 11. Collects the @var{n}th argument
13417 from the static probe at which the tracepoint is located.
13418 @xref{Static Probe Points}.
13419
13420 @item $_sdata
13421 @vindex $_sdata@r{, collect}
13422 Collect static tracepoint marker specific data. Only available for
13423 static tracepoints. @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action
13424 Lists}. On the UST static tracepoints library backend, an
13425 instrumentation point resembles a @code{printf} function call. The
13426 tracing library is able to collect user specified data formatted to a
13427 character string using the format provided by the programmer that
13428 instrumented the program. Other backends have similar mechanisms.
13429 Here's an example of a UST marker call:
13430
13431 @smallexample
13432 const char master_name[] = "$your_name";
13433 trace_mark(channel1, marker1, "hello %s", master_name)
13434 @end smallexample
13435
13436 In this case, collecting @code{$_sdata} collects the string
13437 @samp{hello $yourname}. When analyzing the trace buffer, you can
13438 inspect @samp{$_sdata} like any other variable available to
13439 @value{GDBN}.
13440 @end table
13441
13442 You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
13443 with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
13444 arguments separated by commas; the effect is the same.
13445
13446 The optional @var{mods} changes the usual handling of the arguments.
13447 @code{s} requests that pointers to chars be handled as strings, in
13448 particular collecting the contents of the memory being pointed at, up
13449 to the first zero. The upper bound is by default the value of the
13450 @code{print elements} variable; if @code{s} is followed by a decimal
13451 number, that is the upper bound instead. So for instance
13452 @samp{collect/s25 mystr} collects as many as 25 characters at
13453 @samp{mystr}.
13454
13455 The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
13456 particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
13457
13458 @kindex teval @r{(tracepoints)}
13459 @item teval @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
13460 Evaluate the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit. This
13461 command accepts a comma-separated list of expressions. The results
13462 are discarded, so this is mainly useful for assigning values to trace
13463 state variables (@pxref{Trace State Variables}) without adding those
13464 values to the trace buffer, as would be the case if the @code{collect}
13465 action were used.
13466
13467 @kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
13468 @item while-stepping @var{n}
13469 Perform @var{n} single-step instruction traces after the tracepoint,
13470 collecting new data after each step. The @code{while-stepping}
13471 command is followed by the list of what to collect while stepping
13472 (followed by its own @code{end} command):
13473
13474 @smallexample
13475 > while-stepping 12
13476 > collect $regs, myglobal
13477 > end
13478 >
13479 @end smallexample
13480
13481 @noindent
13482 Note that @code{$pc} is not automatically collected by
13483 @code{while-stepping}; you need to explicitly collect that register if
13484 you need it. You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
13485 @code{stepping}.
13486
13487 @item set default-collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
13488 @kindex set default-collect
13489 @cindex default collection action
13490 This variable is a list of expressions to collect at each tracepoint
13491 hit. It is effectively an additional @code{collect} action prepended
13492 to every tracepoint action list. The expressions are parsed
13493 individually for each tracepoint, so for instance a variable named
13494 @code{xyz} may be interpreted as a global for one tracepoint, and a
13495 local for another, as appropriate to the tracepoint's location.
13496
13497 @item show default-collect
13498 @kindex show default-collect
13499 Show the list of expressions that are collected by default at each
13500 tracepoint hit.
13501
13502 @end table
13503
13504 @node Listing Tracepoints
13505 @subsection Listing Tracepoints
13506
13507 @table @code
13508 @kindex info tracepoints @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
13509 @kindex info tp @r{[}@var{n}@dots{}@r{]}
13510 @cindex information about tracepoints
13511 @item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@dots{}@r{]}
13512 Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't
13513 specify a tracepoint number, displays information about all the
13514 tracepoints defined so far. The format is similar to that used for
13515 @code{info breakpoints}; in fact, @code{info tracepoints} is the same
13516 command, simply restricting itself to tracepoints.
13517
13518 A tracepoint's listing may include additional information specific to
13519 tracing:
13520
13521 @itemize @bullet
13522 @item
13523 its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
13524
13525 @item
13526 the state about installed on target of each location
13527 @end itemize
13528
13529 @smallexample
13530 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
13531 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
13532 1 tracepoint keep y 0x0804ab57 in foo() at main.cxx:7
13533 while-stepping 20
13534 collect globfoo, $regs
13535 end
13536 collect globfoo2
13537 end
13538 pass count 1200
13539 2 tracepoint keep y <MULTIPLE>
13540 collect $eip
13541 2.1 y 0x0804859c in func4 at change-loc.h:35
13542 installed on target
13543 2.2 y 0xb7ffc480 in func4 at change-loc.h:35
13544 installed on target
13545 2.3 y <PENDING> set_tracepoint
13546 3 tracepoint keep y 0x080485b1 in foo at change-loc.c:29
13547 not installed on target
13548 (@value{GDBP})
13549 @end smallexample
13550
13551 @noindent
13552 This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
13553 @end table
13554
13555 @node Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
13556 @subsection Listing Static Tracepoint Markers
13557
13558 @table @code
13559 @kindex info static-tracepoint-markers
13560 @cindex information about static tracepoint markers
13561 @item info static-tracepoint-markers
13562 Display information about all static tracepoint markers defined in the
13563 program.
13564
13565 For each marker, the following columns are printed:
13566
13567 @table @emph
13568 @item Count
13569 An incrementing counter, output to help readability. This is not a
13570 stable identifier.
13571 @item ID
13572 The marker ID, as reported by the target.
13573 @item Enabled or Disabled
13574 Probed markers are tagged with @samp{y}. @samp{n} identifies marks
13575 that are not enabled.
13576 @item Address
13577 Where the marker is in your program, as a memory address.
13578 @item What
13579 Where the marker is in the source for your program, as a file and line
13580 number. If the debug information included in the program does not
13581 allow @value{GDBN} to locate the source of the marker, this column
13582 will be left blank.
13583 @end table
13584
13585 @noindent
13586 In addition, the following information may be printed for each marker:
13587
13588 @table @emph
13589 @item Data
13590 User data passed to the tracing library by the marker call. In the
13591 UST backend, this is the format string passed as argument to the
13592 marker call.
13593 @item Static tracepoints probing the marker
13594 The list of static tracepoints attached to the marker.
13595 @end table
13596
13597 @smallexample
13598 (@value{GDBP}) info static-tracepoint-markers
13599 Cnt ID Enb Address What
13600 1 ust/bar2 y 0x0000000000400e1a in main at stexample.c:25
13601 Data: number1 %d number2 %d
13602 Probed by static tracepoints: #2
13603 2 ust/bar33 n 0x0000000000400c87 in main at stexample.c:24
13604 Data: str %s
13605 (@value{GDBP})
13606 @end smallexample
13607 @end table
13608
13609 @node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
13610 @subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiments
13611
13612 @table @code
13613 @kindex tstart [ @var{notes} ]
13614 @cindex start a new trace experiment
13615 @cindex collected data discarded
13616 @item tstart
13617 This command starts the trace experiment, and begins collecting data.
13618 It has the side effect of discarding all the data collected in the
13619 trace buffer during the previous trace experiment. If any arguments
13620 are supplied, they are taken as a note and stored with the trace
13621 experiment's state. The notes may be arbitrary text, and are
13622 especially useful with disconnected tracing in a multi-user context;
13623 the notes can explain what the trace is doing, supply user contact
13624 information, and so forth.
13625
13626 @kindex tstop [ @var{notes} ]
13627 @cindex stop a running trace experiment
13628 @item tstop
13629 This command stops the trace experiment. If any arguments are
13630 supplied, they are recorded with the experiment as a note. This is
13631 useful if you are stopping a trace started by someone else, for
13632 instance if the trace is interfering with the system's behavior and
13633 needs to be stopped quickly.
13634
13635 @strong{Note}: a trace experiment and data collection may stop
13636 automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
13637 (@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
13638
13639 @kindex tstatus
13640 @cindex status of trace data collection
13641 @cindex trace experiment, status of
13642 @item tstatus
13643 This command displays the status of the current trace data
13644 collection.
13645 @end table
13646
13647 Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
13648
13649 @smallexample
13650 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
13651 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
13652 Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
13653 > collect $regs,$locals,$args
13654 > while-stepping 11
13655 > collect $regs
13656 > end
13657 > end
13658 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
13659 [time passes @dots{}]
13660 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
13661 @end smallexample
13662
13663 @anchor{disconnected tracing}
13664 @cindex disconnected tracing
13665 You can choose to continue running the trace experiment even if
13666 @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target, voluntarily or
13667 involuntarily. For commands such as @code{detach}, the debugger will
13668 ask what you want to do with the trace. But for unexpected
13669 terminations (@value{GDBN} crash, network outage), it would be
13670 unfortunate to lose hard-won trace data, so the variable
13671 @code{disconnected-tracing} lets you decide whether the trace should
13672 continue running without @value{GDBN}.
13673
13674 @table @code
13675 @item set disconnected-tracing on
13676 @itemx set disconnected-tracing off
13677 @kindex set disconnected-tracing
13678 Choose whether a tracing run should continue to run if @value{GDBN}
13679 has disconnected from the target. Note that @code{detach} or
13680 @code{quit} will ask you directly what to do about a running trace no
13681 matter what this variable's setting, so the variable is mainly useful
13682 for handling unexpected situations, such as loss of the network.
13683
13684 @item show disconnected-tracing
13685 @kindex show disconnected-tracing
13686 Show the current choice for disconnected tracing.
13687
13688 @end table
13689
13690 When you reconnect to the target, the trace experiment may or may not
13691 still be running; it might have filled the trace buffer in the
13692 meantime, or stopped for one of the other reasons. If it is running,
13693 it will continue after reconnection.
13694
13695 Upon reconnection, the target will upload information about the
13696 tracepoints in effect. @value{GDBN} will then compare that
13697 information to the set of tracepoints currently defined, and attempt
13698 to match them up, allowing for the possibility that the numbers may
13699 have changed due to creation and deletion in the meantime. If one of
13700 the target's tracepoints does not match any in @value{GDBN}, the
13701 debugger will create a new tracepoint, so that you have a number with
13702 which to specify that tracepoint. This matching-up process is
13703 necessarily heuristic, and it may result in useless tracepoints being
13704 created; you may simply delete them if they are of no use.
13705
13706 @cindex circular trace buffer
13707 If your target agent supports a @dfn{circular trace buffer}, then you
13708 can run a trace experiment indefinitely without filling the trace
13709 buffer; when space runs out, the agent deletes already-collected trace
13710 frames, oldest first, until there is enough room to continue
13711 collecting. This is especially useful if your tracepoints are being
13712 hit too often, and your trace gets terminated prematurely because the
13713 buffer is full. To ask for a circular trace buffer, simply set
13714 @samp{circular-trace-buffer} to on. You can set this at any time,
13715 including during tracing; if the agent can do it, it will change
13716 buffer handling on the fly, otherwise it will not take effect until
13717 the next run.
13718
13719 @table @code
13720 @item set circular-trace-buffer on
13721 @itemx set circular-trace-buffer off
13722 @kindex set circular-trace-buffer
13723 Choose whether a tracing run should use a linear or circular buffer
13724 for trace data. A linear buffer will not lose any trace data, but may
13725 fill up prematurely, while a circular buffer will discard old trace
13726 data, but it will have always room for the latest tracepoint hits.
13727
13728 @item show circular-trace-buffer
13729 @kindex show circular-trace-buffer
13730 Show the current choice for the trace buffer. Note that this may not
13731 match the agent's current buffer handling, nor is it guaranteed to
13732 match the setting that might have been in effect during a past run,
13733 for instance if you are looking at frames from a trace file.
13734
13735 @end table
13736
13737 @table @code
13738 @item set trace-buffer-size @var{n}
13739 @itemx set trace-buffer-size unlimited
13740 @kindex set trace-buffer-size
13741 Request that the target use a trace buffer of @var{n} bytes. Not all
13742 targets will honor the request; they may have a compiled-in size for
13743 the trace buffer, or some other limitation. Set to a value of
13744 @code{unlimited} or @code{-1} to let the target use whatever size it
13745 likes. This is also the default.
13746
13747 @item show trace-buffer-size
13748 @kindex show trace-buffer-size
13749 Show the current requested size for the trace buffer. Note that this
13750 will only match the actual size if the target supports size-setting,
13751 and was able to handle the requested size. For instance, if the
13752 target can only change buffer size between runs, this variable will
13753 not reflect the change until the next run starts. Use @code{tstatus}
13754 to get a report of the actual buffer size.
13755 @end table
13756
13757 @table @code
13758 @item set trace-user @var{text}
13759 @kindex set trace-user
13760
13761 @item show trace-user
13762 @kindex show trace-user
13763
13764 @item set trace-notes @var{text}
13765 @kindex set trace-notes
13766 Set the trace run's notes.
13767
13768 @item show trace-notes
13769 @kindex show trace-notes
13770 Show the trace run's notes.
13771
13772 @item set trace-stop-notes @var{text}
13773 @kindex set trace-stop-notes
13774 Set the trace run's stop notes. The handling of the note is as for
13775 @code{tstop} arguments; the set command is convenient way to fix a
13776 stop note that is mistaken or incomplete.
13777
13778 @item show trace-stop-notes
13779 @kindex show trace-stop-notes
13780 Show the trace run's stop notes.
13781
13782 @end table
13783
13784 @node Tracepoint Restrictions
13785 @subsection Tracepoint Restrictions
13786
13787 @cindex tracepoint restrictions
13788 There are a number of restrictions on the use of tracepoints. As
13789 described above, tracepoint data gathering occurs on the target
13790 without interaction from @value{GDBN}. Thus the full capabilities of
13791 the debugger are not available during data gathering, and then at data
13792 examination time, you will be limited by only having what was
13793 collected. The following items describe some common problems, but it
13794 is not exhaustive, and you may run into additional difficulties not
13795 mentioned here.
13796
13797 @itemize @bullet
13798
13799 @item
13800 Tracepoint expressions are intended to gather objects (lvalues). Thus
13801 the full flexibility of GDB's expression evaluator is not available.
13802 You cannot call functions, cast objects to aggregate types, access
13803 convenience variables or modify values (except by assignment to trace
13804 state variables). Some language features may implicitly call
13805 functions (for instance Objective-C fields with accessors), and therefore
13806 cannot be collected either.
13807
13808 @item
13809 Collection of local variables, either individually or in bulk with
13810 @code{$locals} or @code{$args}, during @code{while-stepping} may
13811 behave erratically. The stepping action may enter a new scope (for
13812 instance by stepping into a function), or the location of the variable
13813 may change (for instance it is loaded into a register). The
13814 tracepoint data recorded uses the location information for the
13815 variables that is correct for the tracepoint location. When the
13816 tracepoint is created, it is not possible, in general, to determine
13817 where the steps of a @code{while-stepping} sequence will advance the
13818 program---particularly if a conditional branch is stepped.
13819
13820 @item
13821 Collection of an incompletely-initialized or partially-destroyed object
13822 may result in something that @value{GDBN} cannot display, or displays
13823 in a misleading way.
13824
13825 @item
13826 When @value{GDBN} displays a pointer to character it automatically
13827 dereferences the pointer to also display characters of the string
13828 being pointed to. However, collecting the pointer during tracing does
13829 not automatically collect the string. You need to explicitly
13830 dereference the pointer and provide size information if you want to
13831 collect not only the pointer, but the memory pointed to. For example,
13832 @code{*ptr@@50} can be used to collect the 50 element array pointed to
13833 by @code{ptr}.
13834
13835 @item
13836 It is not possible to collect a complete stack backtrace at a
13837 tracepoint. Instead, you may collect the registers and a few hundred
13838 bytes from the stack pointer with something like @code{*(unsigned char *)$esp@@300}
13839 (adjust to use the name of the actual stack pointer register on your
13840 target architecture, and the amount of stack you wish to capture).
13841 Then the @code{backtrace} command will show a partial backtrace when
13842 using a trace frame. The number of stack frames that can be examined
13843 depends on the sizes of the frames in the collected stack. Note that
13844 if you ask for a block so large that it goes past the bottom of the
13845 stack, the target agent may report an error trying to read from an
13846 invalid address.
13847
13848 @item
13849 If you do not collect registers at a tracepoint, @value{GDBN} can
13850 infer that the value of @code{$pc} must be the same as the address of
13851 the tracepoint and use that when you are looking at a trace frame
13852 for that tracepoint. However, this cannot work if the tracepoint has
13853 multiple locations (for instance if it was set in a function that was
13854 inlined), or if it has a @code{while-stepping} loop. In those cases
13855 @value{GDBN} will warn you that it can't infer @code{$pc}, and default
13856 it to zero.
13857
13858 @end itemize
13859
13860 @node Analyze Collected Data
13861 @section Using the Collected Data
13862
13863 After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
13864 for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
13865 collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
13866 snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
13867 consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
13868 examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
13869 specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
13870 snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
13871 registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
13872 rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
13873 debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
13874 (@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
13875 behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
13876 when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
13877 the buffer will fail.
13878
13879 @menu
13880 * tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
13881 * tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
13882 * save tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
13883 @end menu
13884
13885 @node tfind
13886 @subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
13887
13888 @kindex tfind
13889 @cindex select trace snapshot
13890 @cindex find trace snapshot
13891 The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
13892 @code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
13893 counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
13894 snapshot is selected.
13895
13896 Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
13897
13898 @table @code
13899 @item tfind start
13900 Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
13901 @code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
13902
13903 @item tfind none
13904 Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
13905
13906 @item tfind end
13907 Same as @samp{tfind none}.
13908
13909 @item tfind
13910 No argument means find the next trace snapshot or find the first
13911 one if no trace snapshot is selected.
13912
13913 @item tfind -
13914 Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
13915 retracing earlier steps.
13916
13917 @item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
13918 Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
13919 proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
13920 argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
13921 for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
13922
13923 @item tfind pc @var{addr}
13924 Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
13925 program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
13926 snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
13927 snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
13928
13929 @item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
13930 Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
13931 addresses (exclusive).
13932
13933 @item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
13934 Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
13935 @var{addr2} (inclusive).
13936
13937 @item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
13938 Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
13939 the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
13940 that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
13941 trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
13942 next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
13943 @code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
13944 stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
13945 @end table
13946
13947 The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
13948 designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
13949 instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
13950 snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
13951 trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
13952 simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
13953 snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
13954 @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
13955 The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
13956 for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
13957 no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
13958 (PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
13959 no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
13960 tracepoint as the current one.
13961
13962 In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
13963 these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
13964 scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
13965 you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
13966 registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
13967
13968 @smallexample
13969 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13970 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
13971 > printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
13972 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
13973 > tfind
13974 > end
13975
13976 Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
13977 Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
13978 Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
13979 Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
13980 Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
13981 Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
13982 Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
13983 Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
13984 Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
13985 Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
13986 Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
13987 @end smallexample
13988
13989 Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
13990 the buffer:
13991
13992 @smallexample
13993 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
13994 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
13995 > printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
13996 > tfind line
13997 > end
13998
13999 Frame 0, X = 1
14000 Frame 7, X = 2
14001 Frame 13, X = 255
14002 @end smallexample
14003
14004 @node tdump
14005 @subsection @code{tdump}
14006 @kindex tdump
14007 @cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
14008 @cindex tracepoint data, display
14009
14010 This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
14011 the current trace snapshot.
14012
14013 @smallexample
14014 (@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
14015 (@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
14016 Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
14017 > collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
14018 > end
14019
14020 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
14021
14022 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
14023 #0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
14024 at gdb_test.c:444
14025 444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
14026
14027 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
14028 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
14029 d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
14030 d1 0x18 24
14031 d2 0x80 128
14032 d3 0x33 51
14033 d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
14034 d5 0x22 34
14035 d6 0xe0 224
14036 d7 0x380035 3670069
14037 a0 0x19e24a 1696330
14038 a1 0x3000668 50333288
14039 a2 0x100 256
14040 a3 0x322000 3284992
14041 a4 0x3000698 50333336
14042 a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
14043 fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
14044 sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
14045 ps 0x0 0
14046 pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
14047 fpcontrol 0x0 0
14048 fpstatus 0x0 0
14049 fpiaddr 0x0 0
14050 p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
14051 p1 = (void *) 0x11
14052 p2 = (void *) 0x22
14053 p3 = (void *) 0x33
14054 p4 = (void *) 0x44
14055 p5 = (void *) 0x55
14056 p6 = (void *) 0x66
14057 gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
14058
14059 (@value{GDBP})
14060 @end smallexample
14061
14062 @code{tdump} works by scanning the tracepoint's current collection
14063 actions and printing the value of each expression listed. So
14064 @code{tdump} can fail, if after a run, you change the tracepoint's
14065 actions to mention variables that were not collected during the run.
14066
14067 Also, for tracepoints with @code{while-stepping} loops, @code{tdump}
14068 uses the collected value of @code{$pc} to distinguish between trace
14069 frames that were collected at the tracepoint hit, and frames that were
14070 collected while stepping. This allows it to correctly choose whether
14071 to display the basic list of collections, or the collections from the
14072 body of the while-stepping loop. However, if @code{$pc} was not collected,
14073 then @code{tdump} will always attempt to dump using the basic collection
14074 list, and may fail if a while-stepping frame does not include all the
14075 same data that is collected at the tracepoint hit.
14076 @c This is getting pretty arcane, example would be good.
14077
14078 @node save tracepoints
14079 @subsection @code{save tracepoints @var{filename}}
14080 @kindex save tracepoints
14081 @kindex save-tracepoints
14082 @cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
14083
14084 This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
14085 their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
14086 suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
14087 tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
14088 Files}). The @w{@code{save-tracepoints}} command is a deprecated
14089 alias for @w{@code{save tracepoints}}
14090
14091 @node Tracepoint Variables
14092 @section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
14093 @cindex tracepoint variables
14094 @cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
14095
14096 @table @code
14097 @vindex $trace_frame
14098 @item (int) $trace_frame
14099 The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
14100 snapshot is selected.
14101
14102 @vindex $tracepoint
14103 @item (int) $tracepoint
14104 The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
14105
14106 @vindex $trace_line
14107 @item (int) $trace_line
14108 The line number for the current trace snapshot.
14109
14110 @vindex $trace_file
14111 @item (char []) $trace_file
14112 The source file for the current trace snapshot.
14113
14114 @vindex $trace_func
14115 @item (char []) $trace_func
14116 The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
14117 @end table
14118
14119 Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
14120 use @code{output} instead.
14121
14122 Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
14123 stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
14124 data. Note that these are not the same as trace state variables,
14125 which are managed by the target.
14126
14127 @smallexample
14128 (@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
14129
14130 (@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
14131 > output $trace_file
14132 > printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
14133 > tfind
14134 > end
14135 @end smallexample
14136
14137 @node Trace Files
14138 @section Using Trace Files
14139 @cindex trace files
14140
14141 In some situations, the target running a trace experiment may no
14142 longer be available; perhaps it crashed, or the hardware was needed
14143 for a different activity. To handle these cases, you can arrange to
14144 dump the trace data into a file, and later use that file as a source
14145 of trace data, via the @code{target tfile} command.
14146
14147 @table @code
14148
14149 @kindex tsave
14150 @item tsave [ -r ] @var{filename}
14151 @itemx tsave [-ctf] @var{dirname}
14152 Save the trace data to @var{filename}. By default, this command
14153 assumes that @var{filename} refers to the host filesystem, so if
14154 necessary @value{GDBN} will copy raw trace data up from the target and
14155 then save it. If the target supports it, you can also supply the
14156 optional argument @code{-r} (``remote'') to direct the target to save
14157 the data directly into @var{filename} in its own filesystem, which may be
14158 more efficient if the trace buffer is very large. (Note, however, that
14159 @code{target tfile} can only read from files accessible to the host.)
14160 By default, this command will save trace frame in tfile format.
14161 You can supply the optional argument @code{-ctf} to save data in CTF
14162 format. The @dfn{Common Trace Format} (CTF) is proposed as a trace format
14163 that can be shared by multiple debugging and tracing tools. Please go to
14164 @indicateurl{http://www.efficios.com/ctf} to get more information.
14165
14166 @kindex target tfile
14167 @kindex tfile
14168 @kindex target ctf
14169 @kindex ctf
14170 @item target tfile @var{filename}
14171 @itemx target ctf @var{dirname}
14172 Use the file named @var{filename} or directory named @var{dirname} as
14173 a source of trace data. Commands that examine data work as they do with
14174 a live target, but it is not possible to run any new trace experiments.
14175 @code{tstatus} will report the state of the trace run at the moment
14176 the data was saved, as well as the current trace frame you are examining.
14177 Both @var{filename} and @var{dirname} must be on a filesystem accessible to
14178 the host.
14179
14180 @smallexample
14181 (@value{GDBP}) target ctf ctf.ctf
14182 (@value{GDBP}) tfind
14183 Found trace frame 0, tracepoint 2
14184 39 ++a; /* set tracepoint 1 here */
14185 (@value{GDBP}) tdump
14186 Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 0:
14187 i = 0
14188 a = 0
14189 b = 1 '\001'
14190 c = @{"123", "456", "789", "123", "456", "789"@}
14191 d = @{@{@{a = 1, b = 2@}, @{a = 3, b = 4@}@}, @{@{a = 5, b = 6@}, @{a = 7, b = 8@}@}@}
14192 (@value{GDBP}) p b
14193 $1 = 1
14194 @end smallexample
14195
14196 @end table
14197
14198 @node Overlays
14199 @chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
14200 @cindex overlays
14201
14202 If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
14203 memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
14204 problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
14205 use overlays.
14206
14207 @menu
14208 * How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
14209 * Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
14210 * Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
14211 mapped by asking the inferior.
14212 * Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
14213 @end menu
14214
14215 @node How Overlays Work
14216 @section How Overlays Work
14217 @cindex mapped overlays
14218 @cindex unmapped overlays
14219 @cindex load address, overlay's
14220 @cindex mapped address
14221 @cindex overlay area
14222
14223 Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
14224 kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
14225 other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
14226 management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
14227 adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
14228
14229 One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
14230 independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
14231 @dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
14232 their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
14233 instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
14234 largest overlay as well.
14235
14236 Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
14237 overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
14238 for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
14239 there.
14240
14241 @c NB: In the below the mapped area's size is greater or equal to the
14242 @c size of all overlays. This is intentional to remind the developer
14243 @c that overlays don't necessarily need to be the same size.
14244
14245 @smallexample
14246 @group
14247 Data Instruction Larger
14248 Address Space Address Space Address Space
14249 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
14250 | | | | | |
14251 +-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
14252 | program | | main | .----| overlay 1 | load address
14253 | variables | | program | | +-----------+
14254 | and heap | | | | | |
14255 +-----------+ | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 2
14256 | | +-----------+ | | | load address
14257 +-----------+ | | | .-| overlay 2 |
14258 | | | | | |
14259 mapped --->+-----------+ | | +-----------+
14260 address | | | | | |
14261 | overlay | <-' | | |
14262 | area | <---' +-----------+<-- overlay 3
14263 | | <---. | | load address
14264 +-----------+ `--| overlay 3 |
14265 | | | |
14266 +-----------+ | |
14267 +-----------+
14268 | |
14269 +-----------+
14270
14271 @anchor{A code overlay}A code overlay
14272 @end group
14273 @end smallexample
14274
14275 The diagram (@pxref{A code overlay}) shows a system with separate data
14276 and instruction address spaces. To map an overlay, the program copies
14277 its code from the larger address space to the instruction address space.
14278 Since the overlays shown here all use the same mapped address, only one
14279 may be mapped at a time. For a system with a single address space for
14280 data and instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the
14281 program variables and heap would share an address space with the main
14282 program and the overlay area.
14283
14284 An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
14285 @dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
14286 instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
14287 in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
14288 is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
14289 the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
14290 called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
14291
14292 Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
14293 program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
14294 global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
14295
14296 @itemize @bullet
14297
14298 @item
14299 Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
14300 must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
14301 return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
14302 overlay, and your program will probably crash.
14303
14304 @item
14305 If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
14306 will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
14307 your program's performance.
14308
14309 @item
14310 The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
14311 overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
14312 mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
14313 and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
14314 You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
14315 addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
14316 ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
14317
14318 @item
14319 The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
14320 to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
14321 instruction and data spaces.
14322
14323 @end itemize
14324
14325 The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
14326 improved in many ways:
14327
14328 @itemize @bullet
14329
14330 @item
14331 If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
14332 hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
14333 contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
14334 This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
14335 area in the usual way.
14336
14337 @item
14338 If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
14339 overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
14340
14341 @item
14342 You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
14343 general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
14344 code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
14345 return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
14346 the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
14347 must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
14348 different data overlay into the same mapped area.
14349
14350 @end itemize
14351
14352
14353 @node Overlay Commands
14354 @section Overlay Commands
14355
14356 To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
14357 correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
14358 virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
14359 mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
14360 @value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
14361 variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
14362
14363 @value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
14364 you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
14365
14366 @table @code
14367 @item overlay off
14368 @kindex overlay
14369 Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
14370 disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
14371 always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
14372 overlay support is disabled.
14373
14374 @item overlay manual
14375 @cindex manual overlay debugging
14376 Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
14377 relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
14378 using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
14379 commands described below.
14380
14381 @item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
14382 @itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
14383 @cindex map an overlay
14384 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
14385 be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
14386 overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
14387 functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
14388 that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
14389 @var{overlay} are now unmapped.
14390
14391 @item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
14392 @itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
14393 @cindex unmap an overlay
14394 Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
14395 must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
14396 When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
14397 overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
14398
14399 @item overlay auto
14400 Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
14401 consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
14402 to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
14403 Overlay Debugging}.
14404
14405 @item overlay load-target
14406 @itemx overlay load
14407 @cindex reloading the overlay table
14408 Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
14409 re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
14410 stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
14411 overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
14412 useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
14413
14414 @item overlay list-overlays
14415 @itemx overlay list
14416 @cindex listing mapped overlays
14417 Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
14418 addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
14419
14420 @end table
14421
14422 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
14423 of the function the address falls in:
14424
14425 @smallexample
14426 (@value{GDBP}) print main
14427 $3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
14428 @end smallexample
14429 @noindent
14430 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
14431 unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
14432 asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
14433 unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
14434
14435 @smallexample
14436 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
14437 No sections are mapped.
14438 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
14439 $5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
14440 @end smallexample
14441 @noindent
14442 When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
14443 name normally:
14444
14445 @smallexample
14446 (@value{GDBP}) overlay list
14447 Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
14448 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
14449 (@value{GDBP}) print foo
14450 $6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
14451 @end smallexample
14452
14453 When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
14454 address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
14455 overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
14456 @code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
14457 code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
14458
14459 @itemize @bullet
14460 @item
14461 @cindex breakpoints in overlays
14462 @cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
14463 You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
14464 @value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
14465 @item
14466 @value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
14467 unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
14468 overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
14469 you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
14470 breakpoints properly.
14471 @end itemize
14472
14473
14474 @node Automatic Overlay Debugging
14475 @section Automatic Overlay Debugging
14476 @cindex automatic overlay debugging
14477
14478 @value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
14479 are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
14480 inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
14481 @code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
14482 looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
14483 current state of the overlays.
14484
14485 Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
14486 @value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
14487
14488 @table @asis
14489
14490 @item @code{_ovly_table}:
14491 This variable must be an array of the following structures:
14492
14493 @smallexample
14494 struct
14495 @{
14496 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
14497 unsigned long vma;
14498
14499 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
14500 unsigned long size;
14501
14502 /* The overlay's load address. */
14503 unsigned long lma;
14504
14505 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
14506 zero otherwise. */
14507 unsigned long mapped;
14508 @}
14509 @end smallexample
14510
14511 @item @code{_novlys}:
14512 This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
14513 number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
14514
14515 @end table
14516
14517 To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
14518 looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
14519 @code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
14520 executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
14521 the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
14522 currently mapped.
14523
14524 In addition, your overlay manager may define a function called
14525 @code{_ovly_debug_event}. If this function is defined, @value{GDBN}
14526 will silently set a breakpoint there. If the overlay manager then
14527 calls this function whenever it has changed the overlay table, this
14528 will enable @value{GDBN} to accurately keep track of which overlays
14529 are in program memory, and update any breakpoints that may be set
14530 in overlays. This will allow breakpoints to work even if the
14531 overlays are kept in ROM or other non-writable memory while they
14532 are not being executed.
14533
14534 @node Overlay Sample Program
14535 @section Overlay Sample Program
14536 @cindex overlay example program
14537
14538 When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
14539 at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
14540 addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
14541 Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
14542 since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
14543 architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
14544 portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
14545
14546 However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
14547 program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
14548 suite. The program consists of the following files from
14549 @file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
14550
14551 @table @file
14552 @item overlays.c
14553 The main program file.
14554 @item ovlymgr.c
14555 A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
14556 @item foo.c
14557 @itemx bar.c
14558 @itemx baz.c
14559 @itemx grbx.c
14560 Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
14561 @item d10v.ld
14562 @itemx m32r.ld
14563 Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
14564 and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
14565 @end table
14566
14567 You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
14568 cross-compiler like this:
14569
14570 @smallexample
14571 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
14572 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
14573 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
14574 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
14575 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
14576 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
14577 $ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
14578 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
14579 @end smallexample
14580
14581 The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
14582 you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
14583 target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
14584
14585
14586 @node Languages
14587 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
14588 @cindex languages
14589
14590 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
14591 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
14592 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
14593 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
14594 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
14595 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
14596
14597 @cindex working language
14598 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
14599 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
14600 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
14601 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
14602 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
14603 language}.
14604
14605 @menu
14606 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
14607 * Show:: Displaying the language
14608 * Checks:: Type and range checks
14609 * Supported Languages:: Supported languages
14610 * Unsupported Languages:: Unsupported languages
14611 @end menu
14612
14613 @node Setting
14614 @section Switching Between Source Languages
14615
14616 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
14617 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
14618 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
14619 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
14620 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
14621 are printed, etc.
14622
14623 In addition to the working language, every source file that
14624 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
14625 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
14626 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
14627 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
14628 controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
14629 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
14630 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
14631 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
14632 Displaying the Language}.
14633
14634 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
14635 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
14636 another language. In that case, make the
14637 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
14638 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
14639 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
14640
14641 @menu
14642 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
14643 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
14644 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
14645 @end menu
14646
14647 @node Filenames
14648 @subsection List of Filename Extensions and Languages
14649
14650 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
14651 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
14652
14653 @table @file
14654 @item .ada
14655 @itemx .ads
14656 @itemx .adb
14657 @itemx .a
14658 Ada source file.
14659
14660 @item .c
14661 C source file
14662
14663 @item .C
14664 @itemx .cc
14665 @itemx .cp
14666 @itemx .cpp
14667 @itemx .cxx
14668 @itemx .c++
14669 C@t{++} source file
14670
14671 @item .d
14672 D source file
14673
14674 @item .m
14675 Objective-C source file
14676
14677 @item .f
14678 @itemx .F
14679 Fortran source file
14680
14681 @item .mod
14682 Modula-2 source file
14683
14684 @item .s
14685 @itemx .S
14686 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
14687 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
14688 @end table
14689
14690 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
14691 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the Language}.
14692
14693 @node Manually
14694 @subsection Setting the Working Language
14695
14696 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
14697 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
14698 your program.
14699
14700 @kindex set language
14701 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
14702 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
14703 a language, such as
14704 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
14705 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
14706
14707 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
14708 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
14709 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
14710 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
14711 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
14712 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
14713 command such as:
14714
14715 @smallexample
14716 print a = b + c
14717 @end smallexample
14718
14719 @noindent
14720 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
14721 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
14722 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
14723 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
14724
14725 @node Automatically
14726 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language
14727
14728 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
14729 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
14730 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
14731 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
14732 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
14733 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
14734 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
14735 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
14736 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
14737
14738 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
14739 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
14740 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
14741 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
14742 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
14743
14744 @node Show
14745 @section Displaying the Language
14746
14747 The following commands help you find out which language is the
14748 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
14749
14750 @table @code
14751 @item show language
14752 @anchor{show language}
14753 @kindex show language
14754 Display the current working language. This is the
14755 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
14756 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
14757
14758 @item info frame
14759 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
14760 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
14761 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
14762 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a Frame}, to identify the other
14763 information listed here.
14764
14765 @item info source
14766 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
14767 Display the source language of this source file.
14768 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
14769 information listed here.
14770 @end table
14771
14772 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
14773 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
14774 with a language explicitly:
14775
14776 @table @code
14777 @item set extension-language @var{ext} @var{language}
14778 @kindex set extension-language
14779 Tell @value{GDBN} that source files with extension @var{ext} are to be
14780 assumed as written in the source language @var{language}.
14781
14782 @item info extensions
14783 @kindex info extensions
14784 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
14785 @end table
14786
14787 @node Checks
14788 @section Type and Range Checking
14789
14790 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
14791 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
14792 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators and making
14793 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
14794 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
14795 by eliminating type mismatches and providing active checks for range
14796 errors when your program is running.
14797
14798 By default @value{GDBN} checks for these errors according to the
14799 rules of the current source language. Although @value{GDBN} does not check
14800 the statements in your program, it can check expressions entered directly
14801 into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via the @code{print} command, for example.
14802
14803 @menu
14804 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
14805 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
14806 @end menu
14807
14808 @cindex type checking
14809 @cindex checks, type
14810 @node Type Checking
14811 @subsection An Overview of Type Checking
14812
14813 Some languages, such as C and C@t{++}, are strongly typed, meaning that the
14814 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
14815 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
14816 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
14817
14818 @smallexample
14819 int klass::my_method(char *b) @{ return b ? 1 : 2; @}
14820
14821 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0)
14822 $1 = 2
14823 @exdent but
14824 (@value{GDBP}) print obj.my_method (0x1234)
14825 Cannot resolve method klass::my_method to any overloaded instance
14826 @end smallexample
14827
14828 The second example fails because in C@t{++} the integer constant
14829 @samp{0x1234} is not type-compatible with the pointer parameter type.
14830
14831 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
14832 @value{GDBN} to not enforce strict type checking or
14833 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
14834 When type checking is disabled, @value{GDBN} successfully evaluates
14835 expressions like the second example above.
14836
14837 Even if type checking is off, there may be other reasons
14838 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
14839 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
14840 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
14841 with the language in use and usually arise from expressions which make
14842 little sense to evaluate anyway.
14843
14844 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling type checking:
14845
14846 @kindex set check type
14847 @kindex show check type
14848 @table @code
14849 @item set check type on
14850 @itemx set check type off
14851 Set strict type checking on or off. If any type mismatches occur in
14852 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
14853 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
14854
14855 @item show check type
14856 Show the current setting of type checking and whether @value{GDBN}
14857 is enforcing strict type checking rules.
14858 @end table
14859
14860 @cindex range checking
14861 @cindex checks, range
14862 @node Range Checking
14863 @subsection An Overview of Range Checking
14864
14865 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
14866 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
14867 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
14868 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
14869 not exceed the bounds of the array.
14870
14871 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
14872 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
14873 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
14874 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
14875
14876 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
14877 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
14878 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
14879 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
14880 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
14881 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
14882
14883 @smallexample
14884 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
14885 @end smallexample
14886
14887 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
14888 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Supported Languages, ,
14889 Supported Languages}, for further details on specific languages.
14890
14891 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
14892
14893 @kindex set check range
14894 @kindex show check range
14895 @table @code
14896 @item set check range auto
14897 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
14898 @xref{Supported Languages, ,Supported Languages}, for the default settings for
14899 each language.
14900
14901 @item set check range on
14902 @itemx set check range off
14903 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
14904 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
14905 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
14906 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
14907
14908 @item set check range warn
14909 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
14910 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
14911 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
14912 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
14913 systems).
14914
14915 @item show range
14916 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
14917 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
14918 @end table
14919
14920 @node Supported Languages
14921 @section Supported Languages
14922
14923 @value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, D, Go, Objective-C, Fortran,
14924 OpenCL C, Pascal, Rust, assembly, Modula-2, and Ada.
14925 @c This is false ...
14926 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
14927 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
14928 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
14929 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
14930 language.
14931
14932 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
14933 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
14934 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
14935 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
14936 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
14937 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
14938 language reference or tutorial.
14939
14940 @menu
14941 * C:: C and C@t{++}
14942 * D:: D
14943 * Go:: Go
14944 * Objective-C:: Objective-C
14945 * OpenCL C:: OpenCL C
14946 * Fortran:: Fortran
14947 * Pascal:: Pascal
14948 * Rust:: Rust
14949 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
14950 * Ada:: Ada
14951 @end menu
14952
14953 @node C
14954 @subsection C and C@t{++}
14955
14956 @cindex C and C@t{++}
14957 @cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
14958
14959 Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
14960 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
14961 together.
14962
14963 @cindex C@t{++}
14964 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
14965 @cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
14966 The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
14967 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
14968 effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
14969 C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
14970 compiler (@code{aCC}).
14971
14972 @menu
14973 * C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
14974 * C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
14975 * C Plus Plus Expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
14976 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
14977 * C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
14978 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
14979 * Debugging C Plus Plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
14980 * Decimal Floating Point:: Numbers in Decimal Floating Point format
14981 @end menu
14982
14983 @node C Operators
14984 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Operators
14985
14986 @cindex C and C@t{++} operators
14987
14988 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
14989 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
14990 often defined on groups of types.
14991
14992 For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
14993
14994 @itemize @bullet
14995
14996 @item
14997 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
14998 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
14999
15000 @item
15001 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
15002 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
15003
15004 @item
15005 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
15006
15007 @item
15008 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
15009
15010 @end itemize
15011
15012 @noindent
15013 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
15014 in order of increasing precedence:
15015
15016 @table @code
15017 @item ,
15018 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
15019 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
15020 expression being the last expression evaluated.
15021
15022 @item =
15023 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
15024 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
15025
15026 @item @var{op}=
15027 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
15028 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
15029 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence. The operator
15030 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
15031 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
15032
15033 @item ?:
15034 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
15035 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. The argument @var{a}
15036 should be of an integral type.
15037
15038 @item ||
15039 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
15040
15041 @item &&
15042 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
15043
15044 @item |
15045 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
15046
15047 @item ^
15048 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
15049
15050 @item &
15051 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
15052
15053 @item ==@r{, }!=
15054 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
15055 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
15056
15057 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
15058 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
15059 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
15060 and non-zero for true.
15061
15062 @item <<@r{, }>>
15063 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
15064
15065 @item @@
15066 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
15067
15068 @item +@r{, }-
15069 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
15070 pointer types.
15071
15072 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
15073 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
15074 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
15075 integral types.
15076
15077 @item ++@r{, }--
15078 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
15079 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
15080 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
15081 operation takes place.
15082
15083 @item *
15084 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
15085 @code{++}.
15086
15087 @item &
15088 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
15089
15090 For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
15091 allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
15092 to examine the address
15093 where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
15094 stored.
15095
15096 @item -
15097 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
15098 precedence as @code{++}.
15099
15100 @item !
15101 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
15102 @code{++}.
15103
15104 @item ~
15105 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
15106 @code{++}.
15107
15108
15109 @item .@r{, }->
15110 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
15111 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
15112 pointer based on the stored type information.
15113 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
15114
15115 @item .*@r{, }->*
15116 Dereferences of pointers to members.
15117
15118 @item []
15119 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
15120 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
15121
15122 @item ()
15123 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
15124
15125 @item ::
15126 C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
15127 and @code{class} types.
15128
15129 @item ::
15130 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
15131 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
15132 above.
15133 @end table
15134
15135 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
15136 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
15137 predefined meaning.
15138
15139 @node C Constants
15140 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Constants
15141
15142 @cindex C and C@t{++} constants
15143
15144 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
15145 following ways:
15146
15147 @itemize @bullet
15148 @item
15149 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
15150 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e.@: zero), and hexadecimal constants
15151 by a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
15152 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
15153 @code{long} value.
15154
15155 @item
15156 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
15157 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
15158 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
15159 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
15160 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
15161 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
15162 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
15163 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
15164 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
15165 constant.
15166
15167 @item
15168 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
15169 integral equivalents.
15170
15171 @item
15172 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
15173 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
15174 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
15175 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
15176 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
15177 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
15178 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
15179 @samp{\n} for newline.
15180
15181 Wide character constants can be written by prefixing a character
15182 constant with @samp{L}, as in C. For example, @samp{L'x'} is the wide
15183 form of @samp{x}. The target wide character set is used when
15184 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
15185
15186 @item
15187 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
15188 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
15189 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
15190 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
15191 characters.
15192
15193 Wide string constants can be written by prefixing a string constant
15194 with @samp{L}, as in C. The target wide character set is used when
15195 computing the value of this constant (@pxref{Character Sets}).
15196
15197 @item
15198 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
15199 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
15200
15201 @item
15202 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
15203 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
15204 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
15205 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
15206 @end itemize
15207
15208 @node C Plus Plus Expressions
15209 @subsubsection C@t{++} Expressions
15210
15211 @cindex expressions in C@t{++}
15212 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
15213
15214 @cindex debugging C@t{++} programs
15215 @cindex C@t{++} compilers
15216 @cindex debug formats and C@t{++}
15217 @cindex @value{NGCC} and C@t{++}
15218 @quotation
15219 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use
15220 the proper compiler and the proper debug format. Currently,
15221 @value{GDBN} works best when debugging C@t{++} code that is compiled
15222 with the most recent version of @value{NGCC} possible. The DWARF
15223 debugging format is preferred; @value{NGCC} defaults to this on most
15224 popular platforms. Other compilers and/or debug formats are likely to
15225 work badly or not at all when using @value{GDBN} to debug C@t{++}
15226 code. @xref{Compilation}.
15227 @end quotation
15228
15229 @enumerate
15230
15231 @cindex member functions
15232 @item
15233 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
15234
15235 @smallexample
15236 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
15237 @end smallexample
15238
15239 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
15240 @cindex namespace in C@t{++}
15241 @item
15242 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
15243 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
15244 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
15245 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}. @code{using}
15246 declarations in the current scope are also respected by @value{GDBN}.
15247
15248 @cindex call overloaded functions
15249 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
15250 @cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
15251 @item
15252 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
15253 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
15254 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
15255 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
15256 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
15257 default arguments.
15258
15259 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
15260 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
15261 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
15262 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
15263 number of function arguments.
15264
15265 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
15266 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C Plus Plus,
15267 ,@value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}}.
15268
15269 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
15270 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
15271 @smallexample
15272 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
15273 @end smallexample
15274
15275 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
15276 see @ref{Completion, ,Command Completion}.
15277
15278 @cindex reference declarations
15279 @item
15280 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} lvalue or rvalue
15281 references; you can use them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++}
15282 source---they are automatically dereferenced.
15283
15284 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
15285 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
15286 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
15287 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
15288 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
15289
15290 @item
15291 @value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
15292 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
15293 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
15294 necessary, for example in an expression like
15295 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
15296 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
15297 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program Variables}).
15298
15299 @item
15300 @value{GDBN} performs argument-dependent lookup, following the C@t{++}
15301 specification.
15302 @end enumerate
15303
15304 @node C Defaults
15305 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Defaults
15306
15307 @cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
15308
15309 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set range checking automatically, it
15310 defaults to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
15311 C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
15312 selects the working language.
15313
15314 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
15315 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
15316 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
15317 these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
15318 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} Infer the Source Language},
15319 for further details.
15320
15321 @node C Checks
15322 @subsubsection C and C@t{++} Type and Range Checks
15323
15324 @cindex C and C@t{++} checks
15325
15326 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, strict type
15327 checking is used. However, if you turn type checking off, @value{GDBN}
15328 will allow certain non-standard conversions, such as promoting integer
15329 constants to pointers.
15330
15331 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
15332 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
15333 that is not itself an array.
15334
15335 @node Debugging C
15336 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
15337
15338 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
15339 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
15340 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
15341 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
15342
15343 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
15344 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
15345 ,Expressions}.
15346
15347 @node Debugging C Plus Plus
15348 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} Features for C@t{++}
15349
15350 @cindex commands for C@t{++}
15351
15352 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
15353 designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
15354
15355 @table @code
15356 @cindex break in overloaded functions
15357 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
15358 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
15359 @value{GDBN} has the capability to display a menu of possible breakpoint
15360 locations to help you specify which function definition you want.
15361 @xref{Ambiguous Expressions,,Ambiguous Expressions}.
15362
15363 @cindex overloading in C@t{++}
15364 @item rbreak @var{regex}
15365 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
15366 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
15367 classes.
15368 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
15369
15370 @cindex C@t{++} exception handling
15371 @item catch throw
15372 @itemx catch rethrow
15373 @itemx catch catch
15374 Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
15375 Catchpoints, , Setting Catchpoints}.
15376
15377 @cindex inheritance
15378 @item ptype @var{typename}
15379 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
15380 @var{typename}.
15381 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
15382
15383 @item info vtbl @var{expression}.
15384 The @code{info vtbl} command can be used to display the virtual
15385 method tables of the object computed by @var{expression}. This shows
15386 one entry per virtual table; there may be multiple virtual tables when
15387 multiple inheritance is in use.
15388
15389 @cindex C@t{++} demangling
15390 @item demangle @var{name}
15391 Demangle @var{name}.
15392 @xref{Symbols}, for a more complete description of the @code{demangle} command.
15393
15394 @cindex C@t{++} symbol display
15395 @item set print demangle
15396 @itemx show print demangle
15397 @itemx set print asm-demangle
15398 @itemx show print asm-demangle
15399 Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
15400 displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
15401 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
15402
15403 @item set print object
15404 @itemx show print object
15405 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
15406 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
15407
15408 @item set print vtbl
15409 @itemx show print vtbl
15410 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
15411 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}.
15412 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
15413 ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
15414
15415 @kindex set overload-resolution
15416 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
15417 @item set overload-resolution on
15418 Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
15419 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
15420 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
15421 using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C Plus Plus
15422 Expressions, ,C@t{++} Expressions}, for details).
15423 If it cannot find a match, it emits a message.
15424
15425 @item set overload-resolution off
15426 Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
15427 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
15428 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
15429 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
15430 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
15431 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
15432 argument types.
15433
15434 @kindex show overload-resolution
15435 @item show overload-resolution
15436 Show the current setting of overload resolution.
15437
15438 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
15439 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
15440 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
15441 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
15442 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
15443 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
15444 @xref{Completion,, Command Completion}, for details on how to do this.
15445
15446 @item @r{Breakpoints in functions with ABI tags}
15447
15448 The GNU C@t{++} compiler introduced the notion of ABI ``tags'', which
15449 correspond to changes in the ABI of a type, function, or variable that
15450 would not otherwise be reflected in a mangled name. See
15451 @url{https://developers.redhat.com/blog/2015/02/05/gcc5-and-the-c11-abi/}
15452 for more detail.
15453
15454 The ABI tags are visible in C@t{++} demangled names. For example, a
15455 function that returns a std::string:
15456
15457 @smallexample
15458 std::string function(int);
15459 @end smallexample
15460
15461 @noindent
15462 when compiled for the C++11 ABI is marked with the @code{cxx11} ABI
15463 tag, and @value{GDBN} displays the symbol like this:
15464
15465 @smallexample
15466 function[abi:cxx11](int)
15467 @end smallexample
15468
15469 You can set a breakpoint on such functions simply as if they had no
15470 tag. For example:
15471
15472 @smallexample
15473 (gdb) b function(int)
15474 Breakpoint 2 at 0x40060d: file main.cc, line 10.
15475 (gdb) info breakpoints
15476 Num Type Disp Enb Address What
15477 1 breakpoint keep y 0x0040060d in function[abi:cxx11](int)
15478 at main.cc:10
15479 @end smallexample
15480
15481 On the rare occasion you need to disambiguate between different ABI
15482 tags, you can do so by simply including the ABI tag in the function
15483 name, like:
15484
15485 @smallexample
15486 (@value{GDBP}) b ambiguous[abi:other_tag](int)
15487 @end smallexample
15488 @end table
15489
15490 @node Decimal Floating Point
15491 @subsubsection Decimal Floating Point format
15492 @cindex decimal floating point format
15493
15494 @value{GDBN} can examine, set and perform computations with numbers in
15495 decimal floating point format, which in the C language correspond to the
15496 @code{_Decimal32}, @code{_Decimal64} and @code{_Decimal128} types as
15497 specified by the extension to support decimal floating-point arithmetic.
15498
15499 There are two encodings in use, depending on the architecture: BID (Binary
15500 Integer Decimal) for x86 and x86-64, and DPD (Densely Packed Decimal) for
15501 PowerPC and S/390. @value{GDBN} will use the appropriate encoding for the
15502 configured target.
15503
15504 Because of a limitation in @file{libdecnumber}, the library used by @value{GDBN}
15505 to manipulate decimal floating point numbers, it is not possible to convert
15506 (using a cast, for example) integers wider than 32-bit to decimal float.
15507
15508 In addition, in order to imitate @value{GDBN}'s behaviour with binary floating
15509 point computations, error checking in decimal float operations ignores
15510 underflow, overflow and divide by zero exceptions.
15511
15512 In the PowerPC architecture, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers
15513 to inspect @code{_Decimal128} values stored in floating point registers.
15514 See @ref{PowerPC,,PowerPC} for more details.
15515
15516 @node D
15517 @subsection D
15518
15519 @cindex D
15520 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in D and compiled with
15521 GDC, LDC or DMD compilers. Currently @value{GDBN} supports only one D
15522 specific feature --- dynamic arrays.
15523
15524 @node Go
15525 @subsection Go
15526
15527 @cindex Go (programming language)
15528 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Go and compiled with
15529 @file{gccgo} or @file{6g} compilers.
15530
15531 Here is a summary of the Go-specific features and restrictions:
15532
15533 @table @code
15534 @cindex current Go package
15535 @item The current Go package
15536 The name of the current package does not need to be specified when
15537 specifying global variables and functions.
15538
15539 For example, given the program:
15540
15541 @example
15542 package main
15543 var myglob = "Shall we?"
15544 func main () @{
15545 // ...
15546 @}
15547 @end example
15548
15549 When stopped inside @code{main} either of these work:
15550
15551 @example
15552 (gdb) p myglob
15553 (gdb) p main.myglob
15554 @end example
15555
15556 @cindex builtin Go types
15557 @item Builtin Go types
15558 The @code{string} type is recognized by @value{GDBN} and is printed
15559 as a string.
15560
15561 @cindex builtin Go functions
15562 @item Builtin Go functions
15563 The @value{GDBN} expression parser recognizes the @code{unsafe.Sizeof}
15564 function and handles it internally.
15565
15566 @cindex restrictions on Go expressions
15567 @item Restrictions on Go expressions
15568 All Go operators are supported except @code{&^}.
15569 The Go @code{_} ``blank identifier'' is not supported.
15570 Automatic dereferencing of pointers is not supported.
15571 @end table
15572
15573 @node Objective-C
15574 @subsection Objective-C
15575
15576 @cindex Objective-C
15577 This section provides information about some commands and command
15578 options that are useful for debugging Objective-C code. See also
15579 @ref{Symbols, info classes}, and @ref{Symbols, info selectors}, for a
15580 few more commands specific to Objective-C support.
15581
15582 @menu
15583 * Method Names in Commands::
15584 * The Print Command with Objective-C::
15585 @end menu
15586
15587 @node Method Names in Commands
15588 @subsubsection Method Names in Commands
15589
15590 The following commands have been extended to accept Objective-C method
15591 names as line specifications:
15592
15593 @kindex clear@r{, and Objective-C}
15594 @kindex break@r{, and Objective-C}
15595 @kindex info line@r{, and Objective-C}
15596 @kindex jump@r{, and Objective-C}
15597 @kindex list@r{, and Objective-C}
15598 @itemize
15599 @item @code{clear}
15600 @item @code{break}
15601 @item @code{info line}
15602 @item @code{jump}
15603 @item @code{list}
15604 @end itemize
15605
15606 A fully qualified Objective-C method name is specified as
15607
15608 @smallexample
15609 -[@var{Class} @var{methodName}]
15610 @end smallexample
15611
15612 where the minus sign is used to indicate an instance method and a
15613 plus sign (not shown) is used to indicate a class method. The class
15614 name @var{Class} and method name @var{methodName} are enclosed in
15615 brackets, similar to the way messages are specified in Objective-C
15616 source code. For example, to set a breakpoint at the @code{create}
15617 instance method of class @code{Fruit} in the program currently being
15618 debugged, enter:
15619
15620 @smallexample
15621 break -[Fruit create]
15622 @end smallexample
15623
15624 To list ten program lines around the @code{initialize} class method,
15625 enter:
15626
15627 @smallexample
15628 list +[NSText initialize]
15629 @end smallexample
15630
15631 In the current version of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus sign is
15632 required. In future versions of @value{GDBN}, the plus or minus
15633 sign will be optional, but you can use it to narrow the search. It
15634 is also possible to specify just a method name:
15635
15636 @smallexample
15637 break create
15638 @end smallexample
15639
15640 You must specify the complete method name, including any colons. If
15641 your program's source files contain more than one @code{create} method,
15642 you'll be presented with a numbered list of classes that implement that
15643 method. Indicate your choice by number, or type @samp{0} to exit if
15644 none apply.
15645
15646 As another example, to clear a breakpoint established at the
15647 @code{makeKeyAndOrderFront:} method of the @code{NSWindow} class, enter:
15648
15649 @smallexample
15650 clear -[NSWindow makeKeyAndOrderFront:]
15651 @end smallexample
15652
15653 @node The Print Command with Objective-C
15654 @subsubsection The Print Command With Objective-C
15655 @cindex Objective-C, print objects
15656 @kindex print-object
15657 @kindex po @r{(@code{print-object})}
15658
15659 The print command has also been extended to accept methods. For example:
15660
15661 @smallexample
15662 print -[@var{object} hash]
15663 @end smallexample
15664
15665 @cindex print an Objective-C object description
15666 @cindex @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, and printing Objective-C objects
15667 @noindent
15668 will tell @value{GDBN} to send the @code{hash} message to @var{object}
15669 and print the result. Also, an additional command has been added,
15670 @code{print-object} or @code{po} for short, which is meant to print
15671 the description of an object. However, this command may only work
15672 with certain Objective-C libraries that have a particular hook
15673 function, @code{_NSPrintForDebugger}, defined.
15674
15675 @node OpenCL C
15676 @subsection OpenCL C
15677
15678 @cindex OpenCL C
15679 This section provides information about @value{GDBN}s OpenCL C support.
15680
15681 @menu
15682 * OpenCL C Datatypes::
15683 * OpenCL C Expressions::
15684 * OpenCL C Operators::
15685 @end menu
15686
15687 @node OpenCL C Datatypes
15688 @subsubsection OpenCL C Datatypes
15689
15690 @cindex OpenCL C Datatypes
15691 @value{GDBN} supports the builtin scalar and vector datatypes specified
15692 by OpenCL 1.1. In addition the half- and double-precision floating point
15693 data types of the @code{cl_khr_fp16} and @code{cl_khr_fp64} OpenCL
15694 extensions are also known to @value{GDBN}.
15695
15696 @node OpenCL C Expressions
15697 @subsubsection OpenCL C Expressions
15698
15699 @cindex OpenCL C Expressions
15700 @value{GDBN} supports accesses to vector components including the access as
15701 lvalue where possible. Since OpenCL C is based on C99 most C expressions
15702 supported by @value{GDBN} can be used as well.
15703
15704 @node OpenCL C Operators
15705 @subsubsection OpenCL C Operators
15706
15707 @cindex OpenCL C Operators
15708 @value{GDBN} supports the operators specified by OpenCL 1.1 for scalar and
15709 vector data types.
15710
15711 @node Fortran
15712 @subsection Fortran
15713 @cindex Fortran-specific support in @value{GDBN}
15714
15715 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, but it
15716 currently supports only the features of Fortran 77 language.
15717
15718 @cindex trailing underscore, in Fortran symbols
15719 Some Fortran compilers (@sc{gnu} Fortran 77 and Fortran 95 compilers
15720 among them) append an underscore to the names of variables and
15721 functions. When you debug programs compiled by those compilers, you
15722 will need to refer to variables and functions with a trailing
15723 underscore.
15724
15725 @menu
15726 * Fortran Operators:: Fortran operators and expressions
15727 * Fortran Defaults:: Default settings for Fortran
15728 * Special Fortran Commands:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Fortran
15729 @end menu
15730
15731 @node Fortran Operators
15732 @subsubsection Fortran Operators and Expressions
15733
15734 @cindex Fortran operators and expressions
15735
15736 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
15737 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on characters or other non-
15738 arithmetic types. Operators are often defined on groups of types.
15739
15740 @table @code
15741 @item **
15742 The exponentiation operator. It raises the first operand to the power
15743 of the second one.
15744
15745 @item :
15746 The range operator. Normally used in the form of array(low:high) to
15747 represent a section of array.
15748
15749 @item %
15750 The access component operator. Normally used to access elements in derived
15751 types. Also suitable for unions. As unions aren't part of regular Fortran,
15752 this can only happen when accessing a register that uses a gdbarch-defined
15753 union type.
15754 @end table
15755
15756 @node Fortran Defaults
15757 @subsubsection Fortran Defaults
15758
15759 @cindex Fortran Defaults
15760
15761 Fortran symbols are usually case-insensitive, so @value{GDBN} by
15762 default uses case-insensitive matches for Fortran symbols. You can
15763 change that with the @samp{set case-insensitive} command, see
15764 @ref{Symbols}, for the details.
15765
15766 @node Special Fortran Commands
15767 @subsubsection Special Fortran Commands
15768
15769 @cindex Special Fortran commands
15770
15771 @value{GDBN} has some commands to support Fortran-specific features,
15772 such as displaying common blocks.
15773
15774 @table @code
15775 @cindex @code{COMMON} blocks, Fortran
15776 @kindex info common
15777 @item info common @r{[}@var{common-name}@r{]}
15778 This command prints the values contained in the Fortran @code{COMMON}
15779 block whose name is @var{common-name}. With no argument, the names of
15780 all @code{COMMON} blocks visible at the current program location are
15781 printed.
15782 @end table
15783
15784 @node Pascal
15785 @subsection Pascal
15786
15787 @cindex Pascal support in @value{GDBN}, limitations
15788 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
15789 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
15790 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
15791 syntax.
15792
15793 The Pascal-specific command @code{set print pascal_static-members}
15794 controls whether static members of Pascal objects are displayed.
15795 @xref{Print Settings, pascal_static-members}.
15796
15797 @node Rust
15798 @subsection Rust
15799
15800 @value{GDBN} supports the @url{https://www.rust-lang.org/, Rust
15801 Programming Language}. Type- and value-printing, and expression
15802 parsing, are reasonably complete. However, there are a few
15803 peculiarities and holes to be aware of.
15804
15805 @itemize @bullet
15806 @item
15807 Linespecs (@pxref{Specify Location}) are never relative to the current
15808 crate. Instead, they act as if there were a global namespace of
15809 crates, somewhat similar to the way @code{extern crate} behaves.
15810
15811 That is, if @value{GDBN} is stopped at a breakpoint in a function in
15812 crate @samp{A}, module @samp{B}, then @code{break B::f} will attempt
15813 to set a breakpoint in a function named @samp{f} in a crate named
15814 @samp{B}.
15815
15816 As a consequence of this approach, linespecs also cannot refer to
15817 items using @samp{self::} or @samp{super::}.
15818
15819 @item
15820 Because @value{GDBN} implements Rust name-lookup semantics in
15821 expressions, it will sometimes prepend the current crate to a name.
15822 For example, if @value{GDBN} is stopped at a breakpoint in the crate
15823 @samp{K}, then @code{print ::x::y} will try to find the symbol
15824 @samp{K::x::y}.
15825
15826 However, since it is useful to be able to refer to other crates when
15827 debugging, @value{GDBN} provides the @code{extern} extension to
15828 circumvent this. To use the extension, just put @code{extern} before
15829 a path expression to refer to the otherwise unavailable ``global''
15830 scope.
15831
15832 In the above example, if you wanted to refer to the symbol @samp{y} in
15833 the crate @samp{x}, you would use @code{print extern x::y}.
15834
15835 @item
15836 The Rust expression evaluator does not support ``statement-like''
15837 expressions such as @code{if} or @code{match}, or lambda expressions.
15838
15839 @item
15840 Tuple expressions are not implemented.
15841
15842 @item
15843 The Rust expression evaluator does not currently implement the
15844 @code{Drop} trait. Objects that may be created by the evaluator will
15845 never be destroyed.
15846
15847 @item
15848 @value{GDBN} does not implement type inference for generics. In order
15849 to call generic functions or otherwise refer to generic items, you
15850 will have to specify the type parameters manually.
15851
15852 @item
15853 @value{GDBN} currently uses the C@t{++} demangler for Rust. In most
15854 cases this does not cause any problems. However, in an expression
15855 context, completing a generic function name will give syntactically
15856 invalid results. This happens because Rust requires the @samp{::}
15857 operator between the function name and its generic arguments. For
15858 example, @value{GDBN} might provide a completion like
15859 @code{crate::f<u32>}, where the parser would require
15860 @code{crate::f::<u32>}.
15861
15862 @item
15863 As of this writing, the Rust compiler (version 1.8) has a few holes in
15864 the debugging information it generates. These holes prevent certain
15865 features from being implemented by @value{GDBN}:
15866 @itemize @bullet
15867
15868 @item
15869 Method calls cannot be made via traits.
15870
15871 @item
15872 Operator overloading is not implemented.
15873
15874 @item
15875 When debugging in a monomorphized function, you cannot use the generic
15876 type names.
15877
15878 @item
15879 The type @code{Self} is not available.
15880
15881 @item
15882 @code{use} statements are not available, so some names may not be
15883 available in the crate.
15884 @end itemize
15885 @end itemize
15886
15887 @node Modula-2
15888 @subsection Modula-2
15889
15890 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
15891
15892 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
15893 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
15894 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
15895 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
15896 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
15897 table.
15898
15899 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
15900 @menu
15901 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
15902 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
15903 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
15904 * M2 Types:: Modula-2 types
15905 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
15906 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
15907 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
15908 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
15909 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
15910 @end menu
15911
15912 @node M2 Operators
15913 @subsubsection Operators
15914 @cindex Modula-2 operators
15915
15916 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
15917 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
15918 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
15919 following definitions hold:
15920
15921 @itemize @bullet
15922
15923 @item
15924 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
15925 their subranges.
15926
15927 @item
15928 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
15929
15930 @item
15931 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
15932
15933 @item
15934 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
15935 @var{type}}.
15936
15937 @item
15938 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
15939
15940 @item
15941 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
15942
15943 @item
15944 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
15945 @end itemize
15946
15947 @noindent
15948 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
15949 increasing precedence:
15950
15951 @table @code
15952 @item ,
15953 Function argument or array index separator.
15954
15955 @item :=
15956 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
15957 @var{value}.
15958
15959 @item <@r{, }>
15960 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
15961 types.
15962
15963 @item <=@r{, }>=
15964 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
15965 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
15966 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
15967
15968 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
15969 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
15970 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
15971 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
15972 comment character.
15973
15974 @item IN
15975 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
15976 Same precedence as @code{<}.
15977
15978 @item OR
15979 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
15980
15981 @item AND@r{, }&
15982 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
15983
15984 @item @@
15985 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
15986
15987 @item +@r{, }-
15988 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
15989 and difference on set types.
15990
15991 @item *
15992 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
15993 on set types.
15994
15995 @item /
15996 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
15997 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
15998
15999 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
16000 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
16001 precedence as @code{*}.
16002
16003 @item -
16004 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
16005
16006 @item ^
16007 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
16008
16009 @item NOT
16010 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
16011 @code{^}.
16012
16013 @item .
16014 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
16015 precedence as @code{^}.
16016
16017 @item []
16018 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
16019
16020 @item ()
16021 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
16022 as @code{^}.
16023
16024 @item ::@r{, }.
16025 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
16026 @end table
16027
16028 @quotation
16029 @emph{Warning:} Set expressions and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
16030 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
16031 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
16032 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
16033 @end quotation
16034
16035
16036 @node Built-In Func/Proc
16037 @subsubsection Built-in Functions and Procedures
16038 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
16039
16040 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
16041 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
16042
16043 @table @var
16044
16045 @item a
16046 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
16047
16048 @item c
16049 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
16050
16051 @item i
16052 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
16053
16054 @item m
16055 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
16056 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
16057 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
16058
16059 @item n
16060 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
16061
16062 @item r
16063 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
16064
16065 @item t
16066 represents a type.
16067
16068 @item v
16069 represents a variable.
16070
16071 @item x
16072 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
16073 explanation of the function for details.
16074 @end table
16075
16076 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
16077
16078 @table @code
16079 @item ABS(@var{n})
16080 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
16081
16082 @item CAP(@var{c})
16083 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
16084 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
16085
16086 @item CHR(@var{i})
16087 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
16088
16089 @item DEC(@var{v})
16090 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
16091
16092 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
16093 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
16094 new value.
16095
16096 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
16097 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
16098 set.
16099
16100 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
16101 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
16102
16103 @item HIGH(@var{a})
16104 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
16105
16106 @item INC(@var{v})
16107 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
16108
16109 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
16110 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
16111 new value.
16112
16113 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
16114 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
16115 there. Returns the new set.
16116
16117 @item MAX(@var{t})
16118 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
16119
16120 @item MIN(@var{t})
16121 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
16122
16123 @item ODD(@var{i})
16124 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
16125
16126 @item ORD(@var{x})
16127 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
16128 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting
16129 the @sc{ascii} character set). The argument @var{x} must be of an
16130 ordered type, which include integral, character and enumerated types.
16131
16132 @item SIZE(@var{x})
16133 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
16134 variable or a type.
16135
16136 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
16137 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
16138
16139 @item TSIZE(@var{x})
16140 Returns the size of its argument. The argument @var{x} can be a
16141 variable or a type.
16142
16143 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
16144 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
16145 @end table
16146
16147 @quotation
16148 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
16149 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
16150 an error.
16151 @end quotation
16152
16153 @cindex Modula-2 constants
16154 @node M2 Constants
16155 @subsubsection Constants
16156
16157 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
16158 ways:
16159
16160 @itemize @bullet
16161
16162 @item
16163 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
16164 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
16165 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
16166 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
16167
16168 @item
16169 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
16170 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
16171 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
16172 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
16173 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
16174 digits.
16175
16176 @item
16177 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
16178 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
16179 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
16180 followed by a @samp{C}.
16181
16182 @item
16183 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
16184 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
16185 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
16186 Constants, ,C and C@t{++} Constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
16187 sequences.
16188
16189 @item
16190 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
16191
16192 @item
16193 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
16194 @code{FALSE}.
16195
16196 @item
16197 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
16198
16199 @item
16200 Set constants are not yet supported.
16201 @end itemize
16202
16203 @node M2 Types
16204 @subsubsection Modula-2 Types
16205 @cindex Modula-2 types
16206
16207 Currently @value{GDBN} can print the following data types in Modula-2
16208 syntax: array types, record types, set types, pointer types, procedure
16209 types, enumerated types, subrange types and base types. You can also
16210 print the contents of variables declared using these type.
16211 This section gives a number of simple source code examples together with
16212 sample @value{GDBN} sessions.
16213
16214 The first example contains the following section of code:
16215
16216 @smallexample
16217 VAR
16218 s: SET OF CHAR ;
16219 r: [20..40] ;
16220 @end smallexample
16221
16222 @noindent
16223 and you can request @value{GDBN} to interrogate the type and value of
16224 @code{r} and @code{s}.
16225
16226 @smallexample
16227 (@value{GDBP}) print s
16228 @{'A'..'C', 'Z'@}
16229 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16230 SET OF CHAR
16231 (@value{GDBP}) print r
16232 21
16233 (@value{GDBP}) ptype r
16234 [20..40]
16235 @end smallexample
16236
16237 @noindent
16238 Likewise if your source code declares @code{s} as:
16239
16240 @smallexample
16241 VAR
16242 s: SET ['A'..'Z'] ;
16243 @end smallexample
16244
16245 @noindent
16246 then you may query the type of @code{s} by:
16247
16248 @smallexample
16249 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16250 type = SET ['A'..'Z']
16251 @end smallexample
16252
16253 @noindent
16254 Note that at present you cannot interactively manipulate set
16255 expressions using the debugger.
16256
16257 The following example shows how you might declare an array in Modula-2
16258 and how you can interact with @value{GDBN} to print its type and contents:
16259
16260 @smallexample
16261 VAR
16262 s: ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR ;
16263 @end smallexample
16264
16265 @smallexample
16266 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16267 ARRAY [-10..10] OF CHAR
16268 @end smallexample
16269
16270 Note that the array handling is not yet complete and although the type
16271 is printed correctly, expression handling still assumes that all
16272 arrays have a lower bound of zero and not @code{-10} as in the example
16273 above.
16274
16275 Here are some more type related Modula-2 examples:
16276
16277 @smallexample
16278 TYPE
16279 colour = (blue, red, yellow, green) ;
16280 t = [blue..yellow] ;
16281 VAR
16282 s: t ;
16283 BEGIN
16284 s := blue ;
16285 @end smallexample
16286
16287 @noindent
16288 The @value{GDBN} interaction shows how you can query the data type
16289 and value of a variable.
16290
16291 @smallexample
16292 (@value{GDBP}) print s
16293 $1 = blue
16294 (@value{GDBP}) ptype t
16295 type = [blue..yellow]
16296 @end smallexample
16297
16298 @noindent
16299 In this example a Modula-2 array is declared and its contents
16300 displayed. Observe that the contents are written in the same way as
16301 their @code{C} counterparts.
16302
16303 @smallexample
16304 VAR
16305 s: ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
16306 BEGIN
16307 s[1] := 1 ;
16308 @end smallexample
16309
16310 @smallexample
16311 (@value{GDBP}) print s
16312 $1 = @{1, 0, 0, 0, 0@}
16313 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16314 type = ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
16315 @end smallexample
16316
16317 The Modula-2 language interface to @value{GDBN} also understands
16318 pointer types as shown in this example:
16319
16320 @smallexample
16321 VAR
16322 s: POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL ;
16323 BEGIN
16324 NEW(s) ;
16325 s^[1] := 1 ;
16326 @end smallexample
16327
16328 @noindent
16329 and you can request that @value{GDBN} describes the type of @code{s}.
16330
16331 @smallexample
16332 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16333 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [1..5] OF CARDINAL
16334 @end smallexample
16335
16336 @value{GDBN} handles compound types as we can see in this example.
16337 Here we combine array types, record types, pointer types and subrange
16338 types:
16339
16340 @smallexample
16341 TYPE
16342 foo = RECORD
16343 f1: CARDINAL ;
16344 f2: CHAR ;
16345 f3: myarray ;
16346 END ;
16347
16348 myarray = ARRAY myrange OF CARDINAL ;
16349 myrange = [-2..2] ;
16350 VAR
16351 s: POINTER TO ARRAY myrange OF foo ;
16352 @end smallexample
16353
16354 @noindent
16355 and you can ask @value{GDBN} to describe the type of @code{s} as shown
16356 below.
16357
16358 @smallexample
16359 (@value{GDBP}) ptype s
16360 type = POINTER TO ARRAY [-2..2] OF foo = RECORD
16361 f1 : CARDINAL;
16362 f2 : CHAR;
16363 f3 : ARRAY [-2..2] OF CARDINAL;
16364 END
16365 @end smallexample
16366
16367 @node M2 Defaults
16368 @subsubsection Modula-2 Defaults
16369 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
16370
16371 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
16372 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
16373 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
16374 selected the working language.
16375
16376 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
16377 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
16378 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN}
16379 Infer the Source Language}, for further details.
16380
16381 @node Deviations
16382 @subsubsection Deviations from Standard Modula-2
16383 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
16384
16385 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
16386 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
16387
16388 @itemize @bullet
16389 @item
16390 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
16391 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
16392 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
16393 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
16394 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
16395 returned a pointer.)
16396
16397 @item
16398 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
16399 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
16400 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
16401 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
16402
16403 @item
16404 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
16405 argument.
16406
16407 @item
16408 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
16409 @end itemize
16410
16411 @node M2 Checks
16412 @subsubsection Modula-2 Type and Range Checks
16413 @cindex Modula-2 checks
16414
16415 @quotation
16416 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
16417 range checking.
16418 @end quotation
16419 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
16420
16421 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
16422
16423 @itemize @bullet
16424 @item
16425 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
16426 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
16427
16428 @item
16429 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
16430 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
16431 @end itemize
16432
16433 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
16434 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
16435
16436 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
16437 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
16438
16439 @node M2 Scope
16440 @subsubsection The Scope Operators @code{::} and @code{.}
16441 @cindex scope
16442 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
16443 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
16444 @ifinfo
16445 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
16446 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
16447 @end ifinfo
16448 @ifnotinfo
16449 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
16450 @end ifnotinfo
16451
16452 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
16453 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
16454 similar syntax:
16455
16456 @smallexample
16457
16458 @var{module} . @var{id}
16459 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
16460 @end smallexample
16461
16462 @noindent
16463 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
16464 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
16465 identifier within your program, except another module.
16466
16467 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
16468 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
16469 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
16470 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
16471
16472 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
16473 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
16474 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
16475 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
16476 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
16477 @var{module}.
16478
16479 @node GDB/M2
16480 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
16481
16482 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
16483 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
16484 specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
16485 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
16486 apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
16487 analogue in Modula-2.
16488
16489 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
16490 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
16491 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
16492 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
16493 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
16494 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
16495
16496 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
16497 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
16498 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
16499
16500 @node Ada
16501 @subsection Ada
16502 @cindex Ada
16503
16504 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} for Ada only support
16505 output from the @sc{gnu} Ada (GNAT) compiler.
16506 Other Ada compilers are not currently supported, and
16507 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
16508 to be difficult.
16509
16510
16511 @cindex expressions in Ada
16512 @menu
16513 * Ada Mode Intro:: General remarks on the Ada syntax
16514 and semantics supported by Ada mode
16515 in @value{GDBN}.
16516 * Omissions from Ada:: Restrictions on the Ada expression syntax.
16517 * Additions to Ada:: Extensions of the Ada expression syntax.
16518 * Overloading support for Ada:: Support for expressions involving overloaded
16519 subprograms.
16520 * Stopping Before Main Program:: Debugging the program during elaboration.
16521 * Ada Exceptions:: Ada Exceptions
16522 * Ada Tasks:: Listing and setting breakpoints in tasks.
16523 * Ada Tasks and Core Files:: Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
16524 * Ravenscar Profile:: Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar
16525 Profile
16526 * Ada Settings:: New settable GDB parameters for Ada.
16527 * Ada Glitches:: Known peculiarities of Ada mode.
16528 @end menu
16529
16530 @node Ada Mode Intro
16531 @subsubsection Introduction
16532 @cindex Ada mode, general
16533
16534 The Ada mode of @value{GDBN} supports a fairly large subset of Ada expression
16535 syntax, with some extensions.
16536 The philosophy behind the design of this subset is
16537
16538 @itemize @bullet
16539 @item
16540 That @value{GDBN} should provide basic literals and access to operations for
16541 arithmetic, dereferencing, field selection, indexing, and subprogram calls,
16542 leaving more sophisticated computations to subprograms written into the
16543 program (which therefore may be called from @value{GDBN}).
16544
16545 @item
16546 That type safety and strict adherence to Ada language restrictions
16547 are not particularly important to the @value{GDBN} user.
16548
16549 @item
16550 That brevity is important to the @value{GDBN} user.
16551 @end itemize
16552
16553 Thus, for brevity, the debugger acts as if all names declared in
16554 user-written packages are directly visible, even if they are not visible
16555 according to Ada rules, thus making it unnecessary to fully qualify most
16556 names with their packages, regardless of context. Where this causes
16557 ambiguity, @value{GDBN} asks the user's intent.
16558
16559 The debugger will start in Ada mode if it detects an Ada main program.
16560 As for other languages, it will enter Ada mode when stopped in a program that
16561 was translated from an Ada source file.
16562
16563 While in Ada mode, you may use `@t{--}' for comments. This is useful
16564 mostly for documenting command files. The standard @value{GDBN} comment
16565 (@samp{#}) still works at the beginning of a line in Ada mode, but not in the
16566 middle (to allow based literals).
16567
16568 @node Omissions from Ada
16569 @subsubsection Omissions from Ada
16570 @cindex Ada, omissions from
16571
16572 Here are the notable omissions from the subset:
16573
16574 @itemize @bullet
16575 @item
16576 Only a subset of the attributes are supported:
16577
16578 @itemize @minus
16579 @item
16580 @t{'First}, @t{'Last}, and @t{'Length}
16581 on array objects (not on types and subtypes).
16582
16583 @item
16584 @t{'Min} and @t{'Max}.
16585
16586 @item
16587 @t{'Pos} and @t{'Val}.
16588
16589 @item
16590 @t{'Tag}.
16591
16592 @item
16593 @t{'Range} on array objects (not subtypes), but only as the right
16594 operand of the membership (@code{in}) operator.
16595
16596 @item
16597 @t{'Access}, @t{'Unchecked_Access}, and
16598 @t{'Unrestricted_Access} (a GNAT extension).
16599
16600 @item
16601 @t{'Address}.
16602 @end itemize
16603
16604 @item
16605 The names in
16606 @code{Characters.Latin_1} are not available and
16607 concatenation is not implemented. Thus, escape characters in strings are
16608 not currently available.
16609
16610 @item
16611 Equality tests (@samp{=} and @samp{/=}) on arrays test for bitwise
16612 equality of representations. They will generally work correctly
16613 for strings and arrays whose elements have integer or enumeration types.
16614 They may not work correctly for arrays whose element
16615 types have user-defined equality, for arrays of real values
16616 (in particular, IEEE-conformant floating point, because of negative
16617 zeroes and NaNs), and for arrays whose elements contain unused bits with
16618 indeterminate values.
16619
16620 @item
16621 The other component-by-component array operations (@code{and}, @code{or},
16622 @code{xor}, @code{not}, and relational tests other than equality)
16623 are not implemented.
16624
16625 @item
16626 @cindex array aggregates (Ada)
16627 @cindex record aggregates (Ada)
16628 @cindex aggregates (Ada)
16629 There is limited support for array and record aggregates. They are
16630 permitted only on the right sides of assignments, as in these examples:
16631
16632 @smallexample
16633 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6)
16634 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (1, others => 0)
16635 (@value{GDBP}) set An_Array := (0|4 => 1, 1..3 => 2, 5 => 6)
16636 (@value{GDBP}) set A_2D_Array := ((1, 2, 3), (4, 5, 6), (7, 8, 9))
16637 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (1, "Peter", True);
16638 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Record := (Name => "Peter", Id => 1, Alive => True)
16639 @end smallexample
16640
16641 Changing a
16642 discriminant's value by assigning an aggregate has an
16643 undefined effect if that discriminant is used within the record.
16644 However, you can first modify discriminants by directly assigning to
16645 them (which normally would not be allowed in Ada), and then performing an
16646 aggregate assignment. For example, given a variable @code{A_Rec}
16647 declared to have a type such as:
16648
16649 @smallexample
16650 type Rec (Len : Small_Integer := 0) is record
16651 Id : Integer;
16652 Vals : IntArray (1 .. Len);
16653 end record;
16654 @end smallexample
16655
16656 you can assign a value with a different size of @code{Vals} with two
16657 assignments:
16658
16659 @smallexample
16660 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec.Len := 4
16661 (@value{GDBP}) set A_Rec := (Id => 42, Vals => (1, 2, 3, 4))
16662 @end smallexample
16663
16664 As this example also illustrates, @value{GDBN} is very loose about the usual
16665 rules concerning aggregates. You may leave out some of the
16666 components of an array or record aggregate (such as the @code{Len}
16667 component in the assignment to @code{A_Rec} above); they will retain their
16668 original values upon assignment. You may freely use dynamic values as
16669 indices in component associations. You may even use overlapping or
16670 redundant component associations, although which component values are
16671 assigned in such cases is not defined.
16672
16673 @item
16674 Calls to dispatching subprograms are not implemented.
16675
16676 @item
16677 The overloading algorithm is much more limited (i.e., less selective)
16678 than that of real Ada. It makes only limited use of the context in
16679 which a subexpression appears to resolve its meaning, and it is much
16680 looser in its rules for allowing type matches. As a result, some
16681 function calls will be ambiguous, and the user will be asked to choose
16682 the proper resolution.
16683
16684 @item
16685 The @code{new} operator is not implemented.
16686
16687 @item
16688 Entry calls are not implemented.
16689
16690 @item
16691 Aside from printing, arithmetic operations on the native VAX floating-point
16692 formats are not supported.
16693
16694 @item
16695 It is not possible to slice a packed array.
16696
16697 @item
16698 The names @code{True} and @code{False}, when not part of a qualified name,
16699 are interpreted as if implicitly prefixed by @code{Standard}, regardless of
16700 context.
16701 Should your program
16702 redefine these names in a package or procedure (at best a dubious practice),
16703 you will have to use fully qualified names to access their new definitions.
16704 @end itemize
16705
16706 @node Additions to Ada
16707 @subsubsection Additions to Ada
16708 @cindex Ada, deviations from
16709
16710 As it does for other languages, @value{GDBN} makes certain generic
16711 extensions to Ada (@pxref{Expressions}):
16712
16713 @itemize @bullet
16714 @item
16715 If the expression @var{E} is a variable residing in memory (typically
16716 a local variable or array element) and @var{N} is a positive integer,
16717 then @code{@var{E}@@@var{N}} displays the values of @var{E} and the
16718 @var{N}-1 adjacent variables following it in memory as an array. In
16719 Ada, this operator is generally not necessary, since its prime use is
16720 in displaying parts of an array, and slicing will usually do this in
16721 Ada. However, there are occasional uses when debugging programs in
16722 which certain debugging information has been optimized away.
16723
16724 @item
16725 @code{@var{B}::@var{var}} means ``the variable named @var{var} that
16726 appears in function or file @var{B}.'' When @var{B} is a file name,
16727 you must typically surround it in single quotes.
16728
16729 @item
16730 The expression @code{@{@var{type}@} @var{addr}} means ``the variable of type
16731 @var{type} that appears at address @var{addr}.''
16732
16733 @item
16734 A name starting with @samp{$} is a convenience variable
16735 (@pxref{Convenience Vars}) or a machine register (@pxref{Registers}).
16736 @end itemize
16737
16738 In addition, @value{GDBN} provides a few other shortcuts and outright
16739 additions specific to Ada:
16740
16741 @itemize @bullet
16742 @item
16743 The assignment statement is allowed as an expression, returning
16744 its right-hand operand as its value. Thus, you may enter
16745
16746 @smallexample
16747 (@value{GDBP}) set x := y + 3
16748 (@value{GDBP}) print A(tmp := y + 1)
16749 @end smallexample
16750
16751 @item
16752 The semicolon is allowed as an ``operator,'' returning as its value
16753 the value of its right-hand operand.
16754 This allows, for example,
16755 complex conditional breaks:
16756
16757 @smallexample
16758 (@value{GDBP}) break f
16759 (@value{GDBP}) condition 1 (report(i); k += 1; A(k) > 100)
16760 @end smallexample
16761
16762 @item
16763 Rather than use catenation and symbolic character names to introduce special
16764 characters into strings, one may instead use a special bracket notation,
16765 which is also used to print strings. A sequence of characters of the form
16766 @samp{["@var{XX}"]} within a string or character literal denotes the
16767 (single) character whose numeric encoding is @var{XX} in hexadecimal. The
16768 sequence of characters @samp{["""]} also denotes a single quotation mark
16769 in strings. For example,
16770 @smallexample
16771 "One line.["0a"]Next line.["0a"]"
16772 @end smallexample
16773 @noindent
16774 contains an ASCII newline character (@code{Ada.Characters.Latin_1.LF})
16775 after each period.
16776
16777 @item
16778 The subtype used as a prefix for the attributes @t{'Pos}, @t{'Min}, and
16779 @t{'Max} is optional (and is ignored in any case). For example, it is valid
16780 to write
16781
16782 @smallexample
16783 (@value{GDBP}) print 'max(x, y)
16784 @end smallexample
16785
16786 @item
16787 When printing arrays, @value{GDBN} uses positional notation when the
16788 array has a lower bound of 1, and uses a modified named notation otherwise.
16789 For example, a one-dimensional array of three integers with a lower bound
16790 of 3 might print as
16791
16792 @smallexample
16793 (3 => 10, 17, 1)
16794 @end smallexample
16795
16796 @noindent
16797 That is, in contrast to valid Ada, only the first component has a @code{=>}
16798 clause.
16799
16800 @item
16801 You may abbreviate attributes in expressions with any unique,
16802 multi-character subsequence of
16803 their names (an exact match gets preference).
16804 For example, you may use @t{a'len}, @t{a'gth}, or @t{a'lh}
16805 in place of @t{a'length}.
16806
16807 @item
16808 @cindex quoting Ada internal identifiers
16809 Since Ada is case-insensitive, the debugger normally maps identifiers you type
16810 to lower case. The GNAT compiler uses upper-case characters for
16811 some of its internal identifiers, which are normally of no interest to users.
16812 For the rare occasions when you actually have to look at them,
16813 enclose them in angle brackets to avoid the lower-case mapping.
16814 For example,
16815 @smallexample
16816 (@value{GDBP}) print <JMPBUF_SAVE>[0]
16817 @end smallexample
16818
16819 @item
16820 Printing an object of class-wide type or dereferencing an
16821 access-to-class-wide value will display all the components of the object's
16822 specific type (as indicated by its run-time tag). Likewise, component
16823 selection on such a value will operate on the specific type of the
16824 object.
16825
16826 @end itemize
16827
16828 @node Overloading support for Ada
16829 @subsubsection Overloading support for Ada
16830 @cindex overloading, Ada
16831
16832 The debugger supports limited overloading. Given a subprogram call in which
16833 the function symbol has multiple definitions, it will use the number of
16834 actual parameters and some information about their types to attempt to narrow
16835 the set of definitions. It also makes very limited use of context, preferring
16836 procedures to functions in the context of the @code{call} command, and
16837 functions to procedures elsewhere.
16838
16839 If, after narrowing, the set of matching definitions still contains more than
16840 one definition, @value{GDBN} will display a menu to query which one it should
16841 use, for instance:
16842
16843 @smallexample
16844 (@value{GDBP}) print f(1)
16845 Multiple matches for f
16846 [0] cancel
16847 [1] foo.f (integer) return boolean at foo.adb:23
16848 [2] foo.f (foo.new_integer) return boolean at foo.adb:28
16849 >
16850 @end smallexample
16851
16852 In this case, just select one menu entry either to cancel expression evaluation
16853 (type @kbd{0} and press @key{RET}) or to continue evaluation with a specific
16854 instance (type the corresponding number and press @key{RET}).
16855
16856 Here are a couple of commands to customize @value{GDBN}'s behavior in this
16857 case:
16858
16859 @table @code
16860
16861 @kindex set ada print-signatures
16862 @item set ada print-signatures
16863 Control whether parameter types and return types are displayed in overloads
16864 selection menus. It is @code{on} by default.
16865 @xref{Overloading support for Ada}.
16866
16867 @kindex show ada print-signatures
16868 @item show ada print-signatures
16869 Show the current setting for displaying parameter types and return types in
16870 overloads selection menu.
16871 @xref{Overloading support for Ada}.
16872
16873 @end table
16874
16875 @node Stopping Before Main Program
16876 @subsubsection Stopping at the Very Beginning
16877
16878 @cindex breakpointing Ada elaboration code
16879 It is sometimes necessary to debug the program during elaboration, and
16880 before reaching the main procedure.
16881 As defined in the Ada Reference
16882 Manual, the elaboration code is invoked from a procedure called
16883 @code{adainit}. To run your program up to the beginning of
16884 elaboration, simply use the following two commands:
16885 @code{tbreak adainit} and @code{run}.
16886
16887 @node Ada Exceptions
16888 @subsubsection Ada Exceptions
16889
16890 A command is provided to list all Ada exceptions:
16891
16892 @table @code
16893 @kindex info exceptions
16894 @item info exceptions
16895 @itemx info exceptions @var{regexp}
16896 The @code{info exceptions} command allows you to list all Ada exceptions
16897 defined within the program being debugged, as well as their addresses.
16898 With a regular expression, @var{regexp}, as argument, only those exceptions
16899 whose names match @var{regexp} are listed.
16900 @end table
16901
16902 Below is a small example, showing how the command can be used, first
16903 without argument, and next with a regular expression passed as an
16904 argument.
16905
16906 @smallexample
16907 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions
16908 All defined Ada exceptions:
16909 constraint_error: 0x613da0
16910 program_error: 0x613d20
16911 storage_error: 0x613ce0
16912 tasking_error: 0x613ca0
16913 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
16914 (@value{GDBP}) info exceptions const.aint
16915 All Ada exceptions matching regular expression "const.aint":
16916 constraint_error: 0x613da0
16917 const.aint_global_e: 0x613b00
16918 @end smallexample
16919
16920 It is also possible to ask @value{GDBN} to stop your program's execution
16921 when an exception is raised. For more details, see @ref{Set Catchpoints}.
16922
16923 @node Ada Tasks
16924 @subsubsection Extensions for Ada Tasks
16925 @cindex Ada, tasking
16926
16927 Support for Ada tasks is analogous to that for threads (@pxref{Threads}).
16928 @value{GDBN} provides the following task-related commands:
16929
16930 @table @code
16931 @kindex info tasks
16932 @item info tasks
16933 This command shows a list of current Ada tasks, as in the following example:
16934
16935
16936 @smallexample
16937 @iftex
16938 @leftskip=0.5cm
16939 @end iftex
16940 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
16941 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
16942 1 8088000 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
16943 2 80a4000 1 15 Accept Statement b
16944 3 809a800 1 15 Child Activation Wait a
16945 * 4 80ae800 3 15 Runnable c
16946
16947 @end smallexample
16948
16949 @noindent
16950 In this listing, the asterisk before the last task indicates it to be the
16951 task currently being inspected.
16952
16953 @table @asis
16954 @item ID
16955 Represents @value{GDBN}'s internal task number.
16956
16957 @item TID
16958 The Ada task ID.
16959
16960 @item P-ID
16961 The parent's task ID (@value{GDBN}'s internal task number).
16962
16963 @item Pri
16964 The base priority of the task.
16965
16966 @item State
16967 Current state of the task.
16968
16969 @table @code
16970 @item Unactivated
16971 The task has been created but has not been activated. It cannot be
16972 executing.
16973
16974 @item Runnable
16975 The task is not blocked for any reason known to Ada. (It may be waiting
16976 for a mutex, though.) It is conceptually "executing" in normal mode.
16977
16978 @item Terminated
16979 The task is terminated, in the sense of ARM 9.3 (5). Any dependents
16980 that were waiting on terminate alternatives have been awakened and have
16981 terminated themselves.
16982
16983 @item Child Activation Wait
16984 The task is waiting for created tasks to complete activation.
16985
16986 @item Accept Statement
16987 The task is waiting on an accept or selective wait statement.
16988
16989 @item Waiting on entry call
16990 The task is waiting on an entry call.
16991
16992 @item Async Select Wait
16993 The task is waiting to start the abortable part of an asynchronous
16994 select statement.
16995
16996 @item Delay Sleep
16997 The task is waiting on a select statement with only a delay
16998 alternative open.
16999
17000 @item Child Termination Wait
17001 The task is sleeping having completed a master within itself, and is
17002 waiting for the tasks dependent on that master to become terminated or
17003 waiting on a terminate Phase.
17004
17005 @item Wait Child in Term Alt
17006 The task is sleeping waiting for tasks on terminate alternatives to
17007 finish terminating.
17008
17009 @item Accepting RV with @var{taskno}
17010 The task is accepting a rendez-vous with the task @var{taskno}.
17011 @end table
17012
17013 @item Name
17014 Name of the task in the program.
17015
17016 @end table
17017
17018 @kindex info task @var{taskno}
17019 @item info task @var{taskno}
17020 This command shows detailled informations on the specified task, as in
17021 the following example:
17022 @smallexample
17023 @iftex
17024 @leftskip=0.5cm
17025 @end iftex
17026 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17027 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17028 1 8077880 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17029 * 2 807c468 1 15 Runnable task_1
17030 (@value{GDBP}) info task 2
17031 Ada Task: 0x807c468
17032 Name: task_1
17033 Thread: 0x807f378
17034 Parent: 1 (main_task)
17035 Base Priority: 15
17036 State: Runnable
17037 @end smallexample
17038
17039 @item task
17040 @kindex task@r{ (Ada)}
17041 @cindex current Ada task ID
17042 This command prints the ID of the current task.
17043
17044 @smallexample
17045 @iftex
17046 @leftskip=0.5cm
17047 @end iftex
17048 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17049 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17050 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17051 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
17052 (@value{GDBP}) task
17053 [Current task is 2]
17054 @end smallexample
17055
17056 @item task @var{taskno}
17057 @cindex Ada task switching
17058 This command is like the @code{thread @var{thread-id}}
17059 command (@pxref{Threads}). It switches the context of debugging
17060 from the current task to the given task.
17061
17062 @smallexample
17063 @iftex
17064 @leftskip=0.5cm
17065 @end iftex
17066 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17067 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17068 1 8077870 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17069 * 2 807c458 1 15 Runnable t
17070 (@value{GDBP}) task 1
17071 [Switching to task 1]
17072 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
17073 (@value{GDBP}) bt
17074 #0 0x8067726 in pthread_cond_wait ()
17075 #1 0x8056714 in system.os_interface.pthread_cond_wait ()
17076 #2 0x805cb63 in system.task_primitives.operations.sleep ()
17077 #3 0x806153e in system.tasking.stages.activate_tasks ()
17078 #4 0x804aacc in un () at un.adb:5
17079 @end smallexample
17080
17081 @item break @var{location} task @var{taskno}
17082 @itemx break @var{location} task @var{taskno} if @dots{}
17083 @cindex breakpoints and tasks, in Ada
17084 @cindex task breakpoints, in Ada
17085 @kindex break @dots{} task @var{taskno}@r{ (Ada)}
17086 These commands are like the @code{break @dots{} thread @dots{}}
17087 command (@pxref{Thread Stops}). The
17088 @var{location} argument specifies source lines, as described
17089 in @ref{Specify Location}.
17090
17091 Use the qualifier @samp{task @var{taskno}} with a breakpoint command
17092 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
17093 particular Ada task reaches this breakpoint. The @var{taskno} is one of the
17094 numeric task identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
17095 column of the @samp{info tasks} display.
17096
17097 If you do not specify @samp{task @var{taskno}} when you set a
17098 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} tasks of your
17099 program.
17100
17101 You can use the @code{task} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
17102 well; in this case, place @samp{task @var{taskno}} before the
17103 breakpoint condition (before the @code{if}).
17104
17105 For example,
17106
17107 @smallexample
17108 @iftex
17109 @leftskip=0.5cm
17110 @end iftex
17111 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17112 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17113 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17114 2 140045060 1 15 Accept/Select Wait t2
17115 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
17116 * 4 140056040 1 15 Runnable t3
17117 (@value{GDBP}) b 15 task 2
17118 Breakpoint 5 at 0x120044cb0: file test_task_debug.adb, line 15.
17119 (@value{GDBP}) cont
17120 Continuing.
17121 task # 1 running
17122 task # 2 running
17123
17124 Breakpoint 5, test_task_debug () at test_task_debug.adb:15
17125 15 flush;
17126 (@value{GDBP}) info tasks
17127 ID TID P-ID Pri State Name
17128 1 140022020 0 15 Child Activation Wait main_task
17129 * 2 140045060 1 15 Runnable t2
17130 3 140044840 1 15 Runnable t1
17131 4 140056040 1 15 Delay Sleep t3
17132 @end smallexample
17133 @end table
17134
17135 @node Ada Tasks and Core Files
17136 @subsubsection Tasking Support when Debugging Core Files
17137 @cindex Ada tasking and core file debugging
17138
17139 When inspecting a core file, as opposed to debugging a live program,
17140 tasking support may be limited or even unavailable, depending on
17141 the platform being used.
17142 For instance, on x86-linux, the list of tasks is available, but task
17143 switching is not supported.
17144
17145 On certain platforms, the debugger needs to perform some
17146 memory writes in order to provide Ada tasking support. When inspecting
17147 a core file, this means that the core file must be opened with read-write
17148 privileges, using the command @samp{"set write on"} (@pxref{Patching}).
17149 Under these circumstances, you should make a backup copy of the core
17150 file before inspecting it with @value{GDBN}.
17151
17152 @node Ravenscar Profile
17153 @subsubsection Tasking Support when using the Ravenscar Profile
17154 @cindex Ravenscar Profile
17155
17156 The @dfn{Ravenscar Profile} is a subset of the Ada tasking features,
17157 specifically designed for systems with safety-critical real-time
17158 requirements.
17159
17160 @table @code
17161 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching on
17162 @cindex task switching with program using Ravenscar Profile
17163 @item set ravenscar task-switching on
17164 Allows task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
17165 Profile. This is the default.
17166
17167 @kindex set ravenscar task-switching off
17168 @item set ravenscar task-switching off
17169 Turn off task switching when debugging a program that uses the Ravenscar
17170 Profile. This is mostly intended to disable the code that adds support
17171 for the Ravenscar Profile, in case a bug in either @value{GDBN} or in
17172 the Ravenscar runtime is preventing @value{GDBN} from working properly.
17173 To be effective, this command should be run before the program is started.
17174
17175 @kindex show ravenscar task-switching
17176 @item show ravenscar task-switching
17177 Show whether it is possible to switch from task to task in a program
17178 using the Ravenscar Profile.
17179
17180 @end table
17181
17182 @node Ada Settings
17183 @subsubsection Ada Settings
17184 @cindex Ada settings
17185
17186 @table @code
17187 @kindex set varsize-limit
17188 @item set varsize-limit @var{size}
17189 Prevent @value{GDBN} from attempting to evaluate objects whose size
17190 is above the given limit (@var{size}) when those sizes are computed
17191 from run-time quantities. This is typically the case when the object
17192 has a variable size, such as an array whose bounds are not known at
17193 compile time for example. Setting @var{size} to @code{unlimited}
17194 removes the size limitation. By default, the limit is about 65KB.
17195
17196 The purpose of having such a limit is to prevent @value{GDBN} from
17197 trying to grab enormous chunks of virtual memory when asked to evaluate
17198 a quantity whose bounds have been corrupted or have not yet been fully
17199 initialized. The limit applies to the results of some subexpressions
17200 as well as to complete expressions. For example, an expression denoting
17201 a simple integer component, such as @code{x.y.z}, may fail if the size of
17202 @code{x.y} is variable and exceeds @code{size}. On the other hand,
17203 @value{GDBN} is sometimes clever; the expression @code{A(i)}, where
17204 @code{A} is an array variable with non-constant size, will generally
17205 succeed regardless of the bounds on @code{A}, as long as the component
17206 size is less than @var{size}.
17207
17208 @kindex show varsize-limit
17209 @item show varsize-limit
17210 Show the limit on types whose size is determined by run-time quantities.
17211 @end table
17212
17213 @node Ada Glitches
17214 @subsubsection Known Peculiarities of Ada Mode
17215 @cindex Ada, problems
17216
17217 Besides the omissions listed previously (@pxref{Omissions from Ada}),
17218 we know of several problems with and limitations of Ada mode in
17219 @value{GDBN},
17220 some of which will be fixed with planned future releases of the debugger
17221 and the GNU Ada compiler.
17222
17223 @itemize @bullet
17224 @item
17225 Static constants that the compiler chooses not to materialize as objects in
17226 storage are invisible to the debugger.
17227
17228 @item
17229 Named parameter associations in function argument lists are ignored (the
17230 argument lists are treated as positional).
17231
17232 @item
17233 Many useful library packages are currently invisible to the debugger.
17234
17235 @item
17236 Fixed-point arithmetic, conversions, input, and output is carried out using
17237 floating-point arithmetic, and may give results that only approximate those on
17238 the host machine.
17239
17240 @item
17241 The GNAT compiler never generates the prefix @code{Standard} for any of
17242 the standard symbols defined by the Ada language. @value{GDBN} knows about
17243 this: it will strip the prefix from names when you use it, and will never
17244 look for a name you have so qualified among local symbols, nor match against
17245 symbols in other packages or subprograms. If you have
17246 defined entities anywhere in your program other than parameters and
17247 local variables whose simple names match names in @code{Standard},
17248 GNAT's lack of qualification here can cause confusion. When this happens,
17249 you can usually resolve the confusion
17250 by qualifying the problematic names with package
17251 @code{Standard} explicitly.
17252 @end itemize
17253
17254 Older versions of the compiler sometimes generate erroneous debugging
17255 information, resulting in the debugger incorrectly printing the value
17256 of affected entities. In some cases, the debugger is able to work
17257 around an issue automatically. In other cases, the debugger is able
17258 to work around the issue, but the work-around has to be specifically
17259 enabled.
17260
17261 @kindex set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
17262 @kindex show ada trust-PAD-over-XVS
17263 @table @code
17264
17265 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS on
17266 Configure GDB to strictly follow the GNAT encoding when computing the
17267 value of Ada entities, particularly when @code{PAD} and @code{PAD___XVS}
17268 types are involved (see @code{ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources for
17269 a complete description of the encoding used by the GNAT compiler).
17270 This is the default.
17271
17272 @item set ada trust-PAD-over-XVS off
17273 This is related to the encoding using by the GNAT compiler. If @value{GDBN}
17274 sometimes prints the wrong value for certain entities, changing @code{ada
17275 trust-PAD-over-XVS} to @code{off} activates a work-around which may fix
17276 the issue. It is always safe to set @code{ada trust-PAD-over-XVS} to
17277 @code{off}, but this incurs a slight performance penalty, so it is
17278 recommended to leave this setting to @code{on} unless necessary.
17279
17280 @end table
17281
17282 @cindex GNAT descriptive types
17283 @cindex GNAT encoding
17284 Internally, the debugger also relies on the compiler following a number
17285 of conventions known as the @samp{GNAT Encoding}, all documented in
17286 @file{gcc/ada/exp_dbug.ads} in the GCC sources. This encoding describes
17287 how the debugging information should be generated for certain types.
17288 In particular, this convention makes use of @dfn{descriptive types},
17289 which are artificial types generated purely to help the debugger.
17290
17291 These encodings were defined at a time when the debugging information
17292 format used was not powerful enough to describe some of the more complex
17293 types available in Ada. Since DWARF allows us to express nearly all
17294 Ada features, the long-term goal is to slowly replace these descriptive
17295 types by their pure DWARF equivalent. To facilitate that transition,
17296 a new maintenance option is available to force the debugger to ignore
17297 those descriptive types. It allows the user to quickly evaluate how
17298 well @value{GDBN} works without them.
17299
17300 @table @code
17301
17302 @kindex maint ada set ignore-descriptive-types
17303 @item maintenance ada set ignore-descriptive-types [on|off]
17304 Control whether the debugger should ignore descriptive types.
17305 The default is not to ignore descriptives types (@code{off}).
17306
17307 @kindex maint ada show ignore-descriptive-types
17308 @item maintenance ada show ignore-descriptive-types
17309 Show if descriptive types are ignored by @value{GDBN}.
17310
17311 @end table
17312
17313 @node Unsupported Languages
17314 @section Unsupported Languages
17315
17316 @cindex unsupported languages
17317 @cindex minimal language
17318 In addition to the other fully-supported programming languages,
17319 @value{GDBN} also provides a pseudo-language, called @code{minimal}.
17320 It does not represent a real programming language, but provides a set
17321 of capabilities close to what the C or assembly languages provide.
17322 This should allow most simple operations to be performed while debugging
17323 an application that uses a language currently not supported by @value{GDBN}.
17324
17325 If the language is set to @code{auto}, @value{GDBN} will automatically
17326 select this language if the current frame corresponds to an unsupported
17327 language.
17328
17329 @node Symbols
17330 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
17331
17332 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
17333 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
17334 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
17335 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
17336 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
17337 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing Files}), or by one of the
17338 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
17339
17340 @cindex symbol names
17341 @cindex names of symbols
17342 @cindex quoting names
17343 @anchor{quoting names}
17344 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
17345 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
17346 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
17347 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program Variables}). File names
17348 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
17349 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
17350 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
17351 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
17352
17353 @smallexample
17354 p 'foo.c'::x
17355 @end smallexample
17356
17357 @noindent
17358 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
17359
17360 @table @code
17361 @cindex case-insensitive symbol names
17362 @cindex case sensitivity in symbol names
17363 @kindex set case-sensitive
17364 @item set case-sensitive on
17365 @itemx set case-sensitive off
17366 @itemx set case-sensitive auto
17367 Normally, when @value{GDBN} looks up symbols, it matches their names
17368 with case sensitivity determined by the current source language.
17369 Occasionally, you may wish to control that. The command @code{set
17370 case-sensitive} lets you do that by specifying @code{on} for
17371 case-sensitive matches or @code{off} for case-insensitive ones. If
17372 you specify @code{auto}, case sensitivity is reset to the default
17373 suitable for the source language. The default is case-sensitive
17374 matches for all languages except for Fortran, for which the default is
17375 case-insensitive matches.
17376
17377 @kindex show case-sensitive
17378 @item show case-sensitive
17379 This command shows the current setting of case sensitivity for symbols
17380 lookups.
17381
17382 @kindex set print type methods
17383 @item set print type methods
17384 @itemx set print type methods on
17385 @itemx set print type methods off
17386 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any methods
17387 declared in that class. You can control this behavior either by
17388 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
17389 print type methods}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
17390 display the methods; this is the default. Specifying @code{off} will
17391 cause @value{GDBN} to omit the methods.
17392
17393 @kindex show print type methods
17394 @item show print type methods
17395 This command shows the current setting of method display when printing
17396 classes.
17397
17398 @kindex set print type nested-type-limit
17399 @item set print type nested-type-limit @var{limit}
17400 @itemx set print type nested-type-limit unlimited
17401 Set the limit of displayed nested types that the type printer will
17402 show. A @var{limit} of @code{unlimited} or @code{-1} will show all
17403 nested definitions. By default, the type printer will not show any nested
17404 types defined in classes.
17405
17406 @kindex show print type nested-type-limit
17407 @item show print type nested-type-limit
17408 This command shows the current display limit of nested types when
17409 printing classes.
17410
17411 @kindex set print type typedefs
17412 @item set print type typedefs
17413 @itemx set print type typedefs on
17414 @itemx set print type typedefs off
17415
17416 Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a class, it displays any typedefs
17417 defined in that class. You can control this behavior either by
17418 passing the appropriate flag to @code{ptype}, or using @command{set
17419 print type typedefs}. Specifying @code{on} will cause @value{GDBN} to
17420 display the typedef definitions; this is the default. Specifying
17421 @code{off} will cause @value{GDBN} to omit the typedef definitions.
17422 Note that this controls whether the typedef definition itself is
17423 printed, not whether typedef names are substituted when printing other
17424 types.
17425
17426 @kindex show print type typedefs
17427 @item show print type typedefs
17428 This command shows the current setting of typedef display when
17429 printing classes.
17430
17431 @kindex info address
17432 @cindex address of a symbol
17433 @item info address @var{symbol}
17434 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
17435 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
17436 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
17437 is always stored.
17438
17439 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
17440 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
17441 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
17442
17443 @kindex info symbol
17444 @cindex symbol from address
17445 @cindex closest symbol and offset for an address
17446 @item info symbol @var{addr}
17447 Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
17448 If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
17449 nearest symbol and an offset from it:
17450
17451 @smallexample
17452 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
17453 _initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
17454 @end smallexample
17455
17456 @noindent
17457 This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
17458 it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
17459
17460 For dynamically linked executables, the name of executable or shared
17461 library containing the symbol is also printed:
17462
17463 @smallexample
17464 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x400225
17465 _start + 5 in section .text of /tmp/a.out
17466 (@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x2aaaac2811cf
17467 __read_nocancel + 6 in section .text of /usr/lib64/libc.so.6
17468 @end smallexample
17469
17470 @kindex demangle
17471 @cindex demangle
17472 @item demangle @r{[}-l @var{language}@r{]} @r{[}@var{--}@r{]} @var{name}
17473 Demangle @var{name}.
17474 If @var{language} is provided it is the name of the language to demangle
17475 @var{name} in. Otherwise @var{name} is demangled in the current language.
17476
17477 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
17478 and is useful when @var{name} begins with a dash.
17479
17480 The parameter @code{demangle-style} specifies how to interpret the kind
17481 of mangling used. @xref{Print Settings}.
17482
17483 @kindex whatis
17484 @item whatis[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
17485 Print the data type of @var{arg}, which can be either an expression
17486 or a name of a data type. With no argument, print the data type of
17487 @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
17488
17489 If @var{arg} is an expression (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), it
17490 is not actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
17491 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
17492
17493 If @var{arg} is a variable or an expression, @code{whatis} prints its
17494 literal type as it is used in the source code. If the type was
17495 defined using a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will @emph{not} print
17496 the data type underlying the @code{typedef}. If the type of the
17497 variable or the expression is a compound data type, such as
17498 @code{struct} or @code{class}, @code{whatis} never prints their
17499 fields or methods. It just prints the @code{struct}/@code{class}
17500 name (a.k.a.@: its @dfn{tag}). If you want to see the members of
17501 such a compound data type, use @code{ptype}.
17502
17503 If @var{arg} is a type name that was defined using @code{typedef},
17504 @code{whatis} @dfn{unrolls} only one level of that @code{typedef}.
17505 Unrolling means that @code{whatis} will show the underlying type used
17506 in the @code{typedef} declaration of @var{arg}. However, if that
17507 underlying type is also a @code{typedef}, @code{whatis} will not
17508 unroll it.
17509
17510 For C code, the type names may also have the form @samp{class
17511 @var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
17512 @var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
17513
17514 @var{flags} can be used to modify how the type is displayed.
17515 Available flags are:
17516
17517 @table @code
17518 @item r
17519 Display in ``raw'' form. Normally, @value{GDBN} substitutes template
17520 parameters and typedefs defined in a class when printing the class'
17521 members. The @code{/r} flag disables this.
17522
17523 @item m
17524 Do not print methods defined in the class.
17525
17526 @item M
17527 Print methods defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
17528 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type methods}.
17529
17530 @item t
17531 Do not print typedefs defined in the class. Note that this controls
17532 whether the typedef definition itself is printed, not whether typedef
17533 names are substituted when printing other types.
17534
17535 @item T
17536 Print typedefs defined in the class. This is the default, but the flag
17537 exists in case you change the default with @command{set print type typedefs}.
17538
17539 @item o
17540 Print the offsets and sizes of fields in a struct, similar to what the
17541 @command{pahole} tool does. This option implies the @code{/tm} flags.
17542
17543 For example, given the following declarations:
17544
17545 @smallexample
17546 struct tuv
17547 @{
17548 int a1;
17549 char *a2;
17550 int a3;
17551 @};
17552
17553 struct xyz
17554 @{
17555 int f1;
17556 char f2;
17557 void *f3;
17558 struct tuv f4;
17559 @};
17560
17561 union qwe
17562 @{
17563 struct tuv fff1;
17564 struct xyz fff2;
17565 @};
17566
17567 struct tyu
17568 @{
17569 int a1 : 1;
17570 int a2 : 3;
17571 int a3 : 23;
17572 char a4 : 2;
17573 int64_t a5;
17574 int a6 : 5;
17575 int64_t a7 : 3;
17576 @};
17577 @end smallexample
17578
17579 Issuing a @kbd{ptype /o struct tuv} command would print:
17580
17581 @smallexample
17582 (@value{GDBP}) ptype /o struct tuv
17583 /* offset | size */ type = struct tuv @{
17584 /* 0 | 4 */ int a1;
17585 /* XXX 4-byte hole */
17586 /* 8 | 8 */ char *a2;
17587 /* 16 | 4 */ int a3;
17588
17589 /* total size (bytes): 24 */
17590 @}
17591 @end smallexample
17592
17593 Notice the format of the first column of comments. There, you can
17594 find two parts separated by the @samp{|} character: the @emph{offset},
17595 which indicates where the field is located inside the struct, in
17596 bytes, and the @emph{size} of the field. Another interesting line is
17597 the marker of a @emph{hole} in the struct, indicating that it may be
17598 possible to pack the struct and make it use less space by reorganizing
17599 its fields.
17600
17601 It is also possible to print offsets inside an union:
17602
17603 @smallexample
17604 (@value{GDBP}) ptype /o union qwe
17605 /* offset | size */ type = union qwe @{
17606 /* 24 */ struct tuv @{
17607 /* 0 | 4 */ int a1;
17608 /* XXX 4-byte hole */
17609 /* 8 | 8 */ char *a2;
17610 /* 16 | 4 */ int a3;
17611
17612 /* total size (bytes): 24 */
17613 @} fff1;
17614 /* 40 */ struct xyz @{
17615 /* 0 | 4 */ int f1;
17616 /* 4 | 1 */ char f2;
17617 /* XXX 3-byte hole */
17618 /* 8 | 8 */ void *f3;
17619 /* 16 | 24 */ struct tuv @{
17620 /* 16 | 4 */ int a1;
17621 /* XXX 4-byte hole */
17622 /* 24 | 8 */ char *a2;
17623 /* 32 | 4 */ int a3;
17624
17625 /* total size (bytes): 24 */
17626 @} f4;
17627
17628 /* total size (bytes): 40 */
17629 @} fff2;
17630
17631 /* total size (bytes): 40 */
17632 @}
17633 @end smallexample
17634
17635 In this case, since @code{struct tuv} and @code{struct xyz} occupy the
17636 same space (because we are dealing with an union), the offset is not
17637 printed for them. However, you can still examine the offset of each
17638 of these structures' fields.
17639
17640 Another useful scenario is printing the offsets of a struct containing
17641 bitfields:
17642
17643 @smallexample
17644 (@value{GDBP}) ptype /o struct tyu
17645 /* offset | size */ type = struct tyu @{
17646 /* 0:31 | 4 */ int a1 : 1;
17647 /* 0:28 | 4 */ int a2 : 3;
17648 /* 0: 5 | 4 */ int a3 : 23;
17649 /* 3: 3 | 1 */ signed char a4 : 2;
17650 /* XXX 3-bit hole */
17651 /* XXX 4-byte hole */
17652 /* 8 | 8 */ int64_t a5;
17653 /* 16:27 | 4 */ int a6 : 5;
17654 /* 16:56 | 8 */ int64_t a7 : 3;
17655
17656 /* total size (bytes): 24 */
17657 @}
17658 @end smallexample
17659
17660 Note how the offset information is now extended to also include how
17661 many bits are left to be used in each bitfield.
17662 @end table
17663
17664 @kindex ptype
17665 @item ptype[/@var{flags}] [@var{arg}]
17666 @code{ptype} accepts the same arguments as @code{whatis}, but prints a
17667 detailed description of the type, instead of just the name of the type.
17668 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
17669
17670 Contrary to @code{whatis}, @code{ptype} always unrolls any
17671 @code{typedef}s in its argument declaration, whether the argument is
17672 a variable, expression, or a data type. This means that @code{ptype}
17673 of a variable or an expression will not print literally its type as
17674 present in the source code---use @code{whatis} for that. @code{typedef}s at
17675 the pointer or reference targets are also unrolled. Only @code{typedef}s of
17676 fields, methods and inner @code{class typedef}s of @code{struct}s,
17677 @code{class}es and @code{union}s are not unrolled even with @code{ptype}.
17678
17679 For example, for this variable declaration:
17680
17681 @smallexample
17682 typedef double real_t;
17683 struct complex @{ real_t real; double imag; @};
17684 typedef struct complex complex_t;
17685 complex_t var;
17686 real_t *real_pointer_var;
17687 @end smallexample
17688
17689 @noindent
17690 the two commands give this output:
17691
17692 @smallexample
17693 @group
17694 (@value{GDBP}) whatis var
17695 type = complex_t
17696 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
17697 type = struct complex @{
17698 real_t real;
17699 double imag;
17700 @}
17701 (@value{GDBP}) whatis complex_t
17702 type = struct complex
17703 (@value{GDBP}) whatis struct complex
17704 type = struct complex
17705 (@value{GDBP}) ptype struct complex
17706 type = struct complex @{
17707 real_t real;
17708 double imag;
17709 @}
17710 (@value{GDBP}) whatis real_pointer_var
17711 type = real_t *
17712 (@value{GDBP}) ptype real_pointer_var
17713 type = double *
17714 @end group
17715 @end smallexample
17716
17717 @noindent
17718 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
17719 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
17720
17721 @cindex incomplete type
17722 Sometimes, programs use opaque data types or incomplete specifications
17723 of complex data structure. If the debug information included in the
17724 program does not allow @value{GDBN} to display a full declaration of
17725 the data type, it will say @samp{<incomplete type>}. For example,
17726 given these declarations:
17727
17728 @smallexample
17729 struct foo;
17730 struct foo *fooptr;
17731 @end smallexample
17732
17733 @noindent
17734 but no definition for @code{struct foo} itself, @value{GDBN} will say:
17735
17736 @smallexample
17737 (@value{GDBP}) ptype foo
17738 $1 = <incomplete type>
17739 @end smallexample
17740
17741 @noindent
17742 ``Incomplete type'' is C terminology for data types that are not
17743 completely specified.
17744
17745 @cindex unknown type
17746 Othertimes, information about a variable's type is completely absent
17747 from the debug information included in the program. This most often
17748 happens when the program or library where the variable is defined
17749 includes no debug information at all. @value{GDBN} knows the variable
17750 exists from inspecting the linker/loader symbol table (e.g., the ELF
17751 dynamic symbol table), but such symbols do not contain type
17752 information. Inspecting the type of a (global) variable for which
17753 @value{GDBN} has no type information shows:
17754
17755 @smallexample
17756 (@value{GDBP}) ptype var
17757 type = <data variable, no debug info>
17758 @end smallexample
17759
17760 @xref{Variables, no debug info variables}, for how to print the values
17761 of such variables.
17762
17763 @kindex info types
17764 @item info types @var{regexp}
17765 @itemx info types
17766 Print a brief description of all types whose names match the regular
17767 expression @var{regexp} (or all types in your program, if you supply
17768 no argument). Each complete typename is matched as though it were a
17769 complete line; thus, @samp{i type value} gives information on all
17770 types in your program whose names include the string @code{value}, but
17771 @samp{i type ^value$} gives information only on types whose complete
17772 name is @code{value}.
17773
17774 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
17775 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
17776 lists all source files and line numbers where a type is defined.
17777
17778 @kindex info type-printers
17779 @item info type-printers
17780 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled may
17781 have ``type printers'' available. When using @command{ptype} or
17782 @command{whatis}, these printers are consulted when the name of a type
17783 is needed. @xref{Type Printing API}, for more information on writing
17784 type printers.
17785
17786 @code{info type-printers} displays all the available type printers.
17787
17788 @kindex enable type-printer
17789 @kindex disable type-printer
17790 @item enable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
17791 @item disable type-printer @var{name}@dots{}
17792 These commands can be used to enable or disable type printers.
17793
17794 @kindex info scope
17795 @cindex local variables
17796 @item info scope @var{location}
17797 List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
17798 accepts a @var{location} argument---a function name, a source line, or
17799 an address preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local
17800 to the scope defined by that location. (@xref{Specify Location}, for
17801 details about supported forms of @var{location}.) For example:
17802
17803 @smallexample
17804 (@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
17805 Scope for command_line_handler:
17806 Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
17807 Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
17808 Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
17809 Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
17810 Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
17811 Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
17812 Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
17813 @end smallexample
17814
17815 @noindent
17816 This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
17817 during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
17818 collect}.
17819
17820 @kindex info source
17821 @item info source
17822 Show information about the current source file---that is, the source file for
17823 the function containing the current point of execution:
17824 @itemize @bullet
17825 @item
17826 the name of the source file, and the directory containing it,
17827 @item
17828 the directory it was compiled in,
17829 @item
17830 its length, in lines,
17831 @item
17832 which programming language it is written in,
17833 @item
17834 if the debug information provides it, the program that compiled the file
17835 (which may include, e.g., the compiler version and command line arguments),
17836 @item
17837 whether the executable includes debugging information for that file, and
17838 if so, what format the information is in (e.g., STABS, Dwarf 2, etc.), and
17839 @item
17840 whether the debugging information includes information about
17841 preprocessor macros.
17842 @end itemize
17843
17844
17845 @kindex info sources
17846 @item info sources
17847 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
17848 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
17849 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
17850
17851 @kindex info functions
17852 @item info functions
17853 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
17854 Similarly to @samp{info types}, this command groups its output by source
17855 files and annotates each function definition with its source line
17856 number.
17857
17858 @item info functions @var{regexp}
17859 Like @samp{info functions}, but only print the names and data types of
17860 functions whose names contain a match for regular expression
17861 @var{regexp}. Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose
17862 names include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
17863 start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters that
17864 conflict with the regular expression language (e.g.@:
17865 @samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
17866
17867 @kindex info variables
17868 @item info variables
17869 Print the names and data types of all variables that are defined
17870 outside of functions (i.e.@: excluding local variables).
17871 The printed variables are grouped by source files and annotated with
17872 their respective source line numbers.
17873
17874 @item info variables @var{regexp}
17875 Like @kbd{info variables}, but only print the names and data types of
17876 non-local variables whose names contain a match for regular expression
17877 @var{regexp}.
17878
17879 @kindex info classes
17880 @cindex Objective-C, classes and selectors
17881 @item info classes
17882 @itemx info classes @var{regexp}
17883 Display all Objective-C classes in your program, or
17884 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
17885 expression.
17886
17887 @kindex info selectors
17888 @item info selectors
17889 @itemx info selectors @var{regexp}
17890 Display all Objective-C selectors in your program, or
17891 (with the @var{regexp} argument) all those matching a particular regular
17892 expression.
17893
17894 @ignore
17895 This was never implemented.
17896 @kindex info methods
17897 @item info methods
17898 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
17899 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
17900 methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
17901 specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
17902 C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
17903 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
17904 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
17905 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
17906 @end ignore
17907
17908 @cindex opaque data types
17909 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
17910 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
17911 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
17912 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
17913 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
17914 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
17915 another source file. The default is on.
17916
17917 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
17918 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
17919
17920 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
17921 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
17922 is printed as follows:
17923 @smallexample
17924 @{<no data fields>@}
17925 @end smallexample
17926
17927 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
17928 @item show opaque-type-resolution
17929 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
17930
17931 @kindex set print symbol-loading
17932 @cindex print messages when symbols are loaded
17933 @item set print symbol-loading
17934 @itemx set print symbol-loading full
17935 @itemx set print symbol-loading brief
17936 @itemx set print symbol-loading off
17937 The @code{set print symbol-loading} command allows you to control the
17938 printing of messages when @value{GDBN} loads symbol information.
17939 By default a message is printed for the executable and one for each
17940 shared library, and normally this is what you want. However, when
17941 debugging apps with large numbers of shared libraries these messages
17942 can be annoying.
17943 When set to @code{brief} a message is printed for each executable,
17944 and when @value{GDBN} loads a collection of shared libraries at once
17945 it will only print one message regardless of the number of shared
17946 libraries. When set to @code{off} no messages are printed.
17947
17948 @kindex show print symbol-loading
17949 @item show print symbol-loading
17950 Show whether messages will be printed when a @value{GDBN} command
17951 entered from the keyboard causes symbol information to be loaded.
17952
17953 @kindex maint print symbols
17954 @cindex symbol dump
17955 @kindex maint print psymbols
17956 @cindex partial symbol dump
17957 @kindex maint print msymbols
17958 @cindex minimal symbol dump
17959 @item maint print symbols @r{[}-pc @var{address}@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17960 @itemx maint print symbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-source @var{source}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17961 @itemx maint print psymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-pc @var{address}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17962 @itemx maint print psymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}-source @var{source}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17963 @itemx maint print msymbols @r{[}-objfile @var{objfile}@r{]} @r{[}--@r{]} @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
17964 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename} or
17965 the terminal if @var{filename} is unspecified.
17966 If @code{-objfile @var{objfile}} is specified, only dump symbols for
17967 that objfile.
17968 If @code{-pc @var{address}} is specified, only dump symbols for the file
17969 with code at that address. Note that @var{address} may be a symbol like
17970 @code{main}.
17971 If @code{-source @var{source}} is specified, only dump symbols for that
17972 source file.
17973
17974 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code.
17975 These commands do not modify internal @value{GDBN} state, therefore
17976 @samp{maint print symbols} will only print symbols for already expanded symbol
17977 tables.
17978 You can use the command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are.
17979 If you use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information
17980 about symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols
17981 defined in files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely.
17982 Finally, @samp{maint print msymbols} just dumps ``minimal symbols'', e.g.,
17983 ``ELF symbols''.
17984
17985 @xref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}, for a discussion of how
17986 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
17987
17988 @kindex maint info symtabs
17989 @kindex maint info psymtabs
17990 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal symbol tables
17991 @cindex symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
17992 @cindex full symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
17993 @cindex partial symbol tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
17994 @item maint info symtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
17995 @itemx maint info psymtabs @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
17996
17997 List the @code{struct symtab} or @code{struct partial_symtab}
17998 structures whose names match @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
17999 given, list them all. The output includes expressions which you can
18000 copy into a @value{GDBN} debugging this one to examine a particular
18001 structure in more detail. For example:
18002
18003 @smallexample
18004 (@value{GDBP}) maint info psymtabs dwarf2read
18005 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
18006 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
18007 @{ psymtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
18008 ((struct partial_symtab *) 0x8474b10)
18009 readin no
18010 fullname (null)
18011 text addresses 0x814d3c8 -- 0x8158074
18012 globals (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x8507a08 @@ 9)
18013 statics (* (struct partial_symbol **) 0x40e95b78 @@ 2882)
18014 dependencies (none)
18015 @}
18016 @}
18017 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
18018 (@value{GDBP})
18019 @end smallexample
18020 @noindent
18021 We see that there is one partial symbol table whose filename contains
18022 the string @samp{dwarf2read}, belonging to the @samp{gdb} executable;
18023 and we see that @value{GDBN} has not read in any symtabs yet at all.
18024 If we set a breakpoint on a function, that will cause @value{GDBN} to
18025 read the symtab for the compilation unit containing that function:
18026
18027 @smallexample
18028 (@value{GDBP}) break dwarf2_psymtab_to_symtab
18029 Breakpoint 1 at 0x814e5da: file /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c,
18030 line 1574.
18031 (@value{GDBP}) maint info symtabs
18032 @{ objfile /home/gnu/build/gdb/gdb
18033 ((struct objfile *) 0x82e69d0)
18034 @{ symtab /home/gnu/src/gdb/dwarf2read.c
18035 ((struct symtab *) 0x86c1f38)
18036 dirname (null)
18037 fullname (null)
18038 blockvector ((struct blockvector *) 0x86c1bd0) (primary)
18039 linetable ((struct linetable *) 0x8370fa0)
18040 debugformat DWARF 2
18041 @}
18042 @}
18043 (@value{GDBP})
18044 @end smallexample
18045
18046 @kindex maint info line-table
18047 @cindex listing @value{GDBN}'s internal line tables
18048 @cindex line tables, listing @value{GDBN}'s internal
18049 @item maint info line-table @r{[} @var{regexp} @r{]}
18050
18051 List the @code{struct linetable} from all @code{struct symtab}
18052 instances whose name matches @var{regexp}. If @var{regexp} is not
18053 given, list the @code{struct linetable} from all @code{struct symtab}.
18054
18055 @kindex maint set symbol-cache-size
18056 @cindex symbol cache size
18057 @item maint set symbol-cache-size @var{size}
18058 Set the size of the symbol cache to @var{size}.
18059 The default size is intended to be good enough for debugging
18060 most applications. This option exists to allow for experimenting
18061 with different sizes.
18062
18063 @kindex maint show symbol-cache-size
18064 @item maint show symbol-cache-size
18065 Show the size of the symbol cache.
18066
18067 @kindex maint print symbol-cache
18068 @cindex symbol cache, printing its contents
18069 @item maint print symbol-cache
18070 Print the contents of the symbol cache.
18071 This is useful when debugging symbol cache issues.
18072
18073 @kindex maint print symbol-cache-statistics
18074 @cindex symbol cache, printing usage statistics
18075 @item maint print symbol-cache-statistics
18076 Print symbol cache usage statistics.
18077 This helps determine how well the cache is being utilized.
18078
18079 @kindex maint flush-symbol-cache
18080 @cindex symbol cache, flushing
18081 @item maint flush-symbol-cache
18082 Flush the contents of the symbol cache, all entries are removed.
18083 This command is useful when debugging the symbol cache.
18084 It is also useful when collecting performance data.
18085
18086 @end table
18087
18088 @node Altering
18089 @chapter Altering Execution
18090
18091 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
18092 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
18093 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
18094 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
18095 program.
18096
18097 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
18098 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
18099 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
18100
18101 @menu
18102 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
18103 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
18104 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
18105 * Returning:: Returning from a function
18106 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
18107 * Patching:: Patching your program
18108 * Compiling and Injecting Code:: Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
18109 @end menu
18110
18111 @node Assignment
18112 @section Assignment to Variables
18113
18114 @cindex assignment
18115 @cindex setting variables
18116 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
18117 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
18118
18119 @smallexample
18120 print x=4
18121 @end smallexample
18122
18123 @noindent
18124 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
18125 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
18126 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
18127 information on operators in supported languages.
18128
18129 @kindex set variable
18130 @cindex variables, setting
18131 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
18132 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
18133 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
18134 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
18135 ,Value History}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
18136
18137 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
18138 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
18139 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
18140 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
18141 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
18142 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
18143 command @code{set width}:
18144
18145 @smallexample
18146 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
18147 type = double
18148 (@value{GDBP}) p width
18149 $4 = 13
18150 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
18151 Invalid syntax in expression.
18152 @end smallexample
18153
18154 @noindent
18155 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
18156 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
18157
18158 @smallexample
18159 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
18160 @end smallexample
18161
18162 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
18163 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
18164 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
18165 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
18166 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
18167 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
18168
18169 @smallexample
18170 @group
18171 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
18172 type = double
18173 (@value{GDBP}) p g
18174 $1 = 1
18175 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
18176 (@value{GDBP}) p g
18177 $2 = 1
18178 (@value{GDBP}) r
18179 The program being debugged has been started already.
18180 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
18181 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
18182 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
18183 Invalid bfd target.
18184 (@value{GDBP}) show g
18185 The current BFD target is "=4".
18186 @end group
18187 @end smallexample
18188
18189 @noindent
18190 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
18191 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
18192 @code{g}, use
18193
18194 @smallexample
18195 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
18196 @end smallexample
18197
18198 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
18199 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
18200 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
18201 same length or shorter.
18202 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
18203 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
18204
18205 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
18206 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
18207 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
18208 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
18209 and representation in memory), and
18210
18211 @smallexample
18212 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
18213 @end smallexample
18214
18215 @noindent
18216 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
18217
18218 @node Jumping
18219 @section Continuing at a Different Address
18220
18221 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
18222 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
18223 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
18224
18225 @table @code
18226 @kindex jump
18227 @kindex j @r{(@code{jump})}
18228 @item jump @var{location}
18229 @itemx j @var{location}
18230 Resume execution at @var{location}. Execution stops again immediately
18231 if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description
18232 of the different forms of @var{location}. It is common
18233 practice to use the @code{tbreak} command in conjunction with
18234 @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting Breakpoints}.
18235
18236 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
18237 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
18238 register other than the program counter. If @var{location} is in
18239 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
18240 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
18241 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
18242 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
18243 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
18244 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
18245 @end table
18246
18247 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
18248 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
18249 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
18250 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
18251 example,
18252
18253 @smallexample
18254 set $pc = 0x485
18255 @end smallexample
18256
18257 @noindent
18258 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
18259 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
18260 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}.
18261
18262 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
18263 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
18264 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
18265 detail.
18266
18267 @c @group
18268 @node Signaling
18269 @section Giving your Program a Signal
18270 @cindex deliver a signal to a program
18271
18272 @table @code
18273 @kindex signal
18274 @item signal @var{signal}
18275 Resume execution where your program is stopped, but immediately give it the
18276 signal @var{signal}. The @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
18277 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
18278 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
18279
18280 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
18281 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
18282 a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
18283 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
18284 signal.
18285
18286 @emph{Note:} When resuming a multi-threaded program, @var{signal} is
18287 delivered to the currently selected thread, not the thread that last
18288 reported a stop. This includes the situation where a thread was
18289 stopped due to a signal. So if you want to continue execution
18290 suppressing the signal that stopped a thread, you should select that
18291 same thread before issuing the @samp{signal 0} command. If you issue
18292 the @samp{signal 0} command with another thread as the selected one,
18293 @value{GDBN} detects that and asks for confirmation.
18294
18295 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
18296 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
18297 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
18298 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
18299 passes the signal directly to your program.
18300
18301 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
18302 after executing the command.
18303
18304 @kindex queue-signal
18305 @item queue-signal @var{signal}
18306 Queue @var{signal} to be delivered immediately to the current thread
18307 when execution of the thread resumes. The @var{signal} can be the name or
18308 the number of a signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and
18309 @code{signal SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
18310 The handling of the signal must be set to pass the signal to the program,
18311 otherwise @value{GDBN} will report an error.
18312 You can control the handling of signals from @value{GDBN} with the
18313 @code{handle} command (@pxref{Signals}).
18314
18315 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, any currently queued signal
18316 for the current thread is discarded and when execution resumes no signal
18317 will be delivered. This is useful when your program stopped on account
18318 of a signal and would ordinarily see the signal when resumed with the
18319 @code{continue} command.
18320
18321 This command differs from the @code{signal} command in that the signal
18322 is just queued, execution is not resumed. And @code{queue-signal} cannot
18323 be used to pass a signal whose handling state has been set to @code{nopass}
18324 (@pxref{Signals}).
18325 @end table
18326 @c @end group
18327
18328 @xref{stepping into signal handlers}, for information on how stepping
18329 commands behave when the thread has a signal queued.
18330
18331 @node Returning
18332 @section Returning from a Function
18333
18334 @table @code
18335 @cindex returning from a function
18336 @kindex return
18337 @item return
18338 @itemx return @var{expression}
18339 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
18340 command. If you give an
18341 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
18342 value.
18343 @end table
18344
18345 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
18346 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
18347 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
18348 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
18349
18350 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
18351 Frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
18352 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
18353 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
18354 of functions.
18355
18356 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
18357 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
18358 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
18359 and Stepping, ,Continuing and Stepping}) resumes execution until the
18360 selected stack frame returns naturally.
18361
18362 @value{GDBN} needs to know how the @var{expression} argument should be set for
18363 the inferior. The concrete registers assignment depends on the OS ABI and the
18364 type being returned by the selected stack frame. For example it is common for
18365 OS ABI to return floating point values in FPU registers while integer values in
18366 CPU registers. Still some ABIs return even floating point values in CPU
18367 registers. Larger integer widths (such as @code{long long int}) also have
18368 specific placement rules. @value{GDBN} already knows the OS ABI from its
18369 current target so it needs to find out also the type being returned to make the
18370 assignment into the right register(s).
18371
18372 Normally, the selected stack frame has debug info. @value{GDBN} will always
18373 use the debug info instead of the implicit type of @var{expression} when the
18374 debug info is available. For example, if you type @kbd{return -1}, and the
18375 function in the current stack frame is declared to return a @code{long long
18376 int}, @value{GDBN} transparently converts the implicit @code{int} value of -1
18377 into a @code{long long int}:
18378
18379 @smallexample
18380 Breakpoint 1, func () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:29
18381 29 return 31;
18382 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
18383 Make func return now? (y or n) y
18384 #0 0x004004f6 in main () at gdb.base/return-nodebug.c:43
18385 43 printf ("result=%lld\n", func ());
18386 (@value{GDBP})
18387 @end smallexample
18388
18389 However, if the selected stack frame does not have a debug info, e.g., if the
18390 function was compiled without debug info, @value{GDBN} has to find out the type
18391 to return from user. Specifying a different type by mistake may set the value
18392 in different inferior registers than the caller code expects. For example,
18393 typing @kbd{return -1} with its implicit type @code{int} would set only a part
18394 of a @code{long long int} result for a debug info less function (on 32-bit
18395 architectures). Therefore the user is required to specify the return type by
18396 an appropriate cast explicitly:
18397
18398 @smallexample
18399 Breakpoint 2, 0x0040050b in func ()
18400 (@value{GDBP}) return -1
18401 Return value type not available for selected stack frame.
18402 Please use an explicit cast of the value to return.
18403 (@value{GDBP}) return (long long int) -1
18404 Make selected stack frame return now? (y or n) y
18405 #0 0x00400526 in main ()
18406 (@value{GDBP})
18407 @end smallexample
18408
18409 @node Calling
18410 @section Calling Program Functions
18411
18412 @table @code
18413 @cindex calling functions
18414 @cindex inferior functions, calling
18415 @item print @var{expr}
18416 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} and display the resulting value.
18417 The expression may include calls to functions in the program being
18418 debugged.
18419
18420 @kindex call
18421 @item call @var{expr}
18422 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
18423 returned values.
18424
18425 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
18426 execute a function from your program that does not return anything
18427 (a.k.a.@: @dfn{a void function}), but without cluttering the output
18428 with @code{void} returned values that @value{GDBN} will otherwise
18429 print. If the result is not void, it is printed and saved in the
18430 value history.
18431 @end table
18432
18433 It is possible for the function you call via the @code{print} or
18434 @code{call} command to generate a signal (e.g., if there's a bug in
18435 the function, or if you passed it incorrect arguments). What happens
18436 in that case is controlled by the @code{set unwindonsignal} command.
18437
18438 Similarly, with a C@t{++} program it is possible for the function you
18439 call via the @code{print} or @code{call} command to generate an
18440 exception that is not handled due to the constraints of the dummy
18441 frame. In this case, any exception that is raised in the frame, but has
18442 an out-of-frame exception handler will not be found. GDB builds a
18443 dummy-frame for the inferior function call, and the unwinder cannot
18444 seek for exception handlers outside of this dummy-frame. What happens
18445 in that case is controlled by the
18446 @code{set unwind-on-terminating-exception} command.
18447
18448 @table @code
18449 @item set unwindonsignal
18450 @kindex set unwindonsignal
18451 @cindex unwind stack in called functions
18452 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding
18453 Set unwinding of the stack if a signal is received while in a function
18454 that @value{GDBN} called in the program being debugged. If set to on,
18455 @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack it created for the call and restores
18456 the context to what it was before the call. If set to off (the
18457 default), @value{GDBN} stops in the frame where the signal was
18458 received.
18459
18460 @item show unwindonsignal
18461 @kindex show unwindonsignal
18462 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
18463 @value{GDBN}.
18464
18465 @item set unwind-on-terminating-exception
18466 @kindex set unwind-on-terminating-exception
18467 @cindex unwind stack in called functions with unhandled exceptions
18468 @cindex call dummy stack unwinding on unhandled exception.
18469 Set unwinding of the stack if a C@t{++} exception is raised, but left
18470 unhandled while in a function that @value{GDBN} called in the program being
18471 debugged. If set to on (the default), @value{GDBN} unwinds the stack
18472 it created for the call and restores the context to what it was before
18473 the call. If set to off, @value{GDBN} the exception is delivered to
18474 the default C@t{++} exception handler and the inferior terminated.
18475
18476 @item show unwind-on-terminating-exception
18477 @kindex show unwind-on-terminating-exception
18478 Show the current setting of stack unwinding in the functions called by
18479 @value{GDBN}.
18480
18481 @end table
18482
18483 @subsection Calling functions with no debug info
18484
18485 @cindex no debug info functions
18486 Sometimes, a function you wish to call is missing debug information.
18487 In such case, @value{GDBN} does not know the type of the function,
18488 including the types of the function's parameters. To avoid calling
18489 the inferior function incorrectly, which could result in the called
18490 function functioning erroneously and even crash, @value{GDBN} refuses
18491 to call the function unless you tell it the type of the function.
18492
18493 For prototyped (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) functions, there are two ways
18494 to do that. The simplest is to cast the call to the function's
18495 declared return type. For example:
18496
18497 @smallexample
18498 (@value{GDBP}) p getenv ("PATH")
18499 'getenv' has unknown return type; cast the call to its declared return type
18500 (@value{GDBP}) p (char *) getenv ("PATH")
18501 $1 = 0x7fffffffe7ba "/usr/local/bin:/"...
18502 @end smallexample
18503
18504 Casting the return type of a no-debug function is equivalent to
18505 casting the function to a pointer to a prototyped function that has a
18506 prototype that matches the types of the passed-in arguments, and
18507 calling that. I.e., the call above is equivalent to:
18508
18509 @smallexample
18510 (@value{GDBP}) p ((char * (*) (const char *)) getenv) ("PATH")
18511 @end smallexample
18512
18513 @noindent
18514 and given this prototyped C or C++ function with float parameters:
18515
18516 @smallexample
18517 float multiply (float v1, float v2) @{ return v1 * v2; @}
18518 @end smallexample
18519
18520 @noindent
18521 these calls are equivalent:
18522
18523 @smallexample
18524 (@value{GDBP}) p (float) multiply (2.0f, 3.0f)
18525 (@value{GDBP}) p ((float (*) (float, float)) multiply) (2.0f, 3.0f)
18526 @end smallexample
18527
18528 If the function you wish to call is declared as unprototyped (i.e.@:
18529 old K&R style), you must use the cast-to-function-pointer syntax, so
18530 that @value{GDBN} knows that it needs to apply default argument
18531 promotions (promote float arguments to double). @xref{ABI, float
18532 promotion}. For example, given this unprototyped C function with
18533 float parameters, and no debug info:
18534
18535 @smallexample
18536 float
18537 multiply_noproto (v1, v2)
18538 float v1, v2;
18539 @{
18540 return v1 * v2;
18541 @}
18542 @end smallexample
18543
18544 @noindent
18545 you call it like this:
18546
18547 @smallexample
18548 (@value{GDBP}) p ((float (*) ()) multiply_noproto) (2.0f, 3.0f)
18549 @end smallexample
18550
18551 @node Patching
18552 @section Patching Programs
18553
18554 @cindex patching binaries
18555 @cindex writing into executables
18556 @cindex writing into corefiles
18557
18558 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
18559 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
18560 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
18561 patching your program's binary.
18562
18563 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
18564 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
18565 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
18566 repairs.
18567
18568 @table @code
18569 @kindex set write
18570 @item set write on
18571 @itemx set write off
18572 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
18573 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @kbd{set write
18574 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
18575
18576 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
18577 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
18578 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
18579
18580 @item show write
18581 @kindex show write
18582 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
18583 as well as reading.
18584 @end table
18585
18586 @node Compiling and Injecting Code
18587 @section Compiling and injecting code in @value{GDBN}
18588 @cindex injecting code
18589 @cindex writing into executables
18590 @cindex compiling code
18591
18592 @value{GDBN} supports on-demand compilation and code injection into
18593 programs running under @value{GDBN}. GCC 5.0 or higher built with
18594 @file{libcc1.so} must be installed for this functionality to be enabled.
18595 This functionality is implemented with the following commands.
18596
18597 @table @code
18598 @kindex compile code
18599 @item compile code @var{source-code}
18600 @itemx compile code -raw @var{--} @var{source-code}
18601 Compile @var{source-code} with the compiler language found as the current
18602 language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). If compilation and
18603 injection is not supported with the current language specified in
18604 @value{GDBN}, or the compiler does not support this feature, an error
18605 message will be printed. If @var{source-code} compiles and links
18606 successfully, @value{GDBN} will load the object-code emitted,
18607 and execute it within the context of the currently selected inferior.
18608 It is important to note that the compiled code is executed immediately.
18609 After execution, the compiled code is removed from @value{GDBN} and any
18610 new types or variables you have defined will be deleted.
18611
18612 The command allows you to specify @var{source-code} in two ways.
18613 The simplest method is to provide a single line of code to the command.
18614 E.g.:
18615
18616 @smallexample
18617 compile code printf ("hello world\n");
18618 @end smallexample
18619
18620 If you specify options on the command line as well as source code, they
18621 may conflict. The @samp{--} delimiter can be used to separate options
18622 from actual source code. E.g.:
18623
18624 @smallexample
18625 compile code -r -- printf ("hello world\n");
18626 @end smallexample
18627
18628 Alternatively you can enter source code as multiple lines of text. To
18629 enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile code} command without any text
18630 following the command. This will start the multiple-line editor and
18631 allow you to type as many lines of source code as required. When you
18632 have completed typing, enter @samp{end} on its own line to exit the
18633 editor.
18634
18635 @smallexample
18636 compile code
18637 >printf ("hello\n");
18638 >printf ("world\n");
18639 >end
18640 @end smallexample
18641
18642 Specifying @samp{-raw}, prohibits @value{GDBN} from wrapping the
18643 provided @var{source-code} in a callable scope. In this case, you must
18644 specify the entry point of the code by defining a function named
18645 @code{_gdb_expr_}. The @samp{-raw} code cannot access variables of the
18646 inferior. Using @samp{-raw} option may be needed for example when
18647 @var{source-code} requires @samp{#include} lines which may conflict with
18648 inferior symbols otherwise.
18649
18650 @kindex compile file
18651 @item compile file @var{filename}
18652 @itemx compile file -raw @var{filename}
18653 Like @code{compile code}, but take the source code from @var{filename}.
18654
18655 @smallexample
18656 compile file /home/user/example.c
18657 @end smallexample
18658 @end table
18659
18660 @table @code
18661 @item compile print @var{expr}
18662 @itemx compile print /@var{f} @var{expr}
18663 Compile and execute @var{expr} with the compiler language found as the
18664 current language in @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Languages}). By default the
18665 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
18666 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
18667 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
18668 Formats}.
18669
18670 @item compile print
18671 @itemx compile print /@var{f}
18672 @cindex reprint the last value
18673 Alternatively you can enter the expression (source code producing it) as
18674 multiple lines of text. To enter this mode, invoke the @samp{compile print}
18675 command without any text following the command. This will start the
18676 multiple-line editor.
18677 @end table
18678
18679 @noindent
18680 The process of compiling and injecting the code can be inspected using:
18681
18682 @table @code
18683 @anchor{set debug compile}
18684 @item set debug compile
18685 @cindex compile command debugging info
18686 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} process of compiling and
18687 injecting the code. The default is off.
18688
18689 @item show debug compile
18690 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} process of
18691 compiling and injecting the code.
18692 @end table
18693
18694 @subsection Compilation options for the @code{compile} command
18695
18696 @value{GDBN} needs to specify the right compilation options for the code
18697 to be injected, in part to make its ABI compatible with the inferior
18698 and in part to make the injected code compatible with @value{GDBN}'s
18699 injecting process.
18700
18701 @noindent
18702 The options used, in increasing precedence:
18703
18704 @table @asis
18705 @item target architecture and OS options (@code{gdbarch})
18706 These options depend on target processor type and target operating
18707 system, usually they specify at least 32-bit (@code{-m32}) or 64-bit
18708 (@code{-m64}) compilation option.
18709
18710 @item compilation options recorded in the target
18711 @value{NGCC} (since version 4.7) stores the options used for compilation
18712 into @code{DW_AT_producer} part of DWARF debugging information according
18713 to the @value{NGCC} option @code{-grecord-gcc-switches}. One has to
18714 explicitly specify @code{-g} during inferior compilation otherwise
18715 @value{NGCC} produces no DWARF. This feature is only relevant for
18716 platforms where @code{-g} produces DWARF by default, otherwise one may
18717 try to enforce DWARF by using @code{-gdwarf-4}.
18718
18719 @item compilation options set by @code{set compile-args}
18720 @end table
18721
18722 @noindent
18723 You can override compilation options using the following command:
18724
18725 @table @code
18726 @item set compile-args
18727 @cindex compile command options override
18728 Set compilation options used for compiling and injecting code with the
18729 @code{compile} commands. These options override any conflicting ones
18730 from the target architecture and/or options stored during inferior
18731 compilation.
18732
18733 @item show compile-args
18734 Displays the current state of compilation options override.
18735 This does not show all the options actually used during compilation,
18736 use @ref{set debug compile} for that.
18737 @end table
18738
18739 @subsection Caveats when using the @code{compile} command
18740
18741 There are a few caveats to keep in mind when using the @code{compile}
18742 command. As the caveats are different per language, the table below
18743 highlights specific issues on a per language basis.
18744
18745 @table @asis
18746 @item C code examples and caveats
18747 When the language in @value{GDBN} is set to @samp{C}, the compiler will
18748 attempt to compile the source code with a @samp{C} compiler. The source
18749 code provided to the @code{compile} command will have much the same
18750 access to variables and types as it normally would if it were part of
18751 the program currently being debugged in @value{GDBN}.
18752
18753 Below is a sample program that forms the basis of the examples that
18754 follow. This program has been compiled and loaded into @value{GDBN},
18755 much like any other normal debugging session.
18756
18757 @smallexample
18758 void function1 (void)
18759 @{
18760 int i = 42;
18761 printf ("function 1\n");
18762 @}
18763
18764 void function2 (void)
18765 @{
18766 int j = 12;
18767 function1 ();
18768 @}
18769
18770 int main(void)
18771 @{
18772 int k = 6;
18773 int *p;
18774 function2 ();
18775 return 0;
18776 @}
18777 @end smallexample
18778
18779 For the purposes of the examples in this section, the program above has
18780 been compiled, loaded into @value{GDBN}, stopped at the function
18781 @code{main}, and @value{GDBN} is awaiting input from the user.
18782
18783 To access variables and types for any program in @value{GDBN}, the
18784 program must be compiled and packaged with debug information. The
18785 @code{compile} command is not an exception to this rule. Without debug
18786 information, you can still use the @code{compile} command, but you will
18787 be very limited in what variables and types you can access.
18788
18789 So with that in mind, the example above has been compiled with debug
18790 information enabled. The @code{compile} command will have access to
18791 all variables and types (except those that may have been optimized
18792 out). Currently, as @value{GDBN} has stopped the program in the
18793 @code{main} function, the @code{compile} command would have access to
18794 the variable @code{k}. You could invoke the @code{compile} command
18795 and type some source code to set the value of @code{k}. You can also
18796 read it, or do anything with that variable you would normally do in
18797 @code{C}. Be aware that changes to inferior variables in the
18798 @code{compile} command are persistent. In the following example:
18799
18800 @smallexample
18801 compile code k = 3;
18802 @end smallexample
18803
18804 @noindent
18805 the variable @code{k} is now 3. It will retain that value until
18806 something else in the example program changes it, or another
18807 @code{compile} command changes it.
18808
18809 Normal scope and access rules apply to source code compiled and
18810 injected by the @code{compile} command. In the example, the variables
18811 @code{j} and @code{k} are not accessible yet, because the program is
18812 currently stopped in the @code{main} function, where these variables
18813 are not in scope. Therefore, the following command
18814
18815 @smallexample
18816 compile code j = 3;
18817 @end smallexample
18818
18819 @noindent
18820 will result in a compilation error message.
18821
18822 Once the program is continued, execution will bring these variables in
18823 scope, and they will become accessible; then the code you specify via
18824 the @code{compile} command will be able to access them.
18825
18826 You can create variables and types with the @code{compile} command as
18827 part of your source code. Variables and types that are created as part
18828 of the @code{compile} command are not visible to the rest of the program for
18829 the duration of its run. This example is valid:
18830
18831 @smallexample
18832 compile code int ff = 5; printf ("ff is %d\n", ff);
18833 @end smallexample
18834
18835 However, if you were to type the following into @value{GDBN} after that
18836 command has completed:
18837
18838 @smallexample
18839 compile code printf ("ff is %d\n'', ff);
18840 @end smallexample
18841
18842 @noindent
18843 a compiler error would be raised as the variable @code{ff} no longer
18844 exists. Object code generated and injected by the @code{compile}
18845 command is removed when its execution ends. Caution is advised
18846 when assigning to program variables values of variables created by the
18847 code submitted to the @code{compile} command. This example is valid:
18848
18849 @smallexample
18850 compile code int ff = 5; k = ff;
18851 @end smallexample
18852
18853 The value of the variable @code{ff} is assigned to @code{k}. The variable
18854 @code{k} does not require the existence of @code{ff} to maintain the value
18855 it has been assigned. However, pointers require particular care in
18856 assignment. If the source code compiled with the @code{compile} command
18857 changed the address of a pointer in the example program, perhaps to a
18858 variable created in the @code{compile} command, that pointer would point
18859 to an invalid location when the command exits. The following example
18860 would likely cause issues with your debugged program:
18861
18862 @smallexample
18863 compile code int ff = 5; p = &ff;
18864 @end smallexample
18865
18866 In this example, @code{p} would point to @code{ff} when the
18867 @code{compile} command is executing the source code provided to it.
18868 However, as variables in the (example) program persist with their
18869 assigned values, the variable @code{p} would point to an invalid
18870 location when the command exists. A general rule should be followed
18871 in that you should either assign @code{NULL} to any assigned pointers,
18872 or restore a valid location to the pointer before the command exits.
18873
18874 Similar caution must be exercised with any structs, unions, and typedefs
18875 defined in @code{compile} command. Types defined in the @code{compile}
18876 command will no longer be available in the next @code{compile} command.
18877 Therefore, if you cast a variable to a type defined in the
18878 @code{compile} command, care must be taken to ensure that any future
18879 need to resolve the type can be achieved.
18880
18881 @smallexample
18882 (gdb) compile code static struct a @{ int a; @} v = @{ 42 @}; argv = &v;
18883 (gdb) compile code printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
18884 gdb command line:1:36: error: dereferencing pointer to incomplete type ‘struct a’
18885 Compilation failed.
18886 (gdb) compile code struct a @{ int a; @}; printf ("%d\n", ((struct a *) argv)->a);
18887 42
18888 @end smallexample
18889
18890 Variables that have been optimized away by the compiler are not
18891 accessible to the code submitted to the @code{compile} command.
18892 Access to those variables will generate a compiler error which @value{GDBN}
18893 will print to the console.
18894 @end table
18895
18896 @subsection Compiler search for the @code{compile} command
18897
18898 @value{GDBN} needs to find @value{NGCC} for the inferior being debugged
18899 which may not be obvious for remote targets of different architecture
18900 than where @value{GDBN} is running. Environment variable @code{PATH} on
18901 @value{GDBN} host is searched for @value{NGCC} binary matching the
18902 target architecture and operating system. This search can be overriden
18903 by @code{set compile-gcc} @value{GDBN} command below. @code{PATH} is
18904 taken from shell that executed @value{GDBN}, it is not the value set by
18905 @value{GDBN} command @code{set environment}). @xref{Environment}.
18906
18907
18908 Specifically @code{PATH} is searched for binaries matching regular expression
18909 @code{@var{arch}(-[^-]*)?-@var{os}-gcc} according to the inferior target being
18910 debugged. @var{arch} is processor name --- multiarch is supported, so for
18911 example both @code{i386} and @code{x86_64} targets look for pattern
18912 @code{(x86_64|i.86)} and both @code{s390} and @code{s390x} targets look
18913 for pattern @code{s390x?}. @var{os} is currently supported only for
18914 pattern @code{linux(-gnu)?}.
18915
18916 On Posix hosts the compiler driver @value{GDBN} needs to find also
18917 shared library @file{libcc1.so} from the compiler. It is searched in
18918 default shared library search path (overridable with usual environment
18919 variable @code{LD_LIBRARY_PATH}), unrelated to @code{PATH} or @code{set
18920 compile-gcc} settings. Contrary to it @file{libcc1plugin.so} is found
18921 according to the installation of the found compiler --- as possibly
18922 specified by the @code{set compile-gcc} command.
18923
18924 @table @code
18925 @item set compile-gcc
18926 @cindex compile command driver filename override
18927 Set compilation command used for compiling and injecting code with the
18928 @code{compile} commands. If this option is not set (it is set to
18929 an empty string), the search described above will occur --- that is the
18930 default.
18931
18932 @item show compile-gcc
18933 Displays the current compile command @value{NGCC} driver filename.
18934 If set, it is the main command @command{gcc}, found usually for example
18935 under name @file{x86_64-linux-gnu-gcc}.
18936 @end table
18937
18938 @node GDB Files
18939 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
18940
18941 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
18942 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
18943 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
18944 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
18945
18946 @menu
18947 * Files:: Commands to specify files
18948 * File Caching:: Information about @value{GDBN}'s file caching
18949 * Separate Debug Files:: Debugging information in separate files
18950 * MiniDebugInfo:: Debugging information in a special section
18951 * Index Files:: Index files speed up GDB
18952 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
18953 * Data Files:: GDB data files
18954 @end menu
18955
18956 @node Files
18957 @section Commands to Specify Files
18958
18959 @cindex symbol table
18960 @cindex core dump file
18961
18962 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
18963 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
18964 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
18965 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
18966
18967 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
18968 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to
18969 specify a file you want to use. Or you are debugging a remote target
18970 via @code{gdbserver} (@pxref{Server, file, Using the @code{gdbserver}
18971 Program}). In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands to specify
18972 new files are useful.
18973
18974 @table @code
18975 @cindex executable file
18976 @kindex file
18977 @item file @var{filename}
18978 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
18979 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
18980 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
18981 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
18982 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
18983 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
18984 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
18985 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
18986
18987 @cindex unlinked object files
18988 @cindex patching object files
18989 You can load unlinked object @file{.o} files into @value{GDBN} using
18990 the @code{file} command. You will not be able to ``run'' an object
18991 file, but you can disassemble functions and inspect variables. Also,
18992 if the underlying BFD functionality supports it, you could use
18993 @kbd{gdb -write} to patch object files using this technique. Note
18994 that @value{GDBN} can neither interpret nor modify relocations in this
18995 case, so branches and some initialized variables will appear to go to
18996 the wrong place. But this feature is still handy from time to time.
18997
18998 @item file
18999 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
19000 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
19001
19002 @kindex exec-file
19003 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
19004 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
19005 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
19006 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
19007 discard information on the executable file.
19008
19009 @kindex symbol-file
19010 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{[} -o @var{offset} @r{]]}
19011 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
19012 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
19013 table and program to run from the same file.
19014
19015 If an optional @var{offset} is specified, it is added to the start
19016 address of each section in the symbol file. This is useful if the
19017 program is relocated at runtime, such as the Linux kernel with kASLR
19018 enabled.
19019
19020 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
19021 program's symbol table.
19022
19023 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents of
19024 some breakpoints and auto-display expressions. This is because they may
19025 contain pointers to the internal data recording symbols and data types,
19026 which are part of the old symbol table data being discarded inside
19027 @value{GDBN}.
19028
19029 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
19030 executing it once.
19031
19032 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
19033 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
19034 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
19035 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
19036 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
19037 using @code{@value{NGCC}} you can generate debugging information for
19038 optimized code.
19039
19040 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
19041 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
19042 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
19043 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
19044 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
19045
19046 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
19047 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
19048 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
19049 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
19050 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
19051 Warnings and Messages}.)
19052
19053 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
19054 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
19055 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
19056 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
19057 in stabs format.
19058
19059 @kindex readnow
19060 @cindex reading symbols immediately
19061 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
19062 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
19063 @itemx file @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @var{filename}
19064 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
19065 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
19066 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
19067 entire symbol table available.
19068
19069 @cindex @code{-readnever}, option for symbol-file command
19070 @cindex never read symbols
19071 @cindex symbols, never read
19072 @item symbol-file @r{[} -readnever @r{]} @var{filename}
19073 @itemx file @r{[} -readnever @r{]} @var{filename}
19074 You can instruct @value{GDBN} to never read the symbolic information
19075 contained in @var{filename} by using the @samp{-readnever} option.
19076 @xref{--readnever}.
19077
19078 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
19079 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
19080 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
19081 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
19082 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
19083 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
19084 @c files.
19085
19086 @kindex core-file
19087 @item core-file @r{[}@var{filename}@r{]}
19088 @itemx core
19089 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
19090 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
19091 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
19092 executable file itself for other parts.
19093
19094 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
19095 to be used.
19096
19097 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
19098 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
19099 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
19100 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
19101 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the Child Process}).
19102
19103 @kindex add-symbol-file
19104 @cindex dynamic linking
19105 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{|} -readnever @r{]} @r{[} -o @var{offset} @r{]} @r{[} @var{textaddress} @r{]} @r{[} -s @var{section} @var{address} @dots{} @r{]}
19106 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
19107 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
19108 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
19109 into the program that is running. The @var{textaddress} parameter gives
19110 the memory address at which the file's text section has been loaded.
19111 You can additionally specify the base address of other sections using
19112 an arbitrary number of @samp{-s @var{section} @var{address}} pairs.
19113 If a section is omitted, @value{GDBN} will use its default addresses
19114 as found in @var{filename}. Any @var{address} or @var{textaddress}
19115 can be given as an expression.
19116
19117 If an optional @var{offset} is specified, it is added to the start
19118 address of each section, except those for which the address was
19119 specified explicitly.
19120
19121 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
19122 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
19123 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
19124 thus read is kept in addition to the old.
19125
19126 Changes can be reverted using the command @code{remove-symbol-file}.
19127
19128 @cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
19129 @cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
19130 @cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
19131 @cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
19132 @cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
19133 Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
19134 executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
19135 relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
19136 information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
19137
19138 @itemize @bullet
19139 @item
19140 the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
19141 that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
19142 @item
19143 every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
19144 been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
19145 @item
19146 you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
19147 provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
19148 @end itemize
19149
19150 @noindent
19151 Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
19152 relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
19153 typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
19154 important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
19155 procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C@t{++} constructor table
19156 assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
19157 general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
19158 relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
19159 as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
19160 way.
19161
19162 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
19163
19164 @kindex remove-symbol-file
19165 @item remove-symbol-file @var{filename}
19166 @item remove-symbol-file -a @var{address}
19167 Remove a symbol file added via the @code{add-symbol-file} command. The
19168 file to remove can be identified by its @var{filename} or by an @var{address}
19169 that lies within the boundaries of this symbol file in memory. Example:
19170
19171 @smallexample
19172 (gdb) add-symbol-file /home/user/gdb/mylib.so 0x7ffff7ff9480
19173 add symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so" at
19174 .text_addr = 0x7ffff7ff9480
19175 (y or n) y
19176 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/mylib.so...done.
19177 (gdb) remove-symbol-file -a 0x7ffff7ff9480
19178 Remove symbol table from file "/home/user/gdb/mylib.so"? (y or n) y
19179 (gdb)
19180 @end smallexample
19181
19182
19183 @code{remove-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
19184
19185 @kindex add-symbol-file-from-memory
19186 @cindex @code{syscall DSO}
19187 @cindex load symbols from memory
19188 @item add-symbol-file-from-memory @var{address}
19189 Load symbols from the given @var{address} in a dynamically loaded
19190 object file whose image is mapped directly into the inferior's memory.
19191 For example, the Linux kernel maps a @code{syscall DSO} into each
19192 process's address space; this DSO provides kernel-specific code for
19193 some system calls. The argument can be any expression whose
19194 evaluation yields the address of the file's shared object file header.
19195 For this command to work, you must have used @code{symbol-file} or
19196 @code{exec-file} commands in advance.
19197
19198 @kindex section
19199 @item section @var{section} @var{addr}
19200 The @code{section} command changes the base address of the named
19201 @var{section} of the exec file to @var{addr}. This can be used if the
19202 exec file does not contain section addresses, (such as in the
19203 @code{a.out} format), or when the addresses specified in the file
19204 itself are wrong. Each section must be changed separately. The
19205 @code{info files} command, described below, lists all the sections and
19206 their addresses.
19207
19208 @kindex info files
19209 @kindex info target
19210 @item info files
19211 @itemx info target
19212 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
19213 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
19214 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
19215 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
19216 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
19217 current ones.
19218
19219 @kindex maint info sections
19220 @item maint info sections
19221 Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
19222 is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
19223 displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
19224 offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
19225 @code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
19226 may be arbitrarily combined):
19227
19228 @table @code
19229 @item ALLOBJ
19230 Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
19231 @item @var{sections}
19232 Display info only for named @var{sections}.
19233 @item @var{section-flags}
19234 Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
19235 The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
19236 @table @code
19237 @item ALLOC
19238 Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
19239 Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
19240 @item LOAD
19241 Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
19242 Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
19243 @item RELOC
19244 Section needs to be relocated before loading.
19245 @item READONLY
19246 Section cannot be modified by the child process.
19247 @item CODE
19248 Section contains executable code only.
19249 @item DATA
19250 Section contains data only (no executable code).
19251 @item ROM
19252 Section will reside in ROM.
19253 @item CONSTRUCTOR
19254 Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
19255 @item HAS_CONTENTS
19256 Section is not empty.
19257 @item NEVER_LOAD
19258 An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
19259 @item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
19260 A notification to the linker that the section contains
19261 COFF shared library information.
19262 @item IS_COMMON
19263 Section contains common symbols.
19264 @end table
19265 @end table
19266 @kindex set trust-readonly-sections
19267 @cindex read-only sections
19268 @item set trust-readonly-sections on
19269 Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
19270 really are read-only (i.e.@: that their contents will not change).
19271 In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
19272 out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
19273 For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
19274 enhancement to debugging performance.
19275
19276 The default is off.
19277
19278 @item set trust-readonly-sections off
19279 Tell @value{GDBN} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
19280 the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
19281 and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
19282
19283 @item show trust-readonly-sections
19284 Show the current setting of trusting readonly sections.
19285 @end table
19286
19287 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
19288 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
19289 name and remembers it that way.
19290
19291 @cindex shared libraries
19292 @anchor{Shared Libraries}
19293 @value{GDBN} supports @sc{gnu}/Linux, MS-Windows, SunOS,
19294 Darwin/Mach-O, SVr4, IBM RS/6000 AIX, QNX Neutrino, FDPIC (FR-V), and
19295 DSBT (TIC6X) shared libraries.
19296
19297 On MS-Windows @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support
19298 shared libraries. @xref{Expat}.
19299
19300 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
19301 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
19302 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
19303 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
19304 debugging a core file).
19305
19306 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
19307 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
19308 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
19309
19310 There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
19311 symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
19312 particularly large or there are many of them.
19313
19314 To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
19315 commands:
19316
19317 @table @code
19318 @kindex set auto-solib-add
19319 @item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
19320 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
19321 will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
19322 attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
19323 informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
19324 is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
19325 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
19326
19327 @cindex memory used for symbol tables
19328 If your program uses lots of shared libraries with debug info that
19329 takes large amounts of memory, you can decrease the @value{GDBN}
19330 memory footprint by preventing it from automatically loading the
19331 symbols from shared libraries. To that end, type @kbd{set
19332 auto-solib-add off} before running the inferior, then load each
19333 library whose debug symbols you do need with @kbd{sharedlibrary
19334 @var{regexp}}, where @var{regexp} is a regular expression that matches
19335 the libraries whose symbols you want to be loaded.
19336
19337 @kindex show auto-solib-add
19338 @item show auto-solib-add
19339 Display the current autoloading mode.
19340 @end table
19341
19342 @cindex load shared library
19343 To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
19344 command:
19345
19346 @table @code
19347 @kindex info sharedlibrary
19348 @kindex info share
19349 @item info share @var{regex}
19350 @itemx info sharedlibrary @var{regex}
19351 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded
19352 that match @var{regex}. If @var{regex} is omitted then print
19353 all shared libraries that are loaded.
19354
19355 @kindex info dll
19356 @item info dll @var{regex}
19357 This is an alias of @code{info sharedlibrary}.
19358
19359 @kindex sharedlibrary
19360 @kindex share
19361 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
19362 @itemx share @var{regex}
19363 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
19364 Unix regular expression.
19365 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
19366 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
19367 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
19368 loaded.
19369
19370 @item nosharedlibrary
19371 @kindex nosharedlibrary
19372 @cindex unload symbols from shared libraries
19373 Unload all shared object library symbols. This discards all symbols
19374 that have been loaded from all shared libraries. Symbols from shared
19375 libraries that were loaded by explicit user requests are not
19376 discarded.
19377 @end table
19378
19379 Sometimes you may wish that @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control
19380 when any of shared library events happen. The best way to do this is
19381 to use @code{catch load} and @code{catch unload} (@pxref{Set
19382 Catchpoints}).
19383
19384 @value{GDBN} also supports the the @code{set stop-on-solib-events}
19385 command for this. This command exists for historical reasons. It is
19386 less useful than setting a catchpoint, because it does not allow for
19387 conditions or commands as a catchpoint does.
19388
19389 @table @code
19390 @item set stop-on-solib-events
19391 @kindex set stop-on-solib-events
19392 This command controls whether @value{GDBN} should give you control
19393 when the dynamic linker notifies it about some shared library event.
19394 The most common event of interest is loading or unloading of a new
19395 shared library.
19396
19397 @item show stop-on-solib-events
19398 @kindex show stop-on-solib-events
19399 Show whether @value{GDBN} stops and gives you control when shared
19400 library events happen.
19401 @end table
19402
19403 Shared libraries are also supported in many cross or remote debugging
19404 configurations. @value{GDBN} needs to have access to the target's libraries;
19405 this can be accomplished either by providing copies of the libraries
19406 on the host system, or by asking @value{GDBN} to automatically retrieve the
19407 libraries from the target. If copies of the target libraries are
19408 provided, they need to be the same as the target libraries, although the
19409 copies on the target can be stripped as long as the copies on the host are
19410 not.
19411
19412 @cindex where to look for shared libraries
19413 For remote debugging, you need to tell @value{GDBN} where the target
19414 libraries are, so that it can load the correct copies---otherwise, it
19415 may try to load the host's libraries. @value{GDBN} has two variables
19416 to specify the search directories for target libraries.
19417
19418 @table @code
19419 @cindex prefix for executable and shared library file names
19420 @cindex system root, alternate
19421 @kindex set solib-absolute-prefix
19422 @kindex set sysroot
19423 @item set sysroot @var{path}
19424 Use @var{path} as the system root for the program being debugged. Any
19425 absolute shared library paths will be prefixed with @var{path}; many
19426 runtime loaders store the absolute paths to the shared library in the
19427 target program's memory. When starting processes remotely, and when
19428 attaching to already-running processes (local or remote), their
19429 executable filenames will be prefixed with @var{path} if reported to
19430 @value{GDBN} as absolute by the operating system. If you use
19431 @code{set sysroot} to find executables and shared libraries, they need
19432 to be laid out in the same way that they are on the target, with
19433 e.g.@: a @file{/bin}, @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib} hierarchy under
19434 @var{path}.
19435
19436 If @var{path} starts with the sequence @file{target:} and the target
19437 system is remote then @value{GDBN} will retrieve the target binaries
19438 from the remote system. This is only supported when using a remote
19439 target that supports the @code{remote get} command (@pxref{File
19440 Transfer,,Sending files to a remote system}). The part of @var{path}
19441 following the initial @file{target:} (if present) is used as system
19442 root prefix on the remote file system. If @var{path} starts with the
19443 sequence @file{remote:} this is converted to the sequence
19444 @file{target:} by @code{set sysroot}@footnote{Historically the
19445 functionality to retrieve binaries from the remote system was
19446 provided by prefixing @var{path} with @file{remote:}}. If you want
19447 to specify a local system root using a directory that happens to be
19448 named @file{target:} or @file{remote:}, you need to use some
19449 equivalent variant of the name like @file{./target:}.
19450
19451 For targets with an MS-DOS based filesystem, such as MS-Windows and
19452 SymbianOS, @value{GDBN} tries prefixing a few variants of the target
19453 absolute file name with @var{path}. But first, on Unix hosts,
19454 @value{GDBN} converts all backslash directory separators into forward
19455 slashes, because the backslash is not a directory separator on Unix:
19456
19457 @smallexample
19458 c:\foo\bar.dll @result{} c:/foo/bar.dll
19459 @end smallexample
19460
19461 Then, @value{GDBN} attempts prefixing the target file name with
19462 @var{path}, and looks for the resulting file name in the host file
19463 system:
19464
19465 @smallexample
19466 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c:/foo/bar.dll
19467 @end smallexample
19468
19469 If that does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries removing
19470 the @samp{:} character from the drive spec, both for convenience, and,
19471 for the case of the host file system not supporting file names with
19472 colons:
19473
19474 @smallexample
19475 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/c/foo/bar.dll
19476 @end smallexample
19477
19478 This makes it possible to have a system root that mirrors a target
19479 with more than one drive. E.g., you may want to setup your local
19480 copies of the target system shared libraries like so (note @samp{c} vs
19481 @samp{z}):
19482
19483 @smallexample
19484 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/foo.dll}
19485 @file{/path/to/sysroot/c/sys/bin/bar.dll}
19486 @file{/path/to/sysroot/z/sys/bin/bar.dll}
19487 @end smallexample
19488
19489 @noindent
19490 and point the system root at @file{/path/to/sysroot}, so that
19491 @value{GDBN} can find the correct copies of both
19492 @file{c:\sys\bin\foo.dll}, and @file{z:\sys\bin\bar.dll}.
19493
19494 If that still does not find the binary, @value{GDBN} tries
19495 removing the whole drive spec from the target file name:
19496
19497 @smallexample
19498 c:/foo/bar.dll @result{} /path/to/sysroot/foo/bar.dll
19499 @end smallexample
19500
19501 This last lookup makes it possible to not care about the drive name,
19502 if you don't want or need to.
19503
19504 The @code{set solib-absolute-prefix} command is an alias for @code{set
19505 sysroot}.
19506
19507 @cindex default system root
19508 @cindex @samp{--with-sysroot}
19509 You can set the default system root by using the configure-time
19510 @samp{--with-sysroot} option. If the system root is inside
19511 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
19512 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default system root will be updated
19513 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
19514 location.
19515
19516 @kindex show sysroot
19517 @item show sysroot
19518 Display the current executable and shared library prefix.
19519
19520 @kindex set solib-search-path
19521 @item set solib-search-path @var{path}
19522 If this variable is set, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
19523 directories to search for shared libraries. @samp{solib-search-path}
19524 is used after @samp{sysroot} fails to locate the library, or if the
19525 path to the library is relative instead of absolute. If you want to
19526 use @samp{solib-search-path} instead of @samp{sysroot}, be sure to set
19527 @samp{sysroot} to a nonexistent directory to prevent @value{GDBN} from
19528 finding your host's libraries. @samp{sysroot} is preferred; setting
19529 it to a nonexistent directory may interfere with automatic loading
19530 of shared library symbols.
19531
19532 @kindex show solib-search-path
19533 @item show solib-search-path
19534 Display the current shared library search path.
19535
19536 @cindex DOS file-name semantics of file names.
19537 @kindex set target-file-system-kind (unix|dos-based|auto)
19538 @kindex show target-file-system-kind
19539 @item set target-file-system-kind @var{kind}
19540 Set assumed file system kind for target reported file names.
19541
19542 Shared library file names as reported by the target system may not
19543 make sense as is on the system @value{GDBN} is running on. For
19544 example, when remote debugging a target that has MS-DOS based file
19545 system semantics, from a Unix host, the target may be reporting to
19546 @value{GDBN} a list of loaded shared libraries with file names such as
19547 @file{c:\Windows\kernel32.dll}. On Unix hosts, there's no concept of
19548 drive letters, so the @samp{c:\} prefix is not normally understood as
19549 indicating an absolute file name, and neither is the backslash
19550 normally considered a directory separator character. In that case,
19551 the native file system would interpret this whole absolute file name
19552 as a relative file name with no directory components. This would make
19553 it impossible to point @value{GDBN} at a copy of the remote target's
19554 shared libraries on the host using @code{set sysroot}, and impractical
19555 with @code{set solib-search-path}. Setting
19556 @code{target-file-system-kind} to @code{dos-based} tells @value{GDBN}
19557 to interpret such file names similarly to how the target would, and to
19558 map them to file names valid on @value{GDBN}'s native file system
19559 semantics. The value of @var{kind} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition
19560 to one of the supported file system kinds. In that case, @value{GDBN}
19561 tries to determine the appropriate file system variant based on the
19562 current target's operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the
19563 Current ABI}). The supported file system settings are:
19564
19565 @table @code
19566 @item unix
19567 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is of Unix
19568 kind. Only file names starting the forward slash (@samp{/}) character
19569 are considered absolute, and the directory separator character is also
19570 the forward slash.
19571
19572 @item dos-based
19573 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target file system is DOS based.
19574 File names starting with either a forward slash, or a drive letter
19575 followed by a colon (e.g., @samp{c:}), are considered absolute, and
19576 both the slash (@samp{/}) and the backslash (@samp{\\}) characters are
19577 considered directory separators.
19578
19579 @item auto
19580 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the file system kind associated with the
19581 target operating system (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
19582 This is the default.
19583 @end table
19584 @end table
19585
19586 @cindex file name canonicalization
19587 @cindex base name differences
19588 When processing file names provided by the user, @value{GDBN}
19589 frequently needs to compare them to the file names recorded in the
19590 program's debug info. Normally, @value{GDBN} compares just the
19591 @dfn{base names} of the files as strings, which is reasonably fast
19592 even for very large programs. (The base name of a file is the last
19593 portion of its name, after stripping all the leading directories.)
19594 This shortcut in comparison is based upon the assumption that files
19595 cannot have more than one base name. This is usually true, but
19596 references to files that use symlinks or similar filesystem
19597 facilities violate that assumption. If your program records files
19598 using such facilities, or if you provide file names to @value{GDBN}
19599 using symlinks etc., you can set @code{basenames-may-differ} to
19600 @code{true} to instruct @value{GDBN} to completely canonicalize each
19601 pair of file names it needs to compare. This will make file-name
19602 comparisons accurate, but at a price of a significant slowdown.
19603
19604 @table @code
19605 @item set basenames-may-differ
19606 @kindex set basenames-may-differ
19607 Set whether a source file may have multiple base names.
19608
19609 @item show basenames-may-differ
19610 @kindex show basenames-may-differ
19611 Show whether a source file may have multiple base names.
19612 @end table
19613
19614 @node File Caching
19615 @section File Caching
19616 @cindex caching of opened files
19617 @cindex caching of bfd objects
19618
19619 To speed up file loading, and reduce memory usage, @value{GDBN} will
19620 reuse the @code{bfd} objects used to track open files. @xref{Top, ,
19621 BFD, bfd, The Binary File Descriptor Library}. The following commands
19622 allow visibility and control of the caching behavior.
19623
19624 @table @code
19625 @kindex maint info bfds
19626 @item maint info bfds
19627 This prints information about each @code{bfd} object that is known to
19628 @value{GDBN}.
19629
19630 @kindex maint set bfd-sharing
19631 @kindex maint show bfd-sharing
19632 @kindex bfd caching
19633 @item maint set bfd-sharing
19634 @item maint show bfd-sharing
19635 Control whether @code{bfd} objects can be shared. When sharing is
19636 enabled @value{GDBN} reuses already open @code{bfd} objects rather
19637 than reopening the same file. Turning sharing off does not cause
19638 already shared @code{bfd} objects to be unshared, but all future files
19639 that are opened will create a new @code{bfd} object. Similarly,
19640 re-enabling sharing does not cause multiple existing @code{bfd}
19641 objects to be collapsed into a single shared @code{bfd} object.
19642
19643 @kindex set debug bfd-cache @var{level}
19644 @kindex bfd caching
19645 @item set debug bfd-cache @var{level}
19646 Turns on debugging of the bfd cache, setting the level to @var{level}.
19647
19648 @kindex show debug bfd-cache
19649 @kindex bfd caching
19650 @item show debug bfd-cache
19651 Show the current debugging level of the bfd cache.
19652 @end table
19653
19654 @node Separate Debug Files
19655 @section Debugging Information in Separate Files
19656 @cindex separate debugging information files
19657 @cindex debugging information in separate files
19658 @cindex @file{.debug} subdirectories
19659 @cindex debugging information directory, global
19660 @cindex global debugging information directories
19661 @cindex build ID, and separate debugging files
19662 @cindex @file{.build-id} directory
19663
19664 @value{GDBN} allows you to put a program's debugging information in a
19665 file separate from the executable itself, in a way that allows
19666 @value{GDBN} to find and load the debugging information automatically.
19667 Since debugging information can be very large---sometimes larger
19668 than the executable code itself---some systems distribute debugging
19669 information for their executables in separate files, which users can
19670 install only when they need to debug a problem.
19671
19672 @value{GDBN} supports two ways of specifying the separate debug info
19673 file:
19674
19675 @itemize @bullet
19676 @item
19677 The executable contains a @dfn{debug link} that specifies the name of
19678 the separate debug info file. The separate debug file's name is
19679 usually @file{@var{executable}.debug}, where @var{executable} is the
19680 name of the corresponding executable file without leading directories
19681 (e.g., @file{ls.debug} for @file{/usr/bin/ls}). In addition, the
19682 debug link specifies a 32-bit @dfn{Cyclic Redundancy Check} (CRC)
19683 checksum for the debug file, which @value{GDBN} uses to validate that
19684 the executable and the debug file came from the same build.
19685
19686 @item
19687 The executable contains a @dfn{build ID}, a unique bit string that is
19688 also present in the corresponding debug info file. (This is supported
19689 only on some operating systems, when using the ELF or PE file formats
19690 for binary files and the @sc{gnu} Binutils.) For more details about
19691 this feature, see the description of the @option{--build-id}
19692 command-line option in @ref{Options, , Command Line Options, ld.info,
19693 The GNU Linker}. The debug info file's name is not specified
19694 explicitly by the build ID, but can be computed from the build ID, see
19695 below.
19696 @end itemize
19697
19698 Depending on the way the debug info file is specified, @value{GDBN}
19699 uses two different methods of looking for the debug file:
19700
19701 @itemize @bullet
19702 @item
19703 For the ``debug link'' method, @value{GDBN} looks up the named file in
19704 the directory of the executable file, then in a subdirectory of that
19705 directory named @file{.debug}, and finally under each one of the global debug
19706 directories, in a subdirectory whose name is identical to the leading
19707 directories of the executable's absolute file name.
19708
19709 @item
19710 For the ``build ID'' method, @value{GDBN} looks in the
19711 @file{.build-id} subdirectory of each one of the global debug directories for
19712 a file named @file{@var{nn}/@var{nnnnnnnn}.debug}, where @var{nn} are the
19713 first 2 hex characters of the build ID bit string, and @var{nnnnnnnn}
19714 are the rest of the bit string. (Real build ID strings are 32 or more
19715 hex characters, not 10.)
19716 @end itemize
19717
19718 So, for example, suppose you ask @value{GDBN} to debug
19719 @file{/usr/bin/ls}, which has a debug link that specifies the
19720 file @file{ls.debug}, and a build ID whose value in hex is
19721 @code{abcdef1234}. If the list of the global debug directories includes
19722 @file{/usr/lib/debug}, then @value{GDBN} will look for the following
19723 debug information files, in the indicated order:
19724
19725 @itemize @minus
19726 @item
19727 @file{/usr/lib/debug/.build-id/ab/cdef1234.debug}
19728 @item
19729 @file{/usr/bin/ls.debug}
19730 @item
19731 @file{/usr/bin/.debug/ls.debug}
19732 @item
19733 @file{/usr/lib/debug/usr/bin/ls.debug}.
19734 @end itemize
19735
19736 @anchor{debug-file-directory}
19737 Global debugging info directories default to what is set by @value{GDBN}
19738 configure option @option{--with-separate-debug-dir}. During @value{GDBN} run
19739 you can also set the global debugging info directories, and view the list
19740 @value{GDBN} is currently using.
19741
19742 @table @code
19743
19744 @kindex set debug-file-directory
19745 @item set debug-file-directory @var{directories}
19746 Set the directories which @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
19747 information files to @var{directory}. Multiple path components can be set
19748 concatenating them by a path separator.
19749
19750 @kindex show debug-file-directory
19751 @item show debug-file-directory
19752 Show the directories @value{GDBN} searches for separate debugging
19753 information files.
19754
19755 @end table
19756
19757 @cindex @code{.gnu_debuglink} sections
19758 @cindex debug link sections
19759 A debug link is a special section of the executable file named
19760 @code{.gnu_debuglink}. The section must contain:
19761
19762 @itemize
19763 @item
19764 A filename, with any leading directory components removed, followed by
19765 a zero byte,
19766 @item
19767 zero to three bytes of padding, as needed to reach the next four-byte
19768 boundary within the section, and
19769 @item
19770 a four-byte CRC checksum, stored in the same endianness used for the
19771 executable file itself. The checksum is computed on the debugging
19772 information file's full contents by the function given below, passing
19773 zero as the @var{crc} argument.
19774 @end itemize
19775
19776 Any executable file format can carry a debug link, as long as it can
19777 contain a section named @code{.gnu_debuglink} with the contents
19778 described above.
19779
19780 @cindex @code{.note.gnu.build-id} sections
19781 @cindex build ID sections
19782 The build ID is a special section in the executable file (and in other
19783 ELF binary files that @value{GDBN} may consider). This section is
19784 often named @code{.note.gnu.build-id}, but that name is not mandatory.
19785 It contains unique identification for the built files---the ID remains
19786 the same across multiple builds of the same build tree. The default
19787 algorithm SHA1 produces 160 bits (40 hexadecimal characters) of the
19788 content for the build ID string. The same section with an identical
19789 value is present in the original built binary with symbols, in its
19790 stripped variant, and in the separate debugging information file.
19791
19792 The debugging information file itself should be an ordinary
19793 executable, containing a full set of linker symbols, sections, and
19794 debugging information. The sections of the debugging information file
19795 should have the same names, addresses, and sizes as the original file,
19796 but they need not contain any data---much like a @code{.bss} section
19797 in an ordinary executable.
19798
19799 The @sc{gnu} binary utilities (Binutils) package includes the
19800 @samp{objcopy} utility that can produce
19801 the separated executable / debugging information file pairs using the
19802 following commands:
19803
19804 @smallexample
19805 @kbd{objcopy --only-keep-debug foo foo.debug}
19806 @kbd{strip -g foo}
19807 @end smallexample
19808
19809 @noindent
19810 These commands remove the debugging
19811 information from the executable file @file{foo} and place it in the file
19812 @file{foo.debug}. You can use the first, second or both methods to link the
19813 two files:
19814
19815 @itemize @bullet
19816 @item
19817 The debug link method needs the following additional command to also leave
19818 behind a debug link in @file{foo}:
19819
19820 @smallexample
19821 @kbd{objcopy --add-gnu-debuglink=foo.debug foo}
19822 @end smallexample
19823
19824 Ulrich Drepper's @file{elfutils} package, starting with version 0.53, contains
19825 a version of the @code{strip} command such that the command @kbd{strip foo -f
19826 foo.debug} has the same functionality as the two @code{objcopy} commands and
19827 the @code{ln -s} command above, together.
19828
19829 @item
19830 Build ID gets embedded into the main executable using @code{ld --build-id} or
19831 the @value{NGCC} counterpart @code{gcc -Wl,--build-id}. Build ID support plus
19832 compatibility fixes for debug files separation are present in @sc{gnu} binary
19833 utilities (Binutils) package since version 2.18.
19834 @end itemize
19835
19836 @noindent
19837
19838 @cindex CRC algorithm definition
19839 The CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink} is the CRC-32 defined in
19840 IEEE 802.3 using the polynomial:
19841
19842 @c TexInfo requires naked braces for multi-digit exponents for Tex
19843 @c output, but this causes HTML output to barf. HTML has to be set using
19844 @c raw commands. So we end up having to specify this equation in 2
19845 @c different ways!
19846 @ifhtml
19847 @display
19848 @html
19849 <em>x</em><sup>32</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>26</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>23</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>22</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>16</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>12</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>11</sup>
19850 + <em>x</em><sup>10</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>8</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>7</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>5</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>4</sup> + <em>x</em><sup>2</sup> + <em>x</em> + 1
19851 @end html
19852 @end display
19853 @end ifhtml
19854 @ifnothtml
19855 @display
19856 @math{x^{32} + x^{26} + x^{23} + x^{22} + x^{16} + x^{12} + x^{11}}
19857 @math{+ x^{10} + x^8 + x^7 + x^5 + x^4 + x^2 + x + 1}
19858 @end display
19859 @end ifnothtml
19860
19861 The function is computed byte at a time, taking the least
19862 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern
19863 @code{0xffffffff} is used, to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC and
19864 the final result is inverted to ensure trailing zeros also affect the
19865 CRC.
19866
19867 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC polynomial as used in handling the
19868 @dfn{Remote Serial Protocol} @code{qCRC} packet (@pxref{qCRC packet}).
19869 However in the case of the Remote Serial Protocol, the CRC is computed
19870 @emph{most} significant bit first, and the result is not inverted, so
19871 trailing zeros have no effect on the CRC value.
19872
19873 To complete the description, we show below the code of the function
19874 which produces the CRC used in @code{.gnu_debuglink}. Inverting the
19875 initially supplied @code{crc} argument means that an initial call to
19876 this function passing in zero will start computing the CRC using
19877 @code{0xffffffff}.
19878
19879 @kindex gnu_debuglink_crc32
19880 @smallexample
19881 unsigned long
19882 gnu_debuglink_crc32 (unsigned long crc,
19883 unsigned char *buf, size_t len)
19884 @{
19885 static const unsigned long crc32_table[256] =
19886 @{
19887 0x00000000, 0x77073096, 0xee0e612c, 0x990951ba, 0x076dc419,
19888 0x706af48f, 0xe963a535, 0x9e6495a3, 0x0edb8832, 0x79dcb8a4,
19889 0xe0d5e91e, 0x97d2d988, 0x09b64c2b, 0x7eb17cbd, 0xe7b82d07,
19890 0x90bf1d91, 0x1db71064, 0x6ab020f2, 0xf3b97148, 0x84be41de,
19891 0x1adad47d, 0x6ddde4eb, 0xf4d4b551, 0x83d385c7, 0x136c9856,
19892 0x646ba8c0, 0xfd62f97a, 0x8a65c9ec, 0x14015c4f, 0x63066cd9,
19893 0xfa0f3d63, 0x8d080df5, 0x3b6e20c8, 0x4c69105e, 0xd56041e4,
19894 0xa2677172, 0x3c03e4d1, 0x4b04d447, 0xd20d85fd, 0xa50ab56b,
19895 0x35b5a8fa, 0x42b2986c, 0xdbbbc9d6, 0xacbcf940, 0x32d86ce3,
19896 0x45df5c75, 0xdcd60dcf, 0xabd13d59, 0x26d930ac, 0x51de003a,
19897 0xc8d75180, 0xbfd06116, 0x21b4f4b5, 0x56b3c423, 0xcfba9599,
19898 0xb8bda50f, 0x2802b89e, 0x5f058808, 0xc60cd9b2, 0xb10be924,
19899 0x2f6f7c87, 0x58684c11, 0xc1611dab, 0xb6662d3d, 0x76dc4190,
19900 0x01db7106, 0x98d220bc, 0xefd5102a, 0x71b18589, 0x06b6b51f,
19901 0x9fbfe4a5, 0xe8b8d433, 0x7807c9a2, 0x0f00f934, 0x9609a88e,
19902 0xe10e9818, 0x7f6a0dbb, 0x086d3d2d, 0x91646c97, 0xe6635c01,
19903 0x6b6b51f4, 0x1c6c6162, 0x856530d8, 0xf262004e, 0x6c0695ed,
19904 0x1b01a57b, 0x8208f4c1, 0xf50fc457, 0x65b0d9c6, 0x12b7e950,
19905 0x8bbeb8ea, 0xfcb9887c, 0x62dd1ddf, 0x15da2d49, 0x8cd37cf3,
19906 0xfbd44c65, 0x4db26158, 0x3ab551ce, 0xa3bc0074, 0xd4bb30e2,
19907 0x4adfa541, 0x3dd895d7, 0xa4d1c46d, 0xd3d6f4fb, 0x4369e96a,
19908 0x346ed9fc, 0xad678846, 0xda60b8d0, 0x44042d73, 0x33031de5,
19909 0xaa0a4c5f, 0xdd0d7cc9, 0x5005713c, 0x270241aa, 0xbe0b1010,
19910 0xc90c2086, 0x5768b525, 0x206f85b3, 0xb966d409, 0xce61e49f,
19911 0x5edef90e, 0x29d9c998, 0xb0d09822, 0xc7d7a8b4, 0x59b33d17,
19912 0x2eb40d81, 0xb7bd5c3b, 0xc0ba6cad, 0xedb88320, 0x9abfb3b6,
19913 0x03b6e20c, 0x74b1d29a, 0xead54739, 0x9dd277af, 0x04db2615,
19914 0x73dc1683, 0xe3630b12, 0x94643b84, 0x0d6d6a3e, 0x7a6a5aa8,
19915 0xe40ecf0b, 0x9309ff9d, 0x0a00ae27, 0x7d079eb1, 0xf00f9344,
19916 0x8708a3d2, 0x1e01f268, 0x6906c2fe, 0xf762575d, 0x806567cb,
19917 0x196c3671, 0x6e6b06e7, 0xfed41b76, 0x89d32be0, 0x10da7a5a,
19918 0x67dd4acc, 0xf9b9df6f, 0x8ebeeff9, 0x17b7be43, 0x60b08ed5,
19919 0xd6d6a3e8, 0xa1d1937e, 0x38d8c2c4, 0x4fdff252, 0xd1bb67f1,
19920 0xa6bc5767, 0x3fb506dd, 0x48b2364b, 0xd80d2bda, 0xaf0a1b4c,
19921 0x36034af6, 0x41047a60, 0xdf60efc3, 0xa867df55, 0x316e8eef,
19922 0x4669be79, 0xcb61b38c, 0xbc66831a, 0x256fd2a0, 0x5268e236,
19923 0xcc0c7795, 0xbb0b4703, 0x220216b9, 0x5505262f, 0xc5ba3bbe,
19924 0xb2bd0b28, 0x2bb45a92, 0x5cb36a04, 0xc2d7ffa7, 0xb5d0cf31,
19925 0x2cd99e8b, 0x5bdeae1d, 0x9b64c2b0, 0xec63f226, 0x756aa39c,
19926 0x026d930a, 0x9c0906a9, 0xeb0e363f, 0x72076785, 0x05005713,
19927 0x95bf4a82, 0xe2b87a14, 0x7bb12bae, 0x0cb61b38, 0x92d28e9b,
19928 0xe5d5be0d, 0x7cdcefb7, 0x0bdbdf21, 0x86d3d2d4, 0xf1d4e242,
19929 0x68ddb3f8, 0x1fda836e, 0x81be16cd, 0xf6b9265b, 0x6fb077e1,
19930 0x18b74777, 0x88085ae6, 0xff0f6a70, 0x66063bca, 0x11010b5c,
19931 0x8f659eff, 0xf862ae69, 0x616bffd3, 0x166ccf45, 0xa00ae278,
19932 0xd70dd2ee, 0x4e048354, 0x3903b3c2, 0xa7672661, 0xd06016f7,
19933 0x4969474d, 0x3e6e77db, 0xaed16a4a, 0xd9d65adc, 0x40df0b66,
19934 0x37d83bf0, 0xa9bcae53, 0xdebb9ec5, 0x47b2cf7f, 0x30b5ffe9,
19935 0xbdbdf21c, 0xcabac28a, 0x53b39330, 0x24b4a3a6, 0xbad03605,
19936 0xcdd70693, 0x54de5729, 0x23d967bf, 0xb3667a2e, 0xc4614ab8,
19937 0x5d681b02, 0x2a6f2b94, 0xb40bbe37, 0xc30c8ea1, 0x5a05df1b,
19938 0x2d02ef8d
19939 @};
19940 unsigned char *end;
19941
19942 crc = ~crc & 0xffffffff;
19943 for (end = buf + len; buf < end; ++buf)
19944 crc = crc32_table[(crc ^ *buf) & 0xff] ^ (crc >> 8);
19945 return ~crc & 0xffffffff;
19946 @}
19947 @end smallexample
19948
19949 @noindent
19950 This computation does not apply to the ``build ID'' method.
19951
19952 @node MiniDebugInfo
19953 @section Debugging information in a special section
19954 @cindex separate debug sections
19955 @cindex @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section
19956
19957 Some systems ship pre-built executables and libraries that have a
19958 special @samp{.gnu_debugdata} section. This feature is called
19959 @dfn{MiniDebugInfo}. This section holds an LZMA-compressed object and
19960 is used to supply extra symbols for backtraces.
19961
19962 The intent of this section is to provide extra minimal debugging
19963 information for use in simple backtraces. It is not intended to be a
19964 replacement for full separate debugging information (@pxref{Separate
19965 Debug Files}). The example below shows the intended use; however,
19966 @value{GDBN} does not currently put restrictions on what sort of
19967 debugging information might be included in the section.
19968
19969 @value{GDBN} has support for this extension. If the section exists,
19970 then it is used provided that no other source of debugging information
19971 can be found, and that @value{GDBN} was configured with LZMA support.
19972
19973 This section can be easily created using @command{objcopy} and other
19974 standard utilities:
19975
19976 @smallexample
19977 # Extract the dynamic symbols from the main binary, there is no need
19978 # to also have these in the normal symbol table.
19979 nm -D @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
19980 | awk '@{ print $1 @}' | sort > dynsyms
19981
19982 # Extract all the text (i.e. function) symbols from the debuginfo.
19983 # (Note that we actually also accept "D" symbols, for the benefit
19984 # of platforms like PowerPC64 that use function descriptors.)
19985 nm @var{binary} --format=posix --defined-only \
19986 | awk '@{ if ($2 == "T" || $2 == "t" || $2 == "D") print $1 @}' \
19987 | sort > funcsyms
19988
19989 # Keep all the function symbols not already in the dynamic symbol
19990 # table.
19991 comm -13 dynsyms funcsyms > keep_symbols
19992
19993 # Separate full debug info into debug binary.
19994 objcopy --only-keep-debug @var{binary} debug
19995
19996 # Copy the full debuginfo, keeping only a minimal set of symbols and
19997 # removing some unnecessary sections.
19998 objcopy -S --remove-section .gdb_index --remove-section .comment \
19999 --keep-symbols=keep_symbols debug mini_debuginfo
20000
20001 # Drop the full debug info from the original binary.
20002 strip --strip-all -R .comment @var{binary}
20003
20004 # Inject the compressed data into the .gnu_debugdata section of the
20005 # original binary.
20006 xz mini_debuginfo
20007 objcopy --add-section .gnu_debugdata=mini_debuginfo.xz @var{binary}
20008 @end smallexample
20009
20010 @node Index Files
20011 @section Index Files Speed Up @value{GDBN}
20012 @cindex index files
20013 @cindex @samp{.gdb_index} section
20014
20015 When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
20016 file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
20017 @value{GDBN} operations work quickly---at the cost of a delay early
20018 on. For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so
20019 @value{GDBN} provides a way to build an index, which speeds up
20020 startup.
20021
20022 For convenience, @value{GDBN} comes with a program,
20023 @command{gdb-add-index}, which can be used to add the index to a
20024 symbol file. It takes the symbol file as its only argument:
20025
20026 @smallexample
20027 $ gdb-add-index symfile
20028 @end smallexample
20029
20030 @xref{gdb-add-index}.
20031
20032 It is also possible to do the work manually. Here is what
20033 @command{gdb-add-index} does behind the curtains.
20034
20035 The index is stored as a section in the symbol file. @value{GDBN} can
20036 write the index to a file, then you can put it into the symbol file
20037 using @command{objcopy}.
20038
20039 To create an index file, use the @code{save gdb-index} command:
20040
20041 @table @code
20042 @item save gdb-index [-dwarf-5] @var{directory}
20043 @kindex save gdb-index
20044 Create index files for all symbol files currently known by
20045 @value{GDBN}. For each known @var{symbol-file}, this command by
20046 default creates it produces a single file
20047 @file{@var{symbol-file}.gdb-index}. If you invoke this command with
20048 the @option{-dwarf-5} option, it produces 2 files:
20049 @file{@var{symbol-file}.debug_names} and
20050 @file{@var{symbol-file}.debug_str}. The files are created in the
20051 given @var{directory}.
20052 @end table
20053
20054 Once you have created an index file you can merge it into your symbol
20055 file, here named @file{symfile}, using @command{objcopy}:
20056
20057 @smallexample
20058 $ objcopy --add-section .gdb_index=symfile.gdb-index \
20059 --set-section-flags .gdb_index=readonly symfile symfile
20060 @end smallexample
20061
20062 Or for @code{-dwarf-5}:
20063
20064 @smallexample
20065 $ objcopy --dump-section .debug_str=symfile.debug_str.new symfile
20066 $ cat symfile.debug_str >>symfile.debug_str.new
20067 $ objcopy --add-section .debug_names=symfile.gdb-index \
20068 --set-section-flags .debug_names=readonly \
20069 --update-section .debug_str=symfile.debug_str.new symfile symfile
20070 @end smallexample
20071
20072 @value{GDBN} will normally ignore older versions of @file{.gdb_index}
20073 sections that have been deprecated. Usually they are deprecated because
20074 they are missing a new feature or have performance issues.
20075 To tell @value{GDBN} to use a deprecated index section anyway
20076 specify @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
20077 The default is @code{off}.
20078 This can speed up startup, but may result in some functionality being lost.
20079 @xref{Index Section Format}.
20080
20081 @emph{Warning:} Setting @code{use-deprecated-index-sections} to @code{on}
20082 must be done before gdb reads the file. The following will not work:
20083
20084 @smallexample
20085 $ gdb -ex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
20086 @end smallexample
20087
20088 Instead you must do, for example,
20089
20090 @smallexample
20091 $ gdb -iex "set use-deprecated-index-sections on" <program>
20092 @end smallexample
20093
20094 There are currently some limitation on indices. They only work when
20095 for DWARF debugging information, not stabs. And, they do not
20096 currently work for programs using Ada.
20097
20098 @node Symbol Errors
20099 @section Errors Reading Symbol Files
20100
20101 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
20102 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
20103 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
20104 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
20105 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
20106 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
20107 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
20108 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
20109 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
20110 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
20111 Messages}).
20112
20113 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
20114
20115 @table @code
20116 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
20117
20118 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
20119 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
20120 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
20121 in its outer scope blocks.
20122
20123 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
20124 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
20125 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
20126 function.
20127
20128 @item block at @var{address} out of order
20129
20130 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
20131 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
20132 do so.
20133
20134 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
20135 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
20136 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
20137 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional Warnings and
20138 Messages}.)
20139
20140 @item bad block start address patched
20141
20142 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
20143 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
20144 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
20145
20146 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
20147 starting on the previous source line.
20148
20149 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
20150
20151 @cindex foo
20152 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
20153 larger than the size of the string table.
20154
20155 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
20156 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
20157 with this name.
20158
20159 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
20160
20161 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
20162 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
20163 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
20164
20165 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
20166 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
20167 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
20168 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
20169 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
20170 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
20171
20172 @item stub type has NULL name
20173
20174 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
20175
20176 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
20177 The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
20178 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
20179 it.
20180
20181 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
20182
20183 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
20184
20185 @end table
20186
20187 @node Data Files
20188 @section GDB Data Files
20189
20190 @cindex prefix for data files
20191 @value{GDBN} will sometimes read an auxiliary data file. These files
20192 are kept in a directory known as the @dfn{data directory}.
20193
20194 You can set the data directory's name, and view the name @value{GDBN}
20195 is currently using.
20196
20197 @table @code
20198 @kindex set data-directory
20199 @item set data-directory @var{directory}
20200 Set the directory which @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files
20201 to @var{directory}.
20202
20203 @kindex show data-directory
20204 @item show data-directory
20205 Show the directory @value{GDBN} searches for auxiliary data files.
20206 @end table
20207
20208 @cindex default data directory
20209 @cindex @samp{--with-gdb-datadir}
20210 You can set the default data directory by using the configure-time
20211 @samp{--with-gdb-datadir} option. If the data directory is inside
20212 @value{GDBN}'s configured binary prefix (set with @samp{--prefix} or
20213 @samp{--exec-prefix}), then the default data directory will be updated
20214 automatically if the installed @value{GDBN} is moved to a new
20215 location.
20216
20217 The data directory may also be specified with the
20218 @code{--data-directory} command line option.
20219 @xref{Mode Options}.
20220
20221 @node Targets
20222 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
20223
20224 @cindex debugging target
20225 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
20226
20227 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
20228 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
20229 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
20230 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
20231 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
20232 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
20233 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
20234 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for Managing Targets}).
20235
20236 @cindex target architecture
20237 It is possible to build @value{GDBN} for several different @dfn{target
20238 architectures}. When @value{GDBN} is built like that, you can choose
20239 one of the available architectures with the @kbd{set architecture}
20240 command.
20241
20242 @table @code
20243 @kindex set architecture
20244 @kindex show architecture
20245 @item set architecture @var{arch}
20246 This command sets the current target architecture to @var{arch}. The
20247 value of @var{arch} can be @code{"auto"}, in addition to one of the
20248 supported architectures.
20249
20250 @item show architecture
20251 Show the current target architecture.
20252
20253 @item set processor
20254 @itemx processor
20255 @kindex set processor
20256 @kindex show processor
20257 These are alias commands for, respectively, @code{set architecture}
20258 and @code{show architecture}.
20259 @end table
20260
20261 @menu
20262 * Active Targets:: Active targets
20263 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
20264 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
20265 @end menu
20266
20267 @node Active Targets
20268 @section Active Targets
20269
20270 @cindex stacking targets
20271 @cindex active targets
20272 @cindex multiple targets
20273
20274 There are multiple classes of targets such as: processes, executable files or
20275 recording sessions. Core files belong to the process class, making core file
20276 and process mutually exclusive. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} can work concurrently
20277 on multiple active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for
20278 example) start a process and inspect its activity, while still having access to
20279 the executable file after the process finishes. Or if you start process
20280 recording (@pxref{Reverse Execution}) and @code{reverse-step} there, you are
20281 presented a virtual layer of the recording target, while the process target
20282 remains stopped at the chronologically last point of the process execution.
20283
20284 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new core
20285 file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}). To
20286 specify as a target a process that is already running, use the @code{attach}
20287 command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an Already-running Process}).
20288
20289 @node Target Commands
20290 @section Commands for Managing Targets
20291
20292 @table @code
20293 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
20294 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
20295 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
20296 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
20297 protocol of the target machine.
20298
20299 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
20300 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
20301 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
20302
20303 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
20304 after executing the command.
20305
20306 @kindex help target
20307 @item help target
20308 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
20309 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
20310 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}).
20311
20312 @item help target @var{name}
20313 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
20314 select it.
20315
20316 @kindex set gnutarget
20317 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
20318 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
20319 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
20320 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
20321 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
20322 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
20323
20324 @quotation
20325 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
20326 you must know the actual BFD name.
20327 @end quotation
20328
20329 @noindent
20330 @xref{Files, , Commands to Specify Files}.
20331
20332 @kindex show gnutarget
20333 @item show gnutarget
20334 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
20335 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
20336 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
20337 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BFD target is "auto"}.
20338 @end table
20339
20340 @cindex common targets
20341 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
20342 configuration):
20343
20344 @table @code
20345 @kindex target
20346 @item target exec @var{program}
20347 @cindex executable file target
20348 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
20349 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
20350
20351 @item target core @var{filename}
20352 @cindex core dump file target
20353 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
20354 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
20355
20356 @item target remote @var{medium}
20357 @cindex remote target
20358 A remote system connected to @value{GDBN} via a serial line or network
20359 connection. This command tells @value{GDBN} to use its own remote
20360 protocol over @var{medium} for debugging. @xref{Remote Debugging}.
20361
20362 For example, if you have a board connected to @file{/dev/ttya} on the
20363 machine running @value{GDBN}, you could say:
20364
20365 @smallexample
20366 target remote /dev/ttya
20367 @end smallexample
20368
20369 @code{target remote} supports the @code{load} command. This is only
20370 useful if you have some other way of getting the stub to the target
20371 system, and you can put it somewhere in memory where it won't get
20372 clobbered by the download.
20373
20374 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
20375 @cindex built-in simulator target
20376 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
20377 In general,
20378 @smallexample
20379 target sim
20380 load
20381 run
20382 @end smallexample
20383 @noindent
20384 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
20385 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
20386 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
20387 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
20388 Processors}.
20389
20390 @item target native
20391 @cindex native target
20392 Setup for local/native process debugging. Useful to make the
20393 @code{run} command spawn native processes (likewise @code{attach},
20394 etc.@:) even when @code{set auto-connect-native-target} is @code{off}
20395 (@pxref{set auto-connect-native-target}).
20396
20397 @end table
20398
20399 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
20400 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
20401
20402 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code once
20403 you've successfully established a connection. You may wish to control
20404 various aspects of this process.
20405
20406 @table @code
20407
20408 @item set hash
20409 @kindex set hash@r{, for remote monitors}
20410 @cindex hash mark while downloading
20411 This command controls whether a hash mark @samp{#} is displayed while
20412 downloading a file to the remote monitor. If on, a hash mark is
20413 displayed after each S-record is successfully downloaded to the
20414 monitor.
20415
20416 @item show hash
20417 @kindex show hash@r{, for remote monitors}
20418 Show the current status of displaying the hash mark.
20419
20420 @item set debug monitor
20421 @kindex set debug monitor
20422 @cindex display remote monitor communications
20423 Enable or disable display of communications messages between
20424 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
20425
20426 @item show debug monitor
20427 @kindex show debug monitor
20428 Show the current status of displaying communications between
20429 @value{GDBN} and the remote monitor.
20430 @end table
20431
20432 @table @code
20433
20434 @kindex load @var{filename} @var{offset}
20435 @item load @var{filename} @var{offset}
20436 @anchor{load}
20437 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
20438 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
20439 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
20440 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
20441 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
20442 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
20443
20444 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
20445 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
20446 target is @dots{}}''
20447
20448 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
20449 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
20450 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
20451 specifies a fixed address.
20452 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
20453
20454 It is also possible to tell @value{GDBN} to load the executable file at a
20455 specific offset described by the optional argument @var{offset}. When
20456 @var{offset} is provided, @var{filename} must also be provided.
20457
20458 Depending on the remote side capabilities, @value{GDBN} may be able to
20459 load programs into flash memory.
20460
20461 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
20462 @end table
20463
20464 @table @code
20465
20466 @kindex flash-erase
20467 @item flash-erase
20468 @anchor{flash-erase}
20469
20470 Erases all known flash memory regions on the target.
20471
20472 @end table
20473
20474 @node Byte Order
20475 @section Choosing Target Byte Order
20476
20477 @cindex choosing target byte order
20478 @cindex target byte order
20479
20480 Some types of processors, such as the @acronym{MIPS}, PowerPC, and Renesas SH,
20481 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
20482 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
20483 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
20484 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
20485 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
20486
20487 @table @code
20488 @kindex set endian
20489 @item set endian big
20490 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
20491
20492 @item set endian little
20493 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
20494
20495 @item set endian auto
20496 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
20497 executable.
20498
20499 @item show endian
20500 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
20501
20502 @end table
20503
20504 If the @code{set endian auto} mode is in effect and no executable has
20505 been selected, then the endianness used is the last one chosen either
20506 by one of the @code{set endian big} and @code{set endian little}
20507 commands or by inferring from the last executable used. If no
20508 endianness has been previously chosen, then the default for this mode
20509 is inferred from the target @value{GDBN} has been built for, and is
20510 @code{little} if the name of the target CPU has an @code{el} suffix
20511 and @code{big} otherwise.
20512
20513 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
20514 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
20515 target system.
20516
20517
20518 @node Remote Debugging
20519 @chapter Debugging Remote Programs
20520 @cindex remote debugging
20521
20522 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
20523 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
20524 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
20525 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
20526 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
20527
20528 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
20529 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
20530 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
20531 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
20532 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
20533 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
20534
20535 Other remote targets may be available in your
20536 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
20537
20538 @menu
20539 * Connecting:: Connecting to a remote target
20540 * File Transfer:: Sending files to a remote system
20541 * Server:: Using the gdbserver program
20542 * Remote Configuration:: Remote configuration
20543 * Remote Stub:: Implementing a remote stub
20544 @end menu
20545
20546 @node Connecting
20547 @section Connecting to a Remote Target
20548 @cindex remote debugging, connecting
20549 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, connecting
20550 @cindex remote debugging, types of connections
20551 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, types of connections
20552 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target remote} mode
20553 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, @code{target extended-remote} mode
20554
20555 This section describes how to connect to a remote target, including the
20556 types of connections and their differences, how to set up executable and
20557 symbol files on the host and target, and the commands used for
20558 connecting to and disconnecting from the remote target.
20559
20560 @subsection Types of Remote Connections
20561
20562 @value{GDBN} supports two types of remote connections, @code{target remote}
20563 mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode. Note that many remote targets
20564 support only @code{target remote} mode. There are several major
20565 differences between the two types of connections, enumerated here:
20566
20567 @table @asis
20568
20569 @cindex remote debugging, detach and program exit
20570 @item Result of detach or program exit
20571 @strong{With target remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or you
20572 detach from it, @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target. When using
20573 @code{gdbserver}, @code{gdbserver} will exit.
20574
20575 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} When the debugged program exits or
20576 you detach from it, @value{GDBN} remains connected to the target, even
20577 though no program is running. You can rerun the program, attach to a
20578 running program, or use @code{monitor} commands specific to the target.
20579
20580 When using @code{gdbserver} in this case, it does not exit unless it was
20581 invoked using the @option{--once} option. If the @option{--once} option
20582 was not used, you can ask @code{gdbserver} to exit using the
20583 @code{monitor exit} command (@pxref{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}).
20584
20585 @item Specifying the program to debug
20586 For both connection types you use the @code{file} command to specify the
20587 program on the host system. If you are using @code{gdbserver} there are
20588 some differences in how to specify the location of the program on the
20589 target.
20590
20591 @strong{With target remote mode:} You must either specify the program to debug
20592 on the @code{gdbserver} command line or use the @option{--attach} option
20593 (@pxref{Attaching to a program,,Attaching to a Running Program}).
20594
20595 @cindex @option{--multi}, @code{gdbserver} option
20596 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} You may specify the program to debug
20597 on the @code{gdbserver} command line, or you can load the program or attach
20598 to it using @value{GDBN} commands after connecting to @code{gdbserver}.
20599
20600 @anchor{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections}
20601 You can start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
20602 or process ID to attach. To do this, use the @option{--multi} command line
20603 option. Then you can connect using @code{target extended-remote} and start
20604 the program you want to debug (see below for details on using the
20605 @code{run} command in this scenario). Note that the conditions under which
20606 @code{gdbserver} terminates depend on how @value{GDBN} connects to it
20607 (@code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}). The
20608 @option{--multi} option to @code{gdbserver} has no influence on that.
20609
20610 @item The @code{run} command
20611 @strong{With target remote mode:} The @code{run} command is not
20612 supported. Once a connection has been established, you can use all
20613 the usual @value{GDBN} commands to examine and change data. The
20614 remote program is already running, so you can use commands like
20615 @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue}.
20616
20617 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} The @code{run} command is
20618 supported. The @code{run} command uses the value set by
20619 @code{set remote exec-file} (@pxref{set remote exec-file}) to select
20620 the program to run. Command line arguments are supported, except for
20621 wildcard expansion and I/O redirection (@pxref{Arguments}).
20622
20623 If you specify the program to debug on the command line, then the
20624 @code{run} command is not required to start execution, and you can
20625 resume using commands like @kbd{step} and @kbd{continue} as with
20626 @code{target remote} mode.
20627
20628 @anchor{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections}
20629 @item Attaching
20630 @strong{With target remote mode:} The @value{GDBN} command @code{attach} is
20631 not supported. To attach to a running program using @code{gdbserver}, you
20632 must use the @option{--attach} option (@pxref{Running gdbserver}).
20633
20634 @strong{With target extended-remote mode:} To attach to a running program,
20635 you may use the @code{attach} command after the connection has been
20636 established. If you are using @code{gdbserver}, you may also invoke
20637 @code{gdbserver} using the @option{--attach} option
20638 (@pxref{Running gdbserver}).
20639
20640 @end table
20641
20642 @anchor{Host and target files}
20643 @subsection Host and Target Files
20644 @cindex remote debugging, symbol files
20645 @cindex symbol files, remote debugging
20646
20647 @value{GDBN}, running on the host, needs access to symbol and debugging
20648 information for your program running on the target. This requires
20649 access to an unstripped copy of your program, and possibly any associated
20650 symbol files. Note that this section applies equally to both @code{target
20651 remote} mode and @code{target extended-remote} mode.
20652
20653 Some remote targets (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}, and
20654 @pxref{Host I/O Packets}) allow @value{GDBN} to access program files over
20655 the same connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. With such a
20656 target, if the remote program is unstripped, the only command you need is
20657 @code{target remote} (or @code{target extended-remote}).
20658
20659 If the remote program is stripped, or the target does not support remote
20660 program file access, start up @value{GDBN} using the name of the local
20661 unstripped copy of your program as the first argument, or use the
20662 @code{file} command. Use @code{set sysroot} to specify the location (on
20663 the host) of target libraries (unless your @value{GDBN} was compiled with
20664 the correct sysroot using @code{--with-sysroot}). Alternatively, you
20665 may use @code{set solib-search-path} to specify how @value{GDBN} locates
20666 target libraries.
20667
20668 The symbol file and target libraries must exactly match the executable
20669 and libraries on the target, with one exception: the files on the host
20670 system should not be stripped, even if the files on the target system
20671 are. Mismatched or missing files will lead to confusing results
20672 during debugging. On @sc{gnu}/Linux targets, mismatched or missing
20673 files may also prevent @code{gdbserver} from debugging multi-threaded
20674 programs.
20675
20676 @subsection Remote Connection Commands
20677 @cindex remote connection commands
20678 @value{GDBN} can communicate with the target over a serial line, or
20679 over an @acronym{IP} network using @acronym{TCP} or @acronym{UDP}. In
20680 each case, @value{GDBN} uses the same protocol for debugging your
20681 program; only the medium carrying the debugging packets varies. The
20682 @code{target remote} and @code{target extended-remote} commands
20683 establish a connection to the target. Both commands accept the same
20684 arguments, which indicate the medium to use:
20685
20686 @table @code
20687
20688 @item target remote @var{serial-device}
20689 @itemx target extended-remote @var{serial-device}
20690 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
20691 Use @var{serial-device} to communicate with the target. For example,
20692 to use a serial line connected to the device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
20693
20694 @smallexample
20695 target remote /dev/ttyb
20696 @end smallexample
20697
20698 If you're using a serial line, you may want to give @value{GDBN} the
20699 @samp{--baud} option, or use the @code{set serial baud} command
20700 (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set serial baud}) before the
20701 @code{target} command.
20702
20703 @item target remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
20704 @itemx target remote @code{@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20705 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20706 @itemx target remote @code{tcp:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20707 @itemx target remote @code{tcp4:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20708 @itemx target remote @code{tcp6:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20709 @itemx target remote @code{tcp6:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20710 @itemx target extended-remote @code{@var{host}:@var{port}}
20711 @itemx target extended-remote @code{@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20712 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20713 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20714 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp4:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20715 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp6:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20716 @itemx target extended-remote @code{tcp6:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20717 @cindex @acronym{TCP} port, @code{target remote}
20718 Debug using a @acronym{TCP} connection to @var{port} on @var{host}.
20719 The @var{host} may be either a host name, a numeric @acronym{IPv4}
20720 address, or a numeric @acronym{IPv6} address (with or without the
20721 square brackets to separate the address from the port); @var{port}
20722 must be a decimal number. The @var{host} could be the target machine
20723 itself, if it is directly connected to the net, or it might be a
20724 terminal server which in turn has a serial line to the target.
20725
20726 For example, to connect to port 2828 on a terminal server named
20727 @code{manyfarms}:
20728
20729 @smallexample
20730 target remote manyfarms:2828
20731 @end smallexample
20732
20733 To connect to port 2828 on a terminal server whose address is
20734 @code{2001:0db8:85a3:0000:0000:8a2e:0370:7334}, you can either use the
20735 square bracket syntax:
20736
20737 @smallexample
20738 target remote [2001:0db8:85a3:0000:0000:8a2e:0370:7334]:2828
20739 @end smallexample
20740
20741 @noindent
20742 or explicitly specify the @acronym{IPv6} protocol:
20743
20744 @smallexample
20745 target remote tcp6:2001:0db8:85a3:0000:0000:8a2e:0370:7334:2828
20746 @end smallexample
20747
20748 This last example may be confusing to the reader, because there is no
20749 visible separation between the hostname and the port number.
20750 Therefore, we recommend the user to provide @acronym{IPv6} addresses
20751 using square brackets for clarity. However, it is important to
20752 mention that for @value{GDBN} there is no ambiguity: the number after
20753 the last colon is considered to be the port number.
20754
20755 If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as your
20756 debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator for your target running on the
20757 same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect to
20758 port 1234 on your local machine:
20759
20760 @smallexample
20761 target remote :1234
20762 @end smallexample
20763 @noindent
20764
20765 Note that the colon is still required here.
20766
20767 @item target remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20768 @itemx target remote @code{udp:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20769 @itemx target remote @code{udp4:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20770 @itemx target remote @code{udp6:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20771 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20772 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20773 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20774 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp4:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20775 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp6:@var{host}:@var{port}}
20776 @itemx target extended-remote @code{udp6:@var{[host]}:@var{port}}
20777 @cindex @acronym{UDP} port, @code{target remote}
20778 Debug using @acronym{UDP} packets to @var{port} on @var{host}. For example, to
20779 connect to @acronym{UDP} port 2828 on a terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
20780
20781 @smallexample
20782 target remote udp:manyfarms:2828
20783 @end smallexample
20784
20785 When using a @acronym{UDP} connection for remote debugging, you should
20786 keep in mind that the `U' stands for ``Unreliable''. @acronym{UDP}
20787 can silently drop packets on busy or unreliable networks, which will
20788 cause havoc with your debugging session.
20789
20790 @item target remote | @var{command}
20791 @itemx target extended-remote | @var{command}
20792 @cindex pipe, @code{target remote} to
20793 Run @var{command} in the background and communicate with it using a
20794 pipe. The @var{command} is a shell command, to be parsed and expanded
20795 by the system's command shell, @code{/bin/sh}; it should expect remote
20796 protocol packets on its standard input, and send replies on its
20797 standard output. You could use this to run a stand-alone simulator
20798 that speaks the remote debugging protocol, to make net connections
20799 using programs like @code{ssh}, or for other similar tricks.
20800
20801 If @var{command} closes its standard output (perhaps by exiting),
20802 @value{GDBN} will try to send it a @code{SIGTERM} signal. (If the
20803 program has already exited, this will have no effect.)
20804
20805 @end table
20806
20807 @cindex interrupting remote programs
20808 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
20809 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
20810 interrupt character (often @kbd{Ctrl-c}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
20811 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
20812 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
20813 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
20814
20815 @smallexample
20816 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
20817 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
20818 @end smallexample
20819
20820 In @code{target remote} mode, if you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons
20821 the remote debugging session. (If you decide you want to try again later,
20822 you can use @kbd{target remote} again to connect once more.) If you type
20823 @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN} goes back to waiting.
20824
20825 In @code{target extended-remote} mode, typing @kbd{n} will leave
20826 @value{GDBN} connected to the target.
20827
20828 @table @code
20829 @kindex detach (remote)
20830 @item detach
20831 When you have finished debugging the remote program, you can use the
20832 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control.
20833 Detaching from the target normally resumes its execution, but the results
20834 will depend on your particular remote stub. After the @code{detach}
20835 command in @code{target remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is free to connect to
20836 another target. In @code{target extended-remote} mode, @value{GDBN} is
20837 still connected to the target.
20838
20839 @kindex disconnect
20840 @item disconnect
20841 The @code{disconnect} command closes the connection to the target, and
20842 the target is generally not resumed. It will wait for @value{GDBN}
20843 (this instance or another one) to connect and continue debugging. After
20844 the @code{disconnect} command, @value{GDBN} is again free to connect to
20845 another target.
20846
20847 @cindex send command to remote monitor
20848 @cindex extend @value{GDBN} for remote targets
20849 @cindex add new commands for external monitor
20850 @kindex monitor
20851 @item monitor @var{cmd}
20852 This command allows you to send arbitrary commands directly to the
20853 remote monitor. Since @value{GDBN} doesn't care about the commands it
20854 sends like this, this command is the way to extend @value{GDBN}---you
20855 can add new commands that only the external monitor will understand
20856 and implement.
20857 @end table
20858
20859 @node File Transfer
20860 @section Sending files to a remote system
20861 @cindex remote target, file transfer
20862 @cindex file transfer
20863 @cindex sending files to remote systems
20864
20865 Some remote targets offer the ability to transfer files over the same
20866 connection used to communicate with @value{GDBN}. This is convenient
20867 for targets accessible through other means, e.g.@: @sc{gnu}/Linux systems
20868 running @code{gdbserver} over a network interface. For other targets,
20869 e.g.@: embedded devices with only a single serial port, this may be
20870 the only way to upload or download files.
20871
20872 Not all remote targets support these commands.
20873
20874 @table @code
20875 @kindex remote put
20876 @item remote put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
20877 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
20878 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
20879
20880 @kindex remote get
20881 @item remote get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
20882 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
20883 on the host system.
20884
20885 @kindex remote delete
20886 @item remote delete @var{targetfile}
20887 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
20888
20889 @end table
20890
20891 @node Server
20892 @section Using the @code{gdbserver} Program
20893
20894 @kindex gdbserver
20895 @cindex remote connection without stubs
20896 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
20897 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
20898 @code{target remote} or @code{target extended-remote}---but without
20899 linking in the usual debugging stub.
20900
20901 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
20902 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
20903 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
20904 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
20905 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
20906 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
20907 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
20908 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
20909 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
20910 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
20911 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
20912 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
20913 choice for debugging.
20914
20915 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
20916 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
20917 protocol.
20918
20919 @quotation
20920 @emph{Warning:} @code{gdbserver} does not have any built-in security.
20921 Do not run @code{gdbserver} connected to any public network; a
20922 @value{GDBN} connection to @code{gdbserver} provides access to the
20923 target system with the same privileges as the user running
20924 @code{gdbserver}.
20925 @end quotation
20926
20927 @anchor{Running gdbserver}
20928 @subsection Running @code{gdbserver}
20929 @cindex arguments, to @code{gdbserver}
20930 @cindex @code{gdbserver}, command-line arguments
20931
20932 Run @code{gdbserver} on the target system. You need a copy of the
20933 program you want to debug, including any libraries it requires.
20934 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
20935 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
20936 system does all the symbol handling.
20937
20938 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
20939 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The usual
20940 syntax is:
20941
20942 @smallexample
20943 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
20944 @end smallexample
20945
20946 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line), or a TCP
20947 hostname and portnumber, or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
20948 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}.
20949 For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
20950 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
20951 @file{/dev/com1}:
20952
20953 @smallexample
20954 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
20955 @end smallexample
20956
20957 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
20958 with it.
20959
20960 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
20961
20962 @smallexample
20963 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
20964 @end smallexample
20965
20966 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
20967 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
20968 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
20969 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
20970 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
20971 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
20972 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
20973 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
20974 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
20975 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
20976 @code{target remote} command.
20977
20978 The @code{stdio} connection is useful when starting @code{gdbserver}
20979 with ssh:
20980
20981 @smallexample
20982 (gdb) target remote | ssh -T hostname gdbserver - hello
20983 @end smallexample
20984
20985 The @samp{-T} option to ssh is provided because we don't need a remote pty,
20986 and we don't want escape-character handling. Ssh does this by default when
20987 a command is provided, the flag is provided to make it explicit.
20988 You could elide it if you want to.
20989
20990 Programs started with stdio-connected gdbserver have @file{/dev/null} for
20991 @code{stdin}, and @code{stdout},@code{stderr} are sent back to gdb for
20992 display through a pipe connected to gdbserver.
20993 Both @code{stdout} and @code{stderr} use the same pipe.
20994
20995 @anchor{Attaching to a program}
20996 @subsubsection Attaching to a Running Program
20997 @cindex attach to a program, @code{gdbserver}
20998 @cindex @option{--attach}, @code{gdbserver} option
20999
21000 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
21001 This is accomplished via the @code{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
21002
21003 @smallexample
21004 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
21005 @end smallexample
21006
21007 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
21008 necessary to point @code{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
21009
21010 In @code{target extended-remote} mode, you can also attach using the
21011 @value{GDBN} attach command
21012 (@pxref{Attaching in Types of Remote Connections}).
21013
21014 @pindex pidof
21015 You can debug processes by name instead of process ID if your target has the
21016 @code{pidof} utility:
21017
21018 @smallexample
21019 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} `pidof @var{program}`
21020 @end smallexample
21021
21022 In case more than one copy of @var{program} is running, or @var{program}
21023 has multiple threads, most versions of @code{pidof} support the
21024 @code{-s} option to only return the first process ID.
21025
21026 @subsubsection TCP port allocation lifecycle of @code{gdbserver}
21027
21028 This section applies only when @code{gdbserver} is run to listen on a TCP
21029 port.
21030
21031 @code{gdbserver} normally terminates after all of its debugged processes have
21032 terminated in @kbd{target remote} mode. On the other hand, for @kbd{target
21033 extended-remote}, @code{gdbserver} stays running even with no processes left.
21034 @value{GDBN} normally terminates the spawned debugged process on its exit,
21035 which normally also terminates @code{gdbserver} in the @kbd{target remote}
21036 mode. Therefore, when the connection drops unexpectedly, and @value{GDBN}
21037 cannot ask @code{gdbserver} to kill its debugged processes, @code{gdbserver}
21038 stays running even in the @kbd{target remote} mode.
21039
21040 When @code{gdbserver} stays running, @value{GDBN} can connect to it again later.
21041 Such reconnecting is useful for features like @ref{disconnected tracing}. For
21042 completeness, at most one @value{GDBN} can be connected at a time.
21043
21044 @cindex @option{--once}, @code{gdbserver} option
21045 By default, @code{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
21046 subsequent connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
21047 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
21048 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session. This
21049 means no further connections to @code{gdbserver} will be possible after the
21050 first one. It also means @code{gdbserver} will terminate after the first
21051 connection with remote @value{GDBN} has closed, even for unexpectedly closed
21052 connections and even in the @kbd{target extended-remote} mode. The
21053 @option{--once} option allows reusing the same port number for connecting to
21054 multiple instances of @code{gdbserver} running on the same host, since each
21055 instance closes its port after the first connection.
21056
21057 @anchor{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}
21058 @subsubsection Other Command-Line Arguments for @code{gdbserver}
21059
21060 You can use the @option{--multi} option to start @code{gdbserver} without
21061 specifying a program to debug or a process to attach to. Then you can
21062 attach in @code{target extended-remote} mode and run or attach to a
21063 program. For more information,
21064 @pxref{--multi Option in Types of Remote Connnections}.
21065
21066 @cindex @option{--debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
21067 The @option{--debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display extra
21068 status information about the debugging process.
21069 @cindex @option{--remote-debug}, @code{gdbserver} option
21070 The @option{--remote-debug} option tells @code{gdbserver} to display
21071 remote protocol debug output. These options are intended for
21072 @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to the developers.
21073
21074 @cindex @option{--debug-format}, @code{gdbserver} option
21075 The @option{--debug-format=option1[,option2,...]} option tells
21076 @code{gdbserver} to include additional information in each output.
21077 Possible options are:
21078
21079 @table @code
21080 @item none
21081 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
21082 @item all
21083 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
21084 @item timestamps
21085 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
21086 @end table
21087
21088 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
21089 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
21090
21091 @cindex @option{--wrapper}, @code{gdbserver} option
21092 The @option{--wrapper} option specifies a wrapper to launch programs
21093 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
21094 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
21095 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
21096
21097 @code{gdbserver} runs the specified wrapper program with a combined
21098 command line including the wrapper arguments, then the name of the
21099 program to debug, then any arguments to the program. The wrapper
21100 runs until it executes your program, and then @value{GDBN} gains control.
21101
21102 You can use any program that eventually calls @code{execve} with
21103 its arguments as a wrapper. Several standard Unix utilities do
21104 this, e.g.@: @code{env} and @code{nohup}. Any Unix shell script ending
21105 with @code{exec "$@@"} will also work.
21106
21107 For example, you can use @code{env} to pass an environment variable to
21108 the debugged program, without setting the variable in @code{gdbserver}'s
21109 environment:
21110
21111 @smallexample
21112 $ gdbserver --wrapper env LD_PRELOAD=libtest.so -- :2222 ./testprog
21113 @end smallexample
21114
21115 @cindex @option{--selftest}
21116 The @option{--selftest} option runs the self tests in @code{gdbserver}:
21117
21118 @smallexample
21119 $ gdbserver --selftest
21120 Ran 2 unit tests, 0 failed
21121 @end smallexample
21122
21123 These tests are disabled in release.
21124 @subsection Connecting to @code{gdbserver}
21125
21126 The basic procedure for connecting to the remote target is:
21127 @itemize
21128
21129 @item
21130 Run @value{GDBN} on the host system.
21131
21132 @item
21133 Make sure you have the necessary symbol files
21134 (@pxref{Host and target files}).
21135 Load symbols for your application using the @code{file} command before you
21136 connect. Use @code{set sysroot} to locate target libraries (unless your
21137 @value{GDBN} was compiled with the correct sysroot using
21138 @code{--with-sysroot}).
21139
21140 @item
21141 Connect to your target (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
21142 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
21143 the @code{target} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
21144 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
21145 @samp{Connection refused}. Don't use the @code{load}
21146 command in @value{GDBN} when using @code{target remote} mode, since the
21147 program is already on the target.
21148
21149 @end itemize
21150
21151 @anchor{Monitor Commands for gdbserver}
21152 @subsection Monitor Commands for @code{gdbserver}
21153 @cindex monitor commands, for @code{gdbserver}
21154
21155 During a @value{GDBN} session using @code{gdbserver}, you can use the
21156 @code{monitor} command to send special requests to @code{gdbserver}.
21157 Here are the available commands.
21158
21159 @table @code
21160 @item monitor help
21161 List the available monitor commands.
21162
21163 @item monitor set debug 0
21164 @itemx monitor set debug 1
21165 Disable or enable general debugging messages.
21166
21167 @item monitor set remote-debug 0
21168 @itemx monitor set remote-debug 1
21169 Disable or enable specific debugging messages associated with the remote
21170 protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}).
21171
21172 @item monitor set debug-format option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
21173 Specify additional text to add to debugging messages.
21174 Possible options are:
21175
21176 @table @code
21177 @item none
21178 Turn off all extra information in debugging output.
21179 @item all
21180 Turn on all extra information in debugging output.
21181 @item timestamps
21182 Include a timestamp in each line of debugging output.
21183 @end table
21184
21185 Options are processed in order. Thus, for example, if @option{none}
21186 appears last then no additional information is added to debugging output.
21187
21188 @item monitor set libthread-db-search-path [PATH]
21189 @cindex gdbserver, search path for @code{libthread_db}
21190 When this command is issued, @var{path} is a colon-separated list of
21191 directories to search for @code{libthread_db} (@pxref{Threads,,set
21192 libthread-db-search-path}). If you omit @var{path},
21193 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} will be reset to its default value.
21194
21195 The special entry @samp{$pdir} for @samp{libthread-db-search-path} is
21196 not supported in @code{gdbserver}.
21197
21198 @item monitor exit
21199 Tell gdbserver to exit immediately. This command should be followed by
21200 @code{disconnect} to close the debugging session. @code{gdbserver} will
21201 detach from any attached processes and kill any processes it created.
21202 Use @code{monitor exit} to terminate @code{gdbserver} at the end
21203 of a multi-process mode debug session.
21204
21205 @end table
21206
21207 @subsection Tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
21208 @cindex tracepoints support in @code{gdbserver}
21209
21210 On some targets, @code{gdbserver} supports tracepoints, fast
21211 tracepoints and static tracepoints.
21212
21213 For fast or static tracepoints to work, a special library called the
21214 @dfn{in-process agent} (IPA), must be loaded in the inferior process.
21215 This library is built and distributed as an integral part of
21216 @code{gdbserver}. In addition, support for static tracepoints
21217 requires building the in-process agent library with static tracepoints
21218 support. At present, the UST (LTTng Userspace Tracer,
21219 @url{http://lttng.org/ust}) tracing engine is supported. This support
21220 is automatically available if UST development headers are found in the
21221 standard include path when @code{gdbserver} is built, or if
21222 @code{gdbserver} was explicitly configured using @option{--with-ust}
21223 to point at such headers. You can explicitly disable the support
21224 using @option{--with-ust=no}.
21225
21226 There are several ways to load the in-process agent in your program:
21227
21228 @table @code
21229 @item Specifying it as dependency at link time
21230
21231 You can link your program dynamically with the in-process agent
21232 library. On most systems, this is accomplished by adding
21233 @code{-linproctrace} to the link command.
21234
21235 @item Using the system's preloading mechanisms
21236
21237 You can force loading the in-process agent at startup time by using
21238 your system's support for preloading shared libraries. Many Unixes
21239 support the concept of preloading user defined libraries. In most
21240 cases, you do that by specifying @code{LD_PRELOAD=libinproctrace.so}
21241 in the environment. See also the description of @code{gdbserver}'s
21242 @option{--wrapper} command line option.
21243
21244 @item Using @value{GDBN} to force loading the agent at run time
21245
21246 On some systems, you can force the inferior to load a shared library,
21247 by calling a dynamic loader function in the inferior that takes care
21248 of dynamically looking up and loading a shared library. On most Unix
21249 systems, the function is @code{dlopen}. You'll use the @code{call}
21250 command for that. For example:
21251
21252 @smallexample
21253 (@value{GDBP}) call dlopen ("libinproctrace.so", ...)
21254 @end smallexample
21255
21256 Note that on most Unix systems, for the @code{dlopen} function to be
21257 available, the program needs to be linked with @code{-ldl}.
21258 @end table
21259
21260 On systems that have a userspace dynamic loader, like most Unix
21261 systems, when you connect to @code{gdbserver} using @code{target
21262 remote}, you'll find that the program is stopped at the dynamic
21263 loader's entry point, and no shared library has been loaded in the
21264 program's address space yet, including the in-process agent. In that
21265 case, before being able to use any of the fast or static tracepoints
21266 features, you need to let the loader run and load the shared
21267 libraries. The simplest way to do that is to run the program to the
21268 main procedure. E.g., if debugging a C or C@t{++} program, start
21269 @code{gdbserver} like so:
21270
21271 @smallexample
21272 $ gdbserver :9999 myprogram
21273 @end smallexample
21274
21275 Start GDB and connect to @code{gdbserver} like so, and run to main:
21276
21277 @smallexample
21278 $ gdb myprogram
21279 (@value{GDBP}) target remote myhost:9999
21280 0x00007f215893ba60 in ?? () from /lib64/ld-linux-x86-64.so.2
21281 (@value{GDBP}) b main
21282 (@value{GDBP}) continue
21283 @end smallexample
21284
21285 The in-process tracing agent library should now be loaded into the
21286 process; you can confirm it with the @code{info sharedlibrary}
21287 command, which will list @file{libinproctrace.so} as loaded in the
21288 process. You are now ready to install fast tracepoints, list static
21289 tracepoint markers, probe static tracepoints markers, and start
21290 tracing.
21291
21292 @node Remote Configuration
21293 @section Remote Configuration
21294
21295 @kindex set remote
21296 @kindex show remote
21297 This section documents the configuration options available when
21298 debugging remote programs. For the options related to the File I/O
21299 extensions of the remote protocol, see @ref{system,
21300 system-call-allowed}.
21301
21302 @table @code
21303 @item set remoteaddresssize @var{bits}
21304 @cindex address size for remote targets
21305 @cindex bits in remote address
21306 Set the maximum size of address in a memory packet to the specified
21307 number of bits. @value{GDBN} will mask off the address bits above
21308 that number, when it passes addresses to the remote target. The
21309 default value is the number of bits in the target's address.
21310
21311 @item show remoteaddresssize
21312 Show the current value of remote address size in bits.
21313
21314 @item set serial baud @var{n}
21315 @cindex baud rate for remote targets
21316 Set the baud rate for the remote serial I/O to @var{n} baud. The
21317 value is used to set the speed of the serial port used for debugging
21318 remote targets.
21319
21320 @item show serial baud
21321 Show the current speed of the remote connection.
21322
21323 @item set serial parity @var{parity}
21324 Set the parity for the remote serial I/O. Supported values of @var{parity} are:
21325 @code{even}, @code{none}, and @code{odd}. The default is @code{none}.
21326
21327 @item show serial parity
21328 Show the current parity of the serial port.
21329
21330 @item set remotebreak
21331 @cindex interrupt remote programs
21332 @cindex BREAK signal instead of Ctrl-C
21333 @anchor{set remotebreak}
21334 If set to on, @value{GDBN} sends a @code{BREAK} signal to the remote
21335 when you type @kbd{Ctrl-c} to interrupt the program running
21336 on the remote. If set to off, @value{GDBN} sends the @samp{Ctrl-C}
21337 character instead. The default is off, since most remote systems
21338 expect to see @samp{Ctrl-C} as the interrupt signal.
21339
21340 @item show remotebreak
21341 Show whether @value{GDBN} sends @code{BREAK} or @samp{Ctrl-C} to
21342 interrupt the remote program.
21343
21344 @item set remoteflow on
21345 @itemx set remoteflow off
21346 @kindex set remoteflow
21347 Enable or disable hardware flow control (@code{RTS}/@code{CTS})
21348 on the serial port used to communicate to the remote target.
21349
21350 @item show remoteflow
21351 @kindex show remoteflow
21352 Show the current setting of hardware flow control.
21353
21354 @item set remotelogbase @var{base}
21355 Set the base (a.k.a.@: radix) of logging serial protocol
21356 communications to @var{base}. Supported values of @var{base} are:
21357 @code{ascii}, @code{octal}, and @code{hex}. The default is
21358 @code{ascii}.
21359
21360 @item show remotelogbase
21361 Show the current setting of the radix for logging remote serial
21362 protocol.
21363
21364 @item set remotelogfile @var{file}
21365 @cindex record serial communications on file
21366 Record remote serial communications on the named @var{file}. The
21367 default is not to record at all.
21368
21369 @item show remotelogfile.
21370 Show the current setting of the file name on which to record the
21371 serial communications.
21372
21373 @item set remotetimeout @var{num}
21374 @cindex timeout for serial communications
21375 @cindex remote timeout
21376 Set the timeout limit to wait for the remote target to respond to
21377 @var{num} seconds. The default is 2 seconds.
21378
21379 @item show remotetimeout
21380 Show the current number of seconds to wait for the remote target
21381 responses.
21382
21383 @cindex limit hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
21384 @cindex remote target, limit break- and watchpoints
21385 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit}
21386 @anchor{set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit}
21387 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit @var{limit}
21388 @itemx set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit @var{limit}
21389 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} remote hardware watchpoints
21390 or breakpoints. The @var{limit} can be set to 0 to disable hardware
21391 watchpoints or breakpoints, and @code{unlimited} for unlimited
21392 watchpoints or breakpoints.
21393
21394 @item show remote hardware-watchpoint-limit
21395 @itemx show remote hardware-breakpoint-limit
21396 Show the current limit for the number of hardware watchpoints or
21397 breakpoints that @value{GDBN} can use.
21398
21399 @cindex limit hardware watchpoints length
21400 @cindex remote target, limit watchpoints length
21401 @anchor{set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit}
21402 @item set remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit @var{limit}
21403 Restrict @value{GDBN} to using @var{limit} bytes for the maximum
21404 length of a remote hardware watchpoint. A @var{limit} of 0 disables
21405 hardware watchpoints and @code{unlimited} allows watchpoints of any
21406 length.
21407
21408 @item show remote hardware-watchpoint-length-limit
21409 Show the current limit (in bytes) of the maximum length of
21410 a remote hardware watchpoint.
21411
21412 @item set remote exec-file @var{filename}
21413 @itemx show remote exec-file
21414 @anchor{set remote exec-file}
21415 @cindex executable file, for remote target
21416 Select the file used for @code{run} with @code{target
21417 extended-remote}. This should be set to a filename valid on the
21418 target system. If it is not set, the target will use a default
21419 filename (e.g.@: the last program run).
21420
21421 @item set remote interrupt-sequence
21422 @cindex interrupt remote programs
21423 @cindex select Ctrl-C, BREAK or BREAK-g
21424 Allow the user to select one of @samp{Ctrl-C}, a @code{BREAK} or
21425 @samp{BREAK-g} as the
21426 sequence to the remote target in order to interrupt the execution.
21427 @samp{Ctrl-C} is a default. Some system prefers @code{BREAK} which
21428 is high level of serial line for some certain time.
21429 Linux kernel prefers @samp{BREAK-g}, a.k.a Magic SysRq g.
21430 It is @code{BREAK} signal followed by character @code{g}.
21431
21432 @item show interrupt-sequence
21433 Show which of @samp{Ctrl-C}, @code{BREAK} or @code{BREAK-g}
21434 is sent by @value{GDBN} to interrupt the remote program.
21435 @code{BREAK-g} is BREAK signal followed by @code{g} and
21436 also known as Magic SysRq g.
21437
21438 @item set remote interrupt-on-connect
21439 @cindex send interrupt-sequence on start
21440 Specify whether interrupt-sequence is sent to remote target when
21441 @value{GDBN} connects to it. This is mostly needed when you debug
21442 Linux kernel. Linux kernel expects @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}
21443 which is known as Magic SysRq g in order to connect @value{GDBN}.
21444
21445 @item show interrupt-on-connect
21446 Show whether interrupt-sequence is sent
21447 to remote target when @value{GDBN} connects to it.
21448
21449 @kindex set tcp
21450 @kindex show tcp
21451 @item set tcp auto-retry on
21452 @cindex auto-retry, for remote TCP target
21453 Enable auto-retry for remote TCP connections. This is useful if the remote
21454 debugging agent is launched in parallel with @value{GDBN}; there is a race
21455 condition because the agent may not become ready to accept the connection
21456 before @value{GDBN} attempts to connect. When auto-retry is
21457 enabled, if the initial attempt to connect fails, @value{GDBN} reattempts
21458 to establish the connection using the timeout specified by
21459 @code{set tcp connect-timeout}.
21460
21461 @item set tcp auto-retry off
21462 Do not auto-retry failed TCP connections.
21463
21464 @item show tcp auto-retry
21465 Show the current auto-retry setting.
21466
21467 @item set tcp connect-timeout @var{seconds}
21468 @itemx set tcp connect-timeout unlimited
21469 @cindex connection timeout, for remote TCP target
21470 @cindex timeout, for remote target connection
21471 Set the timeout for establishing a TCP connection to the remote target to
21472 @var{seconds}. The timeout affects both polling to retry failed connections
21473 (enabled by @code{set tcp auto-retry on}) and waiting for connections
21474 that are merely slow to complete, and represents an approximate cumulative
21475 value. If @var{seconds} is @code{unlimited}, there is no timeout and
21476 @value{GDBN} will keep attempting to establish a connection forever,
21477 unless interrupted with @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The default is 15 seconds.
21478
21479 @item show tcp connect-timeout
21480 Show the current connection timeout setting.
21481 @end table
21482
21483 @cindex remote packets, enabling and disabling
21484 The @value{GDBN} remote protocol autodetects the packets supported by
21485 your debugging stub. If you need to override the autodetection, you
21486 can use these commands to enable or disable individual packets. Each
21487 packet can be set to @samp{on} (the remote target supports this
21488 packet), @samp{off} (the remote target does not support this packet),
21489 or @samp{auto} (detect remote target support for this packet). They
21490 all default to @samp{auto}. For more information about each packet,
21491 see @ref{Remote Protocol}.
21492
21493 During normal use, you should not have to use any of these commands.
21494 If you do, that may be a bug in your remote debugging stub, or a bug
21495 in @value{GDBN}. You may want to report the problem to the
21496 @value{GDBN} developers.
21497
21498 For each packet @var{name}, the command to enable or disable the
21499 packet is @code{set remote @var{name}-packet}. The available settings
21500 are:
21501
21502 @multitable @columnfractions 0.28 0.32 0.25
21503 @item Command Name
21504 @tab Remote Packet
21505 @tab Related Features
21506
21507 @item @code{fetch-register}
21508 @tab @code{p}
21509 @tab @code{info registers}
21510
21511 @item @code{set-register}
21512 @tab @code{P}
21513 @tab @code{set}
21514
21515 @item @code{binary-download}
21516 @tab @code{X}
21517 @tab @code{load}, @code{set}
21518
21519 @item @code{read-aux-vector}
21520 @tab @code{qXfer:auxv:read}
21521 @tab @code{info auxv}
21522
21523 @item @code{symbol-lookup}
21524 @tab @code{qSymbol}
21525 @tab Detecting multiple threads
21526
21527 @item @code{attach}
21528 @tab @code{vAttach}
21529 @tab @code{attach}
21530
21531 @item @code{verbose-resume}
21532 @tab @code{vCont}
21533 @tab Stepping or resuming multiple threads
21534
21535 @item @code{run}
21536 @tab @code{vRun}
21537 @tab @code{run}
21538
21539 @item @code{software-breakpoint}
21540 @tab @code{Z0}
21541 @tab @code{break}
21542
21543 @item @code{hardware-breakpoint}
21544 @tab @code{Z1}
21545 @tab @code{hbreak}
21546
21547 @item @code{write-watchpoint}
21548 @tab @code{Z2}
21549 @tab @code{watch}
21550
21551 @item @code{read-watchpoint}
21552 @tab @code{Z3}
21553 @tab @code{rwatch}
21554
21555 @item @code{access-watchpoint}
21556 @tab @code{Z4}
21557 @tab @code{awatch}
21558
21559 @item @code{pid-to-exec-file}
21560 @tab @code{qXfer:exec-file:read}
21561 @tab @code{attach}, @code{run}
21562
21563 @item @code{target-features}
21564 @tab @code{qXfer:features:read}
21565 @tab @code{set architecture}
21566
21567 @item @code{library-info}
21568 @tab @code{qXfer:libraries:read}
21569 @tab @code{info sharedlibrary}
21570
21571 @item @code{memory-map}
21572 @tab @code{qXfer:memory-map:read}
21573 @tab @code{info mem}
21574
21575 @item @code{read-sdata-object}
21576 @tab @code{qXfer:sdata:read}
21577 @tab @code{print $_sdata}
21578
21579 @item @code{read-spu-object}
21580 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:read}
21581 @tab @code{info spu}
21582
21583 @item @code{write-spu-object}
21584 @tab @code{qXfer:spu:write}
21585 @tab @code{info spu}
21586
21587 @item @code{read-siginfo-object}
21588 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:read}
21589 @tab @code{print $_siginfo}
21590
21591 @item @code{write-siginfo-object}
21592 @tab @code{qXfer:siginfo:write}
21593 @tab @code{set $_siginfo}
21594
21595 @item @code{threads}
21596 @tab @code{qXfer:threads:read}
21597 @tab @code{info threads}
21598
21599 @item @code{get-thread-local-@*storage-address}
21600 @tab @code{qGetTLSAddr}
21601 @tab Displaying @code{__thread} variables
21602
21603 @item @code{get-thread-information-block-address}
21604 @tab @code{qGetTIBAddr}
21605 @tab Display MS-Windows Thread Information Block.
21606
21607 @item @code{search-memory}
21608 @tab @code{qSearch:memory}
21609 @tab @code{find}
21610
21611 @item @code{supported-packets}
21612 @tab @code{qSupported}
21613 @tab Remote communications parameters
21614
21615 @item @code{catch-syscalls}
21616 @tab @code{QCatchSyscalls}
21617 @tab @code{catch syscall}
21618
21619 @item @code{pass-signals}
21620 @tab @code{QPassSignals}
21621 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
21622
21623 @item @code{program-signals}
21624 @tab @code{QProgramSignals}
21625 @tab @code{handle @var{signal}}
21626
21627 @item @code{hostio-close-packet}
21628 @tab @code{vFile:close}
21629 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
21630
21631 @item @code{hostio-open-packet}
21632 @tab @code{vFile:open}
21633 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
21634
21635 @item @code{hostio-pread-packet}
21636 @tab @code{vFile:pread}
21637 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
21638
21639 @item @code{hostio-pwrite-packet}
21640 @tab @code{vFile:pwrite}
21641 @tab @code{remote get}, @code{remote put}
21642
21643 @item @code{hostio-unlink-packet}
21644 @tab @code{vFile:unlink}
21645 @tab @code{remote delete}
21646
21647 @item @code{hostio-readlink-packet}
21648 @tab @code{vFile:readlink}
21649 @tab Host I/O
21650
21651 @item @code{hostio-fstat-packet}
21652 @tab @code{vFile:fstat}
21653 @tab Host I/O
21654
21655 @item @code{hostio-setfs-packet}
21656 @tab @code{vFile:setfs}
21657 @tab Host I/O
21658
21659 @item @code{noack-packet}
21660 @tab @code{QStartNoAckMode}
21661 @tab Packet acknowledgment
21662
21663 @item @code{osdata}
21664 @tab @code{qXfer:osdata:read}
21665 @tab @code{info os}
21666
21667 @item @code{query-attached}
21668 @tab @code{qAttached}
21669 @tab Querying remote process attach state.
21670
21671 @item @code{trace-buffer-size}
21672 @tab @code{QTBuffer:size}
21673 @tab @code{set trace-buffer-size}
21674
21675 @item @code{trace-status}
21676 @tab @code{qTStatus}
21677 @tab @code{tstatus}
21678
21679 @item @code{traceframe-info}
21680 @tab @code{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
21681 @tab Traceframe info
21682
21683 @item @code{install-in-trace}
21684 @tab @code{InstallInTrace}
21685 @tab Install tracepoint in tracing
21686
21687 @item @code{disable-randomization}
21688 @tab @code{QDisableRandomization}
21689 @tab @code{set disable-randomization}
21690
21691 @item @code{startup-with-shell}
21692 @tab @code{QStartupWithShell}
21693 @tab @code{set startup-with-shell}
21694
21695 @item @code{environment-hex-encoded}
21696 @tab @code{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}
21697 @tab @code{set environment}
21698
21699 @item @code{environment-unset}
21700 @tab @code{QEnvironmentUnset}
21701 @tab @code{unset environment}
21702
21703 @item @code{environment-reset}
21704 @tab @code{QEnvironmentReset}
21705 @tab @code{Reset the inferior environment (i.e., unset user-set variables)}
21706
21707 @item @code{set-working-dir}
21708 @tab @code{QSetWorkingDir}
21709 @tab @code{set cwd}
21710
21711 @item @code{conditional-breakpoints-packet}
21712 @tab @code{Z0 and Z1}
21713 @tab @code{Support for target-side breakpoint condition evaluation}
21714
21715 @item @code{multiprocess-extensions}
21716 @tab @code{multiprocess extensions}
21717 @tab Debug multiple processes and remote process PID awareness
21718
21719 @item @code{swbreak-feature}
21720 @tab @code{swbreak stop reason}
21721 @tab @code{break}
21722
21723 @item @code{hwbreak-feature}
21724 @tab @code{hwbreak stop reason}
21725 @tab @code{hbreak}
21726
21727 @item @code{fork-event-feature}
21728 @tab @code{fork stop reason}
21729 @tab @code{fork}
21730
21731 @item @code{vfork-event-feature}
21732 @tab @code{vfork stop reason}
21733 @tab @code{vfork}
21734
21735 @item @code{exec-event-feature}
21736 @tab @code{exec stop reason}
21737 @tab @code{exec}
21738
21739 @item @code{thread-events}
21740 @tab @code{QThreadEvents}
21741 @tab Tracking thread lifetime.
21742
21743 @item @code{no-resumed-stop-reply}
21744 @tab @code{no resumed thread left stop reply}
21745 @tab Tracking thread lifetime.
21746
21747 @end multitable
21748
21749 @node Remote Stub
21750 @section Implementing a Remote Stub
21751
21752 @cindex debugging stub, example
21753 @cindex remote stub, example
21754 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
21755 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
21756 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
21757 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
21758 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
21759 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
21760 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
21761 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
21762
21763 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
21764 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
21765 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
21766 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
21767 program, you need:
21768
21769 @enumerate
21770 @item
21771 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
21772 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
21773 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
21774
21775 @item
21776 A C subroutine library to support your program's
21777 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
21778
21779 @item
21780 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
21781 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
21782 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
21783 documentation.
21784 @end enumerate
21785
21786 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
21787 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
21788 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
21789
21790 @table @emph
21791 @item On the host,
21792 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
21793 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
21794 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
21795
21796 @item On the target,
21797 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
21798 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
21799 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
21800
21801 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
21802 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
21803 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} Program}, for details.
21804 @end table
21805
21806 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
21807 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
21808 @sc{sparc} boards.
21809
21810 @cindex remote serial stub list
21811 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
21812
21813 @table @code
21814
21815 @item i386-stub.c
21816 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
21817 @cindex Intel
21818 @cindex i386
21819 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
21820
21821 @item m68k-stub.c
21822 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
21823 @cindex Motorola 680x0
21824 @cindex m680x0
21825 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
21826
21827 @item sh-stub.c
21828 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
21829 @cindex Renesas
21830 @cindex SH
21831 For Renesas SH architectures.
21832
21833 @item sparc-stub.c
21834 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
21835 @cindex Sparc
21836 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
21837
21838 @item sparcl-stub.c
21839 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
21840 @cindex Fujitsu
21841 @cindex SparcLite
21842 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
21843
21844 @end table
21845
21846 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
21847 recently added stubs.
21848
21849 @menu
21850 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
21851 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
21852 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
21853 @end menu
21854
21855 @node Stub Contents
21856 @subsection What the Stub Can Do for You
21857
21858 @cindex remote serial stub
21859 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
21860 subroutines:
21861
21862 @table @code
21863 @item set_debug_traps
21864 @findex set_debug_traps
21865 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
21866 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
21867 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly in your
21868 program's startup code.
21869
21870 @item handle_exception
21871 @findex handle_exception
21872 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
21873 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
21874 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
21875 run when a trap is triggered.
21876
21877 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
21878 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
21879 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
21880 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
21881 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
21882 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
21883 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
21884 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
21885 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
21886 machine.
21887
21888 @item breakpoint
21889 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
21890 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
21891 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
21892 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
21893 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
21894 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
21895 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
21896 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
21897 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
21898 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
21899 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
21900
21901 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
21902 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
21903 start of your debugging session.
21904 @end table
21905
21906 @node Bootstrapping
21907 @subsection What You Must Do for the Stub
21908
21909 @cindex remote stub, support routines
21910 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
21911 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
21912 debugging target machine.
21913
21914 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
21915 serial port.
21916
21917 @table @code
21918 @item int getDebugChar()
21919 @findex getDebugChar
21920 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
21921 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
21922 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
21923
21924 @item void putDebugChar(int)
21925 @findex putDebugChar
21926 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
21927 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
21928 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
21929 @end table
21930
21931 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
21932 @cindex interrupting remote targets
21933 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
21934 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
21935 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
21936 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
21937 remote system to stop.
21938
21939 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
21940 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
21941 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
21942 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
21943
21944 Other routines you need to supply are:
21945
21946 @table @code
21947 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
21948 @findex exceptionHandler
21949 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
21950 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
21951 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
21952 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
21953 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
21954 The @var{exception_number} specifies the exception which should be changed;
21955 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
21956 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
21957 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
21958 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
21959 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
21960 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
21961 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
21962
21963 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
21964 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
21965 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
21966 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
21967 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
21968
21969 @item void flush_i_cache()
21970 @findex flush_i_cache
21971 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
21972 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
21973 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
21974
21975 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
21976 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
21977 @end table
21978
21979 @noindent
21980 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
21981
21982 @table @code
21983 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
21984 @findex memset
21985 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
21986 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
21987 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
21988 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
21989 @end table
21990
21991 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
21992 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
21993 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
21994 subroutines which @code{@value{NGCC}} generates as inline code.
21995
21996
21997 @node Debug Session
21998 @subsection Putting it All Together
21999
22000 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
22001 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
22002 steps.
22003
22004 @enumerate
22005 @item
22006 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
22007 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What You Must Do for the Stub}):
22008 @display
22009 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
22010 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
22011 @end display
22012
22013 @item
22014 Insert these lines in your program's startup code, before the main
22015 procedure is called:
22016
22017 @smallexample
22018 set_debug_traps();
22019 breakpoint();
22020 @end smallexample
22021
22022 On some machines, when a breakpoint trap is raised, the hardware
22023 automatically makes the PC point to the instruction after the
22024 breakpoint. If your machine doesn't do that, you may need to adjust
22025 @code{handle_exception} to arrange for it to return to the instruction
22026 after the breakpoint on this first invocation, so that your program
22027 doesn't keep hitting the initial breakpoint instead of making
22028 progress.
22029
22030 @item
22031 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
22032 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
22033
22034 @smallexample
22035 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
22036 @end smallexample
22037
22038 @noindent
22039 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
22040 function in your program, that function is called when
22041 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
22042 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
22043 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
22044
22045 @item
22046 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
22047 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
22048
22049 @item
22050 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
22051 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
22052
22053 @item
22054 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
22055 @c document that. FIXME.
22056 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
22057 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
22058
22059 @item
22060 Start @value{GDBN} on the host, and connect to the target
22061 (@pxref{Connecting,,Connecting to a Remote Target}).
22062
22063 @end enumerate
22064
22065 @node Configurations
22066 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
22067
22068 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
22069 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
22070 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
22071
22072 There are three major categories of configurations: native
22073 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
22074 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
22075 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
22076 are quite different from each other.
22077
22078 @menu
22079 * Native::
22080 * Embedded OS::
22081 * Embedded Processors::
22082 * Architectures::
22083 @end menu
22084
22085 @node Native
22086 @section Native
22087
22088 This section describes details specific to particular native
22089 configurations.
22090
22091 @menu
22092 * BSD libkvm Interface:: Debugging BSD kernel memory images
22093 * Process Information:: Process information
22094 * DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
22095 * Cygwin Native:: Features specific to the Cygwin port
22096 * Hurd Native:: Features specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd
22097 * Darwin:: Features specific to Darwin
22098 @end menu
22099
22100 @node BSD libkvm Interface
22101 @subsection BSD libkvm Interface
22102
22103 @cindex libkvm
22104 @cindex kernel memory image
22105 @cindex kernel crash dump
22106
22107 BSD-derived systems (FreeBSD/NetBSD/OpenBSD) have a kernel memory
22108 interface that provides a uniform interface for accessing kernel virtual
22109 memory images, including live systems and crash dumps. @value{GDBN}
22110 uses this interface to allow you to debug live kernels and kernel crash
22111 dumps on many native BSD configurations. This is implemented as a
22112 special @code{kvm} debugging target. For debugging a live system, load
22113 the currently running kernel into @value{GDBN} and connect to the
22114 @code{kvm} target:
22115
22116 @smallexample
22117 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm}
22118 @end smallexample
22119
22120 For debugging crash dumps, provide the file name of the crash dump as an
22121 argument:
22122
22123 @smallexample
22124 (@value{GDBP}) @b{target kvm /var/crash/bsd.0}
22125 @end smallexample
22126
22127 Once connected to the @code{kvm} target, the following commands are
22128 available:
22129
22130 @table @code
22131 @kindex kvm
22132 @item kvm pcb
22133 Set current context from the @dfn{Process Control Block} (PCB) address.
22134
22135 @item kvm proc
22136 Set current context from proc address. This command isn't available on
22137 modern FreeBSD systems.
22138 @end table
22139
22140 @node Process Information
22141 @subsection Process Information
22142 @cindex /proc
22143 @cindex examine process image
22144 @cindex process info via @file{/proc}
22145
22146 Some operating systems provide interfaces to fetch additional
22147 information about running processes beyond memory and per-thread
22148 register state. If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system
22149 with a supported interface, the command @code{info proc} is available
22150 to report information about the process running your program, or about
22151 any process running on your system.
22152
22153 One supported interface is a facility called @samp{/proc} that can be
22154 used to examine the image of a running process using file-system
22155 subroutines. This facility is supported on @sc{gnu}/Linux and Solaris
22156 systems.
22157
22158 On FreeBSD systems, system control nodes are used to query process
22159 information.
22160
22161 In addition, some systems may provide additional process information
22162 in core files. Note that a core file may include a subset of the
22163 information available from a live process. Process information is
22164 currently avaiable from cores created on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD
22165 systems.
22166
22167 @table @code
22168 @kindex info proc
22169 @cindex process ID
22170 @item info proc
22171 @itemx info proc @var{process-id}
22172 Summarize available information about any running process. If a
22173 process ID is specified by @var{process-id}, display information about
22174 that process; otherwise display information about the program being
22175 debugged. The summary includes the debugged process ID, the command
22176 line used to invoke it, its current working directory, and its
22177 executable file's absolute file name.
22178
22179 On some systems, @var{process-id} can be of the form
22180 @samp{[@var{pid}]/@var{tid}} which specifies a certain thread ID
22181 within a process. If the optional @var{pid} part is missing, it means
22182 a thread from the process being debugged (the leading @samp{/} still
22183 needs to be present, or else @value{GDBN} will interpret the number as
22184 a process ID rather than a thread ID).
22185
22186 @item info proc cmdline
22187 @cindex info proc cmdline
22188 Show the original command line of the process. This command is
22189 supported on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD.
22190
22191 @item info proc cwd
22192 @cindex info proc cwd
22193 Show the current working directory of the process. This command is
22194 supported on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD.
22195
22196 @item info proc exe
22197 @cindex info proc exe
22198 Show the name of executable of the process. This command is supported
22199 on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD.
22200
22201 @item info proc mappings
22202 @cindex memory address space mappings
22203 Report the memory address space ranges accessible in the program. On
22204 Solaris and FreeBSD systems, each memory range includes information on
22205 whether the process has read, write, or execute access rights to each
22206 range. On @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD systems, each memory range
22207 includes the object file which is mapped to that range.
22208
22209 @item info proc stat
22210 @itemx info proc status
22211 @cindex process detailed status information
22212 Show additional process-related information, including the user ID and
22213 group ID; virtual memory usage; the signals that are pending, blocked,
22214 and ignored; its TTY; its consumption of system and user time; its
22215 stack size; its @samp{nice} value; etc. These commands are supported
22216 on @sc{gnu}/Linux and FreeBSD.
22217
22218 For @sc{gnu}/Linux systems, see the @samp{proc} man page for more
22219 information (type @kbd{man 5 proc} from your shell prompt).
22220
22221 For FreeBSD systems, @code{info proc stat} is an alias for @code{info
22222 proc status}.
22223
22224 @item info proc all
22225 Show all the information about the process described under all of the
22226 above @code{info proc} subcommands.
22227
22228 @ignore
22229 @comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
22230 @comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
22231 @comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
22232 @kindex info proc times
22233 @item info proc times
22234 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
22235 its children.
22236
22237 @kindex info proc id
22238 @item info proc id
22239 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
22240 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
22241 @end ignore
22242
22243 @item set procfs-trace
22244 @kindex set procfs-trace
22245 @cindex @code{procfs} API calls
22246 This command enables and disables tracing of @code{procfs} API calls.
22247
22248 @item show procfs-trace
22249 @kindex show procfs-trace
22250 Show the current state of @code{procfs} API call tracing.
22251
22252 @item set procfs-file @var{file}
22253 @kindex set procfs-file
22254 Tell @value{GDBN} to write @code{procfs} API trace to the named
22255 @var{file}. @value{GDBN} appends the trace info to the previous
22256 contents of the file. The default is to display the trace on the
22257 standard output.
22258
22259 @item show procfs-file
22260 @kindex show procfs-file
22261 Show the file to which @code{procfs} API trace is written.
22262
22263 @item proc-trace-entry
22264 @itemx proc-trace-exit
22265 @itemx proc-untrace-entry
22266 @itemx proc-untrace-exit
22267 @kindex proc-trace-entry
22268 @kindex proc-trace-exit
22269 @kindex proc-untrace-entry
22270 @kindex proc-untrace-exit
22271 These commands enable and disable tracing of entries into and exits
22272 from the @code{syscall} interface.
22273
22274 @item info pidlist
22275 @kindex info pidlist
22276 @cindex process list, QNX Neutrino
22277 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all the
22278 processes and all the threads within each process.
22279
22280 @item info meminfo
22281 @kindex info meminfo
22282 @cindex mapinfo list, QNX Neutrino
22283 For QNX Neutrino only, this command displays the list of all mapinfos.
22284 @end table
22285
22286 @node DJGPP Native
22287 @subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
22288 @cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
22289 @cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
22290 @cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
22291
22292 @cindex DPMI
22293 @sc{djgpp} is a port of the @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
22294 MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
22295 that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
22296 top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
22297
22298 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
22299 defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
22300 subsection describes those commands.
22301
22302 @table @code
22303 @kindex info dos
22304 @item info dos
22305 This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
22306 information about the target system and important OS structures.
22307
22308 @kindex sysinfo
22309 @cindex MS-DOS system info
22310 @cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
22311 @item info dos sysinfo
22312 This command displays assorted information about the underlying
22313 platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
22314 DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
22315
22316 @cindex GDT
22317 @cindex LDT
22318 @cindex IDT
22319 @cindex segment descriptor tables
22320 @cindex descriptor tables display
22321 @item info dos gdt
22322 @itemx info dos ldt
22323 @itemx info dos idt
22324 These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
22325 and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
22326 tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
22327 that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
22328 descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
22329 descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
22330 rights.
22331
22332 A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
22333 segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
22334 allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
22335 conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
22336 additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
22337
22338 @cindex garbled pointers
22339 These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
22340 Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
22341 displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
22342 display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
22343 example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
22344 debugged program's data segment:
22345
22346 @smallexample
22347 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
22348 @exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
22349 @end smallexample
22350
22351 @noindent
22352 This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
22353 the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
22354
22355 @cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
22356 @item info dos pde
22357 @itemx info dos pte
22358 These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
22359 Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
22360 data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
22361 into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
22362 page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
22363 may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
22364 Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
22365 that is currently in use.
22366
22367 Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
22368 Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
22369 the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
22370 @kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
22371 Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
22372 means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
22373 the specified entry in the Page Directory.
22374
22375 @cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
22376 These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
22377 Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
22378 controller.
22379
22380 These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
22381
22382 @cindex physical address from linear address
22383 @item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
22384 This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
22385 address. The argument @var{addr} is a linear address which should
22386 already have the appropriate segment's base address added to it,
22387 because this command accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any}
22388 segment. For example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for
22389 the page where a variable @code{i} is stored:
22390
22391 @smallexample
22392 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
22393 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
22394 @exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
22395 @end smallexample
22396
22397 @noindent
22398 This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
22399 whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and shows all the
22400 attributes of that page.
22401
22402 Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
22403 since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
22404 address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
22405 be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
22406 declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
22407 @code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
22408
22409 Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
22410 transfer buffer:
22411
22412 @smallexample
22413 @exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
22414 @exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
22415 @exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
22416 @end smallexample
22417
22418 @noindent
22419 (The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
22420 3rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output
22421 clearly shows that this DPMI server maps the addresses in conventional
22422 memory 1:1, i.e.@: the physical (@code{0x00029000} + @code{0x110}) and
22423 linear (@code{0x29110}) addresses are identical.
22424
22425 This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
22426 @end table
22427
22428 @cindex DOS serial data link, remote debugging
22429 In addition to native debugging, the DJGPP port supports remote
22430 debugging via a serial data link. The following commands are specific
22431 to remote serial debugging in the DJGPP port of @value{GDBN}.
22432
22433 @table @code
22434 @kindex set com1base
22435 @kindex set com1irq
22436 @kindex set com2base
22437 @kindex set com2irq
22438 @kindex set com3base
22439 @kindex set com3irq
22440 @kindex set com4base
22441 @kindex set com4irq
22442 @item set com1base @var{addr}
22443 This command sets the base I/O port address of the @file{COM1} serial
22444 port.
22445
22446 @item set com1irq @var{irq}
22447 This command sets the @dfn{Interrupt Request} (@code{IRQ}) line to use
22448 for the @file{COM1} serial port.
22449
22450 There are similar commands @samp{set com2base}, @samp{set com3irq},
22451 etc.@: for setting the port address and the @code{IRQ} lines for the
22452 other 3 COM ports.
22453
22454 @kindex show com1base
22455 @kindex show com1irq
22456 @kindex show com2base
22457 @kindex show com2irq
22458 @kindex show com3base
22459 @kindex show com3irq
22460 @kindex show com4base
22461 @kindex show com4irq
22462 The related commands @samp{show com1base}, @samp{show com1irq} etc.@:
22463 display the current settings of the base address and the @code{IRQ}
22464 lines used by the COM ports.
22465
22466 @item info serial
22467 @kindex info serial
22468 @cindex DOS serial port status
22469 This command prints the status of the 4 DOS serial ports. For each
22470 port, it prints whether it's active or not, its I/O base address and
22471 IRQ number, whether it uses a 16550-style FIFO, its baudrate, and the
22472 counts of various errors encountered so far.
22473 @end table
22474
22475
22476 @node Cygwin Native
22477 @subsection Features for Debugging MS Windows PE Executables
22478 @cindex MS Windows debugging
22479 @cindex native Cygwin debugging
22480 @cindex Cygwin-specific commands
22481
22482 @value{GDBN} supports native debugging of MS Windows programs, including
22483 DLLs with and without symbolic debugging information.
22484
22485 @cindex Ctrl-BREAK, MS-Windows
22486 @cindex interrupt debuggee on MS-Windows
22487 MS-Windows programs that call @code{SetConsoleMode} to switch off the
22488 special meaning of the @samp{Ctrl-C} keystroke cannot be interrupted
22489 by typing @kbd{C-c}. For this reason, @value{GDBN} on MS-Windows
22490 supports @kbd{C-@key{BREAK}} as an alternative interrupt key
22491 sequence, which can be used to interrupt the debuggee even if it
22492 ignores @kbd{C-c}.
22493
22494 There are various additional Cygwin-specific commands, described in
22495 this section. Working with DLLs that have no debugging symbols is
22496 described in @ref{Non-debug DLL Symbols}.
22497
22498 @table @code
22499 @kindex info w32
22500 @item info w32
22501 This is a prefix of MS Windows-specific commands which print
22502 information about the target system and important OS structures.
22503
22504 @item info w32 selector
22505 This command displays information returned by
22506 the Win32 API @code{GetThreadSelectorEntry} function.
22507 It takes an optional argument that is evaluated to
22508 a long value to give the information about this given selector.
22509 Without argument, this command displays information
22510 about the six segment registers.
22511
22512 @item info w32 thread-information-block
22513 This command displays thread specific information stored in the
22514 Thread Information Block (readable on the X86 CPU family using @code{$fs}
22515 selector for 32-bit programs and @code{$gs} for 64-bit programs).
22516
22517 @kindex signal-event
22518 @item signal-event @var{id}
22519 This command signals an event with user-provided @var{id}. Used to resume
22520 crashing process when attached to it using MS-Windows JIT debugging (AeDebug).
22521
22522 To use it, create or edit the following keys in
22523 @code{HKLM\SOFTWARE\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\AeDebug} and/or
22524 @code{HKLM\SOFTWARE\Wow6432Node\Microsoft\Windows NT\CurrentVersion\AeDebug}
22525 (for x86_64 versions):
22526
22527 @itemize @minus
22528 @item
22529 @code{Debugger} (REG_SZ) --- a command to launch the debugger.
22530 Suggested command is: @code{@var{fully-qualified-path-to-gdb.exe} -ex
22531 "attach %ld" -ex "signal-event %ld" -ex "continue"}.
22532
22533 The first @code{%ld} will be replaced by the process ID of the
22534 crashing process, the second @code{%ld} will be replaced by the ID of
22535 the event that blocks the crashing process, waiting for @value{GDBN}
22536 to attach.
22537
22538 @item
22539 @code{Auto} (REG_SZ) --- either @code{1} or @code{0}. @code{1} will
22540 make the system run debugger specified by the Debugger key
22541 automatically, @code{0} will cause a dialog box with ``OK'' and
22542 ``Cancel'' buttons to appear, which allows the user to either
22543 terminate the crashing process (OK) or debug it (Cancel).
22544 @end itemize
22545
22546 @kindex set cygwin-exceptions
22547 @cindex debugging the Cygwin DLL
22548 @cindex Cygwin DLL, debugging
22549 @item set cygwin-exceptions @var{mode}
22550 If @var{mode} is @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that
22551 happen inside the Cygwin DLL. If @var{mode} is @code{off},
22552 @value{GDBN} will delay recognition of exceptions, and may ignore some
22553 exceptions which seem to be caused by internal Cygwin DLL
22554 ``bookkeeping''. This option is meant primarily for debugging the
22555 Cygwin DLL itself; the default value is @code{off} to avoid annoying
22556 @value{GDBN} users with false @code{SIGSEGV} signals.
22557
22558 @kindex show cygwin-exceptions
22559 @item show cygwin-exceptions
22560 Displays whether @value{GDBN} will break on exceptions that happen
22561 inside the Cygwin DLL itself.
22562
22563 @kindex set new-console
22564 @item set new-console @var{mode}
22565 If @var{mode} is @code{on} the debuggee will
22566 be started in a new console on next start.
22567 If @var{mode} is @code{off}, the debuggee will
22568 be started in the same console as the debugger.
22569
22570 @kindex show new-console
22571 @item show new-console
22572 Displays whether a new console is used
22573 when the debuggee is started.
22574
22575 @kindex set new-group
22576 @item set new-group @var{mode}
22577 This boolean value controls whether the debuggee should
22578 start a new group or stay in the same group as the debugger.
22579 This affects the way the Windows OS handles
22580 @samp{Ctrl-C}.
22581
22582 @kindex show new-group
22583 @item show new-group
22584 Displays current value of new-group boolean.
22585
22586 @kindex set debugevents
22587 @item set debugevents
22588 This boolean value adds debug output concerning kernel events related
22589 to the debuggee seen by the debugger. This includes events that
22590 signal thread and process creation and exit, DLL loading and
22591 unloading, console interrupts, and debugging messages produced by the
22592 Windows @code{OutputDebugString} API call.
22593
22594 @kindex set debugexec
22595 @item set debugexec
22596 This boolean value adds debug output concerning execute events
22597 (such as resume thread) seen by the debugger.
22598
22599 @kindex set debugexceptions
22600 @item set debugexceptions
22601 This boolean value adds debug output concerning exceptions in the
22602 debuggee seen by the debugger.
22603
22604 @kindex set debugmemory
22605 @item set debugmemory
22606 This boolean value adds debug output concerning debuggee memory reads
22607 and writes by the debugger.
22608
22609 @kindex set shell
22610 @item set shell
22611 This boolean values specifies whether the debuggee is called
22612 via a shell or directly (default value is on).
22613
22614 @kindex show shell
22615 @item show shell
22616 Displays if the debuggee will be started with a shell.
22617
22618 @end table
22619
22620 @menu
22621 * Non-debug DLL Symbols:: Support for DLLs without debugging symbols
22622 @end menu
22623
22624 @node Non-debug DLL Symbols
22625 @subsubsection Support for DLLs without Debugging Symbols
22626 @cindex DLLs with no debugging symbols
22627 @cindex Minimal symbols and DLLs
22628
22629 Very often on windows, some of the DLLs that your program relies on do
22630 not include symbolic debugging information (for example,
22631 @file{kernel32.dll}). When @value{GDBN} doesn't recognize any debugging
22632 symbols in a DLL, it relies on the minimal amount of symbolic
22633 information contained in the DLL's export table. This section
22634 describes working with such symbols, known internally to @value{GDBN} as
22635 ``minimal symbols''.
22636
22637 Note that before the debugged program has started execution, no DLLs
22638 will have been loaded. The easiest way around this problem is simply to
22639 start the program --- either by setting a breakpoint or letting the
22640 program run once to completion.
22641
22642 @subsubsection DLL Name Prefixes
22643
22644 In keeping with the naming conventions used by the Microsoft debugging
22645 tools, DLL export symbols are made available with a prefix based on the
22646 DLL name, for instance @code{KERNEL32!CreateFileA}. The plain name is
22647 also entered into the symbol table, so @code{CreateFileA} is often
22648 sufficient. In some cases there will be name clashes within a program
22649 (particularly if the executable itself includes full debugging symbols)
22650 necessitating the use of the fully qualified name when referring to the
22651 contents of the DLL. Use single-quotes around the name to avoid the
22652 exclamation mark (``!'') being interpreted as a language operator.
22653
22654 Note that the internal name of the DLL may be all upper-case, even
22655 though the file name of the DLL is lower-case, or vice-versa. Since
22656 symbols within @value{GDBN} are @emph{case-sensitive} this may cause
22657 some confusion. If in doubt, try the @code{info functions} and
22658 @code{info variables} commands or even @code{maint print msymbols}
22659 (@pxref{Symbols}). Here's an example:
22660
22661 @smallexample
22662 (@value{GDBP}) info function CreateFileA
22663 All functions matching regular expression "CreateFileA":
22664
22665 Non-debugging symbols:
22666 0x77e885f4 CreateFileA
22667 0x77e885f4 KERNEL32!CreateFileA
22668 @end smallexample
22669
22670 @smallexample
22671 (@value{GDBP}) info function !
22672 All functions matching regular expression "!":
22673
22674 Non-debugging symbols:
22675 0x6100114c cygwin1!__assert
22676 0x61004034 cygwin1!_dll_crt0@@0
22677 0x61004240 cygwin1!dll_crt0(per_process *)
22678 [etc...]
22679 @end smallexample
22680
22681 @subsubsection Working with Minimal Symbols
22682
22683 Symbols extracted from a DLL's export table do not contain very much
22684 type information. All that @value{GDBN} can do is guess whether a symbol
22685 refers to a function or variable depending on the linker section that
22686 contains the symbol. Also note that the actual contents of the memory
22687 contained in a DLL are not available unless the program is running. This
22688 means that you cannot examine the contents of a variable or disassemble
22689 a function within a DLL without a running program.
22690
22691 Variables are generally treated as pointers and dereferenced
22692 automatically. For this reason, it is often necessary to prefix a
22693 variable name with the address-of operator (``&'') and provide explicit
22694 type information in the command. Here's an example of the type of
22695 problem:
22696
22697 @smallexample
22698 (@value{GDBP}) print 'cygwin1!__argv'
22699 'cygwin1!__argv' has unknown type; cast it to its declared type
22700 @end smallexample
22701
22702 @smallexample
22703 (@value{GDBP}) x 'cygwin1!__argv'
22704 'cygwin1!__argv' has unknown type; cast it to its declared type
22705 @end smallexample
22706
22707 And two possible solutions:
22708
22709 @smallexample
22710 (@value{GDBP}) print ((char **)'cygwin1!__argv')[0]
22711 $2 = 0x22fd98 "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
22712 @end smallexample
22713
22714 @smallexample
22715 (@value{GDBP}) x/2x &'cygwin1!__argv'
22716 0x610c0aa8 <cygwin1!__argv>: 0x10021608 0x00000000
22717 (@value{GDBP}) x/x 0x10021608
22718 0x10021608: 0x0022fd98
22719 (@value{GDBP}) x/s 0x0022fd98
22720 0x22fd98: "/cygdrive/c/mydirectory/myprogram"
22721 @end smallexample
22722
22723 Setting a break point within a DLL is possible even before the program
22724 starts execution. However, under these circumstances, @value{GDBN} can't
22725 examine the initial instructions of the function in order to skip the
22726 function's frame set-up code. You can work around this by using ``*&''
22727 to set the breakpoint at a raw memory address:
22728
22729 @smallexample
22730 (@value{GDBP}) break *&'python22!PyOS_Readline'
22731 Breakpoint 1 at 0x1e04eff0
22732 @end smallexample
22733
22734 The author of these extensions is not entirely convinced that setting a
22735 break point within a shared DLL like @file{kernel32.dll} is completely
22736 safe.
22737
22738 @node Hurd Native
22739 @subsection Commands Specific to @sc{gnu} Hurd Systems
22740 @cindex @sc{gnu} Hurd debugging
22741
22742 This subsection describes @value{GDBN} commands specific to the
22743 @sc{gnu} Hurd native debugging.
22744
22745 @table @code
22746 @item set signals
22747 @itemx set sigs
22748 @kindex set signals@r{, Hurd command}
22749 @kindex set sigs@r{, Hurd command}
22750 This command toggles the state of inferior signal interception by
22751 @value{GDBN}. Mach exceptions, such as breakpoint traps, are not
22752 affected by this command. @code{sigs} is a shorthand alias for
22753 @code{signals}.
22754
22755 @item show signals
22756 @itemx show sigs
22757 @kindex show signals@r{, Hurd command}
22758 @kindex show sigs@r{, Hurd command}
22759 Show the current state of intercepting inferior's signals.
22760
22761 @item set signal-thread
22762 @itemx set sigthread
22763 @kindex set signal-thread
22764 @kindex set sigthread
22765 This command tells @value{GDBN} which thread is the @code{libc} signal
22766 thread. That thread is run when a signal is delivered to a running
22767 process. @code{set sigthread} is the shorthand alias of @code{set
22768 signal-thread}.
22769
22770 @item show signal-thread
22771 @itemx show sigthread
22772 @kindex show signal-thread
22773 @kindex show sigthread
22774 These two commands show which thread will run when the inferior is
22775 delivered a signal.
22776
22777 @item set stopped
22778 @kindex set stopped@r{, Hurd command}
22779 This commands tells @value{GDBN} that the inferior process is stopped,
22780 as with the @code{SIGSTOP} signal. The stopped process can be
22781 continued by delivering a signal to it.
22782
22783 @item show stopped
22784 @kindex show stopped@r{, Hurd command}
22785 This command shows whether @value{GDBN} thinks the debuggee is
22786 stopped.
22787
22788 @item set exceptions
22789 @kindex set exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
22790 Use this command to turn off trapping of exceptions in the inferior.
22791 When exception trapping is off, neither breakpoints nor
22792 single-stepping will work. To restore the default, set exception
22793 trapping on.
22794
22795 @item show exceptions
22796 @kindex show exceptions@r{, Hurd command}
22797 Show the current state of trapping exceptions in the inferior.
22798
22799 @item set task pause
22800 @kindex set task@r{, Hurd commands}
22801 @cindex task attributes (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
22802 @cindex pause current task (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
22803 This command toggles task suspension when @value{GDBN} has control.
22804 Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the task is suspended
22805 whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to off will take
22806 effect the next time the inferior is continued. If this option is set
22807 to off, you can use @code{set thread default pause on} or @code{set
22808 thread pause on} (see below) to pause individual threads.
22809
22810 @item show task pause
22811 @kindex show task@r{, Hurd commands}
22812 Show the current state of task suspension.
22813
22814 @item set task detach-suspend-count
22815 @cindex task suspend count
22816 @cindex detach from task, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22817 This command sets the suspend count the task will be left with when
22818 @value{GDBN} detaches from it.
22819
22820 @item show task detach-suspend-count
22821 Show the suspend count the task will be left with when detaching.
22822
22823 @item set task exception-port
22824 @itemx set task excp
22825 @cindex task exception port, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22826 This command sets the task exception port to which @value{GDBN} will
22827 forward exceptions. The argument should be the value of the @dfn{send
22828 rights} of the task. @code{set task excp} is a shorthand alias.
22829
22830 @item set noninvasive
22831 @cindex noninvasive task options
22832 This command switches @value{GDBN} to a mode that is the least
22833 invasive as far as interfering with the inferior is concerned. This
22834 is the same as using @code{set task pause}, @code{set exceptions}, and
22835 @code{set signals} to values opposite to the defaults.
22836
22837 @item info send-rights
22838 @itemx info receive-rights
22839 @itemx info port-rights
22840 @itemx info port-sets
22841 @itemx info dead-names
22842 @itemx info ports
22843 @itemx info psets
22844 @cindex send rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22845 @cindex receive rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22846 @cindex port rights, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22847 @cindex port sets, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22848 @cindex dead names, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22849 These commands display information about, respectively, send rights,
22850 receive rights, port rights, port sets, and dead names of a task.
22851 There are also shorthand aliases: @code{info ports} for @code{info
22852 port-rights} and @code{info psets} for @code{info port-sets}.
22853
22854 @item set thread pause
22855 @kindex set thread@r{, Hurd command}
22856 @cindex thread properties, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22857 @cindex pause current thread (@sc{gnu} Hurd)
22858 This command toggles current thread suspension when @value{GDBN} has
22859 control. Setting it to on takes effect immediately, and the current
22860 thread is suspended whenever @value{GDBN} gets control. Setting it to
22861 off will take effect the next time the inferior is continued.
22862 Normally, this command has no effect, since when @value{GDBN} has
22863 control, the whole task is suspended. However, if you used @code{set
22864 task pause off} (see above), this command comes in handy to suspend
22865 only the current thread.
22866
22867 @item show thread pause
22868 @kindex show thread@r{, Hurd command}
22869 This command shows the state of current thread suspension.
22870
22871 @item set thread run
22872 This command sets whether the current thread is allowed to run.
22873
22874 @item show thread run
22875 Show whether the current thread is allowed to run.
22876
22877 @item set thread detach-suspend-count
22878 @cindex thread suspend count, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22879 @cindex detach from thread, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22880 This command sets the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on a
22881 thread when detaching. This number is relative to the suspend count
22882 found by @value{GDBN} when it notices the thread; use @code{set thread
22883 takeover-suspend-count} to force it to an absolute value.
22884
22885 @item show thread detach-suspend-count
22886 Show the suspend count @value{GDBN} will leave on the thread when
22887 detaching.
22888
22889 @item set thread exception-port
22890 @itemx set thread excp
22891 Set the thread exception port to which to forward exceptions. This
22892 overrides the port set by @code{set task exception-port} (see above).
22893 @code{set thread excp} is the shorthand alias.
22894
22895 @item set thread takeover-suspend-count
22896 Normally, @value{GDBN}'s thread suspend counts are relative to the
22897 value @value{GDBN} finds when it notices each thread. This command
22898 changes the suspend counts to be absolute instead.
22899
22900 @item set thread default
22901 @itemx show thread default
22902 @cindex thread default settings, @sc{gnu} Hurd
22903 Each of the above @code{set thread} commands has a @code{set thread
22904 default} counterpart (e.g., @code{set thread default pause}, @code{set
22905 thread default exception-port}, etc.). The @code{thread default}
22906 variety of commands sets the default thread properties for all
22907 threads; you can then change the properties of individual threads with
22908 the non-default commands.
22909 @end table
22910
22911 @node Darwin
22912 @subsection Darwin
22913 @cindex Darwin
22914
22915 @value{GDBN} provides the following commands specific to the Darwin target:
22916
22917 @table @code
22918 @item set debug darwin @var{num}
22919 @kindex set debug darwin
22920 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages specific to
22921 the Darwin support. Higher values produce more verbose output.
22922
22923 @item show debug darwin
22924 @kindex show debug darwin
22925 Show the current state of Darwin messages.
22926
22927 @item set debug mach-o @var{num}
22928 @kindex set debug mach-o
22929 When set to a non zero value, enables debugging messages while
22930 @value{GDBN} is reading Darwin object files. (@dfn{Mach-O} is the
22931 file format used on Darwin for object and executable files.) Higher
22932 values produce more verbose output. This is a command to diagnose
22933 problems internal to @value{GDBN} and should not be needed in normal
22934 usage.
22935
22936 @item show debug mach-o
22937 @kindex show debug mach-o
22938 Show the current state of Mach-O file messages.
22939
22940 @item set mach-exceptions on
22941 @itemx set mach-exceptions off
22942 @kindex set mach-exceptions
22943 On Darwin, faults are first reported as a Mach exception and are then
22944 mapped to a Posix signal. Use this command to turn on trapping of
22945 Mach exceptions in the inferior. This might be sometimes useful to
22946 better understand the cause of a fault. The default is off.
22947
22948 @item show mach-exceptions
22949 @kindex show mach-exceptions
22950 Show the current state of exceptions trapping.
22951 @end table
22952
22953
22954 @node Embedded OS
22955 @section Embedded Operating Systems
22956
22957 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
22958 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
22959 architectures.
22960
22961 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
22962 various real-time operating systems.
22963
22964 @node Embedded Processors
22965 @section Embedded Processors
22966
22967 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
22968 configurations.
22969
22970 @cindex send command to simulator
22971 Whenever a specific embedded processor has a simulator, @value{GDBN}
22972 allows to send an arbitrary command to the simulator.
22973
22974 @table @code
22975 @item sim @var{command}
22976 @kindex sim@r{, a command}
22977 Send an arbitrary @var{command} string to the simulator. Consult the
22978 documentation for the specific simulator in use for information about
22979 acceptable commands.
22980 @end table
22981
22982
22983 @menu
22984 * ARC:: Synopsys ARC
22985 * ARM:: ARM
22986 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
22987 * MicroBlaze:: Xilinx MicroBlaze
22988 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
22989 * OpenRISC 1000:: OpenRISC 1000 (or1k)
22990 * PowerPC Embedded:: PowerPC Embedded
22991 * AVR:: Atmel AVR
22992 * CRIS:: CRIS
22993 * Super-H:: Renesas Super-H
22994 @end menu
22995
22996 @node ARC
22997 @subsection Synopsys ARC
22998 @cindex Synopsys ARC
22999 @cindex ARC specific commands
23000 @cindex ARC600
23001 @cindex ARC700
23002 @cindex ARC EM
23003 @cindex ARC HS
23004
23005 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARC-specific commands:
23006
23007 @table @code
23008 @item set debug arc
23009 @kindex set debug arc
23010 Control the level of ARC specific debug messages. Use 0 for no messages (the
23011 default), 1 for debug messages, and 2 for even more debug messages.
23012
23013 @item show debug arc
23014 @kindex show debug arc
23015 Show the level of ARC specific debugging in operation.
23016
23017 @item maint print arc arc-instruction @var{address}
23018 @kindex maint print arc arc-instruction
23019 Print internal disassembler information about instruction at a given address.
23020
23021 @end table
23022
23023 @node ARM
23024 @subsection ARM
23025
23026 @value{GDBN} provides the following ARM-specific commands:
23027
23028 @table @code
23029 @item set arm disassembler
23030 @kindex set arm
23031 This commands selects from a list of disassembly styles. The
23032 @code{"std"} style is the standard style.
23033
23034 @item show arm disassembler
23035 @kindex show arm
23036 Show the current disassembly style.
23037
23038 @item set arm apcs32
23039 @cindex ARM 32-bit mode
23040 This command toggles ARM operation mode between 32-bit and 26-bit.
23041
23042 @item show arm apcs32
23043 Display the current usage of the ARM 32-bit mode.
23044
23045 @item set arm fpu @var{fputype}
23046 This command sets the ARM floating-point unit (FPU) type. The
23047 argument @var{fputype} can be one of these:
23048
23049 @table @code
23050 @item auto
23051 Determine the FPU type by querying the OS ABI.
23052 @item softfpa
23053 Software FPU, with mixed-endian doubles on little-endian ARM
23054 processors.
23055 @item fpa
23056 GCC-compiled FPA co-processor.
23057 @item softvfp
23058 Software FPU with pure-endian doubles.
23059 @item vfp
23060 VFP co-processor.
23061 @end table
23062
23063 @item show arm fpu
23064 Show the current type of the FPU.
23065
23066 @item set arm abi
23067 This command forces @value{GDBN} to use the specified ABI.
23068
23069 @item show arm abi
23070 Show the currently used ABI.
23071
23072 @item set arm fallback-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
23073 @value{GDBN} uses the symbol table, when available, to determine
23074 whether instructions are ARM or Thumb. This command controls
23075 @value{GDBN}'s default behavior when the symbol table is not
23076 available. The default is @samp{auto}, which causes @value{GDBN} to
23077 use the current execution mode (from the @code{T} bit in the @code{CPSR}
23078 register).
23079
23080 @item show arm fallback-mode
23081 Show the current fallback instruction mode.
23082
23083 @item set arm force-mode (arm|thumb|auto)
23084 This command overrides use of the symbol table to determine whether
23085 instructions are ARM or Thumb. The default is @samp{auto}, which
23086 causes @value{GDBN} to use the symbol table and then the setting
23087 of @samp{set arm fallback-mode}.
23088
23089 @item show arm force-mode
23090 Show the current forced instruction mode.
23091
23092 @item set debug arm
23093 Toggle whether to display ARM-specific debugging messages from the ARM
23094 target support subsystem.
23095
23096 @item show debug arm
23097 Show whether ARM-specific debugging messages are enabled.
23098 @end table
23099
23100 @table @code
23101 @item target sim @r{[}@var{simargs}@r{]} @dots{}
23102 The @value{GDBN} ARM simulator accepts the following optional arguments.
23103
23104 @table @code
23105 @item --swi-support=@var{type}
23106 Tell the simulator which SWI interfaces to support. The argument
23107 @var{type} may be a comma separated list of the following values.
23108 The default value is @code{all}.
23109
23110 @table @code
23111 @item none
23112 @item demon
23113 @item angel
23114 @item redboot
23115 @item all
23116 @end table
23117 @end table
23118 @end table
23119
23120 @node M68K
23121 @subsection M68k
23122
23123 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support.
23124
23125 @node MicroBlaze
23126 @subsection MicroBlaze
23127 @cindex Xilinx MicroBlaze
23128 @cindex XMD, Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger
23129
23130 The MicroBlaze is a soft-core processor supported on various Xilinx
23131 FPGAs, such as Spartan or Virtex series. Boards with these processors
23132 usually have JTAG ports which connect to a host system running the Xilinx
23133 Embedded Development Kit (EDK) or Software Development Kit (SDK).
23134 This host system is used to download the configuration bitstream to
23135 the target FPGA. The Xilinx Microprocessor Debugger (XMD) program
23136 communicates with the target board using the JTAG interface and
23137 presents a @code{gdbserver} interface to the board. By default
23138 @code{xmd} uses port @code{1234}. (While it is possible to change
23139 this default port, it requires the use of undocumented @code{xmd}
23140 commands. Contact Xilinx support if you need to do this.)
23141
23142 Use these GDB commands to connect to the MicroBlaze target processor.
23143
23144 @table @code
23145 @item target remote :1234
23146 Use this command to connect to the target if you are running @value{GDBN}
23147 on the same system as @code{xmd}.
23148
23149 @item target remote @var{xmd-host}:1234
23150 Use this command to connect to the target if it is connected to @code{xmd}
23151 running on a different system named @var{xmd-host}.
23152
23153 @item load
23154 Use this command to download a program to the MicroBlaze target.
23155
23156 @item set debug microblaze @var{n}
23157 Enable MicroBlaze-specific debugging messages if non-zero.
23158
23159 @item show debug microblaze @var{n}
23160 Show MicroBlaze-specific debugging level.
23161 @end table
23162
23163 @node MIPS Embedded
23164 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Embedded
23165
23166 @noindent
23167 @value{GDBN} supports these special commands for @acronym{MIPS} targets:
23168
23169 @table @code
23170 @item set mipsfpu double
23171 @itemx set mipsfpu single
23172 @itemx set mipsfpu none
23173 @itemx set mipsfpu auto
23174 @itemx show mipsfpu
23175 @kindex set mipsfpu
23176 @kindex show mipsfpu
23177 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} remote floating point
23178 @cindex floating point, @acronym{MIPS} remote
23179 If your target board does not support the @acronym{MIPS} floating point
23180 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
23181 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
23182 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
23183 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
23184 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
23185 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
23186 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
23187 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
23188 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
23189 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
23190
23191 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
23192 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
23193 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
23194
23195 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
23196 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
23197 @end table
23198
23199 @node OpenRISC 1000
23200 @subsection OpenRISC 1000
23201 @cindex OpenRISC 1000
23202
23203 @noindent
23204 The OpenRISC 1000 provides a free RISC instruction set architecture. It is
23205 mainly provided as a soft-core which can run on Xilinx, Altera and other
23206 FPGA's.
23207
23208 @value{GDBN} for OpenRISC supports the below commands when connecting to
23209 a target:
23210
23211 @table @code
23212
23213 @kindex target sim
23214 @item target sim
23215
23216 Runs the builtin CPU simulator which can run very basic
23217 programs but does not support most hardware functions like MMU.
23218 For more complex use cases the user is advised to run an external
23219 target, and connect using @samp{target remote}.
23220
23221 Example: @code{target sim}
23222
23223 @item set debug or1k
23224 Toggle whether to display OpenRISC-specific debugging messages from the
23225 OpenRISC target support subsystem.
23226
23227 @item show debug or1k
23228 Show whether OpenRISC-specific debugging messages are enabled.
23229 @end table
23230
23231 @node PowerPC Embedded
23232 @subsection PowerPC Embedded
23233
23234 @cindex DVC register
23235 @value{GDBN} supports using the DVC (Data Value Compare) register to
23236 implement in hardware simple hardware watchpoint conditions of the form:
23237
23238 @smallexample
23239 (@value{GDBP}) watch @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} \
23240 if @var{ADDRESS|VARIABLE} == @var{CONSTANT EXPRESSION}
23241 @end smallexample
23242
23243 The DVC register will be automatically used when @value{GDBN} detects
23244 such pattern in a condition expression, and the created watchpoint uses one
23245 debug register (either the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on and the
23246 variable is scalar, or the variable has a length of one byte). This feature
23247 is available in native @value{GDBN} running on a Linux kernel version 2.6.34
23248 or newer.
23249
23250 When running on PowerPC embedded processors, @value{GDBN} automatically uses
23251 ranged hardware watchpoints, unless the @code{exact-watchpoints} option is on,
23252 in which case watchpoints using only one debug register are created when
23253 watching variables of scalar types.
23254
23255 You can create an artificial array to watch an arbitrary memory
23256 region using one of the following commands (@pxref{Expressions}):
23257
23258 @smallexample
23259 (@value{GDBP}) watch *((char *) @var{address})@@@var{length}
23260 (@value{GDBP}) watch @{char[@var{length}]@} @var{address}
23261 @end smallexample
23262
23263 PowerPC embedded processors support masked watchpoints. See the discussion
23264 about the @code{mask} argument in @ref{Set Watchpoints}.
23265
23266 @cindex ranged breakpoint
23267 PowerPC embedded processors support hardware accelerated
23268 @dfn{ranged breakpoints}. A ranged breakpoint stops execution of
23269 the inferior whenever it executes an instruction at any address within
23270 the range it specifies. To set a ranged breakpoint in @value{GDBN},
23271 use the @code{break-range} command.
23272
23273 @value{GDBN} provides the following PowerPC-specific commands:
23274
23275 @table @code
23276 @kindex break-range
23277 @item break-range @var{start-location}, @var{end-location}
23278 Set a breakpoint for an address range given by
23279 @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}, which can specify a function name,
23280 a line number, an offset of lines from the current line or from the start
23281 location, or an address of an instruction (see @ref{Specify Location},
23282 for a list of all the possible ways to specify a @var{location}.)
23283 The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it
23284 executes an instruction at any address within the specified range,
23285 (including @var{start-location} and @var{end-location}.)
23286
23287 @kindex set powerpc
23288 @item set powerpc soft-float
23289 @itemx show powerpc soft-float
23290 Force @value{GDBN} to use (or not use) a software floating point calling
23291 convention. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention based
23292 on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
23293
23294 @item set powerpc vector-abi
23295 @itemx show powerpc vector-abi
23296 Force @value{GDBN} to use the specified calling convention for vector
23297 arguments and return values. The valid options are @samp{auto};
23298 @samp{generic}, to avoid vector registers even if they are present;
23299 @samp{altivec}, to use AltiVec registers; and @samp{spe} to use SPE
23300 registers. By default, @value{GDBN} selects the calling convention
23301 based on the selected architecture and the provided executable file.
23302
23303 @item set powerpc exact-watchpoints
23304 @itemx show powerpc exact-watchpoints
23305 Allow @value{GDBN} to use only one debug register when watching a variable
23306 of scalar type, thus assuming that the variable is accessed through the
23307 address of its first byte.
23308
23309 @end table
23310
23311 @node AVR
23312 @subsection Atmel AVR
23313 @cindex AVR
23314
23315 When configured for debugging the Atmel AVR, @value{GDBN} supports the
23316 following AVR-specific commands:
23317
23318 @table @code
23319 @item info io_registers
23320 @kindex info io_registers@r{, AVR}
23321 @cindex I/O registers (Atmel AVR)
23322 This command displays information about the AVR I/O registers. For
23323 each register, @value{GDBN} prints its number and value.
23324 @end table
23325
23326 @node CRIS
23327 @subsection CRIS
23328 @cindex CRIS
23329
23330 When configured for debugging CRIS, @value{GDBN} provides the
23331 following CRIS-specific commands:
23332
23333 @table @code
23334 @item set cris-version @var{ver}
23335 @cindex CRIS version
23336 Set the current CRIS version to @var{ver}, either @samp{10} or @samp{32}.
23337 The CRIS version affects register names and sizes. This command is useful in
23338 case autodetection of the CRIS version fails.
23339
23340 @item show cris-version
23341 Show the current CRIS version.
23342
23343 @item set cris-dwarf2-cfi
23344 @cindex DWARF-2 CFI and CRIS
23345 Set the usage of DWARF-2 CFI for CRIS debugging. The default is @samp{on}.
23346 Change to @samp{off} when using @code{gcc-cris} whose version is below
23347 @code{R59}.
23348
23349 @item show cris-dwarf2-cfi
23350 Show the current state of using DWARF-2 CFI.
23351
23352 @item set cris-mode @var{mode}
23353 @cindex CRIS mode
23354 Set the current CRIS mode to @var{mode}. It should only be changed when
23355 debugging in guru mode, in which case it should be set to
23356 @samp{guru} (the default is @samp{normal}).
23357
23358 @item show cris-mode
23359 Show the current CRIS mode.
23360 @end table
23361
23362 @node Super-H
23363 @subsection Renesas Super-H
23364 @cindex Super-H
23365
23366 For the Renesas Super-H processor, @value{GDBN} provides these
23367 commands:
23368
23369 @table @code
23370 @item set sh calling-convention @var{convention}
23371 @kindex set sh calling-convention
23372 Set the calling-convention used when calling functions from @value{GDBN}.
23373 Allowed values are @samp{gcc}, which is the default setting, and @samp{renesas}.
23374 With the @samp{gcc} setting, functions are called using the @value{NGCC} calling
23375 convention. If the DWARF-2 information of the called function specifies
23376 that the function follows the Renesas calling convention, the function
23377 is called using the Renesas calling convention. If the calling convention
23378 is set to @samp{renesas}, the Renesas calling convention is always used,
23379 regardless of the DWARF-2 information. This can be used to override the
23380 default of @samp{gcc} if debug information is missing, or the compiler
23381 does not emit the DWARF-2 calling convention entry for a function.
23382
23383 @item show sh calling-convention
23384 @kindex show sh calling-convention
23385 Show the current calling convention setting.
23386
23387 @end table
23388
23389
23390 @node Architectures
23391 @section Architectures
23392
23393 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
23394 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
23395
23396 @menu
23397 * AArch64::
23398 * i386::
23399 * Alpha::
23400 * MIPS::
23401 * HPPA:: HP PA architecture
23402 * SPU:: Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
23403 * PowerPC::
23404 * Nios II::
23405 * Sparc64::
23406 @end menu
23407
23408 @node AArch64
23409 @subsection AArch64
23410 @cindex AArch64 support
23411
23412 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides the
23413 following special commands:
23414
23415 @table @code
23416 @item set debug aarch64
23417 @kindex set debug aarch64
23418 This command determines whether AArch64 architecture-specific debugging
23419 messages are to be displayed.
23420
23421 @item show debug aarch64
23422 Show whether AArch64 debugging messages are displayed.
23423
23424 @end table
23425
23426 @node i386
23427 @subsection x86 Architecture-specific Issues
23428
23429 @table @code
23430 @item set struct-convention @var{mode}
23431 @kindex set struct-convention
23432 @cindex struct return convention
23433 @cindex struct/union returned in registers
23434 Set the convention used by the inferior to return @code{struct}s and
23435 @code{union}s from functions to @var{mode}. Possible values of
23436 @var{mode} are @code{"pcc"}, @code{"reg"}, and @code{"default"} (the
23437 default). @code{"default"} or @code{"pcc"} means that @code{struct}s
23438 are returned on the stack, while @code{"reg"} means that a
23439 @code{struct} or a @code{union} whose size is 1, 2, 4, or 8 bytes will
23440 be returned in a register.
23441
23442 @item show struct-convention
23443 @kindex show struct-convention
23444 Show the current setting of the convention to return @code{struct}s
23445 from functions.
23446 @end table
23447
23448
23449 @subsubsection Intel @dfn{Memory Protection Extensions} (MPX).
23450 @cindex Intel Memory Protection Extensions (MPX).
23451
23452 Memory Protection Extension (MPX) adds the bound registers @samp{BND0}
23453 @footnote{The register named with capital letters represent the architecture
23454 registers.} through @samp{BND3}. Bound registers store a pair of 64-bit values
23455 which are the lower bound and upper bound. Bounds are effective addresses or
23456 memory locations. The upper bounds are architecturally represented in 1's
23457 complement form. A bound having lower bound = 0, and upper bound = 0
23458 (1's complement of all bits set) will allow access to the entire address space.
23459
23460 @samp{BND0} through @samp{BND3} are represented in @value{GDBN} as @samp{bnd0raw}
23461 through @samp{bnd3raw}. Pseudo registers @samp{bnd0} through @samp{bnd3}
23462 display the upper bound performing the complement of one operation on the
23463 upper bound value, i.e.@ when upper bound in @samp{bnd0raw} is 0 in the
23464 @value{GDBN} @samp{bnd0} it will be @code{0xfff@dots{}}. In this sense it
23465 can also be noted that the upper bounds are inclusive.
23466
23467 As an example, assume that the register BND0 holds bounds for a pointer having
23468 access allowed for the range between 0x32 and 0x71. The values present on
23469 bnd0raw and bnd registers are presented as follows:
23470
23471 @smallexample
23472 bnd0raw = @{0x32, 0xffffffff8e@}
23473 bnd0 = @{lbound = 0x32, ubound = 0x71@} : size 64
23474 @end smallexample
23475
23476 This way the raw value can be accessed via bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw. Any
23477 change on bnd0@dots{}bnd3 or bnd0raw@dots{}bnd3raw is reflect on its
23478 counterpart. When the bnd0@dots{}bnd3 registers are displayed via
23479 Python, the display includes the memory size, in bits, accessible to
23480 the pointer.
23481
23482 Bounds can also be stored in bounds tables, which are stored in
23483 application memory. These tables store bounds for pointers by specifying
23484 the bounds pointer's value along with its bounds. Evaluating and changing
23485 bounds located in bound tables is therefore interesting while investigating
23486 bugs on MPX context. @value{GDBN} provides commands for this purpose:
23487
23488 @table @code
23489 @item show mpx bound @var{pointer}
23490 @kindex show mpx bound
23491 Display bounds of the given @var{pointer}.
23492
23493 @item set mpx bound @var{pointer}, @var{lbound}, @var{ubound}
23494 @kindex set mpx bound
23495 Set the bounds of a pointer in the bound table.
23496 This command takes three parameters: @var{pointer} is the pointers
23497 whose bounds are to be changed, @var{lbound} and @var{ubound} are new values
23498 for lower and upper bounds respectively.
23499 @end table
23500
23501 When you call an inferior function on an Intel MPX enabled program,
23502 GDB sets the inferior's bound registers to the init (disabled) state
23503 before calling the function. As a consequence, bounds checks for the
23504 pointer arguments passed to the function will always pass.
23505
23506 This is necessary because when you call an inferior function, the
23507 program is usually in the middle of the execution of other function.
23508 Since at that point bound registers are in an arbitrary state, not
23509 clearing them would lead to random bound violations in the called
23510 function.
23511
23512 You can still examine the influence of the bound registers on the
23513 execution of the called function by stopping the execution of the
23514 called function at its prologue, setting bound registers, and
23515 continuing the execution. For example:
23516
23517 @smallexample
23518 $ break *upper
23519 Breakpoint 2 at 0x4009de: file i386-mpx-call.c, line 47.
23520 $ print upper (a, b, c, d, 1)
23521 Breakpoint 2, upper (a=0x0, b=0x6e0000005b, c=0x0, d=0x0, len=48)....
23522 $ print $bnd0
23523 @{lbound = 0x0, ubound = ffffffff@} : size -1
23524 @end smallexample
23525
23526 At this last step the value of bnd0 can be changed for investigation of bound
23527 violations caused along the execution of the call. In order to know how to
23528 set the bound registers or bound table for the call consult the ABI.
23529
23530 @node Alpha
23531 @subsection Alpha
23532
23533 See the following section.
23534
23535 @node MIPS
23536 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}
23537
23538 @cindex stack on Alpha
23539 @cindex stack on @acronym{MIPS}
23540 @cindex Alpha stack
23541 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} stack
23542 Alpha- and @acronym{MIPS}-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
23543 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
23544 find the beginning of a function.
23545
23546 @cindex response time, @acronym{MIPS} debugging
23547 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
23548 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
23549 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
23550 commands:
23551
23552 @table @code
23553 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, @acronym{MIPS})
23554 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
23555 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
23556 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
23557 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
23558 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
23559 and therefore the longer it takes to run. You should only need to use
23560 this command when debugging a stripped executable.
23561
23562 @item show heuristic-fence-post
23563 Display the current limit.
23564 @end table
23565
23566 @noindent
23567 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
23568 for debugging programs on Alpha or @acronym{MIPS} processors.
23569
23570 Several @acronym{MIPS}-specific commands are available when debugging @acronym{MIPS}
23571 programs:
23572
23573 @table @code
23574 @item set mips abi @var{arg}
23575 @kindex set mips abi
23576 @cindex set ABI for @acronym{MIPS}
23577 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} ABI is used by the inferior. Possible
23578 values of @var{arg} are:
23579
23580 @table @samp
23581 @item auto
23582 The default ABI associated with the current binary (this is the
23583 default).
23584 @item o32
23585 @item o64
23586 @item n32
23587 @item n64
23588 @item eabi32
23589 @item eabi64
23590 @end table
23591
23592 @item show mips abi
23593 @kindex show mips abi
23594 Show the @acronym{MIPS} ABI used by @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
23595
23596 @item set mips compression @var{arg}
23597 @kindex set mips compression
23598 @cindex code compression, @acronym{MIPS}
23599 Tell @value{GDBN} which @acronym{MIPS} compressed
23600 @acronym{ISA, Instruction Set Architecture} encoding is used by the
23601 inferior. @value{GDBN} uses this for code disassembly and other
23602 internal interpretation purposes. This setting is only referred to
23603 when no executable has been associated with the debugging session or
23604 the executable does not provide information about the encoding it uses.
23605 Otherwise this setting is automatically updated from information
23606 provided by the executable.
23607
23608 Possible values of @var{arg} are @samp{mips16} and @samp{micromips}.
23609 The default compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding is @samp{mips16}, as
23610 executables containing @acronym{MIPS16} code frequently are not
23611 identified as such.
23612
23613 This setting is ``sticky''; that is, it retains its value across
23614 debugging sessions until reset either explicitly with this command or
23615 implicitly from an executable.
23616
23617 The compiler and/or assembler typically add symbol table annotations to
23618 identify functions compiled for the @acronym{MIPS16} or
23619 @acronym{microMIPS} @acronym{ISA}s. If these function-scope annotations
23620 are present, @value{GDBN} uses them in preference to the global
23621 compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding setting.
23622
23623 @item show mips compression
23624 @kindex show mips compression
23625 Show the @acronym{MIPS} compressed @acronym{ISA} encoding used by
23626 @value{GDBN} to debug the inferior.
23627
23628 @item set mipsfpu
23629 @itemx show mipsfpu
23630 @xref{MIPS Embedded, set mipsfpu}.
23631
23632 @item set mips mask-address @var{arg}
23633 @kindex set mips mask-address
23634 @cindex @acronym{MIPS} addresses, masking
23635 This command determines whether the most-significant 32 bits of 64-bit
23636 @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off. The argument @var{arg} can be
23637 @samp{on}, @samp{off}, or @samp{auto}. The latter is the default
23638 setting, which lets @value{GDBN} determine the correct value.
23639
23640 @item show mips mask-address
23641 @kindex show mips mask-address
23642 Show whether the upper 32 bits of @acronym{MIPS} addresses are masked off or
23643 not.
23644
23645 @item set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
23646 @kindex set remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
23647 This command controls compatibility with 64-bit @acronym{MIPS} targets that
23648 transfer data in 32-bit quantities. If you have an old @acronym{MIPS} 64 target
23649 that transfers 32 bits for some registers, like @sc{sr} and @sc{fsr},
23650 and 64 bits for other registers, set this option to @samp{on}.
23651
23652 @item show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
23653 @kindex show remote-mips64-transfers-32bit-regs
23654 Show the current setting of compatibility with older @acronym{MIPS} 64 targets.
23655
23656 @item set debug mips
23657 @kindex set debug mips
23658 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the @acronym{MIPS}-specific
23659 target code in @value{GDBN}.
23660
23661 @item show debug mips
23662 @kindex show debug mips
23663 Show the current setting of @acronym{MIPS} debugging messages.
23664 @end table
23665
23666
23667 @node HPPA
23668 @subsection HPPA
23669 @cindex HPPA support
23670
23671 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the HP PA architecture, it provides the
23672 following special commands:
23673
23674 @table @code
23675 @item set debug hppa
23676 @kindex set debug hppa
23677 This command determines whether HPPA architecture-specific debugging
23678 messages are to be displayed.
23679
23680 @item show debug hppa
23681 Show whether HPPA debugging messages are displayed.
23682
23683 @item maint print unwind @var{address}
23684 @kindex maint print unwind@r{, HPPA}
23685 This command displays the contents of the unwind table entry at the
23686 given @var{address}.
23687
23688 @end table
23689
23690
23691 @node SPU
23692 @subsection Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture
23693 @cindex Cell Broadband Engine
23694 @cindex SPU
23695
23696 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Cell Broadband Engine SPU architecture,
23697 it provides the following special commands:
23698
23699 @table @code
23700 @item info spu event
23701 @kindex info spu
23702 Display SPU event facility status. Shows current event mask
23703 and pending event status.
23704
23705 @item info spu signal
23706 Display SPU signal notification facility status. Shows pending
23707 signal-control word and signal notification mode of both signal
23708 notification channels.
23709
23710 @item info spu mailbox
23711 Display SPU mailbox facility status. Shows all pending entries,
23712 in order of processing, in each of the SPU Write Outbound,
23713 SPU Write Outbound Interrupt, and SPU Read Inbound mailboxes.
23714
23715 @item info spu dma
23716 Display MFC DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
23717 DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
23718 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
23719
23720 @item info spu proxydma
23721 Display MFC Proxy-DMA status. Shows all pending commands in the MFC
23722 Proxy-DMA queue. For each entry, opcode, tag, class IDs, effective
23723 and local store addresses and transfer size are shown.
23724
23725 @end table
23726
23727 When @value{GDBN} is debugging a combined PowerPC/SPU application
23728 on the Cell Broadband Engine, it provides in addition the following
23729 special commands:
23730
23731 @table @code
23732 @item set spu stop-on-load @var{arg}
23733 @kindex set spu
23734 Set whether to stop for new SPE threads. When set to @code{on}, @value{GDBN}
23735 will give control to the user when a new SPE thread enters its @code{main}
23736 function. The default is @code{off}.
23737
23738 @item show spu stop-on-load
23739 @kindex show spu
23740 Show whether to stop for new SPE threads.
23741
23742 @item set spu auto-flush-cache @var{arg}
23743 Set whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache. When set to
23744 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will automatically cause the SPE software-managed
23745 cache to be flushed whenever SPE execution stops. This provides a consistent
23746 view of PowerPC memory that is accessed via the cache. If an application
23747 does not use the software-managed cache, this option has no effect.
23748
23749 @item show spu auto-flush-cache
23750 Show whether to automatically flush the software-managed cache.
23751
23752 @end table
23753
23754 @node PowerPC
23755 @subsection PowerPC
23756 @cindex PowerPC architecture
23757
23758 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the PowerPC architecture, it provides a set of
23759 pseudo-registers to enable inspection of 128-bit wide Decimal Floating Point
23760 numbers stored in the floating point registers. These values must be stored
23761 in two consecutive registers, always starting at an even register like
23762 @code{f0} or @code{f2}.
23763
23764 The pseudo-registers go from @code{$dl0} through @code{$dl15}, and are formed
23765 by joining the even/odd register pairs @code{f0} and @code{f1} for @code{$dl0},
23766 @code{f2} and @code{f3} for @code{$dl1} and so on.
23767
23768 For POWER7 processors, @value{GDBN} provides a set of pseudo-registers, the 64-bit
23769 wide Extended Floating Point Registers (@samp{f32} through @samp{f63}).
23770
23771 @node Nios II
23772 @subsection Nios II
23773 @cindex Nios II architecture
23774
23775 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the Nios II architecture,
23776 it provides the following special commands:
23777
23778 @table @code
23779
23780 @item set debug nios2
23781 @kindex set debug nios2
23782 This command turns on and off debugging messages for the Nios II
23783 target code in @value{GDBN}.
23784
23785 @item show debug nios2
23786 @kindex show debug nios2
23787 Show the current setting of Nios II debugging messages.
23788 @end table
23789
23790 @node Sparc64
23791 @subsection Sparc64
23792 @cindex Sparc64 support
23793 @cindex Application Data Integrity
23794 @subsubsection ADI Support
23795
23796 The M7 processor supports an Application Data Integrity (ADI) feature that
23797 detects invalid data accesses. When software allocates memory and enables
23798 ADI on the allocated memory, it chooses a 4-bit version number, sets the
23799 version in the upper 4 bits of the 64-bit pointer to that data, and stores
23800 the 4-bit version in every cacheline of that data. Hardware saves the latter
23801 in spare bits in the cache and memory hierarchy. On each load and store,
23802 the processor compares the upper 4 VA (virtual address) bits to the
23803 cacheline's version. If there is a mismatch, the processor generates a
23804 version mismatch trap which can be either precise or disrupting. The trap
23805 is an error condition which the kernel delivers to the process as a SIGSEGV
23806 signal.
23807
23808 Note that only 64-bit applications can use ADI and need to be built with
23809 ADI-enabled.
23810
23811 Values of the ADI version tags, which are in granularity of a
23812 cacheline (64 bytes), can be viewed or modified.
23813
23814
23815 @table @code
23816 @kindex adi examine
23817 @item adi (examine | x) [ / @var{n} ] @var{addr}
23818
23819 The @code{adi examine} command displays the value of one ADI version tag per
23820 cacheline.
23821
23822 @var{n} is a decimal integer specifying the number in bytes; the default
23823 is 1. It specifies how much ADI version information, at the ratio of 1:ADI
23824 block size, to display.
23825
23826 @var{addr} is the address in user address space where you want @value{GDBN}
23827 to begin displaying the ADI version tags.
23828
23829 Below is an example of displaying ADI versions of variable "shmaddr".
23830
23831 @smallexample
23832 (@value{GDBP}) adi x/100 shmaddr
23833 0xfff800010002c000: 0 0
23834 @end smallexample
23835
23836 @kindex adi assign
23837 @item adi (assign | a) [ / @var{n} ] @var{addr} = @var{tag}
23838
23839 The @code{adi assign} command is used to assign new ADI version tag
23840 to an address.
23841
23842 @var{n} is a decimal integer specifying the number in bytes;
23843 the default is 1. It specifies how much ADI version information, at the
23844 ratio of 1:ADI block size, to modify.
23845
23846 @var{addr} is the address in user address space where you want @value{GDBN}
23847 to begin modifying the ADI version tags.
23848
23849 @var{tag} is the new ADI version tag.
23850
23851 For example, do the following to modify then verify ADI versions of
23852 variable "shmaddr":
23853
23854 @smallexample
23855 (@value{GDBP}) adi a/100 shmaddr = 7
23856 (@value{GDBP}) adi x/100 shmaddr
23857 0xfff800010002c000: 7 7
23858 @end smallexample
23859
23860 @end table
23861
23862 @node Controlling GDB
23863 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
23864
23865 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
23866 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
23867 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print Settings}. Other settings are
23868 described here.
23869
23870 @menu
23871 * Prompt:: Prompt
23872 * Editing:: Command editing
23873 * Command History:: Command history
23874 * Screen Size:: Screen size
23875 * Numbers:: Numbers
23876 * ABI:: Configuring the current ABI
23877 * Auto-loading:: Automatically loading associated files
23878 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
23879 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
23880 * Other Misc Settings:: Other Miscellaneous Settings
23881 @end menu
23882
23883 @node Prompt
23884 @section Prompt
23885
23886 @cindex prompt
23887
23888 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
23889 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
23890 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
23891 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
23892 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
23893 which one you are talking to.
23894
23895 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
23896 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
23897 or a prompt that does not.
23898
23899 @table @code
23900 @kindex set prompt
23901 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
23902 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
23903
23904 @kindex show prompt
23905 @item show prompt
23906 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
23907 @end table
23908
23909 Versions of @value{GDBN} that ship with Python scripting enabled have
23910 prompt extensions. The commands for interacting with these extensions
23911 are:
23912
23913 @table @code
23914 @kindex set extended-prompt
23915 @item set extended-prompt @var{prompt}
23916 Set an extended prompt that allows for substitutions.
23917 @xref{gdb.prompt}, for a list of escape sequences that can be used for
23918 substitution. Any escape sequences specified as part of the prompt
23919 string are replaced with the corresponding strings each time the prompt
23920 is displayed.
23921
23922 For example:
23923
23924 @smallexample
23925 set extended-prompt Current working directory: \w (gdb)
23926 @end smallexample
23927
23928 Note that when an extended-prompt is set, it takes control of the
23929 @var{prompt_hook} hook. @xref{prompt_hook}, for further information.
23930
23931 @kindex show extended-prompt
23932 @item show extended-prompt
23933 Prints the extended prompt. Any escape sequences specified as part of
23934 the prompt string with @code{set extended-prompt}, are replaced with the
23935 corresponding strings each time the prompt is displayed.
23936 @end table
23937
23938 @node Editing
23939 @section Command Editing
23940 @cindex readline
23941 @cindex command line editing
23942
23943 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{Readline} interface. This
23944 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
23945 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
23946 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
23947 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
23948 debugging sessions.
23949
23950 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
23951 command @code{set}.
23952
23953 @table @code
23954 @kindex set editing
23955 @cindex editing
23956 @item set editing
23957 @itemx set editing on
23958 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
23959
23960 @item set editing off
23961 Disable command line editing.
23962
23963 @kindex show editing
23964 @item show editing
23965 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
23966 @end table
23967
23968 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
23969 @xref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library},
23970 @end ifset
23971 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
23972 @xref{Command Line Editing},
23973 @end ifclear
23974 for more details about the Readline
23975 interface. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs or @code{vi} are
23976 encouraged to read that chapter.
23977
23978 @node Command History
23979 @section Command History
23980 @cindex command history
23981
23982 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
23983 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
23984 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
23985 history facility.
23986
23987 @value{GDBN} uses the @sc{gnu} History library, a part of the Readline
23988 package, to provide the history facility.
23989 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
23990 @xref{Using History Interactively, , , history, GNU History Library},
23991 @end ifset
23992 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
23993 @xref{Using History Interactively},
23994 @end ifclear
23995 for the detailed description of the History library.
23996
23997 To issue a command to @value{GDBN} without affecting certain aspects of
23998 the state which is seen by users, prefix it with @samp{server }
23999 (@pxref{Server Prefix}). This
24000 means that this command will not affect the command history, nor will it
24001 affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which command to repeat if @key{RET} is
24002 pressed on a line by itself.
24003
24004 @cindex @code{server}, command prefix
24005 The server prefix does not affect the recording of values into the value
24006 history; to print a value without recording it into the value history,
24007 use the @code{output} command instead of the @code{print} command.
24008
24009 Here is the description of @value{GDBN} commands related to command
24010 history.
24011
24012 @table @code
24013 @cindex history substitution
24014 @cindex history file
24015 @kindex set history filename
24016 @cindex @env{GDBHISTFILE}, environment variable
24017 @item set history filename @var{fname}
24018 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
24019 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
24020 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
24021 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
24022 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
24023 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
24024 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
24025 is not set.
24026
24027 @cindex save command history
24028 @kindex set history save
24029 @item set history save
24030 @itemx set history save on
24031 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
24032 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
24033
24034 @item set history save off
24035 Stop recording command history in a file.
24036
24037 @cindex history size
24038 @kindex set history size
24039 @cindex @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, environment variable
24040 @item set history size @var{size}
24041 @itemx set history size unlimited
24042 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
24043 This defaults to the value of the environment variable @env{GDBHISTSIZE}, or
24044 to 256 if this variable is not set. Non-numeric values of @env{GDBHISTSIZE}
24045 are ignored. If @var{size} is @code{unlimited} or if @env{GDBHISTSIZE} is
24046 either a negative number or the empty string, then the number of commands
24047 @value{GDBN} keeps in the history list is unlimited.
24048
24049 @cindex remove duplicate history
24050 @kindex set history remove-duplicates
24051 @item set history remove-duplicates @var{count}
24052 @itemx set history remove-duplicates unlimited
24053 Control the removal of duplicate history entries in the command history list.
24054 If @var{count} is non-zero, @value{GDBN} will look back at the last @var{count}
24055 history entries and remove the first entry that is a duplicate of the current
24056 entry being added to the command history list. If @var{count} is
24057 @code{unlimited} then this lookbehind is unbounded. If @var{count} is 0, then
24058 removal of duplicate history entries is disabled.
24059
24060 Only history entries added during the current session are considered for
24061 removal. This option is set to 0 by default.
24062
24063 @end table
24064
24065 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
24066 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
24067 @xref{Event Designators, , , history, GNU History Library},
24068 @end ifset
24069 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
24070 @xref{Event Designators},
24071 @end ifclear
24072 for more details.
24073
24074 @cindex history expansion, turn on/off
24075 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
24076 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
24077 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
24078 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
24079 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
24080 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
24081 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
24082
24083 The commands to control history expansion are:
24084
24085 @table @code
24086 @item set history expansion on
24087 @itemx set history expansion
24088 @kindex set history expansion
24089 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
24090
24091 @item set history expansion off
24092 Disable history expansion.
24093
24094 @c @group
24095 @kindex show history
24096 @item show history
24097 @itemx show history filename
24098 @itemx show history save
24099 @itemx show history size
24100 @itemx show history expansion
24101 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
24102 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
24103 @c @end group
24104 @end table
24105
24106 @table @code
24107 @kindex show commands
24108 @cindex show last commands
24109 @cindex display command history
24110 @item show commands
24111 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
24112
24113 @item show commands @var{n}
24114 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
24115
24116 @item show commands +
24117 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
24118 @end table
24119
24120 @node Screen Size
24121 @section Screen Size
24122 @cindex size of screen
24123 @cindex screen size
24124 @cindex pagination
24125 @cindex page size
24126 @cindex pauses in output
24127
24128 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
24129 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
24130 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
24131 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to see one more page of output,
24132 @kbd{q} to discard the remaining output, or @kbd{c} to continue
24133 without paging for the rest of the current command. Also, the screen
24134 width setting determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on
24135 what is being printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a
24136 readable place, rather than simply letting it overflow onto the
24137 following line.
24138
24139 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
24140 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
24141 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
24142 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
24143 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
24144 width} commands:
24145
24146 @table @code
24147 @kindex set height
24148 @kindex set width
24149 @kindex show width
24150 @kindex show height
24151 @item set height @var{lpp}
24152 @itemx set height unlimited
24153 @itemx show height
24154 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
24155 @itemx set width unlimited
24156 @itemx show width
24157 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
24158 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
24159 commands display the current settings.
24160
24161 If you specify a height of either @code{unlimited} or zero lines,
24162 @value{GDBN} does not pause during output no matter how long the
24163 output is. This is useful if output is to a file or to an editor
24164 buffer.
24165
24166 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width unlimited} or @samp{set
24167 width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN} from wrapping its output.
24168
24169 @item set pagination on
24170 @itemx set pagination off
24171 @kindex set pagination
24172 Turn the output pagination on or off; the default is on. Turning
24173 pagination off is the alternative to @code{set height unlimited}. Note that
24174 running @value{GDBN} with the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode
24175 Options, -batch}) also automatically disables pagination.
24176
24177 @item show pagination
24178 @kindex show pagination
24179 Show the current pagination mode.
24180 @end table
24181
24182 @node Numbers
24183 @section Numbers
24184 @cindex number representation
24185 @cindex entering numbers
24186
24187 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
24188 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
24189 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
24190 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that neither begin with @samp{0} or
24191 @samp{0x}, nor end with a @samp{.} are, by default, entered in base
24192 10; likewise, the default display for numbers---when no particular
24193 format is specified---is base 10. You can change the default base for
24194 both input and output with the commands described below.
24195
24196 @table @code
24197 @kindex set input-radix
24198 @item set input-radix @var{base}
24199 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
24200 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
24201 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix; for
24202 example, any of
24203
24204 @smallexample
24205 set input-radix 012
24206 set input-radix 10.
24207 set input-radix 0xa
24208 @end smallexample
24209
24210 @noindent
24211 sets the input base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set input-radix 10}
24212 leaves the input radix unchanged, no matter what it was, since
24213 @samp{10}, being without any leading or trailing signs of its base, is
24214 interpreted in the current radix. Thus, if the current radix is 16,
24215 @samp{10} is interpreted in hex, i.e.@: as 16 decimal, which doesn't
24216 change the radix.
24217
24218 @kindex set output-radix
24219 @item set output-radix @var{base}
24220 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
24221 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. The base must itself be
24222 specified either unambiguously or using the current input radix.
24223
24224 @kindex show input-radix
24225 @item show input-radix
24226 Display the current default base for numeric input.
24227
24228 @kindex show output-radix
24229 @item show output-radix
24230 Display the current default base for numeric display.
24231
24232 @item set radix @r{[}@var{base}@r{]}
24233 @itemx show radix
24234 @kindex set radix
24235 @kindex show radix
24236 These commands set and show the default base for both input and output
24237 of numbers. @code{set radix} sets the radix of input and output to
24238 the same base; without an argument, it resets the radix back to its
24239 default value of 10.
24240
24241 @end table
24242
24243 @node ABI
24244 @section Configuring the Current ABI
24245
24246 @value{GDBN} can determine the @dfn{ABI} (Application Binary Interface) of your
24247 application automatically. However, sometimes you need to override its
24248 conclusions. Use these commands to manage @value{GDBN}'s view of the
24249 current ABI.
24250
24251 @cindex OS ABI
24252 @kindex set osabi
24253 @kindex show osabi
24254 @cindex Newlib OS ABI and its influence on the longjmp handling
24255
24256 One @value{GDBN} configuration can debug binaries for multiple operating
24257 system targets, either via remote debugging or native emulation.
24258 @value{GDBN} will autodetect the @dfn{OS ABI} (Operating System ABI) in use,
24259 but you can override its conclusion using the @code{set osabi} command.
24260 One example where this is useful is in debugging of binaries which use
24261 an alternate C library (e.g.@: @sc{uClibc} for @sc{gnu}/Linux) which does
24262 not have the same identifying marks that the standard C library for your
24263 platform provides.
24264
24265 When @value{GDBN} is debugging the AArch64 architecture, it provides a
24266 ``Newlib'' OS ABI. This is useful for handling @code{setjmp} and
24267 @code{longjmp} when debugging binaries that use the @sc{newlib} C library.
24268 The ``Newlib'' OS ABI can be selected by @code{set osabi Newlib}.
24269
24270 @table @code
24271 @item show osabi
24272 Show the OS ABI currently in use.
24273
24274 @item set osabi
24275 With no argument, show the list of registered available OS ABI's.
24276
24277 @item set osabi @var{abi}
24278 Set the current OS ABI to @var{abi}.
24279 @end table
24280
24281 @cindex float promotion
24282
24283 Generally, the way that an argument of type @code{float} is passed to a
24284 function depends on whether the function is prototyped. For a prototyped
24285 (i.e.@: ANSI/ISO style) function, @code{float} arguments are passed unchanged,
24286 according to the architecture's convention for @code{float}. For unprototyped
24287 (i.e.@: K&R style) functions, @code{float} arguments are first promoted to type
24288 @code{double} and then passed.
24289
24290 Unfortunately, some forms of debug information do not reliably indicate whether
24291 a function is prototyped. If @value{GDBN} calls a function that is not marked
24292 as prototyped, it consults @kbd{set coerce-float-to-double}.
24293
24294 @table @code
24295 @kindex set coerce-float-to-double
24296 @item set coerce-float-to-double
24297 @itemx set coerce-float-to-double on
24298 Arguments of type @code{float} will be promoted to @code{double} when passed
24299 to an unprototyped function. This is the default setting.
24300
24301 @item set coerce-float-to-double off
24302 Arguments of type @code{float} will be passed directly to unprototyped
24303 functions.
24304
24305 @kindex show coerce-float-to-double
24306 @item show coerce-float-to-double
24307 Show the current setting of promoting @code{float} to @code{double}.
24308 @end table
24309
24310 @kindex set cp-abi
24311 @kindex show cp-abi
24312 @value{GDBN} needs to know the ABI used for your program's C@t{++}
24313 objects. The correct C@t{++} ABI depends on which C@t{++} compiler was
24314 used to build your application. @value{GDBN} only fully supports
24315 programs with a single C@t{++} ABI; if your program contains code using
24316 multiple C@t{++} ABI's or if @value{GDBN} can not identify your
24317 program's ABI correctly, you can tell @value{GDBN} which ABI to use.
24318 Currently supported ABI's include ``gnu-v2'', for @code{g++} versions
24319 before 3.0, ``gnu-v3'', for @code{g++} versions 3.0 and later, and
24320 ``hpaCC'' for the HP ANSI C@t{++} compiler. Other C@t{++} compilers may
24321 use the ``gnu-v2'' or ``gnu-v3'' ABI's as well. The default setting is
24322 ``auto''.
24323
24324 @table @code
24325 @item show cp-abi
24326 Show the C@t{++} ABI currently in use.
24327
24328 @item set cp-abi
24329 With no argument, show the list of supported C@t{++} ABI's.
24330
24331 @item set cp-abi @var{abi}
24332 @itemx set cp-abi auto
24333 Set the current C@t{++} ABI to @var{abi}, or return to automatic detection.
24334 @end table
24335
24336 @node Auto-loading
24337 @section Automatically loading associated files
24338 @cindex auto-loading
24339
24340 @value{GDBN} sometimes reads files with commands and settings automatically,
24341 without being explicitly told so by the user. We call this feature
24342 @dfn{auto-loading}. While auto-loading is useful for automatically adapting
24343 @value{GDBN} to the needs of your project, it can sometimes produce unexpected
24344 results or introduce security risks (e.g., if the file comes from untrusted
24345 sources).
24346
24347 @menu
24348 * Init File in the Current Directory:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load local-gdbinit}
24349 * libthread_db.so.1 file:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load libthread-db}
24350
24351 * Auto-loading safe path:: @samp{set/show/info auto-load safe-path}
24352 * Auto-loading verbose mode:: @samp{set/show debug auto-load}
24353 @end menu
24354
24355 There are various kinds of files @value{GDBN} can automatically load.
24356 In addition to these files, @value{GDBN} supports auto-loading code written
24357 in various extension languages. @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
24358
24359 Note that loading of these associated files (including the local @file{.gdbinit}
24360 file) requires accordingly configured @code{auto-load safe-path}
24361 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24362
24363 For these reasons, @value{GDBN} includes commands and options to let you
24364 control when to auto-load files and which files should be auto-loaded.
24365
24366 @table @code
24367 @anchor{set auto-load off}
24368 @kindex set auto-load off
24369 @item set auto-load off
24370 Globally disable loading of all auto-loaded files.
24371 You may want to use this command with the @samp{-iex} option
24372 (@pxref{Option -init-eval-command}) such as:
24373 @smallexample
24374 $ @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load off" untrusted-executable corefile}
24375 @end smallexample
24376
24377 Be aware that system init file (@pxref{System-wide configuration})
24378 and init files from your home directory (@pxref{Home Directory Init File})
24379 still get read (as they come from generally trusted directories).
24380 To prevent @value{GDBN} from auto-loading even those init files, use the
24381 @option{-nx} option (@pxref{Mode Options}), in addition to
24382 @code{set auto-load no}.
24383
24384 @anchor{show auto-load}
24385 @kindex show auto-load
24386 @item show auto-load
24387 Show whether auto-loading of each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) is enabled
24388 or disabled.
24389
24390 @smallexample
24391 (gdb) show auto-load
24392 gdb-scripts: Auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is on.
24393 libthread-db: Auto-loading of inferior specific libthread_db is on.
24394 local-gdbinit: Auto-loading of .gdbinit script from current directory
24395 is on.
24396 python-scripts: Auto-loading of Python scripts is on.
24397 safe-path: List of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
24398 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
24399 scripts-directory: List of directories from which to load auto-loaded scripts
24400 is $debugdir:$datadir/auto-load.
24401 @end smallexample
24402
24403 @anchor{info auto-load}
24404 @kindex info auto-load
24405 @item info auto-load
24406 Print whether each specific @samp{auto-load} file(s) have been auto-loaded or
24407 not.
24408
24409 @smallexample
24410 (gdb) info auto-load
24411 gdb-scripts:
24412 Loaded Script
24413 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb
24414 libthread-db: No auto-loaded libthread-db.
24415 local-gdbinit: Local .gdbinit file "/home/user/gdb/.gdbinit" has been
24416 loaded.
24417 python-scripts:
24418 Loaded Script
24419 Yes /home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py
24420 @end smallexample
24421 @end table
24422
24423 These are @value{GDBN} control commands for the auto-loading:
24424
24425 @multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
24426 @item @xref{set auto-load off}.
24427 @tab Disable auto-loading globally.
24428 @item @xref{show auto-load}.
24429 @tab Show setting of all kinds of files.
24430 @item @xref{info auto-load}.
24431 @tab Show state of all kinds of files.
24432 @item @xref{set auto-load gdb-scripts}.
24433 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} command scripts.
24434 @item @xref{show auto-load gdb-scripts}.
24435 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
24436 @item @xref{info auto-load gdb-scripts}.
24437 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} command scripts.
24438 @item @xref{set auto-load python-scripts}.
24439 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
24440 @item @xref{show auto-load python-scripts}.
24441 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
24442 @item @xref{info auto-load python-scripts}.
24443 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Python scripts.
24444 @item @xref{set auto-load guile-scripts}.
24445 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
24446 @item @xref{show auto-load guile-scripts}.
24447 @tab Show setting of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
24448 @item @xref{info auto-load guile-scripts}.
24449 @tab Show state of @value{GDBN} Guile scripts.
24450 @item @xref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
24451 @tab Control for @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
24452 @item @xref{show auto-load scripts-directory}.
24453 @tab Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
24454 @item @xref{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}.
24455 @tab Add directory for auto-loaded scripts location list.
24456 @item @xref{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
24457 @tab Control for init file in the current directory.
24458 @item @xref{show auto-load local-gdbinit}.
24459 @tab Show setting of init file in the current directory.
24460 @item @xref{info auto-load local-gdbinit}.
24461 @tab Show state of init file in the current directory.
24462 @item @xref{set auto-load libthread-db}.
24463 @tab Control for thread debugging library.
24464 @item @xref{show auto-load libthread-db}.
24465 @tab Show setting of thread debugging library.
24466 @item @xref{info auto-load libthread-db}.
24467 @tab Show state of thread debugging library.
24468 @item @xref{set auto-load safe-path}.
24469 @tab Control directories trusted for automatic loading.
24470 @item @xref{show auto-load safe-path}.
24471 @tab Show directories trusted for automatic loading.
24472 @item @xref{add-auto-load-safe-path}.
24473 @tab Add directory trusted for automatic loading.
24474 @end multitable
24475
24476 @node Init File in the Current Directory
24477 @subsection Automatically loading init file in the current directory
24478 @cindex auto-loading init file in the current directory
24479
24480 By default, @value{GDBN} reads and executes the canned sequences of commands
24481 from init file (if any) in the current working directory,
24482 see @ref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}.
24483
24484 Note that loading of this local @file{.gdbinit} file also requires accordingly
24485 configured @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24486
24487 @table @code
24488 @anchor{set auto-load local-gdbinit}
24489 @kindex set auto-load local-gdbinit
24490 @item set auto-load local-gdbinit [on|off]
24491 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands
24492 (@pxref{Sequences}) found in init file in the current directory.
24493
24494 @anchor{show auto-load local-gdbinit}
24495 @kindex show auto-load local-gdbinit
24496 @item show auto-load local-gdbinit
24497 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands from init file in the
24498 current directory is enabled or disabled.
24499
24500 @anchor{info auto-load local-gdbinit}
24501 @kindex info auto-load local-gdbinit
24502 @item info auto-load local-gdbinit
24503 Print whether canned sequences of commands from init file in the
24504 current directory have been auto-loaded.
24505 @end table
24506
24507 @node libthread_db.so.1 file
24508 @subsection Automatically loading thread debugging library
24509 @cindex auto-loading libthread_db.so.1
24510
24511 This feature is currently present only on @sc{gnu}/Linux native hosts.
24512
24513 @value{GDBN} reads in some cases thread debugging library from places specific
24514 to the inferior (@pxref{set libthread-db-search-path}).
24515
24516 The special @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entry @samp{$sdir} is processed
24517 without checking this @samp{set auto-load libthread-db} switch as system
24518 libraries have to be trusted in general. In all other cases of
24519 @samp{libthread-db-search-path} entries @value{GDBN} checks first if @samp{set
24520 auto-load libthread-db} is enabled before trying to open such thread debugging
24521 library.
24522
24523 Note that loading of this debugging library also requires accordingly configured
24524 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
24525
24526 @table @code
24527 @anchor{set auto-load libthread-db}
24528 @kindex set auto-load libthread-db
24529 @item set auto-load libthread-db [on|off]
24530 Enable or disable the auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library.
24531
24532 @anchor{show auto-load libthread-db}
24533 @kindex show auto-load libthread-db
24534 @item show auto-load libthread-db
24535 Show whether auto-loading of inferior specific thread debugging library is
24536 enabled or disabled.
24537
24538 @anchor{info auto-load libthread-db}
24539 @kindex info auto-load libthread-db
24540 @item info auto-load libthread-db
24541 Print the list of all loaded inferior specific thread debugging libraries and
24542 for each such library print list of inferior @var{pid}s using it.
24543 @end table
24544
24545 @node Auto-loading safe path
24546 @subsection Security restriction for auto-loading
24547 @cindex auto-loading safe-path
24548
24549 As the files of inferior can come from untrusted source (such as submitted by
24550 an application user) @value{GDBN} does not always load any files automatically.
24551 @value{GDBN} provides the @samp{set auto-load safe-path} setting to list
24552 directories trusted for loading files not explicitly requested by user.
24553 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern.
24554
24555 If the path is not set properly you will see a warning and the file will not
24556 get loaded:
24557
24558 @smallexample
24559 $ ./gdb -q ./gdb
24560 Reading symbols from /home/user/gdb/gdb...done.
24561 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been
24562 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
24563 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
24564 warning: File "/home/user/gdb/gdb-gdb.py" auto-loading has been
24565 declined by your `auto-load safe-path' set
24566 to "$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load".
24567 @end smallexample
24568
24569 @noindent
24570 To instruct @value{GDBN} to go ahead and use the init files anyway,
24571 invoke @value{GDBN} like this:
24572
24573 @smallexample
24574 $ gdb -q -iex "set auto-load safe-path /home/user/gdb" ./gdb
24575 @end smallexample
24576
24577 The list of trusted directories is controlled by the following commands:
24578
24579 @table @code
24580 @anchor{set auto-load safe-path}
24581 @kindex set auto-load safe-path
24582 @item set auto-load safe-path @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
24583 Set the list of directories (and their subdirectories) trusted for automatic
24584 loading and execution of scripts. You can also enter a specific trusted file.
24585 Each directory can also be a shell wildcard pattern; wildcards do not match
24586 directory separator - see @code{FNM_PATHNAME} for system function @code{fnmatch}
24587 (@pxref{Wildcard Matching, fnmatch, , libc, GNU C Library Reference Manual}).
24588 If you omit @var{directories}, @samp{auto-load safe-path} will be reset to
24589 its default value as specified during @value{GDBN} compilation.
24590
24591 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
24592 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
24593 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
24594
24595 @anchor{show auto-load safe-path}
24596 @kindex show auto-load safe-path
24597 @item show auto-load safe-path
24598 Show the list of directories trusted for automatic loading and execution of
24599 scripts.
24600
24601 @anchor{add-auto-load-safe-path}
24602 @kindex add-auto-load-safe-path
24603 @item add-auto-load-safe-path
24604 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of directories trusted for
24605 automatic loading and execution of scripts. Multiple entries may be delimited
24606 by the host platform path separator in use.
24607 @end table
24608
24609 This variable defaults to what @code{--with-auto-load-dir} has been configured
24610 to (@pxref{with-auto-load-dir}). @file{$debugdir} and @file{$datadir}
24611 substitution applies the same as for @ref{set auto-load scripts-directory}.
24612 The default @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by
24613 @value{GDBN} configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-safe-path}.
24614
24615 Setting this variable to @file{/} disables this security protection,
24616 corresponding @value{GDBN} configuration option is
24617 @option{--without-auto-load-safe-path}.
24618 This variable is supposed to be set to the system directories writable by the
24619 system superuser only. Users can add their source directories in init files in
24620 their home directories (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). See also deprecated
24621 init file in the current directory
24622 (@pxref{Init File in the Current Directory during Startup}).
24623
24624 To force @value{GDBN} to load the files it declined to load in the previous
24625 example, you could use one of the following ways:
24626
24627 @table @asis
24628 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{add-auto-load-safe-path ~/src/gdb}
24629 Specify this trusted directory (or a file) as additional component of the list.
24630 You have to specify also any existing directories displayed by
24631 by @samp{show auto-load safe-path} (such as @samp{/usr:/bin} in this example).
24632
24633 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /usr:/bin:~/src/gdb" @dots{}}
24634 Specify this directory as in the previous case but just for a single
24635 @value{GDBN} session.
24636
24637 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load safe-path /" @dots{}}
24638 Disable auto-loading safety for a single @value{GDBN} session.
24639 This assumes all the files you debug during this @value{GDBN} session will come
24640 from trusted sources.
24641
24642 @item @kbd{./configure --without-auto-load-safe-path}
24643 During compilation of @value{GDBN} you may disable any auto-loading safety.
24644 This assumes all the files you will ever debug with this @value{GDBN} come from
24645 trusted sources.
24646 @end table
24647
24648 On the other hand you can also explicitly forbid automatic files loading which
24649 also suppresses any such warning messages:
24650
24651 @table @asis
24652 @item @kbd{gdb -iex "set auto-load no" @dots{}}
24653 You can use @value{GDBN} command-line option for a single @value{GDBN} session.
24654
24655 @item @file{~/.gdbinit}: @samp{set auto-load no}
24656 Disable auto-loading globally for the user
24657 (@pxref{Home Directory Init File}). While it is improbable, you could also
24658 use system init file instead (@pxref{System-wide configuration}).
24659 @end table
24660
24661 This setting applies to the file names as entered by user. If no entry matches
24662 @value{GDBN} tries as a last resort to also resolve all the file names into
24663 their canonical form (typically resolving symbolic links) and compare the
24664 entries again. @value{GDBN} already canonicalizes most of the filenames on its
24665 own before starting the comparison so a canonical form of directories is
24666 recommended to be entered.
24667
24668 @node Auto-loading verbose mode
24669 @subsection Displaying files tried for auto-load
24670 @cindex auto-loading verbose mode
24671
24672 For better visibility of all the file locations where you can place scripts to
24673 be auto-loaded with inferior --- or to protect yourself against accidental
24674 execution of untrusted scripts --- @value{GDBN} provides a feature for printing
24675 all the files attempted to be loaded. Both existing and non-existing files may
24676 be printed.
24677
24678 For example the list of directories from which it is safe to auto-load files
24679 (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}) applies also to canonicalized filenames which
24680 may not be too obvious while setting it up.
24681
24682 @smallexample
24683 (gdb) set debug auto-load on
24684 (gdb) file ~/src/t/true
24685 auto-load: Loading canned sequences of commands script "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb"
24686 for objfile "/tmp/true".
24687 auto-load: Updating directories of "/usr:/opt".
24688 auto-load: Using directory "/usr".
24689 auto-load: Using directory "/opt".
24690 warning: File "/tmp/true-gdb.gdb" auto-loading has been declined
24691 by your `auto-load safe-path' set to "/usr:/opt".
24692 @end smallexample
24693
24694 @table @code
24695 @anchor{set debug auto-load}
24696 @kindex set debug auto-load
24697 @item set debug auto-load [on|off]
24698 Set whether to print the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded.
24699
24700 @anchor{show debug auto-load}
24701 @kindex show debug auto-load
24702 @item show debug auto-load
24703 Show whether printing of the filenames attempted to be auto-loaded is turned
24704 on or off.
24705 @end table
24706
24707 @node Messages/Warnings
24708 @section Optional Warnings and Messages
24709
24710 @cindex verbose operation
24711 @cindex optional warnings
24712 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
24713 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
24714 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
24715 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
24716
24717 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
24718 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
24719 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to Specify Files}.
24720
24721 @table @code
24722 @kindex set verbose
24723 @item set verbose on
24724 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
24725
24726 @item set verbose off
24727 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
24728
24729 @kindex show verbose
24730 @item show verbose
24731 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
24732 @end table
24733
24734 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
24735 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
24736 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors Reading
24737 Symbol Files}).
24738
24739 @table @code
24740
24741 @kindex set complaints
24742 @item set complaints @var{limit}
24743 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
24744 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
24745 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
24746 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
24747
24748 @kindex show complaints
24749 @item show complaints
24750 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
24751
24752 @end table
24753
24754 @anchor{confirmation requests}
24755 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
24756 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
24757 you try to run a program which is already running:
24758
24759 @smallexample
24760 (@value{GDBP}) run
24761 The program being debugged has been started already.
24762 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
24763 @end smallexample
24764
24765 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
24766 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
24767
24768 @table @code
24769
24770 @kindex set confirm
24771 @cindex flinching
24772 @cindex confirmation
24773 @cindex stupid questions
24774 @item set confirm off
24775 Disables confirmation requests. Note that running @value{GDBN} with
24776 the @option{--batch} option (@pxref{Mode Options, -batch}) also
24777 automatically disables confirmation requests.
24778
24779 @item set confirm on
24780 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
24781
24782 @kindex show confirm
24783 @item show confirm
24784 Displays state of confirmation requests.
24785
24786 @end table
24787
24788 @cindex command tracing
24789 If you need to debug user-defined commands or sourced files you may find it
24790 useful to enable @dfn{command tracing}. In this mode each command will be
24791 printed as it is executed, prefixed with one or more @samp{+} symbols, the
24792 quantity denoting the call depth of each command.
24793
24794 @table @code
24795 @kindex set trace-commands
24796 @cindex command scripts, debugging
24797 @item set trace-commands on
24798 Enable command tracing.
24799 @item set trace-commands off
24800 Disable command tracing.
24801 @item show trace-commands
24802 Display the current state of command tracing.
24803 @end table
24804
24805 @node Debugging Output
24806 @section Optional Messages about Internal Happenings
24807 @cindex optional debugging messages
24808
24809 @value{GDBN} has commands that enable optional debugging messages from
24810 various @value{GDBN} subsystems; normally these commands are of
24811 interest to @value{GDBN} maintainers, or when reporting a bug. This
24812 section documents those commands.
24813
24814 @table @code
24815 @kindex set exec-done-display
24816 @item set exec-done-display
24817 Turns on or off the notification of asynchronous commands'
24818 completion. When on, @value{GDBN} will print a message when an
24819 asynchronous command finishes its execution. The default is off.
24820 @kindex show exec-done-display
24821 @item show exec-done-display
24822 Displays the current setting of asynchronous command completion
24823 notification.
24824 @kindex set debug
24825 @cindex ARM AArch64
24826 @item set debug aarch64
24827 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to ARM AArch64.
24828 The default is off.
24829 @kindex show debug
24830 @item show debug aarch64
24831 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
24832 ARM AArch64.
24833 @cindex gdbarch debugging info
24834 @cindex architecture debugging info
24835 @item set debug arch
24836 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
24837 @item show debug arch
24838 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
24839 @item set debug aix-solib
24840 @cindex AIX shared library debugging
24841 Control display of debugging messages from the AIX shared library
24842 support module. The default is off.
24843 @item show debug aix-thread
24844 Show the current state of displaying AIX shared library debugging messages.
24845 @item set debug aix-thread
24846 @cindex AIX threads
24847 Display debugging messages about inner workings of the AIX thread
24848 module.
24849 @item show debug aix-thread
24850 Show the current state of AIX thread debugging info display.
24851 @item set debug check-physname
24852 @cindex physname
24853 Check the results of the ``physname'' computation. When reading DWARF
24854 debugging information for C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} attempts to compute
24855 each entity's name. @value{GDBN} can do this computation in two
24856 different ways, depending on exactly what information is present.
24857 When enabled, this setting causes @value{GDBN} to compute the names
24858 both ways and display any discrepancies.
24859 @item show debug check-physname
24860 Show the current state of ``physname'' checking.
24861 @item set debug coff-pe-read
24862 @cindex COFF/PE exported symbols
24863 Control display of debugging messages related to reading of COFF/PE
24864 exported symbols. The default is off.
24865 @item show debug coff-pe-read
24866 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
24867 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
24868 @item set debug dwarf-die
24869 @cindex DWARF DIEs
24870 Dump DWARF DIEs after they are read in.
24871 The value is the number of nesting levels to print.
24872 A value of zero turns off the display.
24873 @item show debug dwarf-die
24874 Show the current state of DWARF DIE debugging.
24875 @item set debug dwarf-line
24876 @cindex DWARF Line Tables
24877 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
24878 DWARF line tables. The default is 0 (off).
24879 A value of 1 provides basic information.
24880 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
24881 @item show debug dwarf-line
24882 Show the current state of DWARF line table debugging.
24883 @item set debug dwarf-read
24884 @cindex DWARF Reading
24885 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to reading
24886 DWARF debug info. The default is 0 (off).
24887 A value of 1 provides basic information.
24888 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
24889 @item show debug dwarf-read
24890 Show the current state of DWARF reader debugging.
24891 @item set debug displaced
24892 @cindex displaced stepping debugging info
24893 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for the
24894 displaced stepping support. The default is off.
24895 @item show debug displaced
24896 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} debugging info
24897 related to displaced stepping.
24898 @item set debug event
24899 @cindex event debugging info
24900 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
24901 default is off.
24902 @item show debug event
24903 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
24904 info.
24905 @item set debug expression
24906 @cindex expression debugging info
24907 Turns on or off display of debugging info about @value{GDBN}
24908 expression parsing. The default is off.
24909 @item show debug expression
24910 Displays the current state of displaying debugging info about
24911 @value{GDBN} expression parsing.
24912 @item set debug fbsd-lwp
24913 @cindex FreeBSD LWP debug messages
24914 Turns on or off debugging messages from the FreeBSD LWP debug support.
24915 @item show debug fbsd-lwp
24916 Show the current state of FreeBSD LWP debugging messages.
24917 @item set debug fbsd-nat
24918 @cindex FreeBSD native target debug messages
24919 Turns on or off debugging messages from the FreeBSD native target.
24920 @item show debug fbsd-nat
24921 Show the current state of FreeBSD native target debugging messages.
24922 @item set debug frame
24923 @cindex frame debugging info
24924 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} frame debugging info. The
24925 default is off.
24926 @item show debug frame
24927 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} frame debugging
24928 info.
24929 @item set debug gnu-nat
24930 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug messages
24931 Turn on or off debugging messages from the @sc{gnu}/Hurd debug support.
24932 @item show debug gnu-nat
24933 Show the current state of @sc{gnu}/Hurd debugging messages.
24934 @item set debug infrun
24935 @cindex inferior debugging info
24936 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} debugging info for running the inferior.
24937 The default is off. @file{infrun.c} contains GDB's runtime state machine used
24938 for implementing operations such as single-stepping the inferior.
24939 @item show debug infrun
24940 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} inferior debugging.
24941 @item set debug jit
24942 @cindex just-in-time compilation, debugging messages
24943 Turn on or off debugging messages from JIT debug support.
24944 @item show debug jit
24945 Displays the current state of @value{GDBN} JIT debugging.
24946 @item set debug lin-lwp
24947 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux LWP debug messages
24948 @cindex Linux lightweight processes
24949 Turn on or off debugging messages from the Linux LWP debug support.
24950 @item show debug lin-lwp
24951 Show the current state of Linux LWP debugging messages.
24952 @item set debug linux-namespaces
24953 @cindex @sc{gnu}/Linux namespaces debug messages
24954 Turn on or off debugging messages from the Linux namespaces debug support.
24955 @item show debug linux-namespaces
24956 Show the current state of Linux namespaces debugging messages.
24957 @item set debug mach-o
24958 @cindex Mach-O symbols processing
24959 Control display of debugging messages related to Mach-O symbols
24960 processing. The default is off.
24961 @item show debug mach-o
24962 Displays the current state of displaying debugging messages related to
24963 reading of COFF/PE exported symbols.
24964 @item set debug notification
24965 @cindex remote async notification debugging info
24966 Turn on or off debugging messages about remote async notification.
24967 The default is off.
24968 @item show debug notification
24969 Displays the current state of remote async notification debugging messages.
24970 @item set debug observer
24971 @cindex observer debugging info
24972 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} observer debugging. This
24973 includes info such as the notification of observable events.
24974 @item show debug observer
24975 Displays the current state of observer debugging.
24976 @item set debug overload
24977 @cindex C@t{++} overload debugging info
24978 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
24979 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
24980 is off.
24981 @item show debug overload
24982 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
24983 debugging info.
24984 @cindex expression parser, debugging info
24985 @cindex debug expression parser
24986 @item set debug parser
24987 Turns on or off the display of expression parser debugging output.
24988 Internally, this sets the @code{yydebug} variable in the expression
24989 parser. @xref{Tracing, , Tracing Your Parser, bison, Bison}, for
24990 details. The default is off.
24991 @item show debug parser
24992 Show the current state of expression parser debugging.
24993 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
24994 @cindex serial connections, debugging
24995 @cindex debug remote protocol
24996 @cindex remote protocol debugging
24997 @cindex display remote packets
24998 @item set debug remote
24999 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
25000 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
25001 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
25002 @item show debug remote
25003 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
25004
25005 @item set debug separate-debug-file
25006 Turns on or off display of debug output about separate debug file search.
25007 @item show debug separate-debug-file
25008 Displays the state of separate debug file search debug output.
25009
25010 @item set debug serial
25011 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
25012 default is off.
25013 @item show debug serial
25014 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
25015 info.
25016 @item set debug solib-frv
25017 @cindex FR-V shared-library debugging
25018 Turn on or off debugging messages for FR-V shared-library code.
25019 @item show debug solib-frv
25020 Display the current state of FR-V shared-library code debugging
25021 messages.
25022 @item set debug symbol-lookup
25023 @cindex symbol lookup
25024 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol lookup.
25025 The default is 0 (off).
25026 A value of 1 provides basic information.
25027 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
25028 @item show debug symbol-lookup
25029 Show the current state of symbol lookup debugging messages.
25030 @item set debug symfile
25031 @cindex symbol file functions
25032 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol file functions.
25033 The default is off. @xref{Files}.
25034 @item show debug symfile
25035 Show the current state of symbol file debugging messages.
25036 @item set debug symtab-create
25037 @cindex symbol table creation
25038 Turns on or off display of debugging messages related to symbol table creation.
25039 The default is 0 (off).
25040 A value of 1 provides basic information.
25041 A value greater than 1 provides more verbose information.
25042 @item show debug symtab-create
25043 Show the current state of symbol table creation debugging.
25044 @item set debug target
25045 @cindex target debugging info
25046 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
25047 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
25048 default is 0. Set it to 1 to track events, and to 2 to also track the
25049 value of large memory transfers.
25050 @item show debug target
25051 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
25052 info.
25053 @item set debug timestamp
25054 @cindex timestampping debugging info
25055 Turns on or off display of timestamps with @value{GDBN} debugging info.
25056 When enabled, seconds and microseconds are displayed before each debugging
25057 message.
25058 @item show debug timestamp
25059 Displays the current state of displaying timestamps with @value{GDBN}
25060 debugging info.
25061 @item set debug varobj
25062 @cindex variable object debugging info
25063 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
25064 info. The default is off.
25065 @item show debug varobj
25066 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
25067 debugging info.
25068 @item set debug xml
25069 @cindex XML parser debugging
25070 Turn on or off debugging messages for built-in XML parsers.
25071 @item show debug xml
25072 Displays the current state of XML debugging messages.
25073 @end table
25074
25075 @node Other Misc Settings
25076 @section Other Miscellaneous Settings
25077 @cindex miscellaneous settings
25078
25079 @table @code
25080 @kindex set interactive-mode
25081 @item set interactive-mode
25082 If @code{on}, forces @value{GDBN} to assume that GDB was started
25083 in a terminal. In practice, this means that @value{GDBN} should wait
25084 for the user to answer queries generated by commands entered at
25085 the command prompt. If @code{off}, forces @value{GDBN} to operate
25086 in the opposite mode, and it uses the default answers to all queries.
25087 If @code{auto} (the default), @value{GDBN} tries to determine whether
25088 its standard input is a terminal, and works in interactive-mode if it
25089 is, non-interactively otherwise.
25090
25091 In the vast majority of cases, the debugger should be able to guess
25092 correctly which mode should be used. But this setting can be useful
25093 in certain specific cases, such as running a MinGW @value{GDBN}
25094 inside a cygwin window.
25095
25096 @kindex show interactive-mode
25097 @item show interactive-mode
25098 Displays whether the debugger is operating in interactive mode or not.
25099 @end table
25100
25101 @node Extending GDB
25102 @chapter Extending @value{GDBN}
25103 @cindex extending GDB
25104
25105 @value{GDBN} provides several mechanisms for extension.
25106 @value{GDBN} also provides the ability to automatically load
25107 extensions when it reads a file for debugging. This allows the
25108 user to automatically customize @value{GDBN} for the program
25109 being debugged.
25110
25111 @menu
25112 * Sequences:: Canned Sequences of @value{GDBN} Commands
25113 * Python:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Python
25114 * Guile:: Extending @value{GDBN} using Guile
25115 * Auto-loading extensions:: Automatically loading extensions
25116 * Multiple Extension Languages:: Working with multiple extension languages
25117 * Aliases:: Creating new spellings of existing commands
25118 @end menu
25119
25120 To facilitate the use of extension languages, @value{GDBN} is capable
25121 of evaluating the contents of a file. When doing so, @value{GDBN}
25122 can recognize which extension language is being used by looking at
25123 the filename extension. Files with an unrecognized filename extension
25124 are always treated as a @value{GDBN} Command Files.
25125 @xref{Command Files,, Command files}.
25126
25127 You can control how @value{GDBN} evaluates these files with the following
25128 setting:
25129
25130 @table @code
25131 @kindex set script-extension
25132 @kindex show script-extension
25133 @item set script-extension off
25134 All scripts are always evaluated as @value{GDBN} Command Files.
25135
25136 @item set script-extension soft
25137 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
25138 extension. If this scripting language is supported, @value{GDBN}
25139 evaluates the script using that language. Otherwise, it evaluates
25140 the file as a @value{GDBN} Command File.
25141
25142 @item set script-extension strict
25143 The debugger determines the scripting language based on filename
25144 extension, and evaluates the script using that language. If the
25145 language is not supported, then the evaluation fails.
25146
25147 @item show script-extension
25148 Display the current value of the @code{script-extension} option.
25149
25150 @end table
25151
25152 @node Sequences
25153 @section Canned Sequences of Commands
25154
25155 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
25156 Command Lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
25157 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
25158 files.
25159
25160 @menu
25161 * Define:: How to define your own commands
25162 * Hooks:: Hooks for user-defined commands
25163 * Command Files:: How to write scripts of commands to be stored in a file
25164 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
25165 * Auto-loading sequences:: Controlling auto-loaded command files
25166 @end menu
25167
25168 @node Define
25169 @subsection User-defined Commands
25170
25171 @cindex user-defined command
25172 @cindex arguments, to user-defined commands
25173 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
25174 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
25175 @code{define} command. User commands may accept an unlimited number of arguments
25176 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
25177 via @code{$arg0@dots{}$argN}. A trivial example:
25178
25179 @smallexample
25180 define adder
25181 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
25182 end
25183 @end smallexample
25184
25185 @noindent
25186 To execute the command use:
25187
25188 @smallexample
25189 adder 1 2 3
25190 @end smallexample
25191
25192 @noindent
25193 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
25194 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
25195 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
25196 functions calls.
25197
25198 @cindex argument count in user-defined commands
25199 @cindex how many arguments (user-defined commands)
25200 In addition, @code{$argc} may be used to find out how many arguments have
25201 been passed.
25202
25203 @smallexample
25204 define adder
25205 if $argc == 2
25206 print $arg0 + $arg1
25207 end
25208 if $argc == 3
25209 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
25210 end
25211 end
25212 @end smallexample
25213
25214 Combining with the @code{eval} command (@pxref{eval}) makes it easier
25215 to process a variable number of arguments:
25216
25217 @smallexample
25218 define adder
25219 set $i = 0
25220 set $sum = 0
25221 while $i < $argc
25222 eval "set $sum = $sum + $arg%d", $i
25223 set $i = $i + 1
25224 end
25225 print $sum
25226 end
25227 @end smallexample
25228
25229 @table @code
25230
25231 @kindex define
25232 @item define @var{commandname}
25233 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
25234 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
25235 The argument @var{commandname} may be a bare command name consisting of letters,
25236 numbers, dashes, and underscores. It may also start with any predefined
25237 prefix command. For example, @samp{define target my-target} creates
25238 a user-defined @samp{target my-target} command.
25239
25240 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
25241 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
25242 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
25243
25244 @kindex document
25245 @kindex end@r{ (user-defined commands)}
25246 @item document @var{commandname}
25247 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
25248 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
25249 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
25250 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
25251 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
25252 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
25253
25254 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
25255 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
25256 does not change the documentation.
25257
25258 @kindex dont-repeat
25259 @cindex don't repeat command
25260 @item dont-repeat
25261 Used inside a user-defined command, this tells @value{GDBN} that this
25262 command should not be repeated when the user hits @key{RET}
25263 (@pxref{Command Syntax, repeat last command}).
25264
25265 @kindex help user-defined
25266 @item help user-defined
25267 List all user-defined commands and all python commands defined in class
25268 COMAND_USER. The first line of the documentation or docstring is
25269 included (if any).
25270
25271 @kindex show user
25272 @item show user
25273 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
25274 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
25275 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
25276 definitions for all user-defined commands.
25277 This does not work for user-defined python commands.
25278
25279 @cindex infinite recursion in user-defined commands
25280 @kindex show max-user-call-depth
25281 @kindex set max-user-call-depth
25282 @item show max-user-call-depth
25283 @itemx set max-user-call-depth
25284 The value of @code{max-user-call-depth} controls how many recursion
25285 levels are allowed in user-defined commands before @value{GDBN} suspects an
25286 infinite recursion and aborts the command.
25287 This does not apply to user-defined python commands.
25288 @end table
25289
25290 In addition to the above commands, user-defined commands frequently
25291 use control flow commands, described in @ref{Command Files}.
25292
25293 When user-defined commands are executed, the
25294 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
25295 stops execution of the user-defined command.
25296
25297 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
25298 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
25299 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
25300 messages when used in a user-defined command.
25301
25302 @node Hooks
25303 @subsection User-defined Command Hooks
25304 @cindex command hooks
25305 @cindex hooks, for commands
25306 @cindex hooks, pre-command
25307
25308 @kindex hook
25309 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
25310 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
25311 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
25312 before that command.
25313
25314 @cindex hooks, post-command
25315 @kindex hookpost
25316 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
25317 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
25318 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
25319 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
25320 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
25321
25322 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
25323 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinite recursion.
25324
25325 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
25326 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
25327
25328 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
25329 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
25330 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
25331 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
25332 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
25333
25334 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
25335 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
25336 you could define:
25337
25338 @smallexample
25339 define hook-stop
25340 handle SIGALRM nopass
25341 end
25342
25343 define hook-run
25344 handle SIGALRM pass
25345 end
25346
25347 define hook-continue
25348 handle SIGALRM pass
25349 end
25350 @end smallexample
25351
25352 As a further example, to hook at the beginning and end of the @code{echo}
25353 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
25354 you could define:
25355
25356 @smallexample
25357 define hook-echo
25358 echo <<<---
25359 end
25360
25361 define hookpost-echo
25362 echo --->>>\n
25363 end
25364
25365 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
25366 <<<---Hello World--->>>
25367 (@value{GDBP})
25368
25369 @end smallexample
25370
25371 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
25372 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
25373 name, e.g.@: @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
25374 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
25375 @c or not?
25376 You can hook a multi-word command by adding @code{hook-} or
25377 @code{hookpost-} to the last word of the command, e.g.@:
25378 @samp{define target hook-remote} to add a hook to @samp{target remote}.
25379
25380 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
25381 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
25382 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
25383
25384 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
25385 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
25386
25387 @node Command Files
25388 @subsection Command Files
25389
25390 @cindex command files
25391 @cindex scripting commands
25392 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a text file made of lines that are
25393 @value{GDBN} commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may
25394 also be included. An empty line in a command file does nothing; it
25395 does not mean to repeat the last command, as it would from the
25396 terminal.
25397
25398 You can request the execution of a command file with the @code{source}
25399 command. Note that the @code{source} command is also used to evaluate
25400 scripts that are not Command Files. The exact behavior can be configured
25401 using the @code{script-extension} setting.
25402 @xref{Extending GDB,, Extending GDB}.
25403
25404 @table @code
25405 @kindex source
25406 @cindex execute commands from a file
25407 @item source [-s] [-v] @var{filename}
25408 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
25409 @end table
25410
25411 The lines in a command file are generally executed sequentially,
25412 unless the order of execution is changed by one of the
25413 @emph{flow-control commands} described below. The commands are not
25414 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates
25415 execution of the command file and control is returned to the console.
25416
25417 @value{GDBN} first searches for @var{filename} in the current directory.
25418 If the file is not found there, and @var{filename} does not specify a
25419 directory, then @value{GDBN} also looks for the file on the source search path
25420 (specified with the @samp{directory} command);
25421 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched because the compilation directory
25422 is not relevant to scripts.
25423
25424 If @code{-s} is specified, then @value{GDBN} searches for @var{filename}
25425 on the search path even if @var{filename} specifies a directory.
25426 The search is done by appending @var{filename} to each element of the
25427 search path. So, for example, if @var{filename} is @file{mylib/myscript}
25428 and the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
25429 look for the script @file{/home/user/mylib/myscript}.
25430 The search is also done if @var{filename} is an absolute path.
25431 For example, if @var{filename} is @file{/tmp/myscript} and
25432 the search path contains @file{/home/user} then @value{GDBN} will
25433 look for the script @file{/home/user/tmp/myscript}.
25434 For DOS-like systems, if @var{filename} contains a drive specification,
25435 it is stripped before concatenation. For example, if @var{filename} is
25436 @file{d:myscript} and the search path contains @file{c:/tmp} then @value{GDBN}
25437 will look for the script @file{c:/tmp/myscript}.
25438
25439 If @code{-v}, for verbose mode, is given then @value{GDBN} displays
25440 each command as it is executed. The option must be given before
25441 @var{filename}, and is interpreted as part of the filename anywhere else.
25442
25443 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
25444 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
25445 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
25446 when called from command files.
25447
25448 @value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
25449 mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
25450 standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
25451 not terminate execution of the command file---execution continues with
25452 the next command.
25453
25454 @smallexample
25455 gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
25456 @end smallexample
25457
25458 (The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
25459 will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
25460 would be directed to @file{log}.
25461
25462 Since commands stored on command files tend to be more general than
25463 commands typed interactively, they frequently need to deal with
25464 complicated situations, such as different or unexpected values of
25465 variables and symbols, changes in how the program being debugged is
25466 built, etc. @value{GDBN} provides a set of flow-control commands to
25467 deal with these complexities. Using these commands, you can write
25468 complex scripts that loop over data structures, execute commands
25469 conditionally, etc.
25470
25471 @table @code
25472 @kindex if
25473 @kindex else
25474 @item if
25475 @itemx else
25476 This command allows to include in your script conditionally executed
25477 commands. The @code{if} command takes a single argument, which is an
25478 expression to evaluate. It is followed by a series of commands that
25479 are executed only if the expression is true (its value is nonzero).
25480 There can then optionally be an @code{else} line, followed by a series
25481 of commands that are only executed if the expression was false. The
25482 end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
25483
25484 @kindex while
25485 @item while
25486 This command allows to write loops. Its syntax is similar to
25487 @code{if}: the command takes a single argument, which is an expression
25488 to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to execute, one per
25489 line, terminated by an @code{end}. These commands are called the
25490 @dfn{body} of the loop. The commands in the body of @code{while} are
25491 executed repeatedly as long as the expression evaluates to true.
25492
25493 @kindex loop_break
25494 @item loop_break
25495 This command exits the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included.
25496 Execution of the script continues after that @code{while}s @code{end}
25497 line.
25498
25499 @kindex loop_continue
25500 @item loop_continue
25501 This command skips the execution of the rest of the body of commands
25502 in the @code{while} loop in whose body it is included. Execution
25503 branches to the beginning of the @code{while} loop, where it evaluates
25504 the controlling expression.
25505
25506 @kindex end@r{ (if/else/while commands)}
25507 @item end
25508 Terminate the block of commands that are the body of @code{if},
25509 @code{else}, or @code{while} flow-control commands.
25510 @end table
25511
25512
25513 @node Output
25514 @subsection Commands for Controlled Output
25515
25516 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
25517 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
25518 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
25519 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
25520 want.
25521
25522 @table @code
25523 @kindex echo
25524 @item echo @var{text}
25525 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
25526 @c because it is not in ANSI.
25527 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
25528 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
25529 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
25530 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
25531 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
25532 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
25533 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
25534 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
25535 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
25536
25537 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
25538 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
25539
25540 @smallexample
25541 echo This is some text\n\
25542 which is continued\n\
25543 onto several lines.\n
25544 @end smallexample
25545
25546 produces the same output as
25547
25548 @smallexample
25549 echo This is some text\n
25550 echo which is continued\n
25551 echo onto several lines.\n
25552 @end smallexample
25553
25554 @kindex output
25555 @item output @var{expression}
25556 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
25557 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
25558 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
25559 on expressions.
25560
25561 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
25562 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
25563 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
25564 Formats}, for more information.
25565
25566 @kindex printf
25567 @item printf @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
25568 Print the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
25569 the string @var{template}. To print several values, make
25570 @var{expressions} be a comma-separated list of individual expressions,
25571 which may be either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as
25572 specified by @var{template}, exactly as a C program would do by
25573 executing the code below:
25574
25575 @smallexample
25576 printf (@var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
25577 @end smallexample
25578
25579 As in @code{C} @code{printf}, ordinary characters in @var{template}
25580 are printed verbatim, while @dfn{conversion specification} introduced
25581 by the @samp{%} character cause subsequent @var{expressions} to be
25582 evaluated, their values converted and formatted according to type and
25583 style information encoded in the conversion specifications, and then
25584 printed.
25585
25586 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
25587
25588 @smallexample
25589 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
25590 @end smallexample
25591
25592 @code{printf} supports all the standard @code{C} conversion
25593 specifications, including the flags and modifiers between the @samp{%}
25594 character and the conversion letter, with the following exceptions:
25595
25596 @itemize @bullet
25597 @item
25598 The argument-ordering modifiers, such as @samp{2$}, are not supported.
25599
25600 @item
25601 The modifier @samp{*} is not supported for specifying precision or
25602 width.
25603
25604 @item
25605 The @samp{'} flag (for separation of digits into groups according to
25606 @code{LC_NUMERIC'}) is not supported.
25607
25608 @item
25609 The type modifiers @samp{hh}, @samp{j}, @samp{t}, and @samp{z} are not
25610 supported.
25611
25612 @item
25613 The conversion letter @samp{n} (as in @samp{%n}) is not supported.
25614
25615 @item
25616 The conversion letters @samp{a} and @samp{A} are not supported.
25617 @end itemize
25618
25619 @noindent
25620 Note that the @samp{ll} type modifier is supported only if the
25621 underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} supports
25622 the @code{long long int} type, and the @samp{L} type modifier is
25623 supported only if @code{long double} type is available.
25624
25625 As in @code{C}, @code{printf} supports simple backslash-escape
25626 sequences, such as @code{\n}, @samp{\t}, @samp{\\}, @samp{\"},
25627 @samp{\a}, and @samp{\f}, that consist of backslash followed by a
25628 single character. Octal and hexadecimal escape sequences are not
25629 supported.
25630
25631 Additionally, @code{printf} supports conversion specifications for DFP
25632 (@dfn{Decimal Floating Point}) types using the following length modifiers
25633 together with a floating point specifier.
25634 letters:
25635
25636 @itemize @bullet
25637 @item
25638 @samp{H} for printing @code{Decimal32} types.
25639
25640 @item
25641 @samp{D} for printing @code{Decimal64} types.
25642
25643 @item
25644 @samp{DD} for printing @code{Decimal128} types.
25645 @end itemize
25646
25647 If the underlying @code{C} implementation used to build @value{GDBN} has
25648 support for the three length modifiers for DFP types, other modifiers
25649 such as width and precision will also be available for @value{GDBN} to use.
25650
25651 In case there is no such @code{C} support, no additional modifiers will be
25652 available and the value will be printed in the standard way.
25653
25654 Here's an example of printing DFP types using the above conversion letters:
25655 @smallexample
25656 printf "D32: %Hf - D64: %Df - D128: %DDf\n",1.2345df,1.2E10dd,1.2E1dl
25657 @end smallexample
25658
25659 @anchor{eval}
25660 @kindex eval
25661 @item eval @var{template}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
25662 Convert the values of one or more @var{expressions} under the control of
25663 the string @var{template} to a command line, and call it.
25664
25665 @end table
25666
25667 @node Auto-loading sequences
25668 @subsection Controlling auto-loading native @value{GDBN} scripts
25669 @cindex native script auto-loading
25670
25671 When a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
25672 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library),
25673 @value{GDBN} will look for the command file @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}.
25674 @xref{Auto-loading extensions}.
25675
25676 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
25677 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
25678
25679 @table @code
25680 @anchor{set auto-load gdb-scripts}
25681 @kindex set auto-load gdb-scripts
25682 @item set auto-load gdb-scripts [on|off]
25683 Enable or disable the auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts.
25684
25685 @anchor{show auto-load gdb-scripts}
25686 @kindex show auto-load gdb-scripts
25687 @item show auto-load gdb-scripts
25688 Show whether auto-loading of canned sequences of commands scripts is enabled or
25689 disabled.
25690
25691 @anchor{info auto-load gdb-scripts}
25692 @kindex info auto-load gdb-scripts
25693 @cindex print list of auto-loaded canned sequences of commands scripts
25694 @item info auto-load gdb-scripts [@var{regexp}]
25695 Print the list of all canned sequences of commands scripts that @value{GDBN}
25696 auto-loaded.
25697 @end table
25698
25699 If @var{regexp} is supplied only canned sequences of commands scripts with
25700 matching names are printed.
25701
25702 @c Python docs live in a separate file.
25703 @include python.texi
25704
25705 @c Guile docs live in a separate file.
25706 @include guile.texi
25707
25708 @node Auto-loading extensions
25709 @section Auto-loading extensions
25710 @cindex auto-loading extensions
25711
25712 @value{GDBN} provides two mechanisms for automatically loading extensions
25713 when a new object file is read (for example, due to the @code{file}
25714 command, or because the inferior has loaded a shared library):
25715 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} and the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}
25716 section of modern file formats like ELF.
25717
25718 @menu
25719 * objfile-gdb.ext file: objfile-gdbdotext file. The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
25720 * .debug_gdb_scripts section: dotdebug_gdb_scripts section. The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
25721 * Which flavor to choose?::
25722 @end menu
25723
25724 The auto-loading feature is useful for supplying application-specific
25725 debugging commands and features.
25726
25727 Auto-loading can be enabled or disabled,
25728 and the list of auto-loaded scripts can be printed.
25729 See the @samp{auto-loading} section of each extension language
25730 for more information.
25731 For @value{GDBN} command files see @ref{Auto-loading sequences}.
25732 For Python files see @ref{Python Auto-loading}.
25733
25734 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
25735 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
25736
25737 @node objfile-gdbdotext file
25738 @subsection The @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} file
25739 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
25740 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
25741 @cindex @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
25742
25743 When a new object file is read, @value{GDBN} looks for a file named
25744 @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.@var{ext}} (we call it @var{script-name} below),
25745 where @var{objfile} is the object file's name and
25746 where @var{ext} is the file extension for the extension language:
25747
25748 @table @code
25749 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.gdb}
25750 GDB's own command language
25751 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.py}
25752 Python
25753 @item @file{@var{objfile}-gdb.scm}
25754 Guile
25755 @end table
25756
25757 @var{script-name} is formed by ensuring that the file name of @var{objfile}
25758 is absolute, following all symlinks, and resolving @code{.} and @code{..}
25759 components, and appending the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} suffix.
25760 If this file exists and is readable, @value{GDBN} will evaluate it as a
25761 script in the specified extension language.
25762
25763 If this file does not exist, then @value{GDBN} will look for
25764 @var{script-name} file in all of the directories as specified below.
25765
25766 Note that loading of these files requires an accordingly configured
25767 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
25768
25769 For object files using @file{.exe} suffix @value{GDBN} tries to load first the
25770 scripts normally according to its @file{.exe} filename. But if no scripts are
25771 found @value{GDBN} also tries script filenames matching the object file without
25772 its @file{.exe} suffix. This @file{.exe} stripping is case insensitive and it
25773 is attempted on any platform. This makes the script filenames compatible
25774 between Unix and MS-Windows hosts.
25775
25776 @table @code
25777 @anchor{set auto-load scripts-directory}
25778 @kindex set auto-load scripts-directory
25779 @item set auto-load scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@r{]}
25780 Control @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location. Multiple directory entries
25781 may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use
25782 (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS).
25783
25784 Each entry here needs to be covered also by the security setting
25785 @code{set auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{set auto-load safe-path}).
25786
25787 @anchor{with-auto-load-dir}
25788 This variable defaults to @file{$debugdir:$datadir/auto-load}. The default
25789 @code{set auto-load safe-path} value can be also overriden by @value{GDBN}
25790 configuration option @option{--with-auto-load-dir}.
25791
25792 Any reference to @file{$debugdir} will get replaced by
25793 @var{debug-file-directory} value (@pxref{Separate Debug Files}) and any
25794 reference to @file{$datadir} will get replaced by @var{data-directory} which is
25795 determined at @value{GDBN} startup (@pxref{Data Files}). @file{$debugdir} and
25796 @file{$datadir} must be placed as a directory component --- either alone or
25797 delimited by @file{/} or @file{\} directory separators, depending on the host
25798 platform.
25799
25800 The list of directories uses path separator (@samp{:} on GNU and Unix
25801 systems, @samp{;} on MS-Windows and MS-DOS) to separate directories, similarly
25802 to the @env{PATH} environment variable.
25803
25804 @anchor{show auto-load scripts-directory}
25805 @kindex show auto-load scripts-directory
25806 @item show auto-load scripts-directory
25807 Show @value{GDBN} auto-loaded scripts location.
25808
25809 @anchor{add-auto-load-scripts-directory}
25810 @kindex add-auto-load-scripts-directory
25811 @item add-auto-load-scripts-directory @r{[}@var{directories}@dots{}@r{]}
25812 Add an entry (or list of entries) to the list of auto-loaded scripts locations.
25813 Multiple entries may be delimited by the host platform path separator in use.
25814 @end table
25815
25816 @value{GDBN} does not track which files it has already auto-loaded this way.
25817 @value{GDBN} will load the associated script every time the corresponding
25818 @var{objfile} is opened.
25819 So your @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} file should be careful to avoid errors if it
25820 is evaluated more than once.
25821
25822 @node dotdebug_gdb_scripts section
25823 @subsection The @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
25824 @cindex @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section
25825
25826 For systems using file formats like ELF and COFF,
25827 when @value{GDBN} loads a new object file
25828 it will look for a special section named @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
25829 If this section exists, its contents is a list of null-terminated entries
25830 specifying scripts to load. Each entry begins with a non-null prefix byte that
25831 specifies the kind of entry, typically the extension language and whether the
25832 script is in a file or inlined in @code{.debug_gdb_scripts}.
25833
25834 The following entries are supported:
25835
25836 @table @code
25837 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_FILE = 1
25838 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_FILE = 3
25839 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT = 4
25840 @item SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_SCHEME_TEXT = 6
25841 @end table
25842
25843 @subsubsection Script File Entries
25844
25845 If the entry specifies a file, @value{GDBN} will look for the file first
25846 in the current directory and then along the source search path
25847 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories}),
25848 except that @file{$cdir} is not searched, since the compilation
25849 directory is not relevant to scripts.
25850
25851 File entries can be placed in section @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} with,
25852 for example, this GCC macro for Python scripts.
25853
25854 @example
25855 /* Note: The "MS" section flags are to remove duplicates. */
25856 #define DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT(script_name) \
25857 asm("\
25858 .pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n\
25859 .byte 1 /* Python */\n\
25860 .asciz \"" script_name "\"\n\
25861 .popsection \n\
25862 ");
25863 @end example
25864
25865 @noindent
25866 For Guile scripts, replace @code{.byte 1} with @code{.byte 3}.
25867 Then one can reference the macro in a header or source file like this:
25868
25869 @example
25870 DEFINE_GDB_PY_SCRIPT ("my-app-scripts.py")
25871 @end example
25872
25873 The script name may include directories if desired.
25874
25875 Note that loading of this script file also requires accordingly configured
25876 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
25877
25878 If the macro invocation is put in a header, any application or library
25879 using this header will get a reference to the specified script,
25880 and with the use of @code{"MS"} attributes on the section, the linker
25881 will remove duplicates.
25882
25883 @subsubsection Script Text Entries
25884
25885 Script text entries allow to put the executable script in the entry
25886 itself instead of loading it from a file.
25887 The first line of the entry, everything after the prefix byte and up to
25888 the first newline (@code{0xa}) character, is the script name, and must not
25889 contain any kind of space character, e.g., spaces or tabs.
25890 The rest of the entry, up to the trailing null byte, is the script to
25891 execute in the specified language. The name needs to be unique among
25892 all script names, as @value{GDBN} executes each script only once based
25893 on its name.
25894
25895 Here is an example from file @file{py-section-script.c} in the @value{GDBN}
25896 testsuite.
25897
25898 @example
25899 #include "symcat.h"
25900 #include "gdb/section-scripts.h"
25901 asm(
25902 ".pushsection \".debug_gdb_scripts\", \"MS\",@@progbits,1\n"
25903 ".byte " XSTRING (SECTION_SCRIPT_ID_PYTHON_TEXT) "\n"
25904 ".ascii \"gdb.inlined-script\\n\"\n"
25905 ".ascii \"class test_cmd (gdb.Command):\\n\"\n"
25906 ".ascii \" def __init__ (self):\\n\"\n"
25907 ".ascii \" super (test_cmd, self).__init__ ("
25908 "\\\"test-cmd\\\", gdb.COMMAND_OBSCURE)\\n\"\n"
25909 ".ascii \" def invoke (self, arg, from_tty):\\n\"\n"
25910 ".ascii \" print (\\\"test-cmd output, arg = %s\\\" % arg)\\n\"\n"
25911 ".ascii \"test_cmd ()\\n\"\n"
25912 ".byte 0\n"
25913 ".popsection\n"
25914 );
25915 @end example
25916
25917 Loading of inlined scripts requires a properly configured
25918 @code{auto-load safe-path} (@pxref{Auto-loading safe path}).
25919 The path to specify in @code{auto-load safe-path} is the path of the file
25920 containing the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section.
25921
25922 @node Which flavor to choose?
25923 @subsection Which flavor to choose?
25924
25925 Given the multiple ways of auto-loading extensions, it might not always
25926 be clear which one to choose. This section provides some guidance.
25927
25928 @noindent
25929 Benefits of the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way:
25930
25931 @itemize @bullet
25932 @item
25933 Can be used with file formats that don't support multiple sections.
25934
25935 @item
25936 Ease of finding scripts for public libraries.
25937
25938 Scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section are searched for
25939 in the source search path.
25940 For publicly installed libraries, e.g., @file{libstdc++}, there typically
25941 isn't a source directory in which to find the script.
25942
25943 @item
25944 Doesn't require source code additions.
25945 @end itemize
25946
25947 @noindent
25948 Benefits of the @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} way:
25949
25950 @itemize @bullet
25951 @item
25952 Works with static linking.
25953
25954 Scripts for libraries done the @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} way require an objfile to
25955 trigger their loading. When an application is statically linked the only
25956 objfile available is the executable, and it is cumbersome to attach all the
25957 scripts from all the input libraries to the executable's
25958 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script.
25959
25960 @item
25961 Works with classes that are entirely inlined.
25962
25963 Some classes can be entirely inlined, and thus there may not be an associated
25964 shared library to attach a @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} script to.
25965
25966 @item
25967 Scripts needn't be copied out of the source tree.
25968
25969 In some circumstances, apps can be built out of large collections of internal
25970 libraries, and the build infrastructure necessary to install the
25971 @file{-gdb.@var{ext}} scripts in a place where @value{GDBN} can find them is
25972 cumbersome. It may be easier to specify the scripts in the
25973 @code{.debug_gdb_scripts} section as relative paths, and add a path to the
25974 top of the source tree to the source search path.
25975 @end itemize
25976
25977 @node Multiple Extension Languages
25978 @section Multiple Extension Languages
25979
25980 The Guile and Python extension languages do not share any state,
25981 and generally do not interfere with each other.
25982 There are some things to be aware of, however.
25983
25984 @subsection Python comes first
25985
25986 Python was @value{GDBN}'s first extension language, and to avoid breaking
25987 existing behaviour Python comes first. This is generally solved by the
25988 ``first one wins'' principle. @value{GDBN} maintains a list of enabled
25989 extension languages, and when it makes a call to an extension language,
25990 (say to pretty-print a value), it tries each in turn until an extension
25991 language indicates it has performed the request (e.g., has returned the
25992 pretty-printed form of a value).
25993 This extends to errors while performing such requests: If an error happens
25994 while, for example, trying to pretty-print an object then the error is
25995 reported and any following extension languages are not tried.
25996
25997 @node Aliases
25998 @section Creating new spellings of existing commands
25999 @cindex aliases for commands
26000
26001 It is often useful to define alternate spellings of existing commands.
26002 For example, if a new @value{GDBN} command defined in Python has
26003 a long name to type, it is handy to have an abbreviated version of it
26004 that involves less typing.
26005
26006 @value{GDBN} itself uses aliases. For example @samp{s} is an alias
26007 of the @samp{step} command even though it is otherwise an ambiguous
26008 abbreviation of other commands like @samp{set} and @samp{show}.
26009
26010 Aliases are also used to provide shortened or more common versions
26011 of multi-word commands. For example, @value{GDBN} provides the
26012 @samp{tty} alias of the @samp{set inferior-tty} command.
26013
26014 You can define a new alias with the @samp{alias} command.
26015
26016 @table @code
26017
26018 @kindex alias
26019 @item alias [-a] [--] @var{ALIAS} = @var{COMMAND}
26020
26021 @end table
26022
26023 @var{ALIAS} specifies the name of the new alias.
26024 Each word of @var{ALIAS} must consist of letters, numbers, dashes and
26025 underscores.
26026
26027 @var{COMMAND} specifies the name of an existing command
26028 that is being aliased.
26029
26030 The @samp{-a} option specifies that the new alias is an abbreviation
26031 of the command. Abbreviations are not shown in command
26032 lists displayed by the @samp{help} command.
26033
26034 The @samp{--} option specifies the end of options,
26035 and is useful when @var{ALIAS} begins with a dash.
26036
26037 Here is a simple example showing how to make an abbreviation
26038 of a command so that there is less to type.
26039 Suppose you were tired of typing @samp{disas}, the current
26040 shortest unambiguous abbreviation of the @samp{disassemble} command
26041 and you wanted an even shorter version named @samp{di}.
26042 The following will accomplish this.
26043
26044 @smallexample
26045 (gdb) alias -a di = disas
26046 @end smallexample
26047
26048 Note that aliases are different from user-defined commands.
26049 With a user-defined command, you also need to write documentation
26050 for it with the @samp{document} command.
26051 An alias automatically picks up the documentation of the existing command.
26052
26053 Here is an example where we make @samp{elms} an abbreviation of
26054 @samp{elements} in the @samp{set print elements} command.
26055 This is to show that you can make an abbreviation of any part
26056 of a command.
26057
26058 @smallexample
26059 (gdb) alias -a set print elms = set print elements
26060 (gdb) alias -a show print elms = show print elements
26061 (gdb) set p elms 20
26062 (gdb) show p elms
26063 Limit on string chars or array elements to print is 200.
26064 @end smallexample
26065
26066 Note that if you are defining an alias of a @samp{set} command,
26067 and you want to have an alias for the corresponding @samp{show}
26068 command, then you need to define the latter separately.
26069
26070 Unambiguously abbreviated commands are allowed in @var{COMMAND} and
26071 @var{ALIAS}, just as they are normally.
26072
26073 @smallexample
26074 (gdb) alias -a set pr elms = set p ele
26075 @end smallexample
26076
26077 Finally, here is an example showing the creation of a one word
26078 alias for a more complex command.
26079 This creates alias @samp{spe} of the command @samp{set print elements}.
26080
26081 @smallexample
26082 (gdb) alias spe = set print elements
26083 (gdb) spe 20
26084 @end smallexample
26085
26086 @node Interpreters
26087 @chapter Command Interpreters
26088 @cindex command interpreters
26089
26090 @value{GDBN} supports multiple command interpreters, and some command
26091 infrastructure to allow users or user interface writers to switch
26092 between interpreters or run commands in other interpreters.
26093
26094 @value{GDBN} currently supports two command interpreters, the console
26095 interpreter (sometimes called the command-line interpreter or @sc{cli})
26096 and the machine interface interpreter (or @sc{gdb/mi}). This manual
26097 describes both of these interfaces in great detail.
26098
26099 By default, @value{GDBN} will start with the console interpreter.
26100 However, the user may choose to start @value{GDBN} with another
26101 interpreter by specifying the @option{-i} or @option{--interpreter}
26102 startup options. Defined interpreters include:
26103
26104 @table @code
26105 @item console
26106 @cindex console interpreter
26107 The traditional console or command-line interpreter. This is the most often
26108 used interpreter with @value{GDBN}. With no interpreter specified at runtime,
26109 @value{GDBN} will use this interpreter.
26110
26111 @item mi
26112 @cindex mi interpreter
26113 The newest @sc{gdb/mi} interface (currently @code{mi2}). Used primarily
26114 by programs wishing to use @value{GDBN} as a backend for a debugger GUI
26115 or an IDE. For more information, see @ref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi}
26116 Interface}.
26117
26118 @item mi2
26119 @cindex mi2 interpreter
26120 The current @sc{gdb/mi} interface.
26121
26122 @item mi1
26123 @cindex mi1 interpreter
26124 The @sc{gdb/mi} interface included in @value{GDBN} 5.1, 5.2, and 5.3.
26125
26126 @end table
26127
26128 @cindex invoke another interpreter
26129
26130 @kindex interpreter-exec
26131 You may execute commands in any interpreter from the current
26132 interpreter using the appropriate command. If you are running the
26133 console interpreter, simply use the @code{interpreter-exec} command:
26134
26135 @smallexample
26136 interpreter-exec mi "-data-list-register-names"
26137 @end smallexample
26138
26139 @sc{gdb/mi} has a similar command, although it is only available in versions of
26140 @value{GDBN} which support @sc{gdb/mi} version 2 (or greater).
26141
26142 Note that @code{interpreter-exec} only changes the interpreter for the
26143 duration of the specified command. It does not change the interpreter
26144 permanently.
26145
26146 @cindex start a new independent interpreter
26147
26148 Although you may only choose a single interpreter at startup, it is
26149 possible to run an independent interpreter on a specified input/output
26150 device (usually a tty).
26151
26152 For example, consider a debugger GUI or IDE that wants to provide a
26153 @value{GDBN} console view. It may do so by embedding a terminal
26154 emulator widget in its GUI, starting @value{GDBN} in the traditional
26155 command-line mode with stdin/stdout/stderr redirected to that
26156 terminal, and then creating an MI interpreter running on a specified
26157 input/output device. The console interpreter created by @value{GDBN}
26158 at startup handles commands the user types in the terminal widget,
26159 while the GUI controls and synchronizes state with @value{GDBN} using
26160 the separate MI interpreter.
26161
26162 To start a new secondary @dfn{user interface} running MI, use the
26163 @code{new-ui} command:
26164
26165 @kindex new-ui
26166 @cindex new user interface
26167 @smallexample
26168 new-ui @var{interpreter} @var{tty}
26169 @end smallexample
26170
26171 The @var{interpreter} parameter specifies the interpreter to run.
26172 This accepts the same values as the @code{interpreter-exec} command.
26173 For example, @samp{console}, @samp{mi}, @samp{mi2}, etc. The
26174 @var{tty} parameter specifies the name of the bidirectional file the
26175 interpreter uses for input/output, usually the name of a
26176 pseudoterminal slave on Unix systems. For example:
26177
26178 @smallexample
26179 (@value{GDBP}) new-ui mi /dev/pts/9
26180 @end smallexample
26181
26182 @noindent
26183 runs an MI interpreter on @file{/dev/pts/9}.
26184
26185 @node TUI
26186 @chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
26187 @cindex TUI
26188 @cindex Text User Interface
26189
26190 @menu
26191 * TUI Overview:: TUI overview
26192 * TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
26193 * TUI Single Key Mode:: TUI single key mode
26194 * TUI Commands:: TUI-specific commands
26195 * TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
26196 @end menu
26197
26198 The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface (TUI) is a terminal
26199 interface which uses the @code{curses} library to show the source
26200 file, the assembly output, the program registers and @value{GDBN}
26201 commands in separate text windows. The TUI mode is supported only
26202 on platforms where a suitable version of the @code{curses} library
26203 is available.
26204
26205 The TUI mode is enabled by default when you invoke @value{GDBN} as
26206 @samp{@value{GDBP} -tui}.
26207 You can also switch in and out of TUI mode while @value{GDBN} runs by
26208 using various TUI commands and key bindings, such as @command{tui
26209 enable} or @kbd{C-x C-a}. @xref{TUI Commands, ,TUI Commands}, and
26210 @ref{TUI Keys, ,TUI Key Bindings}.
26211
26212 @node TUI Overview
26213 @section TUI Overview
26214
26215 In TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text windows:
26216
26217 @table @emph
26218 @item command
26219 This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
26220 prompt and the @value{GDBN} output. The @value{GDBN} input is still
26221 managed using readline.
26222
26223 @item source
26224 The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
26225 line and active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
26226
26227 @item assembly
26228 The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
26229
26230 @item register
26231 This window shows the processor registers. Registers are highlighted
26232 when their values change.
26233 @end table
26234
26235 The source and assembly windows show the current program position
26236 by highlighting the current line and marking it with a @samp{>} marker.
26237 Breakpoints are indicated with two markers. The first marker
26238 indicates the breakpoint type:
26239
26240 @table @code
26241 @item B
26242 Breakpoint which was hit at least once.
26243
26244 @item b
26245 Breakpoint which was never hit.
26246
26247 @item H
26248 Hardware breakpoint which was hit at least once.
26249
26250 @item h
26251 Hardware breakpoint which was never hit.
26252 @end table
26253
26254 The second marker indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled or not:
26255
26256 @table @code
26257 @item +
26258 Breakpoint is enabled.
26259
26260 @item -
26261 Breakpoint is disabled.
26262 @end table
26263
26264 The source, assembly and register windows are updated when the current
26265 thread changes, when the frame changes, or when the program counter
26266 changes.
26267
26268 These windows are not all visible at the same time. The command
26269 window is always visible. The others can be arranged in several
26270 layouts:
26271
26272 @itemize @bullet
26273 @item
26274 source only,
26275
26276 @item
26277 assembly only,
26278
26279 @item
26280 source and assembly,
26281
26282 @item
26283 source and registers, or
26284
26285 @item
26286 assembly and registers.
26287 @end itemize
26288
26289 A status line above the command window shows the following information:
26290
26291 @table @emph
26292 @item target
26293 Indicates the current @value{GDBN} target.
26294 (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
26295
26296 @item process
26297 Gives the current process or thread number.
26298 When no process is being debugged, this field is set to @code{No process}.
26299
26300 @item function
26301 Gives the current function name for the selected frame.
26302 The name is demangled if demangling is turned on (@pxref{Print Settings}).
26303 When there is no symbol corresponding to the current program counter,
26304 the string @code{??} is displayed.
26305
26306 @item line
26307 Indicates the current line number for the selected frame.
26308 When the current line number is not known, the string @code{??} is displayed.
26309
26310 @item pc
26311 Indicates the current program counter address.
26312 @end table
26313
26314 @node TUI Keys
26315 @section TUI Key Bindings
26316 @cindex TUI key bindings
26317
26318 The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
26319 @ifset SYSTEM_READLINE
26320 (@pxref{Command Line Editing, , , rluserman, GNU Readline Library}).
26321 @end ifset
26322 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
26323 (@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
26324 @end ifclear
26325 The following key bindings are installed for both TUI mode and the
26326 @value{GDBN} standard mode.
26327
26328 @table @kbd
26329 @kindex C-x C-a
26330 @item C-x C-a
26331 @kindex C-x a
26332 @itemx C-x a
26333 @kindex C-x A
26334 @itemx C-x A
26335 Enter or leave the TUI mode. When leaving the TUI mode,
26336 the curses window management stops and @value{GDBN} operates using
26337 its standard mode, writing on the terminal directly. When reentering
26338 the TUI mode, control is given back to the curses windows.
26339 The screen is then refreshed.
26340
26341 @kindex C-x 1
26342 @item C-x 1
26343 Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
26344 either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
26345 is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
26346
26347 Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
26348
26349 @kindex C-x 2
26350 @item C-x 2
26351 Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
26352 layout already has two windows, the next layout with two windows is used.
26353 When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
26354 previous layout and the new one.
26355
26356 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
26357
26358 @kindex C-x o
26359 @item C-x o
26360 Change the active window. The TUI associates several key bindings
26361 (like scrolling and arrow keys) with the active window. This command
26362 gives the focus to the next TUI window.
26363
26364 Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x o} binding.
26365
26366 @kindex C-x s
26367 @item C-x s
26368 Switch in and out of the TUI SingleKey mode that binds single
26369 keys to @value{GDBN} commands (@pxref{TUI Single Key Mode}).
26370 @end table
26371
26372 The following key bindings only work in the TUI mode:
26373
26374 @table @asis
26375 @kindex PgUp
26376 @item @key{PgUp}
26377 Scroll the active window one page up.
26378
26379 @kindex PgDn
26380 @item @key{PgDn}
26381 Scroll the active window one page down.
26382
26383 @kindex Up
26384 @item @key{Up}
26385 Scroll the active window one line up.
26386
26387 @kindex Down
26388 @item @key{Down}
26389 Scroll the active window one line down.
26390
26391 @kindex Left
26392 @item @key{Left}
26393 Scroll the active window one column left.
26394
26395 @kindex Right
26396 @item @key{Right}
26397 Scroll the active window one column right.
26398
26399 @kindex C-L
26400 @item @kbd{C-L}
26401 Refresh the screen.
26402 @end table
26403
26404 Because the arrow keys scroll the active window in the TUI mode, they
26405 are not available for their normal use by readline unless the command
26406 window has the focus. When another window is active, you must use
26407 other readline key bindings such as @kbd{C-p}, @kbd{C-n}, @kbd{C-b}
26408 and @kbd{C-f} to control the command window.
26409
26410 @node TUI Single Key Mode
26411 @section TUI Single Key Mode
26412 @cindex TUI single key mode
26413
26414 The TUI also provides a @dfn{SingleKey} mode, which binds several
26415 frequently used @value{GDBN} commands to single keys. Type @kbd{C-x s} to
26416 switch into this mode, where the following key bindings are used:
26417
26418 @table @kbd
26419 @kindex c @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26420 @item c
26421 continue
26422
26423 @kindex d @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26424 @item d
26425 down
26426
26427 @kindex f @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26428 @item f
26429 finish
26430
26431 @kindex n @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26432 @item n
26433 next
26434
26435 @kindex o @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26436 @item o
26437 nexti. The shortcut letter @samp{o} stands for ``step Over''.
26438
26439 @kindex q @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26440 @item q
26441 exit the SingleKey mode.
26442
26443 @kindex r @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26444 @item r
26445 run
26446
26447 @kindex s @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26448 @item s
26449 step
26450
26451 @kindex i @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26452 @item i
26453 stepi. The shortcut letter @samp{i} stands for ``step Into''.
26454
26455 @kindex u @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26456 @item u
26457 up
26458
26459 @kindex v @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26460 @item v
26461 info locals
26462
26463 @kindex w @r{(SingleKey TUI key)}
26464 @item w
26465 where
26466 @end table
26467
26468 Other keys temporarily switch to the @value{GDBN} command prompt.
26469 The key that was pressed is inserted in the editing buffer so that
26470 it is possible to type most @value{GDBN} commands without interaction
26471 with the TUI SingleKey mode. Once the command is entered the TUI
26472 SingleKey mode is restored. The only way to permanently leave
26473 this mode is by typing @kbd{q} or @kbd{C-x s}.
26474
26475
26476 @node TUI Commands
26477 @section TUI-specific Commands
26478 @cindex TUI commands
26479
26480 The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
26481 These commands are always available, even when @value{GDBN} is not in
26482 the TUI mode. When @value{GDBN} is in the standard mode, most
26483 of these commands will automatically switch to the TUI mode.
26484
26485 Note that if @value{GDBN}'s @code{stdout} is not connected to a
26486 terminal, or @value{GDBN} has been started with the machine interface
26487 interpreter (@pxref{GDB/MI, ,The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}), most of
26488 these commands will fail with an error, because it would not be
26489 possible or desirable to enable curses window management.
26490
26491 @table @code
26492 @item tui enable
26493 @kindex tui enable
26494 Activate TUI mode. The last active TUI window layout will be used if
26495 TUI mode has prevsiouly been used in the current debugging session,
26496 otherwise a default layout is used.
26497
26498 @item tui disable
26499 @kindex tui disable
26500 Disable TUI mode, returning to the console interpreter.
26501
26502 @item info win
26503 @kindex info win
26504 List and give the size of all displayed windows.
26505
26506 @item layout @var{name}
26507 @kindex layout
26508 Changes which TUI windows are displayed. In each layout the command
26509 window is always displayed, the @var{name} parameter controls which
26510 additional windows are displayed, and can be any of the following:
26511
26512 @table @code
26513 @item next
26514 Display the next layout.
26515
26516 @item prev
26517 Display the previous layout.
26518
26519 @item src
26520 Display the source and command windows.
26521
26522 @item asm
26523 Display the assembly and command windows.
26524
26525 @item split
26526 Display the source, assembly, and command windows.
26527
26528 @item regs
26529 When in @code{src} layout display the register, source, and command
26530 windows. When in @code{asm} or @code{split} layout display the
26531 register, assembler, and command windows.
26532 @end table
26533
26534 @item focus @var{name}
26535 @kindex focus
26536 Changes which TUI window is currently active for scrolling. The
26537 @var{name} parameter can be any of the following:
26538
26539 @table @code
26540 @item next
26541 Make the next window active for scrolling.
26542
26543 @item prev
26544 Make the previous window active for scrolling.
26545
26546 @item src
26547 Make the source window active for scrolling.
26548
26549 @item asm
26550 Make the assembly window active for scrolling.
26551
26552 @item regs
26553 Make the register window active for scrolling.
26554
26555 @item cmd
26556 Make the command window active for scrolling.
26557 @end table
26558
26559 @item refresh
26560 @kindex refresh
26561 Refresh the screen. This is similar to typing @kbd{C-L}.
26562
26563 @item tui reg @var{group}
26564 @kindex tui reg
26565 Changes the register group displayed in the tui register window to
26566 @var{group}. If the register window is not currently displayed this
26567 command will cause the register window to be displayed. The list of
26568 register groups, as well as their order is target specific. The
26569 following groups are available on most targets:
26570 @table @code
26571 @item next
26572 Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
26573 through all of the available register groups.
26574
26575 @item prev
26576 Repeatedly selecting this group will cause the display to cycle
26577 through all of the available register groups in the reverse order to
26578 @var{next}.
26579
26580 @item general
26581 Display the general registers.
26582 @item float
26583 Display the floating point registers.
26584 @item system
26585 Display the system registers.
26586 @item vector
26587 Display the vector registers.
26588 @item all
26589 Display all registers.
26590 @end table
26591
26592 @item update
26593 @kindex update
26594 Update the source window and the current execution point.
26595
26596 @item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
26597 @itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
26598 @kindex winheight
26599 Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
26600 lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
26601 decrease it. The @var{name} parameter can be one of @code{src} (the
26602 source window), @code{cmd} (the command window), @code{asm} (the
26603 disassembly window), or @code{regs} (the register display window).
26604
26605 @item tabset @var{nchars}
26606 @kindex tabset
26607 Set the width of tab stops to be @var{nchars} characters. This
26608 setting affects the display of TAB characters in the source and
26609 assembly windows.
26610 @end table
26611
26612 @node TUI Configuration
26613 @section TUI Configuration Variables
26614 @cindex TUI configuration variables
26615
26616 Several configuration variables control the appearance of TUI windows.
26617
26618 @table @code
26619 @item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
26620 @kindex set tui border-kind
26621 Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
26622 The possible values are the following:
26623 @table @code
26624 @item space
26625 Use a space character to draw the border.
26626
26627 @item ascii
26628 Use @sc{ascii} characters @samp{+}, @samp{-} and @samp{|} to draw the border.
26629
26630 @item acs
26631 Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
26632 drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
26633 @end table
26634
26635 @item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
26636 @kindex set tui border-mode
26637 @itemx set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
26638 @kindex set tui active-border-mode
26639 Select the display attributes for the borders of the inactive windows
26640 or the active window. The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
26641 @table @code
26642 @item normal
26643 Use normal attributes to display the border.
26644
26645 @item standout
26646 Use standout mode.
26647
26648 @item reverse
26649 Use reverse video mode.
26650
26651 @item half
26652 Use half bright mode.
26653
26654 @item half-standout
26655 Use half bright and standout mode.
26656
26657 @item bold
26658 Use extra bright or bold mode.
26659
26660 @item bold-standout
26661 Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
26662 @end table
26663 @end table
26664
26665 @node Emacs
26666 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
26667
26668 @cindex Emacs
26669 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
26670 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
26671 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
26672 @value{GDBN}.
26673
26674 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
26675 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
26676 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
26677 created Emacs buffer.
26678 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
26679
26680 Running @value{GDBN} under Emacs can be just like running @value{GDBN} normally except for two
26681 things:
26682
26683 @itemize @bullet
26684 @item
26685 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through an Emacs buffer, called
26686 the GUD buffer.
26687
26688 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
26689 and output done by the program you are debugging.
26690
26691 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
26692 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
26693 in this way.
26694
26695 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
26696 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
26697 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
26698 stop.
26699
26700 @item
26701 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
26702
26703 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
26704 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
26705 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
26706 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
26707 and the source.
26708
26709 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
26710 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
26711 @end itemize
26712
26713 We call this @dfn{text command mode}. Emacs 22.1, and later, also uses
26714 a graphical mode, enabled by default, which provides further buffers
26715 that can control the execution and describe the state of your program.
26716 @xref{GDB Graphical Interface,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}.
26717
26718 If you specify an absolute file name when prompted for the @kbd{M-x
26719 gdb} argument, then Emacs sets your current working directory to where
26720 your program resides. If you only specify the file name, then Emacs
26721 sets your current working directory to the directory associated
26722 with the previous buffer. In this case, @value{GDBN} may find your
26723 program by searching your environment's @code{PATH} variable, but on
26724 some operating systems it might not find the source. So, although the
26725 @value{GDBN} input and output session proceeds normally, the auxiliary
26726 buffer does not display the current source and line of execution.
26727
26728 The initial working directory of @value{GDBN} is printed on the top
26729 line of the GUD buffer and this serves as a default for the commands
26730 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files,
26731 ,Commands to Specify Files}.
26732
26733 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If you
26734 need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you
26735 keep several configurations around, with different names) you can
26736 customize the Emacs variable @code{gud-gdb-command-name} to run the
26737 one you want.
26738
26739 In the GUD buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
26740 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
26741
26742 @table @kbd
26743 @item C-h m
26744 Describe the features of Emacs' GUD Mode.
26745
26746 @item C-c C-s
26747 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
26748 update the display window to show the current file and location.
26749
26750 @item C-c C-n
26751 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
26752 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
26753 to show the current file and location.
26754
26755 @item C-c C-i
26756 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
26757 display window accordingly.
26758
26759 @item C-c C-f
26760 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
26761 @code{finish} command.
26762
26763 @item C-c C-r
26764 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
26765 command.
26766
26767 @item C-c <
26768 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
26769 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
26770 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
26771
26772 @item C-c >
26773 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
26774 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
26775 @end table
26776
26777 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x @key{SPC}} (@code{gud-break})
26778 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
26779
26780 In text command mode, if you type @kbd{M-x speedbar}, Emacs displays a
26781 separate frame which shows a backtrace when the GUD buffer is current.
26782 Move point to any frame in the stack and type @key{RET} to make it
26783 become the current frame and display the associated source in the
26784 source buffer. Alternatively, click @kbd{Mouse-2} to make the
26785 selected frame become the current one. In graphical mode, the
26786 speedbar displays watch expressions.
26787
26788 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
26789 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
26790 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
26791 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
26792 frame.
26793
26794 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
26795 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
26796 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
26797 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
26798 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
26799 to correspond properly with the code.
26800
26801 A more detailed description of Emacs' interaction with @value{GDBN} is
26802 given in the Emacs manual (@pxref{Debuggers,,, Emacs, The @sc{gnu}
26803 Emacs Manual}).
26804
26805 @node GDB/MI
26806 @chapter The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface
26807
26808 @unnumberedsec Function and Purpose
26809
26810 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, its purpose
26811 @sc{gdb/mi} is a line based machine oriented text interface to
26812 @value{GDBN} and is activated by specifying using the
26813 @option{--interpreter} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}). It
26814 is specifically intended to support the development of systems which
26815 use the debugger as just one small component of a larger system.
26816
26817 This chapter is a specification of the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. It is written
26818 in the form of a reference manual.
26819
26820 Note that @sc{gdb/mi} is still under construction, so some of the
26821 features described below are incomplete and subject to change
26822 (@pxref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, , @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends}).
26823
26824 @unnumberedsec Notation and Terminology
26825
26826 @cindex notational conventions, for @sc{gdb/mi}
26827 This chapter uses the following notation:
26828
26829 @itemize @bullet
26830 @item
26831 @code{|} separates two alternatives.
26832
26833 @item
26834 @code{[ @var{something} ]} indicates that @var{something} is optional:
26835 it may or may not be given.
26836
26837 @item
26838 @code{( @var{group} )*} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
26839 may repeat zero or more times.
26840
26841 @item
26842 @code{( @var{group} )+} means that @var{group} inside the parentheses
26843 may repeat one or more times.
26844
26845 @item
26846 @code{"@var{string}"} means a literal @var{string}.
26847 @end itemize
26848
26849 @ignore
26850 @heading Dependencies
26851 @end ignore
26852
26853 @menu
26854 * GDB/MI General Design::
26855 * GDB/MI Command Syntax::
26856 * GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI::
26857 * GDB/MI Development and Front Ends::
26858 * GDB/MI Output Records::
26859 * GDB/MI Simple Examples::
26860 * GDB/MI Command Description Format::
26861 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands::
26862 * GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
26863 * GDB/MI Program Context::
26864 * GDB/MI Thread Commands::
26865 * GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands::
26866 * GDB/MI Program Execution::
26867 * GDB/MI Stack Manipulation::
26868 * GDB/MI Variable Objects::
26869 * GDB/MI Data Manipulation::
26870 * GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands::
26871 * GDB/MI Symbol Query::
26872 * GDB/MI File Commands::
26873 @ignore
26874 * GDB/MI Kod Commands::
26875 * GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands::
26876 * GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands::
26877 @end ignore
26878 * GDB/MI Target Manipulation::
26879 * GDB/MI File Transfer Commands::
26880 * GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands::
26881 * GDB/MI Support Commands::
26882 * GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands::
26883 @end menu
26884
26885 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
26886 @node GDB/MI General Design
26887 @section @sc{gdb/mi} General Design
26888 @cindex GDB/MI General Design
26889
26890 Interaction of a @sc{GDB/MI} frontend with @value{GDBN} involves three
26891 parts---commands sent to @value{GDBN}, responses to those commands
26892 and notifications. Each command results in exactly one response,
26893 indicating either successful completion of the command, or an error.
26894 For the commands that do not resume the target, the response contains the
26895 requested information. For the commands that resume the target, the
26896 response only indicates whether the target was successfully resumed.
26897 Notifications is the mechanism for reporting changes in the state of the
26898 target, or in @value{GDBN} state, that cannot conveniently be associated with
26899 a command and reported as part of that command response.
26900
26901 The important examples of notifications are:
26902 @itemize @bullet
26903
26904 @item
26905 Exec notifications. These are used to report changes in
26906 target state---when a target is resumed, or stopped. It would not
26907 be feasible to include this information in response of resuming
26908 commands, because one resume commands can result in multiple events in
26909 different threads. Also, quite some time may pass before any event
26910 happens in the target, while a frontend needs to know whether the resuming
26911 command itself was successfully executed.
26912
26913 @item
26914 Console output, and status notifications. Console output
26915 notifications are used to report output of CLI commands, as well as
26916 diagnostics for other commands. Status notifications are used to
26917 report the progress of a long-running operation. Naturally, including
26918 this information in command response would mean no output is produced
26919 until the command is finished, which is undesirable.
26920
26921 @item
26922 General notifications. Commands may have various side effects on
26923 the @value{GDBN} or target state beyond their official purpose. For example,
26924 a command may change the selected thread. Although such changes can
26925 be included in command response, using notification allows for more
26926 orthogonal frontend design.
26927
26928 @end itemize
26929
26930 There's no guarantee that whenever an MI command reports an error,
26931 @value{GDBN} or the target are in any specific state, and especially,
26932 the state is not reverted to the state before the MI command was
26933 processed. Therefore, whenever an MI command results in an error,
26934 we recommend that the frontend refreshes all the information shown in
26935 the user interface.
26936
26937
26938 @menu
26939 * Context management::
26940 * Asynchronous and non-stop modes::
26941 * Thread groups::
26942 @end menu
26943
26944 @node Context management
26945 @subsection Context management
26946
26947 @subsubsection Threads and Frames
26948
26949 In most cases when @value{GDBN} accesses the target, this access is
26950 done in context of a specific thread and frame (@pxref{Frames}).
26951 Often, even when accessing global data, the target requires that a thread
26952 be specified. The CLI interface maintains the selected thread and frame,
26953 and supplies them to target on each command. This is convenient,
26954 because a command line user would not want to specify that information
26955 explicitly on each command, and because user interacts with
26956 @value{GDBN} via a single terminal, so no confusion is possible as
26957 to what thread and frame are the current ones.
26958
26959 In the case of MI, the concept of selected thread and frame is less
26960 useful. First, a frontend can easily remember this information
26961 itself. Second, a graphical frontend can have more than one window,
26962 each one used for debugging a different thread, and the frontend might
26963 want to access additional threads for internal purposes. This
26964 increases the risk that by relying on implicitly selected thread, the
26965 frontend may be operating on a wrong one. Therefore, each MI command
26966 should explicitly specify which thread and frame to operate on. To
26967 make it possible, each MI command accepts the @samp{--thread} and
26968 @samp{--frame} options, the value to each is @value{GDBN} global
26969 identifier for thread and frame to operate on.
26970
26971 Usually, each top-level window in a frontend allows the user to select
26972 a thread and a frame, and remembers the user selection for further
26973 operations. However, in some cases @value{GDBN} may suggest that the
26974 current thread or frame be changed. For example, when stopping on a
26975 breakpoint it is reasonable to switch to the thread where breakpoint is
26976 hit. For another example, if the user issues the CLI @samp{thread} or
26977 @samp{frame} commands via the frontend, it is desirable to change the
26978 frontend's selection to the one specified by user. @value{GDBN}
26979 communicates the suggestion to change current thread and frame using the
26980 @samp{=thread-selected} notification.
26981
26982 Note that historically, MI shares the selected thread with CLI, so
26983 frontends used the @code{-thread-select} to execute commands in the
26984 right context. However, getting this to work right is cumbersome. The
26985 simplest way is for frontend to emit @code{-thread-select} command
26986 before every command. This doubles the number of commands that need
26987 to be sent. The alternative approach is to suppress @code{-thread-select}
26988 if the selected thread in @value{GDBN} is supposed to be identical to the
26989 thread the frontend wants to operate on. However, getting this
26990 optimization right can be tricky. In particular, if the frontend
26991 sends several commands to @value{GDBN}, and one of the commands changes the
26992 selected thread, then the behaviour of subsequent commands will
26993 change. So, a frontend should either wait for response from such
26994 problematic commands, or explicitly add @code{-thread-select} for
26995 all subsequent commands. No frontend is known to do this exactly
26996 right, so it is suggested to just always pass the @samp{--thread} and
26997 @samp{--frame} options.
26998
26999 @subsubsection Language
27000
27001 The execution of several commands depends on which language is selected.
27002 By default, the current language (@pxref{show language}) is used.
27003 But for commands known to be language-sensitive, it is recommended
27004 to use the @samp{--language} option. This option takes one argument,
27005 which is the name of the language to use while executing the command.
27006 For instance:
27007
27008 @smallexample
27009 -data-evaluate-expression --language c "sizeof (void*)"
27010 ^done,value="4"
27011 (gdb)
27012 @end smallexample
27013
27014 The valid language names are the same names accepted by the
27015 @samp{set language} command (@pxref{Manually}), excluding @samp{auto},
27016 @samp{local} or @samp{unknown}.
27017
27018 @node Asynchronous and non-stop modes
27019 @subsection Asynchronous command execution and non-stop mode
27020
27021 On some targets, @value{GDBN} is capable of processing MI commands
27022 even while the target is running. This is called @dfn{asynchronous
27023 command execution} (@pxref{Background Execution}). The frontend may
27024 specify a preferrence for asynchronous execution using the
27025 @code{-gdb-set mi-async 1} command, which should be emitted before
27026 either running the executable or attaching to the target. After the
27027 frontend has started the executable or attached to the target, it can
27028 find if asynchronous execution is enabled using the
27029 @code{-list-target-features} command.
27030
27031 @table @code
27032 @item -gdb-set mi-async on
27033 @item -gdb-set mi-async off
27034 Set whether MI is in asynchronous mode.
27035
27036 When @code{off}, which is the default, MI execution commands (e.g.,
27037 @code{-exec-continue}) are foreground commands, and @value{GDBN} waits
27038 for the program to stop before processing further commands.
27039
27040 When @code{on}, MI execution commands are background execution
27041 commands (e.g., @code{-exec-continue} becomes the equivalent of the
27042 @code{c&} CLI command), and so @value{GDBN} is capable of processing
27043 MI commands even while the target is running.
27044
27045 @item -gdb-show mi-async
27046 Show whether MI asynchronous mode is enabled.
27047 @end table
27048
27049 Note: In @value{GDBN} version 7.7 and earlier, this option was called
27050 @code{target-async} instead of @code{mi-async}, and it had the effect
27051 of both putting MI in asynchronous mode and making CLI background
27052 commands possible. CLI background commands are now always possible
27053 ``out of the box'' if the target supports them. The old spelling is
27054 kept as a deprecated alias for backwards compatibility.
27055
27056 Even if @value{GDBN} can accept a command while target is running,
27057 many commands that access the target do not work when the target is
27058 running. Therefore, asynchronous command execution is most useful
27059 when combined with non-stop mode (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}). Then,
27060 it is possible to examine the state of one thread, while other threads
27061 are running.
27062
27063 When a given thread is running, MI commands that try to access the
27064 target in the context of that thread may not work, or may work only on
27065 some targets. In particular, commands that try to operate on thread's
27066 stack will not work, on any target. Commands that read memory, or
27067 modify breakpoints, may work or not work, depending on the target. Note
27068 that even commands that operate on global state, such as @code{print},
27069 @code{set}, and breakpoint commands, still access the target in the
27070 context of a specific thread, so frontend should try to find a
27071 stopped thread and perform the operation on that thread (using the
27072 @samp{--thread} option).
27073
27074 Which commands will work in the context of a running thread is
27075 highly target dependent. However, the two commands
27076 @code{-exec-interrupt}, to stop a thread, and @code{-thread-info},
27077 to find the state of a thread, will always work.
27078
27079 @node Thread groups
27080 @subsection Thread groups
27081 @value{GDBN} may be used to debug several processes at the same time.
27082 On some platfroms, @value{GDBN} may support debugging of several
27083 hardware systems, each one having several cores with several different
27084 processes running on each core. This section describes the MI
27085 mechanism to support such debugging scenarios.
27086
27087 The key observation is that regardless of the structure of the
27088 target, MI can have a global list of threads, because most commands that
27089 accept the @samp{--thread} option do not need to know what process that
27090 thread belongs to. Therefore, it is not necessary to introduce
27091 neither additional @samp{--process} option, nor an notion of the
27092 current process in the MI interface. The only strictly new feature
27093 that is required is the ability to find how the threads are grouped
27094 into processes.
27095
27096 To allow the user to discover such grouping, and to support arbitrary
27097 hierarchy of machines/cores/processes, MI introduces the concept of a
27098 @dfn{thread group}. Thread group is a collection of threads and other
27099 thread groups. A thread group always has a string identifier, a type,
27100 and may have additional attributes specific to the type. A new
27101 command, @code{-list-thread-groups}, returns the list of top-level
27102 thread groups, which correspond to processes that @value{GDBN} is
27103 debugging at the moment. By passing an identifier of a thread group
27104 to the @code{-list-thread-groups} command, it is possible to obtain
27105 the members of specific thread group.
27106
27107 To allow the user to easily discover processes, and other objects, he
27108 wishes to debug, a concept of @dfn{available thread group} is
27109 introduced. Available thread group is an thread group that
27110 @value{GDBN} is not debugging, but that can be attached to, using the
27111 @code{-target-attach} command. The list of available top-level thread
27112 groups can be obtained using @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}.
27113 In general, the content of a thread group may be only retrieved only
27114 after attaching to that thread group.
27115
27116 Thread groups are related to inferiors (@pxref{Inferiors and
27117 Programs}). Each inferior corresponds to a thread group of a special
27118 type @samp{process}, and some additional operations are permitted on
27119 such thread groups.
27120
27121 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27122 @node GDB/MI Command Syntax
27123 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Syntax
27124
27125 @menu
27126 * GDB/MI Input Syntax::
27127 * GDB/MI Output Syntax::
27128 @end menu
27129
27130 @node GDB/MI Input Syntax
27131 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Input Syntax
27132
27133 @cindex input syntax for @sc{gdb/mi}
27134 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, input syntax
27135 @table @code
27136 @item @var{command} @expansion{}
27137 @code{@var{cli-command} | @var{mi-command}}
27138
27139 @item @var{cli-command} @expansion{}
27140 @code{[ @var{token} ] @var{cli-command} @var{nl}}, where
27141 @var{cli-command} is any existing @value{GDBN} CLI command.
27142
27143 @item @var{mi-command} @expansion{}
27144 @code{[ @var{token} ] "-" @var{operation} ( " " @var{option} )*
27145 @code{[} " --" @code{]} ( " " @var{parameter} )* @var{nl}}
27146
27147 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
27148 "any sequence of digits"
27149
27150 @item @var{option} @expansion{}
27151 @code{"-" @var{parameter} [ " " @var{parameter} ]}
27152
27153 @item @var{parameter} @expansion{}
27154 @code{@var{non-blank-sequence} | @var{c-string}}
27155
27156 @item @var{operation} @expansion{}
27157 @emph{any of the operations described in this chapter}
27158
27159 @item @var{non-blank-sequence} @expansion{}
27160 @emph{anything, provided it doesn't contain special characters such as
27161 "-", @var{nl}, """ and of course " "}
27162
27163 @item @var{c-string} @expansion{}
27164 @code{""" @var{seven-bit-iso-c-string-content} """}
27165
27166 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
27167 @code{CR | CR-LF}
27168 @end table
27169
27170 @noindent
27171 Notes:
27172
27173 @itemize @bullet
27174 @item
27175 The CLI commands are still handled by the @sc{mi} interpreter; their
27176 output is described below.
27177
27178 @item
27179 The @code{@var{token}}, when present, is passed back when the command
27180 finishes.
27181
27182 @item
27183 Some @sc{mi} commands accept optional arguments as part of the parameter
27184 list. Each option is identified by a leading @samp{-} (dash) and may be
27185 followed by an optional argument parameter. Options occur first in the
27186 parameter list and can be delimited from normal parameters using
27187 @samp{--} (this is useful when some parameters begin with a dash).
27188 @end itemize
27189
27190 Pragmatics:
27191
27192 @itemize @bullet
27193 @item
27194 We want easy access to the existing CLI syntax (for debugging).
27195
27196 @item
27197 We want it to be easy to spot a @sc{mi} operation.
27198 @end itemize
27199
27200 @node GDB/MI Output Syntax
27201 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax
27202
27203 @cindex output syntax of @sc{gdb/mi}
27204 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, output syntax
27205 The output from @sc{gdb/mi} consists of zero or more out-of-band records
27206 followed, optionally, by a single result record. This result record
27207 is for the most recent command. The sequence of output records is
27208 terminated by @samp{(gdb)}.
27209
27210 If an input command was prefixed with a @code{@var{token}} then the
27211 corresponding output for that command will also be prefixed by that same
27212 @var{token}.
27213
27214 @table @code
27215 @item @var{output} @expansion{}
27216 @code{( @var{out-of-band-record} )* [ @var{result-record} ] "(gdb)" @var{nl}}
27217
27218 @item @var{result-record} @expansion{}
27219 @code{ [ @var{token} ] "^" @var{result-class} ( "," @var{result} )* @var{nl}}
27220
27221 @item @var{out-of-band-record} @expansion{}
27222 @code{@var{async-record} | @var{stream-record}}
27223
27224 @item @var{async-record} @expansion{}
27225 @code{@var{exec-async-output} | @var{status-async-output} | @var{notify-async-output}}
27226
27227 @item @var{exec-async-output} @expansion{}
27228 @code{[ @var{token} ] "*" @var{async-output nl}}
27229
27230 @item @var{status-async-output} @expansion{}
27231 @code{[ @var{token} ] "+" @var{async-output nl}}
27232
27233 @item @var{notify-async-output} @expansion{}
27234 @code{[ @var{token} ] "=" @var{async-output nl}}
27235
27236 @item @var{async-output} @expansion{}
27237 @code{@var{async-class} ( "," @var{result} )*}
27238
27239 @item @var{result-class} @expansion{}
27240 @code{"done" | "running" | "connected" | "error" | "exit"}
27241
27242 @item @var{async-class} @expansion{}
27243 @code{"stopped" | @var{others}} (where @var{others} will be added
27244 depending on the needs---this is still in development).
27245
27246 @item @var{result} @expansion{}
27247 @code{ @var{variable} "=" @var{value}}
27248
27249 @item @var{variable} @expansion{}
27250 @code{ @var{string} }
27251
27252 @item @var{value} @expansion{}
27253 @code{ @var{const} | @var{tuple} | @var{list} }
27254
27255 @item @var{const} @expansion{}
27256 @code{@var{c-string}}
27257
27258 @item @var{tuple} @expansion{}
27259 @code{ "@{@}" | "@{" @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "@}" }
27260
27261 @item @var{list} @expansion{}
27262 @code{ "[]" | "[" @var{value} ( "," @var{value} )* "]" | "["
27263 @var{result} ( "," @var{result} )* "]" }
27264
27265 @item @var{stream-record} @expansion{}
27266 @code{@var{console-stream-output} | @var{target-stream-output} | @var{log-stream-output}}
27267
27268 @item @var{console-stream-output} @expansion{}
27269 @code{"~" @var{c-string nl}}
27270
27271 @item @var{target-stream-output} @expansion{}
27272 @code{"@@" @var{c-string nl}}
27273
27274 @item @var{log-stream-output} @expansion{}
27275 @code{"&" @var{c-string nl}}
27276
27277 @item @var{nl} @expansion{}
27278 @code{CR | CR-LF}
27279
27280 @item @var{token} @expansion{}
27281 @emph{any sequence of digits}.
27282 @end table
27283
27284 @noindent
27285 Notes:
27286
27287 @itemize @bullet
27288 @item
27289 All output sequences end in a single line containing a period.
27290
27291 @item
27292 The @code{@var{token}} is from the corresponding request. Note that
27293 for all async output, while the token is allowed by the grammar and
27294 may be output by future versions of @value{GDBN} for select async
27295 output messages, it is generally omitted. Frontends should treat
27296 all async output as reporting general changes in the state of the
27297 target and there should be no need to associate async output to any
27298 prior command.
27299
27300 @item
27301 @cindex status output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27302 @var{status-async-output} contains on-going status information about the
27303 progress of a slow operation. It can be discarded. All status output is
27304 prefixed by @samp{+}.
27305
27306 @item
27307 @cindex async output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27308 @var{exec-async-output} contains asynchronous state change on the target
27309 (stopped, started, disappeared). All async output is prefixed by
27310 @samp{*}.
27311
27312 @item
27313 @cindex notify output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27314 @var{notify-async-output} contains supplementary information that the
27315 client should handle (e.g., a new breakpoint information). All notify
27316 output is prefixed by @samp{=}.
27317
27318 @item
27319 @cindex console output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27320 @var{console-stream-output} is output that should be displayed as is in the
27321 console. It is the textual response to a CLI command. All the console
27322 output is prefixed by @samp{~}.
27323
27324 @item
27325 @cindex target output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27326 @var{target-stream-output} is the output produced by the target program.
27327 All the target output is prefixed by @samp{@@}.
27328
27329 @item
27330 @cindex log output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27331 @var{log-stream-output} is output text coming from @value{GDBN}'s internals, for
27332 instance messages that should be displayed as part of an error log. All
27333 the log output is prefixed by @samp{&}.
27334
27335 @item
27336 @cindex list output in @sc{gdb/mi}
27337 New @sc{gdb/mi} commands should only output @var{lists} containing
27338 @var{values}.
27339
27340
27341 @end itemize
27342
27343 @xref{GDB/MI Stream Records, , @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records}, for more
27344 details about the various output records.
27345
27346 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27347 @node GDB/MI Compatibility with CLI
27348 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Compatibility with CLI
27349
27350 @cindex compatibility, @sc{gdb/mi} and CLI
27351 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, compatibility with CLI
27352
27353 For the developers convenience CLI commands can be entered directly,
27354 but there may be some unexpected behaviour. For example, commands
27355 that query the user will behave as if the user replied yes, breakpoint
27356 command lists are not executed and some CLI commands, such as
27357 @code{if}, @code{when} and @code{define}, prompt for further input with
27358 @samp{>}, which is not valid MI output.
27359
27360 This feature may be removed at some stage in the future and it is
27361 recommended that front ends use the @code{-interpreter-exec} command
27362 (@pxref{-interpreter-exec}).
27363
27364 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27365 @node GDB/MI Development and Front Ends
27366 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Development and Front Ends
27367 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi} development
27368
27369 The application which takes the MI output and presents the state of the
27370 program being debugged to the user is called a @dfn{front end}.
27371
27372 Although @sc{gdb/mi} is still incomplete, it is currently being used
27373 by a variety of front ends to @value{GDBN}. This makes it difficult
27374 to introduce new functionality without breaking existing usage. This
27375 section tries to minimize the problems by describing how the protocol
27376 might change.
27377
27378 Some changes in MI need not break a carefully designed front end, and
27379 for these the MI version will remain unchanged. The following is a
27380 list of changes that may occur within one level, so front ends should
27381 parse MI output in a way that can handle them:
27382
27383 @itemize @bullet
27384 @item
27385 New MI commands may be added.
27386
27387 @item
27388 New fields may be added to the output of any MI command.
27389
27390 @item
27391 The range of values for fields with specified values, e.g.,
27392 @code{in_scope} (@pxref{-var-update}) may be extended.
27393
27394 @c The format of field's content e.g type prefix, may change so parse it
27395 @c at your own risk. Yes, in general?
27396
27397 @c The order of fields may change? Shouldn't really matter but it might
27398 @c resolve inconsistencies.
27399 @end itemize
27400
27401 If the changes are likely to break front ends, the MI version level
27402 will be increased by one. This will allow the front end to parse the
27403 output according to the MI version. Apart from mi0, new versions of
27404 @value{GDBN} will not support old versions of MI and it will be the
27405 responsibility of the front end to work with the new one.
27406
27407 @c Starting with mi3, add a new command -mi-version that prints the MI
27408 @c version?
27409
27410 The best way to avoid unexpected changes in MI that might break your front
27411 end is to make your project known to @value{GDBN} developers and
27412 follow development on @email{gdb@@sourceware.org} and
27413 @email{gdb-patches@@sourceware.org}.
27414 @cindex mailing lists
27415
27416 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27417 @node GDB/MI Output Records
27418 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Output Records
27419
27420 @menu
27421 * GDB/MI Result Records::
27422 * GDB/MI Stream Records::
27423 * GDB/MI Async Records::
27424 * GDB/MI Breakpoint Information::
27425 * GDB/MI Frame Information::
27426 * GDB/MI Thread Information::
27427 * GDB/MI Ada Exception Information::
27428 @end menu
27429
27430 @node GDB/MI Result Records
27431 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Result Records
27432
27433 @cindex result records in @sc{gdb/mi}
27434 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, result records
27435 In addition to a number of out-of-band notifications, the response to a
27436 @sc{gdb/mi} command includes one of the following result indications:
27437
27438 @table @code
27439 @findex ^done
27440 @item "^done" [ "," @var{results} ]
27441 The synchronous operation was successful, @code{@var{results}} are the return
27442 values.
27443
27444 @item "^running"
27445 @findex ^running
27446 This result record is equivalent to @samp{^done}. Historically, it
27447 was output instead of @samp{^done} if the command has resumed the
27448 target. This behaviour is maintained for backward compatibility, but
27449 all frontends should treat @samp{^done} and @samp{^running}
27450 identically and rely on the @samp{*running} output record to determine
27451 which threads are resumed.
27452
27453 @item "^connected"
27454 @findex ^connected
27455 @value{GDBN} has connected to a remote target.
27456
27457 @item "^error" "," "msg=" @var{c-string} [ "," "code=" @var{c-string} ]
27458 @findex ^error
27459 The operation failed. The @code{msg=@var{c-string}} variable contains
27460 the corresponding error message.
27461
27462 If present, the @code{code=@var{c-string}} variable provides an error
27463 code on which consumers can rely on to detect the corresponding
27464 error condition. At present, only one error code is defined:
27465
27466 @table @samp
27467 @item "undefined-command"
27468 Indicates that the command causing the error does not exist.
27469 @end table
27470
27471 @item "^exit"
27472 @findex ^exit
27473 @value{GDBN} has terminated.
27474
27475 @end table
27476
27477 @node GDB/MI Stream Records
27478 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Stream Records
27479
27480 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, stream records
27481 @cindex stream records in @sc{gdb/mi}
27482 @value{GDBN} internally maintains a number of output streams: the console, the
27483 target, and the log. The output intended for each of these streams is
27484 funneled through the @sc{gdb/mi} interface using @dfn{stream records}.
27485
27486 Each stream record begins with a unique @dfn{prefix character} which
27487 identifies its stream (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, , @sc{gdb/mi} Output
27488 Syntax}). In addition to the prefix, each stream record contains a
27489 @code{@var{string-output}}. This is either raw text (with an implicit new
27490 line) or a quoted C string (which does not contain an implicit newline).
27491
27492 @table @code
27493 @item "~" @var{string-output}
27494 The console output stream contains text that should be displayed in the
27495 CLI console window. It contains the textual responses to CLI commands.
27496
27497 @item "@@" @var{string-output}
27498 The target output stream contains any textual output from the running
27499 target. This is only present when GDB's event loop is truly
27500 asynchronous, which is currently only the case for remote targets.
27501
27502 @item "&" @var{string-output}
27503 The log stream contains debugging messages being produced by @value{GDBN}'s
27504 internals.
27505 @end table
27506
27507 @node GDB/MI Async Records
27508 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Async Records
27509
27510 @cindex async records in @sc{gdb/mi}
27511 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, async records
27512 @dfn{Async} records are used to notify the @sc{gdb/mi} client of
27513 additional changes that have occurred. Those changes can either be a
27514 consequence of @sc{gdb/mi} commands (e.g., a breakpoint modified) or a result of
27515 target activity (e.g., target stopped).
27516
27517 The following is the list of possible async records:
27518
27519 @table @code
27520
27521 @item *running,thread-id="@var{thread}"
27522 The target is now running. The @var{thread} field can be the global
27523 thread ID of the the thread that is now running, and it can be
27524 @samp{all} if all threads are running. The frontend should assume
27525 that no interaction with a running thread is possible after this
27526 notification is produced. The frontend should not assume that this
27527 notification is output only once for any command. @value{GDBN} may
27528 emit this notification several times, either for different threads,
27529 because it cannot resume all threads together, or even for a single
27530 thread, if the thread must be stepped though some code before letting
27531 it run freely.
27532
27533 @item *stopped,reason="@var{reason}",thread-id="@var{id}",stopped-threads="@var{stopped}",core="@var{core}"
27534 The target has stopped. The @var{reason} field can have one of the
27535 following values:
27536
27537 @table @code
27538 @item breakpoint-hit
27539 A breakpoint was reached.
27540 @item watchpoint-trigger
27541 A watchpoint was triggered.
27542 @item read-watchpoint-trigger
27543 A read watchpoint was triggered.
27544 @item access-watchpoint-trigger
27545 An access watchpoint was triggered.
27546 @item function-finished
27547 An -exec-finish or similar CLI command was accomplished.
27548 @item location-reached
27549 An -exec-until or similar CLI command was accomplished.
27550 @item watchpoint-scope
27551 A watchpoint has gone out of scope.
27552 @item end-stepping-range
27553 An -exec-next, -exec-next-instruction, -exec-step, -exec-step-instruction or
27554 similar CLI command was accomplished.
27555 @item exited-signalled
27556 The inferior exited because of a signal.
27557 @item exited
27558 The inferior exited.
27559 @item exited-normally
27560 The inferior exited normally.
27561 @item signal-received
27562 A signal was received by the inferior.
27563 @item solib-event
27564 The inferior has stopped due to a library being loaded or unloaded.
27565 This can happen when @code{stop-on-solib-events} (@pxref{Files}) is
27566 set or when a @code{catch load} or @code{catch unload} catchpoint is
27567 in use (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}).
27568 @item fork
27569 The inferior has forked. This is reported when @code{catch fork}
27570 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
27571 @item vfork
27572 The inferior has vforked. This is reported in when @code{catch vfork}
27573 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
27574 @item syscall-entry
27575 The inferior entered a system call. This is reported when @code{catch
27576 syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
27577 @item syscall-return
27578 The inferior returned from a system call. This is reported when
27579 @code{catch syscall} (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
27580 @item exec
27581 The inferior called @code{exec}. This is reported when @code{catch exec}
27582 (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}) has been used.
27583 @end table
27584
27585 The @var{id} field identifies the global thread ID of the thread
27586 that directly caused the stop -- for example by hitting a breakpoint.
27587 Depending on whether all-stop
27588 mode is in effect (@pxref{All-Stop Mode}), @value{GDBN} may either
27589 stop all threads, or only the thread that directly triggered the stop.
27590 If all threads are stopped, the @var{stopped} field will have the
27591 value of @code{"all"}. Otherwise, the value of the @var{stopped}
27592 field will be a list of thread identifiers. Presently, this list will
27593 always include a single thread, but frontend should be prepared to see
27594 several threads in the list. The @var{core} field reports the
27595 processor core on which the stop event has happened. This field may be absent
27596 if such information is not available.
27597
27598 @item =thread-group-added,id="@var{id}"
27599 @itemx =thread-group-removed,id="@var{id}"
27600 A thread group was either added or removed. The @var{id} field
27601 contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. When a thread
27602 group is added, it generally might not be associated with a running
27603 process. When a thread group is removed, its id becomes invalid and
27604 cannot be used in any way.
27605
27606 @item =thread-group-started,id="@var{id}",pid="@var{pid}"
27607 A thread group became associated with a running program,
27608 either because the program was just started or the thread group
27609 was attached to a program. The @var{id} field contains the
27610 @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread group. The @var{pid} field
27611 contains process identifier, specific to the operating system.
27612
27613 @item =thread-group-exited,id="@var{id}"[,exit-code="@var{code}"]
27614 A thread group is no longer associated with a running program,
27615 either because the program has exited, or because it was detached
27616 from. The @var{id} field contains the @value{GDBN} identifier of the
27617 thread group. The @var{code} field is the exit code of the inferior; it exists
27618 only when the inferior exited with some code.
27619
27620 @item =thread-created,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
27621 @itemx =thread-exited,id="@var{id}",group-id="@var{gid}"
27622 A thread either was created, or has exited. The @var{id} field
27623 contains the global @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread. The @var{gid}
27624 field identifies the thread group this thread belongs to.
27625
27626 @item =thread-selected,id="@var{id}"[,frame="@var{frame}"]
27627 Informs that the selected thread or frame were changed. This notification
27628 is not emitted as result of the @code{-thread-select} or
27629 @code{-stack-select-frame} commands, but is emitted whenever an MI command
27630 that is not documented to change the selected thread and frame actually
27631 changes them. In particular, invoking, directly or indirectly
27632 (via user-defined command), the CLI @code{thread} or @code{frame} commands,
27633 will generate this notification. Changing the thread or frame from another
27634 user interface (see @ref{Interpreters}) will also generate this notification.
27635
27636 The @var{frame} field is only present if the newly selected thread is
27637 stopped. See @ref{GDB/MI Frame Information} for the format of its value.
27638
27639 We suggest that in response to this notification, front ends
27640 highlight the selected thread and cause subsequent commands to apply to
27641 that thread.
27642
27643 @item =library-loaded,...
27644 Reports that a new library file was loaded by the program. This
27645 notification has 5 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name},
27646 @var{host-name}, @var{symbols-loaded} and @var{ranges}. The @var{id} field is an
27647 opaque identifier of the library. For remote debugging case,
27648 @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} fields give the name of the
27649 library file on the target, and on the host respectively. For native
27650 debugging, both those fields have the same value. The
27651 @var{symbols-loaded} field is emitted only for backward compatibility
27652 and should not be relied on to convey any useful information. The
27653 @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the thread
27654 group in whose context the library was loaded. If the field is
27655 absent, it means the library was loaded in the context of all present
27656 thread groups. The @var{ranges} field specifies the ranges of addresses belonging
27657 to this library.
27658
27659 @item =library-unloaded,...
27660 Reports that a library was unloaded by the program. This notification
27661 has 3 fields---@var{id}, @var{target-name} and @var{host-name} with
27662 the same meaning as for the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
27663 The @var{thread-group} field, if present, specifies the id of the
27664 thread group in whose context the library was unloaded. If the field is
27665 absent, it means the library was unloaded in the context of all present
27666 thread groups.
27667
27668 @item =traceframe-changed,num=@var{tfnum},tracepoint=@var{tpnum}
27669 @itemx =traceframe-changed,end
27670 Reports that the trace frame was changed and its new number is
27671 @var{tfnum}. The number of the tracepoint associated with this trace
27672 frame is @var{tpnum}.
27673
27674 @item =tsv-created,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}
27675 Reports that the new trace state variable @var{name} is created with
27676 initial value @var{initial}.
27677
27678 @item =tsv-deleted,name=@var{name}
27679 @itemx =tsv-deleted
27680 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is deleted or all
27681 trace state variables are deleted.
27682
27683 @item =tsv-modified,name=@var{name},initial=@var{initial}[,current=@var{current}]
27684 Reports that the trace state variable @var{name} is modified with
27685 the initial value @var{initial}. The current value @var{current} of
27686 trace state variable is optional and is reported if the current
27687 value of trace state variable is known.
27688
27689 @item =breakpoint-created,bkpt=@{...@}
27690 @itemx =breakpoint-modified,bkpt=@{...@}
27691 @itemx =breakpoint-deleted,id=@var{number}
27692 Reports that a breakpoint was created, modified, or deleted,
27693 respectively. Only user-visible breakpoints are reported to the MI
27694 user.
27695
27696 The @var{bkpt} argument is of the same form as returned by the various
27697 breakpoint commands; @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}. The
27698 @var{number} is the ordinal number of the breakpoint.
27699
27700 Note that if a breakpoint is emitted in the result record of a
27701 command, then it will not also be emitted in an async record.
27702
27703 @item =record-started,thread-group="@var{id}",method="@var{method}"[,format="@var{format}"]
27704 @itemx =record-stopped,thread-group="@var{id}"
27705 Execution log recording was either started or stopped on an
27706 inferior. The @var{id} is the @value{GDBN} identifier of the thread
27707 group corresponding to the affected inferior.
27708
27709 The @var{method} field indicates the method used to record execution. If the
27710 method in use supports multiple recording formats, @var{format} will be present
27711 and contain the currently used format. @xref{Process Record and Replay},
27712 for existing method and format values.
27713
27714 @item =cmd-param-changed,param=@var{param},value=@var{value}
27715 Reports that a parameter of the command @code{set @var{param}} is
27716 changed to @var{value}. In the multi-word @code{set} command,
27717 the @var{param} is the whole parameter list to @code{set} command.
27718 For example, In command @code{set check type on}, @var{param}
27719 is @code{check type} and @var{value} is @code{on}.
27720
27721 @item =memory-changed,thread-group=@var{id},addr=@var{addr},len=@var{len}[,type="code"]
27722 Reports that bytes from @var{addr} to @var{data} + @var{len} were
27723 written in an inferior. The @var{id} is the identifier of the
27724 thread group corresponding to the affected inferior. The optional
27725 @code{type="code"} part is reported if the memory written to holds
27726 executable code.
27727 @end table
27728
27729 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Information
27730 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Information
27731
27732 When @value{GDBN} reports information about a breakpoint, a
27733 tracepoint, a watchpoint, or a catchpoint, it uses a tuple with the
27734 following fields:
27735
27736 @table @code
27737 @item number
27738 The breakpoint number. For a breakpoint that represents one location
27739 of a multi-location breakpoint, this will be a dotted pair, like
27740 @samp{1.2}.
27741
27742 @item type
27743 The type of the breakpoint. For ordinary breakpoints this will be
27744 @samp{breakpoint}, but many values are possible.
27745
27746 @item catch-type
27747 If the type of the breakpoint is @samp{catchpoint}, then this
27748 indicates the exact type of catchpoint.
27749
27750 @item disp
27751 This is the breakpoint disposition---either @samp{del}, meaning that
27752 the breakpoint will be deleted at the next stop, or @samp{keep},
27753 meaning that the breakpoint will not be deleted.
27754
27755 @item enabled
27756 This indicates whether the breakpoint is enabled, in which case the
27757 value is @samp{y}, or disabled, in which case the value is @samp{n}.
27758 Note that this is not the same as the field @code{enable}.
27759
27760 @item addr
27761 The address of the breakpoint. This may be a hexidecimal number,
27762 giving the address; or the string @samp{<PENDING>}, for a pending
27763 breakpoint; or the string @samp{<MULTIPLE>}, for a breakpoint with
27764 multiple locations. This field will not be present if no address can
27765 be determined. For example, a watchpoint does not have an address.
27766
27767 @item func
27768 If known, the function in which the breakpoint appears.
27769 If not known, this field is not present.
27770
27771 @item filename
27772 The name of the source file which contains this function, if known.
27773 If not known, this field is not present.
27774
27775 @item fullname
27776 The full file name of the source file which contains this function, if
27777 known. If not known, this field is not present.
27778
27779 @item line
27780 The line number at which this breakpoint appears, if known.
27781 If not known, this field is not present.
27782
27783 @item at
27784 If the source file is not known, this field may be provided. If
27785 provided, this holds the address of the breakpoint, possibly followed
27786 by a symbol name.
27787
27788 @item pending
27789 If this breakpoint is pending, this field is present and holds the
27790 text used to set the breakpoint, as entered by the user.
27791
27792 @item evaluated-by
27793 Where this breakpoint's condition is evaluated, either @samp{host} or
27794 @samp{target}.
27795
27796 @item thread
27797 If this is a thread-specific breakpoint, then this identifies the
27798 thread in which the breakpoint can trigger.
27799
27800 @item task
27801 If this breakpoint is restricted to a particular Ada task, then this
27802 field will hold the task identifier.
27803
27804 @item cond
27805 If the breakpoint is conditional, this is the condition expression.
27806
27807 @item ignore
27808 The ignore count of the breakpoint.
27809
27810 @item enable
27811 The enable count of the breakpoint.
27812
27813 @item traceframe-usage
27814 FIXME.
27815
27816 @item static-tracepoint-marker-string-id
27817 For a static tracepoint, the name of the static tracepoint marker.
27818
27819 @item mask
27820 For a masked watchpoint, this is the mask.
27821
27822 @item pass
27823 A tracepoint's pass count.
27824
27825 @item original-location
27826 The location of the breakpoint as originally specified by the user.
27827 This field is optional.
27828
27829 @item times
27830 The number of times the breakpoint has been hit.
27831
27832 @item installed
27833 This field is only given for tracepoints. This is either @samp{y},
27834 meaning that the tracepoint is installed, or @samp{n}, meaning that it
27835 is not.
27836
27837 @item what
27838 Some extra data, the exact contents of which are type-dependent.
27839
27840 @end table
27841
27842 For example, here is what the output of @code{-break-insert}
27843 (@pxref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands}) might be:
27844
27845 @smallexample
27846 -> -break-insert main
27847 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27848 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
27849 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
27850 times="0"@}
27851 <- (gdb)
27852 @end smallexample
27853
27854 @node GDB/MI Frame Information
27855 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Frame Information
27856
27857 Response from many MI commands includes an information about stack
27858 frame. This information is a tuple that may have the following
27859 fields:
27860
27861 @table @code
27862 @item level
27863 The level of the stack frame. The innermost frame has the level of
27864 zero. This field is always present.
27865
27866 @item func
27867 The name of the function corresponding to the frame. This field may
27868 be absent if @value{GDBN} is unable to determine the function name.
27869
27870 @item addr
27871 The code address for the frame. This field is always present.
27872
27873 @item file
27874 The name of the source files that correspond to the frame's code
27875 address. This field may be absent.
27876
27877 @item line
27878 The source line corresponding to the frames' code address. This field
27879 may be absent.
27880
27881 @item from
27882 The name of the binary file (either executable or shared library) the
27883 corresponds to the frame's code address. This field may be absent.
27884
27885 @end table
27886
27887 @node GDB/MI Thread Information
27888 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Information
27889
27890 Whenever @value{GDBN} has to report an information about a thread, it
27891 uses a tuple with the following fields. The fields are always present unless
27892 stated otherwise.
27893
27894 @table @code
27895 @item id
27896 The global numeric id assigned to the thread by @value{GDBN}.
27897
27898 @item target-id
27899 The target-specific string identifying the thread.
27900
27901 @item details
27902 Additional information about the thread provided by the target.
27903 It is supposed to be human-readable and not interpreted by the
27904 frontend. This field is optional.
27905
27906 @item name
27907 The name of the thread. If the user specified a name using the
27908 @code{thread name} command, then this name is given. Otherwise, if
27909 @value{GDBN} can extract the thread name from the target, then that
27910 name is given. If @value{GDBN} cannot find the thread name, then this
27911 field is omitted.
27912
27913 @item state
27914 The execution state of the thread, either @samp{stopped} or @samp{running},
27915 depending on whether the thread is presently running.
27916
27917 @item frame
27918 The stack frame currently executing in the thread. This field is only present
27919 if the thread is stopped. Its format is documented in
27920 @ref{GDB/MI Frame Information}.
27921
27922 @item core
27923 The value of this field is an integer number of the processor core the
27924 thread was last seen on. This field is optional.
27925 @end table
27926
27927 @node GDB/MI Ada Exception Information
27928 @subsection @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Exception Information
27929
27930 Whenever a @code{*stopped} record is emitted because the program
27931 stopped after hitting an exception catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints}),
27932 @value{GDBN} provides the name of the exception that was raised via
27933 the @code{exception-name} field. Also, for exceptions that were raised
27934 with an exception message, @value{GDBN} provides that message via
27935 the @code{exception-message} field.
27936
27937 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
27938 @node GDB/MI Simple Examples
27939 @section Simple Examples of @sc{gdb/mi} Interaction
27940 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, simple examples
27941
27942 This subsection presents several simple examples of interaction using
27943 the @sc{gdb/mi} interface. In these examples, @samp{->} means that the
27944 following line is passed to @sc{gdb/mi} as input, while @samp{<-} means
27945 the output received from @sc{gdb/mi}.
27946
27947 Note the line breaks shown in the examples are here only for
27948 readability, they don't appear in the real output.
27949
27950 @subheading Setting a Breakpoint
27951
27952 Setting a breakpoint generates synchronous output which contains detailed
27953 information of the breakpoint.
27954
27955 @smallexample
27956 -> -break-insert main
27957 <- ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
27958 enabled="y",addr="0x08048564",func="main",file="myprog.c",
27959 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68",thread-groups=["i1"],
27960 times="0"@}
27961 <- (gdb)
27962 @end smallexample
27963
27964 @subheading Program Execution
27965
27966 Program execution generates asynchronous records and MI gives the
27967 reason that execution stopped.
27968
27969 @smallexample
27970 -> -exec-run
27971 <- ^running
27972 <- (gdb)
27973 <- *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
27974 frame=@{addr="0x08048564",func="main",
27975 args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},@{name="argv",value="0xbfc4d4d4"@}],
27976 file="myprog.c",fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="68"@}
27977 <- (gdb)
27978 -> -exec-continue
27979 <- ^running
27980 <- (gdb)
27981 <- *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
27982 <- (gdb)
27983 @end smallexample
27984
27985 @subheading Quitting @value{GDBN}
27986
27987 Quitting @value{GDBN} just prints the result class @samp{^exit}.
27988
27989 @smallexample
27990 -> (gdb)
27991 <- -gdb-exit
27992 <- ^exit
27993 @end smallexample
27994
27995 Please note that @samp{^exit} is printed immediately, but it might
27996 take some time for @value{GDBN} to actually exit. During that time, @value{GDBN}
27997 performs necessary cleanups, including killing programs being debugged
27998 or disconnecting from debug hardware, so the frontend should wait till
27999 @value{GDBN} exits and should only forcibly kill @value{GDBN} if it
28000 fails to exit in reasonable time.
28001
28002 @subheading A Bad Command
28003
28004 Here's what happens if you pass a non-existent command:
28005
28006 @smallexample
28007 -> -rubbish
28008 <- ^error,msg="Undefined MI command: rubbish"
28009 <- (gdb)
28010 @end smallexample
28011
28012
28013 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28014 @node GDB/MI Command Description Format
28015 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Command Description Format
28016
28017 The remaining sections describe blocks of commands. Each block of
28018 commands is laid out in a fashion similar to this section.
28019
28020 @subheading Motivation
28021
28022 The motivation for this collection of commands.
28023
28024 @subheading Introduction
28025
28026 A brief introduction to this collection of commands as a whole.
28027
28028 @subheading Commands
28029
28030 For each command in the block, the following is described:
28031
28032 @subsubheading Synopsis
28033
28034 @smallexample
28035 -command @var{args}@dots{}
28036 @end smallexample
28037
28038 @subsubheading Result
28039
28040 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28041
28042 The corresponding @value{GDBN} CLI command(s), if any.
28043
28044 @subsubheading Example
28045
28046 Example(s) formatted for readability. Some of the described commands have
28047 not been implemented yet and these are labeled N.A.@: (not available).
28048
28049
28050 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28051 @node GDB/MI Breakpoint Commands
28052 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Breakpoint Commands
28053
28054 @cindex breakpoint commands for @sc{gdb/mi}
28055 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, breakpoint commands
28056 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
28057 breakpoints.
28058
28059 @subheading The @code{-break-after} Command
28060 @findex -break-after
28061
28062 @subsubheading Synopsis
28063
28064 @smallexample
28065 -break-after @var{number} @var{count}
28066 @end smallexample
28067
28068 The breakpoint number @var{number} is not in effect until it has been
28069 hit @var{count} times. To see how this is reflected in the output of
28070 the @samp{-break-list} command, see the description of the
28071 @samp{-break-list} command below.
28072
28073 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28074
28075 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ignore}.
28076
28077 @subsubheading Example
28078
28079 @smallexample
28080 (gdb)
28081 -break-insert main
28082 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
28083 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
28084 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
28085 times="0"@}
28086 (gdb)
28087 -break-after 1 3
28088 ~
28089 ^done
28090 (gdb)
28091 -break-list
28092 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
28093 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28094 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28095 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28096 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28097 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28098 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28099 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28100 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
28101 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
28102 (gdb)
28103 @end smallexample
28104
28105 @ignore
28106 @subheading The @code{-break-catch} Command
28107 @findex -break-catch
28108 @end ignore
28109
28110 @subheading The @code{-break-commands} Command
28111 @findex -break-commands
28112
28113 @subsubheading Synopsis
28114
28115 @smallexample
28116 -break-commands @var{number} [ @var{command1} ... @var{commandN} ]
28117 @end smallexample
28118
28119 Specifies the CLI commands that should be executed when breakpoint
28120 @var{number} is hit. The parameters @var{command1} to @var{commandN}
28121 are the commands. If no command is specified, any previously-set
28122 commands are cleared. @xref{Break Commands}. Typical use of this
28123 functionality is tracing a program, that is, printing of values of
28124 some variables whenever breakpoint is hit and then continuing.
28125
28126 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28127
28128 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{commands}.
28129
28130 @subsubheading Example
28131
28132 @smallexample
28133 (gdb)
28134 -break-insert main
28135 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
28136 enabled="y",addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",
28137 fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
28138 times="0"@}
28139 (gdb)
28140 -break-commands 1 "print v" "continue"
28141 ^done
28142 (gdb)
28143 @end smallexample
28144
28145 @subheading The @code{-break-condition} Command
28146 @findex -break-condition
28147
28148 @subsubheading Synopsis
28149
28150 @smallexample
28151 -break-condition @var{number} @var{expr}
28152 @end smallexample
28153
28154 Breakpoint @var{number} will stop the program only if the condition in
28155 @var{expr} is true. The condition becomes part of the
28156 @samp{-break-list} output (see the description of the @samp{-break-list}
28157 command below).
28158
28159 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28160
28161 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{condition}.
28162
28163 @subsubheading Example
28164
28165 @smallexample
28166 (gdb)
28167 -break-condition 1 1
28168 ^done
28169 (gdb)
28170 -break-list
28171 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
28172 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28173 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28174 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28175 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28176 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28177 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28178 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28179 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
28180 line="5",cond="1",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",ignore="3"@}]@}
28181 (gdb)
28182 @end smallexample
28183
28184 @subheading The @code{-break-delete} Command
28185 @findex -break-delete
28186
28187 @subsubheading Synopsis
28188
28189 @smallexample
28190 -break-delete ( @var{breakpoint} )+
28191 @end smallexample
28192
28193 Delete the breakpoint(s) whose number(s) are specified in the argument
28194 list. This is obviously reflected in the breakpoint list.
28195
28196 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28197
28198 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{delete}.
28199
28200 @subsubheading Example
28201
28202 @smallexample
28203 (gdb)
28204 -break-delete 1
28205 ^done
28206 (gdb)
28207 -break-list
28208 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
28209 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28210 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28211 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28212 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28213 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28214 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28215 body=[]@}
28216 (gdb)
28217 @end smallexample
28218
28219 @subheading The @code{-break-disable} Command
28220 @findex -break-disable
28221
28222 @subsubheading Synopsis
28223
28224 @smallexample
28225 -break-disable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
28226 @end smallexample
28227
28228 Disable the named @var{breakpoint}(s). The field @samp{enabled} in the
28229 break list is now set to @samp{n} for the named @var{breakpoint}(s).
28230
28231 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28232
28233 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disable}.
28234
28235 @subsubheading Example
28236
28237 @smallexample
28238 (gdb)
28239 -break-disable 2
28240 ^done
28241 (gdb)
28242 -break-list
28243 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
28244 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28245 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28246 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28247 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28248 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28249 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28250 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
28251 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
28252 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
28253 (gdb)
28254 @end smallexample
28255
28256 @subheading The @code{-break-enable} Command
28257 @findex -break-enable
28258
28259 @subsubheading Synopsis
28260
28261 @smallexample
28262 -break-enable ( @var{breakpoint} )+
28263 @end smallexample
28264
28265 Enable (previously disabled) @var{breakpoint}(s).
28266
28267 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28268
28269 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{enable}.
28270
28271 @subsubheading Example
28272
28273 @smallexample
28274 (gdb)
28275 -break-enable 2
28276 ^done
28277 (gdb)
28278 -break-list
28279 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
28280 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28281 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28282 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28283 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28284 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28285 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28286 body=[bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28287 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
28288 line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
28289 (gdb)
28290 @end smallexample
28291
28292 @subheading The @code{-break-info} Command
28293 @findex -break-info
28294
28295 @subsubheading Synopsis
28296
28297 @smallexample
28298 -break-info @var{breakpoint}
28299 @end smallexample
28300
28301 @c REDUNDANT???
28302 Get information about a single breakpoint.
28303
28304 The result is a table of breakpoints. @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint
28305 Information}, for details on the format of each breakpoint in the
28306 table.
28307
28308 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28309
28310 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break @var{breakpoint}}.
28311
28312 @subsubheading Example
28313 N.A.
28314
28315 @subheading The @code{-break-insert} Command
28316 @findex -break-insert
28317 @anchor{-break-insert}
28318
28319 @subsubheading Synopsis
28320
28321 @smallexample
28322 -break-insert [ -t ] [ -h ] [ -f ] [ -d ] [ -a ]
28323 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
28324 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ]
28325 @end smallexample
28326
28327 @noindent
28328 If specified, @var{location}, can be one of:
28329
28330 @table @var
28331 @item linespec location
28332 A linespec location. @xref{Linespec Locations}.
28333
28334 @item explicit location
28335 An explicit location. @sc{gdb/mi} explicit locations are
28336 analogous to the CLI's explicit locations using the option names
28337 listed below. @xref{Explicit Locations}.
28338
28339 @table @samp
28340 @item --source @var{filename}
28341 The source file name of the location. This option requires the use
28342 of either @samp{--function} or @samp{--line}.
28343
28344 @item --function @var{function}
28345 The name of a function or method.
28346
28347 @item --label @var{label}
28348 The name of a label.
28349
28350 @item --line @var{lineoffset}
28351 An absolute or relative line offset from the start of the location.
28352 @end table
28353
28354 @item address location
28355 An address location, *@var{address}. @xref{Address Locations}.
28356 @end table
28357
28358 @noindent
28359 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
28360
28361 @table @samp
28362 @item -t
28363 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
28364 @item -h
28365 Insert a hardware breakpoint.
28366 @item -f
28367 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example if it
28368 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
28369 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
28370 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
28371 cannot be parsed.
28372 @item -d
28373 Create a disabled breakpoint.
28374 @item -a
28375 Create a tracepoint. @xref{Tracepoints}. When this parameter
28376 is used together with @samp{-h}, a fast tracepoint is created.
28377 @item -c @var{condition}
28378 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
28379 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
28380 Initialize the @var{ignore-count}.
28381 @item -p @var{thread-id}
28382 Restrict the breakpoint to the thread with the specified global
28383 @var{thread-id}.
28384 @end table
28385
28386 @subsubheading Result
28387
28388 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
28389 resulting breakpoint.
28390
28391 Note: this format is open to change.
28392 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
28393
28394 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28395
28396 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{break}, @samp{tbreak},
28397 @samp{hbreak}, and @samp{thbreak}. @c and @samp{rbreak}.
28398
28399 @subsubheading Example
28400
28401 @smallexample
28402 (gdb)
28403 -break-insert main
28404 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",
28405 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
28406 times="0"@}
28407 (gdb)
28408 -break-insert -t foo
28409 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c",
28410 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
28411 times="0"@}
28412 (gdb)
28413 -break-list
28414 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
28415 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28416 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28417 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28418 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28419 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28420 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28421 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28422 addr="0x0001072c", func="main",file="recursive2.c",
28423 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c,"line="4",thread-groups=["i1"],
28424 times="0"@},
28425 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
28426 addr="0x00010774",func="foo",file="recursive2.c",
28427 fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
28428 times="0"@}]@}
28429 (gdb)
28430 @c -break-insert -r foo.*
28431 @c ~int foo(int, int);
28432 @c ^done,bkpt=@{number="3",addr="0x00010774",file="recursive2.c,
28433 @c "fullname="/home/foo/recursive2.c",line="11",thread-groups=["i1"],
28434 @c times="0"@}
28435 @c (gdb)
28436 @end smallexample
28437
28438 @subheading The @code{-dprintf-insert} Command
28439 @findex -dprintf-insert
28440
28441 @subsubheading Synopsis
28442
28443 @smallexample
28444 -dprintf-insert [ -t ] [ -f ] [ -d ]
28445 [ -c @var{condition} ] [ -i @var{ignore-count} ]
28446 [ -p @var{thread-id} ] [ @var{location} ] [ @var{format} ]
28447 [ @var{argument} ]
28448 @end smallexample
28449
28450 @noindent
28451 If supplied, @var{location} may be specified the same way as for
28452 the @code{-break-insert} command. @xref{-break-insert}.
28453
28454 The possible optional parameters of this command are:
28455
28456 @table @samp
28457 @item -t
28458 Insert a temporary breakpoint.
28459 @item -f
28460 If @var{location} cannot be parsed (for example, if it
28461 refers to unknown files or functions), create a pending
28462 breakpoint. Without this flag, @value{GDBN} will report
28463 an error, and won't create a breakpoint, if @var{location}
28464 cannot be parsed.
28465 @item -d
28466 Create a disabled breakpoint.
28467 @item -c @var{condition}
28468 Make the breakpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
28469 @item -i @var{ignore-count}
28470 Set the ignore count of the breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ignore count})
28471 to @var{ignore-count}.
28472 @item -p @var{thread-id}
28473 Restrict the breakpoint to the thread with the specified global
28474 @var{thread-id}.
28475 @end table
28476
28477 @subsubheading Result
28478
28479 @xref{GDB/MI Breakpoint Information}, for details on the format of the
28480 resulting breakpoint.
28481
28482 @c An out-of-band breakpoint instead of part of the result?
28483
28484 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28485
28486 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dprintf}.
28487
28488 @subsubheading Example
28489
28490 @smallexample
28491 (gdb)
28492 4-dprintf-insert foo "At foo entry\n"
28493 4^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28494 addr="0x000000000040061b",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
28495 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="25",thread-groups=["i1"],
28496 times="0",script=@{"printf \"At foo entry\\n\"","continue"@},
28497 original-location="foo"@}
28498 (gdb)
28499 5-dprintf-insert 26 "arg=%d, g=%d\n" arg g
28500 5^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="dprintf",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28501 addr="0x000000000040062a",func="foo",file="mi-dprintf.c",
28502 fullname="mi-dprintf.c",line="26",thread-groups=["i1"],
28503 times="0",script=@{"printf \"arg=%d, g=%d\\n\", arg, g","continue"@},
28504 original-location="mi-dprintf.c:26"@}
28505 (gdb)
28506 @end smallexample
28507
28508 @subheading The @code{-break-list} Command
28509 @findex -break-list
28510
28511 @subsubheading Synopsis
28512
28513 @smallexample
28514 -break-list
28515 @end smallexample
28516
28517 Displays the list of inserted breakpoints, showing the following fields:
28518
28519 @table @samp
28520 @item Number
28521 number of the breakpoint
28522 @item Type
28523 type of the breakpoint: @samp{breakpoint} or @samp{watchpoint}
28524 @item Disposition
28525 should the breakpoint be deleted or disabled when it is hit: @samp{keep}
28526 or @samp{nokeep}
28527 @item Enabled
28528 is the breakpoint enabled or no: @samp{y} or @samp{n}
28529 @item Address
28530 memory location at which the breakpoint is set
28531 @item What
28532 logical location of the breakpoint, expressed by function name, file
28533 name, line number
28534 @item Thread-groups
28535 list of thread groups to which this breakpoint applies
28536 @item Times
28537 number of times the breakpoint has been hit
28538 @end table
28539
28540 If there are no breakpoints or watchpoints, the @code{BreakpointTable}
28541 @code{body} field is an empty list.
28542
28543 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28544
28545 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info break}.
28546
28547 @subsubheading Example
28548
28549 @smallexample
28550 (gdb)
28551 -break-list
28552 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
28553 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28554 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28555 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28556 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28557 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28558 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28559 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28560 addr="0x000100d0",func="main",file="hello.c",line="5",thread-groups=["i1"],
28561 times="0"@},
28562 bkpt=@{number="2",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28563 addr="0x00010114",func="foo",file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/hello.c",
28564 line="13",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
28565 (gdb)
28566 @end smallexample
28567
28568 Here's an example of the result when there are no breakpoints:
28569
28570 @smallexample
28571 (gdb)
28572 -break-list
28573 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="0",nr_cols="6",
28574 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28575 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28576 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28577 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28578 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28579 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28580 body=[]@}
28581 (gdb)
28582 @end smallexample
28583
28584 @subheading The @code{-break-passcount} Command
28585 @findex -break-passcount
28586
28587 @subsubheading Synopsis
28588
28589 @smallexample
28590 -break-passcount @var{tracepoint-number} @var{passcount}
28591 @end smallexample
28592
28593 Set the passcount for tracepoint @var{tracepoint-number} to
28594 @var{passcount}. If the breakpoint referred to by @var{tracepoint-number}
28595 is not a tracepoint, error is emitted. This corresponds to CLI
28596 command @samp{passcount}.
28597
28598 @subheading The @code{-break-watch} Command
28599 @findex -break-watch
28600
28601 @subsubheading Synopsis
28602
28603 @smallexample
28604 -break-watch [ -a | -r ]
28605 @end smallexample
28606
28607 Create a watchpoint. With the @samp{-a} option it will create an
28608 @dfn{access} watchpoint, i.e., a watchpoint that triggers either on a
28609 read from or on a write to the memory location. With the @samp{-r}
28610 option, the watchpoint created is a @dfn{read} watchpoint, i.e., it will
28611 trigger only when the memory location is accessed for reading. Without
28612 either of the options, the watchpoint created is a regular watchpoint,
28613 i.e., it will trigger when the memory location is accessed for writing.
28614 @xref{Set Watchpoints, , Setting Watchpoints}.
28615
28616 Note that @samp{-break-list} will report a single list of watchpoints and
28617 breakpoints inserted.
28618
28619 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28620
28621 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{watch}, @samp{awatch}, and
28622 @samp{rwatch}.
28623
28624 @subsubheading Example
28625
28626 Setting a watchpoint on a variable in the @code{main} function:
28627
28628 @smallexample
28629 (gdb)
28630 -break-watch x
28631 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@}
28632 (gdb)
28633 -exec-continue
28634 ^running
28635 (gdb)
28636 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="x"@},
28637 value=@{old="-268439212",new="55"@},
28638 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
28639 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="5"@}
28640 (gdb)
28641 @end smallexample
28642
28643 Setting a watchpoint on a variable local to a function. @value{GDBN} will stop
28644 the program execution twice: first for the variable changing value, then
28645 for the watchpoint going out of scope.
28646
28647 @smallexample
28648 (gdb)
28649 -break-watch C
28650 ^done,wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@}
28651 (gdb)
28652 -exec-continue
28653 ^running
28654 (gdb)
28655 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",
28656 wpt=@{number="5",exp="C"@},value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
28657 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
28658 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28659 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
28660 (gdb)
28661 -exec-continue
28662 ^running
28663 (gdb)
28664 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="5",
28665 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
28666 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
28667 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28668 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
28669 (gdb)
28670 @end smallexample
28671
28672 Listing breakpoints and watchpoints, at different points in the program
28673 execution. Note that once the watchpoint goes out of scope, it is
28674 deleted.
28675
28676 @smallexample
28677 (gdb)
28678 -break-watch C
28679 ^done,wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@}
28680 (gdb)
28681 -break-list
28682 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
28683 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28684 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28685 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28686 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28687 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28688 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28689 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28690 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
28691 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28692 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c"line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
28693 times="1"@},
28694 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
28695 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="0"@}]@}
28696 (gdb)
28697 -exec-continue
28698 ^running
28699 (gdb)
28700 *stopped,reason="watchpoint-trigger",wpt=@{number="2",exp="C"@},
28701 value=@{old="-276895068",new="3"@},
28702 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
28703 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28704 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="13"@}
28705 (gdb)
28706 -break-list
28707 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="6",
28708 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28709 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28710 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28711 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28712 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28713 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28714 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28715 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
28716 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28717 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",thread-groups=["i1"],
28718 times="1"@},
28719 bkpt=@{number="2",type="watchpoint",disp="keep",
28720 enabled="y",addr="",what="C",thread-groups=["i1"],times="-5"@}]@}
28721 (gdb)
28722 -exec-continue
28723 ^running
28724 ^done,reason="watchpoint-scope",wpnum="2",
28725 frame=@{func="callee3",args=[@{name="strarg",
28726 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
28727 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28728 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
28729 (gdb)
28730 -break-list
28731 ^done,BreakpointTable=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="6",
28732 hdr=[@{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="number",colhdr="Num"@},
28733 @{width="14",alignment="-1",col_name="type",colhdr="Type"@},
28734 @{width="4",alignment="-1",col_name="disp",colhdr="Disp"@},
28735 @{width="3",alignment="-1",col_name="enabled",colhdr="Enb"@},
28736 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="addr",colhdr="Address"@},
28737 @{width="40",alignment="2",col_name="what",colhdr="What"@}],
28738 body=[bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
28739 addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
28740 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
28741 fullname="/home/foo/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8",
28742 thread-groups=["i1"],times="1"@}]@}
28743 (gdb)
28744 @end smallexample
28745
28746
28747 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28748 @node GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
28749 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoint Commands
28750
28751 This section documents @sc{gdb/mi} commands for manipulating
28752 catchpoints.
28753
28754 @menu
28755 * Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
28756 * Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands::
28757 @end menu
28758
28759 @node Shared Library GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
28760 @subsection Shared Library @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
28761
28762 @subheading The @code{-catch-load} Command
28763 @findex -catch-load
28764
28765 @subsubheading Synopsis
28766
28767 @smallexample
28768 -catch-load [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
28769 @end smallexample
28770
28771 Add a catchpoint for library load events. If the @samp{-t} option is used,
28772 the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
28773 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is created
28774 in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
28775 expression used to match the name of the loaded library.
28776
28777
28778 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28779
28780 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch load}.
28781
28782 @subsubheading Example
28783
28784 @smallexample
28785 -catch-load -t foo.so
28786 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="catchpoint",disp="del",enabled="y",
28787 what="load of library matching foo.so",catch-type="load",times="0"@}
28788 (gdb)
28789 @end smallexample
28790
28791
28792 @subheading The @code{-catch-unload} Command
28793 @findex -catch-unload
28794
28795 @subsubheading Synopsis
28796
28797 @smallexample
28798 -catch-unload [ -t ] [ -d ] @var{regexp}
28799 @end smallexample
28800
28801 Add a catchpoint for library unload events. If the @samp{-t} option is
28802 used, the catchpoint is a temporary one (@pxref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
28803 Breakpoints}). If the @samp{-d} option is used, the catchpoint is
28804 created in a disabled state. The @samp{regexp} argument is a regular
28805 expression used to match the name of the unloaded library.
28806
28807 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28808
28809 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch unload}.
28810
28811 @subsubheading Example
28812
28813 @smallexample
28814 -catch-unload -d bar.so
28815 ^done,bkpt=@{number="2",type="catchpoint",disp="keep",enabled="n",
28816 what="load of library matching bar.so",catch-type="unload",times="0"@}
28817 (gdb)
28818 @end smallexample
28819
28820 @node Ada Exception GDB/MI Catchpoint Commands
28821 @subsection Ada Exception @sc{gdb/mi} Catchpoints
28822
28823 The following @sc{gdb/mi} commands can be used to create catchpoints
28824 that stop the execution when Ada exceptions are being raised.
28825
28826 @subheading The @code{-catch-assert} Command
28827 @findex -catch-assert
28828
28829 @subsubheading Synopsis
28830
28831 @smallexample
28832 -catch-assert [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -t ]
28833 @end smallexample
28834
28835 Add a catchpoint for failed Ada assertions.
28836
28837 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
28838
28839 @table @samp
28840 @item -c @var{condition}
28841 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
28842 @item -d
28843 Create a disabled catchpoint.
28844 @item -t
28845 Create a temporary catchpoint.
28846 @end table
28847
28848 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28849
28850 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch assert}.
28851
28852 @subsubheading Example
28853
28854 @smallexample
28855 -catch-assert
28856 ^done,bkptno="5",bkpt=@{number="5",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
28857 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404888",what="failed Ada assertions",
28858 thread-groups=["i1"],times="0",
28859 original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_assert_failure"@}
28860 (gdb)
28861 @end smallexample
28862
28863 @subheading The @code{-catch-exception} Command
28864 @findex -catch-exception
28865
28866 @subsubheading Synopsis
28867
28868 @smallexample
28869 -catch-exception [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -e @var{exception-name} ]
28870 [ -t ] [ -u ]
28871 @end smallexample
28872
28873 Add a catchpoint stopping when Ada exceptions are raised.
28874 By default, the command stops the program when any Ada exception
28875 gets raised. But it is also possible, by using some of the
28876 optional parameters described below, to create more selective
28877 catchpoints.
28878
28879 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
28880
28881 @table @samp
28882 @item -c @var{condition}
28883 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
28884 @item -d
28885 Create a disabled catchpoint.
28886 @item -e @var{exception-name}
28887 Only stop when @var{exception-name} is raised. This option cannot
28888 be used combined with @samp{-u}.
28889 @item -t
28890 Create a temporary catchpoint.
28891 @item -u
28892 Stop only when an unhandled exception gets raised. This option
28893 cannot be used combined with @samp{-e}.
28894 @end table
28895
28896 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28897
28898 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{catch exception}
28899 and @samp{catch exception unhandled}.
28900
28901 @subsubheading Example
28902
28903 @smallexample
28904 -catch-exception -e Program_Error
28905 ^done,bkptno="4",bkpt=@{number="4",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
28906 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000404874",
28907 what="`Program_Error' Ada exception", thread-groups=["i1"],
28908 times="0",original-location="__gnat_debug_raise_exception"@}
28909 (gdb)
28910 @end smallexample
28911
28912 @subheading The @code{-catch-handlers} Command
28913 @findex -catch-handlers
28914
28915 @subsubheading Synopsis
28916
28917 @smallexample
28918 -catch-handlers [ -c @var{condition}] [ -d ] [ -e @var{exception-name} ]
28919 [ -t ]
28920 @end smallexample
28921
28922 Add a catchpoint stopping when Ada exceptions are handled.
28923 By default, the command stops the program when any Ada exception
28924 gets handled. But it is also possible, by using some of the
28925 optional parameters described below, to create more selective
28926 catchpoints.
28927
28928 The possible optional parameters for this command are:
28929
28930 @table @samp
28931 @item -c @var{condition}
28932 Make the catchpoint conditional on @var{condition}.
28933 @item -d
28934 Create a disabled catchpoint.
28935 @item -e @var{exception-name}
28936 Only stop when @var{exception-name} is handled.
28937 @item -t
28938 Create a temporary catchpoint.
28939 @end table
28940
28941 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28942
28943 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{catch handlers}.
28944
28945 @subsubheading Example
28946
28947 @smallexample
28948 -catch-handlers -e Constraint_Error
28949 ^done,bkptno="4",bkpt=@{number="4",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",
28950 enabled="y",addr="0x0000000000402f68",
28951 what="`Constraint_Error' Ada exception handlers",thread-groups=["i1"],
28952 times="0",original-location="__gnat_begin_handler"@}
28953 (gdb)
28954 @end smallexample
28955
28956 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
28957 @node GDB/MI Program Context
28958 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Context
28959
28960 @subheading The @code{-exec-arguments} Command
28961 @findex -exec-arguments
28962
28963
28964 @subsubheading Synopsis
28965
28966 @smallexample
28967 -exec-arguments @var{args}
28968 @end smallexample
28969
28970 Set the inferior program arguments, to be used in the next
28971 @samp{-exec-run}.
28972
28973 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
28974
28975 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set args}.
28976
28977 @subsubheading Example
28978
28979 @smallexample
28980 (gdb)
28981 -exec-arguments -v word
28982 ^done
28983 (gdb)
28984 @end smallexample
28985
28986
28987 @ignore
28988 @subheading The @code{-exec-show-arguments} Command
28989 @findex -exec-show-arguments
28990
28991 @subsubheading Synopsis
28992
28993 @smallexample
28994 -exec-show-arguments
28995 @end smallexample
28996
28997 Print the arguments of the program.
28998
28999 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29000
29001 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show args}.
29002
29003 @subsubheading Example
29004 N.A.
29005 @end ignore
29006
29007
29008 @subheading The @code{-environment-cd} Command
29009 @findex -environment-cd
29010
29011 @subsubheading Synopsis
29012
29013 @smallexample
29014 -environment-cd @var{pathdir}
29015 @end smallexample
29016
29017 Set @value{GDBN}'s working directory.
29018
29019 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29020
29021 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{cd}.
29022
29023 @subsubheading Example
29024
29025 @smallexample
29026 (gdb)
29027 -environment-cd /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
29028 ^done
29029 (gdb)
29030 @end smallexample
29031
29032
29033 @subheading The @code{-environment-directory} Command
29034 @findex -environment-directory
29035
29036 @subsubheading Synopsis
29037
29038 @smallexample
29039 -environment-directory [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
29040 @end smallexample
29041
29042 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for source files.
29043 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the default
29044 search path. If directories @var{pathdir} are supplied in addition to the
29045 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
29046 occurs as normal.
29047 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
29048 multiple directories in a single command
29049 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
29050 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
29051 If blanks are needed as
29052 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
29053 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
29054 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
29055 character must not be used
29056 in any directory name.
29057 If no directories are specified, the current search path is displayed.
29058
29059 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29060
29061 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{dir}.
29062
29063 @subsubheading Example
29064
29065 @smallexample
29066 (gdb)
29067 -environment-directory /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb
29068 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
29069 (gdb)
29070 -environment-directory ""
29071 ^done,source-path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb:$cdir:$cwd"
29072 (gdb)
29073 -environment-directory -r /home/jjohnstn/src/gdb /usr/src
29074 ^done,source-path="/home/jjohnstn/src/gdb:/usr/src:$cdir:$cwd"
29075 (gdb)
29076 -environment-directory -r
29077 ^done,source-path="$cdir:$cwd"
29078 (gdb)
29079 @end smallexample
29080
29081
29082 @subheading The @code{-environment-path} Command
29083 @findex -environment-path
29084
29085 @subsubheading Synopsis
29086
29087 @smallexample
29088 -environment-path [ -r ] [ @var{pathdir} ]+
29089 @end smallexample
29090
29091 Add directories @var{pathdir} to beginning of search path for object files.
29092 If the @samp{-r} option is used, the search path is reset to the original
29093 search path that existed at gdb start-up. If directories @var{pathdir} are
29094 supplied in addition to the
29095 @samp{-r} option, the search path is first reset and then addition
29096 occurs as normal.
29097 Multiple directories may be specified, separated by blanks. Specifying
29098 multiple directories in a single command
29099 results in the directories added to the beginning of the
29100 search path in the same order they were presented in the command.
29101 If blanks are needed as
29102 part of a directory name, double-quotes should be used around
29103 the name. In the command output, the path will show up separated
29104 by the system directory-separator character. The directory-separator
29105 character must not be used
29106 in any directory name.
29107 If no directories are specified, the current path is displayed.
29108
29109
29110 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29111
29112 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{path}.
29113
29114 @subsubheading Example
29115
29116 @smallexample
29117 (gdb)
29118 -environment-path
29119 ^done,path="/usr/bin"
29120 (gdb)
29121 -environment-path /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb /bin
29122 ^done,path="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/ppc-eabi/gdb:/bin:/usr/bin"
29123 (gdb)
29124 -environment-path -r /usr/local/bin
29125 ^done,path="/usr/local/bin:/usr/bin"
29126 (gdb)
29127 @end smallexample
29128
29129
29130 @subheading The @code{-environment-pwd} Command
29131 @findex -environment-pwd
29132
29133 @subsubheading Synopsis
29134
29135 @smallexample
29136 -environment-pwd
29137 @end smallexample
29138
29139 Show the current working directory.
29140
29141 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29142
29143 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{pwd}.
29144
29145 @subsubheading Example
29146
29147 @smallexample
29148 (gdb)
29149 -environment-pwd
29150 ^done,cwd="/kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/flathead-dev/devo/gdb"
29151 (gdb)
29152 @end smallexample
29153
29154 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29155 @node GDB/MI Thread Commands
29156 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Thread Commands
29157
29158
29159 @subheading The @code{-thread-info} Command
29160 @findex -thread-info
29161
29162 @subsubheading Synopsis
29163
29164 @smallexample
29165 -thread-info [ @var{thread-id} ]
29166 @end smallexample
29167
29168 Reports information about either a specific thread, if the
29169 @var{thread-id} parameter is present, or about all threads.
29170 @var{thread-id} is the thread's global thread ID. When printing
29171 information about all threads, also reports the global ID of the
29172 current thread.
29173
29174 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29175
29176 The @samp{info thread} command prints the same information
29177 about all threads.
29178
29179 @subsubheading Result
29180
29181 The result contains the following attributes:
29182
29183 @table @samp
29184 @item threads
29185 A list of threads. The format of the elements of the list is described in
29186 @ref{GDB/MI Thread Information}.
29187
29188 @item current-thread-id
29189 The global id of the currently selected thread. This field is omitted if there
29190 is no selected thread (for example, when the selected inferior is not running,
29191 and therefore has no threads) or if a @var{thread-id} argument was passed to
29192 the command.
29193
29194 @end table
29195
29196 @subsubheading Example
29197
29198 @smallexample
29199 -thread-info
29200 ^done,threads=[
29201 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
29202 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",
29203 args=[]@},state="running"@},
29204 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
29205 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",
29206 args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
29207 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},
29208 state="running"@}],
29209 current-thread-id="1"
29210 (gdb)
29211 @end smallexample
29212
29213 @subheading The @code{-thread-list-ids} Command
29214 @findex -thread-list-ids
29215
29216 @subsubheading Synopsis
29217
29218 @smallexample
29219 -thread-list-ids
29220 @end smallexample
29221
29222 Produces a list of the currently known global @value{GDBN} thread ids.
29223 At the end of the list it also prints the total number of such
29224 threads.
29225
29226 This command is retained for historical reasons, the
29227 @code{-thread-info} command should be used instead.
29228
29229 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29230
29231 Part of @samp{info threads} supplies the same information.
29232
29233 @subsubheading Example
29234
29235 @smallexample
29236 (gdb)
29237 -thread-list-ids
29238 ^done,thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
29239 current-thread-id="1",number-of-threads="3"
29240 (gdb)
29241 @end smallexample
29242
29243
29244 @subheading The @code{-thread-select} Command
29245 @findex -thread-select
29246
29247 @subsubheading Synopsis
29248
29249 @smallexample
29250 -thread-select @var{thread-id}
29251 @end smallexample
29252
29253 Make thread with global thread number @var{thread-id} the current
29254 thread. It prints the number of the new current thread, and the
29255 topmost frame for that thread.
29256
29257 This command is deprecated in favor of explicitly using the
29258 @samp{--thread} option to each command.
29259
29260 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29261
29262 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{thread}.
29263
29264 @subsubheading Example
29265
29266 @smallexample
29267 (gdb)
29268 -exec-next
29269 ^running
29270 (gdb)
29271 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",thread-id="2",line="187",
29272 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.threads/linux-dp.c"
29273 (gdb)
29274 -thread-list-ids
29275 ^done,
29276 thread-ids=@{thread-id="3",thread-id="2",thread-id="1"@},
29277 number-of-threads="3"
29278 (gdb)
29279 -thread-select 3
29280 ^done,new-thread-id="3",
29281 frame=@{level="0",func="vprintf",
29282 args=[@{name="format",value="0x8048e9c \"%*s%c %d %c\\n\""@},
29283 @{name="arg",value="0x2"@}],file="vprintf.c",line="31"@}
29284 (gdb)
29285 @end smallexample
29286
29287 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29288 @node GDB/MI Ada Tasking Commands
29289 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Ada Tasking Commands
29290
29291 @subheading The @code{-ada-task-info} Command
29292 @findex -ada-task-info
29293
29294 @subsubheading Synopsis
29295
29296 @smallexample
29297 -ada-task-info [ @var{task-id} ]
29298 @end smallexample
29299
29300 Reports information about either a specific Ada task, if the
29301 @var{task-id} parameter is present, or about all Ada tasks.
29302
29303 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29304
29305 The @samp{info tasks} command prints the same information
29306 about all Ada tasks (@pxref{Ada Tasks}).
29307
29308 @subsubheading Result
29309
29310 The result is a table of Ada tasks. The following columns are
29311 defined for each Ada task:
29312
29313 @table @samp
29314 @item current
29315 This field exists only for the current thread. It has the value @samp{*}.
29316
29317 @item id
29318 The identifier that @value{GDBN} uses to refer to the Ada task.
29319
29320 @item task-id
29321 The identifier that the target uses to refer to the Ada task.
29322
29323 @item thread-id
29324 The global thread identifier of the thread corresponding to the Ada
29325 task.
29326
29327 This field should always exist, as Ada tasks are always implemented
29328 on top of a thread. But if @value{GDBN} cannot find this corresponding
29329 thread for any reason, the field is omitted.
29330
29331 @item parent-id
29332 This field exists only when the task was created by another task.
29333 In this case, it provides the ID of the parent task.
29334
29335 @item priority
29336 The base priority of the task.
29337
29338 @item state
29339 The current state of the task. For a detailed description of the
29340 possible states, see @ref{Ada Tasks}.
29341
29342 @item name
29343 The name of the task.
29344
29345 @end table
29346
29347 @subsubheading Example
29348
29349 @smallexample
29350 -ada-task-info
29351 ^done,tasks=@{nr_rows="3",nr_cols="8",
29352 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr=""@},
29353 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="id",colhdr="ID"@},
29354 @{width="9",alignment="1",col_name="task-id",colhdr="TID"@},
29355 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="thread-id",colhdr=""@},
29356 @{width="4",alignment="1",col_name="parent-id",colhdr="P-ID"@},
29357 @{width="3",alignment="1",col_name="priority",colhdr="Pri"@},
29358 @{width="22",alignment="-1",col_name="state",colhdr="State"@},
29359 @{width="1",alignment="2",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@}],
29360 body=[@{current="*",id="1",task-id=" 644010",thread-id="1",priority="48",
29361 state="Child Termination Wait",name="main_task"@}]@}
29362 (gdb)
29363 @end smallexample
29364
29365 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29366 @node GDB/MI Program Execution
29367 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Program Execution
29368
29369 These are the asynchronous commands which generate the out-of-band
29370 record @samp{*stopped}. Currently @value{GDBN} only really executes
29371 asynchronously with remote targets and this interaction is mimicked in
29372 other cases.
29373
29374 @subheading The @code{-exec-continue} Command
29375 @findex -exec-continue
29376
29377 @subsubheading Synopsis
29378
29379 @smallexample
29380 -exec-continue [--reverse] [--all|--thread-group N]
29381 @end smallexample
29382
29383 Resumes the execution of the inferior program, which will continue
29384 to execute until it reaches a debugger stop event. If the
29385 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, execution resumes in reverse until
29386 it reaches a stop event. Stop events may include
29387 @itemize @bullet
29388 @item
29389 breakpoints or watchpoints
29390 @item
29391 signals or exceptions
29392 @item
29393 the end of the process (or its beginning under @samp{--reverse})
29394 @item
29395 the end or beginning of a replay log if one is being used.
29396 @end itemize
29397 In all-stop mode (@pxref{All-Stop
29398 Mode}), may resume only one thread, or all threads, depending on the
29399 value of the @samp{scheduler-locking} variable. If @samp{--all} is
29400 specified, all threads (in all inferiors) will be resumed. The @samp{--all} option is
29401 ignored in all-stop mode. If the @samp{--thread-group} options is
29402 specified, then all threads in that thread group are resumed.
29403
29404 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29405
29406 The corresponding @value{GDBN} corresponding is @samp{continue}.
29407
29408 @subsubheading Example
29409
29410 @smallexample
29411 -exec-continue
29412 ^running
29413 (gdb)
29414 @@Hello world
29415 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="2",frame=@{
29416 func="foo",args=[],file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",
29417 line="13"@}
29418 (gdb)
29419 @end smallexample
29420
29421
29422 @subheading The @code{-exec-finish} Command
29423 @findex -exec-finish
29424
29425 @subsubheading Synopsis
29426
29427 @smallexample
29428 -exec-finish [--reverse]
29429 @end smallexample
29430
29431 Resumes the execution of the inferior program until the current
29432 function is exited. Displays the results returned by the function.
29433 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes the reverse
29434 execution of the inferior program until the point where current
29435 function was called.
29436
29437 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29438
29439 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{finish}.
29440
29441 @subsubheading Example
29442
29443 Function returning @code{void}.
29444
29445 @smallexample
29446 -exec-finish
29447 ^running
29448 (gdb)
29449 @@hello from foo
29450 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
29451 file="hello.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/hello.c",line="7"@}
29452 (gdb)
29453 @end smallexample
29454
29455 Function returning other than @code{void}. The name of the internal
29456 @value{GDBN} variable storing the result is printed, together with the
29457 value itself.
29458
29459 @smallexample
29460 -exec-finish
29461 ^running
29462 (gdb)
29463 *stopped,reason="function-finished",frame=@{addr="0x000107b0",func="foo",
29464 args=[@{name="a",value="1"],@{name="b",value="9"@}@},
29465 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
29466 gdb-result-var="$1",return-value="0"
29467 (gdb)
29468 @end smallexample
29469
29470
29471 @subheading The @code{-exec-interrupt} Command
29472 @findex -exec-interrupt
29473
29474 @subsubheading Synopsis
29475
29476 @smallexample
29477 -exec-interrupt [--all|--thread-group N]
29478 @end smallexample
29479
29480 Interrupts the background execution of the target. Note how the token
29481 associated with the stop message is the one for the execution command
29482 that has been interrupted. The token for the interrupt itself only
29483 appears in the @samp{^done} output. If the user is trying to
29484 interrupt a non-running program, an error message will be printed.
29485
29486 Note that when asynchronous execution is enabled, this command is
29487 asynchronous just like other execution commands. That is, first the
29488 @samp{^done} response will be printed, and the target stop will be
29489 reported after that using the @samp{*stopped} notification.
29490
29491 In non-stop mode, only the context thread is interrupted by default.
29492 All threads (in all inferiors) will be interrupted if the
29493 @samp{--all} option is specified. If the @samp{--thread-group}
29494 option is specified, all threads in that group will be interrupted.
29495
29496 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29497
29498 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interrupt}.
29499
29500 @subsubheading Example
29501
29502 @smallexample
29503 (gdb)
29504 111-exec-continue
29505 111^running
29506
29507 (gdb)
29508 222-exec-interrupt
29509 222^done
29510 (gdb)
29511 111*stopped,signal-name="SIGINT",signal-meaning="Interrupt",
29512 frame=@{addr="0x00010140",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
29513 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="13"@}
29514 (gdb)
29515
29516 (gdb)
29517 -exec-interrupt
29518 ^error,msg="mi_cmd_exec_interrupt: Inferior not executing."
29519 (gdb)
29520 @end smallexample
29521
29522 @subheading The @code{-exec-jump} Command
29523 @findex -exec-jump
29524
29525 @subsubheading Synopsis
29526
29527 @smallexample
29528 -exec-jump @var{location}
29529 @end smallexample
29530
29531 Resumes execution of the inferior program at the location specified by
29532 parameter. @xref{Specify Location}, for a description of the
29533 different forms of @var{location}.
29534
29535 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29536
29537 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{jump}.
29538
29539 @subsubheading Example
29540
29541 @smallexample
29542 -exec-jump foo.c:10
29543 *running,thread-id="all"
29544 ^running
29545 @end smallexample
29546
29547
29548 @subheading The @code{-exec-next} Command
29549 @findex -exec-next
29550
29551 @subsubheading Synopsis
29552
29553 @smallexample
29554 -exec-next [--reverse]
29555 @end smallexample
29556
29557 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
29558 of the next source line is reached.
29559
29560 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
29561 of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the previous
29562 source line. If you issue this command on the first line of a
29563 function, it will take you back to the caller of that function, to the
29564 source line where the function was called.
29565
29566
29567 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29568
29569 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{next}.
29570
29571 @subsubheading Example
29572
29573 @smallexample
29574 -exec-next
29575 ^running
29576 (gdb)
29577 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="8",file="hello.c"
29578 (gdb)
29579 @end smallexample
29580
29581
29582 @subheading The @code{-exec-next-instruction} Command
29583 @findex -exec-next-instruction
29584
29585 @subsubheading Synopsis
29586
29587 @smallexample
29588 -exec-next-instruction [--reverse]
29589 @end smallexample
29590
29591 Executes one machine instruction. If the instruction is a function
29592 call, continues until the function returns. If the program stops at an
29593 instruction in the middle of a source line, the address will be
29594 printed as well.
29595
29596 If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution
29597 of the inferior program, stopping at the previous instruction. If the
29598 previously executed instruction was a return from another function,
29599 it will continue to execute in reverse until the call to that function
29600 (from the current stack frame) is reached.
29601
29602 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29603
29604 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{nexti}.
29605
29606 @subsubheading Example
29607
29608 @smallexample
29609 (gdb)
29610 -exec-next-instruction
29611 ^running
29612
29613 (gdb)
29614 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
29615 addr="0x000100d4",line="5",file="hello.c"
29616 (gdb)
29617 @end smallexample
29618
29619
29620 @subheading The @code{-exec-return} Command
29621 @findex -exec-return
29622
29623 @subsubheading Synopsis
29624
29625 @smallexample
29626 -exec-return
29627 @end smallexample
29628
29629 Makes current function return immediately. Doesn't execute the inferior.
29630 Displays the new current frame.
29631
29632 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29633
29634 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{return}.
29635
29636 @subsubheading Example
29637
29638 @smallexample
29639 (gdb)
29640 200-break-insert callee4
29641 200^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x00010734",
29642 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
29643 (gdb)
29644 000-exec-run
29645 000^running
29646 (gdb)
29647 000*stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
29648 frame=@{func="callee4",args=[],
29649 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29650 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@}
29651 (gdb)
29652 205-break-delete
29653 205^done
29654 (gdb)
29655 111-exec-return
29656 111^done,frame=@{level="0",func="callee3",
29657 args=[@{name="strarg",
29658 value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}],
29659 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29660 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="18"@}
29661 (gdb)
29662 @end smallexample
29663
29664
29665 @subheading The @code{-exec-run} Command
29666 @findex -exec-run
29667
29668 @subsubheading Synopsis
29669
29670 @smallexample
29671 -exec-run [ --all | --thread-group N ] [ --start ]
29672 @end smallexample
29673
29674 Starts execution of the inferior from the beginning. The inferior
29675 executes until either a breakpoint is encountered or the program
29676 exits. In the latter case the output will include an exit code, if
29677 the program has exited exceptionally.
29678
29679 When neither the @samp{--all} nor the @samp{--thread-group} option
29680 is specified, the current inferior is started. If the
29681 @samp{--thread-group} option is specified, it should refer to a thread
29682 group of type @samp{process}, and that thread group will be started.
29683 If the @samp{--all} option is specified, then all inferiors will be started.
29684
29685 Using the @samp{--start} option instructs the debugger to stop
29686 the execution at the start of the inferior's main subprogram,
29687 following the same behavior as the @code{start} command
29688 (@pxref{Starting}).
29689
29690 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29691
29692 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{run}.
29693
29694 @subsubheading Examples
29695
29696 @smallexample
29697 (gdb)
29698 -break-insert main
29699 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",addr="0x0001072c",file="recursive2.c",line="4"@}
29700 (gdb)
29701 -exec-run
29702 ^running
29703 (gdb)
29704 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",
29705 frame=@{func="main",args=[],file="recursive2.c",
29706 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}
29707 (gdb)
29708 @end smallexample
29709
29710 @noindent
29711 Program exited normally:
29712
29713 @smallexample
29714 (gdb)
29715 -exec-run
29716 ^running
29717 (gdb)
29718 x = 55
29719 *stopped,reason="exited-normally"
29720 (gdb)
29721 @end smallexample
29722
29723 @noindent
29724 Program exited exceptionally:
29725
29726 @smallexample
29727 (gdb)
29728 -exec-run
29729 ^running
29730 (gdb)
29731 x = 55
29732 *stopped,reason="exited",exit-code="01"
29733 (gdb)
29734 @end smallexample
29735
29736 Another way the program can terminate is if it receives a signal such as
29737 @code{SIGINT}. In this case, @sc{gdb/mi} displays this:
29738
29739 @smallexample
29740 (gdb)
29741 *stopped,reason="exited-signalled",signal-name="SIGINT",
29742 signal-meaning="Interrupt"
29743 @end smallexample
29744
29745
29746 @c @subheading -exec-signal
29747
29748
29749 @subheading The @code{-exec-step} Command
29750 @findex -exec-step
29751
29752 @subsubheading Synopsis
29753
29754 @smallexample
29755 -exec-step [--reverse]
29756 @end smallexample
29757
29758 Resumes execution of the inferior program, stopping when the beginning
29759 of the next source line is reached, if the next source line is not a
29760 function call. If it is, stop at the first instruction of the called
29761 function. If the @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse
29762 execution of the inferior program, stopping at the beginning of the
29763 previously executed source line.
29764
29765 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29766
29767 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{step}.
29768
29769 @subsubheading Example
29770
29771 Stepping into a function:
29772
29773 @smallexample
29774 -exec-step
29775 ^running
29776 (gdb)
29777 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
29778 frame=@{func="foo",args=[@{name="a",value="10"@},
29779 @{name="b",value="0"@}],file="recursive2.c",
29780 fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@}
29781 (gdb)
29782 @end smallexample
29783
29784 Regular stepping:
29785
29786 @smallexample
29787 -exec-step
29788 ^running
29789 (gdb)
29790 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",line="14",file="recursive2.c"
29791 (gdb)
29792 @end smallexample
29793
29794
29795 @subheading The @code{-exec-step-instruction} Command
29796 @findex -exec-step-instruction
29797
29798 @subsubheading Synopsis
29799
29800 @smallexample
29801 -exec-step-instruction [--reverse]
29802 @end smallexample
29803
29804 Resumes the inferior which executes one machine instruction. If the
29805 @samp{--reverse} option is specified, resumes reverse execution of the
29806 inferior program, stopping at the previously executed instruction.
29807 The output, once @value{GDBN} has stopped, will vary depending on
29808 whether we have stopped in the middle of a source line or not. In the
29809 former case, the address at which the program stopped will be printed
29810 as well.
29811
29812 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29813
29814 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{stepi}.
29815
29816 @subsubheading Example
29817
29818 @smallexample
29819 (gdb)
29820 -exec-step-instruction
29821 ^running
29822
29823 (gdb)
29824 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
29825 frame=@{func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
29826 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
29827 (gdb)
29828 -exec-step-instruction
29829 ^running
29830
29831 (gdb)
29832 *stopped,reason="end-stepping-range",
29833 frame=@{addr="0x000100f4",func="foo",args=[],file="try.c",
29834 fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",line="10"@}
29835 (gdb)
29836 @end smallexample
29837
29838
29839 @subheading The @code{-exec-until} Command
29840 @findex -exec-until
29841
29842 @subsubheading Synopsis
29843
29844 @smallexample
29845 -exec-until [ @var{location} ]
29846 @end smallexample
29847
29848 Executes the inferior until the @var{location} specified in the
29849 argument is reached. If there is no argument, the inferior executes
29850 until a source line greater than the current one is reached. The
29851 reason for stopping in this case will be @samp{location-reached}.
29852
29853 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29854
29855 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{until}.
29856
29857 @subsubheading Example
29858
29859 @smallexample
29860 (gdb)
29861 -exec-until recursive2.c:6
29862 ^running
29863 (gdb)
29864 x = 55
29865 *stopped,reason="location-reached",frame=@{func="main",args=[],
29866 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="6"@}
29867 (gdb)
29868 @end smallexample
29869
29870 @ignore
29871 @subheading -file-clear
29872 Is this going away????
29873 @end ignore
29874
29875 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
29876 @node GDB/MI Stack Manipulation
29877 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Stack Manipulation Commands
29878
29879 @subheading The @code{-enable-frame-filters} Command
29880 @findex -enable-frame-filters
29881
29882 @smallexample
29883 -enable-frame-filters
29884 @end smallexample
29885
29886 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based frame filters to affect the output of
29887 the MI commands relating to stack traces. As there is no way to
29888 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
29889 request that this functionality be enabled.
29890
29891 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
29892
29893 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
29894 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
29895
29896 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-frame} Command
29897 @findex -stack-info-frame
29898
29899 @subsubheading Synopsis
29900
29901 @smallexample
29902 -stack-info-frame
29903 @end smallexample
29904
29905 Get info on the selected frame.
29906
29907 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29908
29909 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info frame} or @samp{frame}
29910 (without arguments).
29911
29912 @subsubheading Example
29913
29914 @smallexample
29915 (gdb)
29916 -stack-info-frame
29917 ^done,frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
29918 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
29919 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@}
29920 (gdb)
29921 @end smallexample
29922
29923 @subheading The @code{-stack-info-depth} Command
29924 @findex -stack-info-depth
29925
29926 @subsubheading Synopsis
29927
29928 @smallexample
29929 -stack-info-depth [ @var{max-depth} ]
29930 @end smallexample
29931
29932 Return the depth of the stack. If the integer argument @var{max-depth}
29933 is specified, do not count beyond @var{max-depth} frames.
29934
29935 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29936
29937 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
29938
29939 @subsubheading Example
29940
29941 For a stack with frame levels 0 through 11:
29942
29943 @smallexample
29944 (gdb)
29945 -stack-info-depth
29946 ^done,depth="12"
29947 (gdb)
29948 -stack-info-depth 4
29949 ^done,depth="4"
29950 (gdb)
29951 -stack-info-depth 12
29952 ^done,depth="12"
29953 (gdb)
29954 -stack-info-depth 11
29955 ^done,depth="11"
29956 (gdb)
29957 -stack-info-depth 13
29958 ^done,depth="12"
29959 (gdb)
29960 @end smallexample
29961
29962 @anchor{-stack-list-arguments}
29963 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-arguments} Command
29964 @findex -stack-list-arguments
29965
29966 @subsubheading Synopsis
29967
29968 @smallexample
29969 -stack-list-arguments [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
29970 [ @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
29971 @end smallexample
29972
29973 Display a list of the arguments for the frames between @var{low-frame}
29974 and @var{high-frame} (inclusive). If @var{low-frame} and
29975 @var{high-frame} are not provided, list the arguments for the whole
29976 call stack. If the two arguments are equal, show the single frame
29977 at the corresponding level. It is an error if @var{low-frame} is
29978 larger than the actual number of frames. On the other hand,
29979 @var{high-frame} may be larger than the actual number of frames, in
29980 which case only existing frames will be returned.
29981
29982 If @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
29983 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
29984 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
29985 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
29986 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
29987 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
29988
29989 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, arguments that
29990 are not available are not listed. Partially available arguments
29991 are still displayed, however.
29992
29993 Use of this command to obtain arguments in a single frame is
29994 deprecated in favor of the @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
29995
29996 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
29997
29998 @value{GDBN} does not have an equivalent command. @code{gdbtk} has a
29999 @samp{gdb_get_args} command which partially overlaps with the
30000 functionality of @samp{-stack-list-arguments}.
30001
30002 @subsubheading Example
30003
30004 @smallexample
30005 (gdb)
30006 -stack-list-frames
30007 ^done,
30008 stack=[
30009 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x00010734",func="callee4",
30010 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30011 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="8"@},
30012 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x0001076c",func="callee3",
30013 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30014 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="17"@},
30015 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x0001078c",func="callee2",
30016 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30017 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="22"@},
30018 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107b4",func="callee1",
30019 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30020 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="27"@},
30021 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107e0",func="main",
30022 file="../../../devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
30023 fullname="/home/foo/bar/devo/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",line="32"@}]
30024 (gdb)
30025 -stack-list-arguments 0
30026 ^done,
30027 stack-args=[
30028 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
30029 frame=@{level="1",args=[name="strarg"]@},
30030 frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@},
30031 frame=@{level="3",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg",name="fltarg"]@},
30032 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
30033 (gdb)
30034 -stack-list-arguments 1
30035 ^done,
30036 stack-args=[
30037 frame=@{level="0",args=[]@},
30038 frame=@{level="1",
30039 args=[@{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
30040 frame=@{level="2",args=[
30041 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
30042 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@},
30043 @{frame=@{level="3",args=[
30044 @{name="intarg",value="2"@},
30045 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@},
30046 @{name="fltarg",value="3.5"@}]@},
30047 frame=@{level="4",args=[]@}]
30048 (gdb)
30049 -stack-list-arguments 0 2 2
30050 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",args=[name="intarg",name="strarg"]@}]
30051 (gdb)
30052 -stack-list-arguments 1 2 2
30053 ^done,stack-args=[frame=@{level="2",
30054 args=[@{name="intarg",value="2"@},
30055 @{name="strarg",value="0x11940 \"A string argument.\""@}]@}]
30056 (gdb)
30057 @end smallexample
30058
30059 @c @subheading -stack-list-exception-handlers
30060
30061
30062 @anchor{-stack-list-frames}
30063 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-frames} Command
30064 @findex -stack-list-frames
30065
30066 @subsubheading Synopsis
30067
30068 @smallexample
30069 -stack-list-frames [ --no-frame-filters @var{low-frame} @var{high-frame} ]
30070 @end smallexample
30071
30072 List the frames currently on the stack. For each frame it displays the
30073 following info:
30074
30075 @table @samp
30076 @item @var{level}
30077 The frame number, 0 being the topmost frame, i.e., the innermost function.
30078 @item @var{addr}
30079 The @code{$pc} value for that frame.
30080 @item @var{func}
30081 Function name.
30082 @item @var{file}
30083 File name of the source file where the function lives.
30084 @item @var{fullname}
30085 The full file name of the source file where the function lives.
30086 @item @var{line}
30087 Line number corresponding to the @code{$pc}.
30088 @item @var{from}
30089 The shared library where this function is defined. This is only given
30090 if the frame's function is not known.
30091 @end table
30092
30093 If invoked without arguments, this command prints a backtrace for the
30094 whole stack. If given two integer arguments, it shows the frames whose
30095 levels are between the two arguments (inclusive). If the two arguments
30096 are equal, it shows the single frame at the corresponding level. It is
30097 an error if @var{low-frame} is larger than the actual number of
30098 frames. On the other hand, @var{high-frame} may be larger than the
30099 actual number of frames, in which case only existing frames will be
30100 returned. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
30101 Python frame filters will not be executed.
30102
30103 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30104
30105 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{backtrace} and @samp{where}.
30106
30107 @subsubheading Example
30108
30109 Full stack backtrace:
30110
30111 @smallexample
30112 (gdb)
30113 -stack-list-frames
30114 ^done,stack=
30115 [frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0001076c",func="foo",
30116 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="11"@},
30117 frame=@{level="1",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30118 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
30119 frame=@{level="2",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30120 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
30121 frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30122 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
30123 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30124 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
30125 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30126 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
30127 frame=@{level="6",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30128 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
30129 frame=@{level="7",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30130 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
30131 frame=@{level="8",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30132 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
30133 frame=@{level="9",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30134 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
30135 frame=@{level="10",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30136 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
30137 frame=@{level="11",addr="0x00010738",func="main",
30138 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="4"@}]
30139 (gdb)
30140 @end smallexample
30141
30142 Show frames between @var{low_frame} and @var{high_frame}:
30143
30144 @smallexample
30145 (gdb)
30146 -stack-list-frames 3 5
30147 ^done,stack=
30148 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30149 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
30150 frame=@{level="4",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30151 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@},
30152 frame=@{level="5",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30153 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
30154 (gdb)
30155 @end smallexample
30156
30157 Show a single frame:
30158
30159 @smallexample
30160 (gdb)
30161 -stack-list-frames 3 3
30162 ^done,stack=
30163 [frame=@{level="3",addr="0x000107a4",func="foo",
30164 file="recursive2.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/recursive2.c",line="14"@}]
30165 (gdb)
30166 @end smallexample
30167
30168
30169 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-locals} Command
30170 @findex -stack-list-locals
30171 @anchor{-stack-list-locals}
30172
30173 @subsubheading Synopsis
30174
30175 @smallexample
30176 -stack-list-locals [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
30177 @end smallexample
30178
30179 Display the local variable names for the selected frame. If
30180 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
30181 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
30182 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
30183 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
30184 structures and unions. In this last case, a frontend can immediately
30185 display the value of simple data types and create variable objects for
30186 other data types when the user wishes to explore their values in
30187 more detail. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is supplied, then
30188 Python frame filters will not be executed.
30189
30190 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
30191 that are not available are not listed. Partially available local
30192 variables are still displayed, however.
30193
30194 This command is deprecated in favor of the
30195 @samp{-stack-list-variables} command.
30196
30197 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30198
30199 @samp{info locals} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_get_locals} in @code{gdbtk}.
30200
30201 @subsubheading Example
30202
30203 @smallexample
30204 (gdb)
30205 -stack-list-locals 0
30206 ^done,locals=[name="A",name="B",name="C"]
30207 (gdb)
30208 -stack-list-locals --all-values
30209 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",value="1"@},@{name="B",value="2"@},
30210 @{name="C",value="@{1, 2, 3@}"@}]
30211 -stack-list-locals --simple-values
30212 ^done,locals=[@{name="A",type="int",value="1"@},
30213 @{name="B",type="int",value="2"@},@{name="C",type="int [3]"@}]
30214 (gdb)
30215 @end smallexample
30216
30217 @anchor{-stack-list-variables}
30218 @subheading The @code{-stack-list-variables} Command
30219 @findex -stack-list-variables
30220
30221 @subsubheading Synopsis
30222
30223 @smallexample
30224 -stack-list-variables [ --no-frame-filters ] [ --skip-unavailable ] @var{print-values}
30225 @end smallexample
30226
30227 Display the names of local variables and function arguments for the selected frame. If
30228 @var{print-values} is 0 or @code{--no-values}, print only the names of
30229 the variables; if it is 1 or @code{--all-values}, print also their
30230 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values}, print the name,
30231 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for arrays,
30232 structures and unions. If the option @code{--no-frame-filters} is
30233 supplied, then Python frame filters will not be executed.
30234
30235 If the @code{--skip-unavailable} option is specified, local variables
30236 and arguments that are not available are not listed. Partially
30237 available arguments and local variables are still displayed, however.
30238
30239 @subsubheading Example
30240
30241 @smallexample
30242 (gdb)
30243 -stack-list-variables --thread 1 --frame 0 --all-values
30244 ^done,variables=[@{name="x",value="11"@},@{name="s",value="@{a = 1, b = 2@}"@}]
30245 (gdb)
30246 @end smallexample
30247
30248
30249 @subheading The @code{-stack-select-frame} Command
30250 @findex -stack-select-frame
30251
30252 @subsubheading Synopsis
30253
30254 @smallexample
30255 -stack-select-frame @var{framenum}
30256 @end smallexample
30257
30258 Change the selected frame. Select a different frame @var{framenum} on
30259 the stack.
30260
30261 This command in deprecated in favor of passing the @samp{--frame}
30262 option to every command.
30263
30264 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
30265
30266 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{frame}, @samp{up},
30267 @samp{down}, @samp{select-frame}, @samp{up-silent}, and @samp{down-silent}.
30268
30269 @subsubheading Example
30270
30271 @smallexample
30272 (gdb)
30273 -stack-select-frame 2
30274 ^done
30275 (gdb)
30276 @end smallexample
30277
30278 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
30279 @node GDB/MI Variable Objects
30280 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Variable Objects
30281
30282 @ignore
30283
30284 @subheading Motivation for Variable Objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
30285
30286 For the implementation of a variable debugger window (locals, watched
30287 expressions, etc.), we are proposing the adaptation of the existing code
30288 used by @code{Insight}.
30289
30290 The two main reasons for that are:
30291
30292 @enumerate 1
30293 @item
30294 It has been proven in practice (it is already on its second generation).
30295
30296 @item
30297 It will shorten development time (needless to say how important it is
30298 now).
30299 @end enumerate
30300
30301 The original interface was designed to be used by Tcl code, so it was
30302 slightly changed so it could be used through @sc{gdb/mi}. This section
30303 describes the @sc{gdb/mi} operations that will be available and gives some
30304 hints about their use.
30305
30306 @emph{Note}: In addition to the set of operations described here, we
30307 expect the @sc{gui} implementation of a variable window to require, at
30308 least, the following operations:
30309
30310 @itemize @bullet
30311 @item @code{-gdb-show} @code{output-radix}
30312 @item @code{-stack-list-arguments}
30313 @item @code{-stack-list-locals}
30314 @item @code{-stack-select-frame}
30315 @end itemize
30316
30317 @end ignore
30318
30319 @subheading Introduction to Variable Objects
30320
30321 @cindex variable objects in @sc{gdb/mi}
30322
30323 Variable objects are "object-oriented" MI interface for examining and
30324 changing values of expressions. Unlike some other MI interfaces that
30325 work with expressions, variable objects are specifically designed for
30326 simple and efficient presentation in the frontend. A variable object
30327 is identified by string name. When a variable object is created, the
30328 frontend specifies the expression for that variable object. The
30329 expression can be a simple variable, or it can be an arbitrary complex
30330 expression, and can even involve CPU registers. After creating a
30331 variable object, the frontend can invoke other variable object
30332 operations---for example to obtain or change the value of a variable
30333 object, or to change display format.
30334
30335 Variable objects have hierarchical tree structure. Any variable object
30336 that corresponds to a composite type, such as structure in C, has
30337 a number of child variable objects, for example corresponding to each
30338 element of a structure. A child variable object can itself have
30339 children, recursively. Recursion ends when we reach
30340 leaf variable objects, which always have built-in types. Child variable
30341 objects are created only by explicit request, so if a frontend
30342 is not interested in the children of a particular variable object, no
30343 child will be created.
30344
30345 For a leaf variable object it is possible to obtain its value as a
30346 string, or set the value from a string. String value can be also
30347 obtained for a non-leaf variable object, but it's generally a string
30348 that only indicates the type of the object, and does not list its
30349 contents. Assignment to a non-leaf variable object is not allowed.
30350
30351 A frontend does not need to read the values of all variable objects each time
30352 the program stops. Instead, MI provides an update command that lists all
30353 variable objects whose values has changed since the last update
30354 operation. This considerably reduces the amount of data that must
30355 be transferred to the frontend. As noted above, children variable
30356 objects are created on demand, and only leaf variable objects have a
30357 real value. As result, gdb will read target memory only for leaf
30358 variables that frontend has created.
30359
30360 The automatic update is not always desirable. For example, a frontend
30361 might want to keep a value of some expression for future reference,
30362 and never update it. For another example, fetching memory is
30363 relatively slow for embedded targets, so a frontend might want
30364 to disable automatic update for the variables that are either not
30365 visible on the screen, or ``closed''. This is possible using so
30366 called ``frozen variable objects''. Such variable objects are never
30367 implicitly updated.
30368
30369 Variable objects can be either @dfn{fixed} or @dfn{floating}. For the
30370 fixed variable object, the expression is parsed when the variable
30371 object is created, including associating identifiers to specific
30372 variables. The meaning of expression never changes. For a floating
30373 variable object the values of variables whose names appear in the
30374 expressions are re-evaluated every time in the context of the current
30375 frame. Consider this example:
30376
30377 @smallexample
30378 void do_work(...)
30379 @{
30380 struct work_state state;
30381
30382 if (...)
30383 do_work(...);
30384 @}
30385 @end smallexample
30386
30387 If a fixed variable object for the @code{state} variable is created in
30388 this function, and we enter the recursive call, the variable
30389 object will report the value of @code{state} in the top-level
30390 @code{do_work} invocation. On the other hand, a floating variable
30391 object will report the value of @code{state} in the current frame.
30392
30393 If an expression specified when creating a fixed variable object
30394 refers to a local variable, the variable object becomes bound to the
30395 thread and frame in which the variable object is created. When such
30396 variable object is updated, @value{GDBN} makes sure that the
30397 thread/frame combination the variable object is bound to still exists,
30398 and re-evaluates the variable object in context of that thread/frame.
30399
30400 The following is the complete set of @sc{gdb/mi} operations defined to
30401 access this functionality:
30402
30403 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
30404 @item @strong{Operation}
30405 @tab @strong{Description}
30406
30407 @item @code{-enable-pretty-printing}
30408 @tab enable Python-based pretty-printing
30409 @item @code{-var-create}
30410 @tab create a variable object
30411 @item @code{-var-delete}
30412 @tab delete the variable object and/or its children
30413 @item @code{-var-set-format}
30414 @tab set the display format of this variable
30415 @item @code{-var-show-format}
30416 @tab show the display format of this variable
30417 @item @code{-var-info-num-children}
30418 @tab tells how many children this object has
30419 @item @code{-var-list-children}
30420 @tab return a list of the object's children
30421 @item @code{-var-info-type}
30422 @tab show the type of this variable object
30423 @item @code{-var-info-expression}
30424 @tab print parent-relative expression that this variable object represents
30425 @item @code{-var-info-path-expression}
30426 @tab print full expression that this variable object represents
30427 @item @code{-var-show-attributes}
30428 @tab is this variable editable? does it exist here?
30429 @item @code{-var-evaluate-expression}
30430 @tab get the value of this variable
30431 @item @code{-var-assign}
30432 @tab set the value of this variable
30433 @item @code{-var-update}
30434 @tab update the variable and its children
30435 @item @code{-var-set-frozen}
30436 @tab set frozeness attribute
30437 @item @code{-var-set-update-range}
30438 @tab set range of children to display on update
30439 @end multitable
30440
30441 In the next subsection we describe each operation in detail and suggest
30442 how it can be used.
30443
30444 @subheading Description And Use of Operations on Variable Objects
30445
30446 @subheading The @code{-enable-pretty-printing} Command
30447 @findex -enable-pretty-printing
30448
30449 @smallexample
30450 -enable-pretty-printing
30451 @end smallexample
30452
30453 @value{GDBN} allows Python-based visualizers to affect the output of the
30454 MI variable object commands. However, because there was no way to
30455 implement this in a fully backward-compatible way, a front end must
30456 request that this functionality be enabled.
30457
30458 Once enabled, this feature cannot be disabled.
30459
30460 Note that if Python support has not been compiled into @value{GDBN},
30461 this command will still succeed (and do nothing).
30462
30463 This feature is currently (as of @value{GDBN} 7.0) experimental, and
30464 may work differently in future versions of @value{GDBN}.
30465
30466 @subheading The @code{-var-create} Command
30467 @findex -var-create
30468
30469 @subsubheading Synopsis
30470
30471 @smallexample
30472 -var-create @{@var{name} | "-"@}
30473 @{@var{frame-addr} | "*" | "@@"@} @var{expression}
30474 @end smallexample
30475
30476 This operation creates a variable object, which allows the monitoring of
30477 a variable, the result of an expression, a memory cell or a CPU
30478 register.
30479
30480 The @var{name} parameter is the string by which the object can be
30481 referenced. It must be unique. If @samp{-} is specified, the varobj
30482 system will generate a string ``varNNNNNN'' automatically. It will be
30483 unique provided that one does not specify @var{name} of that format.
30484 The command fails if a duplicate name is found.
30485
30486 The frame under which the expression should be evaluated can be
30487 specified by @var{frame-addr}. A @samp{*} indicates that the current
30488 frame should be used. A @samp{@@} indicates that a floating variable
30489 object must be created.
30490
30491 @var{expression} is any expression valid on the current language set (must not
30492 begin with a @samp{*}), or one of the following:
30493
30494 @itemize @bullet
30495 @item
30496 @samp{*@var{addr}}, where @var{addr} is the address of a memory cell
30497
30498 @item
30499 @samp{*@var{addr}-@var{addr}} --- a memory address range (TBD)
30500
30501 @item
30502 @samp{$@var{regname}} --- a CPU register name
30503 @end itemize
30504
30505 @cindex dynamic varobj
30506 A varobj's contents may be provided by a Python-based pretty-printer. In this
30507 case the varobj is known as a @dfn{dynamic varobj}. Dynamic varobjs
30508 have slightly different semantics in some cases. If the
30509 @code{-enable-pretty-printing} command is not sent, then @value{GDBN}
30510 will never create a dynamic varobj. This ensures backward
30511 compatibility for existing clients.
30512
30513 @subsubheading Result
30514
30515 This operation returns attributes of the newly-created varobj. These
30516 are:
30517
30518 @table @samp
30519 @item name
30520 The name of the varobj.
30521
30522 @item numchild
30523 The number of children of the varobj. This number is not necessarily
30524 reliable for a dynamic varobj. Instead, you must examine the
30525 @samp{has_more} attribute.
30526
30527 @item value
30528 The varobj's scalar value. For a varobj whose type is some sort of
30529 aggregate (e.g., a @code{struct}), or for a dynamic varobj, this value
30530 will not be interesting.
30531
30532 @item type
30533 The varobj's type. This is a string representation of the type, as
30534 would be printed by the @value{GDBN} CLI. If @samp{print object}
30535 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
30536 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
30537 @emph{declared} one.
30538
30539 @item thread-id
30540 If a variable object is bound to a specific thread, then this is the
30541 thread's global identifier.
30542
30543 @item has_more
30544 For a dynamic varobj, this indicates whether there appear to be any
30545 children available. For a non-dynamic varobj, this will be 0.
30546
30547 @item dynamic
30548 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
30549 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
30550 then this attribute will not be present.
30551
30552 @item displayhint
30553 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
30554 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
30555 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
30556 @end table
30557
30558 Typical output will look like this:
30559
30560 @smallexample
30561 name="@var{name}",numchild="@var{N}",type="@var{type}",thread-id="@var{M}",
30562 has_more="@var{has_more}"
30563 @end smallexample
30564
30565
30566 @subheading The @code{-var-delete} Command
30567 @findex -var-delete
30568
30569 @subsubheading Synopsis
30570
30571 @smallexample
30572 -var-delete [ -c ] @var{name}
30573 @end smallexample
30574
30575 Deletes a previously created variable object and all of its children.
30576 With the @samp{-c} option, just deletes the children.
30577
30578 Returns an error if the object @var{name} is not found.
30579
30580
30581 @subheading The @code{-var-set-format} Command
30582 @findex -var-set-format
30583
30584 @subsubheading Synopsis
30585
30586 @smallexample
30587 -var-set-format @var{name} @var{format-spec}
30588 @end smallexample
30589
30590 Sets the output format for the value of the object @var{name} to be
30591 @var{format-spec}.
30592
30593 @anchor{-var-set-format}
30594 The syntax for the @var{format-spec} is as follows:
30595
30596 @smallexample
30597 @var{format-spec} @expansion{}
30598 @{binary | decimal | hexadecimal | octal | natural | zero-hexadecimal@}
30599 @end smallexample
30600
30601 The natural format is the default format choosen automatically
30602 based on the variable type (like decimal for an @code{int}, hex
30603 for pointers, etc.).
30604
30605 The zero-hexadecimal format has a representation similar to hexadecimal
30606 but with padding zeroes to the left of the value. For example, a 32-bit
30607 hexadecimal value of 0x1234 would be represented as 0x00001234 in the
30608 zero-hexadecimal format.
30609
30610 For a variable with children, the format is set only on the
30611 variable itself, and the children are not affected.
30612
30613 @subheading The @code{-var-show-format} Command
30614 @findex -var-show-format
30615
30616 @subsubheading Synopsis
30617
30618 @smallexample
30619 -var-show-format @var{name}
30620 @end smallexample
30621
30622 Returns the format used to display the value of the object @var{name}.
30623
30624 @smallexample
30625 @var{format} @expansion{}
30626 @var{format-spec}
30627 @end smallexample
30628
30629
30630 @subheading The @code{-var-info-num-children} Command
30631 @findex -var-info-num-children
30632
30633 @subsubheading Synopsis
30634
30635 @smallexample
30636 -var-info-num-children @var{name}
30637 @end smallexample
30638
30639 Returns the number of children of a variable object @var{name}:
30640
30641 @smallexample
30642 numchild=@var{n}
30643 @end smallexample
30644
30645 Note that this number is not completely reliable for a dynamic varobj.
30646 It will return the current number of children, but more children may
30647 be available.
30648
30649
30650 @subheading The @code{-var-list-children} Command
30651 @findex -var-list-children
30652
30653 @subsubheading Synopsis
30654
30655 @smallexample
30656 -var-list-children [@var{print-values}] @var{name} [@var{from} @var{to}]
30657 @end smallexample
30658 @anchor{-var-list-children}
30659
30660 Return a list of the children of the specified variable object and
30661 create variable objects for them, if they do not already exist. With
30662 a single argument or if @var{print-values} has a value of 0 or
30663 @code{--no-values}, print only the names of the variables; if
30664 @var{print-values} is 1 or @code{--all-values}, also print their
30665 values; and if it is 2 or @code{--simple-values} print the name and
30666 value for simple data types and just the name for arrays, structures
30667 and unions.
30668
30669 @var{from} and @var{to}, if specified, indicate the range of children
30670 to report. If @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is
30671 reset and all children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting
30672 at @var{from} (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be
30673 reported.
30674
30675 If a child range is requested, it will only affect the current call to
30676 @code{-var-list-children}, but not future calls to @code{-var-update}.
30677 For this, you must instead use @code{-var-set-update-range}. The
30678 intent of this approach is to enable a front end to implement any
30679 update approach it likes; for example, scrolling a view may cause the
30680 front end to request more children with @code{-var-list-children}, and
30681 then the front end could call @code{-var-set-update-range} with a
30682 different range to ensure that future updates are restricted to just
30683 the visible items.
30684
30685 For each child the following results are returned:
30686
30687 @table @var
30688
30689 @item name
30690 Name of the variable object created for this child.
30691
30692 @item exp
30693 The expression to be shown to the user by the front end to designate this child.
30694 For example this may be the name of a structure member.
30695
30696 For a dynamic varobj, this value cannot be used to form an
30697 expression. There is no way to do this at all with a dynamic varobj.
30698
30699 For C/C@t{++} structures there are several pseudo children returned to
30700 designate access qualifiers. For these pseudo children @var{exp} is
30701 @samp{public}, @samp{private}, or @samp{protected}. In this case the
30702 type and value are not present.
30703
30704 A dynamic varobj will not report the access qualifying
30705 pseudo-children, regardless of the language. This information is not
30706 available at all with a dynamic varobj.
30707
30708 @item numchild
30709 Number of children this child has. For a dynamic varobj, this will be
30710 0.
30711
30712 @item type
30713 The type of the child. If @samp{print object}
30714 (@pxref{Print Settings, set print object}) is set to @code{on}, the
30715 @emph{actual} (derived) type of the object is shown rather than the
30716 @emph{declared} one.
30717
30718 @item value
30719 If values were requested, this is the value.
30720
30721 @item thread-id
30722 If this variable object is associated with a thread, this is the
30723 thread's global thread id. Otherwise this result is not present.
30724
30725 @item frozen
30726 If the variable object is frozen, this variable will be present with a value of 1.
30727
30728 @item displayhint
30729 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
30730 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
30731 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
30732
30733 @item dynamic
30734 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
30735 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
30736 then this attribute will not be present.
30737
30738 @end table
30739
30740 The result may have its own attributes:
30741
30742 @table @samp
30743 @item displayhint
30744 A dynamic varobj can supply a display hint to the front end. The
30745 value comes directly from the Python pretty-printer object's
30746 @code{display_hint} method. @xref{Pretty Printing API}.
30747
30748 @item has_more
30749 This is an integer attribute which is nonzero if there are children
30750 remaining after the end of the selected range.
30751 @end table
30752
30753 @subsubheading Example
30754
30755 @smallexample
30756 (gdb)
30757 -var-list-children n
30758 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
30759 numchild=@var{n},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
30760 (gdb)
30761 -var-list-children --all-values n
30762 ^done,numchild=@var{n},children=[child=@{name=@var{name},exp=@var{exp},
30763 numchild=@var{n},value=@var{value},type=@var{type}@},@r{(repeats N times)}]
30764 @end smallexample
30765
30766
30767 @subheading The @code{-var-info-type} Command
30768 @findex -var-info-type
30769
30770 @subsubheading Synopsis
30771
30772 @smallexample
30773 -var-info-type @var{name}
30774 @end smallexample
30775
30776 Returns the type of the specified variable @var{name}. The type is
30777 returned as a string in the same format as it is output by the
30778 @value{GDBN} CLI:
30779
30780 @smallexample
30781 type=@var{typename}
30782 @end smallexample
30783
30784
30785 @subheading The @code{-var-info-expression} Command
30786 @findex -var-info-expression
30787
30788 @subsubheading Synopsis
30789
30790 @smallexample
30791 -var-info-expression @var{name}
30792 @end smallexample
30793
30794 Returns a string that is suitable for presenting this
30795 variable object in user interface. The string is generally
30796 not valid expression in the current language, and cannot be evaluated.
30797
30798 For example, if @code{a} is an array, and variable object
30799 @code{A} was created for @code{a}, then we'll get this output:
30800
30801 @smallexample
30802 (gdb) -var-info-expression A.1
30803 ^done,lang="C",exp="1"
30804 @end smallexample
30805
30806 @noindent
30807 Here, the value of @code{lang} is the language name, which can be
30808 found in @ref{Supported Languages}.
30809
30810 Note that the output of the @code{-var-list-children} command also
30811 includes those expressions, so the @code{-var-info-expression} command
30812 is of limited use.
30813
30814 @subheading The @code{-var-info-path-expression} Command
30815 @findex -var-info-path-expression
30816
30817 @subsubheading Synopsis
30818
30819 @smallexample
30820 -var-info-path-expression @var{name}
30821 @end smallexample
30822
30823 Returns an expression that can be evaluated in the current
30824 context and will yield the same value that a variable object has.
30825 Compare this with the @code{-var-info-expression} command, which
30826 result can be used only for UI presentation. Typical use of
30827 the @code{-var-info-path-expression} command is creating a
30828 watchpoint from a variable object.
30829
30830 This command is currently not valid for children of a dynamic varobj,
30831 and will give an error when invoked on one.
30832
30833 For example, suppose @code{C} is a C@t{++} class, derived from class
30834 @code{Base}, and that the @code{Base} class has a member called
30835 @code{m_size}. Assume a variable @code{c} is has the type of
30836 @code{C} and a variable object @code{C} was created for variable
30837 @code{c}. Then, we'll get this output:
30838 @smallexample
30839 (gdb) -var-info-path-expression C.Base.public.m_size
30840 ^done,path_expr=((Base)c).m_size)
30841 @end smallexample
30842
30843 @subheading The @code{-var-show-attributes} Command
30844 @findex -var-show-attributes
30845
30846 @subsubheading Synopsis
30847
30848 @smallexample
30849 -var-show-attributes @var{name}
30850 @end smallexample
30851
30852 List attributes of the specified variable object @var{name}:
30853
30854 @smallexample
30855 status=@var{attr} [ ( ,@var{attr} )* ]
30856 @end smallexample
30857
30858 @noindent
30859 where @var{attr} is @code{@{ @{ editable | noneditable @} | TBD @}}.
30860
30861 @subheading The @code{-var-evaluate-expression} Command
30862 @findex -var-evaluate-expression
30863
30864 @subsubheading Synopsis
30865
30866 @smallexample
30867 -var-evaluate-expression [-f @var{format-spec}] @var{name}
30868 @end smallexample
30869
30870 Evaluates the expression that is represented by the specified variable
30871 object and returns its value as a string. The format of the string
30872 can be specified with the @samp{-f} option. The possible values of
30873 this option are the same as for @code{-var-set-format}
30874 (@pxref{-var-set-format}). If the @samp{-f} option is not specified,
30875 the current display format will be used. The current display format
30876 can be changed using the @code{-var-set-format} command.
30877
30878 @smallexample
30879 value=@var{value}
30880 @end smallexample
30881
30882 Note that one must invoke @code{-var-list-children} for a variable
30883 before the value of a child variable can be evaluated.
30884
30885 @subheading The @code{-var-assign} Command
30886 @findex -var-assign
30887
30888 @subsubheading Synopsis
30889
30890 @smallexample
30891 -var-assign @var{name} @var{expression}
30892 @end smallexample
30893
30894 Assigns the value of @var{expression} to the variable object specified
30895 by @var{name}. The object must be @samp{editable}. If the variable's
30896 value is altered by the assign, the variable will show up in any
30897 subsequent @code{-var-update} list.
30898
30899 @subsubheading Example
30900
30901 @smallexample
30902 (gdb)
30903 -var-assign var1 3
30904 ^done,value="3"
30905 (gdb)
30906 -var-update *
30907 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",in_scope="true",type_changed="false"@}]
30908 (gdb)
30909 @end smallexample
30910
30911 @subheading The @code{-var-update} Command
30912 @findex -var-update
30913
30914 @subsubheading Synopsis
30915
30916 @smallexample
30917 -var-update [@var{print-values}] @{@var{name} | "*"@}
30918 @end smallexample
30919
30920 Reevaluate the expressions corresponding to the variable object
30921 @var{name} and all its direct and indirect children, and return the
30922 list of variable objects whose values have changed; @var{name} must
30923 be a root variable object. Here, ``changed'' means that the result of
30924 @code{-var-evaluate-expression} before and after the
30925 @code{-var-update} is different. If @samp{*} is used as the variable
30926 object names, all existing variable objects are updated, except
30927 for frozen ones (@pxref{-var-set-frozen}). The option
30928 @var{print-values} determines whether both names and values, or just
30929 names are printed. The possible values of this option are the same
30930 as for @code{-var-list-children} (@pxref{-var-list-children}). It is
30931 recommended to use the @samp{--all-values} option, to reduce the
30932 number of MI commands needed on each program stop.
30933
30934 With the @samp{*} parameter, if a variable object is bound to a
30935 currently running thread, it will not be updated, without any
30936 diagnostic.
30937
30938 If @code{-var-set-update-range} was previously used on a varobj, then
30939 only the selected range of children will be reported.
30940
30941 @code{-var-update} reports all the changed varobjs in a tuple named
30942 @samp{changelist}.
30943
30944 Each item in the change list is itself a tuple holding:
30945
30946 @table @samp
30947 @item name
30948 The name of the varobj.
30949
30950 @item value
30951 If values were requested for this update, then this field will be
30952 present and will hold the value of the varobj.
30953
30954 @item in_scope
30955 @anchor{-var-update}
30956 This field is a string which may take one of three values:
30957
30958 @table @code
30959 @item "true"
30960 The variable object's current value is valid.
30961
30962 @item "false"
30963 The variable object does not currently hold a valid value but it may
30964 hold one in the future if its associated expression comes back into
30965 scope.
30966
30967 @item "invalid"
30968 The variable object no longer holds a valid value.
30969 This can occur when the executable file being debugged has changed,
30970 either through recompilation or by using the @value{GDBN} @code{file}
30971 command. The front end should normally choose to delete these variable
30972 objects.
30973 @end table
30974
30975 In the future new values may be added to this list so the front should
30976 be prepared for this possibility. @xref{GDB/MI Development and Front Ends, ,@sc{GDB/MI} Development and Front Ends}.
30977
30978 @item type_changed
30979 This is only present if the varobj is still valid. If the type
30980 changed, then this will be the string @samp{true}; otherwise it will
30981 be @samp{false}.
30982
30983 When a varobj's type changes, its children are also likely to have
30984 become incorrect. Therefore, the varobj's children are automatically
30985 deleted when this attribute is @samp{true}. Also, the varobj's update
30986 range, when set using the @code{-var-set-update-range} command, is
30987 unset.
30988
30989 @item new_type
30990 If the varobj's type changed, then this field will be present and will
30991 hold the new type.
30992
30993 @item new_num_children
30994 For a dynamic varobj, if the number of children changed, or if the
30995 type changed, this will be the new number of children.
30996
30997 The @samp{numchild} field in other varobj responses is generally not
30998 valid for a dynamic varobj -- it will show the number of children that
30999 @value{GDBN} knows about, but because dynamic varobjs lazily
31000 instantiate their children, this will not reflect the number of
31001 children which may be available.
31002
31003 The @samp{new_num_children} attribute only reports changes to the
31004 number of children known by @value{GDBN}. This is the only way to
31005 detect whether an update has removed children (which necessarily can
31006 only happen at the end of the update range).
31007
31008 @item displayhint
31009 The display hint, if any.
31010
31011 @item has_more
31012 This is an integer value, which will be 1 if there are more children
31013 available outside the varobj's update range.
31014
31015 @item dynamic
31016 This attribute will be present and have the value @samp{1} if the
31017 varobj is a dynamic varobj. If the varobj is not a dynamic varobj,
31018 then this attribute will not be present.
31019
31020 @item new_children
31021 If new children were added to a dynamic varobj within the selected
31022 update range (as set by @code{-var-set-update-range}), then they will
31023 be listed in this attribute.
31024 @end table
31025
31026 @subsubheading Example
31027
31028 @smallexample
31029 (gdb)
31030 -var-assign var1 3
31031 ^done,value="3"
31032 (gdb)
31033 -var-update --all-values var1
31034 ^done,changelist=[@{name="var1",value="3",in_scope="true",
31035 type_changed="false"@}]
31036 (gdb)
31037 @end smallexample
31038
31039 @subheading The @code{-var-set-frozen} Command
31040 @findex -var-set-frozen
31041 @anchor{-var-set-frozen}
31042
31043 @subsubheading Synopsis
31044
31045 @smallexample
31046 -var-set-frozen @var{name} @var{flag}
31047 @end smallexample
31048
31049 Set the frozenness flag on the variable object @var{name}. The
31050 @var{flag} parameter should be either @samp{1} to make the variable
31051 frozen or @samp{0} to make it unfrozen. If a variable object is
31052 frozen, then neither itself, nor any of its children, are
31053 implicitly updated by @code{-var-update} of
31054 a parent variable or by @code{-var-update *}. Only
31055 @code{-var-update} of the variable itself will update its value and
31056 values of its children. After a variable object is unfrozen, it is
31057 implicitly updated by all subsequent @code{-var-update} operations.
31058 Unfreezing a variable does not update it, only subsequent
31059 @code{-var-update} does.
31060
31061 @subsubheading Example
31062
31063 @smallexample
31064 (gdb)
31065 -var-set-frozen V 1
31066 ^done
31067 (gdb)
31068 @end smallexample
31069
31070 @subheading The @code{-var-set-update-range} command
31071 @findex -var-set-update-range
31072 @anchor{-var-set-update-range}
31073
31074 @subsubheading Synopsis
31075
31076 @smallexample
31077 -var-set-update-range @var{name} @var{from} @var{to}
31078 @end smallexample
31079
31080 Set the range of children to be returned by future invocations of
31081 @code{-var-update}.
31082
31083 @var{from} and @var{to} indicate the range of children to report. If
31084 @var{from} or @var{to} is less than zero, the range is reset and all
31085 children will be reported. Otherwise, children starting at @var{from}
31086 (zero-based) and up to and excluding @var{to} will be reported.
31087
31088 @subsubheading Example
31089
31090 @smallexample
31091 (gdb)
31092 -var-set-update-range V 1 2
31093 ^done
31094 @end smallexample
31095
31096 @subheading The @code{-var-set-visualizer} command
31097 @findex -var-set-visualizer
31098 @anchor{-var-set-visualizer}
31099
31100 @subsubheading Synopsis
31101
31102 @smallexample
31103 -var-set-visualizer @var{name} @var{visualizer}
31104 @end smallexample
31105
31106 Set a visualizer for the variable object @var{name}.
31107
31108 @var{visualizer} is the visualizer to use. The special value
31109 @samp{None} means to disable any visualizer in use.
31110
31111 If not @samp{None}, @var{visualizer} must be a Python expression.
31112 This expression must evaluate to a callable object which accepts a
31113 single argument. @value{GDBN} will call this object with the value of
31114 the varobj @var{name} as an argument (this is done so that the same
31115 Python pretty-printing code can be used for both the CLI and MI).
31116 When called, this object must return an object which conforms to the
31117 pretty-printing interface (@pxref{Pretty Printing API}).
31118
31119 The pre-defined function @code{gdb.default_visualizer} may be used to
31120 select a visualizer by following the built-in process
31121 (@pxref{Selecting Pretty-Printers}). This is done automatically when
31122 a varobj is created, and so ordinarily is not needed.
31123
31124 This feature is only available if Python support is enabled. The MI
31125 command @code{-list-features} (@pxref{GDB/MI Support Commands})
31126 can be used to check this.
31127
31128 @subsubheading Example
31129
31130 Resetting the visualizer:
31131
31132 @smallexample
31133 (gdb)
31134 -var-set-visualizer V None
31135 ^done
31136 @end smallexample
31137
31138 Reselecting the default (type-based) visualizer:
31139
31140 @smallexample
31141 (gdb)
31142 -var-set-visualizer V gdb.default_visualizer
31143 ^done
31144 @end smallexample
31145
31146 Suppose @code{SomeClass} is a visualizer class. A lambda expression
31147 can be used to instantiate this class for a varobj:
31148
31149 @smallexample
31150 (gdb)
31151 -var-set-visualizer V "lambda val: SomeClass()"
31152 ^done
31153 @end smallexample
31154
31155 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31156 @node GDB/MI Data Manipulation
31157 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Data Manipulation
31158
31159 @cindex data manipulation, in @sc{gdb/mi}
31160 @cindex @sc{gdb/mi}, data manipulation
31161 This section describes the @sc{gdb/mi} commands that manipulate data:
31162 examine memory and registers, evaluate expressions, etc.
31163
31164 For details about what an addressable memory unit is,
31165 @pxref{addressable memory unit}.
31166
31167 @c REMOVED FROM THE INTERFACE.
31168 @c @subheading -data-assign
31169 @c Change the value of a program variable. Plenty of side effects.
31170 @c @subsubheading GDB Command
31171 @c set variable
31172 @c @subsubheading Example
31173 @c N.A.
31174
31175 @subheading The @code{-data-disassemble} Command
31176 @findex -data-disassemble
31177
31178 @subsubheading Synopsis
31179
31180 @smallexample
31181 -data-disassemble
31182 [ -s @var{start-addr} -e @var{end-addr} ]
31183 | [ -f @var{filename} -l @var{linenum} [ -n @var{lines} ] ]
31184 -- @var{mode}
31185 @end smallexample
31186
31187 @noindent
31188 Where:
31189
31190 @table @samp
31191 @item @var{start-addr}
31192 is the beginning address (or @code{$pc})
31193 @item @var{end-addr}
31194 is the end address
31195 @item @var{filename}
31196 is the name of the file to disassemble
31197 @item @var{linenum}
31198 is the line number to disassemble around
31199 @item @var{lines}
31200 is the number of disassembly lines to be produced. If it is -1,
31201 the whole function will be disassembled, in case no @var{end-addr} is
31202 specified. If @var{end-addr} is specified as a non-zero value, and
31203 @var{lines} is lower than the number of disassembly lines between
31204 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only @var{lines} lines are
31205 displayed; if @var{lines} is higher than the number of lines between
31206 @var{start-addr} and @var{end-addr}, only the lines up to @var{end-addr}
31207 are displayed.
31208 @item @var{mode}
31209 is one of:
31210 @itemize @bullet
31211 @item 0 disassembly only
31212 @item 1 mixed source and disassembly (deprecated)
31213 @item 2 disassembly with raw opcodes
31214 @item 3 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes (deprecated)
31215 @item 4 mixed source and disassembly
31216 @item 5 mixed source and disassembly with raw opcodes
31217 @end itemize
31218
31219 Modes 1 and 3 are deprecated. The output is ``source centric''
31220 which hasn't proved useful in practice.
31221 @xref{Machine Code}, for a discussion of the difference between
31222 @code{/m} and @code{/s} output of the @code{disassemble} command.
31223 @end table
31224
31225 @subsubheading Result
31226
31227 The result of the @code{-data-disassemble} command will be a list named
31228 @samp{asm_insns}, the contents of this list depend on the @var{mode}
31229 used with the @code{-data-disassemble} command.
31230
31231 For modes 0 and 2 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples with the
31232 following fields:
31233
31234 @table @code
31235 @item address
31236 The address at which this instruction was disassembled.
31237
31238 @item func-name
31239 The name of the function this instruction is within.
31240
31241 @item offset
31242 The decimal offset in bytes from the start of @samp{func-name}.
31243
31244 @item inst
31245 The text disassembly for this @samp{address}.
31246
31247 @item opcodes
31248 This field is only present for modes 2, 3 and 5. This contains the raw opcode
31249 bytes for the @samp{inst} field.
31250
31251 @end table
31252
31253 For modes 1, 3, 4 and 5 the @samp{asm_insns} list contains tuples named
31254 @samp{src_and_asm_line}, each of which has the following fields:
31255
31256 @table @code
31257 @item line
31258 The line number within @samp{file}.
31259
31260 @item file
31261 The file name from the compilation unit. This might be an absolute
31262 file name or a relative file name depending on the compile command
31263 used.
31264
31265 @item fullname
31266 Absolute file name of @samp{file}. It is converted to a canonical form
31267 using the source file search path
31268 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying Source Directories})
31269 and after resolving all the symbolic links.
31270
31271 If the source file is not found this field will contain the path as
31272 present in the debug information.
31273
31274 @item line_asm_insn
31275 This is a list of tuples containing the disassembly for @samp{line} in
31276 @samp{file}. The fields of each tuple are the same as for
31277 @code{-data-disassemble} in @var{mode} 0 and 2, so @samp{address},
31278 @samp{func-name}, @samp{offset}, @samp{inst}, and optionally
31279 @samp{opcodes}.
31280
31281 @end table
31282
31283 Note that whatever included in the @samp{inst} field, is not
31284 manipulated directly by @sc{gdb/mi}, i.e., it is not possible to
31285 adjust its format.
31286
31287 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31288
31289 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disassemble}.
31290
31291 @subsubheading Example
31292
31293 Disassemble from the current value of @code{$pc} to @code{$pc + 20}:
31294
31295 @smallexample
31296 (gdb)
31297 -data-disassemble -s $pc -e "$pc + 20" -- 0
31298 ^done,
31299 asm_insns=[
31300 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
31301 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
31302 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
31303 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
31304 @{address="0x000107c8",func-name="main",offset="12",
31305 inst="or %o2, 0x140, %o1\t! 0x11940 <_lib_version+8>"@},
31306 @{address="0x000107cc",func-name="main",offset="16",
31307 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
31308 @{address="0x000107d0",func-name="main",offset="20",
31309 inst="or %o2, 0x168, %o4\t! 0x11968 <_lib_version+48>"@}]
31310 (gdb)
31311 @end smallexample
31312
31313 Disassemble the whole @code{main} function. Line 32 is part of
31314 @code{main}.
31315
31316 @smallexample
31317 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -- 0
31318 ^done,asm_insns=[
31319 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
31320 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
31321 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
31322 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
31323 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
31324 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@},
31325 [@dots{}]
31326 @{address="0x0001081c",func-name="main",offset="96",inst="ret "@},
31327 @{address="0x00010820",func-name="main",offset="100",inst="restore "@}]
31328 (gdb)
31329 @end smallexample
31330
31331 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main}:
31332
31333 @smallexample
31334 (gdb)
31335 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 0
31336 ^done,asm_insns=[
31337 @{address="0x000107bc",func-name="main",offset="0",
31338 inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@},
31339 @{address="0x000107c0",func-name="main",offset="4",
31340 inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
31341 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
31342 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]
31343 (gdb)
31344 @end smallexample
31345
31346 Disassemble 3 instructions from the start of @code{main} in mixed mode:
31347
31348 @smallexample
31349 (gdb)
31350 -data-disassemble -f basics.c -l 32 -n 3 -- 1
31351 ^done,asm_insns=[
31352 src_and_asm_line=@{line="31",
31353 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31354 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31355 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107bc",
31356 func-name="main",offset="0",inst="save %sp, -112, %sp"@}]@},
31357 src_and_asm_line=@{line="32",
31358 file="../../../src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31359 fullname="/absolute/path/to/src/gdb/testsuite/gdb.mi/basics.c",
31360 line_asm_insn=[@{address="0x000107c0",
31361 func-name="main",offset="4",inst="mov 2, %o0"@},
31362 @{address="0x000107c4",func-name="main",offset="8",
31363 inst="sethi %hi(0x11800), %o2"@}]@}]
31364 (gdb)
31365 @end smallexample
31366
31367
31368 @subheading The @code{-data-evaluate-expression} Command
31369 @findex -data-evaluate-expression
31370
31371 @subsubheading Synopsis
31372
31373 @smallexample
31374 -data-evaluate-expression @var{expr}
31375 @end smallexample
31376
31377 Evaluate @var{expr} as an expression. The expression could contain an
31378 inferior function call. The function call will execute synchronously.
31379 If the expression contains spaces, it must be enclosed in double quotes.
31380
31381 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31382
31383 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{print}, @samp{output}, and
31384 @samp{call}. In @code{gdbtk} only, there's a corresponding
31385 @samp{gdb_eval} command.
31386
31387 @subsubheading Example
31388
31389 In the following example, the numbers that precede the commands are the
31390 @dfn{tokens} described in @ref{GDB/MI Command Syntax, ,@sc{gdb/mi}
31391 Command Syntax}. Notice how @sc{gdb/mi} returns the same tokens in its
31392 output.
31393
31394 @smallexample
31395 211-data-evaluate-expression A
31396 211^done,value="1"
31397 (gdb)
31398 311-data-evaluate-expression &A
31399 311^done,value="0xefffeb7c"
31400 (gdb)
31401 411-data-evaluate-expression A+3
31402 411^done,value="4"
31403 (gdb)
31404 511-data-evaluate-expression "A + 3"
31405 511^done,value="4"
31406 (gdb)
31407 @end smallexample
31408
31409
31410 @subheading The @code{-data-list-changed-registers} Command
31411 @findex -data-list-changed-registers
31412
31413 @subsubheading Synopsis
31414
31415 @smallexample
31416 -data-list-changed-registers
31417 @end smallexample
31418
31419 Display a list of the registers that have changed.
31420
31421 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31422
31423 @value{GDBN} doesn't have a direct analog for this command; @code{gdbtk}
31424 has the corresponding command @samp{gdb_changed_register_list}.
31425
31426 @subsubheading Example
31427
31428 On a PPC MBX board:
31429
31430 @smallexample
31431 (gdb)
31432 -exec-continue
31433 ^running
31434
31435 (gdb)
31436 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",frame=@{
31437 func="main",args=[],file="try.c",fullname="/home/foo/bar/try.c",
31438 line="5"@}
31439 (gdb)
31440 -data-list-changed-registers
31441 ^done,changed-registers=["0","1","2","4","5","6","7","8","9",
31442 "10","11","13","14","15","16","17","18","19","20","21","22","23",
31443 "24","25","26","27","28","30","31","64","65","66","67","69"]
31444 (gdb)
31445 @end smallexample
31446
31447
31448 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-names} Command
31449 @findex -data-list-register-names
31450
31451 @subsubheading Synopsis
31452
31453 @smallexample
31454 -data-list-register-names [ ( @var{regno} )+ ]
31455 @end smallexample
31456
31457 Show a list of register names for the current target. If no arguments
31458 are given, it shows a list of the names of all the registers. If
31459 integer numbers are given as arguments, it will print a list of the
31460 names of the registers corresponding to the arguments. To ensure
31461 consistency between a register name and its number, the output list may
31462 include empty register names.
31463
31464 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31465
31466 @value{GDBN} does not have a command which corresponds to
31467 @samp{-data-list-register-names}. In @code{gdbtk} there is a
31468 corresponding command @samp{gdb_regnames}.
31469
31470 @subsubheading Example
31471
31472 For the PPC MBX board:
31473 @smallexample
31474 (gdb)
31475 -data-list-register-names
31476 ^done,register-names=["r0","r1","r2","r3","r4","r5","r6","r7",
31477 "r8","r9","r10","r11","r12","r13","r14","r15","r16","r17","r18",
31478 "r19","r20","r21","r22","r23","r24","r25","r26","r27","r28","r29",
31479 "r30","r31","f0","f1","f2","f3","f4","f5","f6","f7","f8","f9",
31480 "f10","f11","f12","f13","f14","f15","f16","f17","f18","f19","f20",
31481 "f21","f22","f23","f24","f25","f26","f27","f28","f29","f30","f31",
31482 "", "pc","ps","cr","lr","ctr","xer"]
31483 (gdb)
31484 -data-list-register-names 1 2 3
31485 ^done,register-names=["r1","r2","r3"]
31486 (gdb)
31487 @end smallexample
31488
31489 @subheading The @code{-data-list-register-values} Command
31490 @findex -data-list-register-values
31491
31492 @subsubheading Synopsis
31493
31494 @smallexample
31495 -data-list-register-values
31496 [ @code{--skip-unavailable} ] @var{fmt} [ ( @var{regno} )*]
31497 @end smallexample
31498
31499 Display the registers' contents. The format according to which the
31500 registers' contents are to be returned is given by @var{fmt}, followed
31501 by an optional list of numbers specifying the registers to display. A
31502 missing list of numbers indicates that the contents of all the
31503 registers must be returned. The @code{--skip-unavailable} option
31504 indicates that only the available registers are to be returned.
31505
31506 Allowed formats for @var{fmt} are:
31507
31508 @table @code
31509 @item x
31510 Hexadecimal
31511 @item o
31512 Octal
31513 @item t
31514 Binary
31515 @item d
31516 Decimal
31517 @item r
31518 Raw
31519 @item N
31520 Natural
31521 @end table
31522
31523 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31524
31525 The corresponding @value{GDBN} commands are @samp{info reg}, @samp{info
31526 all-reg}, and (in @code{gdbtk}) @samp{gdb_fetch_registers}.
31527
31528 @subsubheading Example
31529
31530 For a PPC MBX board (note: line breaks are for readability only, they
31531 don't appear in the actual output):
31532
31533 @smallexample
31534 (gdb)
31535 -data-list-register-values r 64 65
31536 ^done,register-values=[@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
31537 @{number="65",value="0x00029002"@}]
31538 (gdb)
31539 -data-list-register-values x
31540 ^done,register-values=[@{number="0",value="0xfe0043c8"@},
31541 @{number="1",value="0x3fff88"@},@{number="2",value="0xfffffffe"@},
31542 @{number="3",value="0x0"@},@{number="4",value="0xa"@},
31543 @{number="5",value="0x3fff68"@},@{number="6",value="0x3fff58"@},
31544 @{number="7",value="0xfe011e98"@},@{number="8",value="0x2"@},
31545 @{number="9",value="0xfa202820"@},@{number="10",value="0xfa202808"@},
31546 @{number="11",value="0x1"@},@{number="12",value="0x0"@},
31547 @{number="13",value="0x4544"@},@{number="14",value="0xffdfffff"@},
31548 @{number="15",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="16",value="0xfffffeff"@},
31549 @{number="17",value="0xefffffed"@},@{number="18",value="0xfffffffe"@},
31550 @{number="19",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="20",value="0xffffffff"@},
31551 @{number="21",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="22",value="0xfffffff7"@},
31552 @{number="23",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="24",value="0xffffffff"@},
31553 @{number="25",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="26",value="0xfffffffb"@},
31554 @{number="27",value="0xffffffff"@},@{number="28",value="0xf7bfffff"@},
31555 @{number="29",value="0x0"@},@{number="30",value="0xfe010000"@},
31556 @{number="31",value="0x0"@},@{number="32",value="0x0"@},
31557 @{number="33",value="0x0"@},@{number="34",value="0x0"@},
31558 @{number="35",value="0x0"@},@{number="36",value="0x0"@},
31559 @{number="37",value="0x0"@},@{number="38",value="0x0"@},
31560 @{number="39",value="0x0"@},@{number="40",value="0x0"@},
31561 @{number="41",value="0x0"@},@{number="42",value="0x0"@},
31562 @{number="43",value="0x0"@},@{number="44",value="0x0"@},
31563 @{number="45",value="0x0"@},@{number="46",value="0x0"@},
31564 @{number="47",value="0x0"@},@{number="48",value="0x0"@},
31565 @{number="49",value="0x0"@},@{number="50",value="0x0"@},
31566 @{number="51",value="0x0"@},@{number="52",value="0x0"@},
31567 @{number="53",value="0x0"@},@{number="54",value="0x0"@},
31568 @{number="55",value="0x0"@},@{number="56",value="0x0"@},
31569 @{number="57",value="0x0"@},@{number="58",value="0x0"@},
31570 @{number="59",value="0x0"@},@{number="60",value="0x0"@},
31571 @{number="61",value="0x0"@},@{number="62",value="0x0"@},
31572 @{number="63",value="0x0"@},@{number="64",value="0xfe00a300"@},
31573 @{number="65",value="0x29002"@},@{number="66",value="0x202f04b5"@},
31574 @{number="67",value="0xfe0043b0"@},@{number="68",value="0xfe00b3e4"@},
31575 @{number="69",value="0x20002b03"@}]
31576 (gdb)
31577 @end smallexample
31578
31579
31580 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory} Command
31581 @findex -data-read-memory
31582
31583 This command is deprecated, use @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} instead.
31584
31585 @subsubheading Synopsis
31586
31587 @smallexample
31588 -data-read-memory [ -o @var{byte-offset} ]
31589 @var{address} @var{word-format} @var{word-size}
31590 @var{nr-rows} @var{nr-cols} [ @var{aschar} ]
31591 @end smallexample
31592
31593 @noindent
31594 where:
31595
31596 @table @samp
31597 @item @var{address}
31598 An expression specifying the address of the first memory word to be
31599 read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
31600 quoted using the C convention.
31601
31602 @item @var{word-format}
31603 The format to be used to print the memory words. The notation is the
31604 same as for @value{GDBN}'s @code{print} command (@pxref{Output Formats,
31605 ,Output Formats}).
31606
31607 @item @var{word-size}
31608 The size of each memory word in bytes.
31609
31610 @item @var{nr-rows}
31611 The number of rows in the output table.
31612
31613 @item @var{nr-cols}
31614 The number of columns in the output table.
31615
31616 @item @var{aschar}
31617 If present, indicates that each row should include an @sc{ascii} dump. The
31618 value of @var{aschar} is used as a padding character when a byte is not a
31619 member of the printable @sc{ascii} character set (printable @sc{ascii}
31620 characters are those whose code is between 32 and 126, inclusively).
31621
31622 @item @var{byte-offset}
31623 An offset to add to the @var{address} before fetching memory.
31624 @end table
31625
31626 This command displays memory contents as a table of @var{nr-rows} by
31627 @var{nr-cols} words, each word being @var{word-size} bytes. In total,
31628 @code{@var{nr-rows} * @var{nr-cols} * @var{word-size}} bytes are read
31629 (returned as @samp{total-bytes}). Should less than the requested number
31630 of bytes be returned by the target, the missing words are identified
31631 using @samp{N/A}. The number of bytes read from the target is returned
31632 in @samp{nr-bytes} and the starting address used to read memory in
31633 @samp{addr}.
31634
31635 The address of the next/previous row or page is available in
31636 @samp{next-row} and @samp{prev-row}, @samp{next-page} and
31637 @samp{prev-page}.
31638
31639 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31640
31641 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}. @code{gdbtk} has
31642 @samp{gdb_get_mem} memory read command.
31643
31644 @subsubheading Example
31645
31646 Read six bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+6} but then offset by
31647 @code{-6} bytes. Format as three rows of two columns. One byte per
31648 word. Display each word in hex.
31649
31650 @smallexample
31651 (gdb)
31652 9-data-read-memory -o -6 -- bytes+6 x 1 3 2
31653 9^done,addr="0x00001390",nr-bytes="6",total-bytes="6",
31654 next-row="0x00001396",prev-row="0x0000138e",next-page="0x00001396",
31655 prev-page="0x0000138a",memory=[
31656 @{addr="0x00001390",data=["0x00","0x01"]@},
31657 @{addr="0x00001392",data=["0x02","0x03"]@},
31658 @{addr="0x00001394",data=["0x04","0x05"]@}]
31659 (gdb)
31660 @end smallexample
31661
31662 Read two bytes of memory starting at address @code{shorts + 64} and
31663 display as a single word formatted in decimal.
31664
31665 @smallexample
31666 (gdb)
31667 5-data-read-memory shorts+64 d 2 1 1
31668 5^done,addr="0x00001510",nr-bytes="2",total-bytes="2",
31669 next-row="0x00001512",prev-row="0x0000150e",
31670 next-page="0x00001512",prev-page="0x0000150e",memory=[
31671 @{addr="0x00001510",data=["128"]@}]
31672 (gdb)
31673 @end smallexample
31674
31675 Read thirty two bytes of memory starting at @code{bytes+16} and format
31676 as eight rows of four columns. Include a string encoding with @samp{x}
31677 used as the non-printable character.
31678
31679 @smallexample
31680 (gdb)
31681 4-data-read-memory bytes+16 x 1 8 4 x
31682 4^done,addr="0x000013a0",nr-bytes="32",total-bytes="32",
31683 next-row="0x000013c0",prev-row="0x0000139c",
31684 next-page="0x000013c0",prev-page="0x00001380",memory=[
31685 @{addr="0x000013a0",data=["0x10","0x11","0x12","0x13"],ascii="xxxx"@},
31686 @{addr="0x000013a4",data=["0x14","0x15","0x16","0x17"],ascii="xxxx"@},
31687 @{addr="0x000013a8",data=["0x18","0x19","0x1a","0x1b"],ascii="xxxx"@},
31688 @{addr="0x000013ac",data=["0x1c","0x1d","0x1e","0x1f"],ascii="xxxx"@},
31689 @{addr="0x000013b0",data=["0x20","0x21","0x22","0x23"],ascii=" !\"#"@},
31690 @{addr="0x000013b4",data=["0x24","0x25","0x26","0x27"],ascii="$%&'"@},
31691 @{addr="0x000013b8",data=["0x28","0x29","0x2a","0x2b"],ascii="()*+"@},
31692 @{addr="0x000013bc",data=["0x2c","0x2d","0x2e","0x2f"],ascii=",-./"@}]
31693 (gdb)
31694 @end smallexample
31695
31696 @subheading The @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} Command
31697 @findex -data-read-memory-bytes
31698
31699 @subsubheading Synopsis
31700
31701 @smallexample
31702 -data-read-memory-bytes [ -o @var{offset} ]
31703 @var{address} @var{count}
31704 @end smallexample
31705
31706 @noindent
31707 where:
31708
31709 @table @samp
31710 @item @var{address}
31711 An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
31712 to be read. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should be
31713 quoted using the C convention.
31714
31715 @item @var{count}
31716 The number of addressable memory units to read. This should be an integer
31717 literal.
31718
31719 @item @var{offset}
31720 The offset relative to @var{address} at which to start reading. This
31721 should be an integer literal. This option is provided so that a frontend
31722 is not required to first evaluate address and then perform address
31723 arithmetics itself.
31724
31725 @end table
31726
31727 This command attempts to read all accessible memory regions in the
31728 specified range. First, all regions marked as unreadable in the memory
31729 map (if one is defined) will be skipped. @xref{Memory Region
31730 Attributes}. Second, @value{GDBN} will attempt to read the remaining
31731 regions. For each one, if reading full region results in an errors,
31732 @value{GDBN} will try to read a subset of the region.
31733
31734 In general, every single memory unit in the region may be readable or not,
31735 and the only way to read every readable unit is to try a read at
31736 every address, which is not practical. Therefore, @value{GDBN} will
31737 attempt to read all accessible memory units at either beginning or the end
31738 of the region, using a binary division scheme. This heuristic works
31739 well for reading accross a memory map boundary. Note that if a region
31740 has a readable range that is neither at the beginning or the end,
31741 @value{GDBN} will not read it.
31742
31743 The result record (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}) that is output of
31744 the command includes a field named @samp{memory} whose content is a
31745 list of tuples. Each tuple represent a successfully read memory block
31746 and has the following fields:
31747
31748 @table @code
31749 @item begin
31750 The start address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
31751
31752 @item end
31753 The end address of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal.
31754
31755 @item offset
31756 The offset of the memory block, as hexadecimal literal, relative to
31757 the start address passed to @code{-data-read-memory-bytes}.
31758
31759 @item contents
31760 The contents of the memory block, in hex.
31761
31762 @end table
31763
31764
31765
31766 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31767
31768 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{x}.
31769
31770 @subsubheading Example
31771
31772 @smallexample
31773 (gdb)
31774 -data-read-memory-bytes &a 10
31775 ^done,memory=[@{begin="0xbffff154",offset="0x00000000",
31776 end="0xbffff15e",
31777 contents="01000000020000000300"@}]
31778 (gdb)
31779 @end smallexample
31780
31781
31782 @subheading The @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} Command
31783 @findex -data-write-memory-bytes
31784
31785 @subsubheading Synopsis
31786
31787 @smallexample
31788 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents}
31789 -data-write-memory-bytes @var{address} @var{contents} @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
31790 @end smallexample
31791
31792 @noindent
31793 where:
31794
31795 @table @samp
31796 @item @var{address}
31797 An expression specifying the address of the first addressable memory unit
31798 to be written. Complex expressions containing embedded white space should
31799 be quoted using the C convention.
31800
31801 @item @var{contents}
31802 The hex-encoded data to write. It is an error if @var{contents} does
31803 not represent an integral number of addressable memory units.
31804
31805 @item @var{count}
31806 Optional argument indicating the number of addressable memory units to be
31807 written. If @var{count} is greater than @var{contents}' length,
31808 @value{GDBN} will repeatedly write @var{contents} until it fills
31809 @var{count} memory units.
31810
31811 @end table
31812
31813 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31814
31815 There's no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
31816
31817 @subsubheading Example
31818
31819 @smallexample
31820 (gdb)
31821 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd"
31822 ^done
31823 (gdb)
31824 @end smallexample
31825
31826 @smallexample
31827 (gdb)
31828 -data-write-memory-bytes &a "aabbccdd" 16e
31829 ^done
31830 (gdb)
31831 @end smallexample
31832
31833 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
31834 @node GDB/MI Tracepoint Commands
31835 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Tracepoint Commands
31836
31837 The commands defined in this section implement MI support for
31838 tracepoints. For detailed introduction, see @ref{Tracepoints}.
31839
31840 @subheading The @code{-trace-find} Command
31841 @findex -trace-find
31842
31843 @subsubheading Synopsis
31844
31845 @smallexample
31846 -trace-find @var{mode} [@var{parameters}@dots{}]
31847 @end smallexample
31848
31849 Find a trace frame using criteria defined by @var{mode} and
31850 @var{parameters}. The following table lists permissible
31851 modes and their parameters. For details of operation, see @ref{tfind}.
31852
31853 @table @samp
31854
31855 @item none
31856 No parameters are required. Stops examining trace frames.
31857
31858 @item frame-number
31859 An integer is required as parameter. Selects tracepoint frame with
31860 that index.
31861
31862 @item tracepoint-number
31863 An integer is required as parameter. Finds next
31864 trace frame that corresponds to tracepoint with the specified number.
31865
31866 @item pc
31867 An address is required as parameter. Finds
31868 next trace frame that corresponds to any tracepoint at the specified
31869 address.
31870
31871 @item pc-inside-range
31872 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds next trace
31873 frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address inside the
31874 specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
31875
31876 @item pc-outside-range
31877 Two addresses are required as parameters. Finds
31878 next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at an address outside
31879 the specified range. Both bounds are considered to be inside the range.
31880
31881 @item line
31882 Line specification is required as parameter. @xref{Specify Location}.
31883 Finds next trace frame that corresponds to a tracepoint at
31884 the specified location.
31885
31886 @end table
31887
31888 If @samp{none} was passed as @var{mode}, the response does not
31889 have fields. Otherwise, the response may have the following fields:
31890
31891 @table @samp
31892 @item found
31893 This field has either @samp{0} or @samp{1} as the value, depending
31894 on whether a matching tracepoint was found.
31895
31896 @item traceframe
31897 The index of the found traceframe. This field is present iff
31898 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
31899
31900 @item tracepoint
31901 The index of the found tracepoint. This field is present iff
31902 the @samp{found} field has value of @samp{1}.
31903
31904 @item frame
31905 The information about the frame corresponding to the found trace
31906 frame. This field is present only if a trace frame was found.
31907 @xref{GDB/MI Frame Information}, for description of this field.
31908
31909 @end table
31910
31911 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31912
31913 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tfind}.
31914
31915 @subheading -trace-define-variable
31916 @findex -trace-define-variable
31917
31918 @subsubheading Synopsis
31919
31920 @smallexample
31921 -trace-define-variable @var{name} [ @var{value} ]
31922 @end smallexample
31923
31924 Create trace variable @var{name} if it does not exist. If
31925 @var{value} is specified, sets the initial value of the specified
31926 trace variable to that value. Note that the @var{name} should start
31927 with the @samp{$} character.
31928
31929 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
31930
31931 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariable}.
31932
31933 @subheading The @code{-trace-frame-collected} Command
31934 @findex -trace-frame-collected
31935
31936 @subsubheading Synopsis
31937
31938 @smallexample
31939 -trace-frame-collected
31940 [--var-print-values @var{var_pval}]
31941 [--comp-print-values @var{comp_pval}]
31942 [--registers-format @var{regformat}]
31943 [--memory-contents]
31944 @end smallexample
31945
31946 This command returns the set of collected objects, register names,
31947 trace state variable names, memory ranges and computed expressions
31948 that have been collected at a particular trace frame. The optional
31949 parameters to the command affect the output format in different ways.
31950 See the output description table below for more details.
31951
31952 The reported names can be used in the normal manner to create
31953 varobjs and inspect the objects themselves. The items returned by
31954 this command are categorized so that it is clear which is a variable,
31955 which is a register, which is a trace state variable, which is a
31956 memory range and which is a computed expression.
31957
31958 For instance, if the actions were
31959 @smallexample
31960 collect myVar, myArray[myIndex], myObj.field, myPtr->field, myCount + 2
31961 collect *(int*)0xaf02bef0@@40
31962 @end smallexample
31963
31964 @noindent
31965 the object collected in its entirety would be @code{myVar}. The
31966 object @code{myArray} would be partially collected, because only the
31967 element at index @code{myIndex} would be collected. The remaining
31968 objects would be computed expressions.
31969
31970 An example output would be:
31971
31972 @smallexample
31973 (gdb)
31974 -trace-frame-collected
31975 ^done,
31976 explicit-variables=[@{name="myVar",value="1"@}],
31977 computed-expressions=[@{name="myArray[myIndex]",value="0"@},
31978 @{name="myObj.field",value="0"@},
31979 @{name="myPtr->field",value="1"@},
31980 @{name="myCount + 2",value="3"@},
31981 @{name="$tvar1 + 1",value="43970027"@}],
31982 registers=[@{number="0",value="0x7fe2c6e79ec8"@},
31983 @{number="1",value="0x0"@},
31984 @{number="2",value="0x4"@},
31985 ...
31986 @{number="125",value="0x0"@}],
31987 tvars=[@{name="$tvar1",current="43970026"@}],
31988 memory=[@{address="0x0000000000602264",length="4"@},
31989 @{address="0x0000000000615bc0",length="4"@}]
31990 (gdb)
31991 @end smallexample
31992
31993 Where:
31994
31995 @table @code
31996 @item explicit-variables
31997 The set of objects that have been collected in their entirety (as
31998 opposed to collecting just a few elements of an array or a few struct
31999 members). For each object, its name and value are printed.
32000 The @code{--var-print-values} option affects how or whether the value
32001 field is output. If @var{var_pval} is 0, then print only the names;
32002 if it is 1, print also their values; and if it is 2, print the name,
32003 type and value for simple data types, and the name and type for
32004 arrays, structures and unions.
32005
32006 @item computed-expressions
32007 The set of computed expressions that have been collected at the
32008 current trace frame. The @code{--comp-print-values} option affects
32009 this set like the @code{--var-print-values} option affects the
32010 @code{explicit-variables} set. See above.
32011
32012 @item registers
32013 The registers that have been collected at the current trace frame.
32014 For each register collected, the name and current value are returned.
32015 The value is formatted according to the @code{--registers-format}
32016 option. See the @command{-data-list-register-values} command for a
32017 list of the allowed formats. The default is @samp{x}.
32018
32019 @item tvars
32020 The trace state variables that have been collected at the current
32021 trace frame. For each trace state variable collected, the name and
32022 current value are returned.
32023
32024 @item memory
32025 The set of memory ranges that have been collected at the current trace
32026 frame. Its content is a list of tuples. Each tuple represents a
32027 collected memory range and has the following fields:
32028
32029 @table @code
32030 @item address
32031 The start address of the memory range, as hexadecimal literal.
32032
32033 @item length
32034 The length of the memory range, as decimal literal.
32035
32036 @item contents
32037 The contents of the memory block, in hex. This field is only present
32038 if the @code{--memory-contents} option is specified.
32039
32040 @end table
32041
32042 @end table
32043
32044 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32045
32046 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
32047
32048 @subsubheading Example
32049
32050 @subheading -trace-list-variables
32051 @findex -trace-list-variables
32052
32053 @subsubheading Synopsis
32054
32055 @smallexample
32056 -trace-list-variables
32057 @end smallexample
32058
32059 Return a table of all defined trace variables. Each element of the
32060 table has the following fields:
32061
32062 @table @samp
32063 @item name
32064 The name of the trace variable. This field is always present.
32065
32066 @item initial
32067 The initial value. This is a 64-bit signed integer. This
32068 field is always present.
32069
32070 @item current
32071 The value the trace variable has at the moment. This is a 64-bit
32072 signed integer. This field is absent iff current value is
32073 not defined, for example if the trace was never run, or is
32074 presently running.
32075
32076 @end table
32077
32078 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32079
32080 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tvariables}.
32081
32082 @subsubheading Example
32083
32084 @smallexample
32085 (gdb)
32086 -trace-list-variables
32087 ^done,trace-variables=@{nr_rows="1",nr_cols="3",
32088 hdr=[@{width="15",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
32089 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="initial",colhdr="Initial"@},
32090 @{width="11",alignment="-1",col_name="current",colhdr="Current"@}],
32091 body=[variable=@{name="$trace_timestamp",initial="0"@}
32092 variable=@{name="$foo",initial="10",current="15"@}]@}
32093 (gdb)
32094 @end smallexample
32095
32096 @subheading -trace-save
32097 @findex -trace-save
32098
32099 @subsubheading Synopsis
32100
32101 @smallexample
32102 -trace-save [ -r ] [ -ctf ] @var{filename}
32103 @end smallexample
32104
32105 Saves the collected trace data to @var{filename}. Without the
32106 @samp{-r} option, the data is downloaded from the target and saved
32107 in a local file. With the @samp{-r} option the target is asked
32108 to perform the save.
32109
32110 By default, this command will save the trace in the tfile format. You can
32111 supply the optional @samp{-ctf} argument to save it the CTF format. See
32112 @ref{Trace Files} for more information about CTF.
32113
32114 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32115
32116 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tsave}.
32117
32118
32119 @subheading -trace-start
32120 @findex -trace-start
32121
32122 @subsubheading Synopsis
32123
32124 @smallexample
32125 -trace-start
32126 @end smallexample
32127
32128 Starts a tracing experiment. The result of this command does not
32129 have any fields.
32130
32131 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32132
32133 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstart}.
32134
32135 @subheading -trace-status
32136 @findex -trace-status
32137
32138 @subsubheading Synopsis
32139
32140 @smallexample
32141 -trace-status
32142 @end smallexample
32143
32144 Obtains the status of a tracing experiment. The result may include
32145 the following fields:
32146
32147 @table @samp
32148
32149 @item supported
32150 May have a value of either @samp{0}, when no tracing operations are
32151 supported, @samp{1}, when all tracing operations are supported, or
32152 @samp{file} when examining trace file. In the latter case, examining
32153 of trace frame is possible but new tracing experiement cannot be
32154 started. This field is always present.
32155
32156 @item running
32157 May have a value of either @samp{0} or @samp{1} depending on whether
32158 tracing experiement is in progress on target. This field is present
32159 if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
32160
32161 @item stop-reason
32162 Report the reason why the tracing was stopped last time. This field
32163 may be absent iff tracing was never stopped on target yet. The
32164 value of @samp{request} means the tracing was stopped as result of
32165 the @code{-trace-stop} command. The value of @samp{overflow} means
32166 the tracing buffer is full. The value of @samp{disconnection} means
32167 tracing was automatically stopped when @value{GDBN} has disconnected.
32168 The value of @samp{passcount} means tracing was stopped when a
32169 tracepoint was passed a maximal number of times for that tracepoint.
32170 This field is present if @samp{supported} field is not @samp{0}.
32171
32172 @item stopping-tracepoint
32173 The number of tracepoint whose passcount as exceeded. This field is
32174 present iff the @samp{stop-reason} field has the value of
32175 @samp{passcount}.
32176
32177 @item frames
32178 @itemx frames-created
32179 The @samp{frames} field is a count of the total number of trace frames
32180 in the trace buffer, while @samp{frames-created} is the total created
32181 during the run, including ones that were discarded, such as when a
32182 circular trace buffer filled up. Both fields are optional.
32183
32184 @item buffer-size
32185 @itemx buffer-free
32186 These fields tell the current size of the tracing buffer and the
32187 remaining space. These fields are optional.
32188
32189 @item circular
32190 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
32191 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
32192 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
32193 and may fill up.
32194
32195 @item disconnected
32196 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
32197 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
32198 that the trace run will stop.
32199
32200 @item trace-file
32201 The filename of the trace file being examined. This field is
32202 optional, and only present when examining a trace file.
32203
32204 @end table
32205
32206 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32207
32208 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstatus}.
32209
32210 @subheading -trace-stop
32211 @findex -trace-stop
32212
32213 @subsubheading Synopsis
32214
32215 @smallexample
32216 -trace-stop
32217 @end smallexample
32218
32219 Stops a tracing experiment. The result of this command has the same
32220 fields as @code{-trace-status}, except that the @samp{supported} and
32221 @samp{running} fields are not output.
32222
32223 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32224
32225 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{tstop}.
32226
32227
32228 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32229 @node GDB/MI Symbol Query
32230 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Symbol Query Commands
32231
32232
32233 @ignore
32234 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-address} Command
32235 @findex -symbol-info-address
32236
32237 @subsubheading Synopsis
32238
32239 @smallexample
32240 -symbol-info-address @var{symbol}
32241 @end smallexample
32242
32243 Describe where @var{symbol} is stored.
32244
32245 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32246
32247 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info address}.
32248
32249 @subsubheading Example
32250 N.A.
32251
32252
32253 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-file} Command
32254 @findex -symbol-info-file
32255
32256 @subsubheading Synopsis
32257
32258 @smallexample
32259 -symbol-info-file
32260 @end smallexample
32261
32262 Show the file for the symbol.
32263
32264 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32265
32266 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command. @code{gdbtk} has
32267 @samp{gdb_find_file}.
32268
32269 @subsubheading Example
32270 N.A.
32271
32272
32273 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-function} Command
32274 @findex -symbol-info-function
32275
32276 @subsubheading Synopsis
32277
32278 @smallexample
32279 -symbol-info-function
32280 @end smallexample
32281
32282 Show which function the symbol lives in.
32283
32284 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32285
32286 @samp{gdb_get_function} in @code{gdbtk}.
32287
32288 @subsubheading Example
32289 N.A.
32290
32291
32292 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-line} Command
32293 @findex -symbol-info-line
32294
32295 @subsubheading Synopsis
32296
32297 @smallexample
32298 -symbol-info-line
32299 @end smallexample
32300
32301 Show the core addresses of the code for a source line.
32302
32303 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32304
32305 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info line}.
32306 @code{gdbtk} has the @samp{gdb_get_line} and @samp{gdb_get_file} commands.
32307
32308 @subsubheading Example
32309 N.A.
32310
32311
32312 @subheading The @code{-symbol-info-symbol} Command
32313 @findex -symbol-info-symbol
32314
32315 @subsubheading Synopsis
32316
32317 @smallexample
32318 -symbol-info-symbol @var{addr}
32319 @end smallexample
32320
32321 Describe what symbol is at location @var{addr}.
32322
32323 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32324
32325 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info symbol}.
32326
32327 @subsubheading Example
32328 N.A.
32329
32330
32331 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-functions} Command
32332 @findex -symbol-list-functions
32333
32334 @subsubheading Synopsis
32335
32336 @smallexample
32337 -symbol-list-functions
32338 @end smallexample
32339
32340 List the functions in the executable.
32341
32342 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32343
32344 @samp{info functions} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_listfunc} and
32345 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
32346
32347 @subsubheading Example
32348 N.A.
32349 @end ignore
32350
32351
32352 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-lines} Command
32353 @findex -symbol-list-lines
32354
32355 @subsubheading Synopsis
32356
32357 @smallexample
32358 -symbol-list-lines @var{filename}
32359 @end smallexample
32360
32361 Print the list of lines that contain code and their associated program
32362 addresses for the given source filename. The entries are sorted in
32363 ascending PC order.
32364
32365 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32366
32367 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
32368
32369 @subsubheading Example
32370 @smallexample
32371 (gdb)
32372 -symbol-list-lines basics.c
32373 ^done,lines=[@{pc="0x08048554",line="7"@},@{pc="0x0804855a",line="8"@}]
32374 (gdb)
32375 @end smallexample
32376
32377
32378 @ignore
32379 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-types} Command
32380 @findex -symbol-list-types
32381
32382 @subsubheading Synopsis
32383
32384 @smallexample
32385 -symbol-list-types
32386 @end smallexample
32387
32388 List all the type names.
32389
32390 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32391
32392 The corresponding commands are @samp{info types} in @value{GDBN},
32393 @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
32394
32395 @subsubheading Example
32396 N.A.
32397
32398
32399 @subheading The @code{-symbol-list-variables} Command
32400 @findex -symbol-list-variables
32401
32402 @subsubheading Synopsis
32403
32404 @smallexample
32405 -symbol-list-variables
32406 @end smallexample
32407
32408 List all the global and static variable names.
32409
32410 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32411
32412 @samp{info variables} in @value{GDBN}, @samp{gdb_search} in @code{gdbtk}.
32413
32414 @subsubheading Example
32415 N.A.
32416
32417
32418 @subheading The @code{-symbol-locate} Command
32419 @findex -symbol-locate
32420
32421 @subsubheading Synopsis
32422
32423 @smallexample
32424 -symbol-locate
32425 @end smallexample
32426
32427 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32428
32429 @samp{gdb_loc} in @code{gdbtk}.
32430
32431 @subsubheading Example
32432 N.A.
32433
32434
32435 @subheading The @code{-symbol-type} Command
32436 @findex -symbol-type
32437
32438 @subsubheading Synopsis
32439
32440 @smallexample
32441 -symbol-type @var{variable}
32442 @end smallexample
32443
32444 Show type of @var{variable}.
32445
32446 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32447
32448 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{ptype}, @code{gdbtk} has
32449 @samp{gdb_obj_variable}.
32450
32451 @subsubheading Example
32452 N.A.
32453 @end ignore
32454
32455
32456 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32457 @node GDB/MI File Commands
32458 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Commands
32459
32460 This section describes the GDB/MI commands to specify executable file names
32461 and to read in and obtain symbol table information.
32462
32463 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-and-symbols} Command
32464 @findex -file-exec-and-symbols
32465
32466 @subsubheading Synopsis
32467
32468 @smallexample
32469 -file-exec-and-symbols @var{file}
32470 @end smallexample
32471
32472 Specify the executable file to be debugged. This file is the one from
32473 which the symbol table is also read. If no file is specified, the
32474 command clears the executable and symbol information. If breakpoints
32475 are set when using this command with no arguments, @value{GDBN} will produce
32476 error messages. Otherwise, no output is produced, except a completion
32477 notification.
32478
32479 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32480
32481 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{file}.
32482
32483 @subsubheading Example
32484
32485 @smallexample
32486 (gdb)
32487 -file-exec-and-symbols /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
32488 ^done
32489 (gdb)
32490 @end smallexample
32491
32492
32493 @subheading The @code{-file-exec-file} Command
32494 @findex -file-exec-file
32495
32496 @subsubheading Synopsis
32497
32498 @smallexample
32499 -file-exec-file @var{file}
32500 @end smallexample
32501
32502 Specify the executable file to be debugged. Unlike
32503 @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols}, the symbol table is @emph{not} read
32504 from this file. If used without argument, @value{GDBN} clears the information
32505 about the executable file. No output is produced, except a completion
32506 notification.
32507
32508 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32509
32510 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{exec-file}.
32511
32512 @subsubheading Example
32513
32514 @smallexample
32515 (gdb)
32516 -file-exec-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
32517 ^done
32518 (gdb)
32519 @end smallexample
32520
32521
32522 @ignore
32523 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-sections} Command
32524 @findex -file-list-exec-sections
32525
32526 @subsubheading Synopsis
32527
32528 @smallexample
32529 -file-list-exec-sections
32530 @end smallexample
32531
32532 List the sections of the current executable file.
32533
32534 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32535
32536 The @value{GDBN} command @samp{info file} shows, among the rest, the same
32537 information as this command. @code{gdbtk} has a corresponding command
32538 @samp{gdb_load_info}.
32539
32540 @subsubheading Example
32541 N.A.
32542 @end ignore
32543
32544
32545 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-file} Command
32546 @findex -file-list-exec-source-file
32547
32548 @subsubheading Synopsis
32549
32550 @smallexample
32551 -file-list-exec-source-file
32552 @end smallexample
32553
32554 List the line number, the current source file, and the absolute path
32555 to the current source file for the current executable. The macro
32556 information field has a value of @samp{1} or @samp{0} depending on
32557 whether or not the file includes preprocessor macro information.
32558
32559 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32560
32561 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info source}
32562
32563 @subsubheading Example
32564
32565 @smallexample
32566 (gdb)
32567 123-file-list-exec-source-file
32568 123^done,line="1",file="foo.c",fullname="/home/bar/foo.c,macro-info="1"
32569 (gdb)
32570 @end smallexample
32571
32572
32573 @subheading The @code{-file-list-exec-source-files} Command
32574 @findex -file-list-exec-source-files
32575
32576 @subsubheading Synopsis
32577
32578 @smallexample
32579 -file-list-exec-source-files
32580 @end smallexample
32581
32582 List the source files for the current executable.
32583
32584 It will always output both the filename and fullname (absolute file
32585 name) of a source file.
32586
32587 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32588
32589 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{info sources}.
32590 @code{gdbtk} has an analogous command @samp{gdb_listfiles}.
32591
32592 @subsubheading Example
32593 @smallexample
32594 (gdb)
32595 -file-list-exec-source-files
32596 ^done,files=[
32597 @{file=foo.c,fullname=/home/foo.c@},
32598 @{file=/home/bar.c,fullname=/home/bar.c@},
32599 @{file=gdb_could_not_find_fullpath.c@}]
32600 (gdb)
32601 @end smallexample
32602
32603 @subheading The @code{-file-list-shared-libraries} Command
32604 @findex -file-list-shared-libraries
32605
32606 @subsubheading Synopsis
32607
32608 @smallexample
32609 -file-list-shared-libraries [ @var{regexp} ]
32610 @end smallexample
32611
32612 List the shared libraries in the program.
32613 With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those libraries whose
32614 names match @var{regexp} are listed.
32615
32616 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32617
32618 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info shared}. The fields
32619 have a similar meaning to the @code{=library-loaded} notification.
32620 The @code{ranges} field specifies the multiple segments belonging to this
32621 library. Each range has the following fields:
32622
32623 @table @samp
32624 @item from
32625 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the segment.
32626 @item to
32627 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the segment.
32628 @end table
32629
32630 @subsubheading Example
32631 @smallexample
32632 (gdb)
32633 -file-list-exec-source-files
32634 ^done,shared-libraries=[
32635 @{id="/lib/libfoo.so",target-name="/lib/libfoo.so",host-name="/lib/libfoo.so",symbols-loaded="1",thread-group="i1",ranges=[@{from="0x72815989",to="0x728162c0"@}]@},
32636 @{id="/lib/libbar.so",target-name="/lib/libbar.so",host-name="/lib/libbar.so",symbols-loaded="1",thread-group="i1",ranges=[@{from="0x76ee48c0",to="0x76ee9160"@}]@}]
32637 (gdb)
32638 @end smallexample
32639
32640
32641 @ignore
32642 @subheading The @code{-file-list-symbol-files} Command
32643 @findex -file-list-symbol-files
32644
32645 @subsubheading Synopsis
32646
32647 @smallexample
32648 -file-list-symbol-files
32649 @end smallexample
32650
32651 List symbol files.
32652
32653 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32654
32655 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info file} (part of it).
32656
32657 @subsubheading Example
32658 N.A.
32659 @end ignore
32660
32661
32662 @subheading The @code{-file-symbol-file} Command
32663 @findex -file-symbol-file
32664
32665 @subsubheading Synopsis
32666
32667 @smallexample
32668 -file-symbol-file @var{file}
32669 @end smallexample
32670
32671 Read symbol table info from the specified @var{file} argument. When
32672 used without arguments, clears @value{GDBN}'s symbol table info. No output is
32673 produced, except for a completion notification.
32674
32675 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32676
32677 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{symbol-file}.
32678
32679 @subsubheading Example
32680
32681 @smallexample
32682 (gdb)
32683 -file-symbol-file /kwikemart/marge/ezannoni/TRUNK/mbx/hello.mbx
32684 ^done
32685 (gdb)
32686 @end smallexample
32687
32688 @ignore
32689 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32690 @node GDB/MI Memory Overlay Commands
32691 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Memory Overlay Commands
32692
32693 The memory overlay commands are not implemented.
32694
32695 @c @subheading -overlay-auto
32696
32697 @c @subheading -overlay-list-mapping-state
32698
32699 @c @subheading -overlay-list-overlays
32700
32701 @c @subheading -overlay-map
32702
32703 @c @subheading -overlay-off
32704
32705 @c @subheading -overlay-on
32706
32707 @c @subheading -overlay-unmap
32708
32709 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32710 @node GDB/MI Signal Handling Commands
32711 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Signal Handling Commands
32712
32713 Signal handling commands are not implemented.
32714
32715 @c @subheading -signal-handle
32716
32717 @c @subheading -signal-list-handle-actions
32718
32719 @c @subheading -signal-list-signal-types
32720 @end ignore
32721
32722
32723 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
32724 @node GDB/MI Target Manipulation
32725 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Target Manipulation Commands
32726
32727
32728 @subheading The @code{-target-attach} Command
32729 @findex -target-attach
32730
32731 @subsubheading Synopsis
32732
32733 @smallexample
32734 -target-attach @var{pid} | @var{gid} | @var{file}
32735 @end smallexample
32736
32737 Attach to a process @var{pid} or a file @var{file} outside of
32738 @value{GDBN}, or a thread group @var{gid}. If attaching to a thread
32739 group, the id previously returned by
32740 @samp{-list-thread-groups --available} must be used.
32741
32742 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32743
32744 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{attach}.
32745
32746 @subsubheading Example
32747 @smallexample
32748 (gdb)
32749 -target-attach 34
32750 =thread-created,id="1"
32751 *stopped,thread-id="1",frame=@{addr="0xb7f7e410",func="bar",args=[]@}
32752 ^done
32753 (gdb)
32754 @end smallexample
32755
32756 @ignore
32757 @subheading The @code{-target-compare-sections} Command
32758 @findex -target-compare-sections
32759
32760 @subsubheading Synopsis
32761
32762 @smallexample
32763 -target-compare-sections [ @var{section} ]
32764 @end smallexample
32765
32766 Compare data of section @var{section} on target to the exec file.
32767 Without the argument, all sections are compared.
32768
32769 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32770
32771 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{compare-sections}.
32772
32773 @subsubheading Example
32774 N.A.
32775 @end ignore
32776
32777
32778 @subheading The @code{-target-detach} Command
32779 @findex -target-detach
32780
32781 @subsubheading Synopsis
32782
32783 @smallexample
32784 -target-detach [ @var{pid} | @var{gid} ]
32785 @end smallexample
32786
32787 Detach from the remote target which normally resumes its execution.
32788 If either @var{pid} or @var{gid} is specified, detaches from either
32789 the specified process, or specified thread group. There's no output.
32790
32791 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32792
32793 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{detach}.
32794
32795 @subsubheading Example
32796
32797 @smallexample
32798 (gdb)
32799 -target-detach
32800 ^done
32801 (gdb)
32802 @end smallexample
32803
32804
32805 @subheading The @code{-target-disconnect} Command
32806 @findex -target-disconnect
32807
32808 @subsubheading Synopsis
32809
32810 @smallexample
32811 -target-disconnect
32812 @end smallexample
32813
32814 Disconnect from the remote target. There's no output and the target is
32815 generally not resumed.
32816
32817 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32818
32819 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{disconnect}.
32820
32821 @subsubheading Example
32822
32823 @smallexample
32824 (gdb)
32825 -target-disconnect
32826 ^done
32827 (gdb)
32828 @end smallexample
32829
32830
32831 @subheading The @code{-target-download} Command
32832 @findex -target-download
32833
32834 @subsubheading Synopsis
32835
32836 @smallexample
32837 -target-download
32838 @end smallexample
32839
32840 Loads the executable onto the remote target.
32841 It prints out an update message every half second, which includes the fields:
32842
32843 @table @samp
32844 @item section
32845 The name of the section.
32846 @item section-sent
32847 The size of what has been sent so far for that section.
32848 @item section-size
32849 The size of the section.
32850 @item total-sent
32851 The total size of what was sent so far (the current and the previous sections).
32852 @item total-size
32853 The size of the overall executable to download.
32854 @end table
32855
32856 @noindent
32857 Each message is sent as status record (@pxref{GDB/MI Output Syntax, ,
32858 @sc{gdb/mi} Output Syntax}).
32859
32860 In addition, it prints the name and size of the sections, as they are
32861 downloaded. These messages include the following fields:
32862
32863 @table @samp
32864 @item section
32865 The name of the section.
32866 @item section-size
32867 The size of the section.
32868 @item total-size
32869 The size of the overall executable to download.
32870 @end table
32871
32872 @noindent
32873 At the end, a summary is printed.
32874
32875 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32876
32877 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{load}.
32878
32879 @subsubheading Example
32880
32881 Note: each status message appears on a single line. Here the messages
32882 have been broken down so that they can fit onto a page.
32883
32884 @smallexample
32885 (gdb)
32886 -target-download
32887 +download,@{section=".text",section-size="6668",total-size="9880"@}
32888 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="512",section-size="6668",
32889 total-sent="512",total-size="9880"@}
32890 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1024",section-size="6668",
32891 total-sent="1024",total-size="9880"@}
32892 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="1536",section-size="6668",
32893 total-sent="1536",total-size="9880"@}
32894 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2048",section-size="6668",
32895 total-sent="2048",total-size="9880"@}
32896 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="2560",section-size="6668",
32897 total-sent="2560",total-size="9880"@}
32898 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3072",section-size="6668",
32899 total-sent="3072",total-size="9880"@}
32900 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="3584",section-size="6668",
32901 total-sent="3584",total-size="9880"@}
32902 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4096",section-size="6668",
32903 total-sent="4096",total-size="9880"@}
32904 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="4608",section-size="6668",
32905 total-sent="4608",total-size="9880"@}
32906 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5120",section-size="6668",
32907 total-sent="5120",total-size="9880"@}
32908 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="5632",section-size="6668",
32909 total-sent="5632",total-size="9880"@}
32910 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6144",section-size="6668",
32911 total-sent="6144",total-size="9880"@}
32912 +download,@{section=".text",section-sent="6656",section-size="6668",
32913 total-sent="6656",total-size="9880"@}
32914 +download,@{section=".init",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
32915 +download,@{section=".fini",section-size="28",total-size="9880"@}
32916 +download,@{section=".data",section-size="3156",total-size="9880"@}
32917 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="512",section-size="3156",
32918 total-sent="7236",total-size="9880"@}
32919 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1024",section-size="3156",
32920 total-sent="7748",total-size="9880"@}
32921 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="1536",section-size="3156",
32922 total-sent="8260",total-size="9880"@}
32923 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2048",section-size="3156",
32924 total-sent="8772",total-size="9880"@}
32925 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="2560",section-size="3156",
32926 total-sent="9284",total-size="9880"@}
32927 +download,@{section=".data",section-sent="3072",section-size="3156",
32928 total-sent="9796",total-size="9880"@}
32929 ^done,address="0x10004",load-size="9880",transfer-rate="6586",
32930 write-rate="429"
32931 (gdb)
32932 @end smallexample
32933
32934
32935 @ignore
32936 @subheading The @code{-target-exec-status} Command
32937 @findex -target-exec-status
32938
32939 @subsubheading Synopsis
32940
32941 @smallexample
32942 -target-exec-status
32943 @end smallexample
32944
32945 Provide information on the state of the target (whether it is running or
32946 not, for instance).
32947
32948 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32949
32950 There's no equivalent @value{GDBN} command.
32951
32952 @subsubheading Example
32953 N.A.
32954
32955
32956 @subheading The @code{-target-list-available-targets} Command
32957 @findex -target-list-available-targets
32958
32959 @subsubheading Synopsis
32960
32961 @smallexample
32962 -target-list-available-targets
32963 @end smallexample
32964
32965 List the possible targets to connect to.
32966
32967 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32968
32969 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{help target}.
32970
32971 @subsubheading Example
32972 N.A.
32973
32974
32975 @subheading The @code{-target-list-current-targets} Command
32976 @findex -target-list-current-targets
32977
32978 @subsubheading Synopsis
32979
32980 @smallexample
32981 -target-list-current-targets
32982 @end smallexample
32983
32984 Describe the current target.
32985
32986 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
32987
32988 The corresponding information is printed by @samp{info file} (among
32989 other things).
32990
32991 @subsubheading Example
32992 N.A.
32993
32994
32995 @subheading The @code{-target-list-parameters} Command
32996 @findex -target-list-parameters
32997
32998 @subsubheading Synopsis
32999
33000 @smallexample
33001 -target-list-parameters
33002 @end smallexample
33003
33004 @c ????
33005 @end ignore
33006
33007 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33008
33009 No equivalent.
33010
33011 @subsubheading Example
33012 N.A.
33013
33014 @subheading The @code{-target-flash-erase} Command
33015 @findex -target-flash-erase
33016
33017 @subsubheading Synopsis
33018
33019 @smallexample
33020 -target-flash-erase
33021 @end smallexample
33022
33023 Erases all known flash memory regions on the target.
33024
33025 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{flash-erase}.
33026
33027 The output is a list of flash regions that have been erased, with starting
33028 addresses and memory region sizes.
33029
33030 @smallexample
33031 (gdb)
33032 -target-flash-erase
33033 ^done,erased-regions=@{address="0x0",size="0x40000"@}
33034 (gdb)
33035 @end smallexample
33036
33037 @subheading The @code{-target-select} Command
33038 @findex -target-select
33039
33040 @subsubheading Synopsis
33041
33042 @smallexample
33043 -target-select @var{type} @var{parameters @dots{}}
33044 @end smallexample
33045
33046 Connect @value{GDBN} to the remote target. This command takes two args:
33047
33048 @table @samp
33049 @item @var{type}
33050 The type of target, for instance @samp{remote}, etc.
33051 @item @var{parameters}
33052 Device names, host names and the like. @xref{Target Commands, ,
33053 Commands for Managing Targets}, for more details.
33054 @end table
33055
33056 The output is a connection notification, followed by the address at
33057 which the target program is, in the following form:
33058
33059 @smallexample
33060 ^connected,addr="@var{address}",func="@var{function name}",
33061 args=[@var{arg list}]
33062 @end smallexample
33063
33064 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33065
33066 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{target}.
33067
33068 @subsubheading Example
33069
33070 @smallexample
33071 (gdb)
33072 -target-select remote /dev/ttya
33073 ^connected,addr="0xfe00a300",func="??",args=[]
33074 (gdb)
33075 @end smallexample
33076
33077 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33078 @node GDB/MI File Transfer Commands
33079 @section @sc{gdb/mi} File Transfer Commands
33080
33081
33082 @subheading The @code{-target-file-put} Command
33083 @findex -target-file-put
33084
33085 @subsubheading Synopsis
33086
33087 @smallexample
33088 -target-file-put @var{hostfile} @var{targetfile}
33089 @end smallexample
33090
33091 Copy file @var{hostfile} from the host system (the machine running
33092 @value{GDBN}) to @var{targetfile} on the target system.
33093
33094 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33095
33096 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote put}.
33097
33098 @subsubheading Example
33099
33100 @smallexample
33101 (gdb)
33102 -target-file-put localfile remotefile
33103 ^done
33104 (gdb)
33105 @end smallexample
33106
33107
33108 @subheading The @code{-target-file-get} Command
33109 @findex -target-file-get
33110
33111 @subsubheading Synopsis
33112
33113 @smallexample
33114 -target-file-get @var{targetfile} @var{hostfile}
33115 @end smallexample
33116
33117 Copy file @var{targetfile} from the target system to @var{hostfile}
33118 on the host system.
33119
33120 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33121
33122 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote get}.
33123
33124 @subsubheading Example
33125
33126 @smallexample
33127 (gdb)
33128 -target-file-get remotefile localfile
33129 ^done
33130 (gdb)
33131 @end smallexample
33132
33133
33134 @subheading The @code{-target-file-delete} Command
33135 @findex -target-file-delete
33136
33137 @subsubheading Synopsis
33138
33139 @smallexample
33140 -target-file-delete @var{targetfile}
33141 @end smallexample
33142
33143 Delete @var{targetfile} from the target system.
33144
33145 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33146
33147 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{remote delete}.
33148
33149 @subsubheading Example
33150
33151 @smallexample
33152 (gdb)
33153 -target-file-delete remotefile
33154 ^done
33155 (gdb)
33156 @end smallexample
33157
33158
33159 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33160 @node GDB/MI Ada Exceptions Commands
33161 @section Ada Exceptions @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
33162
33163 @subheading The @code{-info-ada-exceptions} Command
33164 @findex -info-ada-exceptions
33165
33166 @subsubheading Synopsis
33167
33168 @smallexample
33169 -info-ada-exceptions [ @var{regexp}]
33170 @end smallexample
33171
33172 List all Ada exceptions defined within the program being debugged.
33173 With a regular expression @var{regexp}, only those exceptions whose
33174 names match @var{regexp} are listed.
33175
33176 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33177
33178 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info exceptions}.
33179
33180 @subsubheading Result
33181
33182 The result is a table of Ada exceptions. The following columns are
33183 defined for each exception:
33184
33185 @table @samp
33186 @item name
33187 The name of the exception.
33188
33189 @item address
33190 The address of the exception.
33191
33192 @end table
33193
33194 @subsubheading Example
33195
33196 @smallexample
33197 -info-ada-exceptions aint
33198 ^done,ada-exceptions=@{nr_rows="2",nr_cols="2",
33199 hdr=[@{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="name",colhdr="Name"@},
33200 @{width="1",alignment="-1",col_name="address",colhdr="Address"@}],
33201 body=[@{name="constraint_error",address="0x0000000000613da0"@},
33202 @{name="const.aint_global_e",address="0x0000000000613b00"@}]@}
33203 @end smallexample
33204
33205 @subheading Catching Ada Exceptions
33206
33207 The commands describing how to ask @value{GDBN} to stop when a program
33208 raises an exception are described at @ref{Ada Exception GDB/MI
33209 Catchpoint Commands}.
33210
33211
33212 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33213 @node GDB/MI Support Commands
33214 @section @sc{gdb/mi} Support Commands
33215
33216 Since new commands and features get regularly added to @sc{gdb/mi},
33217 some commands are available to help front-ends query the debugger
33218 about support for these capabilities. Similarly, it is also possible
33219 to query @value{GDBN} about target support of certain features.
33220
33221 @subheading The @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} Command
33222 @cindex @code{-info-gdb-mi-command}
33223 @findex -info-gdb-mi-command
33224
33225 @subsubheading Synopsis
33226
33227 @smallexample
33228 -info-gdb-mi-command @var{cmd_name}
33229 @end smallexample
33230
33231 Query support for the @sc{gdb/mi} command named @var{cmd_name}.
33232
33233 Note that the dash (@code{-}) starting all @sc{gdb/mi} commands
33234 is technically not part of the command name (@pxref{GDB/MI Input
33235 Syntax}), and thus should be omitted in @var{cmd_name}. However,
33236 for ease of use, this command also accepts the form with the leading
33237 dash.
33238
33239 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33240
33241 There is no corresponding @value{GDBN} command.
33242
33243 @subsubheading Result
33244
33245 The result is a tuple. There is currently only one field:
33246
33247 @table @samp
33248 @item exists
33249 This field is equal to @code{"true"} if the @sc{gdb/mi} command exists,
33250 @code{"false"} otherwise.
33251
33252 @end table
33253
33254 @subsubheading Example
33255
33256 Here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command does not exist:
33257
33258 @smallexample
33259 -info-gdb-mi-command unsupported-command
33260 ^done,command=@{exists="false"@}
33261 @end smallexample
33262
33263 @noindent
33264 And here is an example where the @sc{gdb/mi} command is known
33265 to the debugger:
33266
33267 @smallexample
33268 -info-gdb-mi-command symbol-list-lines
33269 ^done,command=@{exists="true"@}
33270 @end smallexample
33271
33272 @subheading The @code{-list-features} Command
33273 @findex -list-features
33274 @cindex supported @sc{gdb/mi} features, list
33275
33276 Returns a list of particular features of the MI protocol that
33277 this version of gdb implements. A feature can be a command,
33278 or a new field in an output of some command, or even an
33279 important bugfix. While a frontend can sometimes detect presence
33280 of a feature at runtime, it is easier to perform detection at debugger
33281 startup.
33282
33283 The command returns a list of strings, with each string naming an
33284 available feature. Each returned string is just a name, it does not
33285 have any internal structure. The list of possible feature names
33286 is given below.
33287
33288 Example output:
33289
33290 @smallexample
33291 (gdb) -list-features
33292 ^done,result=["feature1","feature2"]
33293 @end smallexample
33294
33295 The current list of features is:
33296
33297 @ftable @samp
33298 @item frozen-varobjs
33299 Indicates support for the @code{-var-set-frozen} command, as well
33300 as possible presense of the @code{frozen} field in the output
33301 of @code{-varobj-create}.
33302 @item pending-breakpoints
33303 Indicates support for the @option{-f} option to the @code{-break-insert}
33304 command.
33305 @item python
33306 Indicates Python scripting support, Python-based
33307 pretty-printing commands, and possible presence of the
33308 @samp{display_hint} field in the output of @code{-var-list-children}
33309 @item thread-info
33310 Indicates support for the @code{-thread-info} command.
33311 @item data-read-memory-bytes
33312 Indicates support for the @code{-data-read-memory-bytes} and the
33313 @code{-data-write-memory-bytes} commands.
33314 @item breakpoint-notifications
33315 Indicates that changes to breakpoints and breakpoints created via the
33316 CLI will be announced via async records.
33317 @item ada-task-info
33318 Indicates support for the @code{-ada-task-info} command.
33319 @item language-option
33320 Indicates that all @sc{gdb/mi} commands accept the @option{--language}
33321 option (@pxref{Context management}).
33322 @item info-gdb-mi-command
33323 Indicates support for the @code{-info-gdb-mi-command} command.
33324 @item undefined-command-error-code
33325 Indicates support for the "undefined-command" error code in error result
33326 records, produced when trying to execute an undefined @sc{gdb/mi} command
33327 (@pxref{GDB/MI Result Records}).
33328 @item exec-run-start-option
33329 Indicates that the @code{-exec-run} command supports the @option{--start}
33330 option (@pxref{GDB/MI Program Execution}).
33331 @end ftable
33332
33333 @subheading The @code{-list-target-features} Command
33334 @findex -list-target-features
33335
33336 Returns a list of particular features that are supported by the
33337 target. Those features affect the permitted MI commands, but
33338 unlike the features reported by the @code{-list-features} command, the
33339 features depend on which target GDB is using at the moment. Whenever
33340 a target can change, due to commands such as @code{-target-select},
33341 @code{-target-attach} or @code{-exec-run}, the list of target features
33342 may change, and the frontend should obtain it again.
33343 Example output:
33344
33345 @smallexample
33346 (gdb) -list-target-features
33347 ^done,result=["async"]
33348 @end smallexample
33349
33350 The current list of features is:
33351
33352 @table @samp
33353 @item async
33354 Indicates that the target is capable of asynchronous command
33355 execution, which means that @value{GDBN} will accept further commands
33356 while the target is running.
33357
33358 @item reverse
33359 Indicates that the target is capable of reverse execution.
33360 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
33361
33362 @end table
33363
33364 @c %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%% SECTION %%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%%
33365 @node GDB/MI Miscellaneous Commands
33366 @section Miscellaneous @sc{gdb/mi} Commands
33367
33368 @c @subheading -gdb-complete
33369
33370 @subheading The @code{-gdb-exit} Command
33371 @findex -gdb-exit
33372
33373 @subsubheading Synopsis
33374
33375 @smallexample
33376 -gdb-exit
33377 @end smallexample
33378
33379 Exit @value{GDBN} immediately.
33380
33381 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33382
33383 Approximately corresponds to @samp{quit}.
33384
33385 @subsubheading Example
33386
33387 @smallexample
33388 (gdb)
33389 -gdb-exit
33390 ^exit
33391 @end smallexample
33392
33393
33394 @ignore
33395 @subheading The @code{-exec-abort} Command
33396 @findex -exec-abort
33397
33398 @subsubheading Synopsis
33399
33400 @smallexample
33401 -exec-abort
33402 @end smallexample
33403
33404 Kill the inferior running program.
33405
33406 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33407
33408 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{kill}.
33409
33410 @subsubheading Example
33411 N.A.
33412 @end ignore
33413
33414
33415 @subheading The @code{-gdb-set} Command
33416 @findex -gdb-set
33417
33418 @subsubheading Synopsis
33419
33420 @smallexample
33421 -gdb-set
33422 @end smallexample
33423
33424 Set an internal @value{GDBN} variable.
33425 @c IS THIS A DOLLAR VARIABLE? OR SOMETHING LIKE ANNOTATE ?????
33426
33427 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33428
33429 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set}.
33430
33431 @subsubheading Example
33432
33433 @smallexample
33434 (gdb)
33435 -gdb-set $foo=3
33436 ^done
33437 (gdb)
33438 @end smallexample
33439
33440
33441 @subheading The @code{-gdb-show} Command
33442 @findex -gdb-show
33443
33444 @subsubheading Synopsis
33445
33446 @smallexample
33447 -gdb-show
33448 @end smallexample
33449
33450 Show the current value of a @value{GDBN} variable.
33451
33452 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33453
33454 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show}.
33455
33456 @subsubheading Example
33457
33458 @smallexample
33459 (gdb)
33460 -gdb-show annotate
33461 ^done,value="0"
33462 (gdb)
33463 @end smallexample
33464
33465 @c @subheading -gdb-source
33466
33467
33468 @subheading The @code{-gdb-version} Command
33469 @findex -gdb-version
33470
33471 @subsubheading Synopsis
33472
33473 @smallexample
33474 -gdb-version
33475 @end smallexample
33476
33477 Show version information for @value{GDBN}. Used mostly in testing.
33478
33479 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33480
33481 The @value{GDBN} equivalent is @samp{show version}. @value{GDBN} by
33482 default shows this information when you start an interactive session.
33483
33484 @subsubheading Example
33485
33486 @c This example modifies the actual output from GDB to avoid overfull
33487 @c box in TeX.
33488 @smallexample
33489 (gdb)
33490 -gdb-version
33491 ~GNU gdb 5.2.1
33492 ~Copyright 2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
33493 ~GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License, and
33494 ~you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it under
33495 ~ certain conditions.
33496 ~Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
33497 ~There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty" for
33498 ~ details.
33499 ~This GDB was configured as
33500 "--host=sparc-sun-solaris2.5.1 --target=ppc-eabi".
33501 ^done
33502 (gdb)
33503 @end smallexample
33504
33505 @subheading The @code{-list-thread-groups} Command
33506 @findex -list-thread-groups
33507
33508 @subheading Synopsis
33509
33510 @smallexample
33511 -list-thread-groups [ --available ] [ --recurse 1 ] [ @var{group} ... ]
33512 @end smallexample
33513
33514 Lists thread groups (@pxref{Thread groups}). When a single thread
33515 group is passed as the argument, lists the children of that group.
33516 When several thread group are passed, lists information about those
33517 thread groups. Without any parameters, lists information about all
33518 top-level thread groups.
33519
33520 Normally, thread groups that are being debugged are reported.
33521 With the @samp{--available} option, @value{GDBN} reports thread groups
33522 available on the target.
33523
33524 The output of this command may have either a @samp{threads} result or
33525 a @samp{groups} result. The @samp{thread} result has a list of tuples
33526 as value, with each tuple describing a thread (@pxref{GDB/MI Thread
33527 Information}). The @samp{groups} result has a list of tuples as value,
33528 each tuple describing a thread group. If top-level groups are
33529 requested (that is, no parameter is passed), or when several groups
33530 are passed, the output always has a @samp{groups} result. The format
33531 of the @samp{group} result is described below.
33532
33533 To reduce the number of roundtrips it's possible to list thread groups
33534 together with their children, by passing the @samp{--recurse} option
33535 and the recursion depth. Presently, only recursion depth of 1 is
33536 permitted. If this option is present, then every reported thread group
33537 will also include its children, either as @samp{group} or
33538 @samp{threads} field.
33539
33540 In general, any combination of option and parameters is permitted, with
33541 the following caveats:
33542
33543 @itemize @bullet
33544 @item
33545 When a single thread group is passed, the output will typically
33546 be the @samp{threads} result. Because threads may not contain
33547 anything, the @samp{recurse} option will be ignored.
33548
33549 @item
33550 When the @samp{--available} option is passed, limited information may
33551 be available. In particular, the list of threads of a process might
33552 be inaccessible. Further, specifying specific thread groups might
33553 not give any performance advantage over listing all thread groups.
33554 The frontend should assume that @samp{-list-thread-groups --available}
33555 is always an expensive operation and cache the results.
33556
33557 @end itemize
33558
33559 The @samp{groups} result is a list of tuples, where each tuple may
33560 have the following fields:
33561
33562 @table @code
33563 @item id
33564 Identifier of the thread group. This field is always present.
33565 The identifier is an opaque string; frontends should not try to
33566 convert it to an integer, even though it might look like one.
33567
33568 @item type
33569 The type of the thread group. At present, only @samp{process} is a
33570 valid type.
33571
33572 @item pid
33573 The target-specific process identifier. This field is only present
33574 for thread groups of type @samp{process} and only if the process exists.
33575
33576 @item exit-code
33577 The exit code of this group's last exited thread, formatted in octal.
33578 This field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process} and
33579 only if the process is not running.
33580
33581 @item num_children
33582 The number of children this thread group has. This field may be
33583 absent for an available thread group.
33584
33585 @item threads
33586 This field has a list of tuples as value, each tuple describing a
33587 thread. It may be present if the @samp{--recurse} option is
33588 specified, and it's actually possible to obtain the threads.
33589
33590 @item cores
33591 This field is a list of integers, each identifying a core that one
33592 thread of the group is running on. This field may be absent if
33593 such information is not available.
33594
33595 @item executable
33596 The name of the executable file that corresponds to this thread group.
33597 The field is only present for thread groups of type @samp{process},
33598 and only if there is a corresponding executable file.
33599
33600 @end table
33601
33602 @subheading Example
33603
33604 @smallexample
33605 @value{GDBP}
33606 -list-thread-groups
33607 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2"@}]
33608 -list-thread-groups 17
33609 ^done,threads=[@{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90 (LWP 21257)",
33610 frame=@{level="0",addr="0xffffe410",func="__kernel_vsyscall",args=[]@},state="running"@},
33611 @{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e156b0 (LWP 21254)",
33612 frame=@{level="0",addr="0x0804891f",func="foo",args=[@{name="i",value="10"@}],
33613 file="/tmp/a.c",fullname="/tmp/a.c",line="158"@},state="running"@}]]
33614 -list-thread-groups --available
33615 ^done,groups=[@{id="17",type="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2]@}]
33616 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1
33617 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
33618 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
33619 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},..]
33620 -list-thread-groups --available --recurse 1 17 18
33621 ^done,groups=[@{id="17", types="process",pid="yyy",num_children="2",cores=[1,2],
33622 threads=[@{id="1",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[1]@},
33623 @{id="2",target-id="Thread 0xb7e14b90",cores=[2]@}]@},...]
33624 @end smallexample
33625
33626 @subheading The @code{-info-os} Command
33627 @findex -info-os
33628
33629 @subsubheading Synopsis
33630
33631 @smallexample
33632 -info-os [ @var{type} ]
33633 @end smallexample
33634
33635 If no argument is supplied, the command returns a table of available
33636 operating-system-specific information types. If one of these types is
33637 supplied as an argument @var{type}, then the command returns a table
33638 of data of that type.
33639
33640 The types of information available depend on the target operating
33641 system.
33642
33643 @subsubheading @value{GDBN} Command
33644
33645 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{info os}.
33646
33647 @subsubheading Example
33648
33649 When run on a @sc{gnu}/Linux system, the output will look something
33650 like this:
33651
33652 @smallexample
33653 @value{GDBP}
33654 -info-os
33655 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="10",nr_cols="3",
33656 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="Type"@},
33657 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="Description"@},
33658 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="Title"@}],
33659 body=[item=@{col0="cpus",col1="Listing of all cpus/cores on the system",
33660 col2="CPUs"@},
33661 item=@{col0="files",col1="Listing of all file descriptors",
33662 col2="File descriptors"@},
33663 item=@{col0="modules",col1="Listing of all loaded kernel modules",
33664 col2="Kernel modules"@},
33665 item=@{col0="msg",col1="Listing of all message queues",
33666 col2="Message queues"@},
33667 item=@{col0="processes",col1="Listing of all processes",
33668 col2="Processes"@},
33669 item=@{col0="procgroups",col1="Listing of all process groups",
33670 col2="Process groups"@},
33671 item=@{col0="semaphores",col1="Listing of all semaphores",
33672 col2="Semaphores"@},
33673 item=@{col0="shm",col1="Listing of all shared-memory regions",
33674 col2="Shared-memory regions"@},
33675 item=@{col0="sockets",col1="Listing of all internet-domain sockets",
33676 col2="Sockets"@},
33677 item=@{col0="threads",col1="Listing of all threads",
33678 col2="Threads"@}]
33679 @value{GDBP}
33680 -info-os processes
33681 ^done,OSDataTable=@{nr_rows="190",nr_cols="4",
33682 hdr=[@{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col0",colhdr="pid"@},
33683 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col1",colhdr="user"@},
33684 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col2",colhdr="command"@},
33685 @{width="10",alignment="-1",col_name="col3",colhdr="cores"@}],
33686 body=[item=@{col0="1",col1="root",col2="/sbin/init",col3="0"@},
33687 item=@{col0="2",col1="root",col2="[kthreadd]",col3="1"@},
33688 item=@{col0="3",col1="root",col2="[ksoftirqd/0]",col3="0"@},
33689 ...
33690 item=@{col0="26446",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="0"@},
33691 item=@{col0="28152",col1="stan",col2="bash",col3="1"@}]@}
33692 (gdb)
33693 @end smallexample
33694
33695 (Note that the MI output here includes a @code{"Title"} column that
33696 does not appear in command-line @code{info os}; this column is useful
33697 for MI clients that want to enumerate the types of data, such as in a
33698 popup menu, but is needless clutter on the command line, and
33699 @code{info os} omits it.)
33700
33701 @subheading The @code{-add-inferior} Command
33702 @findex -add-inferior
33703
33704 @subheading Synopsis
33705
33706 @smallexample
33707 -add-inferior
33708 @end smallexample
33709
33710 Creates a new inferior (@pxref{Inferiors and Programs}). The created
33711 inferior is not associated with any executable. Such association may
33712 be established with the @samp{-file-exec-and-symbols} command
33713 (@pxref{GDB/MI File Commands}). The command response has a single
33714 field, @samp{inferior}, whose value is the identifier of the
33715 thread group corresponding to the new inferior.
33716
33717 @subheading Example
33718
33719 @smallexample
33720 @value{GDBP}
33721 -add-inferior
33722 ^done,inferior="i3"
33723 @end smallexample
33724
33725 @subheading The @code{-interpreter-exec} Command
33726 @findex -interpreter-exec
33727
33728 @subheading Synopsis
33729
33730 @smallexample
33731 -interpreter-exec @var{interpreter} @var{command}
33732 @end smallexample
33733 @anchor{-interpreter-exec}
33734
33735 Execute the specified @var{command} in the given @var{interpreter}.
33736
33737 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
33738
33739 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{interpreter-exec}.
33740
33741 @subheading Example
33742
33743 @smallexample
33744 (gdb)
33745 -interpreter-exec console "break main"
33746 &"During symbol reading, couldn't parse type; debugger out of date?.\n"
33747 &"During symbol reading, bad structure-type format.\n"
33748 ~"Breakpoint 1 at 0x8074fc6: file ../../src/gdb/main.c, line 743.\n"
33749 ^done
33750 (gdb)
33751 @end smallexample
33752
33753 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-set} Command
33754 @findex -inferior-tty-set
33755
33756 @subheading Synopsis
33757
33758 @smallexample
33759 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
33760 @end smallexample
33761
33762 Set terminal for future runs of the program being debugged.
33763
33764 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
33765
33766 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{set inferior-tty} /dev/pts/1.
33767
33768 @subheading Example
33769
33770 @smallexample
33771 (gdb)
33772 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
33773 ^done
33774 (gdb)
33775 @end smallexample
33776
33777 @subheading The @code{-inferior-tty-show} Command
33778 @findex -inferior-tty-show
33779
33780 @subheading Synopsis
33781
33782 @smallexample
33783 -inferior-tty-show
33784 @end smallexample
33785
33786 Show terminal for future runs of program being debugged.
33787
33788 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
33789
33790 The corresponding @value{GDBN} command is @samp{show inferior-tty}.
33791
33792 @subheading Example
33793
33794 @smallexample
33795 (gdb)
33796 -inferior-tty-set /dev/pts/1
33797 ^done
33798 (gdb)
33799 -inferior-tty-show
33800 ^done,inferior_tty_terminal="/dev/pts/1"
33801 (gdb)
33802 @end smallexample
33803
33804 @subheading The @code{-enable-timings} Command
33805 @findex -enable-timings
33806
33807 @subheading Synopsis
33808
33809 @smallexample
33810 -enable-timings [yes | no]
33811 @end smallexample
33812
33813 Toggle the printing of the wallclock, user and system times for an MI
33814 command as a field in its output. This command is to help frontend
33815 developers optimize the performance of their code. No argument is
33816 equivalent to @samp{yes}.
33817
33818 @subheading @value{GDBN} Command
33819
33820 No equivalent.
33821
33822 @subheading Example
33823
33824 @smallexample
33825 (gdb)
33826 -enable-timings
33827 ^done
33828 (gdb)
33829 -break-insert main
33830 ^done,bkpt=@{number="1",type="breakpoint",disp="keep",enabled="y",
33831 addr="0x080484ed",func="main",file="myprog.c",
33832 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73",thread-groups=["i1"],
33833 times="0"@},
33834 time=@{wallclock="0.05185",user="0.00800",system="0.00000"@}
33835 (gdb)
33836 -enable-timings no
33837 ^done
33838 (gdb)
33839 -exec-run
33840 ^running
33841 (gdb)
33842 *stopped,reason="breakpoint-hit",disp="keep",bkptno="1",thread-id="0",
33843 frame=@{addr="0x080484ed",func="main",args=[@{name="argc",value="1"@},
33844 @{name="argv",value="0xbfb60364"@}],file="myprog.c",
33845 fullname="/home/nickrob/myprog.c",line="73"@}
33846 (gdb)
33847 @end smallexample
33848
33849 @node Annotations
33850 @chapter @value{GDBN} Annotations
33851
33852 This chapter describes annotations in @value{GDBN}. Annotations were
33853 designed to interface @value{GDBN} to graphical user interfaces or other
33854 similar programs which want to interact with @value{GDBN} at a
33855 relatively high level.
33856
33857 The annotation mechanism has largely been superseded by @sc{gdb/mi}
33858 (@pxref{GDB/MI}).
33859
33860 @ignore
33861 This is Edition @value{EDITION}, @value{DATE}.
33862 @end ignore
33863
33864 @menu
33865 * Annotations Overview:: What annotations are; the general syntax.
33866 * Server Prefix:: Issuing a command without affecting user state.
33867 * Prompting:: Annotations marking @value{GDBN}'s need for input.
33868 * Errors:: Annotations for error messages.
33869 * Invalidation:: Some annotations describe things now invalid.
33870 * Annotations for Running::
33871 Whether the program is running, how it stopped, etc.
33872 * Source Annotations:: Annotations describing source code.
33873 @end menu
33874
33875 @node Annotations Overview
33876 @section What is an Annotation?
33877 @cindex annotations
33878
33879 Annotations start with a newline character, two @samp{control-z}
33880 characters, and the name of the annotation. If there is no additional
33881 information associated with this annotation, the name of the annotation
33882 is followed immediately by a newline. If there is additional
33883 information, the name of the annotation is followed by a space, the
33884 additional information, and a newline. The additional information
33885 cannot contain newline characters.
33886
33887 Any output not beginning with a newline and two @samp{control-z}
33888 characters denotes literal output from @value{GDBN}. Currently there is
33889 no need for @value{GDBN} to output a newline followed by two
33890 @samp{control-z} characters, but if there was such a need, the
33891 annotations could be extended with an @samp{escape} annotation which
33892 means those three characters as output.
33893
33894 The annotation @var{level}, which is specified using the
33895 @option{--annotate} command line option (@pxref{Mode Options}), controls
33896 how much information @value{GDBN} prints together with its prompt,
33897 values of expressions, source lines, and other types of output. Level 0
33898 is for no annotations, level 1 is for use when @value{GDBN} is run as a
33899 subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 3 is the maximum annotation suitable
33900 for programs that control @value{GDBN}, and level 2 annotations have
33901 been made obsolete (@pxref{Limitations, , Limitations of the Annotation
33902 Interface, annotate, GDB's Obsolete Annotations}).
33903
33904 @table @code
33905 @kindex set annotate
33906 @item set annotate @var{level}
33907 The @value{GDBN} command @code{set annotate} sets the level of
33908 annotations to the specified @var{level}.
33909
33910 @item show annotate
33911 @kindex show annotate
33912 Show the current annotation level.
33913 @end table
33914
33915 This chapter describes level 3 annotations.
33916
33917 A simple example of starting up @value{GDBN} with annotations is:
33918
33919 @smallexample
33920 $ @kbd{gdb --annotate=3}
33921 GNU gdb 6.0
33922 Copyright 2003 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
33923 GDB is free software, covered by the GNU General Public License,
33924 and you are welcome to change it and/or distribute copies of it
33925 under certain conditions.
33926 Type "show copying" to see the conditions.
33927 There is absolutely no warranty for GDB. Type "show warranty"
33928 for details.
33929 This GDB was configured as "i386-pc-linux-gnu"
33930
33931 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
33932 (@value{GDBP})
33933 ^Z^Zprompt
33934 @kbd{quit}
33935
33936 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
33937 $
33938 @end smallexample
33939
33940 Here @samp{quit} is input to @value{GDBN}; the rest is output from
33941 @value{GDBN}. The three lines beginning @samp{^Z^Z} (where @samp{^Z}
33942 denotes a @samp{control-z} character) are annotations; the rest is
33943 output from @value{GDBN}.
33944
33945 @node Server Prefix
33946 @section The Server Prefix
33947 @cindex server prefix
33948
33949 If you prefix a command with @samp{server } then it will not affect
33950 the command history, nor will it affect @value{GDBN}'s notion of which
33951 command to repeat if @key{RET} is pressed on a line by itself. This
33952 means that commands can be run behind a user's back by a front-end in
33953 a transparent manner.
33954
33955 The @code{server } prefix does not affect the recording of values into
33956 the value history; to print a value without recording it into the
33957 value history, use the @code{output} command instead of the
33958 @code{print} command.
33959
33960 Using this prefix also disables confirmation requests
33961 (@pxref{confirmation requests}).
33962
33963 @node Prompting
33964 @section Annotation for @value{GDBN} Input
33965
33966 @cindex annotations for prompts
33967 When @value{GDBN} prompts for input, it annotates this fact so it is possible
33968 to know when to send output, when the output from a given command is
33969 over, etc.
33970
33971 Different kinds of input each have a different @dfn{input type}. Each
33972 input type has three annotations: a @code{pre-} annotation, which
33973 denotes the beginning of any prompt which is being output, a plain
33974 annotation, which denotes the end of the prompt, and then a @code{post-}
33975 annotation which denotes the end of any echo which may (or may not) be
33976 associated with the input. For example, the @code{prompt} input type
33977 features the following annotations:
33978
33979 @smallexample
33980 ^Z^Zpre-prompt
33981 ^Z^Zprompt
33982 ^Z^Zpost-prompt
33983 @end smallexample
33984
33985 The input types are
33986
33987 @table @code
33988 @findex pre-prompt annotation
33989 @findex prompt annotation
33990 @findex post-prompt annotation
33991 @item prompt
33992 When @value{GDBN} is prompting for a command (the main @value{GDBN} prompt).
33993
33994 @findex pre-commands annotation
33995 @findex commands annotation
33996 @findex post-commands annotation
33997 @item commands
33998 When @value{GDBN} prompts for a set of commands, like in the @code{commands}
33999 command. The annotations are repeated for each command which is input.
34000
34001 @findex pre-overload-choice annotation
34002 @findex overload-choice annotation
34003 @findex post-overload-choice annotation
34004 @item overload-choice
34005 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to select between various overloaded functions.
34006
34007 @findex pre-query annotation
34008 @findex query annotation
34009 @findex post-query annotation
34010 @item query
34011 When @value{GDBN} wants the user to confirm a potentially dangerous operation.
34012
34013 @findex pre-prompt-for-continue annotation
34014 @findex prompt-for-continue annotation
34015 @findex post-prompt-for-continue annotation
34016 @item prompt-for-continue
34017 When @value{GDBN} is asking the user to press return to continue. Note: Don't
34018 expect this to work well; instead use @code{set height 0} to disable
34019 prompting. This is because the counting of lines is buggy in the
34020 presence of annotations.
34021 @end table
34022
34023 @node Errors
34024 @section Errors
34025 @cindex annotations for errors, warnings and interrupts
34026
34027 @findex quit annotation
34028 @smallexample
34029 ^Z^Zquit
34030 @end smallexample
34031
34032 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an interrupt.
34033
34034 @findex error annotation
34035 @smallexample
34036 ^Z^Zerror
34037 @end smallexample
34038
34039 This annotation occurs right before @value{GDBN} responds to an error.
34040
34041 Quit and error annotations indicate that any annotations which @value{GDBN} was
34042 in the middle of may end abruptly. For example, if a
34043 @code{value-history-begin} annotation is followed by a @code{error}, one
34044 cannot expect to receive the matching @code{value-history-end}. One
34045 cannot expect not to receive it either, however; an error annotation
34046 does not necessarily mean that @value{GDBN} is immediately returning all the way
34047 to the top level.
34048
34049 @findex error-begin annotation
34050 A quit or error annotation may be preceded by
34051
34052 @smallexample
34053 ^Z^Zerror-begin
34054 @end smallexample
34055
34056 Any output between that and the quit or error annotation is the error
34057 message.
34058
34059 Warning messages are not yet annotated.
34060 @c If we want to change that, need to fix warning(), type_error(),
34061 @c range_error(), and possibly other places.
34062
34063 @node Invalidation
34064 @section Invalidation Notices
34065
34066 @cindex annotations for invalidation messages
34067 The following annotations say that certain pieces of state may have
34068 changed.
34069
34070 @table @code
34071 @findex frames-invalid annotation
34072 @item ^Z^Zframes-invalid
34073
34074 The frames (for example, output from the @code{backtrace} command) may
34075 have changed.
34076
34077 @findex breakpoints-invalid annotation
34078 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoints-invalid
34079
34080 The breakpoints may have changed. For example, the user just added or
34081 deleted a breakpoint.
34082 @end table
34083
34084 @node Annotations for Running
34085 @section Running the Program
34086 @cindex annotations for running programs
34087
34088 @findex starting annotation
34089 @findex stopping annotation
34090 When the program starts executing due to a @value{GDBN} command such as
34091 @code{step} or @code{continue},
34092
34093 @smallexample
34094 ^Z^Zstarting
34095 @end smallexample
34096
34097 is output. When the program stops,
34098
34099 @smallexample
34100 ^Z^Zstopped
34101 @end smallexample
34102
34103 is output. Before the @code{stopped} annotation, a variety of
34104 annotations describe how the program stopped.
34105
34106 @table @code
34107 @findex exited annotation
34108 @item ^Z^Zexited @var{exit-status}
34109 The program exited, and @var{exit-status} is the exit status (zero for
34110 successful exit, otherwise nonzero).
34111
34112 @findex signalled annotation
34113 @findex signal-name annotation
34114 @findex signal-name-end annotation
34115 @findex signal-string annotation
34116 @findex signal-string-end annotation
34117 @item ^Z^Zsignalled
34118 The program exited with a signal. After the @code{^Z^Zsignalled}, the
34119 annotation continues:
34120
34121 @smallexample
34122 @var{intro-text}
34123 ^Z^Zsignal-name
34124 @var{name}
34125 ^Z^Zsignal-name-end
34126 @var{middle-text}
34127 ^Z^Zsignal-string
34128 @var{string}
34129 ^Z^Zsignal-string-end
34130 @var{end-text}
34131 @end smallexample
34132
34133 @noindent
34134 where @var{name} is the name of the signal, such as @code{SIGILL} or
34135 @code{SIGSEGV}, and @var{string} is the explanation of the signal, such
34136 as @code{Illegal Instruction} or @code{Segmentation fault}. The arguments
34137 @var{intro-text}, @var{middle-text}, and @var{end-text} are for the
34138 user's benefit and have no particular format.
34139
34140 @findex signal annotation
34141 @item ^Z^Zsignal
34142 The syntax of this annotation is just like @code{signalled}, but @value{GDBN} is
34143 just saying that the program received the signal, not that it was
34144 terminated with it.
34145
34146 @findex breakpoint annotation
34147 @item ^Z^Zbreakpoint @var{number}
34148 The program hit breakpoint number @var{number}.
34149
34150 @findex watchpoint annotation
34151 @item ^Z^Zwatchpoint @var{number}
34152 The program hit watchpoint number @var{number}.
34153 @end table
34154
34155 @node Source Annotations
34156 @section Displaying Source
34157 @cindex annotations for source display
34158
34159 @findex source annotation
34160 The following annotation is used instead of displaying source code:
34161
34162 @smallexample
34163 ^Z^Zsource @var{filename}:@var{line}:@var{character}:@var{middle}:@var{addr}
34164 @end smallexample
34165
34166 where @var{filename} is an absolute file name indicating which source
34167 file, @var{line} is the line number within that file (where 1 is the
34168 first line in the file), @var{character} is the character position
34169 within the file (where 0 is the first character in the file) (for most
34170 debug formats this will necessarily point to the beginning of a line),
34171 @var{middle} is @samp{middle} if @var{addr} is in the middle of the
34172 line, or @samp{beg} if @var{addr} is at the beginning of the line, and
34173 @var{addr} is the address in the target program associated with the
34174 source which is being displayed. The @var{addr} is in the form @samp{0x}
34175 followed by one or more lowercase hex digits (note that this does not
34176 depend on the language).
34177
34178 @node JIT Interface
34179 @chapter JIT Compilation Interface
34180 @cindex just-in-time compilation
34181 @cindex JIT compilation interface
34182
34183 This chapter documents @value{GDBN}'s @dfn{just-in-time} (JIT) compilation
34184 interface. A JIT compiler is a program or library that generates native
34185 executable code at runtime and executes it, usually in order to achieve good
34186 performance while maintaining platform independence.
34187
34188 Programs that use JIT compilation are normally difficult to debug because
34189 portions of their code are generated at runtime, instead of being loaded from
34190 object files, which is where @value{GDBN} normally finds the program's symbols
34191 and debug information. In order to debug programs that use JIT compilation,
34192 @value{GDBN} has an interface that allows the program to register in-memory
34193 symbol files with @value{GDBN} at runtime.
34194
34195 If you are using @value{GDBN} to debug a program that uses this interface, then
34196 it should work transparently so long as you have not stripped the binary. If
34197 you are developing a JIT compiler, then the interface is documented in the rest
34198 of this chapter. At this time, the only known client of this interface is the
34199 LLVM JIT.
34200
34201 Broadly speaking, the JIT interface mirrors the dynamic loader interface. The
34202 JIT compiler communicates with @value{GDBN} by writing data into a global
34203 variable and calling a fuction at a well-known symbol. When @value{GDBN}
34204 attaches, it reads a linked list of symbol files from the global variable to
34205 find existing code, and puts a breakpoint in the function so that it can find
34206 out about additional code.
34207
34208 @menu
34209 * Declarations:: Relevant C struct declarations
34210 * Registering Code:: Steps to register code
34211 * Unregistering Code:: Steps to unregister code
34212 * Custom Debug Info:: Emit debug information in a custom format
34213 @end menu
34214
34215 @node Declarations
34216 @section JIT Declarations
34217
34218 These are the relevant struct declarations that a C program should include to
34219 implement the interface:
34220
34221 @smallexample
34222 typedef enum
34223 @{
34224 JIT_NOACTION = 0,
34225 JIT_REGISTER_FN,
34226 JIT_UNREGISTER_FN
34227 @} jit_actions_t;
34228
34229 struct jit_code_entry
34230 @{
34231 struct jit_code_entry *next_entry;
34232 struct jit_code_entry *prev_entry;
34233 const char *symfile_addr;
34234 uint64_t symfile_size;
34235 @};
34236
34237 struct jit_descriptor
34238 @{
34239 uint32_t version;
34240 /* This type should be jit_actions_t, but we use uint32_t
34241 to be explicit about the bitwidth. */
34242 uint32_t action_flag;
34243 struct jit_code_entry *relevant_entry;
34244 struct jit_code_entry *first_entry;
34245 @};
34246
34247 /* GDB puts a breakpoint in this function. */
34248 void __attribute__((noinline)) __jit_debug_register_code() @{ @};
34249
34250 /* Make sure to specify the version statically, because the
34251 debugger may check the version before we can set it. */
34252 struct jit_descriptor __jit_debug_descriptor = @{ 1, 0, 0, 0 @};
34253 @end smallexample
34254
34255 If the JIT is multi-threaded, then it is important that the JIT synchronize any
34256 modifications to this global data properly, which can easily be done by putting
34257 a global mutex around modifications to these structures.
34258
34259 @node Registering Code
34260 @section Registering Code
34261
34262 To register code with @value{GDBN}, the JIT should follow this protocol:
34263
34264 @itemize @bullet
34265 @item
34266 Generate an object file in memory with symbols and other desired debug
34267 information. The file must include the virtual addresses of the sections.
34268
34269 @item
34270 Create a code entry for the file, which gives the start and size of the symbol
34271 file.
34272
34273 @item
34274 Add it to the linked list in the JIT descriptor.
34275
34276 @item
34277 Point the relevant_entry field of the descriptor at the entry.
34278
34279 @item
34280 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_REGISTER} and call
34281 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
34282 @end itemize
34283
34284 When @value{GDBN} is attached and the breakpoint fires, @value{GDBN} uses the
34285 @code{relevant_entry} pointer so it doesn't have to walk the list looking for
34286 new code. However, the linked list must still be maintained in order to allow
34287 @value{GDBN} to attach to a running process and still find the symbol files.
34288
34289 @node Unregistering Code
34290 @section Unregistering Code
34291
34292 If code is freed, then the JIT should use the following protocol:
34293
34294 @itemize @bullet
34295 @item
34296 Remove the code entry corresponding to the code from the linked list.
34297
34298 @item
34299 Point the @code{relevant_entry} field of the descriptor at the code entry.
34300
34301 @item
34302 Set @code{action_flag} to @code{JIT_UNREGISTER} and call
34303 @code{__jit_debug_register_code}.
34304 @end itemize
34305
34306 If the JIT frees or recompiles code without unregistering it, then @value{GDBN}
34307 and the JIT will leak the memory used for the associated symbol files.
34308
34309 @node Custom Debug Info
34310 @section Custom Debug Info
34311 @cindex custom JIT debug info
34312 @cindex JIT debug info reader
34313
34314 Generating debug information in platform-native file formats (like ELF
34315 or COFF) may be an overkill for JIT compilers; especially if all the
34316 debug info is used for is displaying a meaningful backtrace. The
34317 issue can be resolved by having the JIT writers decide on a debug info
34318 format and also provide a reader that parses the debug info generated
34319 by the JIT compiler. This section gives a brief overview on writing
34320 such a parser. More specific details can be found in the source file
34321 @file{gdb/jit-reader.in}, which is also installed as a header at
34322 @file{@var{includedir}/gdb/jit-reader.h} for easy inclusion.
34323
34324 The reader is implemented as a shared object (so this functionality is
34325 not available on platforms which don't allow loading shared objects at
34326 runtime). Two @value{GDBN} commands, @code{jit-reader-load} and
34327 @code{jit-reader-unload} are provided, to be used to load and unload
34328 the readers from a preconfigured directory. Once loaded, the shared
34329 object is used the parse the debug information emitted by the JIT
34330 compiler.
34331
34332 @menu
34333 * Using JIT Debug Info Readers:: How to use supplied readers correctly
34334 * Writing JIT Debug Info Readers:: Creating a debug-info reader
34335 @end menu
34336
34337 @node Using JIT Debug Info Readers
34338 @subsection Using JIT Debug Info Readers
34339 @kindex jit-reader-load
34340 @kindex jit-reader-unload
34341
34342 Readers can be loaded and unloaded using the @code{jit-reader-load}
34343 and @code{jit-reader-unload} commands.
34344
34345 @table @code
34346 @item jit-reader-load @var{reader}
34347 Load the JIT reader named @var{reader}, which is a shared
34348 object specified as either an absolute or a relative file name. In
34349 the latter case, @value{GDBN} will try to load the reader from a
34350 pre-configured directory, usually @file{@var{libdir}/gdb/} on a UNIX
34351 system (here @var{libdir} is the system library directory, often
34352 @file{/usr/local/lib}).
34353
34354 Only one reader can be active at a time; trying to load a second
34355 reader when one is already loaded will result in @value{GDBN}
34356 reporting an error. A new JIT reader can be loaded by first unloading
34357 the current one using @code{jit-reader-unload} and then invoking
34358 @code{jit-reader-load}.
34359
34360 @item jit-reader-unload
34361 Unload the currently loaded JIT reader.
34362
34363 @end table
34364
34365 @node Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
34366 @subsection Writing JIT Debug Info Readers
34367 @cindex writing JIT debug info readers
34368
34369 As mentioned, a reader is essentially a shared object conforming to a
34370 certain ABI. This ABI is described in @file{jit-reader.h}.
34371
34372 @file{jit-reader.h} defines the structures, macros and functions
34373 required to write a reader. It is installed (along with
34374 @value{GDBN}), in @file{@var{includedir}/gdb} where @var{includedir} is
34375 the system include directory.
34376
34377 Readers need to be released under a GPL compatible license. A reader
34378 can be declared as released under such a license by placing the macro
34379 @code{GDB_DECLARE_GPL_COMPATIBLE_READER} in a source file.
34380
34381 The entry point for readers is the symbol @code{gdb_init_reader},
34382 which is expected to be a function with the prototype
34383
34384 @findex gdb_init_reader
34385 @smallexample
34386 extern struct gdb_reader_funcs *gdb_init_reader (void);
34387 @end smallexample
34388
34389 @cindex @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs}
34390
34391 @code{struct gdb_reader_funcs} contains a set of pointers to callback
34392 functions. These functions are executed to read the debug info
34393 generated by the JIT compiler (@code{read}), to unwind stack frames
34394 (@code{unwind}) and to create canonical frame IDs
34395 (@code{get_Frame_id}). It also has a callback that is called when the
34396 reader is being unloaded (@code{destroy}). The struct looks like this
34397
34398 @smallexample
34399 struct gdb_reader_funcs
34400 @{
34401 /* Must be set to GDB_READER_INTERFACE_VERSION. */
34402 int reader_version;
34403
34404 /* For use by the reader. */
34405 void *priv_data;
34406
34407 gdb_read_debug_info *read;
34408 gdb_unwind_frame *unwind;
34409 gdb_get_frame_id *get_frame_id;
34410 gdb_destroy_reader *destroy;
34411 @};
34412 @end smallexample
34413
34414 @cindex @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks}
34415 @cindex @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}
34416
34417 The callbacks are provided with another set of callbacks by
34418 @value{GDBN} to do their job. For @code{read}, these callbacks are
34419 passed in a @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} and for @code{unwind}
34420 and @code{get_frame_id}, in a @code{struct gdb_unwind_callbacks}.
34421 @code{struct gdb_symbol_callbacks} has callbacks to create new object
34422 files and new symbol tables inside those object files. @code{struct
34423 gdb_unwind_callbacks} has callbacks to read registers off the current
34424 frame and to write out the values of the registers in the previous
34425 frame. Both have a callback (@code{target_read}) to read bytes off the
34426 target's address space.
34427
34428 @node In-Process Agent
34429 @chapter In-Process Agent
34430 @cindex debugging agent
34431 The traditional debugging model is conceptually low-speed, but works fine,
34432 because most bugs can be reproduced in debugging-mode execution. However,
34433 as multi-core or many-core processors are becoming mainstream, and
34434 multi-threaded programs become more and more popular, there should be more
34435 and more bugs that only manifest themselves at normal-mode execution, for
34436 example, thread races, because debugger's interference with the program's
34437 timing may conceal the bugs. On the other hand, in some applications,
34438 it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt the program's execution
34439 long enough for the developer to learn anything helpful about its behavior.
34440 If the program's correctness depends on its real-time behavior, delays
34441 introduced by a debugger might cause the program to fail, even when the
34442 code itself is correct. It is useful to be able to observe the program's
34443 behavior without interrupting it.
34444
34445 Therefore, traditional debugging model is too intrusive to reproduce
34446 some bugs. In order to reduce the interference with the program, we can
34447 reduce the number of operations performed by debugger. The
34448 @dfn{In-Process Agent}, a shared library, is running within the same
34449 process with inferior, and is able to perform some debugging operations
34450 itself. As a result, debugger is only involved when necessary, and
34451 performance of debugging can be improved accordingly. Note that
34452 interference with program can be reduced but can't be removed completely,
34453 because the in-process agent will still stop or slow down the program.
34454
34455 The in-process agent can interpret and execute Agent Expressions
34456 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}) during performing debugging operations. The
34457 agent expressions can be used for different purposes, such as collecting
34458 data in tracepoints, and condition evaluation in breakpoints.
34459
34460 @anchor{Control Agent}
34461 You can control whether the in-process agent is used as an aid for
34462 debugging with the following commands:
34463
34464 @table @code
34465 @kindex set agent on
34466 @item set agent on
34467 Causes the in-process agent to perform some operations on behalf of the
34468 debugger. Just which operations requested by the user will be done
34469 by the in-process agent depends on the its capabilities. For example,
34470 if you request to evaluate breakpoint conditions in the in-process agent,
34471 and the in-process agent has such capability as well, then breakpoint
34472 conditions will be evaluated in the in-process agent.
34473
34474 @kindex set agent off
34475 @item set agent off
34476 Disables execution of debugging operations by the in-process agent. All
34477 of the operations will be performed by @value{GDBN}.
34478
34479 @kindex show agent
34480 @item show agent
34481 Display the current setting of execution of debugging operations by
34482 the in-process agent.
34483 @end table
34484
34485 @menu
34486 * In-Process Agent Protocol::
34487 @end menu
34488
34489 @node In-Process Agent Protocol
34490 @section In-Process Agent Protocol
34491 @cindex in-process agent protocol
34492
34493 The in-process agent is able to communicate with both @value{GDBN} and
34494 GDBserver (@pxref{In-Process Agent}). This section documents the protocol
34495 used for communications between @value{GDBN} or GDBserver and the IPA.
34496 In general, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver sends commands
34497 (@pxref{IPA Protocol Commands}) and data to in-process agent, and then
34498 in-process agent replies back with the return result of the command, or
34499 some other information. The data sent to in-process agent is composed
34500 of primitive data types, such as 4-byte or 8-byte type, and composite
34501 types, which are called objects (@pxref{IPA Protocol Objects}).
34502
34503 @menu
34504 * IPA Protocol Objects::
34505 * IPA Protocol Commands::
34506 @end menu
34507
34508 @node IPA Protocol Objects
34509 @subsection IPA Protocol Objects
34510 @cindex ipa protocol objects
34511
34512 The commands sent to and results received from agent may contain some
34513 complex data types called @dfn{objects}.
34514
34515 The in-process agent is running on the same machine with @value{GDBN}
34516 or GDBserver, so it doesn't have to handle as much differences between
34517 two ends as remote protocol (@pxref{Remote Protocol}) tries to handle.
34518 However, there are still some differences of two ends in two processes:
34519
34520 @enumerate
34521 @item
34522 word size. On some 64-bit machines, @value{GDBN} or GDBserver can be
34523 compiled as a 64-bit executable, while in-process agent is a 32-bit one.
34524 @item
34525 ABI. Some machines may have multiple types of ABI, @value{GDBN} or
34526 GDBserver is compiled with one, and in-process agent is compiled with
34527 the other one.
34528 @end enumerate
34529
34530 Here are the IPA Protocol Objects:
34531
34532 @enumerate
34533 @item
34534 agent expression object. It represents an agent expression
34535 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}).
34536 @anchor{agent expression object}
34537 @item
34538 tracepoint action object. It represents a tracepoint action
34539 (@pxref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint Action Lists}) to collect registers,
34540 memory, static trace data and to evaluate expression.
34541 @anchor{tracepoint action object}
34542 @item
34543 tracepoint object. It represents a tracepoint (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
34544 @anchor{tracepoint object}
34545
34546 @end enumerate
34547
34548 The following table describes important attributes of each IPA protocol
34549 object:
34550
34551 @multitable @columnfractions .30 .20 .50
34552 @headitem Name @tab Size @tab Description
34553 @item @emph{agent expression object} @tab @tab
34554 @item length @tab 4 @tab length of bytes code
34555 @item byte code @tab @var{length} @tab contents of byte code
34556 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting memory} @tab @tab
34557 @item 'M' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
34558 @item addr @tab 8 @tab if @var{basereg} is @samp{-1}, @var{addr} is the
34559 address of the lowest byte to collect, otherwise @var{addr} is the offset
34560 of @var{basereg} for memory collecting.
34561 @item len @tab 8 @tab length of memory for collecting
34562 @item basereg @tab 4 @tab the register number containing the starting
34563 memory address for collecting.
34564 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting registers} @tab @tab
34565 @item 'R' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
34566 @item @emph{tracepoint action for collecting static trace data} @tab @tab
34567 @item 'L' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
34568 @item @emph{tracepoint action for expression evaluation} @tab @tab
34569 @item 'X' @tab 1 @tab type of tracepoint action
34570 @item agent expression @tab length of @tab @ref{agent expression object}
34571 @item @emph{tracepoint object} @tab @tab
34572 @item number @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint
34573 @item address @tab 8 @tab address of tracepoint inserted on
34574 @item type @tab 4 @tab type of tracepoint
34575 @item enabled @tab 1 @tab enable or disable of tracepoint
34576 @item step_count @tab 8 @tab step
34577 @item pass_count @tab 8 @tab pass
34578 @item numactions @tab 4 @tab number of tracepoint actions
34579 @item hit count @tab 8 @tab hit count
34580 @item trace frame usage @tab 8 @tab trace frame usage
34581 @item compiled_cond @tab 8 @tab compiled condition
34582 @item orig_size @tab 8 @tab orig size
34583 @item condition @tab 4 if condition is NULL otherwise length of
34584 @ref{agent expression object}
34585 @tab zero if condition is NULL, otherwise is
34586 @ref{agent expression object}
34587 @item actions @tab variable
34588 @tab numactions number of @ref{tracepoint action object}
34589 @end multitable
34590
34591 @node IPA Protocol Commands
34592 @subsection IPA Protocol Commands
34593 @cindex ipa protocol commands
34594
34595 The spaces in each command are delimiters to ease reading this commands
34596 specification. They don't exist in real commands.
34597
34598 @table @samp
34599
34600 @item FastTrace:@var{tracepoint_object} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}
34601 Installs a new fast tracepoint described by @var{tracepoint_object}
34602 (@pxref{tracepoint object}). The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head}, 8-byte long, is the
34603 head of @dfn{jumppad}, which is used to jump to data collection routine
34604 in IPA finally.
34605
34606 Replies:
34607 @table @samp
34608 @item OK @var{target_address} @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} @var{fjump_size} @var{fjump}
34609 @var{target_address} is address of tracepoint in the inferior.
34610 The @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} is updated head of jumppad. Both of
34611 @var{target_address} and @var{gdb_jump_pad_head} are 8-byte long.
34612 The @var{fjump} contains a sequence of instructions jump to jumppad entry.
34613 The @var{fjump_size}, 4-byte long, is the size of @var{fjump}.
34614 @item E @var{NN}
34615 for an error
34616
34617 @end table
34618
34619 @item close
34620 Closes the in-process agent. This command is sent when @value{GDBN} or GDBserver
34621 is about to kill inferiors.
34622
34623 @item qTfSTM
34624 @xref{qTfSTM}.
34625 @item qTsSTM
34626 @xref{qTsSTM}.
34627 @item qTSTMat
34628 @xref{qTSTMat}.
34629 @item probe_marker_at:@var{address}
34630 Asks in-process agent to probe the marker at @var{address}.
34631
34632 Replies:
34633 @table @samp
34634 @item E @var{NN}
34635 for an error
34636 @end table
34637 @item unprobe_marker_at:@var{address}
34638 Asks in-process agent to unprobe the marker at @var{address}.
34639 @end table
34640
34641 @node GDB Bugs
34642 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
34643 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
34644 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
34645
34646 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
34647
34648 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
34649 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
34650 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
34651 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
34652
34653 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
34654 information that enables us to fix the bug.
34655
34656 @menu
34657 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
34658 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
34659 @end menu
34660
34661 @node Bug Criteria
34662 @section Have You Found a Bug?
34663 @cindex bug criteria
34664
34665 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
34666
34667 @itemize @bullet
34668 @cindex fatal signal
34669 @cindex debugger crash
34670 @cindex crash of debugger
34671 @item
34672 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
34673 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
34674
34675 @cindex error on valid input
34676 @item
34677 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
34678 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
34679 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
34680
34681 @cindex invalid input
34682 @item
34683 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
34684 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
34685 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
34686 for traditional practice''.
34687
34688 @item
34689 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
34690 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
34691 @end itemize
34692
34693 @node Bug Reporting
34694 @section How to Report Bugs
34695 @cindex bug reports
34696 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
34697
34698 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
34699 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
34700 contact that organization first.
34701
34702 You can find contact information for many support companies and
34703 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
34704 distribution.
34705 @c should add a web page ref...
34706
34707 @ifset BUGURL
34708 @ifset BUGURL_DEFAULT
34709 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
34710 @value{GDBN}. The preferred method is to submit them directly using
34711 @uref{http://www.gnu.org/software/gdb/bugs/, @value{GDBN}'s Bugs web
34712 page}. Alternatively, the @email{bug-gdb@@gnu.org, e-mail gateway} can
34713 be used.
34714
34715 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
34716 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
34717 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
34718 @samp{bug-gdb}.
34719
34720 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
34721 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
34722 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
34723 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
34724 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
34725 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
34726 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
34727 bug reports to the mailing list.
34728 @end ifset
34729 @ifclear BUGURL_DEFAULT
34730 In any event, we also recommend that you submit bug reports for
34731 @value{GDBN} to @value{BUGURL}.
34732 @end ifclear
34733 @end ifset
34734
34735 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
34736 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
34737 fact or leave it out, state it!
34738
34739 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
34740 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
34741 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
34742 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
34743 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
34744 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
34745 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
34746 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
34747 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
34748
34749 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
34750 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
34751 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
34752 self-contained.
34753
34754 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
34755 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
34756 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
34757 bugs properly.
34758
34759 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
34760
34761 @itemize @bullet
34762 @item
34763 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
34764 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
34765 version}.
34766
34767 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
34768 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
34769
34770 @item
34771 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
34772 version number.
34773
34774 @item
34775 The details of the @value{GDBN} build-time configuration.
34776 @value{GDBN} shows these details if you invoke it with the
34777 @option{--configuration} command-line option, or if you type
34778 @code{show configuration} at @value{GDBN}'s prompt.
34779
34780 @item
34781 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.@:
34782 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
34783
34784 @item
34785 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
34786 debugging---e.g.@: ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
34787 C Compiler''. For @value{NGCC}, you can say @kbd{@value{GCC} --version}
34788 to get this information; for other compilers, see the documentation for
34789 those compilers.
34790
34791 @item
34792 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
34793 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
34794 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
34795 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
34796
34797 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
34798 and then we might not encounter the bug.
34799
34800 @item
34801 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
34802 reproduce the bug.
34803
34804 @item
34805 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
34806 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
34807
34808 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
34809 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
34810 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
34811 a chance to make a mistake.
34812
34813 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
34814 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
34815 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
34816 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
34817 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
34818 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
34819 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
34820 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
34821
34822 @pindex script
34823 @cindex recording a session script
34824 To collect all this information, you can use a session recording program
34825 such as @command{script}, which is available on many Unix systems.
34826 Just run your @value{GDBN} session inside @command{script} and then
34827 include the @file{typescript} file with your bug report.
34828
34829 Another way to record a @value{GDBN} session is to run @value{GDBN}
34830 inside Emacs and then save the entire buffer to a file.
34831
34832 @item
34833 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
34834 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
34835 it by context, not by line number.
34836
34837 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
34838 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
34839
34840 @end itemize
34841
34842 Here are some things that are not necessary:
34843
34844 @itemize @bullet
34845 @item
34846 A description of the envelope of the bug.
34847
34848 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
34849 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
34850 changes will not affect it.
34851
34852 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
34853 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
34854 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
34855 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
34856
34857 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
34858 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
34859 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
34860 less time, and so on.
34861
34862 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
34863 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
34864
34865 @item
34866 A patch for the bug.
34867
34868 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
34869 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
34870 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
34871 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
34872
34873 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
34874 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
34875 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
34876 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
34877
34878 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
34879 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
34880 help us to understand.
34881
34882 @item
34883 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
34884
34885 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
34886 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
34887 @end itemize
34888
34889 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
34890 @c and consists of the two following files:
34891 @c rluser.texi
34892 @c hsuser.texi
34893 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
34894 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
34895 @ifclear SYSTEM_READLINE
34896 @include rluser.texi
34897 @include hsuser.texi
34898 @end ifclear
34899
34900 @node In Memoriam
34901 @appendix In Memoriam
34902
34903 The @value{GDBN} project mourns the loss of the following long-time
34904 contributors:
34905
34906 @table @code
34907 @item Fred Fish
34908 Fred was a long-standing contributor to @value{GDBN} (1991-2006), and
34909 to Free Software in general. Outside of @value{GDBN}, he was known in
34910 the Amiga world for his series of Fish Disks, and the GeekGadget project.
34911
34912 @item Michael Snyder
34913 Michael was one of the Global Maintainers of the @value{GDBN} project,
34914 with contributions recorded as early as 1996, until 2011. In addition
34915 to his day to day participation, he was a large driving force behind
34916 adding Reverse Debugging to @value{GDBN}.
34917 @end table
34918
34919 Beyond their technical contributions to the project, they were also
34920 enjoyable members of the Free Software Community. We will miss them.
34921
34922 @node Formatting Documentation
34923 @appendix Formatting Documentation
34924
34925 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
34926 @cindex reference card
34927 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
34928 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
34929 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
34930 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
34931 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
34932 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
34933
34934 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
34935 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
34936
34937 @smallexample
34938 make refcard.dvi
34939 @end smallexample
34940
34941 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
34942 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
34943 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
34944 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
34945 your @sc{dvi} output program.
34946
34947 @cindex documentation
34948
34949 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
34950 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
34951 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
34952 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
34953 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
34954 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
34955
34956 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
34957 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
34958 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
34959 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
34960 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
34961 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
34962 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
34963 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
34964
34965 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
34966 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
34967 @code{makeinfo}.
34968
34969 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
34970 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
34971 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
34972
34973 @smallexample
34974 cd gdb
34975 make gdb.info
34976 @end smallexample
34977
34978 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
34979 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
34980 Texinfo definitions file.
34981
34982 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
34983 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
34984 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
34985 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
34986 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
34987 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
34988 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
34989
34990 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
34991 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
34992 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
34993 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
34994 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
34995 directory.
34996
34997 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
34998 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the @file{gdb}
34999 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
35000 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
35001
35002 @smallexample
35003 make gdb.dvi
35004 @end smallexample
35005
35006 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
35007
35008 @node Installing GDB
35009 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
35010 @cindex installation
35011
35012 @menu
35013 * Requirements:: Requirements for building @value{GDBN}
35014 * Running Configure:: Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} script
35015 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
35016 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
35017 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
35018 * System-wide configuration:: Having a system-wide init file
35019 @end menu
35020
35021 @node Requirements
35022 @section Requirements for Building @value{GDBN}
35023 @cindex building @value{GDBN}, requirements for
35024
35025 Building @value{GDBN} requires various tools and packages to be available.
35026 Other packages will be used only if they are found.
35027
35028 @heading Tools/Packages Necessary for Building @value{GDBN}
35029 @table @asis
35030 @item ISO C90 compiler
35031 @value{GDBN} is written in ISO C90. It should be buildable with any
35032 working C90 compiler, e.g.@: GCC.
35033
35034 @end table
35035
35036 @heading Tools/Packages Optional for Building @value{GDBN}
35037 @table @asis
35038 @item Expat
35039 @anchor{Expat}
35040 @value{GDBN} can use the Expat XML parsing library. This library may be
35041 included with your operating system distribution; if it is not, you
35042 can get the latest version from @url{http://expat.sourceforge.net}.
35043 The @file{configure} script will search for this library in several
35044 standard locations; if it is installed in an unusual path, you can
35045 use the @option{--with-libexpat-prefix} option to specify its location.
35046
35047 Expat is used for:
35048
35049 @itemize @bullet
35050 @item
35051 Remote protocol memory maps (@pxref{Memory Map Format})
35052 @item
35053 Target descriptions (@pxref{Target Descriptions})
35054 @item
35055 Remote shared library lists (@xref{Library List Format},
35056 or alternatively @pxref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets})
35057 @item
35058 MS-Windows shared libraries (@pxref{Shared Libraries})
35059 @item
35060 Traceframe info (@pxref{Traceframe Info Format})
35061 @item
35062 Branch trace (@pxref{Branch Trace Format},
35063 @pxref{Branch Trace Configuration Format})
35064 @end itemize
35065
35066 @item MPFR
35067 @anchor{MPFR}
35068 @value{GDBN} can use the GNU MPFR multiple-precision floating-point
35069 library. This library may be included with your operating system
35070 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
35071 @url{http://www.mpfr.org}. The @file{configure} script will search
35072 for this library in several standard locations; if it is installed
35073 in an unusual path, you can use the @option{--with-libmpfr-prefix}
35074 option to specify its location.
35075
35076 GNU MPFR is used to emulate target floating-point arithmetic during
35077 expression evaluation when the target uses different floating-point
35078 formats than the host. If GNU MPFR it is not available, @value{GDBN}
35079 will fall back to using host floating-point arithmetic.
35080
35081 @item zlib
35082 @cindex compressed debug sections
35083 @value{GDBN} will use the @samp{zlib} library, if available, to read
35084 compressed debug sections. Some linkers, such as GNU gold, are capable
35085 of producing binaries with compressed debug sections. If @value{GDBN}
35086 is compiled with @samp{zlib}, it will be able to read the debug
35087 information in such binaries.
35088
35089 The @samp{zlib} library is likely included with your operating system
35090 distribution; if it is not, you can get the latest version from
35091 @url{http://zlib.net}.
35092
35093 @item iconv
35094 @value{GDBN}'s features related to character sets (@pxref{Character
35095 Sets}) require a functioning @code{iconv} implementation. If you are
35096 on a GNU system, then this is provided by the GNU C Library. Some
35097 other systems also provide a working @code{iconv}.
35098
35099 If @value{GDBN} is using the @code{iconv} program which is installed
35100 in a non-standard place, you will need to tell @value{GDBN} where to find it.
35101 This is done with @option{--with-iconv-bin} which specifies the
35102 directory that contains the @code{iconv} program.
35103
35104 On systems without @code{iconv}, you can install GNU Libiconv. If you
35105 have previously installed Libiconv, you can use the
35106 @option{--with-libiconv-prefix} option to configure.
35107
35108 @value{GDBN}'s top-level @file{configure} and @file{Makefile} will
35109 arrange to build Libiconv if a directory named @file{libiconv} appears
35110 in the top-most source directory. If Libiconv is built this way, and
35111 if the operating system does not provide a suitable @code{iconv}
35112 implementation, then the just-built library will automatically be used
35113 by @value{GDBN}. One easy way to set this up is to download GNU
35114 Libiconv, unpack it, and then rename the directory holding the
35115 Libiconv source code to @samp{libiconv}.
35116 @end table
35117
35118 @node Running Configure
35119 @section Invoking the @value{GDBN} @file{configure} Script
35120 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
35121 @value{GDBN} comes with a @file{configure} script that automates the process
35122 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
35123 build the @code{gdb} program.
35124 @iftex
35125 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
35126 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
35127 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
35128 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
35129 @end iftex
35130
35131 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
35132 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
35133 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
35134
35135 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
35136 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
35137
35138 @table @code
35139 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
35140 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
35141
35142 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
35143 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
35144
35145 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
35146 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
35147
35148 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
35149 @sc{gnu} include files
35150
35151 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
35152 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
35153
35154 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
35155 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
35156
35157 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
35158 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
35159
35160 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
35161 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
35162
35163 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
35164 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
35165 @end table
35166
35167 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @file{configure}
35168 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
35169 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
35170
35171 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
35172 if you are not already in it; then run @file{configure}. Pass the
35173 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
35174 argument.
35175
35176 For example:
35177
35178 @smallexample
35179 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
35180 ./configure @var{host}
35181 make
35182 @end smallexample
35183
35184 @noindent
35185 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
35186 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
35187 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @file{configure} tries to guess the
35188 correct value by examining your system.)
35189
35190 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
35191 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
35192 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
35193 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
35194
35195 @need 750
35196 @file{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
35197 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
35198 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
35199
35200 @smallexample
35201 sh configure @var{host}
35202 @end smallexample
35203
35204 If you run @file{configure} from a directory that contains source
35205 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
35206 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN},
35207 @file{configure}
35208 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
35209 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
35210
35211 You should run the @file{configure} script from the top directory in the
35212 source tree, the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory. If you run
35213 @file{configure} from one of the subdirectories, you will configure only
35214 that subdirectory. That is usually not what you want. In particular,
35215 if you run the first @file{configure} from the @file{gdb} subdirectory
35216 of the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} directory, you will omit the
35217 configuration of @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, and other sibling
35218 directories of the @file{gdb} subdirectory. This leads to build errors
35219 about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
35220
35221 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
35222 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
35223 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
35224 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
35225 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
35226
35227 @node Separate Objdir
35228 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in Another Directory
35229
35230 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
35231 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
35232 host and target. @file{configure} is designed to make this easy by
35233 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
35234 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
35235 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
35236 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
35237 program specified there.
35238
35239 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @file{configure}
35240 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
35241 (You also need to specify a path to find @file{configure}
35242 itself from your working directory. If the path to @file{configure}
35243 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
35244 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
35245
35246 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
35247 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
35248
35249 @smallexample
35250 @group
35251 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
35252 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
35253 cd ../gdb-sun4
35254 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
35255 make
35256 @end group
35257 @end smallexample
35258
35259 When @file{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
35260 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
35261 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
35262 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
35263 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
35264 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
35265
35266 Make sure that your path to the @file{configure} script has just one
35267 instance of @file{gdb} in it. If your path to @file{configure} looks
35268 like @file{../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/configure}, you are configuring only
35269 one subdirectory of @value{GDBN}, not the whole package. This leads to
35270 build errors about missing include files such as @file{bfd/bfd.h}.
35271
35272 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
35273 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
35274 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
35275 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
35276 You specify a cross-debugging target by
35277 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @file{configure}.
35278
35279 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
35280 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
35281 called @file{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
35282
35283 The @code{Makefile} that @file{configure} generates in each source
35284 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
35285 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
35286 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
35287 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
35288
35289 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
35290 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
35291 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
35292 with each other.
35293
35294 @node Config Names
35295 @section Specifying Names for Hosts and Targets
35296
35297 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @file{configure}
35298 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
35299 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
35300 of information in the following pattern:
35301
35302 @smallexample
35303 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
35304 @end smallexample
35305
35306 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
35307 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
35308 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
35309
35310 The @file{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
35311 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
35312 aliases. @file{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
35313 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
35314 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
35315 abbreviations---for example:
35316
35317 @smallexample
35318 % sh config.sub i386-linux
35319 i386-pc-linux-gnu
35320 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
35321 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
35322 % sh config.sub hp9k700
35323 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
35324 % sh config.sub sun4
35325 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
35326 % sh config.sub sun3
35327 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
35328 % sh config.sub i986v
35329 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
35330 @end smallexample
35331
35332 @noindent
35333 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
35334 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
35335
35336 @node Configure Options
35337 @section @file{configure} Options
35338
35339 Here is a summary of the @file{configure} options and arguments that
35340 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @file{configure} also has
35341 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
35342 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @file{configure}.
35343
35344 @smallexample
35345 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
35346 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
35347 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
35348 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
35349 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
35350 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
35351 @var{host}
35352 @end smallexample
35353
35354 @noindent
35355 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
35356 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
35357 @samp{--}.
35358
35359 @table @code
35360 @item --help
35361 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @file{configure}.
35362
35363 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
35364 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
35365 @file{@var{dir}}.
35366
35367 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
35368 Configure the source to install programs under directory
35369 @file{@var{dir}}.
35370
35371 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
35372 @need 2000
35373 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
35374 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
35375 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
35376 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
35377 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
35378 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
35379 directories. @file{configure} writes configuration-specific files in
35380 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
35381 directory @var{dirname}. @file{configure} creates directories under
35382 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
35383 @var{dirname}.
35384
35385 @item --norecursion
35386 Configure only the directory level where @file{configure} is executed; do not
35387 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
35388
35389 @item --target=@var{target}
35390 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
35391 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
35392 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
35393
35394 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
35395
35396 @item @var{host} @dots{}
35397 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
35398
35399 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
35400 @end table
35401
35402 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
35403 needed for special purposes only.
35404
35405 @node System-wide configuration
35406 @section System-wide configuration and settings
35407 @cindex system-wide init file
35408
35409 @value{GDBN} can be configured to have a system-wide init file;
35410 this file will be read and executed at startup (@pxref{Startup, , What
35411 @value{GDBN} does during startup}).
35412
35413 Here is the corresponding configure option:
35414
35415 @table @code
35416 @item --with-system-gdbinit=@var{file}
35417 Specify that the default location of the system-wide init file is
35418 @var{file}.
35419 @end table
35420
35421 If @value{GDBN} has been configured with the option @option{--prefix=$prefix},
35422 it may be subject to relocation. Two possible cases:
35423
35424 @itemize @bullet
35425 @item
35426 If the default location of this init file contains @file{$prefix},
35427 it will be subject to relocation. Suppose that the configure options
35428 are @option{--prefix=$prefix --with-system-gdbinit=$prefix/etc/gdbinit};
35429 if @value{GDBN} is moved from @file{$prefix} to @file{$install}, the system
35430 init file is looked for as @file{$install/etc/gdbinit} instead of
35431 @file{$prefix/etc/gdbinit}.
35432
35433 @item
35434 By contrast, if the default location does not contain the prefix,
35435 it will not be relocated. E.g.@: if @value{GDBN} has been configured with
35436 @option{--prefix=/usr/local --with-system-gdbinit=/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
35437 then @value{GDBN} will always look for @file{/usr/share/gdb/gdbinit},
35438 wherever @value{GDBN} is installed.
35439 @end itemize
35440
35441 If the configured location of the system-wide init file (as given by the
35442 @option{--with-system-gdbinit} option at configure time) is in the
35443 data-directory (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure
35444 time) or in one of its subdirectories, then @value{GDBN} will look for the
35445 system-wide init file in the directory specified by the
35446 @option{--data-directory} command-line option.
35447 Note that the system-wide init file is only read once, during @value{GDBN}
35448 initialization. If the data-directory is changed after @value{GDBN} has
35449 started with the @code{set data-directory} command, the file will not be
35450 reread.
35451
35452 @menu
35453 * System-wide Configuration Scripts:: Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
35454 @end menu
35455
35456 @node System-wide Configuration Scripts
35457 @subsection Installed System-wide Configuration Scripts
35458 @cindex system-wide configuration scripts
35459
35460 The @file{system-gdbinit} directory, located inside the data-directory
35461 (as specified by @option{--with-gdb-datadir} at configure time) contains
35462 a number of scripts which can be used as system-wide init files. To
35463 automatically source those scripts at startup, @value{GDBN} should be
35464 configured with @option{--with-system-gdbinit}. Otherwise, any user
35465 should be able to source them by hand as needed.
35466
35467 The following scripts are currently available:
35468 @itemize @bullet
35469
35470 @item @file{elinos.py}
35471 @pindex elinos.py
35472 @cindex ELinOS system-wide configuration script
35473 This script is useful when debugging a program on an ELinOS target.
35474 It takes advantage of the environment variables defined in a standard
35475 ELinOS environment in order to determine the location of the system
35476 shared libraries, and then sets the @samp{solib-absolute-prefix}
35477 and @samp{solib-search-path} variables appropriately.
35478
35479 @item @file{wrs-linux.py}
35480 @pindex wrs-linux.py
35481 @cindex Wind River Linux system-wide configuration script
35482 This script is useful when debugging a program on a target running
35483 Wind River Linux. It expects the @env{ENV_PREFIX} to be set to
35484 the host-side sysroot used by the target system.
35485
35486 @end itemize
35487
35488 @node Maintenance Commands
35489 @appendix Maintenance Commands
35490 @cindex maintenance commands
35491 @cindex internal commands
35492
35493 In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
35494 includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers,
35495 that are not documented elsewhere in this manual. These commands are
35496 provided here for reference. (For commands that turn on debugging
35497 messages, see @ref{Debugging Output}.)
35498
35499 @table @code
35500 @kindex maint agent
35501 @kindex maint agent-eval
35502 @item maint agent @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
35503 @itemx maint agent-eval @r{[}-at @var{location}@r{,}@r{]} @var{expression}
35504 Translate the given @var{expression} into remote agent bytecodes.
35505 This command is useful for debugging the Agent Expression mechanism
35506 (@pxref{Agent Expressions}). The @samp{agent} version produces an
35507 expression useful for data collection, such as by tracepoints, while
35508 @samp{maint agent-eval} produces an expression that evaluates directly
35509 to a result. For instance, a collection expression for @code{globa +
35510 globb} will include bytecodes to record four bytes of memory at each
35511 of the addresses of @code{globa} and @code{globb}, while discarding
35512 the result of the addition, while an evaluation expression will do the
35513 addition and return the sum.
35514 If @code{-at} is given, generate remote agent bytecode for @var{location}.
35515 If not, generate remote agent bytecode for current frame PC address.
35516
35517 @kindex maint agent-printf
35518 @item maint agent-printf @var{format},@var{expr},...
35519 Translate the given format string and list of argument expressions
35520 into remote agent bytecodes and display them as a disassembled list.
35521 This command is useful for debugging the agent version of dynamic
35522 printf (@pxref{Dynamic Printf}).
35523
35524 @kindex maint info breakpoints
35525 @item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
35526 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
35527 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
35528 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
35529 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
35530 is shown:
35531
35532 @table @code
35533 @item breakpoint
35534 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
35535
35536 @item watchpoint
35537 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
35538
35539 @item longjmp
35540 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
35541 @code{longjmp} calls.
35542
35543 @item longjmp resume
35544 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
35545
35546 @item until
35547 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
35548
35549 @item finish
35550 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
35551
35552 @item shlib events
35553 Shared library events.
35554
35555 @end table
35556
35557 @kindex maint info btrace
35558 @item maint info btrace
35559 Pint information about raw branch tracing data.
35560
35561 @kindex maint btrace packet-history
35562 @item maint btrace packet-history
35563 Print the raw branch trace packets that are used to compute the
35564 execution history for the @samp{record btrace} command. Both the
35565 information and the format in which it is printed depend on the btrace
35566 recording format.
35567
35568 @table @code
35569 @item bts
35570 For the BTS recording format, print a list of blocks of sequential
35571 code. For each block, the following information is printed:
35572
35573 @table @asis
35574 @item Block number
35575 Newer blocks have higher numbers. The oldest block has number zero.
35576 @item Lowest @samp{PC}
35577 @item Highest @samp{PC}
35578 @end table
35579
35580 @item pt
35581 For the Intel Processor Trace recording format, print a list of
35582 Intel Processor Trace packets. For each packet, the following
35583 information is printed:
35584
35585 @table @asis
35586 @item Packet number
35587 Newer packets have higher numbers. The oldest packet has number zero.
35588 @item Trace offset
35589 The packet's offset in the trace stream.
35590 @item Packet opcode and payload
35591 @end table
35592 @end table
35593
35594 @kindex maint btrace clear-packet-history
35595 @item maint btrace clear-packet-history
35596 Discards the cached packet history printed by the @samp{maint btrace
35597 packet-history} command. The history will be computed again when
35598 needed.
35599
35600 @kindex maint btrace clear
35601 @item maint btrace clear
35602 Discard the branch trace data. The data will be fetched anew and the
35603 branch trace will be recomputed when needed.
35604
35605 This implicitly truncates the branch trace to a single branch trace
35606 buffer. When updating branch trace incrementally, the branch trace
35607 available to @value{GDBN} may be bigger than a single branch trace
35608 buffer.
35609
35610 @kindex maint set btrace pt skip-pad
35611 @item maint set btrace pt skip-pad
35612 @kindex maint show btrace pt skip-pad
35613 @item maint show btrace pt skip-pad
35614 Control whether @value{GDBN} will skip PAD packets when computing the
35615 packet history.
35616
35617 @kindex set displaced-stepping
35618 @kindex show displaced-stepping
35619 @cindex displaced stepping support
35620 @cindex out-of-line single-stepping
35621 @item set displaced-stepping
35622 @itemx show displaced-stepping
35623 Control whether or not @value{GDBN} will do @dfn{displaced stepping}
35624 if the target supports it. Displaced stepping is a way to single-step
35625 over breakpoints without removing them from the inferior, by executing
35626 an out-of-line copy of the instruction that was originally at the
35627 breakpoint location. It is also known as out-of-line single-stepping.
35628
35629 @table @code
35630 @item set displaced-stepping on
35631 If the target architecture supports it, @value{GDBN} will use
35632 displaced stepping to step over breakpoints.
35633
35634 @item set displaced-stepping off
35635 @value{GDBN} will not use displaced stepping to step over breakpoints,
35636 even if such is supported by the target architecture.
35637
35638 @cindex non-stop mode, and @samp{set displaced-stepping}
35639 @item set displaced-stepping auto
35640 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} will use displaced stepping
35641 only if non-stop mode is active (@pxref{Non-Stop Mode}) and the target
35642 architecture supports displaced stepping.
35643 @end table
35644
35645 @kindex maint check-psymtabs
35646 @item maint check-psymtabs
35647 Check the consistency of currently expanded psymtabs versus symtabs.
35648 Use this to check, for example, whether a symbol is in one but not the other.
35649
35650 @kindex maint check-symtabs
35651 @item maint check-symtabs
35652 Check the consistency of currently expanded symtabs.
35653
35654 @kindex maint expand-symtabs
35655 @item maint expand-symtabs [@var{regexp}]
35656 Expand symbol tables.
35657 If @var{regexp} is specified, only expand symbol tables for file
35658 names matching @var{regexp}.
35659
35660 @kindex maint set catch-demangler-crashes
35661 @kindex maint show catch-demangler-crashes
35662 @cindex demangler crashes
35663 @item maint set catch-demangler-crashes [on|off]
35664 @itemx maint show catch-demangler-crashes
35665 Control whether @value{GDBN} should attempt to catch crashes in the
35666 symbol name demangler. The default is to attempt to catch crashes.
35667 If enabled, the first time a crash is caught, a core file is created,
35668 the offending symbol is displayed and the user is presented with the
35669 option to terminate the current session.
35670
35671 @kindex maint cplus first_component
35672 @item maint cplus first_component @var{name}
35673 Print the first C@t{++} class/namespace component of @var{name}.
35674
35675 @kindex maint cplus namespace
35676 @item maint cplus namespace
35677 Print the list of possible C@t{++} namespaces.
35678
35679 @kindex maint deprecate
35680 @kindex maint undeprecate
35681 @cindex deprecated commands
35682 @item maint deprecate @var{command} @r{[}@var{replacement}@r{]}
35683 @itemx maint undeprecate @var{command}
35684 Deprecate or undeprecate the named @var{command}. Deprecated commands
35685 cause @value{GDBN} to issue a warning when you use them. The optional
35686 argument @var{replacement} says which newer command should be used in
35687 favor of the deprecated one; if it is given, @value{GDBN} will mention
35688 the replacement as part of the warning.
35689
35690 @kindex maint dump-me
35691 @item maint dump-me
35692 @cindex @code{SIGQUIT} signal, dump core of @value{GDBN}
35693 Cause a fatal signal in the debugger and force it to dump its core.
35694 This is supported only on systems which support aborting a program
35695 with the @code{SIGQUIT} signal.
35696
35697 @kindex maint internal-error
35698 @kindex maint internal-warning
35699 @kindex maint demangler-warning
35700 @cindex demangler crashes
35701 @item maint internal-error @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
35702 @itemx maint internal-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
35703 @itemx maint demangler-warning @r{[}@var{message-text}@r{]}
35704
35705 Cause @value{GDBN} to call the internal function @code{internal_error},
35706 @code{internal_warning} or @code{demangler_warning} and hence behave
35707 as though an internal problem has been detected. In addition to
35708 reporting the internal problem, these functions give the user the
35709 opportunity to either quit @value{GDBN} or (for @code{internal_error}
35710 and @code{internal_warning}) create a core file of the current
35711 @value{GDBN} session.
35712
35713 These commands take an optional parameter @var{message-text} that is
35714 used as the text of the error or warning message.
35715
35716 Here's an example of using @code{internal-error}:
35717
35718 @smallexample
35719 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint internal-error testing, 1, 2}
35720 @dots{}/maint.c:121: internal-error: testing, 1, 2
35721 A problem internal to GDB has been detected. Further
35722 debugging may prove unreliable.
35723 Quit this debugging session? (y or n) @kbd{n}
35724 Create a core file? (y or n) @kbd{n}
35725 (@value{GDBP})
35726 @end smallexample
35727
35728 @cindex @value{GDBN} internal error
35729 @cindex internal errors, control of @value{GDBN} behavior
35730 @cindex demangler crashes
35731
35732 @kindex maint set internal-error
35733 @kindex maint show internal-error
35734 @kindex maint set internal-warning
35735 @kindex maint show internal-warning
35736 @kindex maint set demangler-warning
35737 @kindex maint show demangler-warning
35738 @item maint set internal-error @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
35739 @itemx maint show internal-error @var{action}
35740 @itemx maint set internal-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
35741 @itemx maint show internal-warning @var{action}
35742 @itemx maint set demangler-warning @var{action} [ask|yes|no]
35743 @itemx maint show demangler-warning @var{action}
35744 When @value{GDBN} reports an internal problem (error or warning) it
35745 gives the user the opportunity to both quit @value{GDBN} and create a
35746 core file of the current @value{GDBN} session. These commands let you
35747 override the default behaviour for each particular @var{action},
35748 described in the table below.
35749
35750 @table @samp
35751 @item quit
35752 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
35753 quit. The default is to ask the user what to do.
35754
35755 @item corefile
35756 You can specify that @value{GDBN} should always (yes) or never (no)
35757 create a core file. The default is to ask the user what to do. Note
35758 that there is no @code{corefile} option for @code{demangler-warning}:
35759 demangler warnings always create a core file and this cannot be
35760 disabled.
35761 @end table
35762
35763 @kindex maint packet
35764 @item maint packet @var{text}
35765 If @value{GDBN} is talking to an inferior via the serial protocol,
35766 then this command sends the string @var{text} to the inferior, and
35767 displays the response packet. @value{GDBN} supplies the initial
35768 @samp{$} character, the terminating @samp{#} character, and the
35769 checksum.
35770
35771 @kindex maint print architecture
35772 @item maint print architecture @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
35773 Print the entire architecture configuration. The optional argument
35774 @var{file} names the file where the output goes.
35775
35776 @kindex maint print c-tdesc @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
35777 @item maint print c-tdesc
35778 Print the target description (@pxref{Target Descriptions}) as
35779 a C source file. By default, the target description is for the current
35780 target, but if the optional argument @var{file} is provided, that file
35781 is used to produce the description. The @var{file} should be an XML
35782 document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description Format}.
35783 The created source file is built into @value{GDBN} when @value{GDBN} is
35784 built again. This command is used by developers after they add or
35785 modify XML target descriptions.
35786
35787 @kindex maint check xml-descriptions
35788 @item maint check xml-descriptions @var{dir}
35789 Check that the target descriptions dynamically created by @value{GDBN}
35790 equal the descriptions created from XML files found in @var{dir}.
35791
35792 @anchor{maint check libthread-db}
35793 @kindex maint check libthread-db
35794 @item maint check libthread-db
35795 Run integrity checks on the current inferior's thread debugging
35796 library. This exercises all @code{libthread_db} functionality used by
35797 @value{GDBN} on GNU/Linux systems, and by extension also exercises the
35798 @code{proc_service} functions provided by @value{GDBN} that
35799 @code{libthread_db} uses. Note that parts of the test may be skipped
35800 on some platforms when debugging core files.
35801
35802 @kindex maint print dummy-frames
35803 @item maint print dummy-frames
35804 Prints the contents of @value{GDBN}'s internal dummy-frame stack.
35805
35806 @smallexample
35807 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{b add}
35808 @dots{}
35809 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{print add(2,3)}
35810 Breakpoint 2, add (a=2, b=3) at @dots{}
35811 58 return (a + b);
35812 The program being debugged stopped while in a function called from GDB.
35813 @dots{}
35814 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print dummy-frames}
35815 0xa8206d8: id=@{stack=0xbfffe734,code=0xbfffe73f,!special@}, ptid=process 9353
35816 (@value{GDBP})
35817 @end smallexample
35818
35819 Takes an optional file parameter.
35820
35821 @kindex maint print registers
35822 @kindex maint print raw-registers
35823 @kindex maint print cooked-registers
35824 @kindex maint print register-groups
35825 @kindex maint print remote-registers
35826 @item maint print registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
35827 @itemx maint print raw-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
35828 @itemx maint print cooked-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
35829 @itemx maint print register-groups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
35830 @itemx maint print remote-registers @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
35831 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register data structures.
35832
35833 The command @code{maint print raw-registers} includes the contents of
35834 the raw register cache; the command @code{maint print
35835 cooked-registers} includes the (cooked) value of all registers,
35836 including registers which aren't available on the target nor visible
35837 to user; the command @code{maint print register-groups} includes the
35838 groups that each register is a member of; and the command @code{maint
35839 print remote-registers} includes the remote target's register numbers
35840 and offsets in the `G' packets.
35841
35842 These commands take an optional parameter, a file name to which to
35843 write the information.
35844
35845 @kindex maint print reggroups
35846 @item maint print reggroups @r{[}@var{file}@r{]}
35847 Print @value{GDBN}'s internal register group data structures. The
35848 optional argument @var{file} tells to what file to write the
35849 information.
35850
35851 The register groups info looks like this:
35852
35853 @smallexample
35854 (@value{GDBP}) @kbd{maint print reggroups}
35855 Group Type
35856 general user
35857 float user
35858 all user
35859 vector user
35860 system user
35861 save internal
35862 restore internal
35863 @end smallexample
35864
35865 @kindex flushregs
35866 @item flushregs
35867 This command forces @value{GDBN} to flush its internal register cache.
35868
35869 @kindex maint print objfiles
35870 @cindex info for known object files
35871 @item maint print objfiles @r{[}@var{regexp}@r{]}
35872 Print a dump of all known object files.
35873 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print object files whose names
35874 match @var{regexp}. For each object file, this command prints its name,
35875 address in memory, and all of its psymtabs and symtabs.
35876
35877 @kindex maint print user-registers
35878 @cindex user registers
35879 @item maint print user-registers
35880 List all currently available @dfn{user registers}. User registers
35881 typically provide alternate names for actual hardware registers. They
35882 include the four ``standard'' registers @code{$fp}, @code{$pc},
35883 @code{$sp}, and @code{$ps}. @xref{standard registers}. User
35884 registers can be used in expressions in the same way as the canonical
35885 register names, but only the latter are listed by the @code{info
35886 registers} and @code{maint print registers} commands.
35887
35888 @kindex maint print section-scripts
35889 @cindex info for known .debug_gdb_scripts-loaded scripts
35890 @item maint print section-scripts [@var{regexp}]
35891 Print a dump of scripts specified in the @code{.debug_gdb_section} section.
35892 If @var{regexp} is specified, only print scripts loaded by object files
35893 matching @var{regexp}.
35894 For each script, this command prints its name as specified in the objfile,
35895 and the full path if known.
35896 @xref{dotdebug_gdb_scripts section}.
35897
35898 @kindex maint print statistics
35899 @cindex bcache statistics
35900 @item maint print statistics
35901 This command prints, for each object file in the program, various data
35902 about that object file followed by the byte cache (@dfn{bcache})
35903 statistics for the object file. The objfile data includes the number
35904 of minimal, partial, full, and stabs symbols, the number of types
35905 defined by the objfile, the number of as yet unexpanded psym tables,
35906 the number of line tables and string tables, and the amount of memory
35907 used by the various tables. The bcache statistics include the counts,
35908 sizes, and counts of duplicates of all and unique objects, max,
35909 average, and median entry size, total memory used and its overhead and
35910 savings, and various measures of the hash table size and chain
35911 lengths.
35912
35913 @kindex maint print target-stack
35914 @cindex target stack description
35915 @item maint print target-stack
35916 A @dfn{target} is an interface between the debugger and a particular
35917 kind of file or process. Targets can be stacked in @dfn{strata},
35918 so that more than one target can potentially respond to a request.
35919 In particular, memory accesses will walk down the stack of targets
35920 until they find a target that is interested in handling that particular
35921 address.
35922
35923 This command prints a short description of each layer that was pushed on
35924 the @dfn{target stack}, starting from the top layer down to the bottom one.
35925
35926 @kindex maint print type
35927 @cindex type chain of a data type
35928 @item maint print type @var{expr}
35929 Print the type chain for a type specified by @var{expr}. The argument
35930 can be either a type name or a symbol. If it is a symbol, the type of
35931 that symbol is described. The type chain produced by this command is
35932 a recursive definition of the data type as stored in @value{GDBN}'s
35933 data structures, including its flags and contained types.
35934
35935 @kindex maint selftest
35936 @cindex self tests
35937 @item maint selftest @r{[}@var{filter}@r{]}
35938 Run any self tests that were compiled in to @value{GDBN}. This will
35939 print a message showing how many tests were run, and how many failed.
35940 If a @var{filter} is passed, only the tests with @var{filter} in their
35941 name will by ran.
35942
35943 @kindex "maint info selftests"
35944 @cindex self tests
35945 @item maint info selftests
35946 List the selftests compiled in to @value{GDBN}.
35947
35948 @kindex maint set dwarf always-disassemble
35949 @kindex maint show dwarf always-disassemble
35950 @item maint set dwarf always-disassemble
35951 @item maint show dwarf always-disassemble
35952 Control the behavior of @code{info address} when using DWARF debugging
35953 information.
35954
35955 The default is @code{off}, which means that @value{GDBN} should try to
35956 describe a variable's location in an easily readable format. When
35957 @code{on}, @value{GDBN} will instead display the DWARF location
35958 expression in an assembly-like format. Note that some locations are
35959 too complex for @value{GDBN} to describe simply; in this case you will
35960 always see the disassembly form.
35961
35962 Here is an example of the resulting disassembly:
35963
35964 @smallexample
35965 (gdb) info addr argc
35966 Symbol "argc" is a complex DWARF expression:
35967 1: DW_OP_fbreg 0
35968 @end smallexample
35969
35970 For more information on these expressions, see
35971 @uref{http://www.dwarfstd.org/, the DWARF standard}.
35972
35973 @kindex maint set dwarf max-cache-age
35974 @kindex maint show dwarf max-cache-age
35975 @item maint set dwarf max-cache-age
35976 @itemx maint show dwarf max-cache-age
35977 Control the DWARF compilation unit cache.
35978
35979 @cindex DWARF compilation units cache
35980 In object files with inter-compilation-unit references, such as those
35981 produced by the GCC option @samp{-feliminate-dwarf2-dups}, the DWARF
35982 reader needs to frequently refer to previously read compilation units.
35983 This setting controls how long a compilation unit will remain in the
35984 cache if it is not referenced. A higher limit means that cached
35985 compilation units will be stored in memory longer, and more total
35986 memory will be used. Setting it to zero disables caching, which will
35987 slow down @value{GDBN} startup, but reduce memory consumption.
35988
35989 @kindex maint set dwarf unwinders
35990 @kindex maint show dwarf unwinders
35991 @item maint set dwarf unwinders
35992 @itemx maint show dwarf unwinders
35993 Control use of the DWARF frame unwinders.
35994
35995 @cindex DWARF frame unwinders
35996 Many targets that support DWARF debugging use @value{GDBN}'s DWARF
35997 frame unwinders to build the backtrace. Many of these targets will
35998 also have a second mechanism for building the backtrace for use in
35999 cases where DWARF information is not available, this second mechanism
36000 is often an analysis of a function's prologue.
36001
36002 In order to extend testing coverage of the second level stack
36003 unwinding mechanisms it is helpful to be able to disable the DWARF
36004 stack unwinders, this can be done with this switch.
36005
36006 In normal use of @value{GDBN} disabling the DWARF unwinders is not
36007 advisable, there are cases that are better handled through DWARF than
36008 prologue analysis, and the debug experience is likely to be better
36009 with the DWARF frame unwinders enabled.
36010
36011 If DWARF frame unwinders are not supported for a particular target
36012 architecture, then enabling this flag does not cause them to be used.
36013 @kindex maint set profile
36014 @kindex maint show profile
36015 @cindex profiling GDB
36016 @item maint set profile
36017 @itemx maint show profile
36018 Control profiling of @value{GDBN}.
36019
36020 Profiling will be disabled until you use the @samp{maint set profile}
36021 command to enable it. When you enable profiling, the system will begin
36022 collecting timing and execution count data; when you disable profiling or
36023 exit @value{GDBN}, the results will be written to a log file. Remember that
36024 if you use profiling, @value{GDBN} will overwrite the profiling log file
36025 (often called @file{gmon.out}). If you have a record of important profiling
36026 data in a @file{gmon.out} file, be sure to move it to a safe location.
36027
36028 Configuring with @samp{--enable-profiling} arranges for @value{GDBN} to be
36029 compiled with the @samp{-pg} compiler option.
36030
36031 @kindex maint set show-debug-regs
36032 @kindex maint show show-debug-regs
36033 @cindex hardware debug registers
36034 @item maint set show-debug-regs
36035 @itemx maint show show-debug-regs
36036 Control whether to show variables that mirror the hardware debug
36037 registers. Use @code{on} to enable, @code{off} to disable. If
36038 enabled, the debug registers values are shown when @value{GDBN} inserts or
36039 removes a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint, and when the inferior
36040 triggers a hardware-assisted breakpoint or watchpoint.
36041
36042 @kindex maint set show-all-tib
36043 @kindex maint show show-all-tib
36044 @item maint set show-all-tib
36045 @itemx maint show show-all-tib
36046 Control whether to show all non zero areas within a 1k block starting
36047 at thread local base, when using the @samp{info w32 thread-information-block}
36048 command.
36049
36050 @kindex maint set target-async
36051 @kindex maint show target-async
36052 @item maint set target-async
36053 @itemx maint show target-async
36054 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets operate in synchronous or
36055 asynchronous mode (@pxref{Background Execution}). Normally the
36056 default is asynchronous, if it is available; but this can be changed
36057 to more easily debug problems occurring only in synchronous mode.
36058
36059 @kindex maint set target-non-stop @var{mode} [on|off|auto]
36060 @kindex maint show target-non-stop
36061 @item maint set target-non-stop
36062 @itemx maint show target-non-stop
36063
36064 This controls whether @value{GDBN} targets always operate in non-stop
36065 mode even if @code{set non-stop} is @code{off} (@pxref{Non-Stop
36066 Mode}). The default is @code{auto}, meaning non-stop mode is enabled
36067 if supported by the target.
36068
36069 @table @code
36070 @item maint set target-non-stop auto
36071 This is the default mode. @value{GDBN} controls the target in
36072 non-stop mode if the target supports it.
36073
36074 @item maint set target-non-stop on
36075 @value{GDBN} controls the target in non-stop mode even if the target
36076 does not indicate support.
36077
36078 @item maint set target-non-stop off
36079 @value{GDBN} does not control the target in non-stop mode even if the
36080 target supports it.
36081 @end table
36082
36083 @kindex maint set per-command
36084 @kindex maint show per-command
36085 @item maint set per-command
36086 @itemx maint show per-command
36087 @cindex resources used by commands
36088
36089 @value{GDBN} can display the resources used by each command.
36090 This is useful in debugging performance problems.
36091
36092 @table @code
36093 @item maint set per-command space [on|off]
36094 @itemx maint show per-command space
36095 Enable or disable the printing of the memory used by GDB for each command.
36096 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much memory each command
36097 took, following the command's own output.
36098 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
36099 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
36100
36101 @item maint set per-command time [on|off]
36102 @itemx maint show per-command time
36103 Enable or disable the printing of the execution time of @value{GDBN}
36104 for each command.
36105 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display how much time it
36106 took to execute each command, following the command's own output.
36107 Both CPU time and wallclock time are printed.
36108 Printing both is useful when trying to determine whether the cost is
36109 CPU or, e.g., disk/network latency.
36110 Note that the CPU time printed is for @value{GDBN} only, it does not include
36111 the execution time of the inferior because there's no mechanism currently
36112 to compute how much time was spent by @value{GDBN} and how much time was
36113 spent by the program been debugged.
36114 This can also be requested by invoking @value{GDBN} with the
36115 @option{--statistics} command-line switch (@pxref{Mode Options}).
36116
36117 @item maint set per-command symtab [on|off]
36118 @itemx maint show per-command symtab
36119 Enable or disable the printing of basic symbol table statistics
36120 for each command.
36121 If enabled, @value{GDBN} will display the following information:
36122
36123 @enumerate a
36124 @item
36125 number of symbol tables
36126 @item
36127 number of primary symbol tables
36128 @item
36129 number of blocks in the blockvector
36130 @end enumerate
36131 @end table
36132
36133 @kindex maint set check-libthread-db
36134 @kindex maint show check-libthread-db
36135 @item maint set check-libthread-db [on|off]
36136 @itemx maint show check-libthread-db
36137 Control whether @value{GDBN} should run integrity checks on inferior
36138 specific thread debugging libraries as they are loaded. The default
36139 is not to perform such checks. If any check fails @value{GDBN} will
36140 unload the library and continue searching for a suitable candidate as
36141 described in @ref{set libthread-db-search-path}. For more information
36142 about the tests, see @ref{maint check libthread-db}.
36143
36144 @kindex maint space
36145 @cindex memory used by commands
36146 @item maint space @var{value}
36147 An alias for @code{maint set per-command space}.
36148 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
36149
36150 @kindex maint time
36151 @cindex time of command execution
36152 @item maint time @var{value}
36153 An alias for @code{maint set per-command time}.
36154 A non-zero value enables it, zero disables it.
36155
36156 @kindex maint translate-address
36157 @item maint translate-address @r{[}@var{section}@r{]} @var{addr}
36158 Find the symbol stored at the location specified by the address
36159 @var{addr} and an optional section name @var{section}. If found,
36160 @value{GDBN} prints the name of the closest symbol and an offset from
36161 the symbol's location to the specified address. This is similar to
36162 the @code{info address} command (@pxref{Symbols}), except that this
36163 command also allows to find symbols in other sections.
36164
36165 If section was not specified, the section in which the symbol was found
36166 is also printed. For dynamically linked executables, the name of
36167 executable or shared library containing the symbol is printed as well.
36168
36169 @end table
36170
36171 The following command is useful for non-interactive invocations of
36172 @value{GDBN}, such as in the test suite.
36173
36174 @table @code
36175 @item set watchdog @var{nsec}
36176 @kindex set watchdog
36177 @cindex watchdog timer
36178 @cindex timeout for commands
36179 Set the maximum number of seconds @value{GDBN} will wait for the
36180 target operation to finish. If this time expires, @value{GDBN}
36181 reports and error and the command is aborted.
36182
36183 @item show watchdog
36184 Show the current setting of the target wait timeout.
36185 @end table
36186
36187 @node Remote Protocol
36188 @appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
36189
36190 @menu
36191 * Overview::
36192 * Packets::
36193 * Stop Reply Packets::
36194 * General Query Packets::
36195 * Architecture-Specific Protocol Details::
36196 * Tracepoint Packets::
36197 * Host I/O Packets::
36198 * Interrupts::
36199 * Notification Packets::
36200 * Remote Non-Stop::
36201 * Packet Acknowledgment::
36202 * Examples::
36203 * File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension::
36204 * Library List Format::
36205 * Library List Format for SVR4 Targets::
36206 * Memory Map Format::
36207 * Thread List Format::
36208 * Traceframe Info Format::
36209 * Branch Trace Format::
36210 * Branch Trace Configuration Format::
36211 @end menu
36212
36213 @node Overview
36214 @section Overview
36215
36216 There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
36217 protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
36218 machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
36219 recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
36220
36221 In the examples below, @samp{->} and @samp{<-} are used to indicate
36222 transmitted and received data, respectively.
36223
36224 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
36225 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
36226 @cindex remote serial protocol
36227 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments
36228 and notifications, see @ref{Notification Packets}) are sent as a
36229 @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
36230 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
36231 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
36232
36233 @smallexample
36234 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
36235 @end smallexample
36236 @noindent
36237
36238 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
36239 @noindent
36240 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
36241 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
36242 eight bit unsigned checksum).
36243
36244 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
36245 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
36246
36247 @smallexample
36248 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
36249 @end smallexample
36250
36251 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
36252 @noindent
36253 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
36254 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
36255 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
36256
36257 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
36258 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
36259 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
36260 retransmission):
36261
36262 @smallexample
36263 -> @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
36264 <- @code{+}
36265 @end smallexample
36266 @noindent
36267
36268 The @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments can be disabled
36269 once a connection is established.
36270 @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}, for details.
36271
36272 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
36273 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
36274 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
36275 when the operation has completed, and the target has again stopped all
36276 threads in all attached processes. This is the default all-stop mode
36277 behavior, but the remote protocol also supports @value{GDBN}'s non-stop
36278 execution mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}, for details.
36279
36280 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
36281 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
36282 exceptions).
36283
36284 @cindex remote protocol, field separator
36285 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
36286 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
36287 @sc{hex} with leading zeros suppressed.
36288
36289 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
36290 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
36291 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
36292
36293 @cindex remote protocol, binary data
36294 @anchor{Binary Data}
36295 Binary data in most packets is encoded either as two hexadecimal
36296 digits per byte of binary data. This allowed the traditional remote
36297 protocol to work over connections which were only seven-bit clean.
36298 Some packets designed more recently assume an eight-bit clean
36299 connection, and use a more efficient encoding to send and receive
36300 binary data.
36301
36302 The binary data representation uses @code{7d} (@sc{ascii} @samp{@}})
36303 as an escape character. Any escaped byte is transmitted as the escape
36304 character followed by the original character XORed with @code{0x20}.
36305 For example, the byte @code{0x7d} would be transmitted as the two
36306 bytes @code{0x7d 0x5d}. The bytes @code{0x23} (@sc{ascii} @samp{#}),
36307 @code{0x24} (@sc{ascii} @samp{$}), and @code{0x7d} (@sc{ascii}
36308 @samp{@}}) must always be escaped. Responses sent by the stub
36309 must also escape @code{0x2a} (@sc{ascii} @samp{*}), so that it
36310 is not interpreted as the start of a run-length encoded sequence
36311 (described next).
36312
36313 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space.
36314 Run-length encoding replaces runs of identical characters with one
36315 instance of the repeated character, followed by a @samp{*} and a
36316 repeat count. The repeat count is itself sent encoded, to avoid
36317 binary characters in @var{data}: a value of @var{n} is sent as
36318 @code{@var{n}+29}. For a repeat count greater or equal to 3, this
36319 produces a printable @sc{ascii} character, e.g.@: a space (@sc{ascii}
36320 code 32) for a repeat count of 3. (This is because run-length
36321 encoding starts to win for counts 3 or more.) Thus, for example,
36322 @samp{0* } is a run-length encoding of ``0000'': the space character
36323 after @samp{*} means repeat the leading @code{0} @w{@code{32 - 29 =
36324 3}} more times.
36325
36326 The printable characters @samp{#} and @samp{$} or with a numeric value
36327 greater than 126 must not be used. Runs of six repeats (@samp{#}) or
36328 seven repeats (@samp{$}) can be expanded using a repeat count of only
36329 five (@samp{"}). For example, @samp{00000000} can be encoded as
36330 @samp{0*"00}.
36331
36332 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
36333 error number. That number is not well defined.
36334
36335 @cindex empty response, for unsupported packets
36336 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
36337 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
36338 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
36339 on that response.
36340
36341 At a minimum, a stub is required to support the @samp{g} and @samp{G}
36342 commands for register access, and the @samp{m} and @samp{M} commands
36343 for memory access. Stubs that only control single-threaded targets
36344 can implement run control with the @samp{c} (continue), and @samp{s}
36345 (step) commands. Stubs that support multi-threading targets should
36346 support the @samp{vCont} command. All other commands are optional.
36347
36348 @node Packets
36349 @section Packets
36350
36351 The following table provides a complete list of all currently defined
36352 @var{command}s and their corresponding response @var{data}.
36353 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for details about the File
36354 I/O extension of the remote protocol.
36355
36356 Each packet's description has a template showing the packet's overall
36357 syntax, followed by an explanation of the packet's meaning. We
36358 include spaces in some of the templates for clarity; these are not
36359 part of the packet's syntax. No @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to
36360 separate its components. For example, a template like @samp{foo
36361 @var{bar} @var{baz}} describes a packet beginning with the three ASCII
36362 bytes @samp{foo}, followed by a @var{bar}, followed directly by a
36363 @var{baz}. @value{GDBN} does not transmit a space character between the
36364 @samp{foo} and the @var{bar}, or between the @var{bar} and the
36365 @var{baz}.
36366
36367 @cindex @var{thread-id}, in remote protocol
36368 @anchor{thread-id syntax}
36369 Several packets and replies include a @var{thread-id} field to identify
36370 a thread. Normally these are positive numbers with a target-specific
36371 interpretation, formatted as big-endian hex strings. A @var{thread-id}
36372 can also be a literal @samp{-1} to indicate all threads, or @samp{0} to
36373 pick any thread.
36374
36375 In addition, the remote protocol supports a multiprocess feature in
36376 which the @var{thread-id} syntax is extended to optionally include both
36377 process and thread ID fields, as @samp{p@var{pid}.@var{tid}}.
36378 The @var{pid} (process) and @var{tid} (thread) components each have the
36379 format described above: a positive number with target-specific
36380 interpretation formatted as a big-endian hex string, literal @samp{-1}
36381 to indicate all processes or threads (respectively), or @samp{0} to
36382 indicate an arbitrary process or thread. Specifying just a process, as
36383 @samp{p@var{pid}}, is equivalent to @samp{p@var{pid}.-1}. It is an
36384 error to specify all processes but a specific thread, such as
36385 @samp{p-1.@var{tid}}. Note that the @samp{p} prefix is @emph{not} used
36386 for those packets and replies explicitly documented to include a process
36387 ID, rather than a @var{thread-id}.
36388
36389 The multiprocess @var{thread-id} syntax extensions are only used if both
36390 @value{GDBN} and the stub report support for the @samp{multiprocess}
36391 feature using @samp{qSupported}. @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for
36392 more information.
36393
36394 Note that all packet forms beginning with an upper- or lower-case
36395 letter, other than those described here, are reserved for future use.
36396
36397 Here are the packet descriptions.
36398
36399 @table @samp
36400
36401 @item !
36402 @cindex @samp{!} packet
36403 @anchor{extended mode}
36404 Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
36405 persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
36406 debugged.
36407
36408 Reply:
36409 @table @samp
36410 @item OK
36411 The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
36412 @end table
36413
36414 @item ?
36415 @cindex @samp{?} packet
36416 @anchor{? packet}
36417 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for
36418 step and continue. This packet has a special interpretation when the
36419 target is in non-stop mode; see @ref{Remote Non-Stop}.
36420
36421 Reply:
36422 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
36423
36424 @item A @var{arglen},@var{argnum},@var{arg},@dots{}
36425 @cindex @samp{A} packet
36426 Initialized @code{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
36427 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream
36428 @var{arg}. See @code{gdbserver} for more details.
36429
36430 Reply:
36431 @table @samp
36432 @item OK
36433 The arguments were set.
36434 @item E @var{NN}
36435 An error occurred.
36436 @end table
36437
36438 @item b @var{baud}
36439 @cindex @samp{b} packet
36440 (Don't use this packet; its behavior is not well-defined.)
36441 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}.
36442
36443 JTC: @emph{When does the transport layer state change? When it's
36444 received, or after the ACK is transmitted. In either case, there are
36445 problems if the command or the acknowledgment packet is dropped.}
36446
36447 Stan: @emph{If people really wanted to add something like this, and get
36448 it working for the first time, they ought to modify ser-unix.c to send
36449 some kind of out-of-band message to a specially-setup stub and have the
36450 switch happen "in between" packets, so that from remote protocol's point
36451 of view, nothing actually happened.}
36452
36453 @item B @var{addr},@var{mode}
36454 @cindex @samp{B} packet
36455 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
36456 breakpoint at @var{addr}.
36457
36458 Don't use this packet. Use the @samp{Z} and @samp{z} packets instead
36459 (@pxref{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}).
36460
36461 @cindex @samp{bc} packet
36462 @anchor{bc}
36463 @item bc
36464 Backward continue. Execute the target system in reverse. No parameter.
36465 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
36466
36467 Reply:
36468 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
36469
36470 @cindex @samp{bs} packet
36471 @anchor{bs}
36472 @item bs
36473 Backward single step. Execute one instruction in reverse. No parameter.
36474 @xref{Reverse Execution}, for more information.
36475
36476 Reply:
36477 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
36478
36479 @item c @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
36480 @cindex @samp{c} packet
36481 Continue at @var{addr}, which is the address to resume. If @var{addr}
36482 is omitted, resume at current address.
36483
36484 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
36485 packet}.
36486
36487 Reply:
36488 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
36489
36490 @item C @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
36491 @cindex @samp{C} packet
36492 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
36493 @samp{;@var{addr}} is omitted, resume at same address.
36494
36495 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
36496 packet}.
36497
36498 Reply:
36499 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
36500
36501 @item d
36502 @cindex @samp{d} packet
36503 Toggle debug flag.
36504
36505 Don't use this packet; instead, define a general set packet
36506 (@pxref{General Query Packets}).
36507
36508 @item D
36509 @itemx D;@var{pid}
36510 @cindex @samp{D} packet
36511 The first form of the packet is used to detach @value{GDBN} from the
36512 remote system. It is sent to the remote target
36513 before @value{GDBN} disconnects via the @code{detach} command.
36514
36515 The second form, including a process ID, is used when multiprocess
36516 protocol extensions are enabled (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}), to
36517 detach only a specific process. The @var{pid} is specified as a
36518 big-endian hex string.
36519
36520 Reply:
36521 @table @samp
36522 @item OK
36523 for success
36524 @item E @var{NN}
36525 for an error
36526 @end table
36527
36528 @item F @var{RC},@var{EE},@var{CF};@var{XX}
36529 @cindex @samp{F} packet
36530 A reply from @value{GDBN} to an @samp{F} packet sent by the target.
36531 This is part of the File-I/O protocol extension. @xref{File-I/O
36532 Remote Protocol Extension}, for the specification.
36533
36534 @item g
36535 @anchor{read registers packet}
36536 @cindex @samp{g} packet
36537 Read general registers.
36538
36539 Reply:
36540 @table @samp
36541 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
36542 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
36543 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
36544 each register and their position within the @samp{g} packet are
36545 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal gdbarch functions
36546 @code{DEPRECATED_REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and @code{gdbarch_register_name}.
36547
36548 When reading registers from a trace frame (@pxref{Analyze Collected
36549 Data,,Using the Collected Data}), the stub may also return a string of
36550 literal @samp{x}'s in place of the register data digits, to indicate
36551 that the corresponding register has not been collected, thus its value
36552 is unavailable. For example, for an architecture with 4 registers of
36553 4 bytes each, the following reply indicates to @value{GDBN} that
36554 registers 0 and 2 have not been collected, while registers 1 and 3
36555 have been collected, and both have zero value:
36556
36557 @smallexample
36558 -> @code{g}
36559 <- @code{xxxxxxxx00000000xxxxxxxx00000000}
36560 @end smallexample
36561
36562 @item E @var{NN}
36563 for an error.
36564 @end table
36565
36566 @item G @var{XX@dots{}}
36567 @cindex @samp{G} packet
36568 Write general registers. @xref{read registers packet}, for a
36569 description of the @var{XX@dots{}} data.
36570
36571 Reply:
36572 @table @samp
36573 @item OK
36574 for success
36575 @item E @var{NN}
36576 for an error
36577 @end table
36578
36579 @item H @var{op} @var{thread-id}
36580 @cindex @samp{H} packet
36581 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
36582 @samp{G}, et.al.). Depending on the operation to be performed, @var{op}
36583 should be @samp{c} for step and continue operations (note that this
36584 is deprecated, supporting the @samp{vCont} command is a better
36585 option), and @samp{g} for other operations. The thread designator
36586 @var{thread-id} has the format and interpretation described in
36587 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
36588
36589 Reply:
36590 @table @samp
36591 @item OK
36592 for success
36593 @item E @var{NN}
36594 for an error
36595 @end table
36596
36597 @c FIXME: JTC:
36598 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
36599 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
36600 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
36601 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
36602 @c described. For example:
36603 @c
36604 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
36605 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
36606 @c otherwise returns current registers.
36607 @c
36608 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
36609 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
36610 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
36611
36612 @item i @r{[}@var{addr}@r{[},@var{nnn}@r{]]}
36613 @anchor{cycle step packet}
36614 @cindex @samp{i} packet
36615 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @samp{,@var{nnn}} is
36616 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
36617 step starting at that address.
36618
36619 @item I
36620 @cindex @samp{I} packet
36621 Signal, then cycle step. @xref{step with signal packet}. @xref{cycle
36622 step packet}.
36623
36624 @item k
36625 @cindex @samp{k} packet
36626 Kill request.
36627
36628 The exact effect of this packet is not specified.
36629
36630 For a bare-metal target, it may power cycle or reset the target
36631 system. For that reason, the @samp{k} packet has no reply.
36632
36633 For a single-process target, it may kill that process if possible.
36634
36635 A multiple-process target may choose to kill just one process, or all
36636 that are under @value{GDBN}'s control. For more precise control, use
36637 the vKill packet (@pxref{vKill packet}).
36638
36639 If the target system immediately closes the connection in response to
36640 @samp{k}, @value{GDBN} does not consider the lack of packet
36641 acknowledgment to be an error, and assumes the kill was successful.
36642
36643 If connected using @kbd{target extended-remote}, and the target does
36644 not close the connection in response to a kill request, @value{GDBN}
36645 probes the target state as if a new connection was opened
36646 (@pxref{? packet}).
36647
36648 @item m @var{addr},@var{length}
36649 @cindex @samp{m} packet
36650 Read @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
36651 (@pxref{addressable memory unit}). Note that @var{addr} may not be aligned to
36652 any particular boundary.
36653
36654 The stub need not use any particular size or alignment when gathering
36655 data from memory for the response; even if @var{addr} is word-aligned
36656 and @var{length} is a multiple of the word size, the stub is free to
36657 use byte accesses, or not. For this reason, this packet may not be
36658 suitable for accessing memory-mapped I/O devices.
36659 @cindex alignment of remote memory accesses
36660 @cindex size of remote memory accesses
36661 @cindex memory, alignment and size of remote accesses
36662
36663 Reply:
36664 @table @samp
36665 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
36666 Memory contents; each byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
36667 The reply may contain fewer addressable memory units than requested if the
36668 server was able to read only part of the region of memory.
36669 @item E @var{NN}
36670 @var{NN} is errno
36671 @end table
36672
36673 @item M @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
36674 @cindex @samp{M} packet
36675 Write @var{length} addressable memory units starting at address @var{addr}
36676 (@pxref{addressable memory unit}). The data is given by @var{XX@dots{}}; each
36677 byte is transmitted as a two-digit hexadecimal number.
36678
36679 Reply:
36680 @table @samp
36681 @item OK
36682 for success
36683 @item E @var{NN}
36684 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
36685 written).
36686 @end table
36687
36688 @item p @var{n}
36689 @cindex @samp{p} packet
36690 Read the value of register @var{n}; @var{n} is in hex.
36691 @xref{read registers packet}, for a description of how the returned
36692 register value is encoded.
36693
36694 Reply:
36695 @table @samp
36696 @item @var{XX@dots{}}
36697 the register's value
36698 @item E @var{NN}
36699 for an error
36700 @item @w{}
36701 Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
36702 @end table
36703
36704 @item P @var{n@dots{}}=@var{r@dots{}}
36705 @anchor{write register packet}
36706 @cindex @samp{P} packet
36707 Write register @var{n@dots{}} with value @var{r@dots{}}. The register
36708 number @var{n} is in hexadecimal, and @var{r@dots{}} contains two hex
36709 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
36710
36711 Reply:
36712 @table @samp
36713 @item OK
36714 for success
36715 @item E @var{NN}
36716 for an error
36717 @end table
36718
36719 @item q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
36720 @itemx Q @var{name} @var{params}@dots{}
36721 @cindex @samp{q} packet
36722 @cindex @samp{Q} packet
36723 General query (@samp{q}) and set (@samp{Q}). These packets are
36724 described fully in @ref{General Query Packets}.
36725
36726 @item r
36727 @cindex @samp{r} packet
36728 Reset the entire system.
36729
36730 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{R} packet instead.
36731
36732 @item R @var{XX}
36733 @cindex @samp{R} packet
36734 Restart the program being debugged. The @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
36735 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
36736
36737 The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
36738
36739 @item s @r{[}@var{addr}@r{]}
36740 @cindex @samp{s} packet
36741 Single step, resuming at @var{addr}. If
36742 @var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
36743
36744 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
36745 packet}.
36746
36747 Reply:
36748 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
36749
36750 @item S @var{sig}@r{[};@var{addr}@r{]}
36751 @anchor{step with signal packet}
36752 @cindex @samp{S} packet
36753 Step with signal. This is analogous to the @samp{C} packet, but
36754 requests a single-step, rather than a normal resumption of execution.
36755
36756 This packet is deprecated for multi-threading support. @xref{vCont
36757 packet}.
36758
36759 Reply:
36760 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
36761
36762 @item t @var{addr}:@var{PP},@var{MM}
36763 @cindex @samp{t} packet
36764 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
36765 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}, both of which are are 4 byte long.
36766 There must be at least 3 digits in @var{addr}.
36767
36768 @item T @var{thread-id}
36769 @cindex @samp{T} packet
36770 Find out if the thread @var{thread-id} is alive. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
36771
36772 Reply:
36773 @table @samp
36774 @item OK
36775 thread is still alive
36776 @item E @var{NN}
36777 thread is dead
36778 @end table
36779
36780 @item v
36781 Packets starting with @samp{v} are identified by a multi-letter name,
36782 up to the first @samp{;} or @samp{?} (or the end of the packet).
36783
36784 @item vAttach;@var{pid}
36785 @cindex @samp{vAttach} packet
36786 Attach to a new process with the specified process ID @var{pid}.
36787 The process ID is a
36788 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. In all-stop mode, all
36789 threads in the attached process are stopped; in non-stop mode, it may be
36790 attached without being stopped if that is supported by the target.
36791
36792 @c In non-stop mode, on a successful vAttach, the stub should set the
36793 @c current thread to a thread of the newly-attached process. After
36794 @c attaching, GDB queries for the attached process's thread ID with qC.
36795 @c Also note that, from a user perspective, whether or not the
36796 @c target is stopped on attach in non-stop mode depends on whether you
36797 @c use the foreground or background version of the attach command, not
36798 @c on what vAttach does; GDB does the right thing with respect to either
36799 @c stopping or restarting threads.
36800
36801 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
36802
36803 Reply:
36804 @table @samp
36805 @item E @var{nn}
36806 for an error
36807 @item @r{Any stop packet}
36808 for success in all-stop mode (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
36809 @item OK
36810 for success in non-stop mode (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop})
36811 @end table
36812
36813 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@r{[}:@var{thread-id}@r{]]}@dots{}
36814 @cindex @samp{vCont} packet
36815 @anchor{vCont packet}
36816 Resume the inferior, specifying different actions for each thread.
36817
36818 For each inferior thread, the leftmost action with a matching
36819 @var{thread-id} is applied. Threads that don't match any action
36820 remain in their current state. Thread IDs are specified using the
36821 syntax described in @ref{thread-id syntax}. If multiprocess
36822 extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}) are supported, actions
36823 can be specified to match all threads in a process by using the
36824 @samp{p@var{pid}.-1} form of the @var{thread-id}. An action with no
36825 @var{thread-id} matches all threads. Specifying no actions is an
36826 error.
36827
36828 Currently supported actions are:
36829
36830 @table @samp
36831 @item c
36832 Continue.
36833 @item C @var{sig}
36834 Continue with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
36835 @item s
36836 Step.
36837 @item S @var{sig}
36838 Step with signal @var{sig}. The signal @var{sig} should be two hex digits.
36839 @item t
36840 Stop.
36841 @item r @var{start},@var{end}
36842 Step once, and then keep stepping as long as the thread stops at
36843 addresses between @var{start} (inclusive) and @var{end} (exclusive).
36844 The remote stub reports a stop reply when either the thread goes out
36845 of the range or is stopped due to an unrelated reason, such as hitting
36846 a breakpoint. @xref{range stepping}.
36847
36848 If the range is empty (@var{start} == @var{end}), then the action
36849 becomes equivalent to the @samp{s} action. In other words,
36850 single-step once, and report the stop (even if the stepped instruction
36851 jumps to @var{start}).
36852
36853 (A stop reply may be sent at any point even if the PC is still within
36854 the stepping range; for example, it is valid to implement this packet
36855 in a degenerate way as a single instruction step operation.)
36856
36857 @end table
36858
36859 The optional argument @var{addr} normally associated with the
36860 @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, and @samp{S} packets is
36861 not supported in @samp{vCont}.
36862
36863 The @samp{t} action is only relevant in non-stop mode
36864 (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}) and may be ignored by the stub otherwise.
36865 A stop reply should be generated for any affected thread not already stopped.
36866 When a thread is stopped by means of a @samp{t} action,
36867 the corresponding stop reply should indicate that the thread has stopped with
36868 signal @samp{0}, regardless of whether the target uses some other signal
36869 as an implementation detail.
36870
36871 The server must ignore @samp{c}, @samp{C}, @samp{s}, @samp{S}, and
36872 @samp{r} actions for threads that are already running. Conversely,
36873 the server must ignore @samp{t} actions for threads that are already
36874 stopped.
36875
36876 @emph{Note:} In non-stop mode, a thread is considered running until
36877 @value{GDBN} acknowleges an asynchronous stop notification for it with
36878 the @samp{vStopped} packet (@pxref{Remote Non-Stop}).
36879
36880 The stub must support @samp{vCont} if it reports support for
36881 multiprocess extensions (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}).
36882
36883 Reply:
36884 @xref{Stop Reply Packets}, for the reply specifications.
36885
36886 @item vCont?
36887 @cindex @samp{vCont?} packet
36888 Request a list of actions supported by the @samp{vCont} packet.
36889
36890 Reply:
36891 @table @samp
36892 @item vCont@r{[};@var{action}@dots{}@r{]}
36893 The @samp{vCont} packet is supported. Each @var{action} is a supported
36894 command in the @samp{vCont} packet.
36895 @item @w{}
36896 The @samp{vCont} packet is not supported.
36897 @end table
36898
36899 @anchor{vCtrlC packet}
36900 @item vCtrlC
36901 @cindex @samp{vCtrlC} packet
36902 Interrupt remote target as if a control-C was pressed on the remote
36903 terminal. This is the equivalent to reacting to the @code{^C}
36904 (@samp{\003}, the control-C character) character in all-stop mode
36905 while the target is running, except this works in non-stop mode.
36906 @xref{interrupting remote targets}, for more info on the all-stop
36907 variant.
36908
36909 Reply:
36910 @table @samp
36911 @item E @var{nn}
36912 for an error
36913 @item OK
36914 for success
36915 @end table
36916
36917 @item vFile:@var{operation}:@var{parameter}@dots{}
36918 @cindex @samp{vFile} packet
36919 Perform a file operation on the target system. For details,
36920 see @ref{Host I/O Packets}.
36921
36922 @item vFlashErase:@var{addr},@var{length}
36923 @cindex @samp{vFlashErase} packet
36924 Direct the stub to erase @var{length} bytes of flash starting at
36925 @var{addr}. The region may enclose any number of flash blocks, but
36926 its start and end must fall on block boundaries, as indicated by the
36927 flash block size appearing in the memory map (@pxref{Memory Map
36928 Format}). @value{GDBN} groups flash memory programming operations
36929 together, and sends a @samp{vFlashDone} request after each group; the
36930 stub is allowed to delay erase operation until the @samp{vFlashDone}
36931 packet is received.
36932
36933 Reply:
36934 @table @samp
36935 @item OK
36936 for success
36937 @item E @var{NN}
36938 for an error
36939 @end table
36940
36941 @item vFlashWrite:@var{addr}:@var{XX@dots{}}
36942 @cindex @samp{vFlashWrite} packet
36943 Direct the stub to write data to flash address @var{addr}. The data
36944 is passed in binary form using the same encoding as for the @samp{X}
36945 packet (@pxref{Binary Data}). The memory ranges specified by
36946 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets preceding a @samp{vFlashDone} packet must
36947 not overlap, and must appear in order of increasing addresses
36948 (although @samp{vFlashErase} packets for higher addresses may already
36949 have been received; the ordering is guaranteed only between
36950 @samp{vFlashWrite} packets). If a packet writes to an address that was
36951 neither erased by a preceding @samp{vFlashErase} packet nor by some other
36952 target-specific method, the results are unpredictable.
36953
36954
36955 Reply:
36956 @table @samp
36957 @item OK
36958 for success
36959 @item E.memtype
36960 for vFlashWrite addressing non-flash memory
36961 @item E @var{NN}
36962 for an error
36963 @end table
36964
36965 @item vFlashDone
36966 @cindex @samp{vFlashDone} packet
36967 Indicate to the stub that flash programming operation is finished.
36968 The stub is permitted to delay or batch the effects of a group of
36969 @samp{vFlashErase} and @samp{vFlashWrite} packets until a
36970 @samp{vFlashDone} packet is received. The contents of the affected
36971 regions of flash memory are unpredictable until the @samp{vFlashDone}
36972 request is completed.
36973
36974 @item vKill;@var{pid}
36975 @cindex @samp{vKill} packet
36976 @anchor{vKill packet}
36977 Kill the process with the specified process ID @var{pid}, which is a
36978 hexadecimal integer identifying the process. This packet is used in
36979 preference to @samp{k} when multiprocess protocol extensions are
36980 supported; see @ref{multiprocess extensions}.
36981
36982 Reply:
36983 @table @samp
36984 @item E @var{nn}
36985 for an error
36986 @item OK
36987 for success
36988 @end table
36989
36990 @item vMustReplyEmpty
36991 @cindex @samp{vMustReplyEmpty} packet
36992 The correct reply to an unknown @samp{v} packet is to return the empty
36993 string, however, some older versions of @command{gdbserver} would
36994 incorrectly return @samp{OK} for unknown @samp{v} packets.
36995
36996 The @samp{vMustReplyEmpty} is used as a feature test to check how
36997 @command{gdbserver} handles unknown packets, it is important that this
36998 packet be handled in the same way as other unknown @samp{v} packets.
36999 If this packet is handled differently to other unknown @samp{v}
37000 packets then it is possile that @value{GDBN} may run into problems in
37001 other areas, specifically around use of @samp{vFile:setfs:}.
37002
37003 @item vRun;@var{filename}@r{[};@var{argument}@r{]}@dots{}
37004 @cindex @samp{vRun} packet
37005 Run the program @var{filename}, passing it each @var{argument} on its
37006 command line. The file and arguments are hex-encoded strings. If
37007 @var{filename} is an empty string, the stub may use a default program
37008 (e.g.@: the last program run). The program is created in the stopped
37009 state.
37010
37011 @c FIXME: What about non-stop mode?
37012
37013 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
37014
37015 Reply:
37016 @table @samp
37017 @item E @var{nn}
37018 for an error
37019 @item @r{Any stop packet}
37020 for success (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets})
37021 @end table
37022
37023 @item vStopped
37024 @cindex @samp{vStopped} packet
37025 @xref{Notification Packets}.
37026
37027 @item X @var{addr},@var{length}:@var{XX@dots{}}
37028 @anchor{X packet}
37029 @cindex @samp{X} packet
37030 Write data to memory, where the data is transmitted in binary.
37031 Memory is specified by its address @var{addr} and number of addressable memory
37032 units @var{length} (@pxref{addressable memory unit});
37033 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
37034
37035 Reply:
37036 @table @samp
37037 @item OK
37038 for success
37039 @item E @var{NN}
37040 for an error
37041 @end table
37042
37043 @item z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
37044 @itemx Z @var{type},@var{addr},@var{kind}
37045 @anchor{insert breakpoint or watchpoint packet}
37046 @cindex @samp{z} packet
37047 @cindex @samp{Z} packets
37048 Insert (@samp{Z}) or remove (@samp{z}) a @var{type} breakpoint or
37049 watchpoint starting at address @var{address} of kind @var{kind}.
37050
37051 Each breakpoint and watchpoint packet @var{type} is documented
37052 separately.
37053
37054 @emph{Implementation notes: A remote target shall return an empty string
37055 for an unrecognized breakpoint or watchpoint packet @var{type}. A
37056 remote target shall support either both or neither of a given
37057 @samp{Z@var{type}@dots{}} and @samp{z@var{type}@dots{}} packet pair. To
37058 avoid potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should
37059 be implemented in an idempotent way.}
37060
37061 @item z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37062 @itemx Z0,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
37063 @cindex @samp{z0} packet
37064 @cindex @samp{Z0} packet
37065 Insert (@samp{Z0}) or remove (@samp{z0}) a software breakpoint at address
37066 @var{addr} of type @var{kind}.
37067
37068 A software breakpoint is implemented by replacing the instruction at
37069 @var{addr} with a software breakpoint or trap instruction. The
37070 @var{kind} is target-specific and typically indicates the size of the
37071 breakpoint in bytes that should be inserted. E.g., the @sc{arm} and
37072 @sc{mips} can insert either a 2 or 4 byte breakpoint. Some
37073 architectures have additional meanings for @var{kind}
37074 (@pxref{Architecture-Specific Protocol Details}); if no
37075 architecture-specific value is being used, it should be @samp{0}.
37076 @var{kind} is hex-encoded. @var{cond_list} is an optional list of
37077 conditional expressions in bytecode form that should be evaluated on
37078 the target's side. These are the conditions that should be taken into
37079 consideration when deciding if the breakpoint trigger should be
37080 reported back to @value{GDBN}.
37081
37082 See also the @samp{swbreak} stop reason (@pxref{swbreak stop reason})
37083 for how to best report a software breakpoint event to @value{GDBN}.
37084
37085 The @var{cond_list} parameter is comprised of a series of expressions,
37086 concatenated without separators. Each expression has the following form:
37087
37088 @table @samp
37089
37090 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
37091 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
37092 actual conditional expression in bytecode form.
37093
37094 @end table
37095
37096 The optional @var{cmd_list} parameter introduces commands that may be
37097 run on the target, rather than being reported back to @value{GDBN}.
37098 The parameter starts with a numeric flag @var{persist}; if the flag is
37099 nonzero, then the breakpoint may remain active and the commands
37100 continue to be run even when @value{GDBN} disconnects from the target.
37101 Following this flag is a series of expressions concatenated with no
37102 separators. Each expression has the following form:
37103
37104 @table @samp
37105
37106 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
37107 @var{len} is the length of the bytecode expression and @var{expr} is the
37108 actual commands expression in bytecode form.
37109
37110 @end table
37111
37112 @emph{Implementation note: It is possible for a target to copy or move
37113 code that contains software breakpoints (e.g., when implementing
37114 overlays). The behavior of this packet, in the presence of such a
37115 target, is not defined.}
37116
37117 Reply:
37118 @table @samp
37119 @item OK
37120 success
37121 @item @w{}
37122 not supported
37123 @item E @var{NN}
37124 for an error
37125 @end table
37126
37127 @item z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37128 @itemx Z1,@var{addr},@var{kind}@r{[};@var{cond_list}@dots{}@r{]}@r{[};cmds:@var{persist},@var{cmd_list}@dots{}@r{]}
37129 @cindex @samp{z1} packet
37130 @cindex @samp{Z1} packet
37131 Insert (@samp{Z1}) or remove (@samp{z1}) a hardware breakpoint at
37132 address @var{addr}.
37133
37134 A hardware breakpoint is implemented using a mechanism that is not
37135 dependent on being able to modify the target's memory. The
37136 @var{kind}, @var{cond_list}, and @var{cmd_list} arguments have the
37137 same meaning as in @samp{Z0} packets.
37138
37139 @emph{Implementation note: A hardware breakpoint is not affected by code
37140 movement.}
37141
37142 Reply:
37143 @table @samp
37144 @item OK
37145 success
37146 @item @w{}
37147 not supported
37148 @item E @var{NN}
37149 for an error
37150 @end table
37151
37152 @item z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37153 @itemx Z2,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37154 @cindex @samp{z2} packet
37155 @cindex @samp{Z2} packet
37156 Insert (@samp{Z2}) or remove (@samp{z2}) a write watchpoint at @var{addr}.
37157 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
37158
37159 Reply:
37160 @table @samp
37161 @item OK
37162 success
37163 @item @w{}
37164 not supported
37165 @item E @var{NN}
37166 for an error
37167 @end table
37168
37169 @item z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37170 @itemx Z3,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37171 @cindex @samp{z3} packet
37172 @cindex @samp{Z3} packet
37173 Insert (@samp{Z3}) or remove (@samp{z3}) a read watchpoint at @var{addr}.
37174 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
37175
37176 Reply:
37177 @table @samp
37178 @item OK
37179 success
37180 @item @w{}
37181 not supported
37182 @item E @var{NN}
37183 for an error
37184 @end table
37185
37186 @item z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37187 @itemx Z4,@var{addr},@var{kind}
37188 @cindex @samp{z4} packet
37189 @cindex @samp{Z4} packet
37190 Insert (@samp{Z4}) or remove (@samp{z4}) an access watchpoint at @var{addr}.
37191 The number of bytes to watch is specified by @var{kind}.
37192
37193 Reply:
37194 @table @samp
37195 @item OK
37196 success
37197 @item @w{}
37198 not supported
37199 @item E @var{NN}
37200 for an error
37201 @end table
37202
37203 @end table
37204
37205 @node Stop Reply Packets
37206 @section Stop Reply Packets
37207 @cindex stop reply packets
37208
37209 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s}, @samp{vCont},
37210 @samp{vAttach}, @samp{vRun}, @samp{vStopped}, and @samp{?} packets can
37211 receive any of the below as a reply. Except for @samp{?}
37212 and @samp{vStopped}, that reply is only returned
37213 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @dfn{signal
37214 number} is defined by the header @file{include/gdb/signals.h} in the
37215 @value{GDBN} source code.
37216
37217 In non-stop mode, the server will simply reply @samp{OK} to commands
37218 such as @samp{vCont}; any stop will be the subject of a future
37219 notification. @xref{Remote Non-Stop}.
37220
37221 As in the description of request packets, we include spaces in the
37222 reply templates for clarity; these are not part of the reply packet's
37223 syntax. No @value{GDBN} stop reply packet uses spaces to separate its
37224 components.
37225
37226 @table @samp
37227
37228 @item S @var{AA}
37229 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
37230 number). This is equivalent to a @samp{T} response with no
37231 @var{n}:@var{r} pairs.
37232
37233 @item T @var{AA} @var{n1}:@var{r1};@var{n2}:@var{r2};@dots{}
37234 @cindex @samp{T} packet reply
37235 The program received signal number @var{AA} (a two-digit hexadecimal
37236 number). This is equivalent to an @samp{S} response, except that the
37237 @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pairs can carry values of important registers
37238 and other information directly in the stop reply packet, reducing
37239 round-trip latency. Single-step and breakpoint traps are reported
37240 this way. Each @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair is interpreted as follows:
37241
37242 @itemize @bullet
37243 @item
37244 If @var{n} is a hexadecimal number, it is a register number, and the
37245 corresponding @var{r} gives that register's value. The data @var{r} is a
37246 series of bytes in target byte order, with each byte given by a
37247 two-digit hex number.
37248
37249 @item
37250 If @var{n} is @samp{thread}, then @var{r} is the @var{thread-id} of
37251 the stopped thread, as specified in @ref{thread-id syntax}.
37252
37253 @item
37254 If @var{n} is @samp{core}, then @var{r} is the hexadecimal number of
37255 the core on which the stop event was detected.
37256
37257 @item
37258 If @var{n} is a recognized @dfn{stop reason}, it describes a more
37259 specific event that stopped the target. The currently defined stop
37260 reasons are listed below. The @var{aa} should be @samp{05}, the trap
37261 signal. At most one stop reason should be present.
37262
37263 @item
37264 Otherwise, @value{GDBN} should ignore this @samp{@var{n}:@var{r}} pair
37265 and go on to the next; this allows us to extend the protocol in the
37266 future.
37267 @end itemize
37268
37269 The currently defined stop reasons are:
37270
37271 @table @samp
37272 @item watch
37273 @itemx rwatch
37274 @itemx awatch
37275 The packet indicates a watchpoint hit, and @var{r} is the data address, in
37276 hex.
37277
37278 @item syscall_entry
37279 @itemx syscall_return
37280 The packet indicates a syscall entry or return, and @var{r} is the
37281 syscall number, in hex.
37282
37283 @cindex shared library events, remote reply
37284 @item library
37285 The packet indicates that the loaded libraries have changed.
37286 @value{GDBN} should use @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} to fetch a new
37287 list of loaded libraries. The @var{r} part is ignored.
37288
37289 @cindex replay log events, remote reply
37290 @item replaylog
37291 The packet indicates that the target cannot continue replaying
37292 logged execution events, because it has reached the end (or the
37293 beginning when executing backward) of the log. The value of @var{r}
37294 will be either @samp{begin} or @samp{end}. @xref{Reverse Execution},
37295 for more information.
37296
37297 @item swbreak
37298 @anchor{swbreak stop reason}
37299 The packet indicates a software breakpoint instruction was executed,
37300 irrespective of whether it was @value{GDBN} that planted the
37301 breakpoint or the breakpoint is hardcoded in the program. The @var{r}
37302 part must be left empty.
37303
37304 On some architectures, such as x86, at the architecture level, when a
37305 breakpoint instruction executes the program counter points at the
37306 breakpoint address plus an offset. On such targets, the stub is
37307 responsible for adjusting the PC to point back at the breakpoint
37308 address.
37309
37310 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
37311 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
37312 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
37313 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
37314 indicating support.
37315
37316 This packet is required for correct non-stop mode operation.
37317
37318 @item hwbreak
37319 The packet indicates the target stopped for a hardware breakpoint.
37320 The @var{r} part must be left empty.
37321
37322 The same remarks about @samp{qSupported} and non-stop mode above
37323 apply.
37324
37325 @cindex fork events, remote reply
37326 @item fork
37327 The packet indicates that @code{fork} was called, and @var{r}
37328 is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
37329 @ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
37330 field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support
37331 fork events.
37332
37333 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
37334 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
37335 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
37336 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
37337 indicating support.
37338
37339 @cindex vfork events, remote reply
37340 @item vfork
37341 The packet indicates that @code{vfork} was called, and @var{r}
37342 is the thread ID of the new child process. Refer to
37343 @ref{thread-id syntax} for the format of the @var{thread-id}
37344 field. This packet is only applicable to targets that support
37345 vfork events.
37346
37347 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
37348 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
37349 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
37350 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
37351 indicating support.
37352
37353 @cindex vforkdone events, remote reply
37354 @item vforkdone
37355 The packet indicates that a child process created by a vfork
37356 has either called @code{exec} or terminated, so that the
37357 address spaces of the parent and child process are no longer
37358 shared. The @var{r} part is ignored. This packet is only
37359 applicable to targets that support vforkdone events.
37360
37361 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
37362 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
37363 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
37364 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
37365 indicating support.
37366
37367 @cindex exec events, remote reply
37368 @item exec
37369 The packet indicates that @code{execve} was called, and @var{r}
37370 is the absolute pathname of the file that was executed, in hex.
37371 This packet is only applicable to targets that support exec events.
37372
37373 This packet should not be sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions
37374 did not support it. @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an
37375 appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The
37376 remote stub must also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature
37377 indicating support.
37378
37379 @cindex thread create event, remote reply
37380 @anchor{thread create event}
37381 @item create
37382 The packet indicates that the thread was just created. The new thread
37383 is stopped until @value{GDBN} sets it running with a resumption packet
37384 (@pxref{vCont packet}). This packet should not be sent by default;
37385 @value{GDBN} requests it with the @ref{QThreadEvents} packet. See
37386 also the @samp{w} (@pxref{thread exit event}) remote reply below. The
37387 @var{r} part is ignored.
37388
37389 @end table
37390
37391 @item W @var{AA}
37392 @itemx W @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
37393 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
37394 applicable to certain targets.
37395
37396 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
37397 exited process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
37398 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
37399 extensions}. Both @var{AA} and @var{pid} are formatted as big-endian
37400 hex strings.
37401
37402 @item X @var{AA}
37403 @itemx X @var{AA} ; process:@var{pid}
37404 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
37405
37406 The second form of the response, including the process ID of the
37407 terminated process, can be used only when @value{GDBN} has reported
37408 support for multiprocess protocol extensions; see @ref{multiprocess
37409 extensions}. Both @var{AA} and @var{pid} are formatted as big-endian
37410 hex strings.
37411
37412 @anchor{thread exit event}
37413 @cindex thread exit event, remote reply
37414 @item w @var{AA} ; @var{tid}
37415
37416 The thread exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This response
37417 should not be sent by default; @value{GDBN} requests it with the
37418 @ref{QThreadEvents} packet. See also @ref{thread create event} above.
37419 @var{AA} is formatted as a big-endian hex string.
37420
37421 @item N
37422 There are no resumed threads left in the target. In other words, even
37423 though the process is alive, the last resumed thread has exited. For
37424 example, say the target process has two threads: thread 1 and thread
37425 2. The client leaves thread 1 stopped, and resumes thread 2, which
37426 subsequently exits. At this point, even though the process is still
37427 alive, and thus no @samp{W} stop reply is sent, no thread is actually
37428 executing either. The @samp{N} stop reply thus informs the client
37429 that it can stop waiting for stop replies. This packet should not be
37430 sent by default; older @value{GDBN} versions did not support it.
37431 @value{GDBN} requests it, by supplying an appropriate
37432 @samp{qSupported} feature (@pxref{qSupported}). The remote stub must
37433 also supply the appropriate @samp{qSupported} feature indicating
37434 support.
37435
37436 @item O @var{XX}@dots{}
37437 @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, to be
37438 written as the program's console output. This can happen at any time
37439 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
37440 for @samp{W}, @samp{T}, etc. This reply is not permitted in non-stop mode.
37441
37442 @item F @var{call-id},@var{parameter}@dots{}
37443 @var{call-id} is the identifier which says which host system call should
37444 be called. This is just the name of the function. Translation into the
37445 correct system call is only applicable as it's defined in @value{GDBN}.
37446 @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension}, for a list of implemented
37447 system calls.
37448
37449 @samp{@var{parameter}@dots{}} is a list of parameters as defined for
37450 this very system call.
37451
37452 The target replies with this packet when it expects @value{GDBN} to
37453 call a host system call on behalf of the target. @value{GDBN} replies
37454 with an appropriate @samp{F} packet and keeps up waiting for the next
37455 reply packet from the target. The latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
37456 or @samp{s} action is expected to be continued. @xref{File-I/O Remote
37457 Protocol Extension}, for more details.
37458
37459 @end table
37460
37461 @node General Query Packets
37462 @section General Query Packets
37463 @cindex remote query requests
37464
37465 Packets starting with @samp{q} are @dfn{general query packets};
37466 packets starting with @samp{Q} are @dfn{general set packets}. General
37467 query and set packets are a semi-unified form for retrieving and
37468 sending information to and from the stub.
37469
37470 The initial letter of a query or set packet is followed by a name
37471 indicating what sort of thing the packet applies to. For example,
37472 @value{GDBN} may use a @samp{qSymbol} packet to exchange symbol
37473 definitions with the stub. These packet names follow some
37474 conventions:
37475
37476 @itemize @bullet
37477 @item
37478 The name must not contain commas, colons or semicolons.
37479 @item
37480 Most @value{GDBN} query and set packets have a leading upper case
37481 letter.
37482 @item
37483 The names of custom vendor packets should use a company prefix, in
37484 lower case, followed by a period. For example, packets designed at
37485 the Acme Corporation might begin with @samp{qacme.foo} (for querying
37486 foos) or @samp{Qacme.bar} (for setting bars).
37487 @end itemize
37488
37489 The name of a query or set packet should be separated from any
37490 parameters by a @samp{:}; the parameters themselves should be
37491 separated by @samp{,} or @samp{;}. Stubs must be careful to match the
37492 full packet name, and check for a separator or the end of the packet,
37493 in case two packet names share a common prefix. New packets should not begin
37494 with @samp{qC}, @samp{qP}, or @samp{qL}@footnote{The @samp{qP} and @samp{qL}
37495 packets predate these conventions, and have arguments without any terminator
37496 for the packet name; we suspect they are in widespread use in places that
37497 are difficult to upgrade. The @samp{qC} packet has no arguments, but some
37498 existing stubs (e.g.@: RedBoot) are known to not check for the end of the
37499 packet.}.
37500
37501 Like the descriptions of the other packets, each description here
37502 has a template showing the packet's overall syntax, followed by an
37503 explanation of the packet's meaning. We include spaces in some of the
37504 templates for clarity; these are not part of the packet's syntax. No
37505 @value{GDBN} packet uses spaces to separate its components.
37506
37507 Here are the currently defined query and set packets:
37508
37509 @table @samp
37510
37511 @item QAgent:1
37512 @itemx QAgent:0
37513 Turn on or off the agent as a helper to perform some debugging operations
37514 delegated from @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Control Agent}).
37515
37516 @item QAllow:@var{op}:@var{val}@dots{}
37517 @cindex @samp{QAllow} packet
37518 Specify which operations @value{GDBN} expects to request of the
37519 target, as a semicolon-separated list of operation name and value
37520 pairs. Possible values for @var{op} include @samp{WriteReg},
37521 @samp{WriteMem}, @samp{InsertBreak}, @samp{InsertTrace},
37522 @samp{InsertFastTrace}, and @samp{Stop}. @var{val} is either 0,
37523 indicating that @value{GDBN} will not request the operation, or 1,
37524 indicating that it may. (The target can then use this to set up its
37525 own internals optimally, for instance if the debugger never expects to
37526 insert breakpoints, it may not need to install its own trap handler.)
37527
37528 @item qC
37529 @cindex current thread, remote request
37530 @cindex @samp{qC} packet
37531 Return the current thread ID.
37532
37533 Reply:
37534 @table @samp
37535 @item QC @var{thread-id}
37536 Where @var{thread-id} is a thread ID as documented in
37537 @ref{thread-id syntax}.
37538 @item @r{(anything else)}
37539 Any other reply implies the old thread ID.
37540 @end table
37541
37542 @item qCRC:@var{addr},@var{length}
37543 @cindex CRC of memory block, remote request
37544 @cindex @samp{qCRC} packet
37545 @anchor{qCRC packet}
37546 Compute the CRC checksum of a block of memory using CRC-32 defined in
37547 IEEE 802.3. The CRC is computed byte at a time, taking the most
37548 significant bit of each byte first. The initial pattern code
37549 @code{0xffffffff} is used to ensure leading zeros affect the CRC.
37550
37551 @emph{Note:} This is the same CRC used in validating separate debug
37552 files (@pxref{Separate Debug Files, , Debugging Information in Separate
37553 Files}). However the algorithm is slightly different. When validating
37554 separate debug files, the CRC is computed taking the @emph{least}
37555 significant bit of each byte first, and the final result is inverted to
37556 detect trailing zeros.
37557
37558 Reply:
37559 @table @samp
37560 @item E @var{NN}
37561 An error (such as memory fault)
37562 @item C @var{crc32}
37563 The specified memory region's checksum is @var{crc32}.
37564 @end table
37565
37566 @item QDisableRandomization:@var{value}
37567 @cindex disable address space randomization, remote request
37568 @cindex @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet
37569 Some target operating systems will randomize the virtual address space
37570 of the inferior process as a security feature, but provide a feature
37571 to disable such randomization, e.g.@: to allow for a more deterministic
37572 debugging experience. On such systems, this packet with a @var{value}
37573 of 1 directs the target to disable address space randomization for
37574 processes subsequently started via @samp{vRun} packets, while a packet
37575 with a @var{value} of 0 tells the target to enable address space
37576 randomization.
37577
37578 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended mode}).
37579
37580 Reply:
37581 @table @samp
37582 @item OK
37583 The request succeeded.
37584
37585 @item E @var{nn}
37586 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
37587
37588 @item @w{}
37589 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QDisableRandomization} is not supported
37590 by the stub.
37591 @end table
37592
37593 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37594 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37595 This should only be done on targets that actually support disabling
37596 address space randomization.
37597
37598 @item QStartupWithShell:@var{value}
37599 @cindex startup with shell, remote request
37600 @cindex @samp{QStartupWithShell} packet
37601 On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to start the inferior using a
37602 shell program. This is the default behavior on both @value{GDBN} and
37603 @command{gdbserver} (@pxref{set startup-with-shell}). This packet is
37604 used to inform @command{gdbserver} whether it should start the
37605 inferior using a shell or not.
37606
37607 If @var{value} is @samp{0}, @command{gdbserver} will not use a shell
37608 to start the inferior. If @var{value} is @samp{1},
37609 @command{gdbserver} will use a shell to start the inferior. All other
37610 values are considered an error.
37611
37612 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
37613 mode}).
37614
37615 Reply:
37616 @table @samp
37617 @item OK
37618 The request succeeded.
37619
37620 @item E @var{nn}
37621 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
37622 @end table
37623
37624 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37625 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37626 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
37627 actually support starting the inferior using a shell.
37628
37629 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set startup-with-shell}
37630 command; @pxref{set startup-with-shell}.
37631
37632 @item QEnvironmentHexEncoded:@var{hex-value}
37633 @anchor{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}
37634 @cindex set environment variable, remote request
37635 @cindex @samp{QEnvironmentHexEncoded} packet
37636 On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to set environment variables that
37637 will be passed to the inferior during the startup process. This
37638 packet is used to inform @command{gdbserver} of an environment
37639 variable that has been defined by the user on @value{GDBN} (@pxref{set
37640 environment}).
37641
37642 The packet is composed by @var{hex-value}, an hex encoded
37643 representation of the @var{name=value} format representing an
37644 environment variable. The name of the environment variable is
37645 represented by @var{name}, and the value to be assigned to the
37646 environment variable is represented by @var{value}. If the variable
37647 has no value (i.e., the value is @code{null}), then @var{value} will
37648 not be present.
37649
37650 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
37651 mode}).
37652
37653 Reply:
37654 @table @samp
37655 @item OK
37656 The request succeeded.
37657 @end table
37658
37659 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37660 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37661 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
37662 actually support passing environment variables to the starting
37663 inferior.
37664
37665 This packet is related to the @code{set environment} command;
37666 @pxref{set environment}.
37667
37668 @item QEnvironmentUnset:@var{hex-value}
37669 @anchor{QEnvironmentUnset}
37670 @cindex unset environment variable, remote request
37671 @cindex @samp{QEnvironmentUnset} packet
37672 On UNIX-like targets, it is possible to unset environment variables
37673 before starting the inferior in the remote target. This packet is
37674 used to inform @command{gdbserver} of an environment variable that has
37675 been unset by the user on @value{GDBN} (@pxref{unset environment}).
37676
37677 The packet is composed by @var{hex-value}, an hex encoded
37678 representation of the name of the environment variable to be unset.
37679
37680 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
37681 mode}).
37682
37683 Reply:
37684 @table @samp
37685 @item OK
37686 The request succeeded.
37687 @end table
37688
37689 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37690 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37691 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
37692 actually support passing environment variables to the starting
37693 inferior.
37694
37695 This packet is related to the @code{unset environment} command;
37696 @pxref{unset environment}.
37697
37698 @item QEnvironmentReset
37699 @anchor{QEnvironmentReset}
37700 @cindex reset environment, remote request
37701 @cindex @samp{QEnvironmentReset} packet
37702 On UNIX-like targets, this packet is used to reset the state of
37703 environment variables in the remote target before starting the
37704 inferior. In this context, reset means unsetting all environment
37705 variables that were previously set by the user (i.e., were not
37706 initially present in the environment). It is sent to
37707 @command{gdbserver} before the @samp{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}
37708 (@pxref{QEnvironmentHexEncoded}) and the @samp{QEnvironmentUnset}
37709 (@pxref{QEnvironmentUnset}) packets.
37710
37711 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
37712 mode}).
37713
37714 Reply:
37715 @table @samp
37716 @item OK
37717 The request succeeded.
37718 @end table
37719
37720 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37721 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
37722 (@pxref{qSupported}). This should only be done on targets that
37723 actually support passing environment variables to the starting
37724 inferior.
37725
37726 @item QSetWorkingDir:@r{[}@var{directory}@r{]}
37727 @anchor{QSetWorkingDir packet}
37728 @cindex set working directory, remote request
37729 @cindex @samp{QSetWorkingDir} packet
37730 This packet is used to inform the remote server of the intended
37731 current working directory for programs that are going to be executed.
37732
37733 The packet is composed by @var{directory}, an hex encoded
37734 representation of the directory that the remote inferior will use as
37735 its current working directory. If @var{directory} is an empty string,
37736 the remote server should reset the inferior's current working
37737 directory to its original, empty value.
37738
37739 This packet is only available in extended mode (@pxref{extended
37740 mode}).
37741
37742 Reply:
37743 @table @samp
37744 @item OK
37745 The request succeeded.
37746 @end table
37747
37748 @item qfThreadInfo
37749 @itemx qsThreadInfo
37750 @cindex list active threads, remote request
37751 @cindex @samp{qfThreadInfo} packet
37752 @cindex @samp{qsThreadInfo} packet
37753 Obtain a list of all active thread IDs from the target (OS). Since there
37754 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
37755 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
37756 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
37757 be the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
37758 sequence will be the @samp{qsThreadInfo} query.
37759
37760 NOTE: This packet replaces the @samp{qL} query (see below).
37761
37762 Reply:
37763 @table @samp
37764 @item m @var{thread-id}
37765 A single thread ID
37766 @item m @var{thread-id},@var{thread-id}@dots{}
37767 a comma-separated list of thread IDs
37768 @item l
37769 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
37770 @end table
37771
37772 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
37773 more thread IDs, separated by commas.
37774 @value{GDBN} will respond to each reply with a request for more thread
37775 ids (using the @samp{qs} form of the query), until the target responds
37776 with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for @dfn{last}).
37777 Refer to @ref{thread-id syntax}, for the format of the @var{thread-id}
37778 fields.
37779
37780 @emph{Note: @value{GDBN} will send the @code{qfThreadInfo} query during the
37781 initial connection with the remote target, and the very first thread ID
37782 mentioned in the reply will be stopped by @value{GDBN} in a subsequent
37783 message. Therefore, the stub should ensure that the first thread ID in
37784 the @code{qfThreadInfo} reply is suitable for being stopped by @value{GDBN}.}
37785
37786 @item qGetTLSAddr:@var{thread-id},@var{offset},@var{lm}
37787 @cindex get thread-local storage address, remote request
37788 @cindex @samp{qGetTLSAddr} packet
37789 Fetch the address associated with thread local storage specified
37790 by @var{thread-id}, @var{offset}, and @var{lm}.
37791
37792 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the
37793 thread for which to fetch the TLS address. @xref{thread-id syntax}.
37794
37795 @var{offset} is the (big endian, hex encoded) offset associated with the
37796 thread local variable. (This offset is obtained from the debug
37797 information associated with the variable.)
37798
37799 @var{lm} is the (big endian, hex encoded) OS/ABI-specific encoding of the
37800 load module associated with the thread local storage. For example,
37801 a @sc{gnu}/Linux system will pass the link map address of the shared
37802 object associated with the thread local storage under consideration.
37803 Other operating environments may choose to represent the load module
37804 differently, so the precise meaning of this parameter will vary.
37805
37806 Reply:
37807 @table @samp
37808 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
37809 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the address of the thread
37810 local storage requested.
37811
37812 @item E @var{nn}
37813 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
37814
37815 @item @w{}
37816 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTLSAddr} is not supported by the stub.
37817 @end table
37818
37819 @item qGetTIBAddr:@var{thread-id}
37820 @cindex get thread information block address
37821 @cindex @samp{qGetTIBAddr} packet
37822 Fetch address of the Windows OS specific Thread Information Block.
37823
37824 @var{thread-id} is the thread ID associated with the thread.
37825
37826 Reply:
37827 @table @samp
37828 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
37829 Hex encoded (big endian) bytes representing the linear address of the
37830 thread information block.
37831
37832 @item E @var{nn}
37833 An error occured. This means that either the thread was not found, or the
37834 address could not be retrieved.
37835
37836 @item @w{}
37837 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qGetTIBAddr} is not supported by the stub.
37838 @end table
37839
37840 @item qL @var{startflag} @var{threadcount} @var{nextthread}
37841 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
37842 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
37843 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
37844 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
37845 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
37846 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
37847
37848 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qfThreadInfo} query instead (see above).
37849
37850 Reply:
37851 @table @samp
37852 @item qM @var{count} @var{done} @var{argthread} @var{thread}@dots{}
37853 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
37854 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
37855 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
37856 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread}@dots{}
37857 is a sequence of thread IDs, @var{threadid} (eight hex
37858 digits), from the target. See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
37859 @end table
37860
37861 @item qOffsets
37862 @cindex section offsets, remote request
37863 @cindex @samp{qOffsets} packet
37864 Get section offsets that the target used when relocating the downloaded
37865 image.
37866
37867 Reply:
37868 @table @samp
37869 @item Text=@var{xxx};Data=@var{yyy}@r{[};Bss=@var{zzz}@r{]}
37870 Relocate the @code{Text} section by @var{xxx} from its original address.
37871 Relocate the @code{Data} section by @var{yyy} from its original address.
37872 If the object file format provides segment information (e.g.@: @sc{elf}
37873 @samp{PT_LOAD} program headers), @value{GDBN} will relocate entire
37874 segments by the supplied offsets.
37875
37876 @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset may be included in the response,
37877 @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data} offset
37878 to the @code{Bss} section.}
37879
37880 @item TextSeg=@var{xxx}@r{[};DataSeg=@var{yyy}@r{]}
37881 Relocate the first segment of the object file, which conventionally
37882 contains program code, to a starting address of @var{xxx}. If
37883 @samp{DataSeg} is specified, relocate the second segment, which
37884 conventionally contains modifiable data, to a starting address of
37885 @var{yyy}. @value{GDBN} will report an error if the object file
37886 does not contain segment information, or does not contain at least
37887 as many segments as mentioned in the reply. Extra segments are
37888 kept at fixed offsets relative to the last relocated segment.
37889 @end table
37890
37891 @item qP @var{mode} @var{thread-id}
37892 @cindex thread information, remote request
37893 @cindex @samp{qP} packet
37894 Returns information on @var{thread-id}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
37895 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{thread-id} is a thread ID
37896 (@pxref{thread-id syntax}).
37897
37898 Don't use this packet; use the @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} query instead
37899 (see below).
37900
37901 Reply: see @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
37902
37903 @item QNonStop:1
37904 @itemx QNonStop:0
37905 @cindex non-stop mode, remote request
37906 @cindex @samp{QNonStop} packet
37907 @anchor{QNonStop}
37908 Enter non-stop (@samp{QNonStop:1}) or all-stop (@samp{QNonStop:0}) mode.
37909 @xref{Remote Non-Stop}, for more information.
37910
37911 Reply:
37912 @table @samp
37913 @item OK
37914 The request succeeded.
37915
37916 @item E @var{nn}
37917 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
37918
37919 @item @w{}
37920 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QNonStop} is not supported by
37921 the stub.
37922 @end table
37923
37924 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37925 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37926 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set non-stop} command;
37927 @pxref{Non-Stop Mode}.
37928
37929 @item QCatchSyscalls:1 @r{[};@var{sysno}@r{]}@dots{}
37930 @itemx QCatchSyscalls:0
37931 @cindex catch syscalls from inferior, remote request
37932 @cindex @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet
37933 @anchor{QCatchSyscalls}
37934 Enable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}) or disable (@samp{QCatchSyscalls:0})
37935 catching syscalls from the inferior process.
37936
37937 For @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1}, each listed syscall @var{sysno} (encoded
37938 in hex) should be reported to @value{GDBN}. If no syscall @var{sysno}
37939 is listed, every system call should be reported.
37940
37941 Note that if a syscall not in the list is reported, @value{GDBN} will
37942 still filter the event according to its own list from all corresponding
37943 @code{catch syscall} commands. However, it is more efficient to only
37944 report the requested syscalls.
37945
37946 Multiple @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} packets do not combine; any earlier
37947 @samp{QCatchSyscalls:1} list is completely replaced by the new list.
37948
37949 If the inferior process execs, the state of @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is
37950 kept for the new process too. On targets where exec may affect syscall
37951 numbers, for example with exec between 32 and 64-bit processes, the
37952 client should send a new packet with the new syscall list.
37953
37954 Reply:
37955 @table @samp
37956 @item OK
37957 The request succeeded.
37958
37959 @item E @var{nn}
37960 An error occurred. @var{nn} are hex digits.
37961
37962 @item @w{}
37963 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QCatchSyscalls} is not supported by
37964 the stub.
37965 @end table
37966
37967 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote catch-syscalls}
37968 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote catch-syscalls}).
37969 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
37970 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
37971
37972 @item QPassSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
37973 @cindex pass signals to inferior, remote request
37974 @cindex @samp{QPassSignals} packet
37975 @anchor{QPassSignals}
37976 Each listed @var{signal} should be passed directly to the inferior process.
37977 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
37978 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
37979 strictly greater than the previous item. These signals do not need to stop
37980 the inferior, or be reported to @value{GDBN}. All other signals should be
37981 reported to @value{GDBN}. Multiple @samp{QPassSignals} packets do not
37982 combine; any earlier @samp{QPassSignals} list is completely replaced by the
37983 new list. This packet improves performance when using @samp{handle
37984 @var{signal} nostop noprint pass}.
37985
37986 Reply:
37987 @table @samp
37988 @item OK
37989 The request succeeded.
37990
37991 @item E @var{nn}
37992 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
37993
37994 @item @w{}
37995 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QPassSignals} is not supported by
37996 the stub.
37997 @end table
37998
37999 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote pass-signals}
38000 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote pass-signals}).
38001 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38002 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38003
38004 @item QProgramSignals: @var{signal} @r{[};@var{signal}@r{]}@dots{}
38005 @cindex signals the inferior may see, remote request
38006 @cindex @samp{QProgramSignals} packet
38007 @anchor{QProgramSignals}
38008 Each listed @var{signal} may be delivered to the inferior process.
38009 Others should be silently discarded.
38010
38011 In some cases, the remote stub may need to decide whether to deliver a
38012 signal to the program or not without @value{GDBN} involvement. One
38013 example of that is while detaching --- the program's threads may have
38014 stopped for signals that haven't yet had a chance of being reported to
38015 @value{GDBN}, and so the remote stub can use the signal list specified
38016 by this packet to know whether to deliver or ignore those pending
38017 signals.
38018
38019 This does not influence whether to deliver a signal as requested by a
38020 resumption packet (@pxref{vCont packet}).
38021
38022 Signals are numbered identically to continue packets and stop replies
38023 (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}). Each @var{signal} list item should be
38024 strictly greater than the previous item. Multiple
38025 @samp{QProgramSignals} packets do not combine; any earlier
38026 @samp{QProgramSignals} list is completely replaced by the new list.
38027
38028 Reply:
38029 @table @samp
38030 @item OK
38031 The request succeeded.
38032
38033 @item E @var{nn}
38034 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38035
38036 @item @w{}
38037 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QProgramSignals} is not supported
38038 by the stub.
38039 @end table
38040
38041 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote program-signals}
38042 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote program-signals}).
38043 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38044 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38045
38046 @anchor{QThreadEvents}
38047 @item QThreadEvents:1
38048 @itemx QThreadEvents:0
38049 @cindex thread create/exit events, remote request
38050 @cindex @samp{QThreadEvents} packet
38051
38052 Enable (@samp{QThreadEvents:1}) or disable (@samp{QThreadEvents:0})
38053 reporting of thread create and exit events. @xref{thread create
38054 event}, for the reply specifications. For example, this is used in
38055 non-stop mode when @value{GDBN} stops a set of threads and
38056 synchronously waits for the their corresponding stop replies. Without
38057 exit events, if one of the threads exits, @value{GDBN} would hang
38058 forever not knowing that it should no longer expect a stop for that
38059 same thread. @value{GDBN} does not enable this feature unless the
38060 stub reports that it supports it by including @samp{QThreadEvents+} in
38061 its @samp{qSupported} reply.
38062
38063 Reply:
38064 @table @samp
38065 @item OK
38066 The request succeeded.
38067
38068 @item E @var{nn}
38069 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
38070
38071 @item @w{}
38072 An empty reply indicates that @samp{QThreadEvents} is not supported by
38073 the stub.
38074 @end table
38075
38076 Use of this packet is controlled by the @code{set remote thread-events}
38077 command (@pxref{Remote Configuration, set remote thread-events}).
38078
38079 @item qRcmd,@var{command}
38080 @cindex execute remote command, remote request
38081 @cindex @samp{qRcmd} packet
38082 @var{command} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
38083 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output
38084 string. Before the final result packet, the target may also respond
38085 with a number of intermediate @samp{O@var{output}} console output
38086 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
38087 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
38088
38089 Reply:
38090 @table @samp
38091 @item OK
38092 A command response with no output.
38093 @item @var{OUTPUT}
38094 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
38095 @item E @var{NN}
38096 Indicate a badly formed request.
38097 @item @w{}
38098 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qRcmd} is not recognized.
38099 @end table
38100
38101 (Note that the @code{qRcmd} packet's name is separated from the
38102 command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
38103 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
38104 packets.)
38105
38106 @item qSearch:memory:@var{address};@var{length};@var{search-pattern}
38107 @cindex searching memory, in remote debugging
38108 @ifnotinfo
38109 @cindex @samp{qSearch:memory} packet
38110 @end ifnotinfo
38111 @cindex @samp{qSearch memory} packet
38112 @anchor{qSearch memory}
38113 Search @var{length} bytes at @var{address} for @var{search-pattern}.
38114 Both @var{address} and @var{length} are encoded in hex;
38115 @var{search-pattern} is a sequence of bytes, also hex encoded.
38116
38117 Reply:
38118 @table @samp
38119 @item 0
38120 The pattern was not found.
38121 @item 1,address
38122 The pattern was found at @var{address}.
38123 @item E @var{NN}
38124 A badly formed request or an error was encountered while searching memory.
38125 @item @w{}
38126 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSearch:memory} is not recognized.
38127 @end table
38128
38129 @item QStartNoAckMode
38130 @cindex @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet
38131 @anchor{QStartNoAckMode}
38132 Request that the remote stub disable the normal @samp{+}/@samp{-}
38133 protocol acknowledgments (@pxref{Packet Acknowledgment}).
38134
38135 Reply:
38136 @table @samp
38137 @item OK
38138 The stub has switched to no-acknowledgment mode.
38139 @value{GDBN} acknowledges this reponse,
38140 but neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or expect further
38141 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments in the current connection.
38142 @item @w{}
38143 An empty reply indicates that the stub does not support no-acknowledgment mode.
38144 @end table
38145
38146 @item qSupported @r{[}:@var{gdbfeature} @r{[};@var{gdbfeature}@r{]}@dots{} @r{]}
38147 @cindex supported packets, remote query
38148 @cindex features of the remote protocol
38149 @cindex @samp{qSupported} packet
38150 @anchor{qSupported}
38151 Tell the remote stub about features supported by @value{GDBN}, and
38152 query the stub for features it supports. This packet allows
38153 @value{GDBN} and the remote stub to take advantage of each others'
38154 features. @samp{qSupported} also consolidates multiple feature probes
38155 at startup, to improve @value{GDBN} performance---a single larger
38156 packet performs better than multiple smaller probe packets on
38157 high-latency links. Some features may enable behavior which must not
38158 be on by default, e.g.@: because it would confuse older clients or
38159 stubs. Other features may describe packets which could be
38160 automatically probed for, but are not. These features must be
38161 reported before @value{GDBN} will use them. This ``default
38162 unsupported'' behavior is not appropriate for all packets, but it
38163 helps to keep the initial connection time under control with new
38164 versions of @value{GDBN} which support increasing numbers of packets.
38165
38166 Reply:
38167 @table @samp
38168 @item @var{stubfeature} @r{[};@var{stubfeature}@r{]}@dots{}
38169 The stub supports or does not support each returned @var{stubfeature},
38170 depending on the form of each @var{stubfeature} (see below for the
38171 possible forms).
38172 @item @w{}
38173 An empty reply indicates that @samp{qSupported} is not recognized,
38174 or that no features needed to be reported to @value{GDBN}.
38175 @end table
38176
38177 The allowed forms for each feature (either a @var{gdbfeature} in the
38178 @samp{qSupported} packet, or a @var{stubfeature} in the response)
38179 are:
38180
38181 @table @samp
38182 @item @var{name}=@var{value}
38183 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and associated
38184 with the specified @var{value}. The format of @var{value} depends
38185 on the feature, but it must not include a semicolon.
38186 @item @var{name}+
38187 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is supported, and does not
38188 need an associated value.
38189 @item @var{name}-
38190 The remote protocol feature @var{name} is not supported.
38191 @item @var{name}?
38192 The remote protocol feature @var{name} may be supported, and
38193 @value{GDBN} should auto-detect support in some other way when it is
38194 needed. This form will not be used for @var{gdbfeature} notifications,
38195 but may be used for @var{stubfeature} responses.
38196 @end table
38197
38198 Whenever the stub receives a @samp{qSupported} request, the
38199 supplied set of @value{GDBN} features should override any previous
38200 request. This allows @value{GDBN} to put the stub in a known
38201 state, even if the stub had previously been communicating with
38202 a different version of @value{GDBN}.
38203
38204 The following values of @var{gdbfeature} (for the packet sent by @value{GDBN})
38205 are defined:
38206
38207 @table @samp
38208 @item multiprocess
38209 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports multiprocess
38210 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
38211 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
38212 including @samp{multiprocess+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
38213 @xref{multiprocess extensions}, for details.
38214
38215 @item xmlRegisters
38216 This feature indicates that @value{GDBN} supports the XML target
38217 description. If the stub sees @samp{xmlRegisters=} with target
38218 specific strings separated by a comma, it will report register
38219 description.
38220
38221 @item qRelocInsn
38222 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the
38223 @samp{qRelocInsn} packet (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
38224 instruction reply packet}).
38225
38226 @item swbreak
38227 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the swbreak stop
38228 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
38229
38230 @item hwbreak
38231 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports the hwbreak stop
38232 reason in stop replies. @xref{swbreak stop reason}, for details.
38233
38234 @item fork-events
38235 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports fork event
38236 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
38237 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
38238 including @samp{fork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
38239
38240 @item vfork-events
38241 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports vfork event
38242 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
38243 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
38244 including @samp{vfork-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
38245
38246 @item exec-events
38247 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} supports exec event
38248 extensions to the remote protocol. @value{GDBN} does not use such
38249 extensions unless the stub also reports that it supports them by
38250 including @samp{exec-events+} in its @samp{qSupported} reply.
38251
38252 @item vContSupported
38253 This feature indicates whether @value{GDBN} wants to know the
38254 supported actions in the reply to @samp{vCont?} packet.
38255 @end table
38256
38257 Stubs should ignore any unknown values for
38258 @var{gdbfeature}. Any @value{GDBN} which sends a @samp{qSupported}
38259 packet supports receiving packets of unlimited length (earlier
38260 versions of @value{GDBN} may reject overly long responses). Additional values
38261 for @var{gdbfeature} may be defined in the future to let the stub take
38262 advantage of new features in @value{GDBN}, e.g.@: incompatible
38263 improvements in the remote protocol---the @samp{multiprocess} feature is
38264 an example of such a feature. The stub's reply should be independent
38265 of the @var{gdbfeature} entries sent by @value{GDBN}; first @value{GDBN}
38266 describes all the features it supports, and then the stub replies with
38267 all the features it supports.
38268
38269 Similarly, @value{GDBN} will silently ignore unrecognized stub feature
38270 responses, as long as each response uses one of the standard forms.
38271
38272 Some features are flags. A stub which supports a flag feature
38273 should respond with a @samp{+} form response. Other features
38274 require values, and the stub should respond with an @samp{=}
38275 form response.
38276
38277 Each feature has a default value, which @value{GDBN} will use if
38278 @samp{qSupported} is not available or if the feature is not mentioned
38279 in the @samp{qSupported} response. The default values are fixed; a
38280 stub is free to omit any feature responses that match the defaults.
38281
38282 Not all features can be probed, but for those which can, the probing
38283 mechanism is useful: in some cases, a stub's internal
38284 architecture may not allow the protocol layer to know some information
38285 about the underlying target in advance. This is especially common in
38286 stubs which may be configured for multiple targets.
38287
38288 These are the currently defined stub features and their properties:
38289
38290 @multitable @columnfractions 0.35 0.2 0.12 0.2
38291 @c NOTE: The first row should be @headitem, but we do not yet require
38292 @c a new enough version of Texinfo (4.7) to use @headitem.
38293 @item Feature Name
38294 @tab Value Required
38295 @tab Default
38296 @tab Probe Allowed
38297
38298 @item @samp{PacketSize}
38299 @tab Yes
38300 @tab @samp{-}
38301 @tab No
38302
38303 @item @samp{qXfer:auxv:read}
38304 @tab No
38305 @tab @samp{-}
38306 @tab Yes
38307
38308 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
38309 @tab No
38310 @tab @samp{-}
38311 @tab Yes
38312
38313 @item @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
38314 @tab No
38315 @tab @samp{-}
38316 @tab Yes
38317
38318 @item @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read}
38319 @tab No
38320 @tab @samp{-}
38321 @tab Yes
38322
38323 @item @samp{qXfer:features:read}
38324 @tab No
38325 @tab @samp{-}
38326 @tab Yes
38327
38328 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
38329 @tab No
38330 @tab @samp{-}
38331 @tab Yes
38332
38333 @item @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read}
38334 @tab No
38335 @tab @samp{-}
38336 @tab Yes
38337
38338 @item @samp{augmented-libraries-svr4-read}
38339 @tab No
38340 @tab @samp{-}
38341 @tab No
38342
38343 @item @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
38344 @tab No
38345 @tab @samp{-}
38346 @tab Yes
38347
38348 @item @samp{qXfer:sdata:read}
38349 @tab No
38350 @tab @samp{-}
38351 @tab Yes
38352
38353 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:read}
38354 @tab No
38355 @tab @samp{-}
38356 @tab Yes
38357
38358 @item @samp{qXfer:spu:write}
38359 @tab No
38360 @tab @samp{-}
38361 @tab Yes
38362
38363 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read}
38364 @tab No
38365 @tab @samp{-}
38366 @tab Yes
38367
38368 @item @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write}
38369 @tab No
38370 @tab @samp{-}
38371 @tab Yes
38372
38373 @item @samp{qXfer:threads:read}
38374 @tab No
38375 @tab @samp{-}
38376 @tab Yes
38377
38378 @item @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
38379 @tab No
38380 @tab @samp{-}
38381 @tab Yes
38382
38383 @item @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
38384 @tab No
38385 @tab @samp{-}
38386 @tab Yes
38387
38388 @item @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
38389 @tab No
38390 @tab @samp{-}
38391 @tab Yes
38392
38393 @item @samp{Qbtrace:off}
38394 @tab Yes
38395 @tab @samp{-}
38396 @tab Yes
38397
38398 @item @samp{Qbtrace:bts}
38399 @tab Yes
38400 @tab @samp{-}
38401 @tab Yes
38402
38403 @item @samp{Qbtrace:pt}
38404 @tab Yes
38405 @tab @samp{-}
38406 @tab Yes
38407
38408 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size}
38409 @tab Yes
38410 @tab @samp{-}
38411 @tab Yes
38412
38413 @item @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size}
38414 @tab Yes
38415 @tab @samp{-}
38416 @tab Yes
38417
38418 @item @samp{QNonStop}
38419 @tab No
38420 @tab @samp{-}
38421 @tab Yes
38422
38423 @item @samp{QCatchSyscalls}
38424 @tab No
38425 @tab @samp{-}
38426 @tab Yes
38427
38428 @item @samp{QPassSignals}
38429 @tab No
38430 @tab @samp{-}
38431 @tab Yes
38432
38433 @item @samp{QStartNoAckMode}
38434 @tab No
38435 @tab @samp{-}
38436 @tab Yes
38437
38438 @item @samp{multiprocess}
38439 @tab No
38440 @tab @samp{-}
38441 @tab No
38442
38443 @item @samp{ConditionalBreakpoints}
38444 @tab No
38445 @tab @samp{-}
38446 @tab No
38447
38448 @item @samp{ConditionalTracepoints}
38449 @tab No
38450 @tab @samp{-}
38451 @tab No
38452
38453 @item @samp{ReverseContinue}
38454 @tab No
38455 @tab @samp{-}
38456 @tab No
38457
38458 @item @samp{ReverseStep}
38459 @tab No
38460 @tab @samp{-}
38461 @tab No
38462
38463 @item @samp{TracepointSource}
38464 @tab No
38465 @tab @samp{-}
38466 @tab No
38467
38468 @item @samp{QAgent}
38469 @tab No
38470 @tab @samp{-}
38471 @tab No
38472
38473 @item @samp{QAllow}
38474 @tab No
38475 @tab @samp{-}
38476 @tab No
38477
38478 @item @samp{QDisableRandomization}
38479 @tab No
38480 @tab @samp{-}
38481 @tab No
38482
38483 @item @samp{EnableDisableTracepoints}
38484 @tab No
38485 @tab @samp{-}
38486 @tab No
38487
38488 @item @samp{QTBuffer:size}
38489 @tab No
38490 @tab @samp{-}
38491 @tab No
38492
38493 @item @samp{tracenz}
38494 @tab No
38495 @tab @samp{-}
38496 @tab No
38497
38498 @item @samp{BreakpointCommands}
38499 @tab No
38500 @tab @samp{-}
38501 @tab No
38502
38503 @item @samp{swbreak}
38504 @tab No
38505 @tab @samp{-}
38506 @tab No
38507
38508 @item @samp{hwbreak}
38509 @tab No
38510 @tab @samp{-}
38511 @tab No
38512
38513 @item @samp{fork-events}
38514 @tab No
38515 @tab @samp{-}
38516 @tab No
38517
38518 @item @samp{vfork-events}
38519 @tab No
38520 @tab @samp{-}
38521 @tab No
38522
38523 @item @samp{exec-events}
38524 @tab No
38525 @tab @samp{-}
38526 @tab No
38527
38528 @item @samp{QThreadEvents}
38529 @tab No
38530 @tab @samp{-}
38531 @tab No
38532
38533 @item @samp{no-resumed}
38534 @tab No
38535 @tab @samp{-}
38536 @tab No
38537
38538 @end multitable
38539
38540 These are the currently defined stub features, in more detail:
38541
38542 @table @samp
38543 @cindex packet size, remote protocol
38544 @item PacketSize=@var{bytes}
38545 The remote stub can accept packets up to at least @var{bytes} in
38546 length. @value{GDBN} will send packets up to this size for bulk
38547 transfers, and will never send larger packets. This is a limit on the
38548 data characters in the packet, including the frame and checksum.
38549 There is no trailing NUL byte in a remote protocol packet; if the stub
38550 stores packets in a NUL-terminated format, it should allow an extra
38551 byte in its buffer for the NUL. If this stub feature is not supported,
38552 @value{GDBN} guesses based on the size of the @samp{g} packet response.
38553
38554 @item qXfer:auxv:read
38555 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:auxv:read} packet
38556 (@pxref{qXfer auxiliary vector read}).
38557
38558 @item qXfer:btrace:read
38559 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
38560 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}).
38561
38562 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read
38563 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
38564 packet (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}).
38565
38566 @item qXfer:exec-file:read
38567 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:exec-file:read} packet
38568 (@pxref{qXfer executable filename read}).
38569
38570 @item qXfer:features:read
38571 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:features:read} packet
38572 (@pxref{qXfer target description read}).
38573
38574 @item qXfer:libraries:read
38575 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet
38576 (@pxref{qXfer library list read}).
38577
38578 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read
38579 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
38580 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
38581
38582 @item augmented-libraries-svr4-read
38583 The remote stub understands the augmented form of the
38584 @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet
38585 (@pxref{qXfer svr4 library list read}).
38586
38587 @item qXfer:memory-map:read
38588 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read} packet
38589 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}).
38590
38591 @item qXfer:sdata:read
38592 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:sdata:read} packet
38593 (@pxref{qXfer sdata read}).
38594
38595 @item qXfer:spu:read
38596 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:read} packet
38597 (@pxref{qXfer spu read}).
38598
38599 @item qXfer:spu:write
38600 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:spu:write} packet
38601 (@pxref{qXfer spu write}).
38602
38603 @item qXfer:siginfo:read
38604 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:read} packet
38605 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo read}).
38606
38607 @item qXfer:siginfo:write
38608 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:siginfo:write} packet
38609 (@pxref{qXfer siginfo write}).
38610
38611 @item qXfer:threads:read
38612 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
38613 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}).
38614
38615 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read
38616 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
38617 packet (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}).
38618
38619 @item qXfer:uib:read
38620 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:uib:read}
38621 packet (@pxref{qXfer unwind info block}).
38622
38623 @item qXfer:fdpic:read
38624 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:fdpic:read}
38625 packet (@pxref{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}).
38626
38627 @item QNonStop
38628 The remote stub understands the @samp{QNonStop} packet
38629 (@pxref{QNonStop}).
38630
38631 @item QCatchSyscalls
38632 The remote stub understands the @samp{QCatchSyscalls} packet
38633 (@pxref{QCatchSyscalls}).
38634
38635 @item QPassSignals
38636 The remote stub understands the @samp{QPassSignals} packet
38637 (@pxref{QPassSignals}).
38638
38639 @item QStartNoAckMode
38640 The remote stub understands the @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet and
38641 prefers to operate in no-acknowledgment mode. @xref{Packet Acknowledgment}.
38642
38643 @item multiprocess
38644 @anchor{multiprocess extensions}
38645 @cindex multiprocess extensions, in remote protocol
38646 The remote stub understands the multiprocess extensions to the remote
38647 protocol syntax. The multiprocess extensions affect the syntax of
38648 thread IDs in both packets and replies (@pxref{thread-id syntax}), and
38649 add process IDs to the @samp{D} packet and @samp{W} and @samp{X}
38650 replies. Note that reporting this feature indicates support for the
38651 syntactic extensions only, not that the stub necessarily supports
38652 debugging of more than one process at a time. The stub must not use
38653 multiprocess extensions in packet replies unless @value{GDBN} has also
38654 indicated it supports them in its @samp{qSupported} request.
38655
38656 @item qXfer:osdata:read
38657 The remote stub understands the @samp{qXfer:osdata:read} packet
38658 ((@pxref{qXfer osdata read}).
38659
38660 @item ConditionalBreakpoints
38661 The target accepts and implements evaluation of conditional expressions
38662 defined for breakpoints. The target will only report breakpoint triggers
38663 when such conditions are true (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break Conditions}).
38664
38665 @item ConditionalTracepoints
38666 The remote stub accepts and implements conditional expressions defined
38667 for tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoint Conditions}).
38668
38669 @item ReverseContinue
38670 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse continue packet
38671 (@pxref{bc}).
38672
38673 @item ReverseStep
38674 The remote stub accepts and implements the reverse step packet
38675 (@pxref{bs}).
38676
38677 @item TracepointSource
38678 The remote stub understands the @samp{QTDPsrc} packet that supplies
38679 the source form of tracepoint definitions.
38680
38681 @item QAgent
38682 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAgent} packet.
38683
38684 @item QAllow
38685 The remote stub understands the @samp{QAllow} packet.
38686
38687 @item QDisableRandomization
38688 The remote stub understands the @samp{QDisableRandomization} packet.
38689
38690 @item StaticTracepoint
38691 @cindex static tracepoints, in remote protocol
38692 The remote stub supports static tracepoints.
38693
38694 @item InstallInTrace
38695 @anchor{install tracepoint in tracing}
38696 The remote stub supports installing tracepoint in tracing.
38697
38698 @item EnableDisableTracepoints
38699 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTEnable} (@pxref{QTEnable}) and
38700 @samp{QTDisable} (@pxref{QTDisable}) packets that allow tracepoints
38701 to be enabled and disabled while a trace experiment is running.
38702
38703 @item QTBuffer:size
38704 The remote stub supports the @samp{QTBuffer:size} (@pxref{QTBuffer-size})
38705 packet that allows to change the size of the trace buffer.
38706
38707 @item tracenz
38708 @cindex string tracing, in remote protocol
38709 The remote stub supports the @samp{tracenz} bytecode for collecting strings.
38710 See @ref{Bytecode Descriptions} for details about the bytecode.
38711
38712 @item BreakpointCommands
38713 @cindex breakpoint commands, in remote protocol
38714 The remote stub supports running a breakpoint's command list itself,
38715 rather than reporting the hit to @value{GDBN}.
38716
38717 @item Qbtrace:off
38718 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:off} packet.
38719
38720 @item Qbtrace:bts
38721 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:bts} packet.
38722
38723 @item Qbtrace:pt
38724 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace:pt} packet.
38725
38726 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size
38727 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:bts:size} packet.
38728
38729 @item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size
38730 The remote stub understands the @samp{Qbtrace-conf:pt:size} packet.
38731
38732 @item swbreak
38733 The remote stub reports the @samp{swbreak} stop reason for memory
38734 breakpoints.
38735
38736 @item hwbreak
38737 The remote stub reports the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason for hardware
38738 breakpoints.
38739
38740 @item fork-events
38741 The remote stub reports the @samp{fork} stop reason for fork events.
38742
38743 @item vfork-events
38744 The remote stub reports the @samp{vfork} stop reason for vfork events
38745 and vforkdone events.
38746
38747 @item exec-events
38748 The remote stub reports the @samp{exec} stop reason for exec events.
38749
38750 @item vContSupported
38751 The remote stub reports the supported actions in the reply to
38752 @samp{vCont?} packet.
38753
38754 @item QThreadEvents
38755 The remote stub understands the @samp{QThreadEvents} packet.
38756
38757 @item no-resumed
38758 The remote stub reports the @samp{N} stop reply.
38759
38760 @end table
38761
38762 @item qSymbol::
38763 @cindex symbol lookup, remote request
38764 @cindex @samp{qSymbol} packet
38765 Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
38766 requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
38767
38768 Reply:
38769 @table @samp
38770 @item OK
38771 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
38772 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
38773 The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
38774 @value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
38775 @samp{qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}} message, described
38776 below.
38777 @end table
38778
38779 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
38780 Set the value of @var{sym_name} to @var{sym_value}.
38781
38782 @var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value the
38783 target has previously requested.
38784
38785 @var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}. If
38786 @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this field
38787 will be empty.
38788
38789 Reply:
38790 @table @samp
38791 @item OK
38792 The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
38793 @item qSymbol:@var{sym_name}
38794 The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex
38795 encoded). @value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols
38796 (if available), until the target ceases to request them.
38797 @end table
38798
38799 @item qTBuffer
38800 @itemx QTBuffer
38801 @itemx QTDisconnected
38802 @itemx QTDP
38803 @itemx QTDPsrc
38804 @itemx QTDV
38805 @itemx qTfP
38806 @itemx qTfV
38807 @itemx QTFrame
38808 @itemx qTMinFTPILen
38809
38810 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
38811
38812 @item qThreadExtraInfo,@var{thread-id}
38813 @cindex thread attributes info, remote request
38814 @cindex @samp{qThreadExtraInfo} packet
38815 Obtain from the target OS a printable string description of thread
38816 attributes for the thread @var{thread-id}; see @ref{thread-id syntax},
38817 for the forms of @var{thread-id}. This
38818 string may contain anything that the target OS thinks is interesting
38819 for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread. The string is
38820 displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @code{info threads} display. Some
38821 examples of possible thread extra info strings are @samp{Runnable}, or
38822 @samp{Blocked on Mutex}.
38823
38824 Reply:
38825 @table @samp
38826 @item @var{XX}@dots{}
38827 Where @samp{@var{XX}@dots{}} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data,
38828 comprising the printable string containing the extra information about
38829 the thread's attributes.
38830 @end table
38831
38832 (Note that the @code{qThreadExtraInfo} packet's name is separated from
38833 the command by a @samp{,}, not a @samp{:}, contrary to the naming
38834 conventions above. Please don't use this packet as a model for new
38835 packets.)
38836
38837 @item QTNotes
38838 @itemx qTP
38839 @itemx QTSave
38840 @itemx qTsP
38841 @itemx qTsV
38842 @itemx QTStart
38843 @itemx QTStop
38844 @itemx QTEnable
38845 @itemx QTDisable
38846 @itemx QTinit
38847 @itemx QTro
38848 @itemx qTStatus
38849 @itemx qTV
38850 @itemx qTfSTM
38851 @itemx qTsSTM
38852 @itemx qTSTMat
38853 @xref{Tracepoint Packets}.
38854
38855 @item qXfer:@var{object}:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
38856 @cindex read special object, remote request
38857 @cindex @samp{qXfer} packet
38858 @anchor{qXfer read}
38859 Read uninterpreted bytes from the target's special data area
38860 identified by the keyword @var{object}. Request @var{length} bytes
38861 starting at @var{offset} bytes into the data. The content and
38862 encoding of @var{annex} is specific to @var{object}; it can supply
38863 additional details about what data to access.
38864
38865 Reply:
38866 @table @samp
38867 @item m @var{data}
38868 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the
38869 target. There may be more data at a higher address (although
38870 it is permitted to return @samp{m} even for the last valid
38871 block of data, as long as at least one byte of data was read).
38872 It is possible for @var{data} to have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the
38873 request.
38874
38875 @item l @var{data}
38876 Data @var{data} (@pxref{Binary Data}) has been read from the target.
38877 There is no more data to be read. It is possible for @var{data} to
38878 have fewer bytes than the @var{length} in the request.
38879
38880 @item l
38881 The @var{offset} in the request is at the end of the data.
38882 There is no more data to be read.
38883
38884 @item E00
38885 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
38886
38887 @item E @var{nn}
38888 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered reading the data.
38889 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
38890
38891 @item @w{}
38892 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not recognized by
38893 the stub, or that the object does not support reading.
38894 @end table
38895
38896 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All the
38897 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:read:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
38898 formats, listed above.
38899
38900 @table @samp
38901 @item qXfer:auxv:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
38902 @anchor{qXfer auxiliary vector read}
38903 Access the target's @dfn{auxiliary vector}. @xref{OS Information,
38904 auxiliary vector}. Note @var{annex} must be empty.
38905
38906 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38907 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38908
38909 @item qXfer:btrace:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
38910 @anchor{qXfer btrace read}
38911
38912 Return a description of the current branch trace.
38913 @xref{Branch Trace Format}. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer}
38914 packet may have one of the following values:
38915
38916 @table @code
38917 @item all
38918 Returns all available branch trace.
38919
38920 @item new
38921 Returns all available branch trace if the branch trace changed since
38922 the last read request.
38923
38924 @item delta
38925 Returns the new branch trace since the last read request. Adds a new
38926 block to the end of the trace that begins at zero and ends at the source
38927 location of the first branch in the trace buffer. This extra block is
38928 used to stitch traces together.
38929
38930 If the trace buffer overflowed, returns an error indicating the overflow.
38931 @end table
38932
38933 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
38934 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38935
38936 @item qXfer:btrace-conf:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
38937 @anchor{qXfer btrace-conf read}
38938
38939 Return a description of the current branch trace configuration.
38940 @xref{Branch Trace Configuration Format}.
38941
38942 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it
38943 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38944
38945 @item qXfer:exec-file:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
38946 @anchor{qXfer executable filename read}
38947 Return the full absolute name of the file that was executed to create
38948 a process running on the remote system. The annex specifies the
38949 numeric process ID of the process to query, encoded as a hexadecimal
38950 number. If the annex part is empty the remote stub should return the
38951 filename corresponding to the currently executing process.
38952
38953 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38954 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38955
38956 @item qXfer:features:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
38957 @anchor{qXfer target description read}
38958 Access the @dfn{target description}. @xref{Target Descriptions}. The
38959 annex specifies which XML document to access. The main description is
38960 always loaded from the @samp{target.xml} annex.
38961
38962 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38963 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38964
38965 @item qXfer:libraries:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
38966 @anchor{qXfer library list read}
38967 Access the target's list of loaded libraries. @xref{Library List Format}.
38968 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
38969 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
38970
38971 Targets which maintain a list of libraries in the program's memory do
38972 not need to implement this packet; it is designed for platforms where
38973 the operating system manages the list of loaded libraries.
38974
38975 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38976 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38977
38978 @item qXfer:libraries-svr4:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
38979 @anchor{qXfer svr4 library list read}
38980 Access the target's list of loaded libraries when the target is an SVR4
38981 platform. @xref{Library List Format for SVR4 Targets}. The annex part
38982 of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty unless the remote
38983 stub indicated it supports the augmented form of this packet
38984 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
38985 (@pxref{qXfer read}, @ref{qSupported}).
38986
38987 This packet is optional for better performance on SVR4 targets.
38988 @value{GDBN} uses memory read packets to read the SVR4 library list otherwise.
38989
38990 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
38991 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
38992
38993 If the remote stub indicates it supports the augmented form of this
38994 packet then the annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet may
38995 contain a semicolon-separated list of @samp{@var{name}=@var{value}}
38996 arguments. The currently supported arguments are:
38997
38998 @table @code
38999 @item start=@var{address}
39000 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
39001 link_map} to start reading the library list from. If unset or zero
39002 then the first @samp{struct link_map} in the library list will be
39003 chosen as the starting point.
39004
39005 @item prev=@var{address}
39006 A hexadecimal number specifying the address of the @samp{struct
39007 link_map} immediately preceding the @samp{struct link_map}
39008 specified by the @samp{start} argument. If unset or zero then
39009 the remote stub will expect that no @samp{struct link_map}
39010 exists prior to the starting point.
39011
39012 @end table
39013
39014 Arguments that are not understood by the remote stub will be silently
39015 ignored.
39016
39017 @item qXfer:memory-map:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39018 @anchor{qXfer memory map read}
39019 Access the target's @dfn{memory-map}. @xref{Memory Map Format}. The
39020 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
39021 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
39022
39023 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39024 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39025
39026 @item qXfer:sdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39027 @anchor{qXfer sdata read}
39028
39029 Read contents of the extra collected static tracepoint marker
39030 information. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must
39031 be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}). @xref{Tracepoint Actions,,Tracepoint
39032 Action Lists}.
39033
39034 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39035 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
39036 (@pxref{qSupported}).
39037
39038 @item qXfer:siginfo:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39039 @anchor{qXfer siginfo read}
39040 Read contents of the extra signal information on the target
39041 system. The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
39042 empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
39043
39044 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39045 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
39046 (@pxref{qSupported}).
39047
39048 @item qXfer:spu:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39049 @anchor{qXfer spu read}
39050 Read contents of an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
39051 annex specifies which file to read; it must be of the form
39052 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
39053 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
39054 in that context to be accessed.
39055
39056 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39057 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
39058 (@pxref{qSupported}).
39059
39060 @item qXfer:threads:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39061 @anchor{qXfer threads read}
39062 Access the list of threads on target. @xref{Thread List Format}. The
39063 annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty
39064 (@pxref{qXfer read}).
39065
39066 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39067 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39068
39069 @item qXfer:traceframe-info:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39070 @anchor{qXfer traceframe info read}
39071
39072 Return a description of the current traceframe's contents.
39073 @xref{Traceframe Info Format}. The annex part of the generic
39074 @samp{qXfer} packet must be empty (@pxref{qXfer read}).
39075
39076 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39077 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39078
39079 @item qXfer:uib:read:@var{pc}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39080 @anchor{qXfer unwind info block}
39081
39082 Return the unwind information block for @var{pc}. This packet is used
39083 on OpenVMS/ia64 to ask the kernel unwind information.
39084
39085 This packet is not probed by default.
39086
39087 @item qXfer:fdpic:read:@var{annex}:@var{offset},@var{length}
39088 @anchor{qXfer fdpic loadmap read}
39089 Read contents of @code{loadmap}s on the target system. The
39090 annex, either @samp{exec} or @samp{interp}, specifies which @code{loadmap},
39091 executable @code{loadmap} or interpreter @code{loadmap} to read.
39092
39093 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39094 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39095
39096 @item qXfer:osdata:read::@var{offset},@var{length}
39097 @anchor{qXfer osdata read}
39098 Access the target's @dfn{operating system information}.
39099 @xref{Operating System Information}.
39100
39101 @end table
39102
39103 @item qXfer:@var{object}:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
39104 @cindex write data into object, remote request
39105 @anchor{qXfer write}
39106 Write uninterpreted bytes into the target's special data area
39107 identified by the keyword @var{object}, starting at @var{offset} bytes
39108 into the data. The binary-encoded data (@pxref{Binary Data}) to be
39109 written is given by @var{data}@dots{}. The content and encoding of @var{annex}
39110 is specific to @var{object}; it can supply additional details about what data
39111 to access.
39112
39113 Reply:
39114 @table @samp
39115 @item @var{nn}
39116 @var{nn} (hex encoded) is the number of bytes written.
39117 This may be fewer bytes than supplied in the request.
39118
39119 @item E00
39120 The request was malformed, or @var{annex} was invalid.
39121
39122 @item E @var{nn}
39123 The offset was invalid, or there was an error encountered writing the data.
39124 The @var{nn} part is a hex-encoded @code{errno} value.
39125
39126 @item @w{}
39127 An empty reply indicates the @var{object} string was not
39128 recognized by the stub, or that the object does not support writing.
39129 @end table
39130
39131 Here are the specific requests of this form defined so far. All the
39132 @samp{qXfer:@var{object}:write:@dots{}} requests use the same reply
39133 formats, listed above.
39134
39135 @table @samp
39136 @item qXfer:siginfo:write::@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
39137 @anchor{qXfer siginfo write}
39138 Write @var{data} to the extra signal information on the target system.
39139 The annex part of the generic @samp{qXfer} packet must be
39140 empty (@pxref{qXfer write}).
39141
39142 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39143 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response
39144 (@pxref{qSupported}).
39145
39146 @item qXfer:spu:write:@var{annex}:@var{offset}:@var{data}@dots{}
39147 @anchor{qXfer spu write}
39148 Write @var{data} to an @code{spufs} file on the target system. The
39149 annex specifies which file to write; it must be of the form
39150 @file{@var{id}/@var{name}}, where @var{id} specifies an SPU context ID
39151 in the target process, and @var{name} identifes the @code{spufs} file
39152 in that context to be accessed.
39153
39154 This packet is not probed by default; the remote stub must request it,
39155 by supplying an appropriate @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
39156 @end table
39157
39158 @item qXfer:@var{object}:@var{operation}:@dots{}
39159 Requests of this form may be added in the future. When a stub does
39160 not recognize the @var{object} keyword, or its support for
39161 @var{object} does not recognize the @var{operation} keyword, the stub
39162 must respond with an empty packet.
39163
39164 @item qAttached:@var{pid}
39165 @cindex query attached, remote request
39166 @cindex @samp{qAttached} packet
39167 Return an indication of whether the remote server attached to an
39168 existing process or created a new process. When the multiprocess
39169 protocol extensions are supported (@pxref{multiprocess extensions}),
39170 @var{pid} is an integer in hexadecimal format identifying the target
39171 process. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} will omit the @var{pid} field and
39172 the query packet will be simplified as @samp{qAttached}.
39173
39174 This query is used, for example, to know whether the remote process
39175 should be detached or killed when a @value{GDBN} session is ended with
39176 the @code{quit} command.
39177
39178 Reply:
39179 @table @samp
39180 @item 1
39181 The remote server attached to an existing process.
39182 @item 0
39183 The remote server created a new process.
39184 @item E @var{NN}
39185 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
39186 @end table
39187
39188 @item Qbtrace:bts
39189 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Branch Trace Store.
39190
39191 Reply:
39192 @table @samp
39193 @item OK
39194 Branch tracing has been enabled.
39195 @item E.errtext
39196 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
39197 @end table
39198
39199 @item Qbtrace:pt
39200 Enable branch tracing for the current thread using Intel Processor Trace.
39201
39202 Reply:
39203 @table @samp
39204 @item OK
39205 Branch tracing has been enabled.
39206 @item E.errtext
39207 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
39208 @end table
39209
39210 @item Qbtrace:off
39211 Disable branch tracing for the current thread.
39212
39213 Reply:
39214 @table @samp
39215 @item OK
39216 Branch tracing has been disabled.
39217 @item E.errtext
39218 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
39219 @end table
39220
39221 @item Qbtrace-conf:bts:size=@var{value}
39222 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
39223 btrace recording method in bts format.
39224
39225 Reply:
39226 @table @samp
39227 @item OK
39228 The ring buffer size has been set.
39229 @item E.errtext
39230 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
39231 @end table
39232
39233 @item Qbtrace-conf:pt:size=@var{value}
39234 Set the requested ring buffer size for new threads that use the
39235 btrace recording method in pt format.
39236
39237 Reply:
39238 @table @samp
39239 @item OK
39240 The ring buffer size has been set.
39241 @item E.errtext
39242 A badly formed request or an error was encountered.
39243 @end table
39244
39245 @end table
39246
39247 @node Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
39248 @section Architecture-Specific Protocol Details
39249
39250 This section describes how the remote protocol is applied to specific
39251 target architectures. Also see @ref{Standard Target Features}, for
39252 details of XML target descriptions for each architecture.
39253
39254 @menu
39255 * ARM-Specific Protocol Details::
39256 * MIPS-Specific Protocol Details::
39257 @end menu
39258
39259 @node ARM-Specific Protocol Details
39260 @subsection @acronym{ARM}-specific Protocol Details
39261
39262 @menu
39263 * ARM Breakpoint Kinds::
39264 @end menu
39265
39266 @node ARM Breakpoint Kinds
39267 @subsubsection @acronym{ARM} Breakpoint Kinds
39268 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{ARM}
39269
39270 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
39271
39272 @table @r
39273
39274 @item 2
39275 16-bit Thumb mode breakpoint.
39276
39277 @item 3
39278 32-bit Thumb mode (Thumb-2) breakpoint.
39279
39280 @item 4
39281 32-bit @acronym{ARM} mode breakpoint.
39282
39283 @end table
39284
39285 @node MIPS-Specific Protocol Details
39286 @subsection @acronym{MIPS}-specific Protocol Details
39287
39288 @menu
39289 * MIPS Register packet Format::
39290 * MIPS Breakpoint Kinds::
39291 @end menu
39292
39293 @node MIPS Register packet Format
39294 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Register Packet Format
39295 @cindex register packet format, @acronym{MIPS}
39296
39297 The following @code{g}/@code{G} packets have previously been defined.
39298 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as
39299 sixty-four bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?)
39300 to fill the space allocated. Register bytes are transferred in target
39301 byte order. The two nibbles within a register byte are transferred
39302 most-significant -- least-significant.
39303
39304 @table @r
39305
39306 @item MIPS32
39307 All registers are transferred as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
39308 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
39309 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
39310
39311 @item MIPS64
39312 All registers are transferred as sixty-four bit quantities (including
39313 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
39314 as @code{MIPS32}.
39315
39316 @end table
39317
39318 @node MIPS Breakpoint Kinds
39319 @subsubsection @acronym{MIPS} Breakpoint Kinds
39320 @cindex breakpoint kinds, @acronym{MIPS}
39321
39322 These breakpoint kinds are defined for the @samp{Z0} and @samp{Z1} packets.
39323
39324 @table @r
39325
39326 @item 2
39327 16-bit @acronym{MIPS16} mode breakpoint.
39328
39329 @item 3
39330 16-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
39331
39332 @item 4
39333 32-bit standard @acronym{MIPS} mode breakpoint.
39334
39335 @item 5
39336 32-bit @acronym{microMIPS} mode breakpoint.
39337
39338 @end table
39339
39340 @node Tracepoint Packets
39341 @section Tracepoint Packets
39342 @cindex tracepoint packets
39343 @cindex packets, tracepoint
39344
39345 Here we describe the packets @value{GDBN} uses to implement
39346 tracepoints (@pxref{Tracepoints}).
39347
39348 @table @samp
39349
39350 @item QTDP:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{ena}:@var{step}:@var{pass}[:F@var{flen}][:X@var{len},@var{bytes}]@r{[}-@r{]}
39351 @cindex @samp{QTDP} packet
39352 Create a new tracepoint, number @var{n}, at @var{addr}. If @var{ena}
39353 is @samp{E}, then the tracepoint is enabled; if it is @samp{D}, then
39354 the tracepoint is disabled. The @var{step} gives the tracepoint's step
39355 count, and @var{pass} gives its pass count. If an @samp{F} is present,
39356 then the tracepoint is to be a fast tracepoint, and the @var{flen} is
39357 the number of bytes that the target should copy elsewhere to make room
39358 for the tracepoint. If an @samp{X} is present, it introduces a
39359 tracepoint condition, which consists of a hexadecimal length, followed
39360 by a comma and hex-encoded bytes, in a manner similar to action
39361 encodings as described below. If the trailing @samp{-} is present,
39362 further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow to specify this tracepoint's
39363 actions.
39364
39365 Replies:
39366 @table @samp
39367 @item OK
39368 The packet was understood and carried out.
39369 @item qRelocInsn
39370 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
39371 @item @w{}
39372 The packet was not recognized.
39373 @end table
39374
39375 @item QTDP:-@var{n}:@var{addr}:@r{[}S@r{]}@var{action}@dots{}@r{[}-@r{]}
39376 Define actions to be taken when a tracepoint is hit. The @var{n} and
39377 @var{addr} must be the same as in the initial @samp{QTDP} packet for
39378 this tracepoint. This packet may only be sent immediately after
39379 another @samp{QTDP} packet that ended with a @samp{-}. If the
39380 trailing @samp{-} is present, further @samp{QTDP} packets will follow,
39381 specifying more actions for this tracepoint.
39382
39383 In the series of action packets for a given tracepoint, at most one
39384 can have an @samp{S} before its first @var{action}. If such a packet
39385 is sent, it and the following packets define ``while-stepping''
39386 actions. Any prior packets define ordinary actions --- that is, those
39387 taken when the tracepoint is first hit. If no action packet has an
39388 @samp{S}, then all the packets in the series specify ordinary
39389 tracepoint actions.
39390
39391 The @samp{@var{action}@dots{}} portion of the packet is a series of
39392 actions, concatenated without separators. Each action has one of the
39393 following forms:
39394
39395 @table @samp
39396
39397 @item R @var{mask}
39398 Collect the registers whose bits are set in @var{mask},
39399 a hexadecimal number whose @var{i}'th bit is set if register number
39400 @var{i} should be collected. (The least significant bit is numbered
39401 zero.) Note that @var{mask} may be any number of digits long; it may
39402 not fit in a 32-bit word.
39403
39404 @item M @var{basereg},@var{offset},@var{len}
39405 Collect @var{len} bytes of memory starting at the address in register
39406 number @var{basereg}, plus @var{offset}. If @var{basereg} is
39407 @samp{-1}, then the range has a fixed address: @var{offset} is the
39408 address of the lowest byte to collect. The @var{basereg},
39409 @var{offset}, and @var{len} parameters are all unsigned hexadecimal
39410 values (the @samp{-1} value for @var{basereg} is a special case).
39411
39412 @item X @var{len},@var{expr}
39413 Evaluate @var{expr}, whose length is @var{len}, and collect memory as
39414 it directs. The agent expression @var{expr} is as described in
39415 @ref{Agent Expressions}. Each byte of the expression is encoded as a
39416 two-digit hex number in the packet; @var{len} is the number of bytes
39417 in the expression (and thus one-half the number of hex digits in the
39418 packet).
39419
39420 @end table
39421
39422 Any number of actions may be packed together in a single @samp{QTDP}
39423 packet, as long as the packet does not exceed the maximum packet
39424 length (400 bytes, for many stubs). There may be only one @samp{R}
39425 action per tracepoint, and it must precede any @samp{M} or @samp{X}
39426 actions. Any registers referred to by @samp{M} and @samp{X} actions
39427 must be collected by a preceding @samp{R} action. (The
39428 ``while-stepping'' actions are treated as if they were attached to a
39429 separate tracepoint, as far as these restrictions are concerned.)
39430
39431 Replies:
39432 @table @samp
39433 @item OK
39434 The packet was understood and carried out.
39435 @item qRelocInsn
39436 @xref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate instruction reply packet}.
39437 @item @w{}
39438 The packet was not recognized.
39439 @end table
39440
39441 @item QTDPsrc:@var{n}:@var{addr}:@var{type}:@var{start}:@var{slen}:@var{bytes}
39442 @cindex @samp{QTDPsrc} packet
39443 Specify a source string of tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr}.
39444 This is useful to get accurate reproduction of the tracepoints
39445 originally downloaded at the beginning of the trace run. The @var{type}
39446 is the name of the tracepoint part, such as @samp{cond} for the
39447 tracepoint's conditional expression (see below for a list of types), while
39448 @var{bytes} is the string, encoded in hexadecimal.
39449
39450 @var{start} is the offset of the @var{bytes} within the overall source
39451 string, while @var{slen} is the total length of the source string.
39452 This is intended for handling source strings that are longer than will
39453 fit in a single packet.
39454 @c Add detailed example when this info is moved into a dedicated
39455 @c tracepoint descriptions section.
39456
39457 The available string types are @samp{at} for the location,
39458 @samp{cond} for the conditional, and @samp{cmd} for an action command.
39459 @value{GDBN} sends a separate packet for each command in the action
39460 list, in the same order in which the commands are stored in the list.
39461
39462 The target does not need to do anything with source strings except
39463 report them back as part of the replies to the @samp{qTfP}/@samp{qTsP}
39464 query packets.
39465
39466 Although this packet is optional, and @value{GDBN} will only send it
39467 if the target replies with @samp{TracepointSource} @xref{General
39468 Query Packets}, it makes both disconnected tracing and trace files
39469 much easier to use. Otherwise the user must be careful that the
39470 tracepoints in effect while looking at trace frames are identical to
39471 the ones in effect during the trace run; even a small discrepancy
39472 could cause @samp{tdump} not to work, or a particular trace frame not
39473 be found.
39474
39475 @item QTDV:@var{n}:@var{value}:@var{builtin}:@var{name}
39476 @cindex define trace state variable, remote request
39477 @cindex @samp{QTDV} packet
39478 Create a new trace state variable, number @var{n}, with an initial
39479 value of @var{value}, which is a 64-bit signed integer. Both @var{n}
39480 and @var{value} are encoded as hexadecimal values. @value{GDBN} has
39481 the option of not using this packet for initial values of zero; the
39482 target should simply create the trace state variables as they are
39483 mentioned in expressions. The value @var{builtin} should be 1 (one)
39484 if the trace state variable is builtin and 0 (zero) if it is not builtin.
39485 @value{GDBN} only sets @var{builtin} to 1 if a previous @samp{qTfV} or
39486 @samp{qTsV} packet had it set. The contents of @var{name} is the
39487 hex-encoded name (without the leading @samp{$}) of the trace state
39488 variable.
39489
39490 @item QTFrame:@var{n}
39491 @cindex @samp{QTFrame} packet
39492 Select the @var{n}'th tracepoint frame from the buffer, and use the
39493 register and memory contents recorded there to answer subsequent
39494 request packets from @value{GDBN}.
39495
39496 A successful reply from the stub indicates that the stub has found the
39497 requested frame. The response is a series of parts, concatenated
39498 without separators, describing the frame we selected. Each part has
39499 one of the following forms:
39500
39501 @table @samp
39502 @item F @var{f}
39503 The selected frame is number @var{n} in the trace frame buffer;
39504 @var{f} is a hexadecimal number. If @var{f} is @samp{-1}, then there
39505 was no frame matching the criteria in the request packet.
39506
39507 @item T @var{t}
39508 The selected trace frame records a hit of tracepoint number @var{t};
39509 @var{t} is a hexadecimal number.
39510
39511 @end table
39512
39513 @item QTFrame:pc:@var{addr}
39514 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
39515 currently selected frame whose PC is @var{addr};
39516 @var{addr} is a hexadecimal number.
39517
39518 @item QTFrame:tdp:@var{t}
39519 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
39520 currently selected frame that is a hit of tracepoint @var{t}; @var{t}
39521 is a hexadecimal number.
39522
39523 @item QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}
39524 Like @samp{QTFrame:@var{n}}, but select the first tracepoint frame after the
39525 currently selected frame whose PC is between @var{start} (inclusive)
39526 and @var{end} (inclusive); @var{start} and @var{end} are hexadecimal
39527 numbers.
39528
39529 @item QTFrame:outside:@var{start}:@var{end}
39530 Like @samp{QTFrame:range:@var{start}:@var{end}}, but select the first
39531 frame @emph{outside} the given range of addresses (exclusive).
39532
39533 @item qTMinFTPILen
39534 @cindex @samp{qTMinFTPILen} packet
39535 This packet requests the minimum length of instruction at which a fast
39536 tracepoint (@pxref{Set Tracepoints}) may be placed. For instance, on
39537 the 32-bit x86 architecture, it is possible to use a 4-byte jump, but
39538 it depends on the target system being able to create trampolines in
39539 the first 64K of memory, which might or might not be possible for that
39540 system. So the reply to this packet will be 4 if it is able to
39541 arrange for that.
39542
39543 Replies:
39544
39545 @table @samp
39546 @item 0
39547 The minimum instruction length is currently unknown.
39548 @item @var{length}
39549 The minimum instruction length is @var{length}, where @var{length}
39550 is a hexadecimal number greater or equal to 1. A reply
39551 of 1 means that a fast tracepoint may be placed on any instruction
39552 regardless of size.
39553 @item E
39554 An error has occurred.
39555 @item @w{}
39556 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the stub.
39557 @end table
39558
39559 @item QTStart
39560 @cindex @samp{QTStart} packet
39561 Begin the tracepoint experiment. Begin collecting data from
39562 tracepoint hits in the trace frame buffer. This packet supports the
39563 @samp{qRelocInsn} reply (@pxref{Tracepoint Packets,,Relocate
39564 instruction reply packet}).
39565
39566 @item QTStop
39567 @cindex @samp{QTStop} packet
39568 End the tracepoint experiment. Stop collecting trace frames.
39569
39570 @item QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
39571 @anchor{QTEnable}
39572 @cindex @samp{QTEnable} packet
39573 Enable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
39574 experiment. If the tracepoint was previously disabled, then collection
39575 of data from it will resume.
39576
39577 @item QTDisable:@var{n}:@var{addr}
39578 @anchor{QTDisable}
39579 @cindex @samp{QTDisable} packet
39580 Disable tracepoint @var{n} at address @var{addr} in a started tracepoint
39581 experiment. No more data will be collected from the tracepoint unless
39582 @samp{QTEnable:@var{n}:@var{addr}} is subsequently issued.
39583
39584 @item QTinit
39585 @cindex @samp{QTinit} packet
39586 Clear the table of tracepoints, and empty the trace frame buffer.
39587
39588 @item QTro:@var{start1},@var{end1}:@var{start2},@var{end2}:@dots{}
39589 @cindex @samp{QTro} packet
39590 Establish the given ranges of memory as ``transparent''. The stub
39591 will answer requests for these ranges from memory's current contents,
39592 if they were not collected as part of the tracepoint hit.
39593
39594 @value{GDBN} uses this to mark read-only regions of memory, like those
39595 containing program code. Since these areas never change, they should
39596 still have the same contents they did when the tracepoint was hit, so
39597 there's no reason for the stub to refuse to provide their contents.
39598
39599 @item QTDisconnected:@var{value}
39600 @cindex @samp{QTDisconnected} packet
39601 Set the choice to what to do with the tracing run when @value{GDBN}
39602 disconnects from the target. A @var{value} of 1 directs the target to
39603 continue the tracing run, while 0 tells the target to stop tracing if
39604 @value{GDBN} is no longer in the picture.
39605
39606 @item qTStatus
39607 @cindex @samp{qTStatus} packet
39608 Ask the stub if there is a trace experiment running right now.
39609
39610 The reply has the form:
39611
39612 @table @samp
39613
39614 @item T@var{running}@r{[};@var{field}@r{]}@dots{}
39615 @var{running} is a single digit @code{1} if the trace is presently
39616 running, or @code{0} if not. It is followed by semicolon-separated
39617 optional fields that an agent may use to report additional status.
39618
39619 @end table
39620
39621 If the trace is not running, the agent may report any of several
39622 explanations as one of the optional fields:
39623
39624 @table @samp
39625
39626 @item tnotrun:0
39627 No trace has been run yet.
39628
39629 @item tstop[:@var{text}]:0
39630 The trace was stopped by a user-originated stop command. The optional
39631 @var{text} field is a user-supplied string supplied as part of the
39632 stop command (for instance, an explanation of why the trace was
39633 stopped manually). It is hex-encoded.
39634
39635 @item tfull:0
39636 The trace stopped because the trace buffer filled up.
39637
39638 @item tdisconnected:0
39639 The trace stopped because @value{GDBN} disconnected from the target.
39640
39641 @item tpasscount:@var{tpnum}
39642 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} exceeded its pass count.
39643
39644 @item terror:@var{text}:@var{tpnum}
39645 The trace stopped because tracepoint @var{tpnum} had an error. The
39646 string @var{text} is available to describe the nature of the error
39647 (for instance, a divide by zero in the condition expression); it
39648 is hex encoded.
39649
39650 @item tunknown:0
39651 The trace stopped for some other reason.
39652
39653 @end table
39654
39655 Additional optional fields supply statistical and other information.
39656 Although not required, they are extremely useful for users monitoring
39657 the progress of a trace run. If a trace has stopped, and these
39658 numbers are reported, they must reflect the state of the just-stopped
39659 trace.
39660
39661 @table @samp
39662
39663 @item tframes:@var{n}
39664 The number of trace frames in the buffer.
39665
39666 @item tcreated:@var{n}
39667 The total number of trace frames created during the run. This may
39668 be larger than the trace frame count, if the buffer is circular.
39669
39670 @item tsize:@var{n}
39671 The total size of the trace buffer, in bytes.
39672
39673 @item tfree:@var{n}
39674 The number of bytes still unused in the buffer.
39675
39676 @item circular:@var{n}
39677 The value of the circular trace buffer flag. @code{1} means that the
39678 trace buffer is circular and old trace frames will be discarded if
39679 necessary to make room, @code{0} means that the trace buffer is linear
39680 and may fill up.
39681
39682 @item disconn:@var{n}
39683 The value of the disconnected tracing flag. @code{1} means that
39684 tracing will continue after @value{GDBN} disconnects, @code{0} means
39685 that the trace run will stop.
39686
39687 @end table
39688
39689 @item qTP:@var{tp}:@var{addr}
39690 @cindex tracepoint status, remote request
39691 @cindex @samp{qTP} packet
39692 Ask the stub for the current state of tracepoint number @var{tp} at
39693 address @var{addr}.
39694
39695 Replies:
39696 @table @samp
39697 @item V@var{hits}:@var{usage}
39698 The tracepoint has been hit @var{hits} times so far during the trace
39699 run, and accounts for @var{usage} in the trace buffer. Note that
39700 @code{while-stepping} steps are not counted as separate hits, but the
39701 steps' space consumption is added into the usage number.
39702
39703 @end table
39704
39705 @item qTV:@var{var}
39706 @cindex trace state variable value, remote request
39707 @cindex @samp{qTV} packet
39708 Ask the stub for the value of the trace state variable number @var{var}.
39709
39710 Replies:
39711 @table @samp
39712 @item V@var{value}
39713 The value of the variable is @var{value}. This will be the current
39714 value of the variable if the user is examining a running target, or a
39715 saved value if the variable was collected in the trace frame that the
39716 user is looking at. Note that multiple requests may result in
39717 different reply values, such as when requesting values while the
39718 program is running.
39719
39720 @item U
39721 The value of the variable is unknown. This would occur, for example,
39722 if the user is examining a trace frame in which the requested variable
39723 was not collected.
39724 @end table
39725
39726 @item qTfP
39727 @cindex @samp{qTfP} packet
39728 @itemx qTsP
39729 @cindex @samp{qTsP} packet
39730 These packets request data about tracepoints that are being used by
39731 the target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfP} to get the first piece
39732 of data, and multiple @code{qTsP} to get additional pieces. Replies
39733 to these packets generally take the form of the @code{QTDP} packets
39734 that define tracepoints. (FIXME add detailed syntax)
39735
39736 @item qTfV
39737 @cindex @samp{qTfV} packet
39738 @itemx qTsV
39739 @cindex @samp{qTsV} packet
39740 These packets request data about trace state variables that are on the
39741 target. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfV} to get the first vari of data,
39742 and multiple @code{qTsV} to get additional variables. Replies to
39743 these packets follow the syntax of the @code{QTDV} packets that define
39744 trace state variables.
39745
39746 @item qTfSTM
39747 @itemx qTsSTM
39748 @anchor{qTfSTM}
39749 @anchor{qTsSTM}
39750 @cindex @samp{qTfSTM} packet
39751 @cindex @samp{qTsSTM} packet
39752 These packets request data about static tracepoint markers that exist
39753 in the target program. @value{GDBN} sends @code{qTfSTM} to get the
39754 first piece of data, and multiple @code{qTsSTM} to get additional
39755 pieces. Replies to these packets take the following form:
39756
39757 Reply:
39758 @table @samp
39759 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}
39760 A single marker
39761 @item m @var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra},@var{address}:@var{id}:@var{extra}@dots{}
39762 a comma-separated list of markers
39763 @item l
39764 (lower case letter @samp{L}) denotes end of list.
39765 @item E @var{nn}
39766 An error occurred. The error number @var{nn} is given as hex digits.
39767 @item @w{}
39768 An empty reply indicates that the request is not supported by the
39769 stub.
39770 @end table
39771
39772 The @var{address} is encoded in hex;
39773 @var{id} and @var{extra} are strings encoded in hex.
39774
39775 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one or
39776 more markers, separated by commas. @value{GDBN} will respond to each
39777 reply with a request for more markers (using the @samp{qs} form of the
39778 query), until the target responds with @samp{l} (lower-case ell, for
39779 @dfn{last}).
39780
39781 @item qTSTMat:@var{address}
39782 @anchor{qTSTMat}
39783 @cindex @samp{qTSTMat} packet
39784 This packets requests data about static tracepoint markers in the
39785 target program at @var{address}. Replies to this packet follow the
39786 syntax of the @samp{qTfSTM} and @code{qTsSTM} packets that list static
39787 tracepoint markers.
39788
39789 @item QTSave:@var{filename}
39790 @cindex @samp{QTSave} packet
39791 This packet directs the target to save trace data to the file name
39792 @var{filename} in the target's filesystem. The @var{filename} is encoded
39793 as a hex string; the interpretation of the file name (relative vs
39794 absolute, wild cards, etc) is up to the target.
39795
39796 @item qTBuffer:@var{offset},@var{len}
39797 @cindex @samp{qTBuffer} packet
39798 Return up to @var{len} bytes of the current contents of trace buffer,
39799 starting at @var{offset}. The trace buffer is treated as if it were
39800 a contiguous collection of traceframes, as per the trace file format.
39801 The reply consists as many hex-encoded bytes as the target can deliver
39802 in a packet; it is not an error to return fewer than were asked for.
39803 A reply consisting of just @code{l} indicates that no bytes are
39804 available.
39805
39806 @item QTBuffer:circular:@var{value}
39807 This packet directs the target to use a circular trace buffer if
39808 @var{value} is 1, or a linear buffer if the value is 0.
39809
39810 @item QTBuffer:size:@var{size}
39811 @anchor{QTBuffer-size}
39812 @cindex @samp{QTBuffer size} packet
39813 This packet directs the target to make the trace buffer be of size
39814 @var{size} if possible. A value of @code{-1} tells the target to
39815 use whatever size it prefers.
39816
39817 @item QTNotes:@r{[}@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@r{[};@var{type}:@var{text}@r{]}@dots{}
39818 @cindex @samp{QTNotes} packet
39819 This packet adds optional textual notes to the trace run. Allowable
39820 types include @code{user}, @code{notes}, and @code{tstop}, the
39821 @var{text} fields are arbitrary strings, hex-encoded.
39822
39823 @end table
39824
39825 @subsection Relocate instruction reply packet
39826 When installing fast tracepoints in memory, the target may need to
39827 relocate the instruction currently at the tracepoint address to a
39828 different address in memory. For most instructions, a simple copy is
39829 enough, but, for example, call instructions that implicitly push the
39830 return address on the stack, and relative branches or other
39831 PC-relative instructions require offset adjustment, so that the effect
39832 of executing the instruction at a different address is the same as if
39833 it had executed in the original location.
39834
39835 In response to several of the tracepoint packets, the target may also
39836 respond with a number of intermediate @samp{qRelocInsn} request
39837 packets before the final result packet, to have @value{GDBN} handle
39838 this relocation operation. If a packet supports this mechanism, its
39839 documentation will explicitly say so. See for example the above
39840 descriptions for the @samp{QTStart} and @samp{QTDP} packets. The
39841 format of the request is:
39842
39843 @table @samp
39844 @item qRelocInsn:@var{from};@var{to}
39845
39846 This requests @value{GDBN} to copy instruction at address @var{from}
39847 to address @var{to}, possibly adjusted so that executing the
39848 instruction at @var{to} has the same effect as executing it at
39849 @var{from}. @value{GDBN} writes the adjusted instruction to target
39850 memory starting at @var{to}.
39851 @end table
39852
39853 Replies:
39854 @table @samp
39855 @item qRelocInsn:@var{adjusted_size}
39856 Informs the stub the relocation is complete. The @var{adjusted_size} is
39857 the length in bytes of resulting relocated instruction sequence.
39858 @item E @var{NN}
39859 A badly formed request was detected, or an error was encountered while
39860 relocating the instruction.
39861 @end table
39862
39863 @node Host I/O Packets
39864 @section Host I/O Packets
39865 @cindex Host I/O, remote protocol
39866 @cindex file transfer, remote protocol
39867
39868 The @dfn{Host I/O} packets allow @value{GDBN} to perform I/O
39869 operations on the far side of a remote link. For example, Host I/O is
39870 used to upload and download files to a remote target with its own
39871 filesystem. Host I/O uses the same constant values and data structure
39872 layout as the target-initiated File-I/O protocol. However, the
39873 Host I/O packets are structured differently. The target-initiated
39874 protocol relies on target memory to store parameters and buffers.
39875 Host I/O requests are initiated by @value{GDBN}, and the
39876 target's memory is not involved. @xref{File-I/O Remote Protocol
39877 Extension}, for more details on the target-initiated protocol.
39878
39879 The Host I/O request packets all encode a single operation along with
39880 its arguments. They have this format:
39881
39882 @table @samp
39883
39884 @item vFile:@var{operation}: @var{parameter}@dots{}
39885 @var{operation} is the name of the particular request; the target
39886 should compare the entire packet name up to the second colon when checking
39887 for a supported operation. The format of @var{parameter} depends on
39888 the operation. Numbers are always passed in hexadecimal. Negative
39889 numbers have an explicit minus sign (i.e.@: two's complement is not
39890 used). Strings (e.g.@: filenames) are encoded as a series of
39891 hexadecimal bytes. The last argument to a system call may be a
39892 buffer of escaped binary data (@pxref{Binary Data}).
39893
39894 @end table
39895
39896 The valid responses to Host I/O packets are:
39897
39898 @table @samp
39899
39900 @item F @var{result} [, @var{errno}] [; @var{attachment}]
39901 @var{result} is the integer value returned by this operation, usually
39902 non-negative for success and -1 for errors. If an error has occured,
39903 @var{errno} will be included in the result specifying a
39904 value defined by the File-I/O protocol (@pxref{Errno Values}). For
39905 operations which return data, @var{attachment} supplies the data as a
39906 binary buffer. Binary buffers in response packets are escaped in the
39907 normal way (@pxref{Binary Data}). See the individual packet
39908 documentation for the interpretation of @var{result} and
39909 @var{attachment}.
39910
39911 @item @w{}
39912 An empty response indicates that this operation is not recognized.
39913
39914 @end table
39915
39916 These are the supported Host I/O operations:
39917
39918 @table @samp
39919 @item vFile:open: @var{filename}, @var{flags}, @var{mode}
39920 Open a file at @var{filename} and return a file descriptor for it, or
39921 return -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string,
39922 @var{flags} is an integer indicating a mask of open flags
39923 (@pxref{Open Flags}), and @var{mode} is an integer indicating a mask
39924 of mode bits to use if the file is created (@pxref{mode_t Values}).
39925 @xref{open}, for details of the open flags and mode values.
39926
39927 @item vFile:close: @var{fd}
39928 Close the open file corresponding to @var{fd} and return 0, or
39929 -1 if an error occurs.
39930
39931 @item vFile:pread: @var{fd}, @var{count}, @var{offset}
39932 Read data from the open file corresponding to @var{fd}. Up to
39933 @var{count} bytes will be read from the file, starting at @var{offset}
39934 relative to the start of the file. The target may read fewer bytes;
39935 common reasons include packet size limits and an end-of-file
39936 condition. The number of bytes read is returned. Zero should only be
39937 returned for a successful read at the end of the file, or if
39938 @var{count} was zero.
39939
39940 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
39941 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
39942 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
39943 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
39944 some characters were escaped.
39945
39946 @item vFile:pwrite: @var{fd}, @var{offset}, @var{data}
39947 Write @var{data} (a binary buffer) to the open file corresponding
39948 to @var{fd}. Start the write at @var{offset} from the start of the
39949 file. Unlike many @code{write} system calls, there is no
39950 separate @var{count} argument; the length of @var{data} in the
39951 packet is used. @samp{vFile:write} returns the number of bytes written,
39952 which may be shorter than the length of @var{data}, or -1 if an
39953 error occurred.
39954
39955 @item vFile:fstat: @var{fd}
39956 Get information about the open file corresponding to @var{fd}.
39957 On success the information is returned as a binary attachment
39958 and the return value is the size of this attachment in bytes.
39959 If an error occurs the return value is -1. The format of the
39960 returned binary attachment is as described in @ref{struct stat}.
39961
39962 @item vFile:unlink: @var{filename}
39963 Delete the file at @var{filename} on the target. Return 0,
39964 or -1 if an error occurs. The @var{filename} is a string.
39965
39966 @item vFile:readlink: @var{filename}
39967 Read value of symbolic link @var{filename} on the target. Return
39968 the number of bytes read, or -1 if an error occurs.
39969
39970 The data read should be returned as a binary attachment on success.
39971 If zero bytes were read, the response should include an empty binary
39972 attachment (i.e.@: a trailing semicolon). The return value is the
39973 number of target bytes read; the binary attachment may be longer if
39974 some characters were escaped.
39975
39976 @item vFile:setfs: @var{pid}
39977 Select the filesystem on which @code{vFile} operations with
39978 @var{filename} arguments will operate. This is required for
39979 @value{GDBN} to be able to access files on remote targets where
39980 the remote stub does not share a common filesystem with the
39981 inferior(s).
39982
39983 If @var{pid} is nonzero, select the filesystem as seen by process
39984 @var{pid}. If @var{pid} is zero, select the filesystem as seen by
39985 the remote stub. Return 0 on success, or -1 if an error occurs.
39986 If @code{vFile:setfs:} indicates success, the selected filesystem
39987 remains selected until the next successful @code{vFile:setfs:}
39988 operation.
39989
39990 @end table
39991
39992 @node Interrupts
39993 @section Interrupts
39994 @cindex interrupts (remote protocol)
39995 @anchor{interrupting remote targets}
39996
39997 In all-stop mode, when a program on the remote target is running,
39998 @value{GDBN} may attempt to interrupt it by sending a @samp{Ctrl-C},
39999 @code{BREAK} or a @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g}, control of which
40000 is specified via @value{GDBN}'s @samp{interrupt-sequence}.
40001
40002 The precise meaning of @code{BREAK} is defined by the transport
40003 mechanism and may, in fact, be undefined. @value{GDBN} does not
40004 currently define a @code{BREAK} mechanism for any of the network
40005 interfaces except for TCP, in which case @value{GDBN} sends the
40006 @code{telnet} BREAK sequence.
40007
40008 @samp{Ctrl-C}, on the other hand, is defined and implemented for all
40009 transport mechanisms. It is represented by sending the single byte
40010 @code{0x03} without any of the usual packet overhead described in
40011 the Overview section (@pxref{Overview}). When a @code{0x03} byte is
40012 transmitted as part of a packet, it is considered to be packet data
40013 and does @emph{not} represent an interrupt. E.g., an @samp{X} packet
40014 (@pxref{X packet}), used for binary downloads, may include an unescaped
40015 @code{0x03} as part of its packet.
40016
40017 @code{BREAK} followed by @code{g} is also known as Magic SysRq g.
40018 When Linux kernel receives this sequence from serial port,
40019 it stops execution and connects to gdb.
40020
40021 In non-stop mode, because packet resumptions are asynchronous
40022 (@pxref{vCont packet}), @value{GDBN} is always free to send a remote
40023 command to the remote stub, even when the target is running. For that
40024 reason, @value{GDBN} instead sends a regular packet (@pxref{vCtrlC
40025 packet}) with the usual packet framing instead of the single byte
40026 @code{0x03}.
40027
40028 Stubs are not required to recognize these interrupt mechanisms and the
40029 precise meaning associated with receipt of the interrupt is
40030 implementation defined. If the target supports debugging of multiple
40031 threads and/or processes, it should attempt to interrupt all
40032 currently-executing threads and processes.
40033 If the stub is successful at interrupting the
40034 running program, it should send one of the stop
40035 reply packets (@pxref{Stop Reply Packets}) to @value{GDBN} as a result
40036 of successfully stopping the program in all-stop mode, and a stop reply
40037 for each stopped thread in non-stop mode.
40038 Interrupts received while the
40039 program is stopped are queued and the program will be interrupted when
40040 it is resumed next time.
40041
40042 @node Notification Packets
40043 @section Notification Packets
40044 @cindex notification packets
40045 @cindex packets, notification
40046
40047 The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol includes @dfn{notifications},
40048 packets that require no acknowledgment. Both the GDB and the stub
40049 may send notifications (although the only notifications defined at
40050 present are sent by the stub). Notifications carry information
40051 without incurring the round-trip latency of an acknowledgment, and so
40052 are useful for low-impact communications where occasional packet loss
40053 is not a problem.
40054
40055 A notification packet has the form @samp{% @var{data} #
40056 @var{checksum}}, where @var{data} is the content of the notification,
40057 and @var{checksum} is a checksum of @var{data}, computed and formatted
40058 as for ordinary @value{GDBN} packets. A notification's @var{data}
40059 never contains @samp{$}, @samp{%} or @samp{#} characters. Upon
40060 receiving a notification, the recipient sends no @samp{+} or @samp{-}
40061 to acknowledge the notification's receipt or to report its corruption.
40062
40063 Every notification's @var{data} begins with a name, which contains no
40064 colon characters, followed by a colon character.
40065
40066 Recipients should silently ignore corrupted notifications and
40067 notifications they do not understand. Recipients should restart
40068 timeout periods on receipt of a well-formed notification, whether or
40069 not they understand it.
40070
40071 Senders should only send the notifications described here when this
40072 protocol description specifies that they are permitted. In the
40073 future, we may extend the protocol to permit existing notifications in
40074 new contexts; this rule helps older senders avoid confusing newer
40075 recipients.
40076
40077 (Older versions of @value{GDBN} ignore bytes received until they see
40078 the @samp{$} byte that begins an ordinary packet, so new stubs may
40079 transmit notifications without fear of confusing older clients. There
40080 are no notifications defined for @value{GDBN} to send at the moment, but we
40081 assume that most older stubs would ignore them, as well.)
40082
40083 Each notification is comprised of three parts:
40084 @table @samp
40085 @item @var{name}:@var{event}
40086 The notification packet is sent by the side that initiates the
40087 exchange (currently, only the stub does that), with @var{event}
40088 carrying the specific information about the notification, and
40089 @var{name} specifying the name of the notification.
40090 @item @var{ack}
40091 The acknowledge sent by the other side, usually @value{GDBN}, to
40092 acknowledge the exchange and request the event.
40093 @end table
40094
40095 The purpose of an asynchronous notification mechanism is to report to
40096 @value{GDBN} that something interesting happened in the remote stub.
40097
40098 The remote stub may send notification @var{name}:@var{event}
40099 at any time, but @value{GDBN} acknowledges the notification when
40100 appropriate. The notification event is pending before @value{GDBN}
40101 acknowledges. Only one notification at a time may be pending; if
40102 additional events occur before @value{GDBN} has acknowledged the
40103 previous notification, they must be queued by the stub for later
40104 synchronous transmission in response to @var{ack} packets from
40105 @value{GDBN}. Because the notification mechanism is unreliable,
40106 the stub is permitted to resend a notification if it believes
40107 @value{GDBN} may not have received it.
40108
40109 Specifically, notifications may appear when @value{GDBN} is not
40110 otherwise reading input from the stub, or when @value{GDBN} is
40111 expecting to read a normal synchronous response or a
40112 @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgment to a packet it has sent.
40113 Notification packets are distinct from any other communication from
40114 the stub so there is no ambiguity.
40115
40116 After receiving a notification, @value{GDBN} shall acknowledge it by
40117 sending a @var{ack} packet as a regular, synchronous request to the
40118 stub. Such acknowledgment is not required to happen immediately, as
40119 @value{GDBN} is permitted to send other, unrelated packets to the
40120 stub first, which the stub should process normally.
40121
40122 Upon receiving a @var{ack} packet, if the stub has other queued
40123 events to report to @value{GDBN}, it shall respond by sending a
40124 normal @var{event}. @value{GDBN} shall then send another @var{ack}
40125 packet to solicit further responses; again, it is permitted to send
40126 other, unrelated packets as well which the stub should process
40127 normally.
40128
40129 If the stub receives a @var{ack} packet and there are no additional
40130 @var{event} to report, the stub shall return an @samp{OK} response.
40131 At this point, @value{GDBN} has finished processing a notification
40132 and the stub has completed sending any queued events. @value{GDBN}
40133 won't accept any new notifications until the final @samp{OK} is
40134 received . If further notification events occur, the stub shall send
40135 a new notification, @value{GDBN} shall accept the notification, and
40136 the process shall be repeated.
40137
40138 The process of asynchronous notification can be illustrated by the
40139 following example:
40140 @smallexample
40141 <- @code{%Stop:T0505:98e7ffbf;04:4ce6ffbf;08:b1b6e54c;thread:p7526.7526;core:0;}
40142 @code{...}
40143 -> @code{vStopped}
40144 <- @code{T0505:68f37db7;04:40f37db7;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7528;core:0;}
40145 -> @code{vStopped}
40146 <- @code{T0505:68e3fdb6;04:40e3fdb6;08:63850408;thread:p7526.7529;core:0;}
40147 -> @code{vStopped}
40148 <- @code{OK}
40149 @end smallexample
40150
40151 The following notifications are defined:
40152 @multitable @columnfractions 0.12 0.12 0.38 0.38
40153
40154 @item Notification
40155 @tab Ack
40156 @tab Event
40157 @tab Description
40158
40159 @item Stop
40160 @tab vStopped
40161 @tab @var{reply}. The @var{reply} has the form of a stop reply, as
40162 described in @ref{Stop Reply Packets}. Refer to @ref{Remote Non-Stop},
40163 for information on how these notifications are acknowledged by
40164 @value{GDBN}.
40165 @tab Report an asynchronous stop event in non-stop mode.
40166
40167 @end multitable
40168
40169 @node Remote Non-Stop
40170 @section Remote Protocol Support for Non-Stop Mode
40171
40172 @value{GDBN}'s remote protocol supports non-stop debugging of
40173 multi-threaded programs, as described in @ref{Non-Stop Mode}. If the stub
40174 supports non-stop mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN} by including
40175 @samp{QNonStop+} in its @samp{qSupported} response (@pxref{qSupported}).
40176
40177 @value{GDBN} typically sends a @samp{QNonStop} packet only when
40178 establishing a new connection with the stub. Entering non-stop mode
40179 does not alter the state of any currently-running threads, but targets
40180 must stop all threads in any already-attached processes when entering
40181 all-stop mode. @value{GDBN} uses the @samp{?} packet as necessary to
40182 probe the target state after a mode change.
40183
40184 In non-stop mode, when an attached process encounters an event that
40185 would otherwise be reported with a stop reply, it uses the
40186 asynchronous notification mechanism (@pxref{Notification Packets}) to
40187 inform @value{GDBN}. In contrast to all-stop mode, where all threads
40188 in all processes are stopped when a stop reply is sent, in non-stop
40189 mode only the thread reporting the stop event is stopped. That is,
40190 when reporting a @samp{S} or @samp{T} response to indicate completion
40191 of a step operation, hitting a breakpoint, or a fault, only the
40192 affected thread is stopped; any other still-running threads continue
40193 to run. When reporting a @samp{W} or @samp{X} response, all running
40194 threads belonging to other attached processes continue to run.
40195
40196 In non-stop mode, the target shall respond to the @samp{?} packet as
40197 follows. First, any incomplete stop reply notification/@samp{vStopped}
40198 sequence in progress is abandoned. The target must begin a new
40199 sequence reporting stop events for all stopped threads, whether or not
40200 it has previously reported those events to @value{GDBN}. The first
40201 stop reply is sent as a synchronous reply to the @samp{?} packet, and
40202 subsequent stop replies are sent as responses to @samp{vStopped} packets
40203 using the mechanism described above. The target must not send
40204 asynchronous stop reply notifications until the sequence is complete.
40205 If all threads are running when the target receives the @samp{?} packet,
40206 or if the target is not attached to any process, it shall respond
40207 @samp{OK}.
40208
40209 If the stub supports non-stop mode, it should also support the
40210 @samp{swbreak} stop reason if software breakpoints are supported, and
40211 the @samp{hwbreak} stop reason if hardware breakpoints are supported
40212 (@pxref{swbreak stop reason}). This is because given the asynchronous
40213 nature of non-stop mode, between the time a thread hits a breakpoint
40214 and the time the event is finally processed by @value{GDBN}, the
40215 breakpoint may have already been removed from the target. Due to
40216 this, @value{GDBN} needs to be able to tell whether a trap stop was
40217 caused by a delayed breakpoint event, which should be ignored, as
40218 opposed to a random trap signal, which should be reported to the user.
40219 Note the @samp{swbreak} feature implies that the target is responsible
40220 for adjusting the PC when a software breakpoint triggers, if
40221 necessary, such as on the x86 architecture.
40222
40223 @node Packet Acknowledgment
40224 @section Packet Acknowledgment
40225
40226 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
40227 @cindex packet acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
40228 By default, when either the host or the target machine receives a packet,
40229 the first response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
40230 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request retransmission).
40231 This mechanism allows the @value{GDBN} remote protocol to operate over
40232 unreliable transport mechanisms, such as a serial line.
40233
40234 In cases where the transport mechanism is itself reliable (such as a pipe or
40235 TCP connection), the @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are redundant.
40236 It may be desirable to disable them in that case to reduce communication
40237 overhead, or for other reasons. This can be accomplished by means of the
40238 @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet; @pxref{QStartNoAckMode}.
40239
40240 When in no-acknowledgment mode, neither the stub nor @value{GDBN} shall send or
40241 expect @samp{+}/@samp{-} protocol acknowledgments. The packet
40242 and response format still includes the normal checksum, as described in
40243 @ref{Overview}, but the checksum may be ignored by the receiver.
40244
40245 If the stub supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and prefers to operate in
40246 no-acknowledgment mode, it should report that to @value{GDBN}
40247 by including @samp{QStartNoAckMode+} in its response to @samp{qSupported};
40248 @pxref{qSupported}.
40249 If @value{GDBN} also supports @samp{QStartNoAckMode} and it has not been
40250 disabled via the @code{set remote noack-packet off} command
40251 (@pxref{Remote Configuration}),
40252 @value{GDBN} may then send a @samp{QStartNoAckMode} packet to the stub.
40253 Only then may the stub actually turn off packet acknowledgments.
40254 @value{GDBN} sends a final @samp{+} acknowledgment of the stub's @samp{OK}
40255 response, which can be safely ignored by the stub.
40256
40257 Note that @code{set remote noack-packet} command only affects negotiation
40258 between @value{GDBN} and the stub when subsequent connections are made;
40259 it does not affect the protocol acknowledgment state for any current
40260 connection.
40261 Since @samp{+}/@samp{-} acknowledgments are enabled by default when a
40262 new connection is established,
40263 there is also no protocol request to re-enable the acknowledgments
40264 for the current connection, once disabled.
40265
40266 @node Examples
40267 @section Examples
40268
40269 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
40270 does not get any direct output:
40271
40272 @smallexample
40273 -> @code{R00}
40274 <- @code{+}
40275 @emph{target restarts}
40276 -> @code{?}
40277 <- @code{+}
40278 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
40279 -> @code{+}
40280 @end smallexample
40281
40282 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
40283
40284 @smallexample
40285 -> @code{G1445@dots{}}
40286 <- @code{+}
40287 -> @code{s}
40288 <- @code{+}
40289 @emph{time passes}
40290 <- @code{T001:1234123412341234}
40291 -> @code{+}
40292 -> @code{g}
40293 <- @code{+}
40294 <- @code{1455@dots{}}
40295 -> @code{+}
40296 @end smallexample
40297
40298 @node File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
40299 @section File-I/O Remote Protocol Extension
40300 @cindex File-I/O remote protocol extension
40301
40302 @menu
40303 * File-I/O Overview::
40304 * Protocol Basics::
40305 * The F Request Packet::
40306 * The F Reply Packet::
40307 * The Ctrl-C Message::
40308 * Console I/O::
40309 * List of Supported Calls::
40310 * Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes::
40311 * Constants::
40312 * File-I/O Examples::
40313 @end menu
40314
40315 @node File-I/O Overview
40316 @subsection File-I/O Overview
40317 @cindex file-i/o overview
40318
40319 The @dfn{File I/O remote protocol extension} (short: File-I/O) allows the
40320 target to use the host's file system and console I/O to perform various
40321 system calls. System calls on the target system are translated into a
40322 remote protocol packet to the host system, which then performs the needed
40323 actions and returns a response packet to the target system.
40324 This simulates file system operations even on targets that lack file systems.
40325
40326 The protocol is defined to be independent of both the host and target systems.
40327 It uses its own internal representation of datatypes and values. Both
40328 @value{GDBN} and the target's @value{GDBN} stub are responsible for
40329 translating the system-dependent value representations into the internal
40330 protocol representations when data is transmitted.
40331
40332 The communication is synchronous. A system call is possible only when
40333 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}
40334 or @samp{s} packets. While @value{GDBN} handles the request for a system call,
40335 the target is stopped to allow deterministic access to the target's
40336 memory. Therefore File-I/O is not interruptible by target signals. On
40337 the other hand, it is possible to interrupt File-I/O by a user interrupt
40338 (@samp{Ctrl-C}) within @value{GDBN}.
40339
40340 The target's request to perform a host system call does not finish
40341 the latest @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} action. That means,
40342 after finishing the system call, the target returns to continuing the
40343 previous activity (continue, step). No additional continue or step
40344 request from @value{GDBN} is required.
40345
40346 @smallexample
40347 (@value{GDBP}) continue
40348 <- target requests 'system call X'
40349 target is stopped, @value{GDBN} executes system call
40350 -> @value{GDBN} returns result
40351 ... target continues, @value{GDBN} returns to wait for the target
40352 <- target hits breakpoint and sends a Txx packet
40353 @end smallexample
40354
40355 The protocol only supports I/O on the console and to regular files on
40356 the host file system. Character or block special devices, pipes,
40357 named pipes, sockets or any other communication method on the host
40358 system are not supported by this protocol.
40359
40360 File I/O is not supported in non-stop mode.
40361
40362 @node Protocol Basics
40363 @subsection Protocol Basics
40364 @cindex protocol basics, file-i/o
40365
40366 The File-I/O protocol uses the @code{F} packet as the request as well
40367 as reply packet. Since a File-I/O system call can only occur when
40368 @value{GDBN} is waiting for a response from the continuing or stepping target,
40369 the File-I/O request is a reply that @value{GDBN} has to expect as a result
40370 of a previous @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S} or @samp{s} packet.
40371 This @code{F} packet contains all information needed to allow @value{GDBN}
40372 to call the appropriate host system call:
40373
40374 @itemize @bullet
40375 @item
40376 A unique identifier for the requested system call.
40377
40378 @item
40379 All parameters to the system call. Pointers are given as addresses
40380 in the target memory address space. Pointers to strings are given as
40381 pointer/length pair. Numerical values are given as they are.
40382 Numerical control flags are given in a protocol-specific representation.
40383
40384 @end itemize
40385
40386 At this point, @value{GDBN} has to perform the following actions.
40387
40388 @itemize @bullet
40389 @item
40390 If the parameters include pointer values to data needed as input to a
40391 system call, @value{GDBN} requests this data from the target with a
40392 standard @code{m} packet request. This additional communication has to be
40393 expected by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{m}
40394 packet.
40395
40396 @item
40397 @value{GDBN} translates all value from protocol representation to host
40398 representation as needed. Datatypes are coerced into the host types.
40399
40400 @item
40401 @value{GDBN} calls the system call.
40402
40403 @item
40404 It then coerces datatypes back to protocol representation.
40405
40406 @item
40407 If the system call is expected to return data in buffer space specified
40408 by pointer parameters to the call, the data is transmitted to the
40409 target using a @code{M} or @code{X} packet. This packet has to be expected
40410 by the target implementation and is handled as any other @code{M} or @code{X}
40411 packet.
40412
40413 @end itemize
40414
40415 Eventually @value{GDBN} replies with another @code{F} packet which contains all
40416 necessary information for the target to continue. This at least contains
40417
40418 @itemize @bullet
40419 @item
40420 Return value.
40421
40422 @item
40423 @code{errno}, if has been changed by the system call.
40424
40425 @item
40426 ``Ctrl-C'' flag.
40427
40428 @end itemize
40429
40430 After having done the needed type and value coercion, the target continues
40431 the latest continue or step action.
40432
40433 @node The F Request Packet
40434 @subsection The @code{F} Request Packet
40435 @cindex file-i/o request packet
40436 @cindex @code{F} request packet
40437
40438 The @code{F} request packet has the following format:
40439
40440 @table @samp
40441 @item F@var{call-id},@var{parameter@dots{}}
40442
40443 @var{call-id} is the identifier to indicate the host system call to be called.
40444 This is just the name of the function.
40445
40446 @var{parameter@dots{}} are the parameters to the system call.
40447 Parameters are hexadecimal integer values, either the actual values in case
40448 of scalar datatypes, pointers to target buffer space in case of compound
40449 datatypes and unspecified memory areas, or pointer/length pairs in case
40450 of string parameters. These are appended to the @var{call-id} as a
40451 comma-delimited list. All values are transmitted in ASCII
40452 string representation, pointer/length pairs separated by a slash.
40453
40454 @end table
40455
40456
40457
40458 @node The F Reply Packet
40459 @subsection The @code{F} Reply Packet
40460 @cindex file-i/o reply packet
40461 @cindex @code{F} reply packet
40462
40463 The @code{F} reply packet has the following format:
40464
40465 @table @samp
40466
40467 @item F@var{retcode},@var{errno},@var{Ctrl-C flag};@var{call-specific attachment}
40468
40469 @var{retcode} is the return code of the system call as hexadecimal value.
40470
40471 @var{errno} is the @code{errno} set by the call, in protocol-specific
40472 representation.
40473 This parameter can be omitted if the call was successful.
40474
40475 @var{Ctrl-C flag} is only sent if the user requested a break. In this
40476 case, @var{errno} must be sent as well, even if the call was successful.
40477 The @var{Ctrl-C flag} itself consists of the character @samp{C}:
40478
40479 @smallexample
40480 F0,0,C
40481 @end smallexample
40482
40483 @noindent
40484 or, if the call was interrupted before the host call has been performed:
40485
40486 @smallexample
40487 F-1,4,C
40488 @end smallexample
40489
40490 @noindent
40491 assuming 4 is the protocol-specific representation of @code{EINTR}.
40492
40493 @end table
40494
40495
40496 @node The Ctrl-C Message
40497 @subsection The @samp{Ctrl-C} Message
40498 @cindex ctrl-c message, in file-i/o protocol
40499
40500 If the @samp{Ctrl-C} flag is set in the @value{GDBN}
40501 reply packet (@pxref{The F Reply Packet}),
40502 the target should behave as if it had
40503 gotten a break message. The meaning for the target is ``system call
40504 interrupted by @code{SIGINT}''. Consequentially, the target should actually stop
40505 (as with a break message) and return to @value{GDBN} with a @code{T02}
40506 packet.
40507
40508 It's important for the target to know in which
40509 state the system call was interrupted. There are two possible cases:
40510
40511 @itemize @bullet
40512 @item
40513 The system call hasn't been performed on the host yet.
40514
40515 @item
40516 The system call on the host has been finished.
40517
40518 @end itemize
40519
40520 These two states can be distinguished by the target by the value of the
40521 returned @code{errno}. If it's the protocol representation of @code{EINTR}, the system
40522 call hasn't been performed. This is equivalent to the @code{EINTR} handling
40523 on POSIX systems. In any other case, the target may presume that the
40524 system call has been finished --- successfully or not --- and should behave
40525 as if the break message arrived right after the system call.
40526
40527 @value{GDBN} must behave reliably. If the system call has not been called
40528 yet, @value{GDBN} may send the @code{F} reply immediately, setting @code{EINTR} as
40529 @code{errno} in the packet. If the system call on the host has been finished
40530 before the user requests a break, the full action must be finished by
40531 @value{GDBN}. This requires sending @code{M} or @code{X} packets as necessary.
40532 The @code{F} packet may only be sent when either nothing has happened
40533 or the full action has been completed.
40534
40535 @node Console I/O
40536 @subsection Console I/O
40537 @cindex console i/o as part of file-i/o
40538
40539 By default and if not explicitly closed by the target system, the file
40540 descriptors 0, 1 and 2 are connected to the @value{GDBN} console. Output
40541 on the @value{GDBN} console is handled as any other file output operation
40542 (@code{write(1, @dots{})} or @code{write(2, @dots{})}). Console input is handled
40543 by @value{GDBN} so that after the target read request from file descriptor
40544 0 all following typing is buffered until either one of the following
40545 conditions is met:
40546
40547 @itemize @bullet
40548 @item
40549 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-c}. The behaviour is as explained above, and the
40550 @code{read}
40551 system call is treated as finished.
40552
40553 @item
40554 The user presses @key{RET}. This is treated as end of input with a trailing
40555 newline.
40556
40557 @item
40558 The user types @kbd{Ctrl-d}. This is treated as end of input. No trailing
40559 character (neither newline nor @samp{Ctrl-D}) is appended to the input.
40560
40561 @end itemize
40562
40563 If the user has typed more characters than fit in the buffer given to
40564 the @code{read} call, the trailing characters are buffered in @value{GDBN} until
40565 either another @code{read(0, @dots{})} is requested by the target, or debugging
40566 is stopped at the user's request.
40567
40568
40569 @node List of Supported Calls
40570 @subsection List of Supported Calls
40571 @cindex list of supported file-i/o calls
40572
40573 @menu
40574 * open::
40575 * close::
40576 * read::
40577 * write::
40578 * lseek::
40579 * rename::
40580 * unlink::
40581 * stat/fstat::
40582 * gettimeofday::
40583 * isatty::
40584 * system::
40585 @end menu
40586
40587 @node open
40588 @unnumberedsubsubsec open
40589 @cindex open, file-i/o system call
40590
40591 @table @asis
40592 @item Synopsis:
40593 @smallexample
40594 int open(const char *pathname, int flags);
40595 int open(const char *pathname, int flags, mode_t mode);
40596 @end smallexample
40597
40598 @item Request:
40599 @samp{Fopen,@var{pathptr}/@var{len},@var{flags},@var{mode}}
40600
40601 @noindent
40602 @var{flags} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
40603
40604 @table @code
40605 @item O_CREAT
40606 If the file does not exist it will be created. The host
40607 rules apply as far as file ownership and time stamps
40608 are concerned.
40609
40610 @item O_EXCL
40611 When used with @code{O_CREAT}, if the file already exists it is
40612 an error and open() fails.
40613
40614 @item O_TRUNC
40615 If the file already exists and the open mode allows
40616 writing (@code{O_RDWR} or @code{O_WRONLY} is given) it will be
40617 truncated to zero length.
40618
40619 @item O_APPEND
40620 The file is opened in append mode.
40621
40622 @item O_RDONLY
40623 The file is opened for reading only.
40624
40625 @item O_WRONLY
40626 The file is opened for writing only.
40627
40628 @item O_RDWR
40629 The file is opened for reading and writing.
40630 @end table
40631
40632 @noindent
40633 Other bits are silently ignored.
40634
40635
40636 @noindent
40637 @var{mode} is the bitwise @code{OR} of the following values:
40638
40639 @table @code
40640 @item S_IRUSR
40641 User has read permission.
40642
40643 @item S_IWUSR
40644 User has write permission.
40645
40646 @item S_IRGRP
40647 Group has read permission.
40648
40649 @item S_IWGRP
40650 Group has write permission.
40651
40652 @item S_IROTH
40653 Others have read permission.
40654
40655 @item S_IWOTH
40656 Others have write permission.
40657 @end table
40658
40659 @noindent
40660 Other bits are silently ignored.
40661
40662
40663 @item Return value:
40664 @code{open} returns the new file descriptor or -1 if an error
40665 occurred.
40666
40667 @item Errors:
40668
40669 @table @code
40670 @item EEXIST
40671 @var{pathname} already exists and @code{O_CREAT} and @code{O_EXCL} were used.
40672
40673 @item EISDIR
40674 @var{pathname} refers to a directory.
40675
40676 @item EACCES
40677 The requested access is not allowed.
40678
40679 @item ENAMETOOLONG
40680 @var{pathname} was too long.
40681
40682 @item ENOENT
40683 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
40684
40685 @item ENODEV
40686 @var{pathname} refers to a device, pipe, named pipe or socket.
40687
40688 @item EROFS
40689 @var{pathname} refers to a file on a read-only filesystem and
40690 write access was requested.
40691
40692 @item EFAULT
40693 @var{pathname} is an invalid pointer value.
40694
40695 @item ENOSPC
40696 No space on device to create the file.
40697
40698 @item EMFILE
40699 The process already has the maximum number of files open.
40700
40701 @item ENFILE
40702 The limit on the total number of files open on the system
40703 has been reached.
40704
40705 @item EINTR
40706 The call was interrupted by the user.
40707 @end table
40708
40709 @end table
40710
40711 @node close
40712 @unnumberedsubsubsec close
40713 @cindex close, file-i/o system call
40714
40715 @table @asis
40716 @item Synopsis:
40717 @smallexample
40718 int close(int fd);
40719 @end smallexample
40720
40721 @item Request:
40722 @samp{Fclose,@var{fd}}
40723
40724 @item Return value:
40725 @code{close} returns zero on success, or -1 if an error occurred.
40726
40727 @item Errors:
40728
40729 @table @code
40730 @item EBADF
40731 @var{fd} isn't a valid open file descriptor.
40732
40733 @item EINTR
40734 The call was interrupted by the user.
40735 @end table
40736
40737 @end table
40738
40739 @node read
40740 @unnumberedsubsubsec read
40741 @cindex read, file-i/o system call
40742
40743 @table @asis
40744 @item Synopsis:
40745 @smallexample
40746 int read(int fd, void *buf, unsigned int count);
40747 @end smallexample
40748
40749 @item Request:
40750 @samp{Fread,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
40751
40752 @item Return value:
40753 On success, the number of bytes read is returned.
40754 Zero indicates end of file. If count is zero, read
40755 returns zero as well. On error, -1 is returned.
40756
40757 @item Errors:
40758
40759 @table @code
40760 @item EBADF
40761 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
40762 reading.
40763
40764 @item EFAULT
40765 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
40766
40767 @item EINTR
40768 The call was interrupted by the user.
40769 @end table
40770
40771 @end table
40772
40773 @node write
40774 @unnumberedsubsubsec write
40775 @cindex write, file-i/o system call
40776
40777 @table @asis
40778 @item Synopsis:
40779 @smallexample
40780 int write(int fd, const void *buf, unsigned int count);
40781 @end smallexample
40782
40783 @item Request:
40784 @samp{Fwrite,@var{fd},@var{bufptr},@var{count}}
40785
40786 @item Return value:
40787 On success, the number of bytes written are returned.
40788 Zero indicates nothing was written. On error, -1
40789 is returned.
40790
40791 @item Errors:
40792
40793 @table @code
40794 @item EBADF
40795 @var{fd} is not a valid file descriptor or is not open for
40796 writing.
40797
40798 @item EFAULT
40799 @var{bufptr} is an invalid pointer value.
40800
40801 @item EFBIG
40802 An attempt was made to write a file that exceeds the
40803 host-specific maximum file size allowed.
40804
40805 @item ENOSPC
40806 No space on device to write the data.
40807
40808 @item EINTR
40809 The call was interrupted by the user.
40810 @end table
40811
40812 @end table
40813
40814 @node lseek
40815 @unnumberedsubsubsec lseek
40816 @cindex lseek, file-i/o system call
40817
40818 @table @asis
40819 @item Synopsis:
40820 @smallexample
40821 long lseek (int fd, long offset, int flag);
40822 @end smallexample
40823
40824 @item Request:
40825 @samp{Flseek,@var{fd},@var{offset},@var{flag}}
40826
40827 @var{flag} is one of:
40828
40829 @table @code
40830 @item SEEK_SET
40831 The offset is set to @var{offset} bytes.
40832
40833 @item SEEK_CUR
40834 The offset is set to its current location plus @var{offset}
40835 bytes.
40836
40837 @item SEEK_END
40838 The offset is set to the size of the file plus @var{offset}
40839 bytes.
40840 @end table
40841
40842 @item Return value:
40843 On success, the resulting unsigned offset in bytes from
40844 the beginning of the file is returned. Otherwise, a
40845 value of -1 is returned.
40846
40847 @item Errors:
40848
40849 @table @code
40850 @item EBADF
40851 @var{fd} is not a valid open file descriptor.
40852
40853 @item ESPIPE
40854 @var{fd} is associated with the @value{GDBN} console.
40855
40856 @item EINVAL
40857 @var{flag} is not a proper value.
40858
40859 @item EINTR
40860 The call was interrupted by the user.
40861 @end table
40862
40863 @end table
40864
40865 @node rename
40866 @unnumberedsubsubsec rename
40867 @cindex rename, file-i/o system call
40868
40869 @table @asis
40870 @item Synopsis:
40871 @smallexample
40872 int rename(const char *oldpath, const char *newpath);
40873 @end smallexample
40874
40875 @item Request:
40876 @samp{Frename,@var{oldpathptr}/@var{len},@var{newpathptr}/@var{len}}
40877
40878 @item Return value:
40879 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
40880
40881 @item Errors:
40882
40883 @table @code
40884 @item EISDIR
40885 @var{newpath} is an existing directory, but @var{oldpath} is not a
40886 directory.
40887
40888 @item EEXIST
40889 @var{newpath} is a non-empty directory.
40890
40891 @item EBUSY
40892 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} is a directory that is in use by some
40893 process.
40894
40895 @item EINVAL
40896 An attempt was made to make a directory a subdirectory
40897 of itself.
40898
40899 @item ENOTDIR
40900 A component used as a directory in @var{oldpath} or new
40901 path is not a directory. Or @var{oldpath} is a directory
40902 and @var{newpath} exists but is not a directory.
40903
40904 @item EFAULT
40905 @var{oldpathptr} or @var{newpathptr} are invalid pointer values.
40906
40907 @item EACCES
40908 No access to the file or the path of the file.
40909
40910 @item ENAMETOOLONG
40911
40912 @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} was too long.
40913
40914 @item ENOENT
40915 A directory component in @var{oldpath} or @var{newpath} does not exist.
40916
40917 @item EROFS
40918 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
40919
40920 @item ENOSPC
40921 The device containing the file has no room for the new
40922 directory entry.
40923
40924 @item EINTR
40925 The call was interrupted by the user.
40926 @end table
40927
40928 @end table
40929
40930 @node unlink
40931 @unnumberedsubsubsec unlink
40932 @cindex unlink, file-i/o system call
40933
40934 @table @asis
40935 @item Synopsis:
40936 @smallexample
40937 int unlink(const char *pathname);
40938 @end smallexample
40939
40940 @item Request:
40941 @samp{Funlink,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len}}
40942
40943 @item Return value:
40944 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
40945
40946 @item Errors:
40947
40948 @table @code
40949 @item EACCES
40950 No access to the file or the path of the file.
40951
40952 @item EPERM
40953 The system does not allow unlinking of directories.
40954
40955 @item EBUSY
40956 The file @var{pathname} cannot be unlinked because it's
40957 being used by another process.
40958
40959 @item EFAULT
40960 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
40961
40962 @item ENAMETOOLONG
40963 @var{pathname} was too long.
40964
40965 @item ENOENT
40966 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist.
40967
40968 @item ENOTDIR
40969 A component of the path is not a directory.
40970
40971 @item EROFS
40972 The file is on a read-only filesystem.
40973
40974 @item EINTR
40975 The call was interrupted by the user.
40976 @end table
40977
40978 @end table
40979
40980 @node stat/fstat
40981 @unnumberedsubsubsec stat/fstat
40982 @cindex fstat, file-i/o system call
40983 @cindex stat, file-i/o system call
40984
40985 @table @asis
40986 @item Synopsis:
40987 @smallexample
40988 int stat(const char *pathname, struct stat *buf);
40989 int fstat(int fd, struct stat *buf);
40990 @end smallexample
40991
40992 @item Request:
40993 @samp{Fstat,@var{pathnameptr}/@var{len},@var{bufptr}}@*
40994 @samp{Ffstat,@var{fd},@var{bufptr}}
40995
40996 @item Return value:
40997 On success, zero is returned. On error, -1 is returned.
40998
40999 @item Errors:
41000
41001 @table @code
41002 @item EBADF
41003 @var{fd} is not a valid open file.
41004
41005 @item ENOENT
41006 A directory component in @var{pathname} does not exist or the
41007 path is an empty string.
41008
41009 @item ENOTDIR
41010 A component of the path is not a directory.
41011
41012 @item EFAULT
41013 @var{pathnameptr} is an invalid pointer value.
41014
41015 @item EACCES
41016 No access to the file or the path of the file.
41017
41018 @item ENAMETOOLONG
41019 @var{pathname} was too long.
41020
41021 @item EINTR
41022 The call was interrupted by the user.
41023 @end table
41024
41025 @end table
41026
41027 @node gettimeofday
41028 @unnumberedsubsubsec gettimeofday
41029 @cindex gettimeofday, file-i/o system call
41030
41031 @table @asis
41032 @item Synopsis:
41033 @smallexample
41034 int gettimeofday(struct timeval *tv, void *tz);
41035 @end smallexample
41036
41037 @item Request:
41038 @samp{Fgettimeofday,@var{tvptr},@var{tzptr}}
41039
41040 @item Return value:
41041 On success, 0 is returned, -1 otherwise.
41042
41043 @item Errors:
41044
41045 @table @code
41046 @item EINVAL
41047 @var{tz} is a non-NULL pointer.
41048
41049 @item EFAULT
41050 @var{tvptr} and/or @var{tzptr} is an invalid pointer value.
41051 @end table
41052
41053 @end table
41054
41055 @node isatty
41056 @unnumberedsubsubsec isatty
41057 @cindex isatty, file-i/o system call
41058
41059 @table @asis
41060 @item Synopsis:
41061 @smallexample
41062 int isatty(int fd);
41063 @end smallexample
41064
41065 @item Request:
41066 @samp{Fisatty,@var{fd}}
41067
41068 @item Return value:
41069 Returns 1 if @var{fd} refers to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise.
41070
41071 @item Errors:
41072
41073 @table @code
41074 @item EINTR
41075 The call was interrupted by the user.
41076 @end table
41077
41078 @end table
41079
41080 Note that the @code{isatty} call is treated as a special case: it returns
41081 1 to the target if the file descriptor is attached
41082 to the @value{GDBN} console, 0 otherwise. Implementing through system calls
41083 would require implementing @code{ioctl} and would be more complex than
41084 needed.
41085
41086
41087 @node system
41088 @unnumberedsubsubsec system
41089 @cindex system, file-i/o system call
41090
41091 @table @asis
41092 @item Synopsis:
41093 @smallexample
41094 int system(const char *command);
41095 @end smallexample
41096
41097 @item Request:
41098 @samp{Fsystem,@var{commandptr}/@var{len}}
41099
41100 @item Return value:
41101 If @var{len} is zero, the return value indicates whether a shell is
41102 available. A zero return value indicates a shell is not available.
41103 For non-zero @var{len}, the value returned is -1 on error and the
41104 return status of the command otherwise. Only the exit status of the
41105 command is returned, which is extracted from the host's @code{system}
41106 return value by calling @code{WEXITSTATUS(retval)}. In case
41107 @file{/bin/sh} could not be executed, 127 is returned.
41108
41109 @item Errors:
41110
41111 @table @code
41112 @item EINTR
41113 The call was interrupted by the user.
41114 @end table
41115
41116 @end table
41117
41118 @value{GDBN} takes over the full task of calling the necessary host calls
41119 to perform the @code{system} call. The return value of @code{system} on
41120 the host is simplified before it's returned
41121 to the target. Any termination signal information from the child process
41122 is discarded, and the return value consists
41123 entirely of the exit status of the called command.
41124
41125 Due to security concerns, the @code{system} call is by default refused
41126 by @value{GDBN}. The user has to allow this call explicitly with the
41127 @code{set remote system-call-allowed 1} command.
41128
41129 @table @code
41130 @item set remote system-call-allowed
41131 @kindex set remote system-call-allowed
41132 Control whether to allow the @code{system} calls in the File I/O
41133 protocol for the remote target. The default is zero (disabled).
41134
41135 @item show remote system-call-allowed
41136 @kindex show remote system-call-allowed
41137 Show whether the @code{system} calls are allowed in the File I/O
41138 protocol.
41139 @end table
41140
41141 @node Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
41142 @subsection Protocol-specific Representation of Datatypes
41143 @cindex protocol-specific representation of datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
41144
41145 @menu
41146 * Integral Datatypes::
41147 * Pointer Values::
41148 * Memory Transfer::
41149 * struct stat::
41150 * struct timeval::
41151 @end menu
41152
41153 @node Integral Datatypes
41154 @unnumberedsubsubsec Integral Datatypes
41155 @cindex integral datatypes, in file-i/o protocol
41156
41157 The integral datatypes used in the system calls are @code{int},
41158 @code{unsigned int}, @code{long}, @code{unsigned long},
41159 @code{mode_t}, and @code{time_t}.
41160
41161 @code{int}, @code{unsigned int}, @code{mode_t} and @code{time_t} are
41162 implemented as 32 bit values in this protocol.
41163
41164 @code{long} and @code{unsigned long} are implemented as 64 bit types.
41165
41166 @xref{Limits}, for corresponding MIN and MAX values (similar to those
41167 in @file{limits.h}) to allow range checking on host and target.
41168
41169 @code{time_t} datatypes are defined as seconds since the Epoch.
41170
41171 All integral datatypes transferred as part of a memory read or write of a
41172 structured datatype e.g.@: a @code{struct stat} have to be given in big endian
41173 byte order.
41174
41175 @node Pointer Values
41176 @unnumberedsubsubsec Pointer Values
41177 @cindex pointer values, in file-i/o protocol
41178
41179 Pointers to target data are transmitted as they are. An exception
41180 is made for pointers to buffers for which the length isn't
41181 transmitted as part of the function call, namely strings. Strings
41182 are transmitted as a pointer/length pair, both as hex values, e.g.@:
41183
41184 @smallexample
41185 @code{1aaf/12}
41186 @end smallexample
41187
41188 @noindent
41189 which is a pointer to data of length 18 bytes at position 0x1aaf.
41190 The length is defined as the full string length in bytes, including
41191 the trailing null byte. For example, the string @code{"hello world"}
41192 at address 0x123456 is transmitted as
41193
41194 @smallexample
41195 @code{123456/d}
41196 @end smallexample
41197
41198 @node Memory Transfer
41199 @unnumberedsubsubsec Memory Transfer
41200 @cindex memory transfer, in file-i/o protocol
41201
41202 Structured data which is transferred using a memory read or write (for
41203 example, a @code{struct stat}) is expected to be in a protocol-specific format
41204 with all scalar multibyte datatypes being big endian. Translation to
41205 this representation needs to be done both by the target before the @code{F}
41206 packet is sent, and by @value{GDBN} before
41207 it transfers memory to the target. Transferred pointers to structured
41208 data should point to the already-coerced data at any time.
41209
41210
41211 @node struct stat
41212 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct stat
41213 @cindex struct stat, in file-i/o protocol
41214
41215 The buffer of type @code{struct stat} used by the target and @value{GDBN}
41216 is defined as follows:
41217
41218 @smallexample
41219 struct stat @{
41220 unsigned int st_dev; /* device */
41221 unsigned int st_ino; /* inode */
41222 mode_t st_mode; /* protection */
41223 unsigned int st_nlink; /* number of hard links */
41224 unsigned int st_uid; /* user ID of owner */
41225 unsigned int st_gid; /* group ID of owner */
41226 unsigned int st_rdev; /* device type (if inode device) */
41227 unsigned long st_size; /* total size, in bytes */
41228 unsigned long st_blksize; /* blocksize for filesystem I/O */
41229 unsigned long st_blocks; /* number of blocks allocated */
41230 time_t st_atime; /* time of last access */
41231 time_t st_mtime; /* time of last modification */
41232 time_t st_ctime; /* time of last change */
41233 @};
41234 @end smallexample
41235
41236 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
41237 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
41238 structure is of size 64 bytes.
41239
41240 The values of several fields have a restricted meaning and/or
41241 range of values.
41242
41243 @table @code
41244
41245 @item st_dev
41246 A value of 0 represents a file, 1 the console.
41247
41248 @item st_ino
41249 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
41250
41251 @item st_mode
41252 Valid mode bits are described in @ref{Constants}. Any other
41253 bits have currently no meaning for the target.
41254
41255 @item st_uid
41256 @itemx st_gid
41257 @itemx st_rdev
41258 No valid meaning for the target. Transmitted unchanged.
41259
41260 @item st_atime
41261 @itemx st_mtime
41262 @itemx st_ctime
41263 These values have a host and file system dependent
41264 accuracy. Especially on Windows hosts, the file system may not
41265 support exact timing values.
41266 @end table
41267
41268 The target gets a @code{struct stat} of the above representation and is
41269 responsible for coercing it to the target representation before
41270 continuing.
41271
41272 Note that due to size differences between the host, target, and protocol
41273 representations of @code{struct stat} members, these members could eventually
41274 get truncated on the target.
41275
41276 @node struct timeval
41277 @unnumberedsubsubsec struct timeval
41278 @cindex struct timeval, in file-i/o protocol
41279
41280 The buffer of type @code{struct timeval} used by the File-I/O protocol
41281 is defined as follows:
41282
41283 @smallexample
41284 struct timeval @{
41285 time_t tv_sec; /* second */
41286 long tv_usec; /* microsecond */
41287 @};
41288 @end smallexample
41289
41290 The integral datatypes conform to the definitions given in the
41291 appropriate section (see @ref{Integral Datatypes}, for details) so this
41292 structure is of size 8 bytes.
41293
41294 @node Constants
41295 @subsection Constants
41296 @cindex constants, in file-i/o protocol
41297
41298 The following values are used for the constants inside of the
41299 protocol. @value{GDBN} and target are responsible for translating these
41300 values before and after the call as needed.
41301
41302 @menu
41303 * Open Flags::
41304 * mode_t Values::
41305 * Errno Values::
41306 * Lseek Flags::
41307 * Limits::
41308 @end menu
41309
41310 @node Open Flags
41311 @unnumberedsubsubsec Open Flags
41312 @cindex open flags, in file-i/o protocol
41313
41314 All values are given in hexadecimal representation.
41315
41316 @smallexample
41317 O_RDONLY 0x0
41318 O_WRONLY 0x1
41319 O_RDWR 0x2
41320 O_APPEND 0x8
41321 O_CREAT 0x200
41322 O_TRUNC 0x400
41323 O_EXCL 0x800
41324 @end smallexample
41325
41326 @node mode_t Values
41327 @unnumberedsubsubsec mode_t Values
41328 @cindex mode_t values, in file-i/o protocol
41329
41330 All values are given in octal representation.
41331
41332 @smallexample
41333 S_IFREG 0100000
41334 S_IFDIR 040000
41335 S_IRUSR 0400
41336 S_IWUSR 0200
41337 S_IXUSR 0100
41338 S_IRGRP 040
41339 S_IWGRP 020
41340 S_IXGRP 010
41341 S_IROTH 04
41342 S_IWOTH 02
41343 S_IXOTH 01
41344 @end smallexample
41345
41346 @node Errno Values
41347 @unnumberedsubsubsec Errno Values
41348 @cindex errno values, in file-i/o protocol
41349
41350 All values are given in decimal representation.
41351
41352 @smallexample
41353 EPERM 1
41354 ENOENT 2
41355 EINTR 4
41356 EBADF 9
41357 EACCES 13
41358 EFAULT 14
41359 EBUSY 16
41360 EEXIST 17
41361 ENODEV 19
41362 ENOTDIR 20
41363 EISDIR 21
41364 EINVAL 22
41365 ENFILE 23
41366 EMFILE 24
41367 EFBIG 27
41368 ENOSPC 28
41369 ESPIPE 29
41370 EROFS 30
41371 ENAMETOOLONG 91
41372 EUNKNOWN 9999
41373 @end smallexample
41374
41375 @code{EUNKNOWN} is used as a fallback error value if a host system returns
41376 any error value not in the list of supported error numbers.
41377
41378 @node Lseek Flags
41379 @unnumberedsubsubsec Lseek Flags
41380 @cindex lseek flags, in file-i/o protocol
41381
41382 @smallexample
41383 SEEK_SET 0
41384 SEEK_CUR 1
41385 SEEK_END 2
41386 @end smallexample
41387
41388 @node Limits
41389 @unnumberedsubsubsec Limits
41390 @cindex limits, in file-i/o protocol
41391
41392 All values are given in decimal representation.
41393
41394 @smallexample
41395 INT_MIN -2147483648
41396 INT_MAX 2147483647
41397 UINT_MAX 4294967295
41398 LONG_MIN -9223372036854775808
41399 LONG_MAX 9223372036854775807
41400 ULONG_MAX 18446744073709551615
41401 @end smallexample
41402
41403 @node File-I/O Examples
41404 @subsection File-I/O Examples
41405 @cindex file-i/o examples
41406
41407 Example sequence of a write call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
41408 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be written:
41409
41410 @smallexample
41411 <- @code{Fwrite,3,1234,6}
41412 @emph{request memory read from target}
41413 -> @code{m1234,6}
41414 <- XXXXXX
41415 @emph{return "6 bytes written"}
41416 -> @code{F6}
41417 @end smallexample
41418
41419 Example sequence of a read call, file descriptor 3, buffer is at target
41420 address 0x1234, 6 bytes should be read:
41421
41422 @smallexample
41423 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
41424 @emph{request memory write to target}
41425 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
41426 @emph{return "6 bytes read"}
41427 -> @code{F6}
41428 @end smallexample
41429
41430 Example sequence of a read call, call fails on the host due to invalid
41431 file descriptor (@code{EBADF}):
41432
41433 @smallexample
41434 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
41435 -> @code{F-1,9}
41436 @end smallexample
41437
41438 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} before syscall on
41439 host is called:
41440
41441 @smallexample
41442 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
41443 -> @code{F-1,4,C}
41444 <- @code{T02}
41445 @end smallexample
41446
41447 Example sequence of a read call, user presses @kbd{Ctrl-c} after syscall on
41448 host is called:
41449
41450 @smallexample
41451 <- @code{Fread,3,1234,6}
41452 -> @code{X1234,6:XXXXXX}
41453 <- @code{T02}
41454 @end smallexample
41455
41456 @node Library List Format
41457 @section Library List Format
41458 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
41459
41460 On some platforms, a dynamic loader (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) runs in the
41461 same process as your application to manage libraries. In this case,
41462 @value{GDBN} can use the loader's symbol table and normal memory
41463 operations to maintain a list of shared libraries. On other
41464 platforms, the operating system manages loaded libraries.
41465 @value{GDBN} can not retrieve the list of currently loaded libraries
41466 through memory operations, so it uses the @samp{qXfer:libraries:read}
41467 packet (@pxref{qXfer library list read}) instead. The remote stub
41468 queries the target's operating system and reports which libraries
41469 are loaded.
41470
41471 The @samp{qXfer:libraries:read} packet returns an XML document which
41472 lists loaded libraries and their offsets. Each library has an
41473 associated name and one or more segment or section base addresses,
41474 which report where the library was loaded in memory.
41475
41476 For the common case of libraries that are fully linked binaries, the
41477 library should have a list of segments. If the target supports
41478 dynamic linking of a relocatable object file, its library XML element
41479 should instead include a list of allocated sections. The segment or
41480 section bases are start addresses, not relocation offsets; they do not
41481 depend on the library's link-time base addresses.
41482
41483 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
41484 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
41485
41486 A simple memory map, with one loaded library relocated by a single
41487 offset, looks like this:
41488
41489 @smallexample
41490 <library-list>
41491 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6">
41492 <segment address="0x10000000"/>
41493 </library>
41494 </library-list>
41495 @end smallexample
41496
41497 Another simple memory map, with one loaded library with three
41498 allocated sections (.text, .data, .bss), looks like this:
41499
41500 @smallexample
41501 <library-list>
41502 <library name="sharedlib.o">
41503 <section address="0x10000000"/>
41504 <section address="0x20000000"/>
41505 <section address="0x30000000"/>
41506 </library>
41507 </library-list>
41508 @end smallexample
41509
41510 The format of a library list is described by this DTD:
41511
41512 @smallexample
41513 <!-- library-list: Root element with versioning -->
41514 <!ELEMENT library-list (library)*>
41515 <!ATTLIST library-list version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
41516 <!ELEMENT library (segment*, section*)>
41517 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
41518 <!ELEMENT segment EMPTY>
41519 <!ATTLIST segment address CDATA #REQUIRED>
41520 <!ELEMENT section EMPTY>
41521 <!ATTLIST section address CDATA #REQUIRED>
41522 @end smallexample
41523
41524 In addition, segments and section descriptors cannot be mixed within a
41525 single library element, and you must supply at least one segment or
41526 section for each library.
41527
41528 @node Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
41529 @section Library List Format for SVR4 Targets
41530 @cindex library list format, remote protocol
41531
41532 On SVR4 platforms @value{GDBN} can use the symbol table of a dynamic loader
41533 (e.g.@: @file{ld.so}) and normal memory operations to maintain a list of
41534 shared libraries. Still a special library list provided by this packet is
41535 more efficient for the @value{GDBN} remote protocol.
41536
41537 The @samp{qXfer:libraries-svr4:read} packet returns an XML document which lists
41538 loaded libraries and their SVR4 linker parameters. For each library on SVR4
41539 target, the following parameters are reported:
41540
41541 @itemize @minus
41542 @item
41543 @code{name}, the absolute file name from the @code{l_name} field of
41544 @code{struct link_map}.
41545 @item
41546 @code{lm} with address of @code{struct link_map} used for TLS
41547 (Thread Local Storage) access.
41548 @item
41549 @code{l_addr}, the displacement as read from the field @code{l_addr} of
41550 @code{struct link_map}. For prelinked libraries this is not an absolute
41551 memory address. It is a displacement of absolute memory address against
41552 address the file was prelinked to during the library load.
41553 @item
41554 @code{l_ld}, which is memory address of the @code{PT_DYNAMIC} segment
41555 @end itemize
41556
41557 Additionally the single @code{main-lm} attribute specifies address of
41558 @code{struct link_map} used for the main executable. This parameter is used
41559 for TLS access and its presence is optional.
41560
41561 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
41562 SVR4 library lists. @xref{Expat}.
41563
41564 A simple memory map, with two loaded libraries (which do not use prelink),
41565 looks like this:
41566
41567 @smallexample
41568 <library-list-svr4 version="1.0" main-lm="0xe4f8f8">
41569 <library name="/lib/ld-linux.so.2" lm="0xe4f51c" l_addr="0xe2d000"
41570 l_ld="0xe4eefc"/>
41571 <library name="/lib/libc.so.6" lm="0xe4fbe8" l_addr="0x154000"
41572 l_ld="0x152350"/>
41573 </library-list-svr>
41574 @end smallexample
41575
41576 The format of an SVR4 library list is described by this DTD:
41577
41578 @smallexample
41579 <!-- library-list-svr4: Root element with versioning -->
41580 <!ELEMENT library-list-svr4 (library)*>
41581 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
41582 <!ATTLIST library-list-svr4 main-lm CDATA #IMPLIED>
41583 <!ELEMENT library EMPTY>
41584 <!ATTLIST library name CDATA #REQUIRED>
41585 <!ATTLIST library lm CDATA #REQUIRED>
41586 <!ATTLIST library l_addr CDATA #REQUIRED>
41587 <!ATTLIST library l_ld CDATA #REQUIRED>
41588 @end smallexample
41589
41590 @node Memory Map Format
41591 @section Memory Map Format
41592 @cindex memory map format
41593
41594 To be able to write into flash memory, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain a
41595 memory map from the target. This section describes the format of the
41596 memory map.
41597
41598 The memory map is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:memory-map:read}
41599 (@pxref{qXfer memory map read}) packet and is an XML document that
41600 lists memory regions.
41601
41602 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
41603 memory maps. @xref{Expat}.
41604
41605 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
41606
41607 @smallexample
41608 <?xml version="1.0"?>
41609 <!DOCTYPE memory-map
41610 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
41611 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-memory-map.dtd">
41612 <memory-map>
41613 region...
41614 </memory-map>
41615 @end smallexample
41616
41617 Each region can be either:
41618
41619 @itemize
41620
41621 @item
41622 A region of RAM starting at @var{addr} and extending for @var{length}
41623 bytes from there:
41624
41625 @smallexample
41626 <memory type="ram" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
41627 @end smallexample
41628
41629
41630 @item
41631 A region of read-only memory:
41632
41633 @smallexample
41634 <memory type="rom" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
41635 @end smallexample
41636
41637
41638 @item
41639 A region of flash memory, with erasure blocks @var{blocksize}
41640 bytes in length:
41641
41642 @smallexample
41643 <memory type="flash" start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}">
41644 <property name="blocksize">@var{blocksize}</property>
41645 </memory>
41646 @end smallexample
41647
41648 @end itemize
41649
41650 Regions must not overlap. @value{GDBN} assumes that areas of memory not covered
41651 by the memory map are RAM, and uses the ordinary @samp{M} and @samp{X}
41652 packets to write to addresses in such ranges.
41653
41654 The formal DTD for memory map format is given below:
41655
41656 @smallexample
41657 <!-- ................................................... -->
41658 <!-- Memory Map XML DTD ................................ -->
41659 <!-- File: memory-map.dtd .............................. -->
41660 <!-- .................................... .............. -->
41661 <!-- memory-map.dtd -->
41662 <!-- memory-map: Root element with versioning -->
41663 <!ELEMENT memory-map (memory)*>
41664 <!ATTLIST memory-map version CDATA #FIXED "1.0.0">
41665 <!ELEMENT memory (property)*>
41666 <!-- memory: Specifies a memory region,
41667 and its type, or device. -->
41668 <!ATTLIST memory type (ram|rom|flash) #REQUIRED
41669 start CDATA #REQUIRED
41670 length CDATA #REQUIRED>
41671 <!-- property: Generic attribute tag -->
41672 <!ELEMENT property (#PCDATA | property)*>
41673 <!ATTLIST property name (blocksize) #REQUIRED>
41674 @end smallexample
41675
41676 @node Thread List Format
41677 @section Thread List Format
41678 @cindex thread list format
41679
41680 To efficiently update the list of threads and their attributes,
41681 @value{GDBN} issues the @samp{qXfer:threads:read} packet
41682 (@pxref{qXfer threads read}) and obtains the XML document with
41683 the following structure:
41684
41685 @smallexample
41686 <?xml version="1.0"?>
41687 <threads>
41688 <thread id="id" core="0" name="name">
41689 ... description ...
41690 </thread>
41691 </threads>
41692 @end smallexample
41693
41694 Each @samp{thread} element must have the @samp{id} attribute that
41695 identifies the thread (@pxref{thread-id syntax}). The
41696 @samp{core} attribute, if present, specifies which processor core
41697 the thread was last executing on. The @samp{name} attribute, if
41698 present, specifies the human-readable name of the thread. The content
41699 of the of @samp{thread} element is interpreted as human-readable
41700 auxiliary information. The @samp{handle} attribute, if present,
41701 is a hex encoded representation of the thread handle.
41702
41703
41704 @node Traceframe Info Format
41705 @section Traceframe Info Format
41706 @cindex traceframe info format
41707
41708 To be able to know which objects in the inferior can be examined when
41709 inspecting a tracepoint hit, @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of
41710 memory ranges, registers and trace state variables that have been
41711 collected in a traceframe.
41712
41713 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:traceframe-info:read}
41714 (@pxref{qXfer traceframe info read}) packet and is an XML document.
41715
41716 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
41717 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
41718
41719 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
41720
41721 @smallexample
41722 <?xml version="1.0"?>
41723 <!DOCTYPE traceframe-info
41724 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Memory Map V1.0//EN"
41725 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-traceframe-info.dtd">
41726 <traceframe-info>
41727 block...
41728 </traceframe-info>
41729 @end smallexample
41730
41731 Each traceframe block can be either:
41732
41733 @itemize
41734
41735 @item
41736 A region of collected memory starting at @var{addr} and extending for
41737 @var{length} bytes from there:
41738
41739 @smallexample
41740 <memory start="@var{addr}" length="@var{length}"/>
41741 @end smallexample
41742
41743 @item
41744 A block indicating trace state variable numbered @var{number} has been
41745 collected:
41746
41747 @smallexample
41748 <tvar id="@var{number}"/>
41749 @end smallexample
41750
41751 @end itemize
41752
41753 The formal DTD for the traceframe info format is given below:
41754
41755 @smallexample
41756 <!ELEMENT traceframe-info (memory | tvar)* >
41757 <!ATTLIST traceframe-info version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
41758
41759 <!ELEMENT memory EMPTY>
41760 <!ATTLIST memory start CDATA #REQUIRED
41761 length CDATA #REQUIRED>
41762 <!ELEMENT tvar>
41763 <!ATTLIST tvar id CDATA #REQUIRED>
41764 @end smallexample
41765
41766 @node Branch Trace Format
41767 @section Branch Trace Format
41768 @cindex branch trace format
41769
41770 In order to display the branch trace of an inferior thread,
41771 @value{GDBN} needs to obtain the list of branches. This list is
41772 represented as list of sequential code blocks that are connected via
41773 branches. The code in each block has been executed sequentially.
41774
41775 This list is obtained using the @samp{qXfer:btrace:read}
41776 (@pxref{qXfer btrace read}) packet and is an XML document.
41777
41778 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
41779 traceframe info discovery. @xref{Expat}.
41780
41781 The top-level structure of the document is shown below:
41782
41783 @smallexample
41784 <?xml version="1.0"?>
41785 <!DOCTYPE btrace
41786 PUBLIC "+//IDN gnu.org//DTD GDB Branch Trace V1.0//EN"
41787 "http://sourceware.org/gdb/gdb-btrace.dtd">
41788 <btrace>
41789 block...
41790 </btrace>
41791 @end smallexample
41792
41793 @itemize
41794
41795 @item
41796 A block of sequentially executed instructions starting at @var{begin}
41797 and ending at @var{end}:
41798
41799 @smallexample
41800 <block begin="@var{begin}" end="@var{end}"/>
41801 @end smallexample
41802
41803 @end itemize
41804
41805 The formal DTD for the branch trace format is given below:
41806
41807 @smallexample
41808 <!ELEMENT btrace (block* | pt) >
41809 <!ATTLIST btrace version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
41810
41811 <!ELEMENT block EMPTY>
41812 <!ATTLIST block begin CDATA #REQUIRED
41813 end CDATA #REQUIRED>
41814
41815 <!ELEMENT pt (pt-config?, raw?)>
41816
41817 <!ELEMENT pt-config (cpu?)>
41818
41819 <!ELEMENT cpu EMPTY>
41820 <!ATTLIST cpu vendor CDATA #REQUIRED
41821 family CDATA #REQUIRED
41822 model CDATA #REQUIRED
41823 stepping CDATA #REQUIRED>
41824
41825 <!ELEMENT raw (#PCDATA)>
41826 @end smallexample
41827
41828 @node Branch Trace Configuration Format
41829 @section Branch Trace Configuration Format
41830 @cindex branch trace configuration format
41831
41832 For each inferior thread, @value{GDBN} can obtain the branch trace
41833 configuration using the @samp{qXfer:btrace-conf:read}
41834 (@pxref{qXfer btrace-conf read}) packet.
41835
41836 The configuration describes the branch trace format and configuration
41837 settings for that format. The following information is described:
41838
41839 @table @code
41840 @item bts
41841 This thread uses the @dfn{Branch Trace Store} (@acronym{BTS}) format.
41842 @table @code
41843 @item size
41844 The size of the @acronym{BTS} ring buffer in bytes.
41845 @end table
41846 @item pt
41847 This thread uses the @dfn{Intel Processor Trace} (@acronym{Intel
41848 PT}) format.
41849 @table @code
41850 @item size
41851 The size of the @acronym{Intel PT} ring buffer in bytes.
41852 @end table
41853 @end table
41854
41855 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
41856 branch trace configuration discovery. @xref{Expat}.
41857
41858 The formal DTD for the branch trace configuration format is given below:
41859
41860 @smallexample
41861 <!ELEMENT btrace-conf (bts?, pt?)>
41862 <!ATTLIST btrace-conf version CDATA #FIXED "1.0">
41863
41864 <!ELEMENT bts EMPTY>
41865 <!ATTLIST bts size CDATA #IMPLIED>
41866
41867 <!ELEMENT pt EMPTY>
41868 <!ATTLIST pt size CDATA #IMPLIED>
41869 @end smallexample
41870
41871 @include agentexpr.texi
41872
41873 @node Target Descriptions
41874 @appendix Target Descriptions
41875 @cindex target descriptions
41876
41877 One of the challenges of using @value{GDBN} to debug embedded systems
41878 is that there are so many minor variants of each processor
41879 architecture in use. It is common practice for vendors to start with
41880 a standard processor core --- ARM, PowerPC, or @acronym{MIPS}, for example ---
41881 and then make changes to adapt it to a particular market niche. Some
41882 architectures have hundreds of variants, available from dozens of
41883 vendors. This leads to a number of problems:
41884
41885 @itemize @bullet
41886 @item
41887 With so many different customized processors, it is difficult for
41888 the @value{GDBN} maintainers to keep up with the changes.
41889 @item
41890 Since individual variants may have short lifetimes or limited
41891 audiences, it may not be worthwhile to carry information about every
41892 variant in the @value{GDBN} source tree.
41893 @item
41894 When @value{GDBN} does support the architecture of the embedded system
41895 at hand, the task of finding the correct architecture name to give the
41896 @command{set architecture} command can be error-prone.
41897 @end itemize
41898
41899 To address these problems, the @value{GDBN} remote protocol allows a
41900 target system to not only identify itself to @value{GDBN}, but to
41901 actually describe its own features. This lets @value{GDBN} support
41902 processor variants it has never seen before --- to the extent that the
41903 descriptions are accurate, and that @value{GDBN} understands them.
41904
41905 @value{GDBN} must be linked with the Expat library to support XML
41906 target descriptions. @xref{Expat}.
41907
41908 @menu
41909 * Retrieving Descriptions:: How descriptions are fetched from a target.
41910 * Target Description Format:: The contents of a target description.
41911 * Predefined Target Types:: Standard types available for target
41912 descriptions.
41913 * Enum Target Types:: How to define enum target types.
41914 * Standard Target Features:: Features @value{GDBN} knows about.
41915 @end menu
41916
41917 @node Retrieving Descriptions
41918 @section Retrieving Descriptions
41919
41920 Target descriptions can be read from the target automatically, or
41921 specified by the user manually. The default behavior is to read the
41922 description from the target. @value{GDBN} retrieves it via the remote
41923 protocol using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{General Query Packets,
41924 qXfer}). The @var{annex} in the @samp{qXfer} packet will be
41925 @samp{target.xml}. The contents of the @samp{target.xml} annex are an
41926 XML document, of the form described in @ref{Target Description
41927 Format}.
41928
41929 Alternatively, you can specify a file to read for the target description.
41930 If a file is set, the target will not be queried. The commands to
41931 specify a file are:
41932
41933 @table @code
41934 @cindex set tdesc filename
41935 @item set tdesc filename @var{path}
41936 Read the target description from @var{path}.
41937
41938 @cindex unset tdesc filename
41939 @item unset tdesc filename
41940 Do not read the XML target description from a file. @value{GDBN}
41941 will use the description supplied by the current target.
41942
41943 @cindex show tdesc filename
41944 @item show tdesc filename
41945 Show the filename to read for a target description, if any.
41946 @end table
41947
41948
41949 @node Target Description Format
41950 @section Target Description Format
41951 @cindex target descriptions, XML format
41952
41953 A target description annex is an @uref{http://www.w3.org/XML/, XML}
41954 document which complies with the Document Type Definition provided in
41955 the @value{GDBN} sources in @file{gdb/features/gdb-target.dtd}. This
41956 means you can use generally available tools like @command{xmllint} to
41957 check that your feature descriptions are well-formed and valid.
41958 However, to help people unfamiliar with XML write descriptions for
41959 their targets, we also describe the grammar here.
41960
41961 Target descriptions can identify the architecture of the remote target
41962 and (for some architectures) provide information about custom register
41963 sets. They can also identify the OS ABI of the remote target.
41964 @value{GDBN} can use this information to autoconfigure for your
41965 target, or to warn you if you connect to an unsupported target.
41966
41967 Here is a simple target description:
41968
41969 @smallexample
41970 <target version="1.0">
41971 <architecture>i386:x86-64</architecture>
41972 </target>
41973 @end smallexample
41974
41975 @noindent
41976 This minimal description only says that the target uses
41977 the x86-64 architecture.
41978
41979 A target description has the following overall form, with [ ] marking
41980 optional elements and @dots{} marking repeatable elements. The elements
41981 are explained further below.
41982
41983 @smallexample
41984 <?xml version="1.0"?>
41985 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "gdb-target.dtd">
41986 <target version="1.0">
41987 @r{[}@var{architecture}@r{]}
41988 @r{[}@var{osabi}@r{]}
41989 @r{[}@var{compatible}@r{]}
41990 @r{[}@var{feature}@dots{}@r{]}
41991 </target>
41992 @end smallexample
41993
41994 @noindent
41995 The description is generally insensitive to whitespace and line
41996 breaks, under the usual common-sense rules. The XML version
41997 declaration and document type declaration can generally be omitted
41998 (@value{GDBN} does not require them), but specifying them may be
41999 useful for XML validation tools. The @samp{version} attribute for
42000 @samp{<target>} may also be omitted, but we recommend
42001 including it; if future versions of @value{GDBN} use an incompatible
42002 revision of @file{gdb-target.dtd}, they will detect and report
42003 the version mismatch.
42004
42005 @subsection Inclusion
42006 @cindex target descriptions, inclusion
42007 @cindex XInclude
42008 @ifnotinfo
42009 @cindex <xi:include>
42010 @end ifnotinfo
42011
42012 It can sometimes be valuable to split a target description up into
42013 several different annexes, either for organizational purposes, or to
42014 share files between different possible target descriptions. You can
42015 divide a description into multiple files by replacing any element of
42016 the target description with an inclusion directive of the form:
42017
42018 @smallexample
42019 <xi:include href="@var{document}"/>
42020 @end smallexample
42021
42022 @noindent
42023 When @value{GDBN} encounters an element of this form, it will retrieve
42024 the named XML @var{document}, and replace the inclusion directive with
42025 the contents of that document. If the current description was read
42026 using @samp{qXfer}, then so will be the included document;
42027 @var{document} will be interpreted as the name of an annex. If the
42028 current description was read from a file, @value{GDBN} will look for
42029 @var{document} as a file in the same directory where it found the
42030 original description.
42031
42032 @subsection Architecture
42033 @cindex <architecture>
42034
42035 An @samp{<architecture>} element has this form:
42036
42037 @smallexample
42038 <architecture>@var{arch}</architecture>
42039 @end smallexample
42040
42041 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
42042 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
42043
42044 @subsection OS ABI
42045 @cindex @code{<osabi>}
42046
42047 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
42048 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
42049
42050 An @samp{<osabi>} element has this form:
42051
42052 @smallexample
42053 <osabi>@var{abi-name}</osabi>
42054 @end smallexample
42055
42056 @var{abi-name} is an OS ABI name from the same selection accepted by
42057 @w{@code{set osabi}} (@pxref{ABI, ,Configuring the Current ABI}).
42058
42059 @subsection Compatible Architecture
42060 @cindex @code{<compatible>}
42061
42062 This optional field was introduced in @value{GDBN} version 7.0.
42063 Previous versions of @value{GDBN} ignore it.
42064
42065 A @samp{<compatible>} element has this form:
42066
42067 @smallexample
42068 <compatible>@var{arch}</compatible>
42069 @end smallexample
42070
42071 @var{arch} is one of the architectures from the set accepted by
42072 @code{set architecture} (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
42073
42074 A @samp{<compatible>} element is used to specify that the target
42075 is able to run binaries in some other than the main target architecture
42076 given by the @samp{<architecture>} element. For example, on the
42077 Cell Broadband Engine, the main architecture is @code{powerpc:common}
42078 or @code{powerpc:common64}, but the system is able to run binaries
42079 in the @code{spu} architecture as well. The way to describe this
42080 capability with @samp{<compatible>} is as follows:
42081
42082 @smallexample
42083 <architecture>powerpc:common</architecture>
42084 <compatible>spu</compatible>
42085 @end smallexample
42086
42087 @subsection Features
42088 @cindex <feature>
42089
42090 Each @samp{<feature>} describes some logical portion of the target
42091 system. Features are currently used to describe available CPU
42092 registers and the types of their contents. A @samp{<feature>} element
42093 has this form:
42094
42095 @smallexample
42096 <feature name="@var{name}">
42097 @r{[}@var{type}@dots{}@r{]}
42098 @var{reg}@dots{}
42099 </feature>
42100 @end smallexample
42101
42102 @noindent
42103 Each feature's name should be unique within the description. The name
42104 of a feature does not matter unless @value{GDBN} has some special
42105 knowledge of the contents of that feature; if it does, the feature
42106 should have its standard name. @xref{Standard Target Features}.
42107
42108 @subsection Types
42109
42110 Any register's value is a collection of bits which @value{GDBN} must
42111 interpret. The default interpretation is a two's complement integer,
42112 but other types can be requested by name in the register description.
42113 Some predefined types are provided by @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Predefined
42114 Target Types}), and the description can define additional composite
42115 and enum types.
42116
42117 Each type element must have an @samp{id} attribute, which gives
42118 a unique (within the containing @samp{<feature>}) name to the type.
42119 Types must be defined before they are used.
42120
42121 @cindex <vector>
42122 Some targets offer vector registers, which can be treated as arrays
42123 of scalar elements. These types are written as @samp{<vector>} elements,
42124 specifying the array element type, @var{type}, and the number of elements,
42125 @var{count}:
42126
42127 @smallexample
42128 <vector id="@var{id}" type="@var{type}" count="@var{count}"/>
42129 @end smallexample
42130
42131 @cindex <union>
42132 If a register's value is usefully viewed in multiple ways, define it
42133 with a union type containing the useful representations. The
42134 @samp{<union>} element contains one or more @samp{<field>} elements,
42135 each of which has a @var{name} and a @var{type}:
42136
42137 @smallexample
42138 <union id="@var{id}">
42139 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
42140 @dots{}
42141 </union>
42142 @end smallexample
42143
42144 @cindex <struct>
42145 @cindex <flags>
42146 If a register's value is composed from several separate values, define
42147 it with either a structure type or a flags type.
42148 A flags type may only contain bitfields.
42149 A structure type may either contain only bitfields or contain no bitfields.
42150 If the value contains only bitfields, its total size in bytes must be
42151 specified.
42152
42153 Non-bitfield values have a @var{name} and @var{type}.
42154
42155 @smallexample
42156 <struct id="@var{id}">
42157 <field name="@var{name}" type="@var{type}"/>
42158 @dots{}
42159 </struct>
42160 @end smallexample
42161
42162 Both @var{name} and @var{type} values are required.
42163 No implicit padding is added.
42164
42165 Bitfield values have a @var{name}, @var{start}, @var{end} and @var{type}.
42166
42167 @smallexample
42168 <struct id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
42169 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}" type="@var{type}"/>
42170 @dots{}
42171 </struct>
42172 @end smallexample
42173
42174 @smallexample
42175 <flags id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
42176 <field name="@var{name}" start="@var{start}" end="@var{end}" type="@var{type}"/>
42177 @dots{}
42178 </flags>
42179 @end smallexample
42180
42181 The @var{name} value is required.
42182 Bitfield values may be named with the empty string, @samp{""},
42183 in which case the field is ``filler'' and its value is not printed.
42184 Not all bits need to be specified, so ``filler'' fields are optional.
42185
42186 The @var{start} and @var{end} values are required, and @var{type}
42187 is optional.
42188 The field's @var{start} must be less than or equal to its @var{end},
42189 and zero represents the least significant bit.
42190
42191 The default value of @var{type} is @code{bool} for single bit fields,
42192 and an unsigned integer otherwise.
42193
42194 Which to choose? Structures or flags?
42195
42196 Registers defined with @samp{flags} have these advantages over
42197 defining them with @samp{struct}:
42198
42199 @itemize @bullet
42200 @item
42201 Arithmetic may be performed on them as if they were integers.
42202 @item
42203 They are printed in a more readable fashion.
42204 @end itemize
42205
42206 Registers defined with @samp{struct} have one advantage over
42207 defining them with @samp{flags}:
42208
42209 @itemize @bullet
42210 @item
42211 One can fetch individual fields like in @samp{C}.
42212
42213 @smallexample
42214 (gdb) print $my_struct_reg.field3
42215 $1 = 42
42216 @end smallexample
42217
42218 @end itemize
42219
42220 @subsection Registers
42221 @cindex <reg>
42222
42223 Each register is represented as an element with this form:
42224
42225 @smallexample
42226 <reg name="@var{name}"
42227 bitsize="@var{size}"
42228 @r{[}regnum="@var{num}"@r{]}
42229 @r{[}save-restore="@var{save-restore}"@r{]}
42230 @r{[}type="@var{type}"@r{]}
42231 @r{[}group="@var{group}"@r{]}/>
42232 @end smallexample
42233
42234 @noindent
42235 The components are as follows:
42236
42237 @table @var
42238
42239 @item name
42240 The register's name; it must be unique within the target description.
42241
42242 @item bitsize
42243 The register's size, in bits.
42244
42245 @item regnum
42246 The register's number. If omitted, a register's number is one greater
42247 than that of the previous register (either in the current feature or in
42248 a preceding feature); the first register in the target description
42249 defaults to zero. This register number is used to read or write
42250 the register; e.g.@: it is used in the remote @code{p} and @code{P}
42251 packets, and registers appear in the @code{g} and @code{G} packets
42252 in order of increasing register number.
42253
42254 @item save-restore
42255 Whether the register should be preserved across inferior function
42256 calls; this must be either @code{yes} or @code{no}. The default is
42257 @code{yes}, which is appropriate for most registers except for
42258 some system control registers; this is not related to the target's
42259 ABI.
42260
42261 @item type
42262 The type of the register. It may be a predefined type, a type
42263 defined in the current feature, or one of the special types @code{int}
42264 and @code{float}. @code{int} is an integer type of the correct size
42265 for @var{bitsize}, and @code{float} is a floating point type (in the
42266 architecture's normal floating point format) of the correct size for
42267 @var{bitsize}. The default is @code{int}.
42268
42269 @item group
42270 The register group to which this register belongs. It can be one of the
42271 standard register groups @code{general}, @code{float}, @code{vector} or an
42272 arbitrary string. Group names should be limited to alphanumeric characters.
42273 If a group name is made up of multiple words the words may be separated by
42274 hyphens; e.g.@: @code{special-group} or @code{ultra-special-group}. If no
42275 @var{group} is specified, @value{GDBN} will not display the register in
42276 @code{info registers}.
42277
42278 @end table
42279
42280 @node Predefined Target Types
42281 @section Predefined Target Types
42282 @cindex target descriptions, predefined types
42283
42284 Type definitions in the self-description can build up composite types
42285 from basic building blocks, but can not define fundamental types. Instead,
42286 standard identifiers are provided by @value{GDBN} for the fundamental
42287 types. The currently supported types are:
42288
42289 @table @code
42290
42291 @item bool
42292 Boolean type, occupying a single bit.
42293
42294 @item int8
42295 @itemx int16
42296 @itemx int32
42297 @itemx int64
42298 @itemx int128
42299 Signed integer types holding the specified number of bits.
42300
42301 @item uint8
42302 @itemx uint16
42303 @itemx uint32
42304 @itemx uint64
42305 @itemx uint128
42306 Unsigned integer types holding the specified number of bits.
42307
42308 @item code_ptr
42309 @itemx data_ptr
42310 Pointers to unspecified code and data. The program counter and
42311 any dedicated return address register may be marked as code
42312 pointers; printing a code pointer converts it into a symbolic
42313 address. The stack pointer and any dedicated address registers
42314 may be marked as data pointers.
42315
42316 @item ieee_single
42317 Single precision IEEE floating point.
42318
42319 @item ieee_double
42320 Double precision IEEE floating point.
42321
42322 @item arm_fpa_ext
42323 The 12-byte extended precision format used by ARM FPA registers.
42324
42325 @item i387_ext
42326 The 10-byte extended precision format used by x87 registers.
42327
42328 @item i386_eflags
42329 32bit @sc{eflags} register used by x86.
42330
42331 @item i386_mxcsr
42332 32bit @sc{mxcsr} register used by x86.
42333
42334 @end table
42335
42336 @node Enum Target Types
42337 @section Enum Target Types
42338 @cindex target descriptions, enum types
42339
42340 Enum target types are useful in @samp{struct} and @samp{flags}
42341 register descriptions. @xref{Target Description Format}.
42342
42343 Enum types have a name, size and a list of name/value pairs.
42344
42345 @smallexample
42346 <enum id="@var{id}" size="@var{size}">
42347 <evalue name="@var{name}" value="@var{value}"/>
42348 @dots{}
42349 </enum>
42350 @end smallexample
42351
42352 Enums must be defined before they are used.
42353
42354 @smallexample
42355 <enum id="levels_type" size="4">
42356 <evalue name="low" value="0"/>
42357 <evalue name="high" value="1"/>
42358 </enum>
42359 <flags id="flags_type" size="4">
42360 <field name="X" start="0"/>
42361 <field name="LEVEL" start="1" end="1" type="levels_type"/>
42362 </flags>
42363 <reg name="flags" bitsize="32" type="flags_type"/>
42364 @end smallexample
42365
42366 Given that description, a value of 3 for the @samp{flags} register
42367 would be printed as:
42368
42369 @smallexample
42370 (gdb) info register flags
42371 flags 0x3 [ X LEVEL=high ]
42372 @end smallexample
42373
42374 @node Standard Target Features
42375 @section Standard Target Features
42376 @cindex target descriptions, standard features
42377
42378 A target description must contain either no registers or all the
42379 target's registers. If the description contains no registers, then
42380 @value{GDBN} will assume a default register layout, selected based on
42381 the architecture. If the description contains any registers, the
42382 default layout will not be used; the standard registers must be
42383 described in the target description, in such a way that @value{GDBN}
42384 can recognize them.
42385
42386 This is accomplished by giving specific names to feature elements
42387 which contain standard registers. @value{GDBN} will look for features
42388 with those names and verify that they contain the expected registers;
42389 if any known feature is missing required registers, or if any required
42390 feature is missing, @value{GDBN} will reject the target
42391 description. You can add additional registers to any of the
42392 standard features --- @value{GDBN} will display them just as if
42393 they were added to an unrecognized feature.
42394
42395 This section lists the known features and their expected contents.
42396 Sample XML documents for these features are included in the
42397 @value{GDBN} source tree, in the directory @file{gdb/features}.
42398
42399 Names recognized by @value{GDBN} should include the name of the
42400 company or organization which selected the name, and the overall
42401 architecture to which the feature applies; so e.g.@: the feature
42402 containing ARM core registers is named @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}.
42403
42404 The names of registers are not case sensitive for the purpose
42405 of recognizing standard features, but @value{GDBN} will only display
42406 registers using the capitalization used in the description.
42407
42408 @menu
42409 * AArch64 Features::
42410 * ARC Features::
42411 * ARM Features::
42412 * i386 Features::
42413 * MicroBlaze Features::
42414 * MIPS Features::
42415 * M68K Features::
42416 * NDS32 Features::
42417 * Nios II Features::
42418 * OpenRISC 1000 Features::
42419 * PowerPC Features::
42420 * S/390 and System z Features::
42421 * Sparc Features::
42422 * TIC6x Features::
42423 @end menu
42424
42425
42426 @node AArch64 Features
42427 @subsection AArch64 Features
42428 @cindex target descriptions, AArch64 features
42429
42430 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.core} feature is required for AArch64
42431 targets. It should contain registers @samp{x0} through @samp{x30},
42432 @samp{sp}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
42433
42434 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
42435 it should contain registers @samp{v0} through @samp{v31}, @samp{fpsr},
42436 and @samp{fpcr}.
42437
42438 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.aarch64.sve} feature is optional. If present,
42439 it should contain registers @samp{z0} through @samp{z31}, @samp{p0}
42440 through @samp{p15}, @samp{ffr} and @samp{vg}.
42441
42442 @node ARC Features
42443 @subsection ARC Features
42444 @cindex target descriptions, ARC Features
42445
42446 ARC processors are highly configurable, so even core registers and their number
42447 are not completely predetermined. In addition flags and PC registers which are
42448 important to @value{GDBN} are not ``core'' registers in ARC. It is required
42449 that one of the core registers features is present.
42450 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.aux-minimal} feature is mandatory.
42451
42452 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.v2} feature is required for ARC EM and ARC HS
42453 targets with a normal register file. It should contain registers @samp{r0}
42454 through @samp{r25}, @samp{gp}, @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink},
42455 @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}. This feature may contain register @samp{ilink}
42456 and any of extension core registers @samp{r32} through @samp{r59/acch}.
42457 @samp{ilink} and extension core registers are not available to read/write, when
42458 debugging GNU/Linux applications, thus @samp{ilink} is made optional.
42459
42460 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core-reduced.v2} feature is required for ARC EM and
42461 ARC HS targets with a reduced register file. It should contain registers
42462 @samp{r0} through @samp{r3}, @samp{r10} through @samp{r15}, @samp{gp},
42463 @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink}, @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}.
42464 This feature may contain register @samp{ilink} and any of extension core
42465 registers @samp{r32} through @samp{r59/acch}.
42466
42467 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.arcompact} feature is required for ARCompact
42468 targets with a normal register file. It should contain registers @samp{r0}
42469 through @samp{r25}, @samp{gp}, @samp{fp}, @samp{sp}, @samp{r30}, @samp{blink},
42470 @samp{lp_count} and @samp{pcl}. This feature may contain registers
42471 @samp{ilink1}, @samp{ilink2} and any of extension core registers @samp{r32}
42472 through @samp{r59/acch}. @samp{ilink1} and @samp{ilink2} and extension core
42473 registers are not available when debugging GNU/Linux applications. The only
42474 difference with @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.core.v2} feature is in the names of
42475 @samp{ilink1} and @samp{ilink2} registers and that @samp{r30} is mandatory in
42476 ARC v2, but @samp{ilink2} is optional on ARCompact.
42477
42478 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arc.aux-minimal} feature is required for all ARC
42479 targets. It should contain registers @samp{pc} and @samp{status32}.
42480
42481 @node ARM Features
42482 @subsection ARM Features
42483 @cindex target descriptions, ARM features
42484
42485 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core} feature is required for non-M-profile
42486 ARM targets.
42487 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp},
42488 @samp{lr}, @samp{pc}, and @samp{cpsr}.
42489
42490 For M-profile targets (e.g. Cortex-M3), the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.core}
42491 feature is replaced by @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.m-profile}. It should contain
42492 registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r13}, @samp{sp}, @samp{lr}, @samp{pc},
42493 and @samp{xpsr}.
42494
42495 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.fpa} feature is optional. If present, it
42496 should contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f7} and @samp{fps}.
42497
42498 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.xscale.iwmmxt} feature is optional. If present,
42499 it should contain at least registers @samp{wR0} through @samp{wR15} and
42500 @samp{wCGR0} through @samp{wCGR3}. The @samp{wCID}, @samp{wCon},
42501 @samp{wCSSF}, and @samp{wCASF} registers are optional.
42502
42503 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} feature is optional. If present, it
42504 should contain at least registers @samp{d0} through @samp{d15}. If
42505 they are present, @samp{d16} through @samp{d31} should also be included.
42506 @value{GDBN} will synthesize the single-precision registers from
42507 halves of the double-precision registers.
42508
42509 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.neon} feature is optional. It does not
42510 need to contain registers; it instructs @value{GDBN} to display the
42511 VFP double-precision registers as vectors and to synthesize the
42512 quad-precision registers from pairs of double-precision registers.
42513 If this feature is present, @samp{org.gnu.gdb.arm.vfp} must also
42514 be present and include 32 double-precision registers.
42515
42516 @node i386 Features
42517 @subsection i386 Features
42518 @cindex target descriptions, i386 features
42519
42520 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.core} feature is required for i386/amd64
42521 targets. It should describe the following registers:
42522
42523 @itemize @minus
42524 @item
42525 @samp{eax} through @samp{edi} plus @samp{eip} for i386
42526 @item
42527 @samp{rax} through @samp{r15} plus @samp{rip} for amd64
42528 @item
42529 @samp{eflags}, @samp{cs}, @samp{ss}, @samp{ds}, @samp{es},
42530 @samp{fs}, @samp{gs}
42531 @item
42532 @samp{st0} through @samp{st7}
42533 @item
42534 @samp{fctrl}, @samp{fstat}, @samp{ftag}, @samp{fiseg}, @samp{fioff},
42535 @samp{foseg}, @samp{fooff} and @samp{fop}
42536 @end itemize
42537
42538 The register sets may be different, depending on the target.
42539
42540 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature is optional. It should
42541 describe registers:
42542
42543 @itemize @minus
42544 @item
42545 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm7} for i386
42546 @item
42547 @samp{xmm0} through @samp{xmm15} for amd64
42548 @item
42549 @samp{mxcsr}
42550 @end itemize
42551
42552 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature is optional and requires the
42553 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.sse} feature. It should
42554 describe the upper 128 bits of @sc{ymm} registers:
42555
42556 @itemize @minus
42557 @item
42558 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm7h} for i386
42559 @item
42560 @samp{ymm0h} through @samp{ymm15h} for amd64
42561 @end itemize
42562
42563 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.mpx} is an optional feature representing Intel
42564 Memory Protection Extension (MPX). It should describe the following registers:
42565
42566 @itemize @minus
42567 @item
42568 @samp{bnd0raw} through @samp{bnd3raw} for i386 and amd64.
42569 @item
42570 @samp{bndcfgu} and @samp{bndstatus} for i386 and amd64.
42571 @end itemize
42572
42573 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.linux} feature is optional. It should
42574 describe a single register, @samp{orig_eax}.
42575
42576 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.segments} feature is optional. It should
42577 describe two system registers: @samp{fs_base} and @samp{gs_base}.
42578
42579 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx512} feature is optional and requires the
42580 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.avx} feature. It should
42581 describe additional @sc{xmm} registers:
42582
42583 @itemize @minus
42584 @item
42585 @samp{xmm16h} through @samp{xmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
42586 @end itemize
42587
42588 It should describe the upper 128 bits of additional @sc{ymm} registers:
42589
42590 @itemize @minus
42591 @item
42592 @samp{ymm16h} through @samp{ymm31h}, only valid for amd64.
42593 @end itemize
42594
42595 It should
42596 describe the upper 256 bits of @sc{zmm} registers:
42597
42598 @itemize @minus
42599 @item
42600 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm7h} for i386.
42601 @item
42602 @samp{zmm0h} through @samp{zmm15h} for amd64.
42603 @end itemize
42604
42605 It should
42606 describe the additional @sc{zmm} registers:
42607
42608 @itemize @minus
42609 @item
42610 @samp{zmm16h} through @samp{zmm31h}, only valid for amd64.
42611 @end itemize
42612
42613 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.i386.pkeys} feature is optional. It should
42614 describe a single register, @samp{pkru}. It is a 32-bit register
42615 valid for i386 and amd64.
42616
42617 @node MicroBlaze Features
42618 @subsection MicroBlaze Features
42619 @cindex target descriptions, MicroBlaze features
42620
42621 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.core} feature is required for MicroBlaze
42622 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
42623 @samp{rpc}, @samp{rmsr}, @samp{rear}, @samp{resr}, @samp{rfsr}, @samp{rbtr},
42624 @samp{rpvr}, @samp{rpvr1} through @samp{rpvr11}, @samp{redr}, @samp{rpid},
42625 @samp{rzpr}, @samp{rtlbx}, @samp{rtlbsx}, @samp{rtlblo}, and @samp{rtlbhi}.
42626
42627 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.microblaze.stack-protect} feature is optional.
42628 If present, it should contain registers @samp{rshr} and @samp{rslr}
42629
42630 @node MIPS Features
42631 @subsection @acronym{MIPS} Features
42632 @cindex target descriptions, @acronym{MIPS} features
42633
42634 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cpu} feature is required for @acronym{MIPS} targets.
42635 It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31}, @samp{lo},
42636 @samp{hi}, and @samp{pc}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending
42637 on the target.
42638
42639 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.cp0} feature is also required. It should
42640 contain at least the @samp{status}, @samp{badvaddr}, and @samp{cause}
42641 registers. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
42642
42643 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.fpu} feature is currently required, though
42644 it may be optional in a future version of @value{GDBN}. It should
42645 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}, @samp{fcsr}, and
42646 @samp{fir}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
42647
42648 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.dsp} feature is optional. It should
42649 contain registers @samp{hi1} through @samp{hi3}, @samp{lo1} through
42650 @samp{lo3}, and @samp{dspctl}. The @samp{dspctl} register should
42651 be 32-bit and the rest may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
42652
42653 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.mips.linux} feature is optional. It should
42654 contain a single register, @samp{restart}, which is used by the
42655 Linux kernel to control restartable syscalls.
42656
42657 @node M68K Features
42658 @subsection M68K Features
42659 @cindex target descriptions, M68K features
42660
42661 @table @code
42662 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.m68k.core}
42663 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.core}
42664 @itemx @samp{org.gnu.gdb.fido.core}
42665 One of those features must be always present.
42666 The feature that is present determines which flavor of m68k is
42667 used. The feature that is present should contain registers
42668 @samp{d0} through @samp{d7}, @samp{a0} through @samp{a5}, @samp{fp},
42669 @samp{sp}, @samp{ps} and @samp{pc}.
42670
42671 @item @samp{org.gnu.gdb.coldfire.fp}
42672 This feature is optional. If present, it should contain registers
42673 @samp{fp0} through @samp{fp7}, @samp{fpcontrol}, @samp{fpstatus} and
42674 @samp{fpiaddr}.
42675 @end table
42676
42677 @node NDS32 Features
42678 @subsection NDS32 Features
42679 @cindex target descriptions, NDS32 features
42680
42681 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nds32.core} feature is required for NDS32
42682 targets. It should contain at least registers @samp{r0} through
42683 @samp{r10}, @samp{r15}, @samp{fp}, @samp{gp}, @samp{lp}, @samp{sp},
42684 and @samp{pc}.
42685
42686 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nds32.fpu} feature is optional. If present,
42687 it should contain 64-bit double-precision floating-point registers
42688 @samp{fd0} through @emph{fdN}, which should be @samp{fd3}, @samp{fd7},
42689 @samp{fd15}, or @samp{fd31} based on the FPU configuration implemented.
42690
42691 @emph{Note:} The first sixteen 64-bit double-precision floating-point
42692 registers are overlapped with the thirty-two 32-bit single-precision
42693 floating-point registers. The 32-bit single-precision registers, if
42694 not being listed explicitly, will be synthesized from halves of the
42695 overlapping 64-bit double-precision registers. Listing 32-bit
42696 single-precision registers explicitly is deprecated, and the
42697 support to it could be totally removed some day.
42698
42699 @node Nios II Features
42700 @subsection Nios II Features
42701 @cindex target descriptions, Nios II features
42702
42703 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.nios2.cpu} feature is required for Nios II
42704 targets. It should contain the 32 core registers (@samp{zero},
42705 @samp{at}, @samp{r2} through @samp{r23}, @samp{et} through @samp{ra}),
42706 @samp{pc}, and the 16 control registers (@samp{status} through
42707 @samp{mpuacc}).
42708
42709 @node OpenRISC 1000 Features
42710 @subsection Openrisc 1000 Features
42711 @cindex target descriptions, OpenRISC 1000 features
42712
42713 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0} feature is required for OpenRISC 1000
42714 targets. It should contain the 32 general purpose registers (@samp{r0}
42715 through @samp{r31}), @samp{ppc}, @samp{npc} and @samp{sr}.
42716
42717 @node PowerPC Features
42718 @subsection PowerPC Features
42719 @cindex target descriptions, PowerPC features
42720
42721 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} feature is required for PowerPC
42722 targets. It should contain registers @samp{r0} through @samp{r31},
42723 @samp{pc}, @samp{msr}, @samp{cr}, @samp{lr}, @samp{ctr}, and
42724 @samp{xer}. They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
42725
42726 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.fpu} feature is optional. It should
42727 contain registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f31} and @samp{fpscr}.
42728
42729 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.altivec} feature is optional. It should
42730 contain registers @samp{vr0} through @samp{vr31}, @samp{vscr},
42731 and @samp{vrsave}.
42732
42733 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.vsx} feature is optional. It should
42734 contain registers @samp{vs0h} through @samp{vs31h}. @value{GDBN}
42735 will combine these registers with the floating point registers
42736 (@samp{f0} through @samp{f31}) and the altivec registers (@samp{vr0}
42737 through @samp{vr31}) to present the 128-bit wide registers @samp{vs0}
42738 through @samp{vs63}, the set of vector registers for POWER7.
42739
42740 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.spe} feature is optional. It should
42741 contain registers @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}, @samp{acc}, and
42742 @samp{spefscr}. SPE targets should provide 32-bit registers in
42743 @samp{org.gnu.gdb.power.core} and provide the upper halves in
42744 @samp{ev0h} through @samp{ev31h}. @value{GDBN} will combine
42745 these to present registers @samp{ev0} through @samp{ev31} to the
42746 user.
42747
42748 @node S/390 and System z Features
42749 @subsection S/390 and System z Features
42750 @cindex target descriptions, S/390 features
42751 @cindex target descriptions, System z features
42752
42753 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.core} feature is required for S/390 and
42754 System z targets. It should contain the PSW and the 16 general
42755 registers. In particular, System z targets should provide the 64-bit
42756 registers @samp{pswm}, @samp{pswa}, and @samp{r0} through @samp{r15}.
42757 S/390 targets should provide the 32-bit versions of these registers.
42758 A System z target that runs in 31-bit addressing mode should provide
42759 32-bit versions of @samp{pswm} and @samp{pswa}, as well as the general
42760 register's upper halves @samp{r0h} through @samp{r15h}, and their
42761 lower halves @samp{r0l} through @samp{r15l}.
42762
42763 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.fpr} feature is required. It should
42764 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{f0} through @samp{f15}, and
42765 @samp{fpc}.
42766
42767 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.acr} feature is required. It should
42768 contain the 32-bit registers @samp{acr0} through @samp{acr15}.
42769
42770 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.linux} feature is optional. It should
42771 contain the register @samp{orig_r2}, which is 64-bit wide on System z
42772 targets and 32-bit otherwise. In addition, the feature may contain
42773 the @samp{last_break} register, whose width depends on the addressing
42774 mode, as well as the @samp{system_call} register, which is always
42775 32-bit wide.
42776
42777 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.tdb} feature is optional. It should
42778 contain the 64-bit registers @samp{tdb0}, @samp{tac}, @samp{tct},
42779 @samp{atia}, and @samp{tr0} through @samp{tr15}.
42780
42781 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.vx} feature is optional. It should contain
42782 64-bit wide registers @samp{v0l} through @samp{v15l}, which will be
42783 combined by @value{GDBN} with the floating point registers @samp{f0}
42784 through @samp{f15} to present the 128-bit wide vector registers
42785 @samp{v0} through @samp{v15}. In addition, this feature should
42786 contain the 128-bit wide vector registers @samp{v16} through
42787 @samp{v31}.
42788
42789 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.gs} feature is optional. It should contain
42790 the 64-bit wide guarded-storage-control registers @samp{gsd},
42791 @samp{gssm}, and @samp{gsepla}.
42792
42793 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.s390.gsbc} feature is optional. It should contain
42794 the 64-bit wide guarded-storage broadcast control registers
42795 @samp{bc_gsd}, @samp{bc_gssm}, and @samp{bc_gsepla}.
42796
42797 @node Sparc Features
42798 @subsection Sparc Features
42799 @cindex target descriptions, sparc32 features
42800 @cindex target descriptions, sparc64 features
42801 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.cpu} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
42802 targets. It should describe the following registers:
42803
42804 @itemize @minus
42805 @item
42806 @samp{g0} through @samp{g7}
42807 @item
42808 @samp{o0} through @samp{o7}
42809 @item
42810 @samp{l0} through @samp{l7}
42811 @item
42812 @samp{i0} through @samp{i7}
42813 @end itemize
42814
42815 They may be 32-bit or 64-bit depending on the target.
42816
42817 Also the @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.fpu} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
42818 targets. It should describe the following registers:
42819
42820 @itemize @minus
42821 @item
42822 @samp{f0} through @samp{f31}
42823 @item
42824 @samp{f32} through @samp{f62} for sparc64
42825 @end itemize
42826
42827 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.sparc.cp0} feature is required for sparc32/sparc64
42828 targets. It should describe the following registers:
42829
42830 @itemize @minus
42831 @item
42832 @samp{y}, @samp{psr}, @samp{wim}, @samp{tbr}, @samp{pc}, @samp{npc},
42833 @samp{fsr}, and @samp{csr} for sparc32
42834 @item
42835 @samp{pc}, @samp{npc}, @samp{state}, @samp{fsr}, @samp{fprs}, and @samp{y}
42836 for sparc64
42837 @end itemize
42838
42839 @node TIC6x Features
42840 @subsection TMS320C6x Features
42841 @cindex target descriptions, TIC6x features
42842 @cindex target descriptions, TMS320C6x features
42843 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.core} feature is required for TMS320C6x
42844 targets. It should contain registers @samp{A0} through @samp{A15},
42845 registers @samp{B0} through @samp{B15}, @samp{CSR} and @samp{PC}.
42846
42847 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.gp} feature is optional. It should
42848 contain registers @samp{A16} through @samp{A31} and @samp{B16}
42849 through @samp{B31}.
42850
42851 The @samp{org.gnu.gdb.tic6x.c6xp} feature is optional. It should
42852 contain registers @samp{TSR}, @samp{ILC} and @samp{RILC}.
42853
42854 @node Operating System Information
42855 @appendix Operating System Information
42856 @cindex operating system information
42857
42858 @menu
42859 * Process list::
42860 @end menu
42861
42862 Users of @value{GDBN} often wish to obtain information about the state of
42863 the operating system running on the target---for example the list of
42864 processes, or the list of open files. This section describes the
42865 mechanism that makes it possible. This mechanism is similar to the
42866 target features mechanism (@pxref{Target Descriptions}), but focuses
42867 on a different aspect of target.
42868
42869 Operating system information is retrived from the target via the
42870 remote protocol, using @samp{qXfer} requests (@pxref{qXfer osdata
42871 read}). The object name in the request should be @samp{osdata}, and
42872 the @var{annex} identifies the data to be fetched.
42873
42874 @node Process list
42875 @appendixsection Process list
42876 @cindex operating system information, process list
42877
42878 When requesting the process list, the @var{annex} field in the
42879 @samp{qXfer} request should be @samp{processes}. The returned data is
42880 an XML document. The formal syntax of this document is defined in
42881 @file{gdb/features/osdata.dtd}.
42882
42883 An example document is:
42884
42885 @smallexample
42886 <?xml version="1.0"?>
42887 <!DOCTYPE target SYSTEM "osdata.dtd">
42888 <osdata type="processes">
42889 <item>
42890 <column name="pid">1</column>
42891 <column name="user">root</column>
42892 <column name="command">/sbin/init</column>
42893 <column name="cores">1,2,3</column>
42894 </item>
42895 </osdata>
42896 @end smallexample
42897
42898 Each item should include a column whose name is @samp{pid}. The value
42899 of that column should identify the process on the target. The
42900 @samp{user} and @samp{command} columns are optional, and will be
42901 displayed by @value{GDBN}. The @samp{cores} column, if present,
42902 should contain a comma-separated list of cores that this process
42903 is running on. Target may provide additional columns,
42904 which @value{GDBN} currently ignores.
42905
42906 @node Trace File Format
42907 @appendix Trace File Format
42908 @cindex trace file format
42909
42910 The trace file comes in three parts: a header, a textual description
42911 section, and a trace frame section with binary data.
42912
42913 The header has the form @code{\x7fTRACE0\n}. The first byte is
42914 @code{0x7f} so as to indicate that the file contains binary data,
42915 while the @code{0} is a version number that may have different values
42916 in the future.
42917
42918 The description section consists of multiple lines of @sc{ascii} text
42919 separated by newline characters (@code{0xa}). The lines may include a
42920 variety of optional descriptive or context-setting information, such
42921 as tracepoint definitions or register set size. @value{GDBN} will
42922 ignore any line that it does not recognize. An empty line marks the end
42923 of this section.
42924
42925 @table @code
42926 @item R @var{size}
42927 Specifies the size of a register block in bytes. This is equal to the
42928 size of a @code{g} packet payload in the remote protocol. @var{size}
42929 is an ascii decimal number. There should be only one such line in
42930 a single trace file.
42931
42932 @item status @var{status}
42933 Trace status. @var{status} has the same format as a @code{qTStatus}
42934 remote packet reply. There should be only one such line in a single trace
42935 file.
42936
42937 @item tp @var{payload}
42938 Tracepoint definition. The @var{payload} has the same format as
42939 @code{qTfP}/@code{qTsP} remote packet reply payload. A single tracepoint
42940 may take multiple lines of definition, corresponding to the multiple
42941 reply packets.
42942
42943 @item tsv @var{payload}
42944 Trace state variable definition. The @var{payload} has the same format as
42945 @code{qTfV}/@code{qTsV} remote packet reply payload. A single variable
42946 may take multiple lines of definition, corresponding to the multiple
42947 reply packets.
42948
42949 @item tdesc @var{payload}
42950 Target description in XML format. The @var{payload} is a single line of
42951 the XML file. All such lines should be concatenated together to get
42952 the original XML file. This file is in the same format as @code{qXfer}
42953 @code{features} payload, and corresponds to the main @code{target.xml}
42954 file. Includes are not allowed.
42955
42956 @end table
42957
42958 The trace frame section consists of a number of consecutive frames.
42959 Each frame begins with a two-byte tracepoint number, followed by a
42960 four-byte size giving the amount of data in the frame. The data in
42961 the frame consists of a number of blocks, each introduced by a
42962 character indicating its type (at least register, memory, and trace
42963 state variable). The data in this section is raw binary, not a
42964 hexadecimal or other encoding; its endianness matches the target's
42965 endianness.
42966
42967 @c FIXME bi-arch may require endianness/arch info in description section
42968
42969 @table @code
42970 @item R @var{bytes}
42971 Register block. The number and ordering of bytes matches that of a
42972 @code{g} packet in the remote protocol. Note that these are the
42973 actual bytes, in target order, not a hexadecimal encoding.
42974
42975 @item M @var{address} @var{length} @var{bytes}...
42976 Memory block. This is a contiguous block of memory, at the 8-byte
42977 address @var{address}, with a 2-byte length @var{length}, followed by
42978 @var{length} bytes.
42979
42980 @item V @var{number} @var{value}
42981 Trace state variable block. This records the 8-byte signed value
42982 @var{value} of trace state variable numbered @var{number}.
42983
42984 @end table
42985
42986 Future enhancements of the trace file format may include additional types
42987 of blocks.
42988
42989 @node Index Section Format
42990 @appendix @code{.gdb_index} section format
42991 @cindex .gdb_index section format
42992 @cindex index section format
42993
42994 This section documents the index section that is created by @code{save
42995 gdb-index} (@pxref{Index Files}). The index section is
42996 DWARF-specific; some knowledge of DWARF is assumed in this
42997 description.
42998
42999 The mapped index file format is designed to be directly
43000 @code{mmap}able on any architecture. In most cases, a datum is
43001 represented using a little-endian 32-bit integer value, called an
43002 @code{offset_type}. Big endian machines must byte-swap the values
43003 before using them. Exceptions to this rule are noted. The data is
43004 laid out such that alignment is always respected.
43005
43006 A mapped index consists of several areas, laid out in order.
43007
43008 @enumerate
43009 @item
43010 The file header. This is a sequence of values, of @code{offset_type}
43011 unless otherwise noted:
43012
43013 @enumerate
43014 @item
43015 The version number, currently 8. Versions 1, 2 and 3 are obsolete.
43016 Version 4 uses a different hashing function from versions 5 and 6.
43017 Version 6 includes symbols for inlined functions, whereas versions 4
43018 and 5 do not. Version 7 adds attributes to the CU indices in the
43019 symbol table. Version 8 specifies that symbols from DWARF type units
43020 (@samp{DW_TAG_type_unit}) refer to the type unit's symbol table and not the
43021 compilation unit (@samp{DW_TAG_comp_unit}) using the type.
43022
43023 @value{GDBN} will only read version 4, 5, or 6 indices
43024 by specifying @code{set use-deprecated-index-sections on}.
43025 GDB has a workaround for potentially broken version 7 indices so it is
43026 currently not flagged as deprecated.
43027
43028 @item
43029 The offset, from the start of the file, of the CU list.
43030
43031 @item
43032 The offset, from the start of the file, of the types CU list. Note
43033 that this area can be empty, in which case this offset will be equal
43034 to the next offset.
43035
43036 @item
43037 The offset, from the start of the file, of the address area.
43038
43039 @item
43040 The offset, from the start of the file, of the symbol table.
43041
43042 @item
43043 The offset, from the start of the file, of the constant pool.
43044 @end enumerate
43045
43046 @item
43047 The CU list. This is a sequence of pairs of 64-bit little-endian
43048 values, sorted by the CU offset. The first element in each pair is
43049 the offset of a CU in the @code{.debug_info} section. The second
43050 element in each pair is the length of that CU. References to a CU
43051 elsewhere in the map are done using a CU index, which is just the
43052 0-based index into this table. Note that if there are type CUs, then
43053 conceptually CUs and type CUs form a single list for the purposes of
43054 CU indices.
43055
43056 @item
43057 The types CU list. This is a sequence of triplets of 64-bit
43058 little-endian values. In a triplet, the first value is the CU offset,
43059 the second value is the type offset in the CU, and the third value is
43060 the type signature. The types CU list is not sorted.
43061
43062 @item
43063 The address area. The address area consists of a sequence of address
43064 entries. Each address entry has three elements:
43065
43066 @enumerate
43067 @item
43068 The low address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value.
43069
43070 @item
43071 The high address. This is a 64-bit little-endian value. Like
43072 @code{DW_AT_high_pc}, the value is one byte beyond the end.
43073
43074 @item
43075 The CU index. This is an @code{offset_type} value.
43076 @end enumerate
43077
43078 @item
43079 The symbol table. This is an open-addressed hash table. The size of
43080 the hash table is always a power of 2.
43081
43082 Each slot in the hash table consists of a pair of @code{offset_type}
43083 values. The first value is the offset of the symbol's name in the
43084 constant pool. The second value is the offset of the CU vector in the
43085 constant pool.
43086
43087 If both values are 0, then this slot in the hash table is empty. This
43088 is ok because while 0 is a valid constant pool index, it cannot be a
43089 valid index for both a string and a CU vector.
43090
43091 The hash value for a table entry is computed by applying an
43092 iterative hash function to the symbol's name. Starting with an
43093 initial value of @code{r = 0}, each (unsigned) character @samp{c} in
43094 the string is incorporated into the hash using the formula depending on the
43095 index version:
43096
43097 @table @asis
43098 @item Version 4
43099 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + c - 113}.
43100
43101 @item Versions 5 to 7
43102 The formula is @code{r = r * 67 + tolower (c) - 113}.
43103 @end table
43104
43105 The terminating @samp{\0} is not incorporated into the hash.
43106
43107 The step size used in the hash table is computed via
43108 @code{((hash * 17) & (size - 1)) | 1}, where @samp{hash} is the hash
43109 value, and @samp{size} is the size of the hash table. The step size
43110 is used to find the next candidate slot when handling a hash
43111 collision.
43112
43113 The names of C@t{++} symbols in the hash table are canonicalized. We
43114 don't currently have a simple description of the canonicalization
43115 algorithm; if you intend to create new index sections, you must read
43116 the code.
43117
43118 @item
43119 The constant pool. This is simply a bunch of bytes. It is organized
43120 so that alignment is correct: CU vectors are stored first, followed by
43121 strings.
43122
43123 A CU vector in the constant pool is a sequence of @code{offset_type}
43124 values. The first value is the number of CU indices in the vector.
43125 Each subsequent value is the index and symbol attributes of a CU in
43126 the CU list. This element in the hash table is used to indicate which
43127 CUs define the symbol and how the symbol is used.
43128 See below for the format of each CU index+attributes entry.
43129
43130 A string in the constant pool is zero-terminated.
43131 @end enumerate
43132
43133 Attributes were added to CU index values in @code{.gdb_index} version 7.
43134 If a symbol has multiple uses within a CU then there is one
43135 CU index+attributes value for each use.
43136
43137 The format of each CU index+attributes entry is as follows
43138 (bit 0 = LSB):
43139
43140 @table @asis
43141
43142 @item Bits 0-23
43143 This is the index of the CU in the CU list.
43144 @item Bits 24-27
43145 These bits are reserved for future purposes and must be zero.
43146 @item Bits 28-30
43147 The kind of the symbol in the CU.
43148
43149 @table @asis
43150 @item 0
43151 This value is reserved and should not be used.
43152 By reserving zero the full @code{offset_type} value is backwards compatible
43153 with previous versions of the index.
43154 @item 1
43155 The symbol is a type.
43156 @item 2
43157 The symbol is a variable or an enum value.
43158 @item 3
43159 The symbol is a function.
43160 @item 4
43161 Any other kind of symbol.
43162 @item 5,6,7
43163 These values are reserved.
43164 @end table
43165
43166 @item Bit 31
43167 This bit is zero if the value is global and one if it is static.
43168
43169 The determination of whether a symbol is global or static is complicated.
43170 The authorative reference is the file @file{dwarf2read.c} in
43171 @value{GDBN} sources.
43172
43173 @end table
43174
43175 This pseudo-code describes the computation of a symbol's kind and
43176 global/static attributes in the index.
43177
43178 @smallexample
43179 is_external = get_attribute (die, DW_AT_external);
43180 language = get_attribute (cu_die, DW_AT_language);
43181 switch (die->tag)
43182 @{
43183 case DW_TAG_typedef:
43184 case DW_TAG_base_type:
43185 case DW_TAG_subrange_type:
43186 kind = TYPE;
43187 is_static = 1;
43188 break;
43189 case DW_TAG_enumerator:
43190 kind = VARIABLE;
43191 is_static = language != CPLUS;
43192 break;
43193 case DW_TAG_subprogram:
43194 kind = FUNCTION;
43195 is_static = ! (is_external || language == ADA);
43196 break;
43197 case DW_TAG_constant:
43198 kind = VARIABLE;
43199 is_static = ! is_external;
43200 break;
43201 case DW_TAG_variable:
43202 kind = VARIABLE;
43203 is_static = ! is_external;
43204 break;
43205 case DW_TAG_namespace:
43206 kind = TYPE;
43207 is_static = 0;
43208 break;
43209 case DW_TAG_class_type:
43210 case DW_TAG_interface_type:
43211 case DW_TAG_structure_type:
43212 case DW_TAG_union_type:
43213 case DW_TAG_enumeration_type:
43214 kind = TYPE;
43215 is_static = language != CPLUS;
43216 break;
43217 default:
43218 assert (0);
43219 @}
43220 @end smallexample
43221
43222 @node Man Pages
43223 @appendix Manual pages
43224 @cindex Man pages
43225
43226 @menu
43227 * gdb man:: The GNU Debugger man page
43228 * gdbserver man:: Remote Server for the GNU Debugger man page
43229 * gcore man:: Generate a core file of a running program
43230 * gdbinit man:: gdbinit scripts
43231 * gdb-add-index man:: Add index files to speed up GDB
43232 @end menu
43233
43234 @node gdb man
43235 @heading gdb man
43236
43237 @c man title gdb The GNU Debugger
43238
43239 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdb
43240 gdb [@option{-help}] [@option{-nh}] [@option{-nx}] [@option{-q}]
43241 [@option{-batch}] [@option{-cd=}@var{dir}] [@option{-f}]
43242 [@option{-b}@w{ }@var{bps}]
43243 [@option{-tty=}@var{dev}] [@option{-s} @var{symfile}]
43244 [@option{-e}@w{ }@var{prog}] [@option{-se}@w{ }@var{prog}]
43245 [@option{-c}@w{ }@var{core}] [@option{-p}@w{ }@var{procID}]
43246 [@option{-x}@w{ }@var{cmds}] [@option{-d}@w{ }@var{dir}]
43247 [@var{prog}|@var{prog} @var{procID}|@var{prog} @var{core}]
43248 @c man end
43249
43250 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdb
43251 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
43252 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes -- or what another
43253 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
43254
43255 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
43256 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
43257
43258 @itemize @bullet
43259 @item
43260 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
43261
43262 @item
43263 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
43264
43265 @item
43266 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
43267
43268 @item
43269 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
43270 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
43271 @end itemize
43272
43273 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C, C@t{++}, Fortran and
43274 Modula-2.
43275
43276 @value{GDBN} is invoked with the shell command @code{gdb}. Once started, it reads
43277 commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit with the @value{GDBN}
43278 command @code{quit}. You can get online help from @value{GDBN} itself
43279 by using the command @code{help}.
43280
43281 You can run @code{gdb} with no arguments or options; but the most
43282 usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument or two, specifying an
43283 executable program as the argument:
43284
43285 @smallexample
43286 gdb program
43287 @end smallexample
43288
43289 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file specified:
43290
43291 @smallexample
43292 gdb program core
43293 @end smallexample
43294
43295 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
43296 to debug a running process:
43297
43298 @smallexample
43299 gdb program 1234
43300 gdb -p 1234
43301 @end smallexample
43302
43303 @noindent
43304 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
43305 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
43306 With option @option{-p} you can omit the @var{program} filename.
43307
43308 Here are some of the most frequently needed @value{GDBN} commands:
43309
43310 @c pod2man highlights the right hand side of the @item lines.
43311 @table @env
43312 @item break [@var{file}:]@var{function}
43313 Set a breakpoint at @var{function} (in @var{file}).
43314
43315 @item run [@var{arglist}]
43316 Start your program (with @var{arglist}, if specified).
43317
43318 @item bt
43319 Backtrace: display the program stack.
43320
43321 @item print @var{expr}
43322 Display the value of an expression.
43323
43324 @item c
43325 Continue running your program (after stopping, e.g. at a breakpoint).
43326
43327 @item next
43328 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{over} any
43329 function calls in the line.
43330
43331 @item edit [@var{file}:]@var{function}
43332 look at the program line where it is presently stopped.
43333
43334 @item list [@var{file}:]@var{function}
43335 type the text of the program in the vicinity of where it is presently stopped.
43336
43337 @item step
43338 Execute next program line (after stopping); step @emph{into} any
43339 function calls in the line.
43340
43341 @item help [@var{name}]
43342 Show information about @value{GDBN} command @var{name}, or general information
43343 about using @value{GDBN}.
43344
43345 @item quit
43346 Exit from @value{GDBN}.
43347 @end table
43348
43349 @ifset man
43350 For full details on @value{GDBN},
43351 see @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
43352 by Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch. The same text is available online
43353 as the @code{gdb} entry in the @code{info} program.
43354 @end ifset
43355 @c man end
43356
43357 @c man begin OPTIONS gdb
43358 Any arguments other than options specify an executable
43359 file and core file (or process ID); that is, the first argument
43360 encountered with no
43361 associated option flag is equivalent to a @option{-se} option, and the second,
43362 if any, is equivalent to a @option{-c} option if it's the name of a file.
43363 Many options have
43364 both long and short forms; both are shown here. The long forms are also
43365 recognized if you truncate them, so long as enough of the option is
43366 present to be unambiguous. (If you prefer, you can flag option
43367 arguments with @option{+} rather than @option{-}, though we illustrate the
43368 more usual convention.)
43369
43370 All the options and command line arguments you give are processed
43371 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the @option{-x}
43372 option is used.
43373
43374 @table @env
43375 @item -help
43376 @itemx -h
43377 List all options, with brief explanations.
43378
43379 @item -symbols=@var{file}
43380 @itemx -s @var{file}
43381 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
43382
43383 @item -write
43384 Enable writing into executable and core files.
43385
43386 @item -exec=@var{file}
43387 @itemx -e @var{file}
43388 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when
43389 appropriate, and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core
43390 dump.
43391
43392 @item -se=@var{file}
43393 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
43394 file.
43395
43396 @item -core=@var{file}
43397 @itemx -c @var{file}
43398 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
43399
43400 @item -command=@var{file}
43401 @itemx -x @var{file}
43402 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}.
43403
43404 @item -ex @var{command}
43405 Execute given @value{GDBN} @var{command}.
43406
43407 @item -directory=@var{directory}
43408 @itemx -d @var{directory}
43409 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
43410
43411 @item -nh
43412 Do not execute commands from @file{~/.gdbinit}.
43413
43414 @item -nx
43415 @itemx -n
43416 Do not execute commands from any @file{.gdbinit} initialization files.
43417
43418 @item -quiet
43419 @itemx -q
43420 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
43421 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
43422
43423 @item -batch
43424 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the command
43425 files specified with @option{-x} (and @file{.gdbinit}, if not inhibited).
43426 Exit with nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN}
43427 commands in the command files.
43428
43429 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for example to
43430 download and run a program on another computer; in order to make this
43431 more useful, the message
43432
43433 @smallexample
43434 Program exited normally.
43435 @end smallexample
43436
43437 @noindent
43438 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under @value{GDBN} control
43439 terminates) is not issued when running in batch mode.
43440
43441 @item -cd=@var{directory}
43442 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
43443 instead of the current directory.
43444
43445 @item -fullname
43446 @itemx -f
43447 Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells
43448 @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line number in a standard,
43449 recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is displayed (which
43450 includes each time the program stops). This recognizable format looks
43451 like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by the file name, line number
43452 and character position separated by colons, and a newline. The
43453 Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two @samp{\032}
43454 characters as a signal to display the source code for the frame.
43455
43456 @item -b @var{bps}
43457 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
43458 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
43459
43460 @item -tty=@var{device}
43461 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
43462 @end table
43463 @c man end
43464
43465 @c man begin SEEALSO gdb
43466 @ifset man
43467 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
43468 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
43469 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
43470
43471 @smallexample
43472 info gdb
43473 @end smallexample
43474
43475 @noindent
43476 should give you access to the complete manual.
43477
43478 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
43479 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
43480 @end ifset
43481 @c man end
43482
43483 @node gdbserver man
43484 @heading gdbserver man
43485
43486 @c man title gdbserver Remote Server for the GNU Debugger
43487 @format
43488 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbserver
43489 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
43490
43491 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
43492
43493 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
43494 @c man end
43495 @end format
43496
43497 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbserver
43498 @command{gdbserver} is a program that allows you to run @value{GDBN} on a different machine
43499 than the one which is running the program being debugged.
43500
43501 @ifclear man
43502 @subheading Usage (server (target) side)
43503 @end ifclear
43504 @ifset man
43505 Usage (server (target) side):
43506 @end ifset
43507
43508 First, you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug put onto
43509 the target system. The program can be stripped to save space if needed, as
43510 @command{gdbserver} doesn't care about symbols. All symbol handling is taken care of by
43511 the @value{GDBN} running on the host system.
43512
43513 To use the server, you log on to the target system, and run the @command{gdbserver}
43514 program. You must tell it (a) how to communicate with @value{GDBN}, (b) the name of
43515 your program, and (c) its arguments. The general syntax is:
43516
43517 @smallexample
43518 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [@var{args} ...]
43519 @end smallexample
43520
43521 For example, using a serial port, you might say:
43522
43523 @smallexample
43524 @ifset man
43525 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/com1>.
43526 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
43527 @end ifset
43528 @ifclear man
43529 target> gdbserver @file{/dev/com1} emacs foo.txt
43530 @end ifclear
43531 @end smallexample
43532
43533 This tells @command{gdbserver} to debug emacs with an argument of foo.txt, and
43534 to communicate with @value{GDBN} via @file{/dev/com1}. @command{gdbserver} now
43535 waits patiently for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate with it.
43536
43537 To use a TCP connection, you could say:
43538
43539 @smallexample
43540 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
43541 @end smallexample
43542
43543 This says pretty much the same thing as the last example, except that we are
43544 going to communicate with the @code{host} @value{GDBN} via TCP. The @code{host:2345} argument means
43545 that we are expecting to see a TCP connection from @code{host} to local TCP port
43546 2345. (Currently, the @code{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number you
43547 want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any existing TCP
43548 ports on the target system. This same port number must be used in the host
43549 @value{GDBN}s @code{target remote} command, which will be described shortly. Note that if
43550 you chose a port number that conflicts with another service, @command{gdbserver} will
43551 print an error message and exit.
43552
43553 @command{gdbserver} can also attach to running programs.
43554 This is accomplished via the @option{--attach} argument. The syntax is:
43555
43556 @smallexample
43557 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
43558 @end smallexample
43559
43560 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
43561 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
43562
43563 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
43564 or process ID to attach, use the @option{--multi} command line option.
43565 In such case you should connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} to start
43566 the program you want to debug.
43567
43568 @smallexample
43569 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
43570 @end smallexample
43571
43572 @ifclear man
43573 @subheading Usage (host side)
43574 @end ifclear
43575 @ifset man
43576 Usage (host side):
43577 @end ifset
43578
43579 You need an unstripped copy of the target program on your host system, since
43580 @value{GDBN} needs to examine it's symbol tables and such. Start up @value{GDBN} as you normally
43581 would, with the target program as the first argument. (You may need to use the
43582 @option{--baud} option if the serial line is running at anything except 9600 baud.)
43583 That is @code{gdb TARGET-PROG}, or @code{gdb --baud BAUD TARGET-PROG}. After that, the only
43584 new command you need to know about is @code{target remote}
43585 (or @code{target extended-remote}). Its argument is either
43586 a device name (usually a serial device, like @file{/dev/ttyb}), or a @code{HOST:PORT}
43587 descriptor. For example:
43588
43589 @smallexample
43590 @ifset man
43591 @c @file would wrap it as F</dev/ttyb>.
43592 (gdb) target remote /dev/ttyb
43593 @end ifset
43594 @ifclear man
43595 (gdb) target remote @file{/dev/ttyb}
43596 @end ifclear
43597 @end smallexample
43598
43599 @noindent
43600 communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and:
43601
43602 @smallexample
43603 (gdb) target remote the-target:2345
43604 @end smallexample
43605
43606 @noindent
43607 communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host `the-target', where
43608 you previously started up @command{gdbserver} with the same port number. Note that for
43609 TCP connections, you must start up @command{gdbserver} prior to using the `target remote'
43610 command, otherwise you may get an error that looks something like
43611 `Connection refused'.
43612
43613 @command{gdbserver} can also debug multiple inferiors at once,
43614 described in
43615 @ifset man
43616 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Inferiors and Programs}
43617 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Inferiors and Programs'}.
43618 @end ifset
43619 @ifclear man
43620 @ref{Inferiors and Programs}.
43621 @end ifclear
43622 In such case use the @code{extended-remote} @value{GDBN} command variant:
43623
43624 @smallexample
43625 (gdb) target extended-remote the-target:2345
43626 @end smallexample
43627
43628 The @command{gdbserver} option @option{--multi} may or may not be used in such
43629 case.
43630 @c man end
43631
43632 @c man begin OPTIONS gdbserver
43633 There are three different modes for invoking @command{gdbserver}:
43634
43635 @itemize @bullet
43636
43637 @item
43638 Debug a specific program specified by its program name:
43639
43640 @smallexample
43641 gdbserver @var{comm} @var{prog} [@var{args}@dots{}]
43642 @end smallexample
43643
43644 The @var{comm} parameter specifies how should the server communicate
43645 with @value{GDBN}; it is either a device name (to use a serial line),
43646 a TCP port number (@code{:1234}), or @code{-} or @code{stdio} to use
43647 stdin/stdout of @code{gdbserver}. Specify the name of the program to
43648 debug in @var{prog}. Any remaining arguments will be passed to the
43649 program verbatim. When the program exits, @value{GDBN} will close the
43650 connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
43651
43652 @item
43653 Debug a specific program by specifying the process ID of a running
43654 program:
43655
43656 @smallexample
43657 gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
43658 @end smallexample
43659
43660 The @var{comm} parameter is as described above. Supply the process ID
43661 of a running program in @var{pid}; @value{GDBN} will do everything
43662 else. Like with the previous mode, when the process @var{pid} exits,
43663 @value{GDBN} will close the connection, and @code{gdbserver} will exit.
43664
43665 @item
43666 Multi-process mode -- debug more than one program/process:
43667
43668 @smallexample
43669 gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
43670 @end smallexample
43671
43672 In this mode, @value{GDBN} can instruct @command{gdbserver} which
43673 command(s) to run. Unlike the other 2 modes, @value{GDBN} will not
43674 close the connection when a process being debugged exits, so you can
43675 debug several processes in the same session.
43676 @end itemize
43677
43678 In each of the modes you may specify these options:
43679
43680 @table @env
43681
43682 @item --help
43683 List all options, with brief explanations.
43684
43685 @item --version
43686 This option causes @command{gdbserver} to print its version number and exit.
43687
43688 @item --attach
43689 @command{gdbserver} will attach to a running program. The syntax is:
43690
43691 @smallexample
43692 target> gdbserver --attach @var{comm} @var{pid}
43693 @end smallexample
43694
43695 @var{pid} is the process ID of a currently running process. It isn't
43696 necessary to point @command{gdbserver} at a binary for the running process.
43697
43698 @item --multi
43699 To start @code{gdbserver} without supplying an initial command to run
43700 or process ID to attach, use this command line option.
43701 Then you can connect using @kbd{target extended-remote} and start
43702 the program you want to debug. The syntax is:
43703
43704 @smallexample
43705 target> gdbserver --multi @var{comm}
43706 @end smallexample
43707
43708 @item --debug
43709 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display extra status information about the debugging
43710 process.
43711 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
43712 the developers.
43713
43714 @item --remote-debug
43715 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to display remote protocol debug output.
43716 This option is intended for @code{gdbserver} development and for bug reports to
43717 the developers.
43718
43719 @item --debug-format=option1@r{[},option2,...@r{]}
43720 Instruct @code{gdbserver} to include extra information in each line
43721 of debugging output.
43722 @xref{Other Command-Line Arguments for gdbserver}.
43723
43724 @item --wrapper
43725 Specify a wrapper to launch programs
43726 for debugging. The option should be followed by the name of the
43727 wrapper, then any command-line arguments to pass to the wrapper, then
43728 @kbd{--} indicating the end of the wrapper arguments.
43729
43730 @item --once
43731 By default, @command{gdbserver} keeps the listening TCP port open, so that
43732 additional connections are possible. However, if you start @code{gdbserver}
43733 with the @option{--once} option, it will stop listening for any further
43734 connection attempts after connecting to the first @value{GDBN} session.
43735
43736 @c --disable-packet is not documented for users.
43737
43738 @c --disable-randomization and --no-disable-randomization are superseded by
43739 @c QDisableRandomization.
43740
43741 @end table
43742 @c man end
43743
43744 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbserver
43745 @ifset man
43746 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
43747 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
43748 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
43749
43750 @smallexample
43751 info gdb
43752 @end smallexample
43753
43754 should give you access to the complete manual.
43755
43756 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
43757 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
43758 @end ifset
43759 @c man end
43760
43761 @node gcore man
43762 @heading gcore
43763
43764 @c man title gcore Generate a core file of a running program
43765
43766 @format
43767 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gcore
43768 gcore [-a] [-o @var{prefix}] @var{pid1} [@var{pid2}...@var{pidN}]
43769 @c man end
43770 @end format
43771
43772 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gcore
43773 Generate core dumps of one or more running programs with process IDs
43774 @var{pid1}, @var{pid2}, etc. A core file produced by @command{gcore}
43775 is equivalent to one produced by the kernel when the process crashes
43776 (and when @kbd{ulimit -c} was used to set up an appropriate core dump
43777 limit). However, unlike after a crash, after @command{gcore} finishes
43778 its job the program remains running without any change.
43779 @c man end
43780
43781 @c man begin OPTIONS gcore
43782 @table @env
43783 @item -a
43784 Dump all memory mappings. The actual effect of this option depends on
43785 the Operating System. On @sc{gnu}/Linux, it will disable
43786 @code{use-coredump-filter} (@pxref{set use-coredump-filter}) and
43787 enable @code{dump-excluded-mappings} (@pxref{set
43788 dump-excluded-mappings}).
43789
43790 @item -o @var{prefix}
43791 The optional argument @var{prefix} specifies the prefix to be used
43792 when composing the file names of the core dumps. The file name is
43793 composed as @file{@var{prefix}.@var{pid}}, where @var{pid} is the
43794 process ID of the running program being analyzed by @command{gcore}.
43795 If not specified, @var{prefix} defaults to @var{gcore}.
43796 @end table
43797 @c man end
43798
43799 @c man begin SEEALSO gcore
43800 @ifset man
43801 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
43802 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
43803 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
43804
43805 @smallexample
43806 info gdb
43807 @end smallexample
43808
43809 @noindent
43810 should give you access to the complete manual.
43811
43812 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
43813 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
43814 @end ifset
43815 @c man end
43816
43817 @node gdbinit man
43818 @heading gdbinit
43819
43820 @c man title gdbinit GDB initialization scripts
43821
43822 @format
43823 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdbinit
43824 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
43825 @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
43826 @end ifset
43827
43828 ~/.gdbinit
43829
43830 ./.gdbinit
43831 @c man end
43832 @end format
43833
43834 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdbinit
43835 These files contain @value{GDBN} commands to automatically execute during
43836 @value{GDBN} startup. The lines of contents are canned sequences of commands,
43837 described in
43838 @ifset man
43839 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Sequences}
43840 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Sequences}.
43841 @end ifset
43842 @ifclear man
43843 @ref{Sequences}.
43844 @end ifclear
43845
43846 Please read more in
43847 @ifset man
43848 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Startup}
43849 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}.
43850 @end ifset
43851 @ifclear man
43852 @ref{Startup}.
43853 @end ifclear
43854
43855 @table @env
43856 @ifset SYSTEM_GDBINIT
43857 @item @value{SYSTEM_GDBINIT}
43858 @end ifset
43859 @ifclear SYSTEM_GDBINIT
43860 @item (not enabled with @code{--with-system-gdbinit} during compilation)
43861 @end ifclear
43862 System-wide initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
43863 @value{GDBN} option @code{-nx} or @code{-n}.
43864 See more in
43865 @ifset man
43866 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{System-wide configuration}
43867 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'System-wide configuration'}.
43868 @end ifset
43869 @ifclear man
43870 @ref{System-wide configuration}.
43871 @end ifclear
43872
43873 @item ~/.gdbinit
43874 User initialization file. It is executed unless user specified
43875 @value{GDBN} options @code{-nx}, @code{-n} or @code{-nh}.
43876
43877 @item ./.gdbinit
43878 Initialization file for current directory. It may need to be enabled with
43879 @value{GDBN} security command @code{set auto-load local-gdbinit}.
43880 See more in
43881 @ifset man
43882 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Init File in the Current Directory}
43883 -- shell command @code{info -f gdb -n 'Init File in the Current Directory'}.
43884 @end ifset
43885 @ifclear man
43886 @ref{Init File in the Current Directory}.
43887 @end ifclear
43888 @end table
43889 @c man end
43890
43891 @c man begin SEEALSO gdbinit
43892 @ifset man
43893 gdb(1), @code{info -f gdb -n Startup}
43894
43895 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
43896 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
43897 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
43898
43899 @smallexample
43900 info gdb
43901 @end smallexample
43902
43903 should give you access to the complete manual.
43904
43905 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
43906 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
43907 @end ifset
43908 @c man end
43909
43910 @node gdb-add-index man
43911 @heading gdb-add-index
43912 @pindex gdb-add-index
43913 @anchor{gdb-add-index}
43914
43915 @c man title gdb-add-index Add index files to speed up GDB
43916
43917 @c man begin SYNOPSIS gdb-add-index
43918 gdb-add-index @var{filename}
43919 @c man end
43920
43921 @c man begin DESCRIPTION gdb-add-index
43922 When @value{GDBN} finds a symbol file, it scans the symbols in the
43923 file in order to construct an internal symbol table. This lets most
43924 @value{GDBN} operations work quickly--at the cost of a delay early on.
43925 For large programs, this delay can be quite lengthy, so @value{GDBN}
43926 provides a way to build an index, which speeds up startup.
43927
43928 To determine whether a file contains such an index, use the command
43929 @kbd{readelf -S filename}: the index is stored in a section named
43930 @code{.gdb_index}. The index file can only be produced on systems
43931 which use ELF binaries and DWARF debug information (i.e., sections
43932 named @code{.debug_*}).
43933
43934 @command{gdb-add-index} uses @value{GDBN} and @command{objdump} found
43935 in the @env{PATH} environment variable. If you want to use different
43936 versions of these programs, you can specify them through the
43937 @env{GDB} and @env{OBJDUMP} environment variables.
43938
43939 See more in
43940 @ifset man
43941 the @value{GDBN} manual in node @code{Index Files}
43942 -- shell command @kbd{info -f gdb -n "Index Files"}.
43943 @end ifset
43944 @ifclear man
43945 @ref{Index Files}.
43946 @end ifclear
43947 @c man end
43948
43949 @c man begin SEEALSO gdb-add-index
43950 @ifset man
43951 The full documentation for @value{GDBN} is maintained as a Texinfo manual.
43952 If the @code{info} and @code{gdb} programs and @value{GDBN}'s Texinfo
43953 documentation are properly installed at your site, the command
43954
43955 @smallexample
43956 info gdb
43957 @end smallexample
43958
43959 should give you access to the complete manual.
43960
43961 @cite{Using GDB: A Guide to the GNU Source-Level Debugger},
43962 Richard M. Stallman and Roland H. Pesch, July 1991.
43963 @end ifset
43964 @c man end
43965
43966 @include gpl.texi
43967
43968 @node GNU Free Documentation License
43969 @appendix GNU Free Documentation License
43970 @include fdl.texi
43971
43972 @node Concept Index
43973 @unnumbered Concept Index
43974
43975 @printindex cp
43976
43977 @node Command and Variable Index
43978 @unnumbered Command, Variable, and Function Index
43979
43980 @printindex fn
43981
43982 @tex
43983 % I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
43984 % meantime:
43985 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
43986 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
43987 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
43988 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
43989 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
43990 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
43991 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
43992 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
43993 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
43994 \page\colophon
43995 % Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 1991.
43996 @end tex
43997
43998 @bye
This page took 1.050363 seconds and 5 git commands to generate.